114 0 113MB
Massey Ferguson 8400
Workshop service manual n° 3378647M2 CONTENTS 01 - Introduction - Specifications 03 - Engine 05 - Gearbox 06 - Rear axle 07 - Power take off 08 - Front axle 09 - Hydraulics 10 - Electrical equipment 11 - Electronics 12 - Cab and equipment
AGCO S.A. All rights reserved Beauvais France
H
September 2005
Massey Ferguson 8400
September 2005
¤ H
AGCO S.A. All rights reserved Beauvais France
Introduction - Specifications
01 - Introduction - Specifications CONTENTS 01A01 - Introduction
Massey Ferguson 8400
¤ H
Contents - i
Introduction - Specifications
Contents - ii
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400
Introduction
01A01 - Introduction
CONTENTS A . Using the manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . General characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 C . Ground speeds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 D . General dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 E . Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 F . Conversion tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 G . Retaining compounds and sealing products . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 H . Tightening torques . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
01A01.1
Introduction
01A01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Introduction
A . Using the manual General The purpose of this manual is to assist Dealers and Agents in the efficient installation, maintenance and repair of AGCO equipment. Carrying out the procedures as detailed, together with the use of special tools where appropriate, will enable the operations to be completed within the time stated in the Repair Time Schedule.
Page numbering
Tractor safety features may be impaired if non-genuine parts are fitted. Legislation in certain countries prohibits the fitting of parts that do not comply with the tractor manufacturer’s specifications. Torque wrench setting figures given in the Workshop Service Manual must be strictly adhered to. Locking devices must be fitted where specified. If the efficiency of a locking device is impaired during removal, it must be replaced. The tractor warranty may be invalidated if non-genuine AGCO parts are fitted. All AGCO replacement parts have the full backing of the manufacturer’s warranty. AGCO Dealers and Agents are required to supply only genuine service parts.
The present manual is divided into chapters and sections, and each page is numbered with the following information: Example: 10A01.1 10 = Chapter A = Section 01 = Sequence number within the section 1 = Page number within the section The issue number is indicated at the bottom of the page.
Use For quick reference, each chapter starts with a table of contents, listing the various sections included in that chapter.
Meaning of references (..) : identification of parts and components
Amendments Amended pages will be issued carrying the same page number as the former pages; only the issue number and date will be changed. Former pages should be destroyed.
Service tools Where the use of a service tool is necessary to carry out an operation, the tool reference is mentioned following the relevant instruction. Drawings for locally made tools are given in the final sections of the relevant chapters.
Repairs and replacements When parts have to be replaced, it is essential that only genuine AGCO parts are used. The following points are of particular importance when carrying out repairs and fitting replacement parts and accessories.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
01A01.3
Introduction
B . General characteristics 8450 model
Automated power take-off
yes
Front power take-off
no Front axle
Engine ISO (CV)power
215
ISO power (Kw)
158
Trademark
SISU EEM
Type
74ETA
Model
AG 210 (750/522): 15.75
Front / Rear axle synchro ratio
1.348
Type
fixed
Rotational direction
anti-clockwise
Number of clutch discs
6
Number of cylinders / Cylinder capacity (L)
6 / 7.4
Fender (4WD)
optional
Turbocharger
yes
2-wheel drive
no
Intercooler
Air / air
Front linkage (optional)
Injection pump
Bosch VP44
Fan
Viscostatic
152 l/min Closed Centre
yes
Alternator
150 A
Orbitrol steering unit
OSPDF 80/240
Steering (volume cc)
80 (first pump) and 240 (second pump)
Model
DYNA VT ML 200
Brake master cylinder
power-assisted
Clutch / Reverse shuttle
Gearbox with continuous variation, direction reverse under load
Transmission
Ranges-speeds
Continuous speed variation from 0 to 40 kph in forward and reverse position (speed limited to 30, 35, or 40 kph depending on country) Rear axle
Model
HA 200
Drive units
Epicyclic
3.5 T Hydraulics
Hydraulic trailer brake
optional (*)
Pneumatic trailer brake
no
Auxiliary spool valves (maximum number)
5 electrohydraulic (2 SMS)
Couplers
decompression Electronics
Transmission control
AUTOTRONIC 4
Wheel shaft Ø
110
Instrument panel
DCC2
Reduction ratio
8.25
Linkage calculator
Auto5
Brake discs per trumpet housing
6
Parking brake
ParkLock
Differential lock
multidisc
Reduction ratio of bevel gear / differential
3.58 Linkage
Stabilisers
telescopic
Perforated bar
optional
3-point linkage
type 3 or 3.2, hook or ball type (*)
Clevis
pin-adjusting or quick-adjusting scale
Automatic clevis
pin-adjusting or quick-adjusting scale
Hitch eye bolt
eye bolt or automatic hook (*)
Swinging drawbar
standard
Roller swinging drawbar
optional
Draft sensors
2
Sensor capacity
9T
Datatronic 3
optional
Dual control (front and rear)
optional
TIC without draft sensor
optional
Fieldstar
no Cab
Suspension
optional
Rear view mirrors
manual (standard) or electrical (optional)
Air conditioning
manual (standard) or automatic (optional)
Standard bonnet
tilting
Standard roof
standard
High-visibility roof
no
Reference (*): according to country
Power take-off Type
Interchangeable shaft
540/1000
standard
540E/1000
optional
Number of clutch discs
6
Power take-off brake
mechanical
Proportional PTO
no
01A01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Introduction 8460model
Front power take-off
no Front axle
Engine ISO (CV)power
235
Model
AG 210 (750/522): 15.75
Front / Rear axle synchro ratio
1.348
ISO power (Kw)
173
Type
fixed
Trademark
SISU EEM
Rotational direction
anti-clockwise
Type
74 ETA
Number of clutch discs
6
Number of cylinders / Cylinder capacity
6 / 7.4
Fender (4WD)
optional
Turbocharger
yes
Intercooler
Air / air
Injection pump
Bosch VP44
Fan
Viscostatic
Alternator
150 A Transmission
Model
DYNA VT ML 200
Clutch / Reverse shuttle
Gearbox with continuous variation, direction reverse under load
Ranges-speeds
Continuous speed variation from 0 to 40 kph in forward and reverse position (speed limited to 30, 35, or 40 kph depending on country)
2WD
no
Front linkage (optional)
3.5 T Hydraulics
152 l/min Closed Centre
yes
Orbitrol steering unit
OSPDF 80/240
Steering (volume cc)
80 (first pump) and 240 (second pump)
Brake master cylinder
power-assisted
Hydraulic trailer brake
optional (*)
Pneumatic trailer brake
no
Auxiliary spool valves (maximum number)
5 electrohydraulic (2 SMS)
Couplers
decompression
Rear axle
Electronics
Model
HA200
Drive units
Epicyclic
Wheel shaft Ø
110
Reduction ratio
8.25
Brake discs per trumpet housing
6
Parking brake
ParkLock
Differential lock
multidisc
Reduction ratio of bevel gear / differential
3.58
Transmission control
AUTOTRONIC 4
Instrument panel
DCC2
Linkage calculator
Auto5
Draft sensors
2
Sensor capacity
9T
Datatronic
optional
Dual control (front and rear)
optional
TIC without draft sensor
optional
Fieldstar
Linkage Stabilisers
telescopic
Perforated bar
optional
3-point linkage
type 3 or 3.2, hook or ball type (*)
Clevis
pin-adjusting or quick-adjusting scale
Automatic clevis
pin-adjusting or quick-adjusting scale
Hitch eye bolt
eye bolt or automatic hook (*)
Swinging drawbar
standard
Roller swinging drawbar
optional
no Cab
Suspension
optional
Rear view mirrors
manual (standard) or electrical (optional)
Air conditioning
manual (standard) or automatic (optional)
Standard bonnet
tilting
Standard roof
standard
High-visibility roof
no
Reference (*): according to country
Power take-off Type
Interchangeable shaft
540/1000
standard
540E/1000
optional
Number of clutch discs
6
Power take-off brake
mechanical
Proportional PTO
no
Automated power take-off
yes
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
01A01.5
Introduction 8470model
Front power take-off
no Front axle
Engine ISO (CV)power
260
Model
AG 280 (760/521): 16.8
Front / Rear axle synchro ratio
1.336
ISO power (Kw)
191
Type
fixed
Trademark
SISU EEM
Rotational direction
anti-clockwise
Type
84ETA
Number of clutch discs
6
Number of cylinders / Cylinder capacity
6 / 8.4
Fender (4WD)
optional
Turbocharger
yes
Intercooler
Air / air
Injection pump
Bosch VP44
Fan
Viscostatic
Alternator
150 A Transmission
Model
DYNA VT ML 260
Clutch / Reverse shuttle
Gearbox with continuous variation, direction reverse under load
Ranges-speeds
Continuous speed variation from 0 to 40 kph in forward and reverse position (speed limited to 30, 35, or 40 kph depending on country)
2WD
no
Front linkage (optional)
5T Hydraulics
152 l/min Closed Centre
yes
Orbitrol steering unit
OSPDF 80/240
Steering (volume cc)
80 (first pump) and 240 (second pump)
Brake master cylinder
power-assisted
Hydraulic trailer brake
optional (*)
Pneumatic trailer brake
no
Auxiliary spool valves (maximum number)
5 electrohydraulic (2 SMS)
Couplers
decompression
Rear axle
Electronics
Model
HA260
Drive units
Epicyclic
Wheel shaft Ø
110
Reduction ratio
9.2
Brake discs per trumpet housing
6
Parking brake
ParkLock
Differential lock
multidisc
Reduction ratio of bevel gear / differential
3.81
Transmission control
AUTOTRONIC 4
Instrument panel
DCC2
Linkage calculator
Auto5
Draft sensors
2
Sensor capacity
9T
Datatronic
optional
Dual control (front and rear)
optional
TIC without draft sensor
optional
Fieldstar
Linkage Stabilisers
telescopic
Perforated bar
optional
3-point linkage
type 3 or 3.2, hook or ball type (*)
Clevis
pin-adjusting or quick-adjusting scale
Automatic clevis
pin-adjusting or quick-adjusting scale
Hitch eye bolt
eye bolt or automatic hook (*)
Swinging drawbar
standard
Roller swinging drawbar
optional
no Cab
Suspension
optional
Rear view mirrors
manual (standard) or electrical (optional)
Air conditioning
manual (standard) or automatic (optional)
Standard bonnet
tilting
Standard roof
standard
High-visibility roof
no
Reference (*): according to country
Power take-off Type
Interchangeable shaft
540/1000
standard
540E/1000
optional
Number of clutch discs
6
Power take-off brake
mechanical
Proportional PTO
no
Automated power take-off
yes
01A01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Introduction 8480model
Front power take-off
no Front axle
Engine ISO (CV)power
290
Model
AG 280 (760/521): 16.8
Front / Rear axle synchro ratio
1.336
ISO power (Kw)
213
Type
fixed
Trademark
SISU EEM
Rotational direction
anti-clockwise
Type
84 ETA
Number of clutch discs
6
Number of cylinders / Cylinder capacity
6 / 8.4
Fender (4WD)
optional
Turbocharger
yes
Intercooler
Air / air
Injection pump
Bosch VP44
Fan
Viscostatic
Alternator
150 A Transmission
Model
DYNA VT ML 260
Clutch / Reverse shuttle
Gearbox with continuous variation, direction reverse under load
Ranges-speeds
Continuous speed variation from 0 to 40 kph in forward and reverse position (speed limited to 30, 35, or 40 kph depending on country)
2WD
no
Front linkage (optional)
5T Hydraulics
152 l/min Closed Centre
yes
Orbitrol steering unit
OSPDF 80/240
Steering (volume cc)
80 (first pump) and 240 (second pump)
Brake master cylinder
power-assisted
Hydraulic trailer brake
optional (*)
Pneumatic trailer brake
no
Auxiliary spool valves (maximum number)
5 electrohydraulic (2 SMS)
Couplers
decompression
Rear axle
Electronics
Model
HA260
Drive units
Epicyclic
Wheel shaft Ø
110
Reduction ratio
9.2
Brake discs per trumpet housing
6
Parking brake
ParkLock
Differential lock
multidisc
Reduction ratio of bevel gear / differential
3.81
Transmission control
AUTOTRONIC 4
Instrument panel
DCC2
Linkage calculator
Auto5
Draft sensors
2
Sensor capacity
9T
Datatronic
optional
Dual control (front and rear)
optional
TIC without draft sensor
optional
Fieldstar
Linkage Stabilisers
telescopic
Perforated bar
optional
3-point linkage
type 3 or 3.2, hook or ball type (*)
Clevis
pin-adjusting or quick-adjusting scale
Automatic clevis
pin-adjusting or quick-adjusting scale
Hitch eye bolt
eye bolt or automatic hook (*)
Swinging drawbar
standard
Roller swinging drawbar
optional
no Cab
Suspension
optional
Rear view mirrors
manual (standard) or electrical (optional)
Air conditioning
manual (standard) or automatic (optional)
Standard bonnet
tilting
Standard roof
standard
High-visibility roof
no
Reference (*): according to country
Power take-off Type
Interchangeable shaft
540/1000
standard
540E/1000
optional
Number of clutch discs
6
Power take-off brake
mechanical
Proportional PTO
no
Automated power take-off
yes
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
01A01.7
Introduction
C . Ground speeds
Range Tortoise Field speeds Hare Road speeds
kph
kph
Forward 0 - 32
Reverse 0 - 20
mph
0 - 20
0 - 12.4
kph
0 - 40
0 - 40
mph
0 - 25
0 - 25
40 kph
40
32 kph kph
MA-01-06003A
20
0 Fig. 1
NOTE: Speeds are limited as required by legislation in force in the relevant countries. Speed is limited electronically.
01A01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Introduction
D . General dimensions Wheels with steel flange The various track settings are obtained by changing the position of the rim in relation to the disc or by reversing the wheels. NOTE: Ensure a sufficient gap remains between the tyres and the inside of the fenders. If the wheels are reversed, transfer them to opposite sides of the tractor. On refitting, tighten the nuts progressively according to the tightening torque table (chapter 6). TABLE OF REAR WHEEL TRACK VALUES in mm
D E
Rear Axle
MA-01-06004A
D = wheel offset 75 mm (2.95 in) E = wheel disc thickness 15 mm (0.59 in) Disc facing inwards (min. - max.) Disc facing outwards (min. – max.)
8450 to 8480
HA 200/260 (Short straight shaft)
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
1699 (66.9) - 1996 (78.6)
2029 (79.9) - 2326 (91.6)
01A01.9
Introduction Wheels with cast iron disc TABLE OF REAR WHEEL TRACK VALUES in mm
D E DNF 12017-12
A
C
B
D
Rear Axle
MA-01-06005A
D = wheel offset 75 mm (2.95 in) E = wheel disc thickness 15 mm (0.59 in) Disc facing inwards (min. - max.) Disc facing outwards (min. – max.)
8450 to 8480 8450 to 8480
01A01.10
¤ H
HA 200/260 HA 200/260
A - 1485 (58.5) - 1781 (70.1) B - 1959 (77.1) - 2256 (88.8)
C - 1815 (71.5) - 2111 (83.1) D - 2289 (90.1) - 2586 (101.8)
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Introduction Attachment points and dimensions
4445,11 1089,87
952 512
211,3
885
17
128,41 15
8
190
16
0
7
6
1551,5
22
21 4 1
5
2 -! !
3
14 9
Z
10
Y
18
13
11 12
20
19
Dimensions in relation to point 0 X
REFERENCE
DIMENSIONS (mm)
0 = Engine axis
REFERENCE
DIMENSIONS (mm)
x
y
z
0 = Engine axis
x
y
z
-1831.54
+/-193.504
-157.14
12
M 20
-848.64
+/-193.504
-89.98
13
M 20
-118.89
+/-193.504
-176
1
M 20
2
M 20
-1875.9
+/-193.504
-185.17
3
M 20
-1873.89
+/-193.504
-265.14
14
M 20
-747.07
+/-193.504
-87.13
4
M 20
-1636.6
+/-193.504
-151.24
15
M 20
-247.86
+/-308.504
18.15
5
M 20
-1377.98
+/-193.504
-112.08
16
M 20
-120.9
+/-308.504
-21.34
6
M 20
-1303.05
+/-193.504
-111.19
17
M 20
-118.89
+/-308.504
-59.63
7
M 20
-1253.07
+/-193.504
-109.93
18
M 20
-245.85
+/-308.504
-61.83
8
M 20
-961.67
+/-193.504
-57.25
19
M 20
-243.3
+/-308.504
-163.39
9
M 20
-947.97
+/-193.504
-181.11
20
M 20
-116.34
+/-308.504
-160.2
10
M 20
-950.21
+/-193.504
92.24
21
M 20
1718.33
+/-775
-35
11
M 20
-846.41
+/-193.504
-178.55
22
M 20
1878.33
+/-775
-35
Fig. 2
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
01A01.11
Introduction
E . Capacities
01A01.12
¤ H
Types
Models
Capacities
Engine oil
8450 8460 / 8470 / 8480
19 L 20 L
Auxiliary hydraulics
8450 / 8460 / 8470 / 8480
90 L / 100 L
Clutch hydraulics
8450 / 8460 / 8470 / 8480
0.6 L
Transmission oil
8450 / 8460 / 8470 / 8480
85 L
Rear final drive unit
8450 / 8460 / 8470 / 8480
2 x 13 L
Front axle
8450 / 8460 8470 / 8480
14.8 L 16 L
Front final drive unit
8450 / 8460 8470 / 8480
2 x 1.7 L 2 x 2.7 L
Engine cooling
8450 / 8460 / 8470 / 8480
34 L
Fuel tank
8450 / 8460 / 8470 / 8480
350 L
Additional tank
8450 / 8460 / 8470 / 8480
250 L
Windshield washer
8450 / 8460 / 8470 / 8480
4L
Air conditioning
8450 / 8460 / 8470 / 8480
1,550 grams
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Introduction
POWER
F . Conversion tables
multiply by LENGTH multiply by
ps
x 0.9863
hp
hp
x 1.0139
ps
kW
x 1.3410
hp
hp
x 0.7457
kW
mm
x 0.0394
in
in
x 25.400
mm
m
x 3.2808
ft
TORQUE
ft
x 0.3048
m
multiply by
km
x 0.6214
mile
Nm
x 0.738
lbf ft
mile
x 1.6093
km
lbf ft
x 1.356
Nm
AREA
PRESSURE
multiply by
multiply by
mm²
x 0.0015
in²
bar
x 14.504
lbf/in²
in²
x 645.16
mm²
lbf/in²
x 0.0690
bar
m²
x 10.764
ft²
ft²
x 0.0929
m²
SPEED
ha
x 2.4711
acre
multiply by
acre
x 0.4047
ha
km/h
x 0.6214
mph
mph
x 1.6093
km/h
VOLUME multiply by
WEIGHT
cm3
x 0.06102
in3
in3
x 16.387
cm3
g
x 0.0353
oz
m3
x 35.315
ft3
oz
x 28.350
g
ft3
x 0.0283
m3
kg
x 2.2046
lb
lb
x 0.4536
kg
kg
x 0.00098
UK ton
UK ton
x 1016.1
kg
t
x 0.9842
UK ton
UK ton
x 1.016
t
t
x 1.1023
US ton
US ton
x 0.9072
t
CAPACITY multiply by ml
x 0.0351
fl oz
fl oz
x 28.413
ml
l
x 0.2200
gal
gal
x 4.5640
l
l
x 0.2640
US gal
US gal
x 3.7850
l
gal
x 1.2010
US gal
US gal
x 0.8330
gal
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
multiply by
TEMPERATURE °C
°C x 1.8 + 32
°F
°F
(°F - 32)/1.8
°C
01A01.13
Introduction
G . Retaining compounds and sealing products The Loctite compounds mentioned in this manual are referred to by their industrial name. For repair purposes, use their commercial names or the corresponding AGCO references listed in the following table: Loctite industrial name
Description name
270
Stud lock
242
Lock and Seal
Silicone AS 310
Clear silicone
5910 black silicone trumpet sealant
Blacktite
510 mating face sealant
Formajoint Masterjoint
518 mating face sealant
Unijoint Masterjoint
NOTE: use the product “Form A gasket 2” when sealing between plastic material and cast iron (or steel).
- for cylindrical fittings, apply the product on the two mating faces using a clean brush. - for mating faces, apply a bead to one of the two faces, circling the holes, and then tighten as quickly as possible. NOTE: a) Do not use too much of the compound in order to avoid locking adjacent parts. b) Do not attempt to retighten after 5 minutes of curing, in order to avoid breaking the film of compound. c) If the ambient temperature is less than +10°C, and to ensure quicker setting of Loctite compounds, (except SILICOMET), use LOCTITE T 747 activator on at least one of the two parts. Excess sealant outside the joint will not harden (anaerobic curing of the compound – i.e. curing takes place only in absence of oxygen).
Grease When grease is used in components which are in contact with transmission oil, use grease which is miscible with oil to avoid clogging the hydraulic filters. Use grease: "Amber Technical" grease supplied by: WITCO company, 76320 Saint-Pierre des Elfes, France.
These products can be ordered from the following address: Henkel Loctite France S.A. 10, avenue Eugène Gazeau BP 40090 F-60304 Senlis Cedex, FRANCE
Application method for Loctite products 1. Remove all traces of previous sealants and corrosion - mechanically: wire brush or emery cloth - chemically: "DECAPLOC 88" Leave the product to take effect and then wipe clean. 2. Degrease the components with dry solvent - preferably, use “Super Solvant Sec LOCTITE 706”. 3. Allow the solvents to evaporate 4. Apply the recommended type of LOCTITE product to the parts: - for blind tapped holes, apply a quantity of the product to the last threads at the bottom of the hole.
01A01.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Introduction
H . Tightening torques Use the tightening torques for screws and nuts as indicated in the tables: - 1 and 2 for metric threads - 3 and 4 for inch-system threads When a specific torque is required, it is stated in the text. Tables 1 and 3 indicate the nomal tightening torque values to apply to threaded zinc-plated elements, with normal nuts, with coarse or fine threads, with or without a flat washer or lockwasher, and weldable nuts more than 0.8 d high. Tables 2 and 4 indicate the reduced tightening torque values to apply to threaded elements in assemblies with zinc-plated self-locking locknuts, phosphate-coated nuts and screws, thin nuts, waldable nuts less than 0.8 d high. These values are to be applied to dry assemblies. If the threads are oiled, reduce the tightening torques. NOTE: Read the tensile grade on the screw head to determine the corresponding tightening torque. Example:
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
01A01.15
Introduction
Table 1: Tightening torque values. Zinc-plated metric threads
Nominal dimension d
Tensile grade
Tensile grade
ISO 8.8 (SAE 5, BS S)
ISO 10.9 (SAE 8, BS V)
Torque Nm
Torque Nm
Min
Max
Min
Max
M3
1.3
1.7
1
2.4
M4
3.1
4.1
4
5.7
M5
6
8
8
11.5
M6
10
14
14
20
M8
25
35
36
46
M10
50
70
72
96
M12
90
120
120
160
M16
200
260
300
400
M20
420
560
600
800
M24
720
960
1000
1300
M30
1400
1800
2100
2800
M36
2500
3300
3600
4800
Table 2: Reduced tightening torque values. Metric threads
Nominal dimension d
Tensile grade
ISO 8.8 (SAE 5, BS S)
ISO 10.9 (SAE 8, BS V)
Torque Nm
Torque Nm
Min
Max
Min
Max
M3
1
1.4
1
1.9
M4
2.5
3.3
3
4.6
M5
4.8
6.4
6
9.2
M6
8
11
12
16
M8
20
28
29
37
M10
40
56
57
77
M12
72
96
100
130
M16
160
210
240
320
M20
340
450
480
640
M24
570
770
800
1040
M30
1100
1400
1700
2200
M36
2000
2600
2900
3800
01A01.16
¤ H
Tensile grade
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Introduction
Table 3: Tightening torque values. Zinc-plated inch system threads
Nominal dimension d
Tensile grade
Tensile grade
SAE 5 (ISO 8.8, BS S)
SAE 8 (ISO 10.9, BS V)
Torque Nm
Torque Nm
Min
Max
Min
Max
#6
1.8
2.4
2
3.3
#8
3.4
4.4
4
6.3
#10
4.7
6.3
6
8.9
1/4
11
15
16
22
5/16
22
30
31
43
3/8
39
53
55
75
7/16
64
86
90
120
1/2
100
130
140
180
5/8
200
260
280
370
3/4
350
460
490
660
7/8
560
760
800
1060
1
840
1120
1200
1600
1 1/8
1050
1390
1700
2200
1 1/4
1500
2000
2400
3200
1 1/2
2600
3400
4100
5400
Table 4: Reduced tightening torque values. Inch-system threads
Nominal dimension d
Tensile grade
SAE 5 (ISO 8.8, BS S)
SAE 8 (ISO 10.9, BS V)
Torque Nm
Torque Nm
Min
Max
Min
Max
#6
1.5
1.9
2
2.6
#8
2.7
3.5
3
5
#10
3.8
5
5
7.1
1/4
8.8
12
13
18
5/16
18
24
25
34
3/8
31
42
44
60
7/16
51
69
72
96
1/2
80
104
110
140
5/8
160
210
220
300
3/4
280
370
390
530
7/8
450
610
640
850
1
670
900
960
1280
1 1/8
8400
1100
1360
1760
1 1/4
1200
1600
1920
2560
1 1/2
2100
2700
3280
4320
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Tensile grade
01A01.17
Introduction
01A01.18
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Engine
03 - Engine CONTENTS 03A01 - Sisu engine - General
Massey Ferguson 8400
¤ H
Contents - i
Engine
Contents - ii
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400
Sisu engine - General
03A01 - Sisu engine - General
CONTENTS A . Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Specifications and standards concerning fuel, oil and coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 C . Main characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
03A01.1
Sisu engine - General
03A01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Sisu engine - General
A . Introduction This section only provides general information about Sisu engines used on this tractor series.
B . Specifications and standards concerning fuel, oil and coolant The engines fitted on this tractor series comply with standards concerning emissions imposed by the authorities. (EU97/68/EC Stage 2 and EPA 40 CFR 89 Tier 2). The quality of fluids used in these engines as well as the servicing schedule must be respected in order to keep pollution emission levels low and to maintain the tractor good performance during its whole life. Fuel quality: The fuel must comply with standard DIN EN 590 and with the following specifications: Density (at 15°C): 0.82 to 0.84 Kg/dm3 Viscosity (at 40°C): 2 to 4.5 mm2/s Cetane index: min. 51 Sulphur content: max. 0.005 p-% Water content: max. 200 mg/kg Oil quality: The oil used must comply with standard API CH-4. Coolant quality: The coolant used must comply with standard ASTM D 3306. It must be composed of pure water and ethylene/propylene glycol antifreeze agent in the following proportions: 40 - 60% water 40 - 60% antifreeze agent The ideal ratio is 50% water to 50% antifreeze agent.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
03A01.3
Sisu engine - General
C . Main characteristics Model Engine type Number of cylinders Bore Stroke Capacity Compression ratio Compression pressure (kPa) Allowable compression deviation between cylinders (kPa) Output at 2,200 rpm ch (kw) ISO Maximum torque (Nm) at speed (rpm) Idle speed Nominal speed Maximum speed at no load Pre- / Post-heating Wet cylinder sleeves Weight (kg) Injection pump Trademark and type Rotation Static timing angle (degrees) Engine position Engine check angle (degrees) Injection order Lift pump Injectors Trademark Code Nozzle holder Nozzle New and servicing setting (bar) Miscellaneous Suction system Minimum boost pressure at 2,200 rpm at full load (bar) Number of valves per cylinder Valve spring Valve seat insert (Inlet / Exhaust) Inlet / Exhaust valve angle Inlet / Exhaust valve tip clearance (mm) Oil cooler Number of temperature switches Opening temperature (start/full) Fan Piston cooling nozzle Oil filter Fuel filter (microns)
03A01.4
¤ H
8450 SISU 74 ETA 6 108 134 7.4 17.5/1 2000 / 3500 350 215 (158) 925 1500 800 2200 2350 yes yes 520 Bosch VP44 Clockwise 26° TDC pin 1-5-3-6-2-4 Electric Stanadyne M33877 5 ports 278 Intercooler air/air turbocompressor (no wastegate) 1.2 2 simple yes / yes 35° / 45° 0.35 / 0.35 yes 2 83°C Vistronic yes 1 prefilter (30) + filter (5)
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Sisu engine - General
Model Engine type Number of cylinders Bore Stroke Capacity Compression ratio Compression pressure (kPa) Allowable compression deviation between cylinders (kPa) Output at 2,200 rpm ch (kw) ISO Maximum torque (Nm) at speed (rpm) Idle speed Nominal speed Maximum speed at no load Pre- / Post-heating Wet cylinder sleeves Weight (kg) Injection pump Trademark and type Rotation Static timing angle (degrees) Engine position Engine check angle (degrees) Injection order Lift pump Injectors Trademark Code Nozzle holder Nozzle New and servicing setting (bar) Miscellaneous Suction system Minimum boost pressure at 2,200 rpm at full load (bar) Number of valves per cylinder Valve spring Valve seat insert (Inlet / Exhaust) Inlet / Exhaust valve angle Inlet / Exhaust valve tip clearance (mm) Oil cooler Number of temperature switches Opening temperature (start/full) Fan Piston cooling nozzle Oil filter Fuel filter (microns)
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
8460 SISU 74 ETA 6 108 134 7.4 17.5/1 2000 / 3500 350 235 (173) 990 1500 800 2200 2350 yes yes 520 Bosch VP44 Clockwise 26° TDC pin 1-5-3-6-2-4 Electric Stanadyne M33877 5 ports 278 Intercooler air/air turbocompressor (no wastegate) 1.3 2 simple yes / yes 35° / 45° 0.35 / 0.35 yes 2 83°C Vistronic yes 1 prefilter (30) + filter (5)
03A01.5
Sisu engine - General
Model Engine type Number of cylinders Bore Stroke Capacity Compression ratio Compression pressure (kPa) Allowable compression deviation between cylinders (kPa) Output at 2,200 rpm ch (kw) ISO Maximum torque (Nm) at speed (rpm) Idle speed Nominal speed Maximum speed at no load Pre- / Post-heating Wet cylinder sleeves Weight (kg) Injection pump Trademark and type Rotation Static timing angle (degrees) Engine position Engine check angle (degrees) Injection order Lift pump Injectors Trademark Code Nozzle holder Nozzle New and servicing setting (bar) Miscellaneous Suction system Minimum boost pressure at 2,200 rpm at full load (bar) Number of valves per cylinder Valve spring Valve seat insert (Inlet / Exhaust) Inlet / Exhaust valve angle Inlet / Exhaust valve tip clearance (mm) Oil cooler Number of temperature switches Opening temperature (start/full) Fan Piston cooling nozzle Oil filter Fuel filter (microns)
03A01.6
¤ H
8470 SISU 84 ETA 6 111 145 8.4 17.5/1 2000 / 3500 350 260 (191) 925 1100 800 2200 2350 yes yes 660 Bosch VP44 Clockwise 28° TDC pin 1-5-3-6-2-4 Electric Stanadyne M33877 5 ports 278 Intercooler air/air turbocompressor (no wastegate) 1.1 2 simple yes / yes 35° / 45° 0.35 / 0.35 yes 2 83°C Vistronic yes 1 prefilter (30) + filter (5)
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Sisu engine - General
Model Engine type Number of cylinders Bore Stroke Capacity Compression ratio Compression pressure (kPa) Allowable compression deviation between cylinders (kPa) Output at 2,200 rpm ch (kw) ISO Maximum torque (Nm) at speed (rpm) Idle speed Nominal speed Maximum speed at no load Pre- / Post-heating Wet cylinder sleeves Weight (kg) Injection pump Trademark and type Rotation Static timing angle (degrees) Engine position Engine check angle (degrees) Injection order Lift pump Injectors Trademark Code Nozzle holder Nozzle New and servicing setting (bar) Miscellaneous Suction system Minimum boost pressure at 2,200 rpm at full load (bar) Number of valves per cylinder Valve spring Valve seat insert (Inlet / Exhaust) Inlet / Exhaust valve angle Inlet / Exhaust valve tip clearance (mm) Oil cooler Number of temperature switches Opening temperature (start/full) Fan Piston cooling nozzle Oil filter Fuel filter (microns)
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
8480 SISU 84 ETA 6 111 145 8.4 17.5/1 2000 / 3500 350 290 (213) 1190 1500 800 2200 2350 yes yes 660 Bosch VP44 Clockwise 28° TDC pin 1-5-3-6-2-4 Electric Stanadyne M33877 5 ports 278 Intercooler air/air turbocompressor (no wastegate) 1.2 2 simple yes / yes 35° / 45° 0.35 / 0.35 yes 2 83°C Vistronic yes 1 prefilter (30) + filter (5)
03A01.7
Sisu engine - General
03A01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Gearbox
05 - Gearbox CONTENTS 05A01 - General - Dyna VT Operation 05B01 - DYNA VT hydraulics 05C01 - Replacing the DYNA VT unit
Massey Ferguson 8400
¤ H
Contents - i
Gearbox
Contents - ii
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400
General - Dyna VT Operation
05A01 - General - Dyna VT Operation
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Dyna VT transmission operating diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 C . Operation and use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05A01.1
General - Dyna VT Operation
05A01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
General - Dyna VT Operation
A . General Operating principle of the DYNA VT transmission The Dyna VT transmission is a continuously variable transmission in both forward and reverse positions. Hare/Tortoise range switching with synchronisation is incorporated into the transmission. The Tortoise range allows ground speeds of 0 to 32 kph. The Hare range allows ground speeds of 0 to 50 kph (according to country), and the maximum standard speed is electronically limited to 40 kph. The Tortoise range is intended for heavy traction work at low speeds of less than 12 kph. The Hare range is intended for road driving (transport). At 50 kph, the transmission ratio is controlled electronically according to engine speed. Power transmission can be hydrostatic OR mechanical or hydrostatic AND mechanical. In simple terms, we can state : - Slow forward position = Power transmission: majority = hydrostatic / minority = mechanical - Fast forward position = Power transmission: minority = hydrostatic / majority = mechanical. For detailed explanations, see the transmission operating diagram.
Power transmission hydrostatic circuit The Dyna VT transmission unit is flexible suspended in the transmission housing. This latter also serves as an oil tank for the hydrostatic transmission. Filling: OilTerrac Extra or Terrac Tractran 9/Fluid 9, or any other oil complying with standard CMS M1143 or CMS M1144. The lube oil pump sucks oil through the suction strainer. The temperature sensor monitors the transmission oil temperature. In brief, if the transmission oil is cold, little oil passes through the cooler and most goes through the by-pass valve. This valve opens at a differential pressure of approximately 3.5 bars. The hydraulic oil temperature is monitored by the temperature sensor. The service pump supplies the system pressure to the Dyna VT control spool valves and comfort control solenoid valves. The system pressure of approximately 18 bars is limited by a pressure-limiting valve with throttling port.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Two different pressures are present in the system. • Low pressure for the Dyna VT transmission control and auxiliary pressure for rear PTO clutch, differential block and universal joint brake. The measuring point of this pressure is approximately 18 bars. • High pressure in the Dyna VT transmission. Pressure measuring point, approximately 500 + 20 bars. The oil filter clogging is monitored by a pressure switch according to the transmission oil temperature. When this temperature is lower than 50°C, oil filter clogging is not monitored. Cooled transmission oil inlet into the high pressure circuit is performed in alternation by two non-return valves. Hot transmission oil outlet from the high pressure circuit occurs through the pressure relief valve. The high pressure circuit comprises : a variable displacement pump and a hydrostatic motor, two non-return valves, two high pressure limiting valves, one pressure relief valve, one coupler function solenoid valve, one clutch function controlled valve and one check connector. The pump and motor screw cylinders are controlled by two 4/3 spool valves. These 4/3 spool valves are mechanically controlled by the cam channel drive shaft. Rotation of the drive shaft is initiated, according to the need, by the control unit which thus defines the hydraulic capacity and hence the hydraulic power. The variable displacement pump and hydrostatic motor pivot proportionally. In backup position, the screw shaft is manually activated from the driver’s cab. In limp home position, the transmission automatically blocks at approximately 30 kph after engine start-up. If the clutch pedal, parking brake or neutral switch are used, the high pressure circuit is automatically unloaded by means of two high pressure limiters. The coupler function is controlled by the pressure limiter.
05A01.3
General - Dyna VT Operation The control unit (Fig. 1) The control unit drives the cam channel drive shaft, which changes the Dyna VT transmission ratio. The control unit comprises the following elements : • Limp home operation control (required in the event of electronic control failure). • Coupling of the incremental rotational angle sensor with a digital resolution of 8,000 pulses per revolution. • Epicyclic gear train transmission i = 192: 1 (screw shaft motor) • 12 VDC electric motor, 0.4 to 7 amps, vacuum control unit 4,500 rpm • Friction clutch 2.5 to 3.5 Nm, using the limp home operation socket wrench, 4 to 5 Nm.
Fig. 1
Following ignition, the control unit searches for the reference point (approximate neutral point between forward and reverse operation).
Sensors Engine sensor (TR23) (Fig. 2): measures engine speed. This sensor measures engine speed. If it fails, only the limp home operation can be used.
Fig. 2
Summing shaft (TR19) and drive pinion (TR11) Hall sensor: measures engine speed or rate and recognises the rotational direction (Fig. 3).
Fig. 3
05A01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
General - Dyna VT Operation High pressure sensor (TR17) transmits the instantaneous oil pressure in the high pressure oil circuit to the electronic system (Fig. 4).
TR17
Fig. 4
Throttle pedal sensor (CAB 44) (Fig. 5): transmits the position of the throttle pedal to the electronic system and compares it to the engine speed. This position sensor is used for load control.
Fig. 5
Clutch pedal progressivity sensor (CAB 12) (Fig. 6): electronically monitors clutch pedal travel.
Fig. 6
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05A01.5
General - Dyna VT Operation Hare / Tortoise range position sensor (TR8) (Fig. 7): electronically monitors the range selector switch position.
Fig. 7
Temperature sensor (TR12) (Fig. 8): monitors transmission oil temperature. Temperatures greater than 110°C are stored with an error code.
Fig. 8 HP filter clogging sensor (TR13) (Fig. 9): monitors the clogging of the high pressure filter.
Fig. 9
05A01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H 4
4
1
1 : Epicyclic gear train 2 : Hydrostatic pump 3 : Summing shaft 4 : Hydrostatic motor 5 : Range shifting
A: Transmission of mechanical force B: Transmission of hydrostatic force C: Power take-off drive D: Front axle drive
D: Sun gear pinion Drives the summing shaft
C: Pinion gear
B: Ring gear Drives the hydrostatic pump
A: Planet carrier Driven by the engine
B . Dyna VT transmission operating diagrams
5
3
2
General - Dyna VT Operation
Epicyclic gear train / Power distribution
Fig. 10
05A01.7
05A01.8
¤ H 4
5
2
3
4
1
ENGINE STARTED, TRACTOR AT STANDSTILL
• The engine drives the planet carrier (A) • The ring gear (B) turns, driving the pump (2) without any flow • The hydrostatic motors 4 do not turn • The sun gear (D) does not turn as it is blocked by the tractor wheels via the rear axle bevel gear
B: Transmission of hydrostatic force
A: Transmission of mechanical force
General - Dyna VT Operation
Dynamic stop
Fig. 11
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
4
5
3
2
4
1
99% TRANSMISSION OF HYDROSTATIC POWER 1% TRANSMISSION OF MECHANICAL POWER
• The pump (2) tilts and supplies flow to the motors (4) • The motors (4) drive the rear axle • The sun gear starts to turn and the ring gear speed decreases
B: Transmission of hydrostatic force
A: Transmission of mechanical force
General - Dyna VT Operation
Start-up
Fig. 12
05A01.9
05A01.10
¤ H 4
5
3
2
4
1
50% TRANSMISSION OF HYDROSTATIC POWER 50% TRANSMISSION OF MECHANICAL POWER
• The pump (2) angle increases • The pump flow increases and the angle of the motors (4) decreases • The sun gear speed increases, increasing the bevel gear speed • The planet carrier speed is constant • The ring gear speed decreases
B : Transmission of hydrostatic force
A: Transmission of mechanical force
General - Dyna VT Operation
Average ground speed
Fig. 13
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
4
5
3
2
4
1
REDUCED ENGINE SPEED 100% TRANSMISSION OF MECHANICAL POWER
• The angle of the motors (4) is 0° and the flow from the pump is blocked • The pump (2) is thus blocked stationary, as is the ring gear • The planet carrier turns • The sun gear turns, driving the bevel gear on its own
B : Transmission of hydrostatic force
A: Transmission of mechanical force
General - Dyna VT Operation
Transport
Fig. 14
05A01.11
05A01.12
¤ H 4
5
3
2
4
1
AVERAGE SPEED 100% TRANSMISSION OF HYDROSTATIC POWER THE GEAR RING ROTATES FASTER THAN THE ENGINE
• The pump (2) is tilted at the opposite angle, so the flow is reversed • The motors (4) turn in the opposite direction • The sun gear thus turns in the opposite direction to the planet carrier and so also drives the bevel gear in the opposite direction • The ring gear speed increases
B: Transmission of hydrostatic force
A: Transmission of mechanical force
General - Dyna VT Operation
Reverse
Fig. 15
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
General - Dyna VT Operation Architecture of the hydrostatic components For conventional hydrostatic components, the rotational angle only reaches 30°. Example of a conventional variable displacement pump with axial pistons.
Piston travel
Angular travel
Cylinder block Fig. 16 This system, on the other hand, proposes hydrostatic components specially designed to provide a 45° rotational angle. Example of a special variable displacement pump with axial pistons. This means : • Higher intrinsic yield of hydrostatic components with respect to conventional components. • A 45° rotational angle offers the possibility of increasing the ground speed scope, resulting in a decrease in the number of required mechanical ranges.
Fig. 17
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05A01.13
General - Dyna VT Operation
C . Operation and use 1
Start-up
2
10
Switch on the ignition. The TC 2.10 and DC 2.10 (2.00 being the software version installed in the tractor) symbols flash on the instrument panel right-hand screen (Fig. 18).
15
5
20
RPM x 100
0
25
A
HYDR OIL 95 %
A
540 750 1000
MA-05-04290A
A
B
95°C
85°C
110°C
60°C
A
KPH MPH RPM
100°C
B
540 750 1000
A
540 750 1000
KPH MPH RPM
A
B
KPH MPH RPM
Fig. 18
Fully press down the clutch pedal (Fig. 19).
Fig. 19 The left-hand lever (reverse shuttle) should be in the neutral position (Fig. 20). Start the engine and release the clutch pedal.
Fig. 20
05A01.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
General - Dyna VT Operation Selecting movement and direction The Dyna VT transmission possesses a user interface and a specific display screen. The power shuttle lever (Fig. 21) controls direction of travel, and speed increase and decrease. Set the left-hand lever to the desired direction of movement, the corresponding symbol comes on the relevant screen. When the tractor is in movement, each change of direction is achieved with the left-hand lever (Fig. 21). (1) Neutral position (2) Forward position (3) Reverse position To set the tractor in motion (forward or reverse), adapt the transmission ratio with the right-hand lever, or the plus and minus buttons of the reverse shuttle lever, depending on the desired speed. During tractor movement, if the clutch pedal is activated, the transmission ratio is decreased until speed is zero.
2 1 3
Fig. 21
The armrest lever (Fig. 22), with no neutral or ParkLock, also controls speed increase and decrease depending on the direction of movement.
Fig. 22
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05A01.15
General - Dyna VT Operation Lever mode and pedal mode At start-up, the tractor is always in lever mode, transmission control is performed with the lever only (Fig. 24). To activate the various modes (lever, pedal...), use button (1) (Fig. 24) with the throttle pedal released. The status of the selected mode is visible on the DOT MATRIX screen (Fig. 23 and Fig. 26) 1- In pedal mode, the transmission is exclusively controlled by the pedal. To preset the maximum speed, press the clutch pedal to neutral position, then activate the armrest lever (Fig. 22) or the left-hand lever in forward position (Fig. 21) to increase or decrease the value displayed on the DOT MATRIX screen (Fig. 26). Engine speed is electronically adjusted to the transmission speed. Two variants may be selected when in pedal mode :
1 Fig. 24
1-1. POWER MODE. This is the max. speed at the max. engine speed (no programmed max. engine speed). 1-2. ECO MODE. This is the max. speed at the engine speed of 1,800 rpm (in this mode, 1,800 rpm is the max. engine speed). 2- In lever mode, the speed depends on the movement on the lever on armrest (Fig. 22). 3- A third mode may be available, the self-propelled mode. In this mode, the user sets the engine speed with the A and B memories and forward motion is controlled by the throttle pedal and the hand throttle lever (2) (Fig. 25) or the armrest speed lever (Fig. 22).
2 Fig. 25
Lever mode
Fig. 23 Pedal mode
05A01.16
¤ H
Max. speed
Fig. 26
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
General - Dyna VT Operation Increasing and decreasing speed To increase or decrease speed, both levers can be used. The left-hand lever (Fig. 27) adjusts speed by increments of 0.1 to 2 kph, depending on the duration of lever pressure.
Fig. 27
The right-hand lever (Fig. 28) makes adjusting the transmission ratio easier thanks to its progressive action.When the ratio decreases, the tractor stops at 0 kph (dynamic stop).
Fig. 28
Adjusting the speed throttle lever The travel of the right-hand armrest lever possesses increments that vary with the position of this latter. There are 3 types of increment (Fig. 29): • 0.03 to 0.5 during the slot 1 or slot 4 • 1 during slot 2 or slot 5 • 2 during slot 3 or slot 6 NOTE: If speed regulation is active, pressing the lever automatically deactivates it.
SLOT 3 SLOT 2 SLOT 1 SLOT 4 SLOT 5 SLOT 6 Fig. 29
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05A01.17
General - Dyna VT Operation Hare / Tortoise range The Dyna VT transmission possesses 2 gear ranges. Each range is limited:
Gear range (in kph) Tortoise
Hare
Display
KPH MA-05-04143A
Fig. 30
KPH MA-05-04142A
Fig. 31
Forward
0 to 32
0 to 40
Reverse
0 to 20
0 to 40
B Fig. 32
A button (B) on the right-hand console (Fig. 32) is used for shifting Hare/Tortoise range. When the tractor is in movement, shifting can only be performed from Tortoise to Hare. For shifting from Hare to Tortoise, the left-hand lever (Fig. 27) must be in the neutral position or the clutch pedal depressed. Memorising
SV1
and
SV2
Speed regulator SV1 and SV2 The ground speed is kept constant. The “speed regulator” function enables the user to store a ground speed and to recall it easily. Two independent memory keys (SV1 and SV2) are available (Fig. 33). This allows two speeds to be memorised (e.g.: working speed and transport speed). The memorised speeds are displayed to the right of the Dot Matrix screen (Fig. 34) (A) and (B). When the “speed regulator” is used, the screen display is as in Fig. 34. “SV1” activation indicator (D) “SV2” activation indicator (E)
Fig. 33
D
A
E
B Fig. 34
05A01.18
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
General - Dyna VT Operation Preset speeds using the SV1 and SV2 potentiometers (Fig. 35) After having called up the “speed regulator” menu, the ground speed can be adjusted using the SV1 and SV2 potentiometers. The adjusted values are automatically stored and remain in memory even after the tractor is turned off. NOTE: It is also possible to change the stored speed when the tractor is driving with an activated "regulated" speed. It is possible to switch from one memory to the other simply by pressing the SV1 and SV2 buttons (Fig. 33). If buttons SV1 or SV2 (Fig. 33) are pressed down for more than 3 seconds, the current speed is memorised and replaces the previous stored value. The "speed regulator" can only be activated if the following conditions have been met : • Clutch pedal not activated • The tractor is in movement • Engine speed greater than 1,100 rpm If these conditions are not met the "speed regulator" function is deactivated and the instantaneous transmission ratio is maintained, with no subsequent control. Start-up with the “speed regulator” function is not possible. Stored speeds can be activated in both directions of movement. “Speed regulator” control ceases when: • The drive lever is used • The foot brake or the engine brake is used • Engine speed drops below 1,100 rpm • The neutral switch is activated • The driver switches from Tortoise to Hare.
Adjusting speed regulators
Fig. 35
Supervisor icon
Fig. 36
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05A01.19
General - Dyna VT Operation Engine underspeed supervisor This supervisor is used to limit the drop in engine speed and to adapt it to engine output. When operating at the engine maximum output, the driver must constantly adapt the tractor speed with the controls in order to remain within the appropriate power range. Permanent comparison is performed between the specified output speed (position of the throttle pedal) and the engine speed. The underspeed supervisor is automatically triggered when the engine speed drops under the effect of a load. The supervisor value is set by means of the potentiometer located on the right-hand console (Fig. 37). When the engine underspeed supervisor is active, an icon is displayed on the left-hand screen (Fig. 36). Control is activated only if the engine speed drops by more than 180 rpm.
Adjusting the underspeed supervisor
Fig. 37
Potentiometer set to 10: The ground speed decreases to maintain a constant engine speed. Potentiometer set to 40: The engine speed increases to maintain a constant ground speed. Potentiometer set between 10 and 40: Combination of the two previous explanations.
05A01.20
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
General - Dyna VT Operation Clutch-coupler function (CLUTCH) Clutch function Although the Dyna VT transmission has neither forward clutch nor coupler, the tractor possesses a clutch pedal. The clutch pedal is used for dosing the traction effort (in a similar manner to conventional clutch slipping). When an obstacle appears suddenly, the tractor can be rapidly stopped, just like a conventional tractor, by pressing the clutch and brake pedals. Coupler function Traction power is limited at low engine speed thanks to a pressure relief valve located on the transmission hydrostatic loop. In connection with engine speed, the coupler function is achieved by modulating the pressure in the hydrostatic circuit. Thus, the coupler function replaces the measured action of a clutch pedal.
Fig. 38
Coupler function under traction The coupler function enters into action as soon as engine speed drops below 1,400 rpm. Pressure drops in the hydrostatic loop in proportion to the drop in engine speed. Just like a coupler, the function limits engine overload and avoids stalling. The coupler function can be validated with the DOT MATRIX (Fig. 38). NOTE: to activate (Fig. 38) or deactivate (Fig. 39) the coupler function, press the OK key for 5 seconds.
The coupler function is "ON" by default at start-up whatever the status when the tractor engine is stopped.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Fig. 39
05A01.21
General - Dyna VT Operation Fast reversing When changing the direction of movement, the tractor decreases to a halt, then accelerates in the opposite direction. Reversing is not possible if the following functions are active : • underspeed supervisor • speed regulator • turbo clutch function If the clutch pedal is pressed during fast reversing, a temporary stop may occur.
Setting restart speeds when shifting To activate the preset values, press the clutch pedal, the tractor icon ((A) Fig. 40) flashes. A desired value can be set with the reverse shuttle lever (Fig. 41). Position 2 (+ or -) sets the forward value (B), position 3 (+ or -) sets the reverse value (C). Preset values vary according to the Hare/Tortoise range position. They are stored when the engine is turned off. The preset speed is obtained at an engine speed of 1,800 rpm. If the preset values are set to 0.2, reversal will occur at the same forward and reverse speeds.
B A
C Fig. 40
NOTE: In all cases, the driver can activate dynamic stop by placing the left-hand lever in the “2 to 1” or “3 to 1” positions.
2 1 3
Fig. 41
05A01.22
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
General - Dyna VT Operation Using the DOT MATRIX screen
A
B
The DOT MATRIX screen is initialised at tractor start-up (Fig. 42). To display the various menus, press the right-hand lever buttons (Fig. 44) and follow the instructions in the table on the following page. A: DOT MATRIX screen (Fig. 42) B: Right-hand lever (Fig. 44)
Fig. 43
Fig. 44 Fig. 42
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05A01.23
General - Dyna VT Operation
Screens
Access
Function
Ignition before engine start (ignition key on +ACC position)
Auxiliary oil level screen Displays the filling level of the auxiliary oil tank (0-100%): - 100% full tank - 50% warning threshold. When the auxiliary oil tank level drops below 50%, it is automatically displayed every 4 minutes (press ESC to return to the main screen). If the sensor is defective, the ERROR message is displayed instead of the filling level
Tractor start-up
Start-up screen Displays the restart speeds, the SV1 and SV2 speeds, engine supervisor, PTO, pedal or lever mode.
HYDR OIL 95 % MA-05-04291A
1430 1160
To display from the start-up screen
0 RPM 0% 2,6
Sv 1 MA-05-04292A
Work screen Displays memorised engine speeds, PTO speed, actual wheel slip rate, lever mode, pedal mode (power or eco), self-propelled mode and SV1 and SV2 speeds.
Reverse shuttle sensitivity Allows to adjust the response time when shifting direction of travel To increase or decrease The delay begins when the reverse shuttle the value lever is activated. If the delay is authorised, declutching takes place 5 seconds after Allows a delay (5 seconds) to be the lever is pulled. If not authorised, authorised or not when reversing declutching takes place as soon as the direction of travel. lever is activated. To display from the start-up screen
4 +
Delay No
-
MA-05-04032A
OK
To display from the start-up screen To increase or decrease the value
MODE + -
4 2 +
Pedal mode sensitivity screen Used to adjust acceleration (+) and deceleration (-) sensitivity in pedal mode operation.
MA-05-04293A
OK
05A01.24
¤ H
To display from the start-up screen Press 5 seconds to reset
Fuel used screen Consumption indicator : - 0 Quantity of fuel consumed since last reset. - T: total fuel consumed. This value cannot be modified or reset.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
General - Dyna VT Operation Screens
Access
OK
ESC
OK
To display from the previous screen Press to enter the settings Wheel slip screen (optional). menu The symbol appears Enables the max. allowable slip to be To set the required wheel defined and displays the current wheel slip slip percentage value setting. Allows to exit the settings screen To display from the previous screen Press to enter the menus To select one of the displayed flow rate values or timing To modify displayed flow rate values
ESC
OK
SV1 SV2 A
ON ON
A B B
Joystick setting menu (1/2) This menu allows to adjust the flow rate values of each spool valve controlled by the Joystick. If the Joystick is locked (padlock displayed on screen) press the armrest ON/OFF button.
When timing is selected, it is possible to display the type of Joystick setting menu (2/2) timing (value or infinite) To adjust the timing value This menu allows to activate or deactivate timing, and can be adjusted from 0 to 60 seconds or to infinite mode. Allows to exit the settings screen and validate settings Headland 2 screen (if Datatronic 3 not installed) This menu allows to adjust the engine speed when changing linkage status (work Allows to activate the mode or or transport). The operating conditions are: validate the values Used to shift from one line -ON mode -power shuttle lever out of neutral to another -tractor moving. Allows to set the seconds value - When the linkage transport mode is selected, engine speed B is activated after of the displayed time the preset time. - When the linkage working mode is selected, engine speed A is activated after the preset time. To display from the previous screen To activate or deactivate one of the two functions
EEM-SV
Function
Headland 1 screen This menu is used to vary the engine speed during activation of SV1 and SV2 memorised ground speeds.
MA-05-04294A
OK
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
To display from the previous screen Clutch - coupler screen Press 5 seconds to switch from Displays whether the clutch- coupler On to OFF fonction is on or off.
05A01.25
General - Dyna VT Operation Screens
Access To display from the previous screen To modify displayed linkage and spool valve flow rate values
To display from the previous screen
Function Linkage and spool valves menu This menu allows to give priority to the auxiliary spool valves over the linkage, and vice versa. Maximum linkage value: 100 Minimum spool valve value 0 Minimum linkage value: 20 Maximum spool valve value: 80 Error code screen Displays all tractor error codes. Each error code is displayed for 4 seconds in a loop.
To display from the previous screen To increase or decrease the value
Brightness screen Setting screen brightness
To display from the previous screen To increase or decrease the value
Contrast screen Setting screen contrast
IMPORTANT : When the engine is stopped, all DOT MATRIX functions except the coupler function (CLUTCH) shift to OFF position.
05A01.26
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DYNA VT hydraulics
05B01 - DYNA VT hydraulics
CONTENTS A . Forward / Reverse high pressure relief valves. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Scavenging valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 C . Control spool valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 D . DYNA VT hydraulic tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 E . Service tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05B01.1
DYNA VT hydraulics
05B01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DYNA VT hydraulics
A . Forward / Reverse high pressure relief valves General The purpose of the high pressure relief valves is to regulate the increase in HP pressure. They protect the transmission elements (hydrostatic motors and pump).
PH (4V4/ 4V5)
PH Ø1
2V4
ES
ES
PH (4V4/ 4V5)
PH
ES 2V6
Ø1
2V3
PH
PH (4V4/ 4V5)
ES
PH
A
B
MA-05-04146A
A = Coupler and clutch functions inactive: Pressure identical in both chambers. The spool is held in closed position by the spring. B = Coupler and clutch functions active: the pressure drop caused by the restrictor (nozzle) applies a force to
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
C Fig. 1 the spool that is more powerful than the force of the spring. The spool moves to the right, bringing PH into contact with ES (booster). C = HP pressure is limited by the clutch and coupler spools.
05B01.3
DYNA VT hydraulics Replacing Forward / Reverse HP pressure relief valves 1. Drain the transmission oil 2. Loosen the 2 plugs with hexagonal heads located under the transmission housing. (Fig. 2) 3. Use a wrench to remove the high pressure relief valves. NOTE: V = Forward high pressure relief valve R = Reverse high pressure relief valve.
Fig. 2
The high pressure relief valve is a controlled pressure relief valve (Fig. 3) Adjustment pressure when new: R500 + 20 bar. Adjustment pressure after several hours: 480 ± 20 bar. Only replace O’rings if they are damaged. Do not move the thrust collar. Tighten the pressure relief valve to a torque of
250 + 20 Nm Fig. 3
REMARK: Fill the transmission oil at an external filling station. (AGCO ref.: AGO2)
05B01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DYNA VT hydraulics
B . Scavenging valve This valve allows to “flush” the oil in the hydrostatic loop.
Operation (Fig. 4)
Pressure in A, B: max. 500 bar. Pressure in T: max. 50 bar Opening pressure: delta p = 7 bar between A and B
Fig. 4
Transmission at neutral (Fig. 5) pA = pB, delta p < 7 bar The spool is held in “middle” position by the spring. The two channels (A, B) are closed.
Fig. 5
“Pulling” phase (Fig. 6) pA > pB, delta p > 7 bar The spool moves upwards via control port XA. Channel B communicates with T. The hot oil coming from the low pressure side B can therefore be “flushed” and sent by the cooler via port T.
Fig. 6
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05B01.5
DYNA VT hydraulics “Pushing” phase (Fig. 7) pA > pB, delta p > 7 bar The spool moves downwards via control port XB. Channel A communicates with T. The hot oil coming from the low pressure side A can therefore be “flushed” and sent by the cooler via port T.
Fig. 7
Disassembling (Fig. 8)
the
scavenging
valve
1. Drain the transmission oil. 2. Remove the plug (arrow Fig. 8) located under the transmission housing. 3. Use a wrench to remove the scavenging valve.
Fig. 8 Fig. 9 : Only replace O’rings if they are damaged. Do not move the thrust collars. The thrust collars are positioned facing each other. Tighten the scavenging valve to a torque of 200 + 10 Nm. REMARK: The new scavenging valve with a seal groove (arrow Fig. 9) is provided as a replacement. Tighten to the required torques:
250 + 20 Nm
4. Fill the transmission oil at an external filling station. (Ref. AGO2).
05B01.6
¤ H
Fig. 9
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DYNA VT hydraulics
C . Control spool valve Pressure relief valve - 4V4 / Y004 coupler function The coupler function valve (4V4) regulates the increase in hydrostatic pressure (PH) in proportion to the engine speed. Due to this component the coupler effect is simulated. The coupler function valve is fitted to the control block where the hydrostatic loop PH and tank return junction is located. If this junction is not closed, the pressure in the hydrostatic loop cannot increase, and the tractor does not reach its maximum pulling power. The junction between the hydrostatic loop PH and tank is closed by the coupler function valve (4V4).
Fig. 10 The coupler function valve is controlled by the electronic control unit. The strength of the current depends on the engine speed, and changes as shown by the following table : Engine speed in rpm
Current supplied at A
Maximum PH in bar
Remark
800
0
0
Transmission at neutral
800
approx. 0.46
78
Transmission "active"
1200
1.23
105
from 1400
1.71
500
In order for the pressure to increase in the HP loop, it is necessary to maintain the electrical supply and the tightness of the coupler function valve.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05B01.7
DYNA VT hydraulics The tighness of the valve seal can be ensured by a mechanical lock mechanism. 5. Move the control lever (see arrow Fig. 11)
Fig. 11
6. Or tighten the internal Allen screw.
Fig. 12
05B01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DYNA VT hydraulics Pressure relief valve 4V5 - clutch function The clutch function valve is fitted to the control block where the PH hydrostatic loop and tank return junction is located. The clutch function valve also allows to limit the maximum pressure PH in the 500 bar (± 20 bar) hydrostatic loop. Due to the clutch function valve, when the clutch pedal is not activated, the junction between the hydrostatic loop and tank return is closed. By moving the clutch pedal, the clutch function valve opens and the hydrostatic loop communicates with the
tank return channel. This results in a drop in pressure (interruption of the pulling effort) in the hydrostatic loop, proportional to how far in the clutch pedal is pressed (comparable to a mechanical forward clutch). Clutch pedal pressed in fully, High pressure PH = 0 bar. The maximum pressure can be achieved in the hydrostatic loop only when the clutch valve (4V5) is functioning perfectly.
Fig. 13
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05B01.9
DYNA VT hydraulics Checking the control block If maximum pressure is not reached when measuring the HP pressure, the transmission module may be defective, but it is also possible that the internal seal tightness of the control block is the cause of the problem. To be sure that it is necessary to disassemble the transmission module, it is recommended to first check the seal tightness of the spool valve block (transmission control). The pressure in the hydrostatic loop can only increase if the pressure relief valve seals are tight.
- Coupler function (4V4 / Y004) - Clutch function (4V5) When the following conditions are met, the coupler function valve allows the pressure in the hydrostatic loop to increase : - Engine speed higher than 1400 rpm (PWM - Signal) - Limp home mode activated - Valve locked mechanically (tighten the internal Allen screw or move the lever). The clutch function valve is closed (increase in HP pressure possible) when the clutch pedal is not activated.
Fig. 14 The tightness of the 2 pressure relief valves (4V4 / 4V5) can be controlled by the T union.
Fig. 15
05B01.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DYNA VT hydraulics Checking the hydrostatic loop in the control block
DANGER: Chock the tractor (HP pressure measurement).
7. Remove the right-hand rear wheel and its protective guard located behind it 8. Remove the T union. 9. Fit a test pressure gauge to measure pressures higher than 500 bar at the PH union.
Fig. 16 Checking procedure : 10. Start the engine. 11. Activate the limp home mode by pressing in the clutch pedal fully and pressing on the button (Fig. 17). 12. Apply the handbrake.
Fig. 17
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05B01.11
DYNA VT hydraulics 13. Use the limp home mode lever to start the transmission (Fig. 18).
Fig. 18
PH
T union
Possible causes
250 bar
No oil flow to the T union
Transmission module error (shuttle valve, pressure pipe union). =>Remove the module.
250 bar
Oil flows from the T union
Coupler function valve (4V4) or clutch function valve (4V5) not tightly sealed. => Change the valve.
Checking the clutch function valve (4V4) 14. Mechanically lock the valve (tighten the internal Allen screw (Fig. 12) or move the lever (Fig. 11)) PH
T union
Possible causes
250 bar
Oil flows from the T union
Clutch function valve (4V5) not tightly sealed => Change the valve
500 bar
Oil flows from the T union, but the pressure is not constant
Electrically check the coupler function valve => Change the valve if faulty
05B01.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DYNA VT hydraulics
D . DYNA VT hydraulic tests Supply pressure measurements
Fig. 19
Measuring points
Reference on component
Description
Measuring points
Reference on component
Description
M1
KV
Cooler upstream pressure
M11
ZWK
PTO clutch pressure
M2
SM
Lubricating pressure
M13
750
750 rpm PTO selector pressure
M3
AS
Flushing pressure
M14
VR
Front axle clutch pressure
M4
ES
Booster pressure
M15
DS
Differential lock pressure
M5
PU
Service pump pressure
M16
1000
1000 rpm PTO selector pressure
M6
P
Transmission system pressure
M17
Brake service pressure
M7
I
Tortoise range shifting pressure
M18
Rear axle beam lubricating pressure
M8
II
Hare range shifting pressure
M19
Reverse position HP pressure
M9
PH
High pressure (HP)
M21
Front PTO clutch pressure
M10
PHA
Rear axle beam and braking system pressure
M22
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
T
Oil leak on clutch function spool valve / coupler function solenoid valve
05B01.13
DYNA VT hydraulics Precautions to be taken during the pressure measurements: The oil temperature must be between 35 and 45°C IMPORTANT: When measuring the transmission pressure, raise all wheels of the tractor to prevent accidents. 1. 2. 3. 4.
Set transmission ratio (Hi/Lo) to speed of 0. Release the handbrake. Engage the front axle. Differential lock and PTO clutch are not engaged.
On right-hand side, in the middle of the tractor : 5. Remove right-hand rear wheel and its protective guard. 6. Connect a test pressure gauge. Measure the pressures set out below according to the different engine speeds (see settings table below) - PU Pressure (M5). Pressure measuring point located between the service pump and the pressure filter (Fig. 19) - P Pressure (M6) System pressure downstream of pressure filter (Fig. 19). - ES booster pressure (Fig. 19) - AS flushing or discharge pressure - SM transmission lubricating pressure (Fig. 19).
Set values for pressure measurement (in bar) Engine speeds
PU (M5)
P (M6)
ES (M4)
AS (M3)
SM (M2)
800
25 ±2
25 ±2
16 ±2
9 ±2
1.4 ±0.2
1200
26 ±2
25.5 ±2
19 ±2
11.5 ±2
2.2 ±0.3
1600
27 ±2
26 ±2
20 ±2
13 ±2
3.6 ±0.5
2000
28 ±2
27 ±2
23 ±2
15 ±2
5 ±0.5
05B01.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DYNA VT hydraulics High pressure (HP) measurements
DANGER: High pressure measurements must never exceed a maximum of 5 seconds, to prevent the oil from heating. Preliminary operations: Engage hare range and set the starting speed to maximum, or transmission to limp home mode (do not turn the control unit by more than 15° in order to avoid heating the oil). Measuring points PH
Engine speed
Value in bar
1600
New assembly 500 + 20 Old assembly 500 - 40
NOTE: Load the hydrostatic loop at maximum for 5 seconds before taking the following measurements. Measuring points
Engine speed
Value in bar
P
1600
26 ±2
ES
1600
13 ±2
AS
1600
12 ±2
SM
1600
1.6 ±0.4
Measuring points
Engine speed
Value in bar
In Hare or Tortoise range
1600
26 ±2
Shifting pressure measurements
NOTE: Alternately supply solenoid valves 1 (4V1) and 2 (4V2) with a 12 V (DC) supply
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05B01.15
DYNA VT hydraulics Rear PTO, differential lock and front axle clutch solenoid valve measurement NOTE: The unit is located on the rear axle housing, behind the spool valves. Access is limited, so great care must be taken.
Fig. 20
Measuring points M10
Rear axle beam, brakes and front PTO system pressure
M11
Rear PTO clutch
M13
750 rpm PTO selector pressure
M14
Front axle clutch
M15
Differential lock
M16
1000 rpm PTO selector pressure
M17
Braking system pressure
M18
Rear axle beam lubricating pressure
05B01.16
¤ H
Description
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DYNA VT hydraulics NOTE: Run the engine at 1200 rpm. Simultaneously check the pressure at unions M10 and M18 (SM).
Shifting status of hydraulic parts
Measuring points
System pressure M10 in Lubricating pressure M18 bar in bar
Power take-off - On / Off
M11
18 ± 0.2
2 ± 0.3
Differential lock - On / Off
M15
18 ± 0.2
2 ± 0.3
Front axle - On / Off
M14
18 ± 0.2
2,1 ± 0.3
Single wheel braking
M17
18 ± 0.2
1,6 ± 0.3
Activation of locked brake pedal
M17
18 ± 0.2
1,2 ± 0.3
In order to check the rear PTO, it is also possible to measure pressure levels at the unions located at the rear right- and left-hand sides of the PTO housing.
1 = Rear PTO clutch (M12-1.5 union) 2 = Rear axle beam lubricating pressure (M10-1 union) 3+4 = 750 or 540 speed selection (M10-1 union)
Fig. 21
Fig. 22
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05B01.17
DYNA VT hydraulics
Pressure tests on DYNA VT transmission 8400 series tractors Customer Chassis number : Engine number : Putting into service : Total service hours:
Dealer number
Recommendation: the measurements should be taken with all four wheels raised. Risk of accident!!! Measuring condition: transmission oil temperature range 35-45°C
I. Supply pressure measurements Measuring point PU
P
ES
AS
SM
Engine speed rpm 800 1200 1600 2000 800 1200 1600 2000 800 1200 1600 2000 800 1200 1600 2000 800 1200 1600 2000
Specified value / bar Measurement
Tolerance
25 126 27 28 25 25,5 26 27 16 19 20 23 9 11,5 13 15 1,4 2,2 3,6 5
+2 +2 +2 +2 +2 +2 +2 +2 ±2 ±2 ±2 ±2 ±2 ±2 ±2 ±2 ±0,2 ±0,3 ±0,5 ±0,5
Measurement in bar
Remarks
II. High pressure measurements. Pressure measurements in forward speed and in reverse speed, maximum measurement time 5 seconds Measuring point Forward / reverse PH P ES AS SM
Engine speed rpm 1600
Specified value / bar Measurement
Tolerance
New = 500 Used = 500 26 13 12 1,6
+20 -40 +2 ±2 ±2 ±0,4
Measurement in bar
Remarks
III. Ranges 1 and 2 shift measurement. Solenoid valves 1 and 2 supplied alternately by 12 VDC Measuring point I II Date: AGCO
05B01.18
¤ H
Engine speed rpm 1600 1600
Specified value / bar Measurement
Tolerance
26 26
±2 ±2
Measurement in bar
Remarks
Signature: September 2004
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DYNA VT hydraulics Summary table of the high pressure values HP measurement
Pressure in bar
Measurement
Pressure in bar
PH
500 + 20
P
26+ 2
PH
500 + 20
ES
13 + 2
PH
500 + 20
AS
12 ± 2
PH
500 + 20
SM
1,6 ± 0,4
Diagram showing the pressure check points on the valve block
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05B01.19
DYNA VT hydraulics
Service pump P
High pressure PH
Speed limitation solenoid valve
Clutch function controlled valve
Hare/Tortoise supply pressure Solenoid valves Tortoise range
Hare range
Coupler function solenoid valve
05B01.20
¤ H
HP Pressure sensor Fig. 23
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DYNA VT hydraulics
Valve housing with test connections Lubricating pressure (SM)
Booster pressure (ES)
Service pump relief valve (50 b)
Booster valve (6.5 b) Oil cooler bypass valve
Flushing valve (6 b)
Service pressure (PU)
Flushing pressure (AS) temperature (°C) Lubricating pressure valve (6.5 b)
Fig. 24
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05B01.21
DYNA VT hydraulics
E . Service tools 1. Tool available in AGCO network AG02 - External filling station (Fig. 25)
MA-05-04158A
Fig. 25
05B01.22
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Replacing the DYNA VT unit
05C01 - Replacing the DYNA VT unit
CONTENTS A . Desassembling the Dyna VT module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Assembling the Dyna VT module. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 C . Service tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05C01.1
Replacing the DYNA VT unit
05C01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Replacing the DYNA VT unit
A . Desassembling the Dyna VT module
Preliminary operations: 1. Drain the transmission oil (approx. 65l.) 2. Disassemble the cab.
DANGER: Before disconnecting the pipes, it is necessary to release the pressure in the brake accumulator by pumping on the pedals. 3. Remove the unions after emptying, taking the precautions necessary to prevent any dirty particles from entering the air conditioning circuit
ADVICE: It is recommended to raise the cab slightly before splitting it. 4. Pinch the heating pipes closed to avoid draining the circuit. 5. Attach the cab to a suitable hoisting system and lift it off.
CAUTION: Take care not to damage the roof cap. 6. Disconnect the cables and hydraulic unions, taking care to mark them. 7. Remove the spool valve block.
CAUTION: Mark all parts at disassembly. 8. Hoist and remove the cab. 9. Remove the accumulator assembly.
Fig. 1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05C01.3
Replacing the DYNA VT unit 10. Move the range selector to neutral. 11. Take off the limp home console.
Fig. 2 12. Disconnect the connector. 13. Remove the control unit.
Fig. 3 14. Take off the pressure filter housing. Recover the oil that flows out.
Fig. 4
05C01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Replacing the DYNA VT unit 15. Remove the electrical connectors and hydraulic pipes. 16. Remove the valve block.
Fig. 5
17. Disconnect the connectors, the clutch vent line and the hydraulic pipes. 18. Remove the valve block.
Fig. 6
19. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the summing shaft sensor.
Fig. 7
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05C01.5
Replacing the DYNA VT unit 20. Remove the pipe support and strapping. 21. Unscrew the cover screws. 22. Raise the cover using the M10 eye-bolt.
Fig. 8 23. Unscrew the locking screw and take out the control shaft.
Fig. 9
24. Remove the retainer circlips and push the hoses inwards. 25. Disconnect the high pressure hoses.
Fig. 10
05C01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Replacing the DYNA VT unit 26. Remove the 3 circlips and push the hoses inwards.
Fig. 11 27. Remove the hydraulic pipes (supply pressure of auxiliary functions).
Fig. 12
28. Take off the drive shaft circlip. 29. Push the shaft backwards.
Fig. 13
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05C01.7
Replacing the DYNA VT unit 30. Unscrew the 3 M8 screws from the planet carrier. 31. Push the shaft backwards.
Fig. 14
32. Remove the drive pinion circlip. 33. Push the circlip, washer and socket towards the drive pinion, as indicated by the arrow.
Fig. 15 34. Swivel the hydrostatic motors and the pump inwards using a lever.
Fig. 16
05C01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Replacing the DYNA VT unit 35. Unscrew the 2 nuts (see arrows) located on the left and right.
Fig. 17 36. Unscrew the upper M12 locking screw. 37. On the inner surface of the gearbox housing, unscrew the 2 closing plugs. 38. Recover the oil. 39. Unscrew the 2 locking screws on the lower shaft.
Fig. 18 40. Install lifting tackle. 41. Slightly raise the hydraulic module, ensuring the lifting tackle remains under a certain level of tension.
Fig. 19
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05C01.9
Replacing the DYNA VT unit 42. Using a slide hammer puller on the M20 threads, extract the flexible suspension shafts.
Fig. 20 43. Take the transmission module carefully out of the gearbox housing using the lifting tackle. 44. Stay alert in case other parts move.
DANGER: Do not stand under heavy loads.
Fig. 21
05C01.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Replacing the DYNA VT unit
B . Assembling the Dyna VT module
CAUTION: Before reassembling, all components, mating faces and grooves must be clean. Any rust, mud or water must be removed. 45. Raise the transmission block with lifting tackle, after securing it. 46. Move the range selector (Hare / Tortoise) (arrow Fig. 22) to “Neutral” (middle position).
Fig. 22 47. Clean any oil or seal fragments from the transmission housing mating face. 48. Move the range selector finger (see arrow) to “Neutral”. (middle position).
Fig. 23 If necessary: 49. Fit the circlip and washer on the shoulder of the drive pinion. 50. Push the socket onto the drive pinion. 51. Fit the flange on the link shaft (PTO drive) and fit the link shaft.
Fig. 24
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05C01.11
Replacing the DYNA VT unit 52. Fit the transmission module in the transmission housing. Stay alert in case other parts move. 53. Fit the two shafts into the bores of the transmission housing and transmission module. NOTE: The two shafts are of different lengths; the longer one is fitted at the base of the gearbox.
Fig. 25
54. Check the sockets (flexible) for wear, and fit new sockets if necessary. 55. Insert the sockets home into the bores.
Fig. 26
56. Fit the ring, with the bore turned towards the flexible socket. 57. Tighten the M20 nut. 58. Carry out the same assembly operation on the three other threads.
Fig. 27
05C01.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Replacing the DYNA VT unit 59. Tighten the four M20 nuts to a torque of:
250 Nm
NOTE: When tightening, hold the opposite nut still. 60. Unhook the lifting tackle.
Fig. 28
61. Install a planet gear of the power transmission epicyclic gear train turned upwards. 62. Centre the transmission module. The distance between the ring gear and the transmission housing must be identical on either side.
Fig. 29
63. Tighten the 4 locking screws to a torque of:
86 Nm
64. Install 2 closing plugs fitted with new seals under the transmission housing. 65. Test the correct operating of Hare / Tortoise range shifting (check finger positioning). Fig. 30
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05C01.13
Replacing the DYNA VT unit 66. Turn the transmission module until a tooth of the disc, intended for the Hall sensor, can be seen at the middle of the bore. (arrow Fig. 31).
Fig. 31
67. Smear the mating face of the Hall sensor with sealing product (ref. X903.050.553) (non-hardening) and insert the sensor into its housing. 68. Tighten the attachment screws to a torque of:
25 Nm
69. Reconnect the electrical connector. NOTE: If the Hall sensor is being reused, insert 2 strips of paper 0.9 mm thick into the Hall sensor groove (these strips ensure centring).
Fig. 32
70. Swivel the hydrostatic motors to their stop (45°).
Fig. 33
05C01.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Replacing the DYNA VT unit 71. Pull the drive pinion socket forwards to release the groove from the circlip. Insert the circlip into the groove. NOTE: If the socket does not engage, chock a front wheel and turn it until the socket is engaged.
Fig. 34
72. Fit the flange on the epicyclic gear train. Tighten the M8 screws to a torque of:
25 Nm
Fig. 35
73. Insert the hydraulic hoses into the bores on the front right-hand side of the transmission housing. 74. Secure the hoses using circlips (opening facing downwards). - 1 = short blue hose (flushing) - 2 = long blue hose (boosting) - 3 = black hose (lubricating)
Fig. 36
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05C01.15
Replacing the DYNA VT unit At the front on top of the transmission housing: 75. Fit the ring in the groove of the shaft. 76. Push the shaft forwards. Install the washer. 77. Fit the circlip in the pinion groove.
Fig. 37 78. Fit the hydraulic pipe (supply pressure of auxiliary functions).
Fig. 38
79. Insert the pressure pipes in the bores in the right-hand side of the transmission housing. -
1 = supply pressure hydraulic hose 2 = Hare range shifting 3 = ground speed limiting 4 = Tortoise range shifting 5 = Regulating valves (tilting) 6 = High pressure for forward clutch and coupler function.
Fig. 39
05C01.16
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Replacing the DYNA VT unit 80. Attach the hydraulic pipes using circlips.
Fig. 40 81. Screw 2 M8 threaded rods into the transmission housing. 82. Fit new O’rings. 83. Stick seals in the block using grease. 84. Fit the control block. 85. Tighten the attachment screw (from the inside to the outside) to a torque of:
25 Nm
Fig. 41
86. Connect the connectors, clutch function bleed pipe and hydraulic pipes. -
4V1 = Hare range solenoid valve 4V2 = Tortoise range solenoid valve 4V4 = Coupler function solenoid valve 4V3 = Ground speed limiting solenoid valve
Fig. 42
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05C01.17
Replacing the DYNA VT unit 87. Screw 2 M8 threaded rods into the transmission housing. Fit new seals. 88. Fit new seals with grease in the valve block. 89. Install the block and tighten the screws, starting with the inside screws to the following torque:
25 Nm
90. Connect the connectors and hydraulic pipes.
Fig. 43
91. Fit new O’rings with grease and attach the pressure filter, tightening the screws to the following torque:
25 Nm
92. Connect the connector.
Fig. 44
93. If necessary, smear the lip seal with a mixture of white spirit and water (1:1) and fit it home. Fill the lip seals 2/3 full with grease. 94. Fit the control shaft.
Fig. 45
05C01.18
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Replacing the DYNA VT unit 95. Turn the shaft until the locking screw thread can be seen. NOTE: Smear the thread of the Allen screw with plastic binder (LOCTITE) (Ref. X 903.050.084) and tighten the screw to the following torque:
25 Nm
Fig. 46
96. Fit the intermediate coupler with the two bosses (see arrows) pointing to the control unit.
Fig. 47
97. Fit the pre-assembled control unit on the transmission housing. 98. Tighten the M8 cylindrical screws to a torque of:
25 Nm
99. Reconnect the electrical connector.
Fig. 48
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05C01.19
Replacing the DYNA VT unit 100.Unscrew the plug marked PU. 101.Connect the filling station (Fig. 49). NOTE: Using the external filling station it is possible to avoid dry operation of the hydrostatic pump and hydrostatic motor. 102.Be sure to comply with the oil quantity and type (see chapter 1). NOTE: During the filling process, swivel the hydrostatic pumps and motors. Ensure the hydraulic unions are completely sealed. Fill the transmission oil with a filling station.
MA-05-04158A
Fig. 49
103.Smear the mating face of the transmission housing with sealing product (Ref. X903.050.074). 104.Fit the cover. 105.Tighten the M12 screws to a torque of:
86 Nm
106.Fit the pipe support. 107.Refit the cab. 108.Reassemble all hydraulic unions as marked at disassembly. 109.Refit the spool valve support. 110.Reconnect all electrical connections as marked at disassembly. 111.Connect the heating pipes. 112.Connect the air conditioning pipes. 113.Check the levels of the various liquids.
05C01.20
¤ H
Fig. 50
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Replacing the DYNA VT unit
C . Service tools 1. Tool available in AGCO network AG02 - External filling station (Fig. 51)
MA-05-04158A
Fig. 51
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
05C01.21
Replacing the DYNA VT unit
05C01.22
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Rear axle
06 - Rear axle CONTENTS 06B01 - Final drive units 06C01 - Braking unit
Massey Ferguson 8400
¤ H
Contents - i
Rear axle
Contents - ii
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400
Final drive units
06B01 - Final drive units
CONTENTS A . Généralités . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Removing a rear axle drive unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 C . Refitting a rear axle drive unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 D . Disassembling a rear axle drive unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 E . Reassembling a rear axle drive unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 F . Service tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06B01.1
Final drive units
06B01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Final drive units
A . Généralités The rear axle final drive units have a separate lubrication system to the rear axle. Tightness between the two parts is ensured by a double lip seal. The brakes are multidisc (6 discs with friction lining and 6 intermediate plates per final drive unit). They operate via a braking mechanism activated by a brake cylinder and a control lever.
86 N.m
120 N.m 350 N.m
D
A
C B
MA-06-04227A
Fig. 1 Adjusting the bearings: Preload the taper roller bearings (A, B) using shim (C) so that the rotational resistance torque increases from 4 to 6 Nm (without spi seal). Planet carrier axial clearance: Specified clearance: 0.2 to 0.5 mm (there must be axial clearance!)
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06B01.3
Final drive units
Fig. 2
06B01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Final drive units
Pos.
Description
Pos.
Description
1
Ring gear
20
Threaded rod M12 x 165-10.9
2
Planet gear
21
Nut M12-10
3
Pin
23
Locking screw M30 x 1.5
4
Circlip
24
Joint d’étanchéité
5
Needle bearing cage
25
Ring
10
Allen screw
26
Shim
11
Plate
27
Taper roller bearing
12
Pin
28
Taper roller bearing
14
Planet carrier
29
Snap ring
15
Drive unit housing
30
Spi seal
16
Joint d’étanchéité
31
Rear axle shaft
17
Magnetic plug
32
Wheel stud
18
Allen screw M12 x 160-10.9
35
Shaft
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06B01.5
Final drive units
Fig. 3
06B01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Final drive units
Pos.
Description
Pos.
Description
1
Ring gear
21
Nut M12-10
2
Planet gear
23
Locking screw M30 x 1.5
3
Pin
24
Joint d’étanchéité
4
Circlip
25
Ring
5
Needle bearing cage
26
Shim
10
Allen screw
27
Taper roller bearing
11
Plate
28
Taper roller bearing
12
Pin
29
O’ring
14
Planet carrier
30
Spi seal
15
Drive unit housing
31
Rear axle shaft
16
Joint d’étanchéité
33
O’ring
17
Magnetic plug
35
Shaft
18
Allen screw M12 x 160-10.9
40
Spacer
19
Cylindrical screw
41
Cover
20
Threaded rod M12-165 -10.9
42
Allen screw
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06B01.7
Final drive units
Page left blank intentionally
06B01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Final drive units
Cross-section of a drive unit
32 30
29 28
27
26 25 11
31 MA-06-04210A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
12 10
15
4
18
16
5
17
2
1
3
4
35
14 Fig. 4
06B01.9
Final drive units
Page left blank intentionally
06B01.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Final drive units
B . Removing a rear axle drive unit The following must be carried out before disassembling 1. Drain the transmission. 2. Drain the drive units. 3. It is necessary to remove a cab support to extract a drive unit. 4. Remove the rear wheels and securely chock the tractor. 5. Remove obstructive protective guards. 6. Remove the hitch stabiliser (Arrow Fig. 1).
Fig. 1
7. Remove cab suspension supports ( Fig. 2) 8. Remove other parts which might obstruct disassembly.
Fig. 2
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06B01.11
Final drive units 9. Support the drive unit in a secure manner using a suitable lifting device. Remove the drive unit housing attachment parts (Fig. 3). 10. In place of the 2 two CHC screws, screw in 2 threaded screws to release the rear axle drive unit.
Fig. 3
11. Remove the drive unit.
Fig. 4
06B01.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Final drive units
C . Refitting a rear axle drive unit 12. Clean the mating surface between the rear axle and the drive unit, and smear with a sealing product (Ref. X903-050-074).
Fig. 5
13. Fit the drive unit with a suitable lifting device.
Fig. 6 14. Fit and tighten diametrically opposed screws (18 and 21) to a torque of:
120 Nm
15. Carry out operations (6 to 10) in reverse order.
Fig. 7
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06B01.13
Final drive units
D . Disassembling a rear axle drive unit NOTE: The operations described apply to a standard drive unit. Adjustment and reconditioning are identical for long shaft drive units. Preliminary operations: Remove the rear axle drive unit (see § B) 16. Unscrew the cylindrical screws (19) by about 10 mm and knock out the ring gear (1) with a mallet. 17. Remove ring gear (1). Fig. 8
18. Unscrew the Allen screw (10) and remove the planet carrier. IMPORTANT: The screw (10) is stuck at assembly.
Fig. 9 If necessary: 19. Remove the circlips (4). 20. Take out the pins (3). 21. Remove the planet gears (2) 22. Replace any defective parts.
Fig. 10
06B01.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Final drive units 23. Fit the planet gears (2). 24. Fit the pins (3). 25. Fit the circlips (4).
Fig. 11 Preloading the axle shaft: 26. Fit one or two shims (ref. X 534.739.501) (individual thickness: 1 mm) on the bearing of the axle shaft (31). 27. Fit the planet carrier. NOTE: If no shims are available, a locally made tightening socket can be used to preload the axle shaft bearing.
Fig. 12
28. Pretighten the journal of the axle shaft using the Allen screw (10). 29. Remove the planet carrier (14) again. IMPORTANT: Do not turn the axle shaft (31).
Fig. 13
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06B01.15
Final drive units 30. Take out the split ring (25) from the groove in the axle shaft (31). 31. Take off the shims. 32. Take out the cotter pin.
Fig. 14
33. Insert the protective plug X 899.980.157 on the end of the axle shaft. 34. Fit the planet carrier.
Fig. 15
35. Fit a locally made mounting handle (see Fig. 16) to the axle shaft (31). 36. Drive out the axle shaft (31) onto a metal block.
Fig. 16
06B01.16
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Final drive units 37. Take the internal ring out of the taper roller bearing (28) using extractor X 899.980.159. 38. Next, extract the spi seal (30).
Fig. 17
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06B01.17
Final drive units
E . Reassembling a rear axle drive unit Important: Before reassembling, all components, mating faces and grooves must be clean. Any rust, mud or water must be removed. If necessary: 39. Fit home the external ring of the taper roller bearing (28). 40. Fit the snap ring (29) into the groove. 41. On the opposite side, fit home the external ring of the taper roller bearing.
Fig. 18
42. Heat the internal ring of the taper roller bearing (28) to approximately 80°C and install it in the drive unit housing (15). 43. Smear the outside of the new spi seal (30) with sealing product X 903.051.711, clean the inside with a mixture of white spirit and water (1:1) and fit it home.
Fig. 19
44. Before the internal ring cools, fit home the shaft (31) using locally made handles (see Fig. 20).
Fig. 20
06B01.18
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Final drive units 45. Turn the housing (15) upside down. 46. Heat the internal ring of the taper roller bearing (27) to approximately 80°C and fit it home. 47. Smear the axle shaft journal with transmission oil.
Fig. 21 48. Support the housing (15). The axle shaft journal clearance should be minimal. 49. Fit the torque gauge (ref. X 899.980.150). 50. Measure and note down the rotational strength of the sealing ring. Example: 5.0 Nm
51. Select a thickness of shims (26) to allow tight assembly of the split ring (25). NOTE: Wherever possible, fit shims (26) so that the shim 1.0 mm thick is on the split ring (25) side.
Fig. 22
Fig. 23
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06B01.19
Final drive units 52. Fit two shims (Ref. X 534.739.501) (individual thickness: 1 mm) on the axle shaft (31). 53. Refit the planet carrier and tighten home. The resistance of the bearing at the axle shaft journal should increase slightly. NOTE: If bearing resistance does not increase, take off the planet carrier again and fit new shims (26) under the split ring (25), see Fig. 23, then preload the axle shaft journal again.
Fig. 24
54. Tap the journal on either side with a mallet to reduce the load on it. 55. Remove the planet carrier again. 56. Select the thickness of shims (26) to allow assembly of the split ring (25) by tapping lightly with a hammer. 57. Fit the cotter pin (ref. 12) in the axle shaft (31).
Fig. 25 58. Smear the thread of the Allen screw (10) with plastic binder (Ref. W 903.050.084) and tighten to the following torque:
350 Nm
59. Tap the journal on either side with a mallet to reduce the load on it.
Fig. 26
06B01.20
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Final drive units 60. Measure and note down the rotational resistance of the sealing ring and journal using the torque wrench X 899.980.150. Specified value: 4.0 to 6.0 Nm (bearing / journal) plus rotational resistance (sealing ring Fig. 22) e.g. 5.0 Nm. Correct any non-conformity by fitting new shims (26) (see Fig. 23 and Fig. 25).
Fig. 27
61. Check the axial clearance of the planet carrier (14) using two levers. 62. Specified value: 0.2 to 0.5 mm axial clearance. NOTE: there must be axial clearance.
Fig. 28
Depending on which parts were disassembled (Fig. 10): Assembling planet gears: 63. Fit the snap ring in the socket groove and fit the socket (arrow) home in the planet gear (2) until the snap ring is held in place. NOTE: It is not possible to remove the socket (arrow).
Fig. 29
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06B01.21
Final drive units 64. With grease, stick the 19 bearings of the bearing set (5) in the planet gear (2). 65. With grease, stick the ring of the bearing set (5) in the planet gear (2). 66. Carry out the same assembly operation on the opposite side of the planet gear (2).
Fig. 30
67. Install the circlips (4) in the groove of the planet carrier (14).
Fig. 31
68. Insert the preassembled planet gear (2). 69. Insert the pin (3) and fit home the circlip (4) in the groove of the planet carrier (14).
Fig. 32
06B01.22
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Final drive units 70. Clean the mating face and smear with sealing product X 903.050.074.
Fig. 33
71. Install the ring gear with internal teething (1). 72. Tighten the cylindrical screws (19) to a torque of:
86 Nm
73. Refit the drive unit on the rear axle (see § C).
Fig. 34
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06B01.23
Final drive units
F . Service tools Section under construction.
06B01.24
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Braking unit
06C01 - Braking unit
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Disassembling the rear axle brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 C . Reassembling the rear axle brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 D . Disassembling a wheel brake cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 E . Reassembling a wheel brake cylinder. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 F . Bleeding the brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06C01.1
Braking unit
06C01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Braking unit
A . General On MF 8400 series tractors, the brake cylinders are fitted on the rear axle housing. The brakes are sealed against the final drive units by a seal (12). The braking unit comprises a control plate, discs and intermediate plates. The control plate is pushed apart by the control rod, forcing the discs against the intermediate plates which are splined together by 4 pins (7). The control rod is activated either by the brake
piston, activated by the brake pedal, or by the control lever, activated by the ParkLock ram. When the brake is released, minimum clearance is maintained by the control plate springs. The brake discs are lubricated by an oil flow. This oil flow comes from the distribution block, and directs oil between the discs, where it lubricates the braking surfaces when they are not in use, and cools the brakes when they are in use.
Exploded view of rear axle braking unit
Fig. 1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06C01.3
Braking unit
Exploded view parts list Pos.
Description
Pos.
Description
1
Bearing flange
12
Spi seal
2
Bearing flange
16
Control disc
3
O’ring
17
Ball
4
Screw M12x40-10.9
18
Spring
7
Pin
19
Dowel pin
8
O’ring
20
Disc
9
Brake plate
21
Intermediate plate
10
Shaft
23
Loctite X903.050.074
11
Allen screw M12 x 160-10.9
06C01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Braking unit
B . Disassembling the rear axle brakes 1. 2. 3. 4.
Remove the drive unit (see chapter 6). Remove the corresponding wheel brake cylinder. Take out the shaft (10). Unscrew the Allen screws from the brake plate (9).
Fig. 2
5. Take off the brake plate (9) using the impact extractor (Ref. X899.980.053). 6. Remove the discs and intermediate plates.
Fig. 3
7. Take off the control disc (16) and the other discs and intermediate plates. 8. Take out the pin (7). 9. Disassemble the other side in the same way.
Fig. 4
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06C01.5
Braking unit
C . Reassembling the rear axle brakes IMPORTANT: Check the wear and grooves of the discs. Oil the brake discs before fitting them. 10. Fit the discs. Start with an intermediate plate (external blade ref. 21), then a disc with lining (internal blade ref. 20), with the larger drilled hole (see arrow Fig. 5) turned downwards (for easier insertion of the shaft (10)).
Fig. 5
11. Fit the intermediate plate (21), then a disc (20), with the larger drilled hole turned downwards (arrow Fig. 6).
Fig. 6
12. Fit a disc (20) with the larger drilled hole turned downwards (arrow Fig. 7) on the control disc (16). The control pin (arrow Fig. 7) should be turned upwards towards the brake cylinder. 13. Fit an intermediate plate (21) on the pin of the control disc (16). 14. Insert the set of discs positioned as described.
Fig. 7
06C01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Braking unit 15. Next, fit a disc (20 Fig. 8) with the larger drilled hole facing downwards (arrow) on the control disc (16). 16. Fit the intermediate plate (21) on the pin (see arrow) of the control disc (16).
Fig. 8
17. Fit a disc (20 Fig. 9) with the larger drilled hole turned downwards (arrow). 18. Next fit an intermediate plate (21) on the pins (7).
Fig. 9
19. Fit a disc (20 Fig. 10) with the larger drilled hole turned downwards (arrow). 20. Next fit an intermediate plate (21) on the pins (7).
Fig. 10
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06C01.7
Braking unit 21. Smear the outside of a new spi seal (12) with a mixture of water and white spirit and fit it home in the centre of the brake plate (9). The seal lips must be turned towards the oil pressure chambers. 22. Smear new O’rings (8) with grease and fit them in the groove of the brake plate (9). The oil channels (arrow Fig. 11) of the brake plate must be turned downwards at assembly.
Fig. 11
23. Refit the brake plate (9) fitted as described above. Check the position of the oil channels. 24. Tighten diametrically opposed screws to a torque of:
120 Nm
Fig. 12
25. Fill the lips of the spi seal (12) 2/3 full with grease. 26. Full insert the shaft (10). IMPORTANT: When fitting home the shaft, it should make a noise as it hits its stop. If no noise is heard, the last disc may not have been fitted. 27. Refit the drive unit.
Fig. 13
06C01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Braking unit
D . Disassembling a wheel brake cylinder 28. Remove the "ParkLock" parking brake controls.
Fig. 14
29. Disconnect the hydraulic control pipe.
Fig. 15 30. Remove the bleed pipe.
Fig. 16
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06C01.9
Braking unit 31. Loosen and remove the attachment screws from the upper part of the wheel brake cylinder.
Fig. 17 32. Remove the upper part of the wheel brake cylinder. NOTE: When raising the upper part, ensure the return spring does not fall out.
Fig. 18
33. Loosen and remove the 3 CHC screws from the lower part of the wheel brake cylinder.
Fig. 19
06C01.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Braking unit 34. Remove the lower part of the wheel brake cylinder. NOTE: Take care not to drop the brake control lever into the reducer.
Fig. 20
35. Remove the control arm retaining screw.
Fig. 21
36. Mark the position of the control arm in relation to the pin, then remove the control arm and plastic ring.
Fig. 22
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06C01.11
Braking unit 37. Remove the pusher piston.
Fig. 23 38. Take out the pin and the second plastic ring.
Fig. 24 39. Remove and discard the lip seals.
Fig. 25
06C01.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Braking unit 40. Remove and discard the O’rings.
Fig. 26
41. Remove the piston and discard the lip seals. (arrows Fig. 27). 42. Clean, degrease and check all components; replace any defective parts. NOTE: It is strongly advised to carry out the same operation for each wheel cylinder.
Fig. 27
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06C01.13
Braking unit
E . Reassembling a wheel brake cylinder IMPORTANT: Before reassembly, all components, mating faces and grooves must be clean. Any rust, mud or water must be removed. 43. Fit new seals on the piston. NOTE: Ensure seals are positioned correctly, with the wider lips turned towards the outside of the piston (Fig. 28).
Fig. 28
44. Smear the lip seals with miscible grease, then fit the brake piston in its housing.
Fig. 29
45. Fit new lip seals smeared with miscible grease in the brake cylinder body.
Fig. 30
06C01.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Braking unit 46. Fit new O’rings smeared with miscible grease on the brake cylinder body.
Fig. 31
47. Insert the control pin fitted with its plastic washer.
Fig. 32
48. Fit the control arm as marked at disassembly.
Fig. 33
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06C01.15
Braking unit 49. Fit the control arm retaining screw.
Fig. 34 50. Install a new O'ring (arrow Fig. 35).
Fig. 35 51. Fit the control piston.
Fig. 36
06C01.16
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Braking unit 52. Fit the reversing lever on the control piston, and fill the assembling ball joint with miscible grease. (arrow Fig. 37).
Fig. 37
53. Insert the control pin fitted with its plastic washer.
Fig. 38
54. Tighten the CHC screws to a torque of:
69 Nm
Fig. 39
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06C01.17
Braking unit 55. Fit the piston return spring.
Fig. 40 56. Install the brake piston cover, fitted with its piston.
Fig. 41
57. Insert and tighten the attachment screws to a torque of:
25 Nm
Fig. 42
06C01.18
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Braking unit 58. Refit the bleed pipe.
Fig. 43 59. Reconnect the hydraulic pipe.
Fig. 44
60. Refit the “ParkLock” parking brake controls. 61. Bleed the brake circuit. See "Bleeding the brakes" paragraph.
Fig. 45
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
06C01.19
Braking unit
F . Bleeding the brakes Section under construction.
06C01.20
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Power take off
07 - Power take off CONTENTS 07A01 - Rear PTO 07B01 - Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO
Massey Ferguson 8400
¤ H
Contents - i
Power take off
Contents - ii
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400
Rear PTO
07A01 - Rear PTO
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07A01.1
Rear PTO
07A01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Rear PTO
A . General PTO clutch - exploded view
Fig. 1 Ref.
Description
Description
1
Shim
21
Allen screw
2
Taper roller bearings
22
Grower washer
3
Clutch cover
23
Bush
4
Cylindrical screw
25
Pinion
5
Shim
28
Taper roller bearing
6
Internal blade holder
29
Nozzle
8
Shim
30
Locking half-rings
9
Spring washer
31
Circlip
10
Set of blades (11-12)
32
O’ring
11
Disc
35
Shaft
12
Intermediate plate
36
Taper roller bearing
13
Piston
37
Ring with rectangular section
14
Ring
38
Grub screw
16
Lip seal
39
Nozzle
18
Plate
40
Sensor
19
Lip seal
42
Shaft
20
Brake disc
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Ref.
07A01.3
Rear PTO Rear PTO drive - exploded view
Fig. 2 Ref.
Description
Ref.
Description
101
Taper roller bearing
121
Circlip
102
Shim
122
Washer
104
Clutch body
123
Taper roller bearing
105
Roller
124
Shim
107
Circlip
125
Grub screw
108
Washer
126
Spi seal
109
Needle bearing cage
127
O’ring
110
Spacer
128
Bearing cover
112
Circlip
129
Cylindrical screw
113
Taper roller bearing
132
Spacer
114
Circlip
133
Threaded stud M10 x 50 - 10.9
115
Allen screw
134
Nut M10-10
116
Stop
135
PTO guard
118
Pinion (1000 rpm)
137
End-fitting
Pinion (540 or 750 rpm)
139
Sensor
Shaft
140
Allen screw
118A 120
07A01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Rear PTO Rear PTO control - exploded view
Fig. 3 Ref.
Description
Ref.
Description
201
Stirrup
216
Allen screw
202
Hexagonal nut
217
Rams
203
Stud
218
O’ring
205
Allen screw
219
Compact seal
206
Hexagonal nut
220
Compact seal
207
Spacer pipe
221
Spring
210
Hexagonal nut
222
Piston
211
Hexagonal nut
224
Piston
212
Washer
225
Allen screw
213
Hexagonal nut
226
Rams
214
Roller
226
Rams
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07A01.5
Rear PTO Rear PTO cover - exploded view
Fig. 4 Ref.
Description
Ref.
Description
301
Rear axle housing
311
Closing plug
303
Seal
315
Dowel pin
304
Cover
316
Housing cover
305
Allen screw
317
Screw M18 x 90 - 10.9
307
Closing plug
318
Screw M18 x 110 -10.9
308
Sealing ring
319
Threaded stud M18 x 130 - 10.9
309
Closing plug
322
Sealing ring
310
Sealing ring
325
Cylindrical screw
07A01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Rear PTO Cross-section view of rear PTO
Fig. 5
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07A01.7
Rear PTO
07A01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO
07B01 - Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO
CONTENTS A . Disassembling the power take-off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Reassembling the power take-off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07B01.1
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO
07B01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO
A . Disassembling the power take-off Preparation 1. Lower the rear linkage. 2. Drain the transmission oil. 3. Remove the trailer linkage (depending on equipment). 4. Mark and remove the PTO connector TR9 (arrow Fig. 1). 5. Mark and remove the PTO connector TR10 (arrow Fig. 1).
Fig. 1 6. Unscrew all attachment screws. 7. Take the silicone out of the threaded bores and tighten 2 screws M12 (arrows Fig. 2) 8. Support the cover using a lifting tool and push it back using the two screws.
Fig. 2 9. Take off the rear PTO transmission cover. IMPORTANT: Take care of the adjustment shims (arrow Fig. 3), which are used to adjust the bearing clearance.
Fig. 3
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07B01.3
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 10. Push back the clutch cover (3) using 2 disc screws M10.
Fig. 4
11. Remove the nozzle (29).
Fig. 5
12. Fit the compression tool (ref. X899.980.145) and compress the clutch. 13. Extract the locking half-rings (30). 14. Release the clutch. 15. Remove the disc carrier and the set of discs (10).
Fig. 6
07B01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 16. Remove the adjustment shims (8), the set of Belleville washers (9) and the ring (14).
Fig. 7 17. Remove the piston (13).
Fig. 8 18. Remove a screws (21) and take off the blade (18).
Fig. 9
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07B01.5
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 19. Take off the circlip (31) and remove the brake disc (20).
Fig. 10
20. Take off the brake disc.
Fig. 11 21. Extract the bearing (101) using an extractor. 22. Take out the washer.
Fig. 12
07B01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 23. Unscrew the nuts (210 and 211). 24. Note the values of the nuts (210 and 211) if required. 25. Remove the stops (116). 26. Take out the control mechanism.
Fig. 13 27. Remove the pinions (118) and (118a).
Fig. 14
28. Take out the shaft (35). 29. If required, take off the external rings of the bearing.
Fig. 15
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07B01.7
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 30. If necessary, remove the ram (217) and / or (226).
Fig. 16 31. Take off the circlip (107), washer (108) and pinions.
Fig. 17 32. Remove the circlip (112). 33. Release the pinion (118).
Fig. 18
07B01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO
B . Reassembling the power take-off IMPORTANT: Before reassembling, all components, mating faces and grooves must be clean. Any rust, mud or water must be removed. 34. Fit home the bearing (113) in the pinion (118a) and lock with the circlip (114), then fit the pinion (118) to its stop.
Fig. 19 35. Fit the circlip (112) on the opposite side.
Fig. 20 36. Fit home the internal ring of the bearing (123) on the shaft (120). 37. Position the washer (122). 38. Fit the circlip (121). 39. Smear the 2 grub screws (25) with plastic binder (ref. X 903.050.084) and tighten them until the internal ring of the bearing (123) reaches its stop. The washer (122) must be fitted home.
Fig. 21
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07B01.9
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 40. Fit the 1st needle bearing cage (109), the spacer (110) and the 2nd needle bearing cage (109) on the shaft (120). 41. Fit the shaft (120). 42. Position the washer (108). 43. Fit the circlip (107).
Fig. 22
44. Fit new seals (219) in the ram (217). 45. Fit a new O’ring (218) in the groove of the ram (217). Smear the oil tight seals with miscible grease. 46. Insert the piston (222) and spring (221) as indicated in the ram (217). NOTE: The oil tight seal (219) is comprised of 2 parts: an O’ring on the outside and a piston strip guide on the inside.
Fig. 23 47. Fit new seals (220) in the ram (226). 48. Fit a new O’ring (218) in the groove of the ram (226). 49. Smear the oil tight seals with miscible grease. 50. Insert the piston (224) and spring (221) as indicated in the ram (226). NOTE: The oil tight seal (219) is comprised of 2 parts: an O’ring on the outside and a piston strip guide on the inside.
Fig. 24
07B01.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 51. Fit the rams (217 and 226). 52. Smear the thread of the screws (216 and 225) with plastic binder (ref. X 903.050.084) and tighten the screws to the following torque:
49 Nm
53. Refit the hydraulic pipes which have been removed in the housing cover (316). Fig. 25
54. If the housing is fitted with a new cover (316), screw the nozzle (29) to its stop in the threaded bore. 55. Fit home the external ring of the bearing (36).
Fig. 26
56. Smear 2 new rings (37) with miscible grease and install and lock them in the grooves of the shaft (35). 57. Fit home the internal ring of the bearing (36). 58. When assembling a new shaft (35), smear the thread of the threaded stud (38) with plastic binder (ref. X 903.050.084), and screw to its stop. 59. Tighten the nozzle (29) to its stop.
Fig. 27
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07B01.11
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 60. Fit the pre-assembled shaft (35) in the housing cover (316). If required, fit compensating shims (124) and fit home the external ring of the bearing (123).
Fig. 28 61. Fit the pair of ring gears and the pinion (25).
Fig. 29 Pre-assembling the stirrup 62. Smear the thread of the screws (205) with plastic binder (ref. X 903 050 084). 63. Fit spacers (207) and rollers (214). 64. Tighten nuts (206).
Fig. 30
07B01.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 65. Insert the rollers (105) into the clutch body (104). 66. Smear the thread of the screws (203) with plastic binder (ref. X 903 050 084). 67. Fit the stirrup tight to an identical distance, then loosen each screw (203) by 1/6 of a turn and lock them in this position.
Fig. 31
68. Screw the nuts (ref. 210, 211 and 213) onto the rods of the pistons (222, 224). 69. Fit the washers (212) with their chamfer turned upwards.
Fig. 32 70. Fit the pre-assembled stirrup (201). 71. Fit the washers (212) with their chamfer turned downwards. 72. Unscrew the nuts (210 and 211).
Fig. 33
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07B01.13
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 73. Smear the thread of the screws (115) with plastic binder (ref. X 903 050 084). 74. Fit the stops (116) and lock the screws (115).
Fig. 34 NOTE: The following must be carried out before setting stirrup travel: 75. The oblong hole in the stirrup (201) must be turned towards the ram (226). 76. Screw and lock the nuts (211, 210) to their stop.
Fig. 35 77. Screw a locally made eye nut M12 onto the piston rod of the ram (217). Using a lifting tool, pull hard on the piston rod. (Coupling at 750 or 540 rpm). 78. Check the clearance of the clutch body (104). Specified value: 0.1 to 0.2 mm clearance.
Fig. 36
07B01.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO If outside the specified clearance: 79. Adjust with nuts M12 (top and bottom) until clearance of 0.1 to 0.2 mm is obtained.
Fig. 37 80. Take off the lifting tool and unscrew the eye nut M12.
Fig. 38
81. Push the piston rod of the ram (226) fully in using a clamp, until the nuts (213) and at their stop. (Lifting limit, 1000 rpm position). 82. Check the clearance of the clutch body (104). Specified value: 0.1 to 0.2 mm clearance.
Fig. 39
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07B01.15
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO If outside the specified clearance: 83. Adjust the nuts (213) until clearance of 0.1 to 0.2 mm is obtained.
Fig. 40 84. Take off the clamp. 85. The coupling shifts to "Neutral" position. 86. The 750 or 540 and 1000 rpm ring gears should be able to turn freely. 87. The upward and downward free travel of the coupling should be identical. 88. If not, readjust the coupling.
Fig. 41
89. Fit the shim (102). 90. Fit the internal ring of the bearing (101) up against the shaft (120).
Fig. 42
07B01.16
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 91. Fit the pinion (25). 92. Smear a new O’ring with miscible grease and fit it in the groove of the shaft (35). 93. Check the brake disc (20) for wear. If necessary, fit a new brake disc (20).
Fig. 43 94. Fit the circlip (31). 95. Smear a new lip seal (19) with miscible grease and fit it in the brake disc groove, with the seal lips turned towards the oil chamber.
Fig. 44
96. Fit the blade (18). 97. Smear the thread of the screw (21) with Loctite (ref. X 903 054 084), and fit the Grower washer (22) and socket (23). 98. Tighten the screw.
Fig. 45
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07B01.17
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 99. Smear a new lip seal (16) with miscible grease and fit it in the inner groove of the piston, with the seal lips turned towards the oil chamber.
Fig. 46
100.Fit the pre-assembled piston (13). 101.Fit the ring (14).
Fig. 47
102.Fit 5 Belleville washers (9) with the large external diameters facing each other, and the compensating shims (8). NOTE: The external diameter of the first Belleville washer (9) should be turned towards the ring (14) of the piston (13). If required, for example if compensating shims (8) are lost, set the preload of the Belleville washer set (9).
Fig. 48
07B01.18
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO Setting the preload of Belleville washer set 103.Remove the shim (5) from the internal disc carrier (6). 104.Smear the thread of the screw (4) with plastic binder (Ref. X 903 050 084) and tighten.
Fig. 49 105.Fit home the pre-assembled ring carrier (6). 106.Measure and note the distance between the disc carrier (6) and the end of the shaft (35). Example: 23.2 mm.
Fig. 50
107.Fit the compression tool (ref. X 899 980 145) and compress the set of Belleville washers (9). 108.Fit the locking half-rings (30). 109.If the locking half-rings (30) are chamfered on just one side, the chamfered side must face the disc carrier (6). 110.Remove the compression tool (ref. X 899 980 145)
Fig. 51
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07B01.19
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 111.Measure and note the distance between the disc carrier (6) and the end of the shaft (35). Example: 25.8 mm. If the washer set gives compensating clearance of approximately 2.5 mm when completely compressed, the preload is correct. 112.If not, correct it with compensating shims.
Fig. 52
Installing the set of discs (10) on the disc carrier (6) For references, see Fig. 1 of the “General” paragraph in the “Rear power take-off” section. 113.Start with an external blade. 114.Next alternate with an internal blade (11). Each internal blade (11) should be fitted in respect to the narrow slot (pos. 2 Fig. 53) while the wide slot (pos. 3 Fig. 53) should be positioned either side alternately. NOTE: Total number of discs: 7 external discs (12) and 6 internal discs (11).
3
2
3
MA-07-04226A
Fig. 53
115.Fit the disc carrier (6) together with the set of Belleville washers (9).
Fig. 54
07B01.20
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 116.Fit the compression tool (ref. X 899 980 145). 117.Compress the clutch. 118.Fit the locking half-rings (30). If the locking half-rings are chamfered on just one side, the chamfered side must face the disc carrier (6). NOTE: If the disc carrier (6) does not fit into place, fit it without the set of discs (10) and mark the teeth.
Fig. 55 119.Push the set of discs home, ensuring it is correctly centred. 120.Measure the distance (uncoupling clearance) using laminated shims. Specified values: 1.75 to 3.50 mm 121.If the minimum distance of 1.75 mm is not obtained, the discs are wrapped. 122.Fit a new set of discs (10).
Fig. 56 123.Smear the thread of the nozzle (29) with plastic binder (ref. X 903 050 084). 124.Tighten the nozzle (29) to a torque of:
25 Nm
Fig. 57
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07B01.21
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 125.If necessary, fit the bearing (28) to its stop with its closed part facing upwards into the interior of the clutch cover (3).
Fig. 58
126.Fit the bearing (2) up against the clutch cover (3).
Fig. 59
127.Adjust the position of the external discs (12) and fit the clutch cover (3) to its stop.
Fig. 60
07B01.22
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 128.Fit compensating shims (1) on the bearing (2). 129.Measure and note the distance between the mating faces. For example: 178.6 mm.
Fig. 61 The distance between the flange face and the mating face of the journal is written in white on the top part of the rear axle housing. Example: 178.71. The distance between the journal of the bearing (2) and the flange face of the housing cover should be less than 0.1 to 0.2 mm, as the written value indicates. This means that the journal clearance must be 0.1 to 0.2 mm. If not, correct it with compensating shims (1).
Fig. 62 The distance between the flange face and the mating face of the journal of the lower shaft is written in white on the lower part of the rear axle housing. Example: 148.75. NOTE: This value is not necessary in case of repair, because a dial gauge must be used to measure the bearing clearance. Check the bearing clearance of the lower shaft (120).
Fig. 63
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07B01.23
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 130.Fit the compensating shims (1) in the upper bore. 131.Smear 4 new O’rings with miscible grease and fit them at the position of the oil pressure pipes (arrows Fig. 64).
Fig. 64 132.Clean the housing mating face. 133.Check the 2 locating pins are fitted correctly (arrows Fig. 65). 134.Smear the mating face with sealing product (ref. X 903.050.074).
Fig. 65
135.Carefully raise the housing cover and fit it on the rear axle housing.
Fig. 66
07B01.24
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 136.Tighten the M18 screws and nuts to a torque of:
400 Nm
Fig. 67 If necessary: 137.Smear the outside of a new shaft sealing ring (126) with a thin layer of sealing product (ref. X 903.051.711), and insert it until it comes into light contact with the cover (128), the seal lips turned towards the oil chamber. Depth approximately 5 mm. 138.Fill the lip seals 2/3 full with miscible grease.
Fig. 68 139.Fit the corresponding compensating shims (124). 140.Smear new O’rings (127) with miscible grease and fit them in the groove of the cover (128). 141.Smear the thread of the screws (129) with plastic binder (ref. X 903.050.084) and tighten.
Fig. 69
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07B01.25
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO 142.Rotate the shaft (120) 10 times. 143.Fit a dial gauge. 144.Push in the shaft (120) once and note the clearance value J2 (Fig. 71).
Fig. 70 145.Rotate the shaft (120) 10 times. 146.Fit a dial gauge. 147.Pull once on the shaft (120) and note the clearance value J1 (Fig. 72).
J1 J2
Total clearance J = J1+ J2. 0.02 mm < J < 0.07 mm 148.If not, correct it with compensating shims (124).
MA-07-04148A
Fig. 71
Fig. 72
07B01.26
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO PTO end-fitting with 6 x 1’ 3/8" splines Also compatible: PTO end-fitting with 21 x 1’ 3/8" splines PTO end-fitting with 6 x 1’ 3/4" splines PTO end-fitting with 20 x 1’ 3/4" splines NOTE: The PTO end-fitting has 4 drive holes for the PTO sensor (arrow Fig. 73).
Fig. 73 149.Fit the end-fitting (137). 150.Fit the spacer (132).
Fig. 74 151.Lock the end-fitting (137 with a screw M16 (arrow Fig. 75) (for easier assembly). 152.Tighten the nuts (134) (M0-10) to a torque of:
69 Nm
153.Top up the transmission oil level (see Operator Instruction Book).
Fig. 75
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
07B01.27
Assembling and disassembling the rear PTO
07B01.28
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Front axle
08 - Front axle CONTENTS 08E01 - 4-wheel drive clutch 08E02 - Universal joint shaft brake
Massey Ferguson 8400
¤ H
Contents - i
Front axle
Contents - ii
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400
4-wheel drive clutch
08E01 - 4-wheel drive clutch
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 C . Disassembling the 4WD clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 D . Reassembling the 4WD clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 E . Service tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E01.1
4-wheel drive clutch
08E01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
4-wheel drive clutch
A . General
B . Operation
The front axle clutch assembly is fitted in the lower part of the gearbox. The transmission module must be removed in order to gain access to the 4WD clutch. It comprises: - a shaft (5) turning on two ball bearings fitted in the bore of the unit housing, - a hydraulic clutch assembly integral with the rotating gear (15), - a disc carrier (9) centred on the shaft by needle bearings, which drives the clutch discs.
Declutching The 4WD solenoid valve sends the 17 bar pressure into the shaft (5) via a channel drilled in the gearbox housing. The pressure moves the piston washer (20) which presses against the spring washers (17) via the piston (18), thus releasing the discs (30). The disc carrier (9) integral with the shaft no longer turns.
Clutching
The helical gear (15) is constantly meshed to the idling gear on the drive pinion.
When the pressure is cut-off, the spring washers are released and push the piston and piston washer assembly, which compresses the discs (30), allowing the disc carrier (9) integral with the shaft to turn.
4WD clutch - exploded view 17 6
21
5
23 9
6 30
41
2
43
1 7 3 32
40
12 8
33 42
10
14
31
28
44
26 11
25
15
27 16 17 36
18 19 37
35
22 MA-05-04240A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
20
Fig. 1
08E01.3
4-wheel drive clutch Legend Ref. Description
Ref.
Description
1
Cover
22
Lip seal
2
Circlip
23
Thrust plate
3
Bearing
25
Clutch cover
5
Shaft
26
Pin
6
Screw
27
Washer
7
Ring with rectangular section
28
Circlip
8
Ring with rectangular section
30
External disc
9
Disc carrier
31
Internal disc
10 Oil seal
32
Thrust plate
11 Snap ring
33
Circlip
12 Needle bearing cage
35
Protective guard
14 Circlip
36
Screw
15 Pinion
37
Washer
16 Drive pinion
39
Bearing
17 Set of spring washers
40
Spi seal
18 Piston
41
Bearing
19 Lip seal
42
Washer shim
20 Piston washer
43
Circlip
21 O’ring
44
O’ring
08E01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
4-wheel drive clutch Cross-section view of 4WD clutch
1
2
6
7
3
7
9
14
15
10
5
12
16
18
17
19
8
21
8
22
23
20
30
25
32
31
26
33
35
28 27
MA-05-04241A
Fig. 2
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E01.5
4-wheel drive clutch
Page left blank intentionally
08E01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
4-wheel drive clutch
Overall view
35
32
30
23
8
8
17
16
31
25
20
22
21
19
18
15
9
3
6
1
10
14
7
7
2
26
28
27
33
12
5
MA-08-04001A
Fig. 3
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E01.7
4-wheel drive clutch
Page left blank intentionally
08E01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
4-wheel drive clutch
C . Disassembling the 4WD clutch The following operations must first be carried out: 1. Drain the transmission oil (approx. 65 litres). 2. Remove the universal joint shaft. 3. Remove brake pipes and hydraulic pipes which obstruct access. 4. Remove the transmission unit. NOTE: For easier reading, the work is carried out on a scale model. 5. Remove the suction pipe (Fig. 4). 6. Remove M8 screws and take out the retaining washer. Fig. 4
7. Extract the suction pipe from the filter housing.
Fig. 5
8. Take off the closing plate. 9. Take out the suction filter.
Fig. 6
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E01.9
4-wheel drive clutch 10. Take the housing out of the suction filter. (Specific locally made tool).
Fig. 7 11. Specific locally made tool.
Fig. 8
12. Remove the drive pinion speed sensor.
Fig. 9
08E01.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
4-wheel drive clutch 13. Pull the shaft (5) backwards.
CAUTION: When the shaft has been removed, the front axle drive clutch is no longer controlled. There is a risk of injury.
Fig. 10
14. Extract the whole front axle drive clutch along with its guard. (35)
Fig. 11
15. Fit a stirrup (locally made). Using a press, compress the spring washer set assembly (17) until the circlip (2) is released.
Fig. 12
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E01.11
4-wheel drive clutch 16. Remove the circlip (2) and carefully release the load exerted by the press.
Fig. 13
17. Extract the pinion (15).
Fig. 14
18. Remove the set of spring washers (17).
Fig. 15
08E01.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
4-wheel drive clutch 19. Take out the piston (18), the piston washer (20) and the thrust plate (23).
Fig. 16
20. Remove the set of discs (30-31), the thrust plate (32) and the disc carrier (9).
Fig. 17
21. Discard the O’ring (21) and the lip seal (19).
Fig. 18
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E01.13
4-wheel drive clutch
D . Reassembling the 4WD clutch 22. Fit the disc carrier (9) with a new O'ring (21) and a new lip seal (19). NOTE: Grease the O’ring (21) and lip seal (19). The lip seal groove is directed to the oil chamber (arrow Fig. 19).
Fig. 19 23. Fit the disc carrier (9) in the clutch cover (25). 24. Fit the thrust plate (32). The groove should face the clutch cover (25) (arrow Fig. 20).
Fig. 20 25. Starting with an internal disc (31), assemble the set of discs. 26. Oil the internal discs. 27. Fit the internal discs (31) and external discs (30) alternately.
Fig. 21
08E01.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
4-wheel drive clutch 28. Fit the thrust plate (23). The groove (arrow Fig. 22) should face the internal disc (30).
Fig. 22 29. Fit a new lip seal (22) on the piston washer (20). NOTE: Grease the lip seal (22). The lip seal groove should be turned towards to the oil chamber (arrow Fig. 23).
Fig. 23 30. Fit the piston washer (20) in the piston (18). Position it correctly (arrow Fig. 24).
Fig. 24
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E01.15
4-wheel drive clutch 31. Fit the piston (18) fitted with the washer (20).
Fig. 25 32. Fit the set of spring washers.
Fig. 26
33. Fit pinion (15).
Fig. 27
08E01.16
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
4-wheel drive clutch 34. Install the shaft (5) in the centre of the front axle drive clutch.
Fig. 28 35. Fit the front axle clutch with its shaft (5) under a press.
Fig. 29
36. Using a locally made stirrup, and the press, compress the set of spring washers (17). 37. Fit the circlip (2).
Fig. 30
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E01.17
4-wheel drive clutch 38. Fit the assembled front axle clutch and hold it in place with a shim.
Fig. 31 39. Grease and fit the 4 rings with rectangular sections (arrows Fig. 32) in the grooves of shaft (5). Offset the openings in relation to one another. NOTE: Screw the threaded rods (6) into the shaft (5) after smearing the shaft thread with binder (Ref. X903.050.091): The shaft thread must be completely free of grease. Allow the binder to harden for 12 hours.
Fig. 32 40. Fit the shaft (5), remove the shim and fit the guard (35). NOTE: The bearing (32) must not be damaged. Engage the shaft carefully.
Fig. 33
08E01.18
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
4-wheel drive clutch 41. Fit the suction filter housing. 42. Fit the suction pipe fitted with a new seal (Pos. A Fig. 34) in the suction filter housing.
Fig. 34
43. Grease and fit new seals.
Fig. 35
44. Fit the retaining washer in the groove. 45. Tighten M8 screw.
Fig. 36
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E01.19
4-wheel drive clutch 46. Fit the closing plate with a new seal.
Fig. 37 47. Fit the drive pinion speed sensor with a sealing product (Ref. X 903.050.553) 48. Refit the transmission unit. 49. Refit brake pipes and hydraulic pipes which obstruct access. 50. Refit the universal joint shaft. 51. Fill transmission with hydraulic oil. (See “Filling the gearbox” section).
Fig. 38
08E01.20
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
4-wheel drive clutch
E . Service tools Under development.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E01.21
4-wheel drive clutch
08E01.22
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Universal joint shaft brake
08E02 - Universal joint shaft brake
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Disassembling the universal joint shaft brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 C . Reassembling the universal joint shaft brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 D . Disassembling the universal joint shaft brake control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 E . Reassembling the universal joint shaft brake control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E02.1
Universal joint shaft brake
08E02.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Universal joint shaft brake
A . General On MF 8400 series tractors, the universal joint shaft brake comprises 6 discs and 6 intermediate plates, distributed on either side of a mechanism and activated by a control piston and a pin. The control piston is located on the right-hand side of the gearbox. The brake piston pushes the control rod, which activates the brake plate. This then moves apart, and compresses the discs against the intermediate plates, which are splined together by pins (14). When released, the control plate springs ensure minimum clearance between the brake discs. Lubrication is ensured by an external hydraulic pipe coming from the lubricating circuit.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E02.3
Universal joint shaft brake Exploded view of the universal joint shaft brake
Fig. 1
Ref. Description
Ref.
Description
1
Shaft
12
Intermediate plate
3
Flange
14
pin
4
Dowel pin
16
Universal joint shaft brake control piston
5
Allen screw
17
Control rod
7
Brake plate
22
Seal
8
Ball
23
Cylindrical screw
9
Spring
25
Stud
10 Dowel pin
26
Nut
11 Disc
08E02.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Universal joint shaft brake Cross-section view of the universal joint shaft brake
Fig. 2
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E02.5
Universal joint shaft brake
B . Disassembling the universal joint shaft brake The following operations must first be carried out: 1. Drain the transmission oil (approx. 65 litres). 2. Split the tractor between the clutch housing and transmission housing. See chapter 2. 3. Remove the universal joint shaft. NOTE: For easier reading, the work is carried out on a scale model. References are relative to Fig. 1. 4. Remove the suction filter of the variable displacement pump, if it obstructs disassembly. (depending on model)
Fig. 3
5. Take off the internal leak pipe and deflector.
Fig. 4
6. Remove the lubricating oil pipe.
Fig. 5
08E02.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Universal joint shaft brake 7. Remove the control piston of the universal joint shaft brake (16).
Fig. 6 8. Take off the sleeve.
Fig. 7
9. Remove the screws from the flange (5). 10. Push out the flange (3) with two M8 screws. IMPORTANT: When pushing out the flange, the drive shaft must not leave its seat.
Fig. 8
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E02.7
Universal joint shaft brake 11. Take off the flange (3), discs (11), intermediate plates (12) and brake plate (7).
Fig. 9
08E02.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Universal joint shaft brake
C . Reassembling the universal joint shaft brake IMPORTANT: Before reassembly, all components, mating faces and grooves must be clean. Any rust, mud or water must be removed. 12. Fit the studs (4).
Fig. 10
13. Starting with an intermediate plate (12), fit 3 intermediate plates (12) and three discs (11) alternately. 1. The first intermediate plate is fitted in position A. IMPORTANT: Use new intermediate plates (12) and new discs (11). Oil the discs before assembly.
Fig. 11 2. The second intermediate plate is fitted in position B, and so on alternately.
Fig. 12
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E02.9
Universal joint shaft brake 14. Fit the brake plate (7). The control pin (arrow) must be opposite the drilled hole (arrow).
Fig. 13
15. Fit the control piston of the brake (16) with a new seal (22).
Fig. 14
16. Assemble the activating corner correctly as shown (arrow) on the brake plate (7).
Fig. 15
08E02.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Universal joint shaft brake 17. Fit the remaining discs (11) and intermediate plates (12).
Fig. 16
18. Clean the mating face of the cover and smear with sealing product (ref. X 903.050.074). 19. Fit the flange (3) and tighten the screws (5) to a torque of:
50 Nm
Fig. 17
20. Check the axial clearance of the universal joint shaft with a dial gauge. Specified value: 0.3 + 0.1mm
Fig. 18
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E02.11
Universal joint shaft brake 21. If outside the specified value, correct the clearance with compensating shims.
Fig. 19
22. Fit the lubricating pipe, return pipe and deflector.
Fig. 20
23. Fit a new suction filter.
Fig. 21
08E02.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Universal joint shaft brake 24. Grease and install a new O’ring. 25. Insert the sleeve on the shaft (1).
Fig. 22 Adjusting the brake control piston: 26. Unscrew the locknut. 27. Tighten the adjustment rod with a torque wrench (or the corresponding torque gauge, ref. X 899.980.151); to a torque of:
4 to 5 Nm
Fig. 23 28. Unscrew the rod by 3.6 turns and lock it in this position. 29. Assemble the tractor between the clutch housing and transmission housing. 30. Refit the universal joint shaft. 31. Fill up the transmission oil.
Fig. 24
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E02.13
Universal joint shaft brake
D . Disassembling the universal joint shaft brake control 32. Remove the hydraulic pipe.
Fig. 25
33. Loosen and remove the brake cylinder attachment screws.
Fig. 26 34. Remove the brake cylinder and control rod. 35. Discard the paper gasket.
Fig. 27
08E02.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Universal joint shaft brake
E . Reassembling the universal joint shaft brake control 36. Clean the mating faces of the gearbox and brake cylinder. 37. Smear the control lever ball joint with miscible grease. 38. Fit the control rod in the brake cylinder. 39. Oil and fit a new paper gasket.
Fig. 28
40. Fit the control rod / brake cylinder assembly in the gearbox housing.
Fig. 29
41. Fit and tighten the brake cylinder attachment screws. 42. Reconnect the hydraulic pipe. 43. Bleed the brake. See "Bleeding the brakes" paragraph.
Fig. 30
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
08E02.15
Universal joint shaft brake
08E02.16
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Hydraulics
09 - Hydraulics CONTENTS 09A01 - Description of the circuit 09B01 - Illustrated diagram 09C01 - Hydraulic legends and diagrams 09D01 - Layout of components 09E01 - Trailer braking and ParkLock 09F01 - Auxiliary spool valves 09G01 - Lift control valve 09H01 - Load Sensing hydrostatic steering 09I01 - Main braking circuit 09J01 - Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 09K01 - Auxiliary hydraulics tests
Massey Ferguson 8400
¤ H
Contents - i
Hydraulics
Contents - ii
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400
Description of the circuit
09A01 - Description of the circuit
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Characteristics of the components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09A01.1
Description of the circuit
09A01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Description of the circuit
A . General The hydraulic system on MF 8400 tractors is of closed centre with flow rate and pressure control. It comprises two separate high and low pressure circuits supplied respectively by a variable displacement pump and a fixed displacement pump.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09A01.3
Description of the circuit Parts list (Fig. 1 and Fig. 2) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) (12) (13) (14) (15) (16) (17) (18) (19) (20) (21) (22) (23) (24) (25) (26) (27) (28) (29) (30) (31) (32) (33) (34) (35) (36)
19cc fixed displacement pump 60cc variable displacement pump Steering priority valve Steering spool valve Steering ram 300 µm strainer 450 µm strainer 10 µm filter Cooler By pass (5 bar) Distribution block 200 bar pressure relief valve Braking circuit priority valve Trailer braking valve Trailer brake control proportional solenoid valve Trailer brake control safety solenoid valve LS signal breaker solenoid valve Make and break valve (braking circuit load) Auxiliary spool valves assembly Lift control spool valve Lift rams Accumulator (ParkLock circuit) Accumulator (braking circuit) ParkLock ParkLock lever ParkLock ram Tractor braking valve Brake pedals Rear brakes Pressure sensor Front axle shaft brake Front axle shaft braking valve Pump (18 bar transmission circuit) Pressure reversing solenoid valve Pressure switches Trailer brake coupler
09A01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Description of the circuit
25 26
19
24
27
34
29 28
21 22 20
30
23
17
31
18
13
10 32 35
16
9
5
36
12
15 4 3
14
11
33
1 2
8
6 7 MA-09-03627A
Fig. 1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09A01.5
Description of the circuit
9
5
27 3 4 8 7
1
6
2
31 18 23 17 22
16
25
15 11
26
14
19
13
20
12 10
29 High pressure circuit Cooling system Braking circuit Tank return Load Sensing Suction MA-09-03628A
29 32
34 21 Fig. 2
09A01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Description of the circuit Description of the circuits “Open centre” steering circuit The steering circuit is supplied by the fixed displacement pump (1), which sucks via a hose from the hydraulic tank. The pump discharge is directed to a priority valve (3) which ensures priority of the Orbitrol (4) and sends excess flow to the distribution block (11), then to the cooling circuit (9). A valve (10) located in the distribution block is fitted parallel to the cooler (9). This valve prevents the differential pressure exceeding ∆P 5 bar at the cooler outlets; however, when starting the tractor in cold weather, the pressure on the return filter can reach 4.5 bar, which means that the maximum pressure on the cooler supply is 4.5 + 5 = 9.5 bar. The maximum flow rate of this circuit is provided by the fixed displacement pump. Distribution circuit of the Load Sensing circuit variable displacement pump The Load Sensing circuit is supplied by the variable displacement pump (2), which sucks via a hose from the hydraulic tank. The pump discharge is directed to the distribution block (11) by a hose. When the tractor is being operated but the hydraulic controls are not used (auxiliary spool valves, brake system), the pressure in the discharge circuit of the variable displacement pump is 18 bar ± 2 and the pump flow rate is equal to the control leak of the pressure and flow rate regulation. When a hydraulic control is activated, the Load Sensing line controls the flow rate regulation and the pump (2) changes capacity to maintain a ∆P of 14 bar between the discharge pressure and useful pressure.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Trailer braking valve The trailer braking valve block includes a priority valve (13) which directs the flow giving priority to the trailer braking valve (14) and the make and break valve (18). Trailer brake pressure is proportional to the control pressure increased by a factor of 8 or 9. For “XFR” control pressure of 10 bar, the pressure at the trailer brakes “FR” is 80 to 90 bar.
Operation of the priority valve Reducing the flow rate to the auxiliaries and reducing pressure When the maximum pump flow rate is used by the auxiliary parts, the valve reduces the flow to these parts to direct flow to the trailer brake when the brakes are activated. Pressure “Paux” remains constant. Maintaining flow rate to the auxiliaries When the flow rate used is less than the maximum pump output, the brake valve controller can be adjusted so that the flow rate regulator corrects pump capacity. Flow rate to the auxiliaries is maintained, pressure "Paux" becomes equal to the highest useful pressure of the circuit, and the spool valve pressure is maintained by the auxiliary spool valve pressure balance.
09A01.7
Description of the circuit
B . Characteristics of the components Characteristics of the pumps “Open centre circuit” steering circuit pump -
DANFOSS SNP2/19 gear pump 19cc fixed capacity Maximum pressure: 210 bar Maximum rotational speed : 3000 rpm Suction pressure: 0.8 to 3 bar. Gear ratio: 67/58 Pump flow rate with different engine speeds: Engine speed rpm
pump flow rate in l/min
pump rotation in rpm
nominal 2200
48
2541
min. 850
19
982
max. 2350
52
2715
Load Sensing circuit variable displacement pump -
DANFOSS Frame J60 variable displacement pump Maximum pump capacity: 60cc Maximum pressure: 400 bar Maximum rotational speed : 3120 rpm Nominal pressure: 310 bar Suction pressure: 0.8 bar Regulation: DFR type pressure-flow rate regulator Differential pressure ∆P at flow regulator: 14 bar “Stand-by” flow cancellation pressure: 18 bar ± 2 Flow cancellation pressure: 200 bar ± 10 Gear ratio: 67/58 Pump flow rate with different engine speeds: Engine speed rpm
pump flow rate in l/min
pump rotation in rpm
nominal 2200
152
2541
min. 850
59
982
max. 2350
163
2715
09A01.8
¤ H
Characteristics of distribution block (Fig 3) Description of the distribution block and trailer braking valve functions To ensure the tractor hydraulic components are kept supplied: - Linkage - Auxiliary spool valves - Cooling - Trailer braking valve Excess flow that is not used by the steering unit is redirected to the distribution block, then to the hydraulic cooler. The distribution block is fitted with a safety by-pass valve (10) for the cooler. A 230 bar safety valve (12) protects the variable displacement pump. The hydraulic distribution of this pump is ensured by the circuit selectors (S) on the Load Sensing line and by the bypass circuits of the pressure line on this block. The block containing the trailer braking valve flanges on the distribution block. It consists of the following: - a priority valve (13) - the trailer braking valve (14) - the make and break valve (18) - the control solenoid valves (15) and (16) of the trailer braking valve (14) - the LS signal breaker solenoid valve (17) The trailer braking valve (14) and make and break valve (18) have priority on all functions supplied by the Load Sensing variable displacement pump. All tank returns are directed to the distribution block; in this way all returns are filtered into the tank. A valve (C) is fitted on the “Open Centre circuit” return line to avoid possible overloads in the variable displacement pump return.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
2
1
MA-09-03578A
FS
P
T
Px
Tx
F2
A2
A1
15
16
13
11
135 bar
9
TRAILER BRAKING VALVE
12
FR
22 bar
14
10
6
3
Pp
7
230 bar
5
8
DISTRIBUTION BLOCK
PPp
¤ H 5 bar
ParkLock
4
T
Pp
TC
AC Pp
T DIR
T AUX
T OPT
X AUX
X OPT
P DIR
P AUX P OPT
Description of the circuit
Diagram of the distribution block and trailer braking valve assembly
Fig 3
09A01.9
Description of the circuit ParkLock function of the block The make and break valve (18) maintains pressure in the accumulators (22) and (23) between 135 and 165 bar. The pressure of the accumulator (22) supplies the ram of the ParkLock (26) to release the tractor brakes. The accumulator (23) is used for the tractor braking circuit. When the accumulator pressure drops below 135 bar the make and break valve (18) status changes, the Load Sensing line sends a message to the pump regulation to increase its capacity and loads the accumulators. A time delay relay activated when the starter is switched on allows the solenoid valve (17) to break the LS signal when the tractor is started. If the signal is not broken when the engine is started, the pressure needed by the make and break valve would require the pump to regulate an excessive pressure level that would overload the starter. When powered, the solenoid valve (34) of the ParkLock function allows the valve chamber of the ParkLock (26) to communicate with the accumulator (22) to release the tractor brakes. The pressure reversing valve (24) is activated by the lever (25) located in the cab. It allows the pressure in the valve (26) to be released when the lever (25) is activated. It also maintains the pressure in the ParkLock valve at 120 bar.
Trailer braking valve function The trailer braking valve (14) is controlled by the proportional solenoid valve (15) or the solenoid valve (16). The trailer braking line is linked to the tank when the valve is not controlled; when the tractor brakes are activated, pressure builds in the pilot flow housing of the trailer braking valve and the trailer braking line communicates with the pump supply. The control pressure and trailer brake pressure are proportional until the pressure reaches 150 bar. The proportional solenoid valve (15) is controlled by the Autotronic 5 according to the signal received by a pressure sensor located on the front brake control. The proportional solenoid valve (15) is supplied with 18 bar pressure (hydraulic transmission circuit) and controls the trailer braking valve between 0 and 17 bar, depending on the signal received. The solenoid valve (16) ensures the trailer braking valve (14) is controlled when the emergency handbrake (lever 25) is activated, if the ParkLock switch on the reverse shuttle lever is not engaged. A circuit selector allows the trailer braking valve to be controlled by one of the two solenoid valves.
09A01.10
¤ H
Characteristics of the braking block elements Priority valve (13) It ensures priority to the trailer braking valve (14) and the make and break valve (18) to load the accumulators (22) and (23); excess flow is sent to the linkage spool valve and auxiliary spool valves.
Make and break valve (18) The make and break valve allows the accumulators (22) and (23) to remain loaded to operate the ParkLock (26) and tractor braking valve (27) respectively. Opening pressure: 135 bar Cut-out pressure: 165 bar Accumulator supply flow rate: 5 l/min
Trailer braking valve Valve proportional to trailer braking pressure “FR” between 10 and 150 bar depending on the control pressure regulated by the proportional solenoid valve (15). The maximum trailer braking valve pressure is between: 140 bar < max. "FR" < 150 bar. - Valve brake flow rate > 50 l/min - Maximum control pressure: 30 bar - Control pressure to obtain maximum trailer brake pressure in FR: 17 bar - Hysteresis < 10%
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Description of the circuit Control proportional solenoid valve of the trailer braking valve (15) The control proportional solenoid valve of the trailer braking valve is supplied with pressure between 30 and 18 bar by the transmission hydraulic circuit in Px. The return in Tx is to the transmission hydraulic circuit tank. Voltage supply: 12 V Maximum current: 2000 mA Maximum pressure in P: 30 bar
Pressure switch The pressure switch signals a fault in the charging of the accumulators. An indicator light or buzzer alerts the user in case of a brake valve supply pressure fault. Contact opening pressure: 105 bar
Control safety solenoid valve of the trailer braking valve (16) Voltage supply: 12 V Maximum current: 2000 mA Maximum pressure in P: 30 bar
Control solenoid valve (34) of the ParkLock ram pressure reversing valve Voltage supply: 12 V Maximum current: 2000 mA Maximum pressure in P: 230 bar Flow rate: 5 l/min. with ∆P = 5 bar
Pressure reversing valve (24) The pressure reversing valve ensures the emergency brake function, and allows pressure in the pressure reducing ram to reduce gradually from 120 to 0 bar. It also ensures limits pressure in the ram to 120 bar, as the supply pressure of this valve is between 135 and 165 bar.
Solenoid valve (17) to break LS signal when tractor is started This solenoid valve is controlled by a time delay relay with: - Solenoid valve supply on the starter supply - Solenoid valve circuit broken 5 seconds after starter circuit has been cut.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09A01.11
Description of the circuit Characteristics of hydraulic tank and filter Return filter, by-pass and clogging indicator light The return filter is fitted to the upper part of the tank, and collects return flow coming from the variable displacement pump and fixed displacement pump. When the tractor is operated without the hydraulic controls being activated, the capacity setting of the variable displacement pump is equal to the regulation leaks. These leaks are collected by the pump drain and are sent straight to the tank without passing through the return filter; only the fixed displacement pump flow rate is collected by the return filter. If the engine runs at 2,200 rpm, with a maximum flow rate from the variable displacement pump circuit, the flow rate collected by the return is: 152 + 48 = 200 l/min. Maximum flow through filter: Qmax = 200 l/min Filter size: 10 µm ß15 > 100 By-pass setting: 5 bar. The by-pass is included in the filter element, and is replaced each time the element is changed. The clogging indicator light located on the filter head informs the operator of the clogging level of the filter element; it includes the following features: - Contact closing pressure: 3 bar ± 0.4 - Electrical protection: IP67 - Operating temperature: -30°C to +100 °C - Connection: Deutsch DT 04-2P - Maximum voltage: 42 Volt The temperature probe is located at the bottom of the hydraulic tank, and it has the following functions: - It cuts the clogging signal when the temperature in the tank is lower than 20°C. - Its buzzer warns the operator when the temperature in the tank exceeds 95°C. - The tank oil level is displayed on the DCC2 for a few seconds when the engine is started. An electronic gauge located in the spacer that serves as a tank sends information to the DCC2. The level can be checked at any time on a DOT MATRIX screen.
09A01.12
¤ H
Characteristics of pump suction strainers The pump suction strainers are located in the hydraulic tank, and their purpose is to prevent possible pollution of the pumps when topping up the tank, or when filling the tank after draining. For the Open Centre: - Filter element surface: 720 cm² - Filter size: 300 µm For the Load Sensing circuit: - Filter element surface: 800 cm² - Filter size: 450 µm
Auxiliary spool valves and lift control valve (Fig 4, Fig 5 and Fig. 6) Characteristics of auxiliary spool valves The hydraulic auxiliary spool valve set can have different configurations, and can comprise 4, 5 or 6 electronically controlled spool valves. Spool valve operation is controlled by the electronics, allowing for the following functions: - infinite and time delay : the spool valve is maintained in open position, regardless of the pressure. - ZF: zero leak or anti-return controlled valve on port B (2) of the spool valve to maintain a load in the chamber supplied by port B. - Floating: spool (1) position or ports A and B on T are linked by moving the joystick forward. - Flow rate adjustment in % : using the on-board computer, flow rate can be adjusted either from P to A or from P to B.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Description of the circuit Diagram of an electronically controlled spool valve with anti-return valve on port B
1
2
B A
R
LS
MA-09-04038A
P
X
Rx
4
3
Fig 4
The spool valves are fitted with pressure balances (3 Fig 4). The role of these balances is to regulate the flow rate, depending on the load. When using 2 hydraulic functions simultaneously, the pump locks depending on which function has the higher demand, the balance of the spool valve with the lowest pressure operates at reduced pressure and creates a ∆P of the difference between use pressure and pump pressure. The flow rate used by this spool valve remains stable regardless of other functions used, provided that the pump capacity is adequate. The flow rate is adjusted by the spool (1); the electronics adjust the spool opening depending on the flow rate percentage required.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09A01.13
Description of the circuit Diagram of closing plate with supply to control solenoid valves of the electronically controlled spool valves 1
X3
P3
R
P
X
Rx
MA-09-04044A
3
2
Fig 5
The solenoid valve (1 Fig 5) located on the closing plate allows pressure to be maintained between 21 and 24 bar to control the electrohydraulic spool valves. The control solenoid valves located in each spool valve then use this pressure to move the spools of the spool valves (1 Fig 4). Lines X and Rx direct the pressure to the control solenoid valves. The filter (2 Fig 5) secures the entire pollution control section and the valve (3 Fig 5) protects the Rx control line governing possible overloads on the R lines or return lines of other applications.
General characteristics of electronically controlled spool valves The following data are for a viscosity of 35 cst for a spool valve with anti-return valves in A and B: - Maximum flow rate: 100 l/min. - ∆P in spool valve from P to A or B: 14 bar at 80 l/min. - ∆P in spool valve from B to R: 10 bar below 80 l/min. - ∆P in spool valve from A to R: 7 bar below 80 l/min. - ∆P from control to pressure balance: 7 bar at 80 l/min.
09A01.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Description of the circuit Diagram of the lift control valve 2
R
LS
P
X
4
1
5
Rx A
R1
MA-09-04040A
6
3
Fig. 6
Characteristics of lift control valve (Fig. 6) The lift control valve comprises 2 electronically controlled proportional valves: one valve (1) for lifting and the other valve (2) for lowering. The pressure balance (3) allows to control the flow rate to the lift rams when used simultaneously with other hydraulic components. The valve (4) maintains the load in the ram chambers when the lift valve is not used. The pressure relief valve (5) is set at 225 bar, and limits the pressure in the lift ram chambers in case of heavy shocks to the lift arms. The circuit selector (6) informs the Load Sensing pump of pressure and flow rate requirements. Lift control valve specifications The following data are given for a viscosity of 35 cst. - Maximum flow rate: 100l/min. - ∆P in spool valve from P to A: to be set below 90 l/min. - ∆P in spool valve from A to R1: 22 bar below 90 l/min.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09A01.15
Description of the circuit Steering unit OSPFD 80/240 steering unit
Diagram of the OSPFD 80/240 steering unit
1
8
7
3
160 bar
T LS
P DIR
MA-09-03577A
2
4
6
5 Fig 7
Characteristics of the steering unit OSPFD 80/240 (Fig 7) - Shock valves (1 et 2) setting: 225 -245 bar - Supply valve (3) setting: 155 - 160 bar - Steering unit (5) capacity: 240 cc / rev. - Steering unit (8) capacity: 80 cc / rev. - Supply valve (6) setting: 10 bar - Torque of spool valve return to neutral springs (4): 1.5 daN The specified number of steering wheel turns from stop-to-stop is 4.7 revs.
09A01.16
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Illustrated diagram
09B01 - Illustrated diagram
CONTENTS A . Auxiliary hydraulics illustrated diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09B01.1
Illustrated diagram
09B01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Illustrated diagram
A . Auxiliary hydraulics illustrated diagram Parts list (Fig. 1) (1)
Auxiliary hydraulic pumps / Orbitrol priority valve assembly (2) Orbitrol (3) Priority block / trailer braking valve assembly (4) 18 bar circuit hydraulic pump (5) ParkLock and ParkLock accumulators (6) Main brake master cylinders (7) Rear brakes (8) Front brake (9) Auxiliary hydraulic spool valves and lift spool valve (10) Connectors to add spool valves
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09B01.3
Illustrated diagram
Page left blank intentionally
09B01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Illustrated diagram
X aux P aux T aux
B A
B A
10 5 3
7
P 3/4
B A
T 3/4 X SUS
P SUS
T SUS LS 3/8
6
FS
135 bar A1
B A
P SUS P AUX P OPT
T 22 bar
P P DIR
9
A2
F2
X OPT
B A
X AUX X SUS
230 bar Tx Px
T OPT T SUS T AUX T DIR AC
LS PV
Pp 5 bar
FR Pp
TC
B A
Pp
PPp
Pp
8
T
OSPFD 80/240
T 160 bar LS
4 P DIR
7 bar
2 60 cc
19 cc 1
1
90 2 A 2
B
90 3
A
3
B
180
1
1
2 1 180
MA-09-03585A 2
Fig. 1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09B01.5
Illustrated diagram
09B01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Hydraulic legends and diagrams
09C01 - Hydraulic legends and diagrams
CONTENTS A . Legend of transmission hydraulics diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Legend of auxiliary hydraulics diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 C . Transmission hydraulics diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 D . Auxiliary hydraulics diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09C01.1
Hydraulic legends and diagrams
09C01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Hydraulic legends and diagrams
A . Legend of transmission hydraulics diagram Component
Description Different circuits
1
Valve block (boosting / lubricating)
2
Hydrostatic loop
3
Adjustment
4
Transmission control unit
5
Rear axle beam brakes
6
Solenoid valve block on rear axle beam
7
Front power take-off Pumps
1P1
Service pump
1P2
Lubricating pump
2P1
Hydrostatic pump Drive components
2A1
Hydrostatic motor
2A2
Hydrostatic motor
3A1
Piston for setting the hydrostatic pump displacement
3A2
Piston for setting the hydrostatic motor displacement
3A3
Ground speed limiter in limp home mode
4A1
Forward range selector
5A1
Right-hand brake cylinder
5A2
Left-hand brake cylinder
5A3
Universal joint shaft brake
6A1
Rear PTO clutch
6A2
540 (or 750) rpm PTO selector piston (depending on equipment fit)
6A3
1000 rpm PTO selector piston
6A4
Front axle clutch
6A5
Rear axle differential lock
6A6
1000 rpm PTO selector piston
6A7
Front axle differential lock
7A1
Front PTO clutch
7A2
Front PTO brake Sensors
1S1
Transmission oil temperature sensor
1S2
Pressure filter clogging switch
4S1
HP loop pressure sensor
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09C01.3
Hydraulic legends and diagrams
Component
Description Other components
1Z1
Suction filter with bypass
1Z2
Pressure filter with bypass
1Z3
Transmission oil cooler
1Z4
Transmission lubrication
3Z1
Actuator shaft
3Z2
Actuator unit
4Z1
Clutch pedal with sensor cylinder
4Z2
Accumulator
5Z1
Brake pedal with master brake cylinder
5Z2
Rear PTO lubrication
5Z3
Differential and right-hand brake lubrication
5Z4
Differential and left-hand brake lubrication
5Z5
Universal joint brake lubrication Valves (or spool valves / solenoid valves)
1V1
Cooler bypass valve
1V2
Flushing pressure relief valve
1V3
Booster pressure relief valve
1V4
Lubricating pressure relief valve
1V5
Service pump pressure relief valve
1V6
Servocircuit pressure relief valve
2V1
Forward booster non-return valve
2V2
Reverse booster non-return valve
2V3
Forward high-pressure relief valve
2V4
Reverse high-pressure relief valve
2V5
Scavenging valve
2V6
Shuttle valve
3V1
Hydrostatic pump spool valve
3V2
Hydrostatic motor spool valve
4V1
Hare range solenoid valve
4V2
Tortoise range solenoid valve
4V3
Ground speed limiting solenoid valve
4V4
Coupler function solenoid valve
4V5
Clutch function spool valve
4V6
Rear axle pressure relief spool valve
5V1
Cooling oil valve, right-hand brake
5V2
Cooling oil valve, left-hand brake
5V4
Universal joint brake control valve
5V5
Cooling oil valve, universal joint brake
09C01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Hydraulic legends and diagrams
Component
Description
5V6
Brake distribution spool valve
6V1
Rear PTO clutch solenoid valve
6V3
540 (or 750) rpm PTO control solenoid valve (depending on equipment fit)
6V4
Front axle clutch solenoid valve
6V5
Differential lock solenoid valve
6V6
1000 rpm PTO control solenoid valve
7V1
Front PTO clutch solenoid valve
7V2
Front PTO brake solenoid valve Measuring points
M1
Pressure upstream of cooler
M2
Lubricating pressure
M3
Flushing pressure
M4
Booster pressure
M5
Service pump pressure
M6
Transmission system pressure
M7
Range 1 (Tortoise) shifting pressure
M8
Range 2 (Hare) shifting pressure
M9
High pressure
M10
Rear axle beam and braking system pressure
M11
PTO clutch pressure
M13
540 (or 750) rpm PTO selector pressure (depending on equipment fit)
M14
Front axle clutch pressure
M15
Differential lock pressure
M16
1000 rpm PTO selector pressure
M17
Brake service pressure
M18
Brake service pressure
M21
Front PTO clutch pressure
M22
Oil leak from clutch or coupler function valve
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09C01.5
Hydraulic legends and diagrams
B . Legend of auxiliary hydraulics diagram Component 1
Distribution block
2
Trailer braking valve (according to equipment fit)
3
Steering unit
4
Braking unit
5
ParkLock
6
Variable displacement pump
7
Auxiliary pump
8
Filtration
9
Oil cooler
10
Pressure relief valve
11
Pressure connectors
12
Auxiliary spool valve
13
Auxiliary spool valve
14
Auxiliary spool valve
15
Auxiliary spool valve
16
Auxiliary spool valve + front linkage
17
Auxiliary spool valve + auto hitch
18
Lift control valve
19
Spool valve closing plate
20
Front linkage valves
21
Auto hitch valves
22
Rear brakes
23
Front brake
09C01.6
¤ H
Description
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Hydraulic legends and diagrams
C . Transmission hydraulics diagram 7A1
7A2 5Z2
6A7
5A1
M21
7V1
6A1
6A3
1000
750
6A6
6A5
5A2
7V2
5V4
5V6
6V1
6V4
6V5
6V6
6V3
7 5V3
5
6 M17
M18
M11
M10
M14
M13
M16
M15
4Z2 4S1 I
M9
P
(PH)
M22
4V5
V=0.3l p=10bar
M6
(P)
M8
4V4 p=18bar
4Z1
M7
4V6
4V3
4V1
4V2
Ø 0.3
5Z1 4Z3
1Z4
5Z5
5A3
3Z2
4
3A3 3Z1
M
(SM) p=25bar
M2
3V2
3V1
1V6
4A1
1S2 Ø 2%
p=3.5bar
Ø 2%
Ø 3%
Ø 3%
p=5bar
p=7bar
1V1 3A2
3A1 1V2
1Z3
p=6.5bar
M1
1V3
p=6.5bar
p=50bar
3
10µ 1Z2
1V5
1P2
T
p=10bar
M3 U
1S1
1V4 23.4 cc
(AS)
M4
(ES)
p=7bar
2V4
1
Ø 1%
2V5
2P1 2V1
M5
p=0-500bar
6A4
2V6 14 cc
2V3
1P1 223 cc
223 cc
2V2
Ø 1%
2A1
223 cc
2A2
p=0-500bar
1Z1 p=0.25bar
200µ
2
15µ
Fig. 1 MA-07-04147A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09C01.7
Hydraulic legends and diagrams
Page left blank intentionally
09C01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Hydraulic legends and diagrams
D . Auxiliary hydraulics diagram 11 X aux P 3/4 P aux T 3/4 T aux LS 3/8
2
1
B A
5
12 X SUS
P SUS
T SUS
22 B A
13
FS
135 bar
P SUS P AUX P OPT
T A1
22 bar
P
B A
P DIR A2
10
F2
14
X OPT
X AUX X SUS
4 230 bar Tx Px
T OPT T SUS T AUX
B A
T DIR AC
LS PV
Pp 5 bar
FR Pp
15
TC
9
Pp
PPp
Pp
T
B A
16
OSPFD 80/240
B A
T 160 bar
23
17
LS
P DIR
7 bar
18
7 3
6
60 cc
19 cc
19 8 125µ
125µ 15µ
21
1
1
90˚ 2 A 2
B
90˚ 3
A
3
B
180˚
MA-09-03579A
1
2 1 180˚
2
20
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Fig. 2
09C01.9
Hydraulic legends and diagrams
09C01.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Layout of components
09D01 - Layout of components
CONTENTS A . Main components of the hydraulic circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Layout of hydraulic circuit components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09D01.1
Layout of components
09D01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Layout of components
A . Main components of the hydraulic circuit Reference (Fig. 1)
Components
1
Variable displacement pump
2
Fixed displacement pump
3
Steering priority valve
4
Suction strainer
5
Clogging sensor
6
Temperature sensor
7
Tank return filter
8
Distribution block
On top of the rear axle
9
High pressure relief-valve
On the distribution block
10
Braking valve
On top of the rear axle
11
Trailer brake control proportional solenoid valve
12
Trailer brake control safety solenoid valve
13
Pressure switches
14
ParkLock
15
Accumulators
16
Pressure reverse valve control solenoid valve
In the ParkLock unit
17
Load sensing signal breaker solenoid valve
In the braking valve block
18
Rear brakes
In the rear axle
19
Front brake
In the transmission housing
20
Auxiliary hydraulic spool valves
21
Lift control valve
22
Brake master cylinder
At the front of the cab
23
Trailer brake pressure sensor
On the master cylinder
24
PTO, front axle, differential solenoid valves
On top of the rear axle
25
Transmission control components
26
High pressure filter
27
18 bar circuit hydraulic pump
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Layout
In the cast iron tank housing
In the sheet metal tank
In the braking valve block
On top of the rear axle
On top of the rear axle
On the right-hand side of the gearbox
09D01.3
Layout of components
Page left blank intentionally
09D01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Layout of components
B . Layout of hydraulic circuit components
22
23
18 24
25
27 26
4
1
2
5
3
6
7
16 19 17
15 8 14
MA-09-03580A
10
13
11
12
9
20 21
Fig. 1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09D01.5
Layout of components
09D01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Trailer braking and ParkLock
09E01 - Trailer braking and ParkLock
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Distribution block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 C . Diagram of the trailer brake and ParkLock assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 D . Braking valve and ParkLock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 E . Priority valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 F . Trailer brake operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 G . ParkLock operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 H . Removing and refitting the distribution block and spool valve support. . . . . . . . . 18 I . Removing and refitting the distribution block and braking block - ParkLock . . . . 20 J . Removing and refitting the ParkLock ram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 K . Tractor Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09E01.1
Trailer braking and ParkLock
09E01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Trailer braking and ParkLock
A . General MF 8400 series tractors are fitted with a trailer braking system and an electrohydraulic ParkLock (parking brake) controlled by the Autotronic 5. The two systems are assembled in a hydraulic unit (1 Fig. 1) located above the gearbox and are supplied by the variable displacement pump of the tractor auxiliary hydraulics circuit. The priority of these safety functions is ensured by the priority block (2 Fig. 1) which also ensures distribution of the hydraulic flow to the various hydraulic functions of the tractor (linkage, auxiliary spool valves).
Fig. 1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09E01.3
Trailer braking and ParkLock
B . Distribution block Identification of ports Parts list (Fig. 2 and Fig. 4) (Ppv)
Supply (high pressure hydraulic pump)
(Paux)
Auxiliary and lift spool valves supply
(Popt)
Supply (to optional unions)
(Psus)
Suspended front axle supply
(T)
Return to main tank
(Taux)
Auxiliary spool valves return
(Topt)
Optional unions return
(Tsus)
Front suspension linkage spool valves return (if fitted)
(Xaux)
Load Sensing line - auxiliary and linkage spool valves
(Xopt)
Load Sensing line - optional unions
(Xsus)
Load Sensing line - front suspension (if fitted)
(LSpv)
Main Load Sensing line to pump
(Tdir)
Steering circuit return (Orbitrol excess flow)
(AC)
To cooler
(TC)
Cooler return
(PpPPV) Pressure connector (high pressure hydraulic pump) (PpT)
Pressure connector (tank return)
(PpLS) Pressure connector (Load Sensing line) (PpAC) Pressure connector (cooler) (1)
Pressure relief valve (210 bar)
09E01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Trailer braking and ParkLock
Front*
Left-hand side*
Back*
Right-hand side*
* orientation as compared with the tractor direction travel
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Fig. 2
09E01.5
Trailer braking and ParkLock Functions of the distribution block The distribution block allows hydraulic flows to be directed to the different elements of the circuit depending on the priorities and the requirements of these elements.
T opt
210 bar
T sus T aux Tdir AC
5 bar
Pressure relief valve A safety valve (1 Fig. 2) is fitted to the distribution block and limits the auxiliary hydraulic circuit pressure to 210 bar maximum. A pressure connector (PpPPV Fig. 2) located on the block allows the safety valve setting to be checked.
TC
1
T
Cooling Excess flow from the steering circuit is directed to the distribution block via (Tdir), then to the cooler located at the front of the tractor. A 5 bar by-pass valve is fitted parallel to the cooling system to avoid overloading the cooler. A pressure connector (PpAC) fitted to the block allows the pressure of the cooling system to be checked.
PpAC
MA-09-03588A
Fig. 3
Tank return All circuit returns are centralised on the distribution block and return to the tank via a single hose (T Fig. 2). NOTE: In order to avoid increasing the cooling system pressure due to the high pressure circuit return, a non-return valve is located on the cooler return (1 Fig. 3).
09E01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Trailer braking and ParkLock
C . Diagram of the trailer brake and ParkLock assembly
135 bar
P SUS P AUX
A1 22 bar
P OPT
A2
F2 X OPT
X AUX X SUS
T OPT T SUS T AUX T DIR
210 bar Tx Px
5 bar
AC
FR
PpAC TC
PpT T PpLS PpPpv LSpv
MA-09-03632A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Ppv
Fig. 4
09E01.7
Trailer braking and ParkLock
D . Braking valve and ParkLock Identification of ports Parts list (Fig. 4 and Fig. 5) (A1) (A2) (F2) (Fr) (Px) (Tx)
Accumulator and ParkLock Accumulator To brake master cylinder Trailer braking coupler Transmission 18 bar hydraulic circuit Tank return
(1)
Trailer braking valve control proportional solenoid valve Trailer brake control safety solenoid valve LS line breaker solenoid valve (starting aid)
(2) (3)
NOTE: Tractors not fitted with trailer braking are fitted with the same block. Only the channels from the block to the coupler are plugged.
Characteristics of the accumulators (A1) and (A2) - Volume: 0.75 l - Gas used: nitrogen - Load pressure: • A1 Accumulator (ParkLock): 108 bar • A2 Accumulator (tractor braking): 44 bar
09E01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Trailer braking and ParkLock
Front*
Back*
* orientation as compared with the tractor direction travel
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Left-hand side*
Right-hand side*
Fig. 5
09E01.9
Trailer braking and ParkLock Parts list (Fig. 6)
E . Priority valve The trailer braking and ParkLock block comprises a priority valve (4 Fig. 6). This valve is a proportional valve that ensures minimum flow of 50 l/min to the priority elements (trailer brake, ParkLock).
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8)
Trailer braking valve Trailer brake control proportional solenoid valve Trailer brake control safety solenoid valve Priority valve Trailer brake coupler To ParkLock To tractor braking spool valve Transmission 18 bar circuit
135 bar
6
A1
22 bar
4 A2
2 7
F2
1 8
Tx Px
FR
5 MA-09-03582A
3 Fig. 6
09E01.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Trailer braking and ParkLock
F . Trailer brake operation General (Fig. 6) The trailer braking valve (1) is controlled by the Autotronic 5. The calculator receives pressure data from the tractor braking circuit, and controls the braking valve (1) via a proportional solenoid valve (2). The trailer braking valve (1) can also be controlled by a safety solenoid valve (3). A circuit selector allows the valve to be controlled by one of the two solenoid valves. The valve is controlled on the transmission 18 bar circuit, the pressure being supplied by a fixed displacement pump located on the gearbox. NOTE: The safety solenoid valve (3) supplies the trailer braking valve when it is not powered. It is switched on when the tractor is started. NOTE: When the emergency handbrake (lever 6 Fig. 11) is applied, the safety solenoid valve (3) returns to standby position and the trailer brake is supplied.
Neutral position When the tractor brakes are not activated, the control solenoid valve (2) is at neutral. The safety solenoid valve (3) is powered. The braking valve (1) is not controlled. The trailer braking coupler communicates with the tank.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09E01.11
Trailer braking and ParkLock Braking position (Fig. 7) When the brakes are activated, the Autotronic 5 controls the proportional valve (2) depending on the pressure measured by the sensor located at the braking spool valve on the tractor front axle braking circuit (TR34). When braking, the proportional solenoid valve (2) controls the trailer braking valve with pressure Px. The braking valve (1) connects line FR with the high pressure circuit. The control pressure and trailer brake pressure FR are proportional until trailer braking pressure reaches 150 bar.
Control circuit High pressure circuit
135 bar A1
22 bar
4
A2
2
F2
1 Tx Px
TR34 FR
5 MA-09-03583A
3 Fig. 7
09E01.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Trailer braking and ParkLock
G . ParkLock operation General The ParkLock is an electrohydraulic system used for the parking brake. It can also be used as an emergency handbrake in the relevant circumstances. It comprises a ram (1 Fig. 8) mechanically connected to the tractor brakes. The ParkLock ram comprises two springs which activate the brakes. These are released by the hydraulic pressure applied to the ram. The ram comprises two helical springs, a hydraulic piston and a cable mechanism linked to the brakes. When the pressure in the ram chamber is neutral, the springs activate the brakes; when the chamber is pressurised, the piston compresses the springs to release the brakes. The assembly is controlled by an Autotronic 5 type electronic calculator (see chapter 11). The ram is supplied by a circuit comprising an accumulator (3) maintained at 135 - 165 bar pressure by the make and break valve (4). For safety reasons, two pressure switches (5) are fitted on the make and break circuit to detect any circuit failure (Fig. 9).
DANGER: The ParkLock ram must under no circumstances be disassembled. The springs in the ParkLock ram are constantly compressed and can cause serious injury to the operator.
1
MA-09-03611A
Fig. 8
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09E01.13
Trailer braking and ParkLock Parts list (Fig. 9 to Fig. 12) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) (P) (T) (X)
ParkLock ram Accumulator (tractor braking circuit) Accumulator (ParkLock circuit) Make and break valve Pressure switches Emergency handbrake lever Solenoid valve Pressure reversing valve Priority valve LS line breaker solenoid valve ParkLock button Valve supply Tank return To ram
6
1
FS
T X P
7 8
5 4
9
10
3
135 bar A1
2
22 bar
A2
MA-09-03589A F2
Fig. 9
09E01.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Trailer braking and ParkLock Use Parking brake (A Fig. 13) The ParkLock is usually activated by the button located under the reverse shuttle lever to the left of the steering wheel (11 Fig. 10). When activated, the button controls the solenoid valve (7 Fig. 9) via the calculator. When the solenoid valve is supplied, it connects the ram chamber with the tank, and the ParkLock is engaged. When the operator activates the button (11) to disengage the ParkLock, the solenoid valve is no longer supplied. The ram receives the pressure, the springs are compressed and the brakes are released.
Emergency handbrake (B Fig. 13)
Fig. 10
In case of emergency, the ParkLock can be activated by the lever (6) located to the left of the driver's seat in the cab. The lever acts mechanically on a proportional spool valve (8) which connects the ram chamber with the tank return and activates the brakes. When using the emergency handbrake, the trailer brake is also supplied by the safety solenoid valve (3 Fig. 7). To use the emergency handbrake, see the Operator Instruction Book.
Fig. 11
8
T
6
T
P X
P X
7 MA-09-03633A
Fig. 12
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09E01.15
Trailer braking and ParkLock
button ON (A Fig. 13) button OFF (ParkLock engaged) (ParkLock disengaged)
lever ON (B Fig. 13) (ParkLock engaged)
lever OFF (ParkLock disengaged)
Solenoid valve (7)
0V
12 V
12 V
12 V
Trailer braking safety solenoid valve (3 Fig. 6)
12 V
12 V
0V
12 V
11 6
A
B
6
FS
1
1
FS
T
T X
X
P
P
P
P
7 MA-09-03590A
8
Fig. 13
09E01.16
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Trailer braking and ParkLock Make and break valve The make and break circuit is located in the braking block. It is supplied by a priority valve in the braking circuit (9 Fig. 14). The make and break valve maintains the pressure in the two accumulators between 135 and 165 bar. One accumulator is used for the ParkLock; the other for the tractor braking circuit.
4
9
135 bar
Parklock
22 bar
Valve opening (Fig. 14) When the accumulator pressure drops below 135 bar, the valve opens to load the circuit. The spool connects the ParkLock Load Sensing line with the pump flow so that the pump can increase the flow rate as required to load the accumulators. MA-09-03591A
Fig. 14
Valve closing (Fig. 15) When the pressure reaches 165 bar, the pressure shifts the spool. In this position, the ParkLock Load Sensing line connects with the tank to release pressure in the Load Sensing line and reduce the pump flow rate. A non-return valve (A) maintains the pressure in the ParkLock circuit.
Starting aid solenoid valve (10)
4
A
9
135 bar
Parklock
22 bar
A solenoid valve (10 Fig. 16) is fitted to the ParkLock Load Sensing line. When the tractor is started, the solenoid valve closes the ParkLock LS line so that the pump is not is operating at full flow rate, thus helping the engine to start. This solenoid valve is controlled by acting on the starter. MA-09-03592A
Fig. 15
10
135 bar
Parklock
22 bar
MA-09-03593A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Fig. 16
09E01.17
Trailer braking and ParkLock
H . Removing and refitting the distribution block and spool valve support Preliminary operations
DANGER: Before carrying out any work on the distribution block, its pressure must be bled as follows: - Stop the engine. - Release the rear brake bleed screws. - Press down the brake pedals half way without releasing, until the effort on the pedals reduces slightly. - Tighten the bleed screws again.
Fig. 17
1. Chock the wheels of the tractor. Fit stands under the rear axle. Take off the rear wheels of the tractor. 2. Sling the cab.
3. 4. 5. 6. 7.
8. 9.
10.
CAUTION: Ensure the tractor doors and rear window are closed when hitching the slings. Take off the front and rear cab supports. Mark and disconnect the electrical harnesses and hydraulic hoses. Using a hoist, remove the cab. Disconnect and remove the supply pipes of the Dromone hitch and front linkage if fitted (Fig. 17). Remove the trailer electrical socket and the Dual Control connector (if fitted). Pass the harnesses through the slots (1) in the support (Fig. 18). Take off the 3rd point linkage support. Mark and disconnect the harnesses: - of the lift control valve, - of the spool valves, - of the solenoid valves. Mark and disconnect the hoses: - of the lift rams - of the spool valve leak recovery tanks.
09E01.18
¤ H
Fig. 18
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Trailer braking and ParkLock 11. Mark and disconnect the following hoses on the distribution block: - high flow rate pump supply, - tank return, - cooler supply and return, - 18 bar circuit supply and return (trailer brake control), - to the ParkLock and braking accumulators, - to the tractor braking valve, - from the steering pump (excess flow).
Removing the support 12. Take out the two Allen screws (1 Fig. 19) located at the rear of the spool valve couplers. 13. Remove the two locknuts (2 Fig. 20). 14. Sling the support assembly with the distribution block and auxiliary spool valves. 15. Take out the two lower attachment screws from the support. 16. Using a hoist, raise the assembly and remove it.
Fig. 19
Refitting the support 17. Using a hoist or a suitable lifting tool, fit the support, distribution block and spool valve assembly on the transmission and fit the two lower attachments screws on the support. 18. Lower the hoist and refit the assembly on its support. Fit the two locknuts (2 Fig. 20). 19. Refit the two Allen screws (1 Fig. 19).
Final operations 20. 21. 22. 23. 24.
Fig. 20
Carry out the operations 11 to 1 in reverse order. Refit the tractor wheels and take out the stands. Start the engine. Bleed the tractor and trailer brakes (see chapter 9). Check the operation of the hydraulic circuit.
Fig. 21
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09E01.19
Trailer braking and ParkLock
I . Removing and refitting the distribution block and braking block ParkLock Removal 25. Remove the distribution block and spool valve support (see § H). 26. Take off the hoses connected to the small chambers of the linkage rams (Fig. 22). 27. Disconnect the supply, return and Load Sensing pipes from the optional unions (2 Fig. 18). 28. Remove the supply pipe from the trailer brake (3 Fig. 18). 29. Disconnect the supply, return and Load Sensing pipes (P, T and LS respectively Fig. 23) from the spool valves. 30. Remove the lift control valve return pipe (Fig. 24). 31. Remove the attachment screws from the distribution block.
MA-09-03651A
Fig. 22
Refitting 32. Refit the distribution block on the support plate. Fit the attachment screws. 33. Carry out the operations 26 to 31 in reverse order. 34. Refit the distribution block and spool valve support (see § H).
Fig. 23
Fig. 24
09E01.20
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Trailer braking and ParkLock
J . Removing and refitting the ParkLock ram
DANGER: The ParkLock ram must under no circumstances be disassembled. The springs in the ParkLock ram are constantly compressed and can cause serious injury to the operator.
DANGER: Care must be taken when removing the ParkLock ram. Ensure that noone activates the ParkLock during the ram removal or refitting operations.
Fig. 25
Preliminary operations 35. Park the tractor on a flat surface. Chock the rear wheels of the tractor.
DANGER: As the tractor has no parking brake during this operation, the tractor wheels must be chocked correctly to keep the tractor completely stationary. 36. With the engine running, disengage the ParkLock. 37. Disconnect the position sensor harness (11) (Fig. 25). 38. Take out the two attachment screws and remove the support plate of the position sensor (11) (Fig. 26). 39. Remove the cotter pin and take out the pin (8) (Fig. 27).
Fig. 26
Fig. 27
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09E01.21
Trailer braking and ParkLock 40. Engage the ParkLock to release the pressure in the ram (6). Ensure that it disengages correctly from the lever (1).
DANGER: Keep your hands clear from the ram. 41. Stop the engine. 42. Release the pressure in the high pressure circuit (see following procedure).
Depressurizing the high pressure circuit
DANGER: Before carrying out any work on the ParkLock, its circuit pressure must be bled as follows: - Stop the engine. - Release the rear brake bleed screws. - Press down the brake pedals half way without releasing, until the effort on the pedals reduces slightly. - Tighten the bleed screws again.
Fig. 28
CAUTION: Do not restart the engine while the ram hose is disconnected.
Removing the ram 43. Disconnect the supply hose from the ParkLock ram. 44. Remove the attachment screws from the ram (10). 45. Remove the ram (6).
09E01.22
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Trailer braking and ParkLock Refitting the ram and adjusting the ParkLock ram rod linkage (Fig. 29)
51. Fit the locknut (5) on the threaded rod of the ram. Fit the clevis (4) and adjust it to insert the pin (8) in the clevis (4) and lever (1), while maintaining distance X. 52. Fit a new cotter pin in the pin (8). Tighten the locknut (5). 53. Refit the support plate of the position sensor (11). 54. Bleed the braking circuit. Check the correct operation of the ParkLock, braking and the tractor high pressure circuit.
46. Before refitting the ram, check that distance X between the lever (1) and the housing of the linkage pin (2) is between 4 and 5 mm. If not, adjust the length of the right- and left-hand swivel arms (3) to obtain this value. 47. Remove the clevis (4) and the locknut (5) from the ram rod. 48. Assemble the ram (6) on its support (7). 49. Connect the ram supply hose. 50. Start the engine. Move the ParkLock switch (11 Fig. 10) located under the reverse shuttle lever to "ParkLock engaged" position, then to "ParkLock disengaged" position.
DANGER: Keep your hands clear from the ram.
8 9 1
4 5 2
X 6
5
4
11
12 13
7
MA-09-03634A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
10
3
1
Fig. 29
09E01.23
Trailer braking and ParkLock
K . Tractor Towing During certain tractor breakdowns (engine unable to start, hydraulic system failure, etc.) the ParkLock stays on and automatically brakes the tractor rear wheels. To tow the tractor, the brakes must be released as follows: - Chock the wheels of the tractor. NOTE:The tractor transmission must be in neutral. - Loosen the locknut (13) (Fig. 29). - Take out the screw (12) and remove the protective spacer (14). - Refit the screw. Tighten the screw until it is in contact with the lever (1). - Retighten the screw by 6 turns. MA-09-03920A-MF
Fig. 30
12
12
14
14
MA-09-03921A
Fig. 31
1
0mm
12
x5
12
14
MA-09-03922A
Fig. 32
09E01.24
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary spool valves
09F01 - Auxiliary spool valves
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Layout of components and identification of ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 C . Spool valve operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 D . Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 E . Removing and refitting hydraulic couplers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 F . Removing and refitting the auxiliary spool valves . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09F01.1
Auxiliary spool valves
09F01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary spool valves
A . General MF 8400 series tractors may be fitted with a maximum of four to six spool valves. The spool valves are all electrohydraulic.
Description of the components The SB23LS - EHS BOSCH spool valves that control the supply to the hydraulic couplers comprise two parts:
The spool valves are located above the rear axle. They are stacked on top of one another, with the lift control spool valve under the auxiliary spool valves. The assembly includes internal channels to distribute the flow to the different stages. Under the assembly, a closing plate is fitted with a pressure relief valve to control the spool valves and acts as a plug to the various channels. Above the assembly, an additional stage receives connections to the distribution block.
Hydraulic part See operation below. Electrohydraulic part comprising: - an ON / OFF solenoid valve and a 3-way pressure relief valve located on the end plate of the distribution block - a pilot valve fitted in the electrohydraulic unit. This section only deals with the hydraulic part. For the electronic part, see Chapter 11. The electrohydraulically controlled SB23LS EHS spool valves operate in a Closed Centre circuit. They are supplied with high pressure, high flow rate oil from the priority block. If no priority function is activated, all flow is directed to the spool valves. When certain priority functions are activated, the excess flow then remains available for the auxiliary spool valves. The adjustment of the flow rate, expressed as a percentage, may be displayed on the onboard computer (Datatronic) by the operator (see chapter 11 - Electronics). The electrohydraulic spool valves have a floating position, time delay and zero leak valve on port B. The main spool of the spool valve directs oil towards the outlet ports A or B. The spool valves consist of both electronic and hydraulic components, the latter containing spools and valves. Some elements cannot be repaired as spare parts.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09F01.3
Auxiliary spool valves Parts list (Fig. 2) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7)
Auxiliary and lift control spool valves assembly Upper oil manifold Optional auxiliary spool valve 6 Optional auxiliary spool valve 5 Auxiliary spool valves 1 to 4 Lift control spool valve Lower closing plate with pressure relief valve
2
Spool valve control 1
The spool valves are controlled either by the Joystick (1 Fig. 1) (2 spool valves) or by the levers (2 Fig. 1) located on the right-hand console in the cab 4 spool valves). MA-09-03616A
Fig. 1
The electrohydraulic spool valve parameters can be set via the Datatronic 3 (if installed) or the DOT MATRIX (Joystick only). See the “Electronics” chapter for further information.
09F01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary spool valves
2
3 241
4
5 1
5
5
5
6
7
MA-09-03601A
Fig. 2 Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09F01.5
Auxiliary spool valves Configuration of spool valves depending on the tractor hydraulic equipment
Equipment
Spool valve colour code Red
Green
Black
Yellow
Dromone hook FRONT LINKAGE FRONT LINKAGE Front / rear Dual Control FRONT LINKAGE Front push-pull FRONT LINKAGE Front push-pull Front / rear Dual Control FRONT LINKAGE Dromone hook Dromone hook Rear Dual Control FRONT LINKAGE Dromone hook Front push-pull FRONT LINKAGE Dromone hook Front push-pull Front / rear Dual Control NOTE: The spool valve arrangement is the same regardless of the number of spool valves fitted.
09F01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary spool valves Correspondence between spool valves and couplers (Fig. 3)
6 5 4 3 2 1
MA-09-03595A
5
6
3
4
1
2
MA-03596A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Fig. 3
09F01.7
Auxiliary spool valves
B . Layout of components and identification of ports
P
Ports on spool valve (Fig. 4) and oil manifold (Fig. 5) P High pressure inlet from variable displacement pump via the distribution block T Return to tank via the distribution block LS Signal to pump Load Sensing pump regulator via the distribution block Ports on spool valve (Fig. 4) A Spool valve A outlet to corresponding hydraulic coupler B Spool valve B outlet to corresponding hydraulic coupler
A
LS
T
B
Fig. 4
MA-09-03603A
P LS T
MA-09-03604A
Fig. 5
09F01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary spool valves
C . Spool valve operation P
The electrohydraulically controlled spool valves use pressurised oil (21 - 24 bar) to move the spool. A pressure relief valve (10 Fig. 6) located in the spool valve assembly creates this control pressure.
10 8
Parts list (Fig. 6 and Fig. 7) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (P) (R)
Main valve spool Electrohydraulic unit Return spring Piston Pilot valve Digital electronic system Displacement sensor Solenoid valve 3-way pressure relief valve Pressure relief valve block Pressure Return
T LS P R Rx
X3
FP
Operation of the pressure relief valve (7 Fig. 6) When the ON - OFF solenoid valve (8) located on end plate (7) is open, the flow from the pump is directed to the 3-way pressure relief valve (9) (Fig. 6). The latter supplies the pilot valve (5) (Fig. 7) with a pressure of 21 to 24 bar via a pressure balancing valve. The channels R (supply) and Rx (return) direct oil under 21 - 24 bar pressure to the pilot valves, which control the position of the spool via the piston (4) (Fig. 7). The pilot valve receives a signal from the digital device (6) and moves the main spool (1) according to the information received from the Joystick or lever. The digital device is informed of the position of the main spool by a displacement sensor (7) (Fig. 7). The pilot valve and the digital device are housed in the unit (2) (Fig. 7) fixed on the end of the spool valve.
9
MA-09-03602A
X3 FP X3 R Rx P T LS
: Filter : Location of diagnostics connector : Pilot valve supply : Pilot valve return : Pressure : Tank return : Load Sensing line Fig. 6
NOTE: Channels P and R are connected to the auxiliary spool valve.
Fig. 7
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09F01.9
Auxiliary spool valves Operation of the auxiliary spool valve (Fig. 8 and Fig. 9) When spool (1) is moved electrohydraulically upwards by the pilot valve (5) (Fig. 7), high pressure oil penetrates via channel P, passes through restrictor C and grooves D. It is then directed to channel E, where it pushes ball (2) and enters chamber F. Simultaneously, the ramp on the spool raises valve (3) and oil flows via port B. Port A is supplied by moving spool (1) downwards.
D
E P
R C A LS F
B
MA-09-03605A
Fig. 8
09F01.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary spool valves
1
A 5
3 B
2 MA-09-03606A
Fig. 9 Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09F01.11
Auxiliary spool valves
D . Diagram Parts list (Fig. 10) (2) (5) (6) (7)
Upper oil manifold Auxiliary spool valves Lift control spool valve Lower closing plate with pressure relief valve
09F01.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary spool valves
2
X aux P aux
P
LS
T
T aux
Rx R
B A
B A
5
A
6
Rx R
7 MA-09-03607A
Fig. 10 Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09F01.13
Auxiliary spool valves
E . Removing and refitting hydraulic couplers Preliminary operations 1. Disconnect the channels from the optional unions (2) marked P, T, LS and D (Fig. 11). Repeat the operation for the trailer brake (3). 2. Remove the support plate from the trailer electrical socket.
Removing the hydraulic couplers 3. Mark the channels between the distribution block and the hydraulic couplers. 4. Disconnect and remove the channels between the distribution block and the hydraulic couplers. 5. Disconnect and remove the leak recovery tank channels.
Fig. 11
If the couplers must be separated, carry out operation 6.
8 6. Unscrew the cap nuts (8). Remove the upper plate (6) and coupler stages (4) (Fig. 12). NOTE: The O’rings (5) inserted between each stage are used for the leak recovery circuit. 7. Remove the screws (9). Take off: - the leak recovery tank supports (10) with the threaded rods (7) if the couplers have been previously removed. - the complete coupler blocks (4) fitted on the plate (10).
7
6
4
5
9
10 11
MA-09-03609A
Fig. 12
09F01.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary spool valves Refitting the hydraulic couplers 8. Carry out operations 5 to 7 in reverse order. 9. Refit the pipes between the couplers and distribution block as marked at operation 3.
F . Removing and refitting the auxiliary spool valves Removing the auxiliary spool valves 10. Take off the support plate from the distribution block / spool valve assembly (see Trailer braking and ParkLock section in Chapter 9). 11. Take off the coupler assemblies (see § E). 12. Remove the hydraulic supply pipes, Load Sensing pipes and return pipes on the upper plate of the spool valve block (Fig. 13). 13. Disconnect the supply hoses from the lift rams. Remove the lift control spool valve return pipe (Fig. 13). 14. Unscrew and remove the three spool valve block attachment nuts and their washers. 15. Mark the order the different spool valve stages, lift control valve and closing plates are arranged. 16. Separate the distribution block components. Discard the O’rings inserted between the elements.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
MA-09-03612A
Fig. 13
09F01.15
Auxiliary spool valves Refitting the distribution block 17. Clean and check the condition of each spool valve and ensure no ports are blocked. 18. Lightly smear the end of the rod threads (Fig. 14) with Loctite 241 or equivalent. Screw the threaded rods into the upper closing plate (manifold). 19. Clean the mating faces between each distribution block element. 20. Check the presence of new O’rings (J Fig. 15) between each element. 21. On a workbench, assemble the distribution block elements vertically to ensure the correct positioning of the seals. Stack the elements in the order noted at operation 15. 22. Fit the distribution block on the support. Fit and tighten the three attachment nuts with their washers. 23. Reconnect the supply hoses to the lift rams. Refit the spool valve return pipe. 24. Refit the supply pipes, Load Sensing pipes and return pipes on the upper plate of the spool valve block (Fig. 13). 25. Refit the coupler assembly (see § E). 26. Refit the support plate on the distribution block / spool valve assembly (see Trailer braking and ParLock section in Chapter 9).
241
MA-09-03657A
Fig. 14
J
MA-09-03652A
Fig. 15
09F01.16
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Lift control valve
09G01 - Lift control valve
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Layout of components and identification of ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 C . Removing - Refitting the distribution block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 D . Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 E . Neutral position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 F . Lifting position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 G . Lowering position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 H . Assembly procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09G01.1
Lift control valve
09G01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Lift control valve
A . General The function of the lift control valve is to regulate the oil flow to and from the lift rams according to the signals transmitted by the ELC calculator. This spool valve contains an LS port for the Load Sensing system. This control port allows the spool valve to send pressure information to the priority block. This spool valve is made up of elements themselves comprising spools and valves. Some of the elements cannot be repaired as spare parts.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09G01.3
Lift control valve
B . Layout of components and identification of ports Layout of components The Bosch lift control valve is made up by two parts: The hydraulic part (spool valve) (Fig. 1) (1) (2) (4) (5) (6) (9) (10) (11)
Non-return valve, maintaining the oil in the rams Spool valve assembly used in the lowering phase Control spool valve Flow regulating spool valve Shock valve Flow regulating spool spring Control spool spring Spool valve assembly spring
The electrical part (solenoid valves) (Fig. 1) (7) (8)
Lowering solenoid valve Lifting solenoid valve
NOTE: To determine whether a fault is hydraulic or electrical, press the push-buttons at the ends of the solenoid valves; this eliminates the electronic effect of the lift function.
Fig. 1
09G01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Lift control valve Identification of ports Because the lift control valve and auxiliary spool valves are stacked together, they share supply, return and LS signal pipes. (12) High pressure supply from the pump via the priority block (13) Load Sensing signal to priority block (15) Auxiliary spool valve tank return (16) HP ram supply (17) Lift control valve tank return
C . Removing - Refitting the distribution block To carry out the removal - refitting of the distribution block (lift control valve and auxiliary spool valves), see the “Auxiliary spool valves” section.
NOTE: The lift rams used are double acting. The small chambers (ram rod side) are connected respectively to the tank return and cooling system.
12
13
15
16 MA-09-03597A
17
Fig. 2
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09G01.5
Lift control valve
D . Diagram T
X
P
1 B A
2
B A
3
4
5 MA-09-03594A
1 2 3 4 5 P T X Tr
Upper closing plate First hydraulic spool valve Last hydraulic spool valve Lift control spool valve Lower closing plate Pump Return to auxiliary spool valve tank Load Sensing circuit Return to lift control valve tank
09G01.6
¤ H
Tr
Fig. 3
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Lift control valve
E . Neutral position When the engine is not running and the spool valve is in the neutral position, the control spool (4) and the spool valve assembly (2) are maintained respectively by the springs (10) and (11). The flow rate control valve (5) is pushed to the left by the spring (9). With the engine running and the spool valve on standby, no pressure data is transmitted to the priority block. The LS line communicates with the return.
Fig. 4
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09G01.7
Lift control valve
F . Lifting position When the Lift solenoid valve (8) is activated, the control spool (4) is moved to the right. The LS pressure data is transmitted to the upper face of the flow regulating spool valve (5) (on the spring (9) side) and moves the spool downwards or towards the left thus directing the oil flow to the control spool and the non-return valve (1).
The movement of the flow regulating spool valve is dampened by the volume of oil present in chamber d. As soon as the pressure on the valve (1) is greater than that in the rams, the lifting arms rise. The LS line is connected with the output line (16) to the lift rams, thus informing the priority block. If the pressure in the rams is too high (shocks received by the lifting arm), the valve (6) opens and the excess pressure is directed to the return.
Fig. 5
09G01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Lift control valve
G . Lowering position When the solenoid valve (7) is activated to lower the lift arms, the spool valve assembly (2) allows the oil coming from the rams to flow into the return. The LS pressure data is transmitted to the face of the flow regulating spool valve (5) (spring (9) side) and on the priority block.
H . Assembly procedure To assemble the distribution block (lift control valve and auxiliary spool valves), see “Auxiliary spool valves” section.
Fig. 6
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09G01.9
Lift control valve
09G01.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering
09H01 - Load Sensing hydrostatic steering
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . The Load Sensing principle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 C . Orbitrol operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 D . Disassembling and reassembling the Orbitrol steering unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 E . Removing - refitting and disassembling - reassembling the steering ram . . . . . . . 15 F . Steering column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 G . Removing and refitting the steering column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 H . Removing and refitting the control lever assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 I . Removing and refitting the column tilt mechanism . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 J . Removing and refitting the column locking up mechanism. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 K . Disassembling the lower bush . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09H01.1
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering
09H01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering
A . General The steering system used on tractors fitted with a DYNA VT transmission and closed centre hydraulics is dynamic, and there is no mechanical link between the steering wheel and the steering ram. Its control principle is of the "Load Sensing" type. The system comprises the following main components: - a pressurised oil supply, from a fixed displacement pump via a priority valve, - an Orbitrol steering unit: OSPDF 80/240 LS Dynamic 4WD with closed centre, by-pass mounted on tractors fitted with a 4WD Dana AG210 or AG280 front axle. - a double acting steering ram fitted to the 4WD front axle. The Orbitrol is supplied by a fixed flow rate pump via a priority block. The priority block is controlled by the steering unit Load Sensing line, and directs priority oil flow to the steering circuit; excess flow is redirected to the distribution block then to the cooling circuit. When steering remains in neutral, all pump flow is directed to the cooling system. When the steering wheel is turned, the necessary flow of oil is directed to the corresponding side of the steering ram. The other side of the ram is connected to the tank return ports. In case of engine breakdown or fixed displacement pump failure, the Orbitrol acts as a hand-operated pump so that the steering can be controlled. This obviously requires a much greater effort to be applied to the steering wheel.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09H01.3
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering Description of the Orbitrol steering unit The Orbitrol comprises a selector spool valve, a spring centred supply sleeve and a drive shaft linked to the steering column. It has five hydraulic ports: - pressure - return to the selector cover - two supplies to the steering ram - Load Sensing The circuit is protected by a safety valve and two shock valves as well as two suction valves. The Orbitrol OSPDF 80/240 comprises twin stator rotors (5)(8) of different capacities. Specifications: - Shock valves (1)(2) setting: 225 -245 bar - Supply valve (3) setting: 155 -160 bar - Steering unit (5) capacity: 240 cm3 / turn - Steering unit (8) capacity: 80 cm3 / turn - Supply valve (6) setting: 10 bar - Return to neutral springs torque (4): 1.5 daNm
1
8
7
3
160 bar
T LS
P DIR
MA-09-03577A
09H01.4
¤ H
2
4
6
5
Fig. 1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering
B . The Load Sensing principle Orbitrol steering unit The Load Sensing port is either connected with the tank when the steering is in neutral position, or connected with the pressure supply line as soon as the steering wheel is turned. The Load Sensing line communicates with the pump priority valve. The standby pressure to the Orbitrol supply (on standby) is 12.5 bar.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09H01.5
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering Steering unit parts list (Fig. 2, Fig. 3) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) (12) (13) (14) (15) (16) (17) (18) (19) (20) (21) (22) (23) (24) (25) (26)
Lip seal Centring springs Bush O’ring Cotter pin Sleeve Spool valve O’ring Link shaft O’ring Plate O’ring Plate O’ring Spacer O’ring O’ring Integrated spool Spool body Seals O’ring Washer Needle bearing Washer Relief valve Block
(27) Rotor (gear type 80 cm3) (28) Stator (gear type 80 cm3) (29) O’ring (30) Stator (gear type 240 cm3) (31) (32) (33) (34) (35) (36) (37) (38) (39) (40) (41) (42)
Rotor (gear type 240 cm3) Plate Spring O’ring Closing plate Screw Shock valves Non-return valve Spacers Non-return valve Suction valve Cotter pin
09H01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering
Overall view
1
21
2
22
3
23
4
24
5 6
25
7 8 9
26
10
27
11
28
12
29
13
30
14
31
15
32
16
33
17
34
18
35
19
36
20
MA-09-03641A
Fig. 2 Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09H01.7
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering
Exploded view 37 37 1 41 39 4 22 23 24 3
25
5 26 6
40 38 15
8 12
7 28
9
29
2
10 11 27
14
13 31 30 33 16 32 17 19 18 42 34 MA-09-03642A
35 20 36
Fig. 3
09H01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering
C . Orbitrol operation Neutral position (engine running) (Fig. 4) In this position the spool valve (7) is centred in relation to the sleeve (6) by the springs (2). The channels P1 L - R are not supplied. The flow from the fixed displacement pump is directed to the cooling system by priority valve B. Two shock valves and two suction valves are located in ports L and R of the steering unit. The shock valves protect the circuit between the two steering ram chambers and the steering unit from shocks to the front wheels. The suction valves allow the oil released by the shock valves to flow from the right-hand channel to the left-hand channel, or vice versa.
L
R
T
P1
P
LS B
MA-09-03613A
P B LS P1
High flow rate supply from the fixed flow rate pump Steering priority valve Pilot flow Supply to the metering devices
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
T L R
Tank return Steering ram left-hand supply Steering ram right-hand supply Fig. 4
09H01.9
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering Steering on lock position (engine running) (Fig. 5) Any action on the steering wheel (left or right) produces an angular offset of the spool valve (7) and opens the Orbitrol closed circuit. A control pressure allows the necessary flow to be supplied, via the priority valve B, to the Orbitrol and metering devices (27)(31) and (28)(30). The rotors (27)(31) are driven in rotation and discharge a quantity of oil proportional to the degree of rotation towards the rams. The rotation of rotors (27)(31) is equal to that of the steering wheel. Depending on the direction of rotation, the flow of oil from the rotors is sent to one side or the other of the ram.
A one-way valve is screwed into the steering unit supply port. This valve prevents excessive pressure exerted to the front wheels from being transmitted to the pump when the steering lock is applied. If the pressure in the steering circuit becomes too high, the relief valve (25) located inside the steering unit is activated and the excess pressure is directed towards channel T.
L
R
T
P1
P
LS B
MA-09-03614A
P B LS P1
High flow rate supply from the fixed flow rate pump Steering priority valve Pilot flow Supply to the metering devices
09H01.10
¤ H
T L R
Tank return Steering ram left-hand supply Steering ram right-hand supply Fig. 5
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering Manual steering (engine stopped) (Fig. 4) When the pump is no longer providing pressure or when the pressure is too low, the rotors (27)(31) are no longer hydraulically driven. Steering is no longer power assisted. In this case, action on the steering wheel compresses the centring springs (2). The angular clearance between the pin (5) and sleeve (6) is cancelled and the metering devices (rotor and stator) and mechanically driven. The oil returning from the rams passes through the non-return valve (38) and supplies the metering device. The pressure generated is proportional to the torque applied to the steering wheel. A great effort is therefore required to turn the wheel in order to steer the tractor.
L
R
T
P1
P
LS B
MA-09-03614A
P B LS P1
High flow rate supply from the fixed flow rate pump Steering priority valve Pilot flow Supply to the metering devices
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
T L R
Tank return Steering ram left-hand supply Steering ram right-hand supply Fig. 6
09H01.11
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering
D . Disassembling and reassembling the Orbitrol steering unit Disassembly 1. Remove the steering unit from the tractor. 2. Place the steering unit in a vice fitted with plastic jaws. 3. Mark the location of screws (36). Remove the screws (36) and seals (20). 4. Take off the closing plate (35), the O'ring (34), the body (19), the integrated spool (18) and spring (33). 5. Remove the O'ring (17). Locate the position of plate (32) and remove it. 6. Remove the O'ring (16). Remove stator (30) and rotor (31). Remove the O'ring (14). 7. Mark and remove plate (13). 8. Remove spacer (15), stator (28), rotor (27). Mark and remove plate (11). Remove the O'ring (10). 9. Take out the splined link shaft (9). 10. Unscrew the threaded bush and recover the ball from the non-return valve (38). 11. Take out the two axle pins and the balls from the suction valves (41) of the steering unit. 12. Extract the sleeve (6) and spool valve (7) assembly by pushing it out while checking that the pin (5) lies along the horizontal axis. 13. Take out washers (22)(24), the needle bearing (23) and bush (3) from the sleeve / spool valve assembly. Remove the pin (5), and the centring springs (2) by pressing on one of their ends. Remove the sleeve (6) from the spool valve (7). 14. Unscrew the plug from the relief valve (25). Using an 8 mm Allen wrench, disassemble the threaded bush and remove the seal, the spring and the valve (the crimped seat cannot be removed). 15. Unscrew the two plugs from the shock valves (37) and remove the seals. Using a 6 mm Allen wrench, disassemble the threaded bushes and take out the springs and balls (the crimped seats cannot be removed). 16. Extract the sealing ring (1) and O'ring (21). 17. Disassemble the non-return valve (40).
09H01.12
¤ H
MA-09-03619A
2 Fig. 7
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering Reassembly 18. Check and clean the components. Replace any defective parts. Lubricate the components with clean transmission oil. 19. Reassemble the non-return valve (40). 20. Fit seal (1), O'ring (21) and the bush. 21. Place the valve balls and springs in the recesses of the shock valves (37). Screw in the threaded bushes, fit the seals and tighten the plugs. 22. Fit the valve and spring in the recesses of the relief valve (25), and screw in the threaded bush. Fit the seal and tighten the plug to a torque of 40 - 60 Nm. 23. Insert the spool valve (6) into the sleeve (7). Position the centring springs (2) according to Fig. 7 and insert the pin (5). 24. Position the bush (3) on the sleeve and spool valve assembly so that the chamfer facilitates assembly in the steering unit. 25. Fit washers (22)(24), with the chamfer of washer (24) turned towards the centring springs (2) and inserting needle bearing (23) between them. 26. Fit the sleeve and spool valve assembly in the steering unit by oscillating it slightly. Check that the pin (5) is held horizontally. 27. Fit the two valve balls and the two pins in the recesses of the suction valves (41). 28. Fit the valve ball in the recess of the non-return valve (38) and screw in the threaded bush. 29. Position the splined link shaft (9). 30. Fit the O'ring (10) and the plate (11). 31. Fit the rotor (27) so that the two concave depressions “C” lie along the axis of the slot in the splined link shaft (9) (Fig. 8). 32. Fit the O'rings (12)(29) on the stator (28). 33. Fit the stator (28) by turning it slightly without moving the rotor (27) so that it fixing holes align with those of the steering unit. Position the spacer (15) and plate (13). NOTE: The rotor (27) and the pin (5) must be in the position shown in Fig. 9. 34. Refit rotor (31) on the spacer (15) so that the two depressions “C” lie in the axis of the slot of splined shaft (9) (Fig. 8).
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
9
27 31
C MA-09-03620A
Fig. 8
27 31
5 MA-09-03618A
Fig. 9
09H01.13
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering 35. Place the O'rings (14)(16) on the stator (30). Fit and move it with an angular movement so that the fixing holes align with those provided in the steering unit. NOTE: The rotor (31) and the pin (5) must be in the position indicated (Fig. 9). 36. Refit plate (32) in the position marked at disassembly. 37. Check that the bore of body (19) and the rim of spool (18) are not scratched. 38. Check that the spool moves normally in the body. 39. Slide the spool fitted with its oil tightness components into the body. Fit O'rings (17)(34) and spring (33). 40. Refit the cover plate (35). 41. Refit the new seals (20) and screws (36) as marked at disassembly. 42. Tighten opposing screws to a torque of 35 Nm. 43. Using a test bench or a suitable fixture, check the steering unit operation. Refit the steering unit on the tractor. 44. Check the oil tightness of the hydraulic unions.
09H01.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering
E . Removing - refitting and disassembling - reassembling the steering ram Removal 45. Disconnect and block off the hose feed pipes to the ram, carefully identifying their positions. 46. Drive out the steering ball joints (1 Fig. 10) using a suitable extractor. 47. Take out the screws (2) from the ram and remove it.
Refitting 48. Refit the ram. Fit and tighten screws (2) to 180 - 200 Nm after lightly smearing the thread with Loctite 270 or equivalent. 49. Fix the steering ball joints. Tighten the nuts (4) to 115 - 130 Nm and lock them with new pins. 50. Reconnect the hose feed pipes in the positions identified during disassembly. 51. Fit the wheel(s) and tighten the nuts to a torque of 400 - 450 Nm.
4
3 5
2 MA-09-03617A
1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Fig. 10
09H01.15
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering Disassembly 52. Release and remove the ball joints (5) (Fig. 10). 53. Take off the lock rings (5) using a suitable locally made tool, while simultaneously turning the guide rings (3) (Fig. 11). 54. Take out the piston rod (6) from cylinder (4). 55. Discard all the seals (sealing ring, O'rings, dust guards and lock rings).
Reassembly 56. Clean the components. Replace any defective parts. Remark - Check the condition of the internal bore of the cylinder and the operational parts of the piston rod. Systematically discard all scratched components that may affect the oil tightness of the steering mechanism. 57. Lubricate the O'rings, bushes and internal bore with clean transmission oil. 58. Fit the relevant seals on the piston rod (6) and the guide bushes (3). 59. Slide the piston rod fitted with its seals in the cylinder bore. 60. Fit the guide bushes at each end of the cylinder, taking care not to damage the lip of the sealing rings. 61. Position the machined groove of each guide bush opposite the cylinder groove. Turn the guide bushes while simultaneously slipping in the lock rings. 62. Tighten and lock the ball joints (7) (Fig. 10) to a torque of 120 - 150 Nm, the threads previously smeared with Loctite 270 or equivalent. 63. Refit the steering ram on the tractor. 64. Check the ram supply and tightness.
Fig. 11
Final operation 65. Carry out a road test on the steering system.
09H01.16
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering
F . Steering column The steering column assembly comprises two parts: - the fixed lower part composed of a pipe and a body foot - the mobile upper part composed of a pipe with a welded stirrup, as well as a unit holding the steering wheel height and tilt adjustment systems.
Operation Height adjustment When the control lever (4) is moved upwards, the T rod makes the lever (6) pivot, lowering the arm (20). The screw (5) integral with the arm presses against the brake plate, freeing it and allowing the upper part of the steering column to move. The spring (3) returns the lever (4) to position. Tilt adjustment When the control lever (4) is moved downwards, press the T rod which pushes against the end of the notched lever (9)(10), freeing it from the steering rack (11)(12) and allowing the upper part of the unit (17) to tilt. Two silent blocks (24) absorb shocks to the tilt stop of the upper part of the column. The two return springs (25) and (26) facilitate steering wheel positioning.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09H01.17
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering Steering column parts list (Fig. 12, Fig. 13) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) (12) (13) (14) (15) (16) (17) (18) (19) (20) (21) (22) (23) (24) (25) (26)
Washer Washer Spring Control lever Adjusting screw Lever Spring Boot Notched lever Notched lever Steering rack Steering rack Screw Nut Pin Nuts Column articulated housing Nuts Column fixed housing Arm Nut Pin Bushes Silent blocks Spring Spring
09H01.18
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering
Overall view
16 4
17
4
24
12 11
14 T 13
T
9 9 10
15
10
7
1
1 19
6
6 20
20 3 18
3
5 5
21
MA-09-03646A
Fig. 12 Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09H01.19
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering
Exploded view
8
11 12 13 14
7
15 9 24 4
10 6 26
20 T 5 21
25
2
1
22
3
23
19
MA-09-03645A
Fig. 13
09H01.20
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering
G . Removing and refitting the steering column
3
Removal 66. Using the lever located to the right under the steering wheel, pull the steering column as far as possible towards the driver. 67. Take off the steering wheel and the instrument panel lower cover (1). Disconnect the connectors of the reverse shuttle, wiper control unit and DOT MATRIX keyboard (if fitted). 68. If there is not sufficient access space, also take out the upper cover (2) and instrument panel (3) (Fig. 14). 69. Remove the 4 attachment screws fixing the column base to the cab support. 70. Take off the column assembly.
Refitting 71. Check all steering column positions function correctly. 72. Lightly smear the shaft (29) splines with Anti-Seize grease or equivalent. 73. Carry out the operations 67 to 70 in reverse order. NOTE: Tighten the steering wheel nut to a torque of 57 - 78 Nm. 74. Check the correct operation of the electrical equipment, reverse shuttle lever, ParkLock, etc.
H . Removing and refitting the control lever assembly Removal 75. Remove the steering column. Carry out operations 66 to 70. 76. Remove the half housings around the steering column. Take off the reverse shuttle control, lighting switch and DOT MATRIX keyboard (if fitted). 77. Remove and discard the retaining washers (1)(2). Remove the spring (3) and lever (4) with the boot (8) and lever (6).
2
1 MA-09-03643A
Fig. 14
I . Removing and refitting the column tilt mechanism Removal 81. Remove the steering column. Carry out operations 66 to 70. 82. Remove the half housings around the steering column. Take off the reverse shuttle control, lighting switch and DOT MATRIX keyboard (if fitted). 83. Remove and discard the retaining washers (1)(2). Remove the spring (3) and lever (4) with the boot (8) and lever (6). 84. Press on the notched levers (9)(10) to compress the spring (7). Take off the nuts (14). Take off the steering racks (11) and (12). 85. Drive out the pin (15). Remove the notched levers (9)(10) and the spring (7).
Refitting 78. Refit the levers (6) and (4) and spring (3). Refit the retaining washers (1)(2). 79. Adjust the lever (6) so the T rod touches the notched levers (9)(10). 80. Carry out operation 76 in reverse and proceed to operations 71 to 74.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09H01.21
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering Refitting 86. Carry out operation 85 in reverse order. 87. Compress the spring (7). Fit the steering racks (11) and (12). Fit and tighten the screws (14) greased with Loctite 241. 88. Refit the lever (4), T rod and spring (3). Refit the retaining washers (1)(2). 89. Adjust the lever (4) so that the T rod comes into contact with the notched levers (11) and (12). 90. Carry out operation 82 in reverse and proceed to operations 71 to 74.
16
17
J . Removing and refitting the column locking up mechanism Removal 91. Remove the steering column. Carry out operations 66 to 70. 92. Remove the half housings around the steering column. 93. Carry out operations 82 to 85. 94. Take out the adjusting screw (5) (3mm Allen key). 95. Disassemble the nuts (16) and their respective screws, and separate the upper articulated part (17) of the column. 96. Disassemble the nuts (18) and their respective screws, and separate the lower part (19) of the column. 97. Remove the arm (20) and brake plate and nut (21).
19 18
MA-09-03644A
Refitting 98. Carry out the operations 95 to 97 in reverse order. 99. Fit and adjust the screw (5). 100.Refit the tilt adjustment mechanism (operations 86 to 90).
09H01.22
¤ H
Fig. 15
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering
K . Disassembling the lower bush Disassembling the bush (23 Fig. 13) 101.Using the lever located to the right under the steering wheel, pull the steering column as far as possible towards the driver. 102.Take off the steering wheel and the instrument panel lower cover (1). Disconnect the connectors of the reverse shuttle, wiper control unit and DOT MATRIX keyboard (if fitted). 103.If there is not sufficient access space, also take out the upper cover (2) and instrument panel (3) (Fig. 14). 104.Remove the 4 attachment screws fixing the column base to the cab support. 105.Take off the column assembly. 106.Remove the half housings around the steering column. Take off the reverse shuttle control, lighting switch and DOT MATRIX keyboard (if fitted). 107.Remove and discard the retaining washers (1)(2). Remove the spring (3) and lever (4) with the boot (8) and lever (6). 108.Press on the notched levers (9)(10) to compress the spring (7). Take off the nuts (14). Take off the steering racks (11) and (12). 109.Drive out the pin (15). Remove the notched levers (9)(10) and the spring (7). 110.Take out the adjusting screw (5) (3mm Allen key). 111.Disassemble the nuts (16) and their respective screws, and separate the upper articulated part (17) of the column. 112.Disassemble the nuts (18) and their respective screws, and separate the lower part (19) of the column. 113.Remove the arm (20) and brake plate and nut (21). 114.Extract the bush (23) from the housing (19).
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Reassembly 115.Refit the bush (23). 116.Refit the arm (20) and brake plate and nut (21). 117.Assemble the lower part (19) of the column. Reassemble the nuts (18) and their respective screws. 118.Assemble the upper articulated part (17) of the column. Reassemble the nuts (16) and their respective screws. 119.Refit the notched levers (9)(10) and spring and fit the pin (15). 120.Compress the spring (7). Fit the steering racks (11) and (12). Fit and tighten the screws (14) greased with Loctite 241. 121.Refit the lever (4), T rod and spring (3). Refit the retaining washers (1)(2). 122.Adjust the lever (4) so that the T rod comes into contact with the notched levers (11) and (12). 123.Refit the reverse shuttle control, lighting switch and DOT MATRIX keyboard (if fitted). Refit the half housings around the steering column. 124.Check all steering column positions function correctly. 125.Lightly smear the shaft (29) splines with Anti-Seize grease or equivalent. 126.Carry out the operations 67 to 70 in reverse order. 127.Refit the column assembly. 128.Fit the 4 attachment screws fixing the column base to the cab support. Tighten the screws to a torque of 57 - 78 Nm. 129.Refit the removed covers and instrument panel (if disassembled). 130.Check the operation of electrical equipment, reverse shuttle lever, ParkLock, etc.
09H01.23
Load Sensing hydrostatic steering
09H01.24
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Main braking circuit
09I01 - Main braking circuit
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Braking valve control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 C . Relations between the different tractor braking circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 D . Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 E . Rear brake cylinders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 F . Removing the universal joint shaft brake. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 G . Bleeding the brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09I01.1
Main braking circuit
09I01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Main braking circuit
A . General
Characteristics of braking components Braking valve
Tractors with a DYNA VT transmission are fitted with a hydraulic braking system operating on the high pressure auxiliary circuit for the rear brakes and on the transmission low pressure circuit for the front axle shaft brake. They are both controlled by a braking valve activated by two pedals that can operate coupled or uncoupled. The braking valve, located at the front of the pedal, receives and directs pressure to the various components. It controls: - The right- and left-hand brakes located under the rear axle, and operating simultaneously or separately, - the front axle shaft brake control, - the trailer brake control via a pressure sensor located on the valve.
- Braking pressure: 0 to 70 bar. - Working travel: 16 mm Rear brakes - Piston diameter: 50.8 mm - Piston stroke: 3.7 mm - Maximum volume used by piston: 12.25 cm3 on each side Front brakes -
Piston diameter: 62 mm Piston stroke: 6.1 mm Rear brake / front brake pressure ratio: 2.04 bar Maximum braking pressure: 18 bar
Rear brakes Located in the rear axle, the two disc brakes are independent. Each brake is controlled hydraulically by a cylinder, or mechanically by the ParkLock ram. The braking valve is supplied by the make and break valve located under the distribution block with an accumulator that maintains a pressure reserve of 135 - 165 bar (see "Trailer braking and ParkLock” section). The braking valve includes a pressure relief valve (0-70 bar). The pressure is distributed to the brake by two spools located on either side of the pressure relief valve.
Front axle shaft brake The front axle brake is located at the front of the gearbox. It is a hydraulically controlled multidisc brake. The main braking valve controls a power-assisted braking valve which operates the front brake under a 18 bar max. pressure (transmission low pressure circuit).
Trailer brake The trailer brake is controlled electro-hydraulically. A pressure sensor informs the Autotronic 5 calculator of the pressure in the braking circuit. This then activates a proportional solenoid valve that controls the trailer brake valve via the transmission 18 bar circuit (see “Trailer braking and ParkLock” section).
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09I01.3
Main braking circuit
B . Braking valve control Parts list (Fig. 1 and Fig. 2) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11)
Main braking valve block Braking pressure regulator Left-hand brake control Right-hand brake control Pedals Bearing Bearing Bearing Bearing Sensor Spring
11 1
Identification of ports (Fig. 2) (P) (T) (X)
High pressure supply Tank return Control of front axle shaft brake and trailer brake pressure sensor (F1) Left-hand brake supply (F2) Right-hand brake supply
Braking control The pedals are pressed against the braking valve rods via bearings (6) (7) (8) (9). Each pedal simultaneously controls the pressure regulator (2 Fig. 2) and corresponding spool valve (3) or (4).
8
1
5
7
6
9
8
10
MA-09-03623
5
Fig. 1
09I01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Main braking circuit
1
3
2
4
MA-09-03622A
Fig. 2 Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09I01.5
Main braking circuit
C . Relations between the different tractor braking circuits The braking circuits of the rear axle, front axle and trailer are hydraulically or electrically linked. These circuits must react simultaneously to a single action on the brake pedals.
Parts list (Fig. 3) (P1)
High pressure variable displacement pump
(P2)
Transmission low pressure hydraulic pump
(PB)
Trailer brake and ParkLock priority valve
(CD)
Make and break valve
(TV)
Trailer braking valve
(BV)
Tractor braking valve
(EV)
Trailer brake control proportional solenoid valve
(AC1)
Accumulator (ParkLock)
(AC2)
Accumulator (rear brakes)
(TB)
Trailer brake
(BR1)
Rear brake
(BR2)
Rear brake
(BP1)
Pedal
(BP2)
Pedal
(M)
Pressure sensor
(FD)
Front brake control valve
(BF)
Front brake
(AUX)
To non-priority components
(AUTO 5)
Autotronic 5 calculator
Action on tractor brakes Pedals coupled When one of the two pedals (BP1) and (BP2) is activated, the pressure regulator located in the braking valve regulates the pressure coming from the make and break valve (CD) and accumulator (AC2). The braking valve then distributes this pressure to the rear brakes (BR1) and (BR2). Simultaneaously, the braking valve sends a pressure signal to the spool valve (FD) and pressure sensor (M). The spool valve (FD) controls the front axle brake (BF) with pressure from the pump (P2) (transmission 18 bar circuit). The sensor (M) allows the Autotronic 5 to control the trailer brake via the proportional solenoid valve (EV) (see “Trailer braking and ParkLock” section). Pedals uncoupled If the driver presses on just one pedal, this acts on the braking valve pressure regulator and on a brake spool valve. The pressure is directed to the corresponding brake. The “&” valve in the braking block ensures no pressure signal is supplied to the spool valve (FD) or sensor (M). The front brake (BF) and trailer brake (TB) are only activated when both brake pedals are simultaneously activated. “&” Valve The “&” valve (7 Fig. 4) is fitted in the braking block. It allows pressure to be supplied to the trailer brake and front brake only if the two pedals are activated. The pressure directed to the rear left- and right-hand brakes must be identical to enable operation of the front brake and trailer brake.
(PARKLOCK) ParkLock assembly (ram and control)
09I01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Main braking circuit
AUX
Parklock
PB
P1
Electrical connection
High pressure
Control circuit
TB
TV
CD
AC1
EV
AC2
BR1
AUTO 5
BV
BR2
BP1
BP2
M
FD
P2
BF
Tractor braking principle
MA-09-03621A
Fig. 3 Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09I01.7
Main braking circuit
D . Diagram Parts list (Fig. 4) (1) Tractor braking valve (2) Pressure relief spool (3) Right-hand brake spool (4) Left-hand brake spool (5) Right-hand brake (6) Left-hand brake (7) & Valve (8) Accumulator (braking circuit) (9) Accumulator (ParkLock circuit) (10) Transmission low pressure circuit pump (11) Front axle shaft brake control spool (12) Front axle shaft brake (M1) Braking circuit load pressure switch (M2) Braking circuit load pressure switch (TR 34) Trailer braking pressure sensor (A) Trailer brake control (B) To ParkLock (C) Braking circuit supply pressure from make and break valve (135 - 165 bar)
09I01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Main braking circuit
M1
M2
9 B C
8
6
4 7 1 12 2 11 TR 34 3 5
10
A
MA-09-03625A
Fig. 4 Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09I01.9
Main braking circuit
E . Rear brake cylinders The rear brake cylinders are located on the rear axle, beside the trumpet housings.
Description (Fig. 7) The rear axle braking system consists of a brake cylinder (1), a piston (2), and a rod (5) that acts on an assembly (3) comprised of discs (6) and intermediate plates (7) (see chapter 6). The brake disc assembly is fitted before the final drive unit (4) in the rear trumpet housing. The piston acts on the rod (5) whose triangular end allows the two intermediate plates (9) and (10) to swivel in relation to each other. When swivelling, the intermediate plates (9) and (10) are kept separate by balls (8). Return springs (18) restore the intermediate plates (9) and (10) to position when the brakes are released. The port (16) is linked to the bleed circuit by a pipe (see § G).
Fig. 5
MA-09-03636A
Operation Braking can be activated hydraulically (brake pedals) or mechanically (ParkLock). Pedal braking The braking pressure (coming from the braking valve) arrives at the cylinder via the port (14) (Fig. 7). The piston (2) is forced down by the pressure, driving down the lower part of the piston (17) and rod (5) and activates the braking mechanism.
11 5
17
MA-09-03637A
Mechanical braking (ParkLock)
Fig. 6
When the brakes are activated by the ParkLock ram, the levers (18) activate the cams (11 Fig. 6). As they rotate they drive the lower part of the pistons (17) and rod (5) and activate the braking mechanism. When the lower part of the piston (17) has lowered, the spring (15) keeps the upper part of the piston (2) at the top of the cylinder.
09I01.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
10
9
18
8 5
17
MA-09-03635A
15
13
1
2
16
14
11
6
7
3
1
2
5
4
Main braking circuit
Fig. 7 Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09I01.11
Main braking circuit
F . Removing the universal joint shaft brake The front axle shaft brake is located at the front of the gearbox.
19
Operation The front axle shaft brake operates in a similar manner to the rear brakes. A piston (20 Fig. 8) pushes a rod (21) with a triangular end. The triangular part allows two intermediate plates (22 Fig. 9) to swivel in relation to each other, while they are held apart by balls (23).
20
21
MA-09-03638A
Fig. 8
09I01.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Main braking circuit
26
22 19 25
21 23 24
MA-09-03639A
24
26
25 MA-09-03640A
23
22
Fig. 9 Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09I01.13
Main braking circuit
G . Bleeding the brakes 2 The tractor brakes are bled through bleed plugs (Fig. 10) located at the rear right-hand side of the tractor beside the auxiliary spool valves: (1) Front axle shaft brake (2) Rear left-hand brake (3) Rear right-hand brake
1 3
The trailer brake is bled through the bleed plug located on top of the distribution block (Fig. 11). NOTE: The brakes must be bled every 1200 hours, or when working on the braking circuit.
Bleeding method 1. Start the engine. 2. Open the right-hand (3), left-hand (2) and front (1) bleed plugs (Fig. 10). 3. Press moderately on the coupled brake pedals, with pedal travel of approximately 20 mm. NOTE: Never press the pedals down more than 25 mm when the bleed plugs are open. A jet of oil under pressure will spurt out of the bleed plugs. 4. Let the air bleed out at the plugs. 5. Close the plugs again when the fluid coming out no longer shows any trace of foam or air bubbles. Release the pedals. 6. Open the bleed plug on the trailer brake valve (Fig. 11). 7. Repeat the operations 3 to 5. 8. Check the oil levels in the auxiliary hydraulics and gearbox.
MA-09-03624A
Fig. 10
MA-09-03626A
Fig. 11
09I01.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps
09J01 - Disassembling and reassembling the pumps
CONTENTS A . General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Disassembling the steering pump and the variable displacement pump . . . . . . . . 8 C . Reassembling the steering pump and the variable displacement pump . . . . . . . . 16 D . Disassembling the service pump (18 bar) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 E . Reassembling the service pump (18 bar) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 F . Disassembling the lubricating pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 G . Reassembling the lubricating pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09J01.1
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps
09J01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps
A . General The steering pump is fitted at the end of the variable displacement pump. It is a 19cc fixed displacement pump, with a 120 bar maximum pressure and a gear ratio of 67/58. It is fitted to the variable displacement pump by two CHC M8 screws. It rotates around a coupling sleeve.
The variable displacement pump has maximum capacity of 60cc, and a 400 bar maximum pressure. The gear ratio is 67/58. Drive is transmitted directly to the gearbox by a gear train. The pump is fitted to the gearbox housing by two HM 12 screws. The service pump (18 bar) is a 14cc fixed displacement pump fitted to the gearbox housing, and is driven by a gear train. The lubricating pump is a fixed displacement pump. It is a gear pump and is fitted to the same drive pinion as the service pump. It’s capacity is 23.4cc.
Diagram of the variable displacement pump and steering pump
86 N.m 50 N.m
25 N.m Variable displacement pump VD pump control Steering pump Priority block MA-09-04107A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Fig. 1
09J01.3
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps
Exploded view of the variable displacement pump.
14 15 16 17 18 10
19
9 8
13
7 6
12
5
11
4 3 20
2 21
1 22
26 23
25 24
Fig. 2
MA-09-04133A
Ref.
Description
Ref.
Description
1
O’ring
14
O’ring
2
Flange
15
Union
3
Screw
16
O’ring
4
Hose
17
Elbow union
5
Gasket
18
Hose
6
Plug
19
Screw
7
O’ring
20
Flange
8
Washer
21
O’ring
9
Rigid pipe
22
Collar
10
Screw
23
Hose
11
O’ring
24
O’ring
12
Union
25
Screw
13
Rigid pipe
26
Washer
09J01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps
Exploded view of the steering pump
27 28 29 30 31 32
50 47 46
49 48
45 44
33
43
34
42
35
41
36
40
37
39 38
Fig. 3 MA-09-04134A
Ref.
Description
Description
27
Screw
40
Union
28
Union plate
41
Seal
29
Hose
42
Union
30
Union
43
Rigid pipe
31
Screw
44
Union
32
O’ring
45
O’ring
33
Hose
46
Washer
34
Union
47
Screw
35
O’ring
48
O’ring
36
O’ring
49
Union
37
Union
50
Hose
38
Strainer
39
Seal
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Ref.
09J01.5
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps
Exploded view of the service pump (18 bar)
58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51
59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 Fig. 4
MA-09-04135A
Ref.
Description
Ref.
Description
51
Screw
60
Cover
52
Rigid pipe
61
Catchdog
53
Union
62
O’ring
54
Screw
63
Hydraulic pump
55
Union
64
O’ring
56
O’ring
65
Insert
57
O’ring
66
Screw
58
Screw
67
Screw
59
O’ring
09J01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps
Exploded view of the lubricating pump
74
75
76
77
78
79
73
72
71
70
69
68
80 81
82
MA-09-04136A
83
84 Fig. 5
Ref.
Description
Description
68
Key
77
Suction filter
69
Washer
78
O’ring
70
Screw
79
Circlip
71
Screw
80
Pipe
72
O’ring
81
O’ring
73
O’ring
82
Pump
74
Filter
83
Drive pinion
75
Screw
84
Circlip
76
Cover
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Ref.
09J01.7
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps
B . Disassembling the steering pump and the variable displacement pump NOTE: The pumps are removed and refitted through the spacer hole, but to improve visibility the photos show a scale model without an engine and with the spacer removed in certain cases. The references in the text refer to the following figures (Fig. 2, Fig. 3, Fig. 4 and Fig. 5).
Preliminary operations: 1. Chock the tractor and take off the rear right-hand wheel. 2. Remove the exhaust system. 3. Take off the right-hand protective guards. 4. Take off the protective guard over the right-hand footstep. 5. Remove the right-hand footstep. 6. Drain and remove the fuel tank. 7. Drain the hydraulic oil. 8. Remove the protective housings that might obstruct access. 9. Disconnect the hydraulic pipes connected to the tank (Fig. 6 and Fig. 7).
Fig. 6
Fig. 7 10. Disconnect the hose (33) from the steering pump priority block.
Fig. 8
09J01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 11. Take out the attachment screws (10) from the hydraulic pressure pipe of the variable displacement pump.
Fig. 9
12. Take out the tank attachment screws.
Fig. 10
13. Remove the oil tank.
Fig. 11
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09J01.9
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 14. Take out the rigid pipe (9) through the port, then disassemble it.
Fig. 12
15. Remove the hose (50) from the steering pump priority block.
Fig. 13
16. Take out the attachment screws (27) from the union plate (28).
Fig. 14
09J01.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 17. Gently remove the plate from the spacer, and disassemble the hydraulic union from the priority block.
Fig. 15
18. Remove the “Load Sensing” control pipe from the variable displacement pump.
Fig. 16
19. Disconnect the hose (33) from the steering pump priority block.
Fig. 17
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09J01.11
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 20. Loosen the collar (22), then disconnect the variable displacement pump suction hose (23).
Fig. 18
21. Take off the rigid pipe (43) fitted with its strainer (38). NOTE: Access to the union is limited, so a 41 mm pipe wrench is recommended.
Fig. 19
22. Remove the union (44) from the pump.
Fig. 20
09J01.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 23. Take out the attachment screws (47) from the steering pump.
Fig. 21
24. Remove the steering pump. 25. Discard the O’ring.
Fig. 22
26. Remove the coupling sleeve.
Fig. 23
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09J01.13
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 27. Loosen and take out the screws (3), then remove the pressure union of the variable displacement pump. NOTE: Access is limited, so a 10 mm multipurpose wrench is recommended.
Fig. 24
28. Remove the return rigid pipe (13) to the variable displacement pump tank. NOTE: Access is limited, so a 27 mm pipe wrench is recommended.
Fig. 25
29. Remove the screws (25) from the variable displacement pump flange. NOTE: Access is limited, so an 18 mm offset pipe socket is recommended.
Fig. 26
09J01.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 30. Support the variable displacement pump across the housing with a wooden shim, and pull the pump away of the gear teeth.
Fig. 27
31. Take the pump out of the spacer; 32. Discard the paper gasket. NOTE: It is recommended to turn the suction channel of the pump upwards and to remove an attachment stud from the tank to extract the pump more easily.
Fig. 28
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09J01.15
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps
C . Reassembling the steering pump and the variable displacement pump IMPORTANT: Before reassembling, all components, mating faces and grooves must be clean. Any rust, mud or water must be removed. 33. Grease and fit new seals. 34. Screw two M12 guide studs into M12 screw holes to assist pump assembly. 35. Insert the variable displacement pump into the spacer and slide it onto the studs. NOTE: A wooden shim can be fitted to assist pump positioning.
36. Take out the guide studs and attach the pump using the two M12 attachment screws (25). 37. Tighten the M12 screws (25) to a torque of:
Fig. 29
86 Nm
38. Fit the return rigid pipe (13) to the variable displacement pump tank. NOTE: Access is limited, so a 27 mm pipe wrench is recommended.
Fig. 30
Fig. 31
09J01.16
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 39. Fit the variable displacement pump pressure hose (4). 40. Tighten the screws (3) to a torque of:
50 Nm
Fig. 32
41. Fit the coupling sleeve of the two pumps.
Fig. 33 42. Fit a new O’ring on the steering pump centring diameter, and fit the steering pump in its housing.
Fig. 34
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09J01.17
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 43. Fit and tighten the steering pump screws (47) to a torque of:
25 Nm
Fig. 35 44. Fit the steering pump union (44).
Fig. 36 45. Fit the steering pump rigid pipe (43) fitted with its strainer (38).
Fig. 37
09J01.18
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 46. Connect the hose (23) on the variable displacement pump suction channel, and tighten the collar (22).
Fig. 38
47. Attach the hose (33) on the steering pump priority block.
Fig. 39
48. Fit the elbow (17) on the variable displacement pump.
Fig. 40
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09J01.19
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 49. Fit the steering pump priority block hose (50) and tighten the three screws (27) to a torque of:
10 Nm
Fig. 41 50. Fit the hose (50) on the steering pump priority block.
Fig. 42 51. Take out the pressure hose (4) from the variable displacement pump through the spacer plug (6), and connect it to the rigid pipe (9) of the washer (8).
Fig. 43
09J01.20
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 52. Refit the stud if removed when extractng the pump. 53. Clean the mating faces of the tank and spacer. 54. Smear one of the cleaned surfaces with sealing product (ref. X903.050.074). 55. Fit the hydraulic tank.
Fig. 44 56. Fit and tighten the tank attachment screws.
Fig. 45
57. Tighten the screws (10) of the washer (8).
Fig. 46
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09J01.21
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 58. Fit the hose to the union (30).
Fig. 47 59. 60. 61. 62. 63. 64. 65. 66.
67. 68. 69.
Fit the tank hydraulic channels. (Fig. 48 and Fig. 49) Refit the protective housings that were removed. Refit the fuel tank. Refit the footstep. Refit the protective guard over the right-hand footstep. Refit the right-hand protective guards. Refit the exhaust system. Top up the hydraulic oil (approximately 65L). NOTE: The recommended oil quality and quantity should be respected. Check the operation and tightness of the hydraulic circuit. Repair any defective elements or seals. Refit the rear right-hand wheel. Fig. 48
Fig. 49
09J01.22
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps
D . Disassembling the service pump (18 bar) NOTE: The service pump is removed and refitted through the spacer hole, but to improve visibility the photos show a scale model without an engine and with the spacer removed in certain cases. The references in the text refer to the following figures (Fig. 2, Fig. 3, Fig. 4 and Fig. 5).
Preliminary operations: 70. take out the variable displacement pump from the spacer (see “Disassembling the steering pump and the variable displacement pump” section). 71. Loosen the screws (54) of the service pump union (55). Fig. 50
72. Take out the attachment screw from the union (55) on the gearbox housing and remove the suction pipe. 73. Discard the O’rings (56) and (57).
Fig. 51
74. Loosen the rigid pipe of the service pump pressure pipe and remove the hydraulic pipe (52).
Fig. 52
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09J01.23
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 75. Take out the screws (51) from the service pump and remove the pump. 76. Discard the O’ring (62).
Fig. 53
77. Check the condition of the service pump catchdog (61) (arrow Fig. 54).
Fig. 54
09J01.24
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps
E . Reassembling the service pump (18 bar) 78. Smear the service pump groove with miscible grease and fit it with a new O’ring (62).
Fig. 55
79. Remove the insert (65). 80. Discard the O'ring (64). 81. Smear a new O’ring (64) with miscible grease and fit it in the union flange groove.
Fig. 56 82. Refit the insert (65). 83. Tighten the diametrically opposed screws (66) and (67) to a torque of:
10 Nm
Fig. 57
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09J01.25
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 84. Fit the catchdog (61) on the service pump pin. NOTE: The service pump drive pin and gearbox drive pin are at a right angle to each other. To avoid incorrect refitting, the catchdog is grooved on the pump side.
Fig. 58 85. Fit the pump in its housing. 86. Insert and tighten the screws (51) to a torque of:
49 Nm
87. Smear the O’rings (56) with miscible grease, and fit them in the union (55) grooves. 88. Smear the O’ring (57) with miscible grease and fit it in the suction flange groove.
Fig. 59
Fig. 60
09J01.26
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 89. Fit the suction elbow with the flange, and hold it in position by fitting the attachment screw on the gearbox. (arrow Fig. 61).
Fig. 61 90. Fit and tighten the screws (54) on the suction flange.
Fig. 62
91. Fit and tighten the rigid pipe (52). 92. Refit the variable displacement pump. See “Reassembling the steering pump and the variable displacement pump” section.
Fig. 63
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09J01.27
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps
F . Disassembling the lubricating pump Preliminary operations: 93. Remove the transmission unit. See “Disassembling the Dyna VT module” section. NOTE: The references in the text refer to the following figures (Fig. 2, Fig. 3, Fig. 4 and Fig. 5). 94. Take out the screws (75), then remove the cover (76).
Fig. 64
95. Remove the filter (74).
Fig. 65 96. Loosen the pipe on the pressure filter side.
Fig. 66
09J01.28
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 97. Loosen the pipe on the rear axle side.
Fig. 67 98. Remove the circlip (79) from the suction pipe.
Fig. 68
99. Fit home the suction pipe in the suction filter pipe to release it from the pump.
Fig. 69
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09J01.29
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 100.Loosen and remove the 2 screws (71).
Fig. 70
101.Remove the lubricating pump.
Fig. 71
102.Remove the suction pipe. 103.Discard the O’rings.
Fig. 72
09J01.30
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 104.Take off the pump pinion circlip (84).
Fig. 73 105.Remove the pump pinion (83).
Fig. 74
106.Take off the key (68). 107.Check the pump condition, and replace it if required.
Fig. 75
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09J01.31
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps
G . Reassembling the lubricating pump IMPORTANT: Before reassembling, all components, mating faces and grooves must be clean. Any mud, rust or water must be removed. 108.Fit the key (68) in its housing.
Fig. 76 109.Fit the drive pinion (83).
Fig. 77 110.Fit the shaft circlip (84).
Fig. 78
09J01.32
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 111.Fit the pump in its housing in the gearbox. Hold it in position using 2 screws. 112.Refit the pipe on the pressure filter side and rear axle side (arrow Fig. 79).
Fig. 79 113.Prepare the suction pipe. 114.Fit the 2 O’rings (81) and circlips (79) as shown in (Fig. 80).
Fig. 80
115.Fit the side not fitted with the O’ring in the suction filter pipe (77).
Fig. 81
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09J01.33
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 116.Smear the O'ring with miscible grease and fit home the pipe in the suction pump. NOTE: The circlip groove on the suction filter pipe side must be cleared.
Fig. 82
117.Smear it with miscible grease, then slide the O’ring into its groove.
Fig. 83
118.Fit the circlip in its groove.
Fig. 84
09J01.34
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 119.Fit the pipe into the suction filter until it abuts against the circlip. NOTE: The circlip groove on the pump side must be cleared.
Fig. 85
120.Fit the circlip on the pipe, on the pump side.
Fig. 86
121.Definitively tighten the pump attachment screws to a torque of:
25 Nm
Fig. 87
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09J01.35
Disassembling and reassembling the pumps 122.Fit the suction filter (74).
Fig. 88
123.Fit the cover (76) using the 3 screws (75).
Fig. 89
124.Tighten the screws (75) to a torque of:
25 Nm
125.Refit the transmission unit. See “Reassembling the Dyna VT module” section.
Fig. 90
09J01.36
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary hydraulics tests
09K01 - Auxiliary hydraulics tests
CONTENTS A . General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Steering and cooling circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 C . High flow rate auxiliary hydraulic circuit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 D . Service tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09K01.1
Auxiliary hydraulics tests
09K01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary hydraulics tests
A . General The hydraulic system fitted on tractors equipped with a DYNA VT transmission is made of two parts: - the transmission hydraulic circuit - the auxiliary hydraulic circuit
Auxiliary hydraulic circuit The auxiliary hydraulic circuit comprises two pumps. One is a 19cc fixed displacement pump and the other is a 60cc variable displacement pump. The fixed displacement pump supplies the following components: - the steering spool valve, - the cooling system. The variable displacement pump supplies the following components: - trailer braking, - ParkLock circuit, - auxiliary spool valves, - lift control spool valve, - optional equipment fitted on the auxiliary spool valves circuit. Both pumps are installed in the cast-iron hydraulic tank used as a spacer between the gearbox and the engine.
Transmission hydraulic circuit The transmission hydraulic circuit comprises two fixed displacement pumps. Their displacement is of 14 cc and 23.4 cc. They supply: - 14 cc pump: the transmission control circuit (solenoid valves, clutches) - 23.4 cc pump: the gearbox lubricating and cooling circuit (hydraulic cooler, lubrication) For the hydraulic tests concerning the transmission circuit, see chapter 5.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Preliminary operations Before starting the tests, run the engine at 2000 rpm to raise the oil temperature to 60 °C (132 °F) minimum. To assist the rise in temperature, connect a flow meter to an auxiliary spool valve and limit the flow rate in the flow meter. As soon as the oil temperature reaches or exceeds 60°C (132°F), switch off the auxiliary spool valve and open the flow meter valve to the maximum. To carry out the tests indicated in this section, it is recommended to use the following equipment, available in the AGCO network: - MF 3001: Pressure gauge kit; - MF 3016: 4 - 160 l/min (0.9 - 36 Gal/min) turbine flow meter kit; - MF 3017: Pipe assembly for MF 3016 flow meter; - 3582045M1: Female diagnostics coupler; If not available, use equivalent equipment; - AG01A: Hydraulic measurement and testing instrument kit (see § D). REMINDER: In all cases, ensure the direction of oil flow is correct in order to avoid any damage to the flow meter. Also choose pressure gauges, pipes and unions of sufficient capacity and strength for the checks to be carried out. NOTE: It may be necessary to adapt the tests proposed in this manual according to the function to be tested. In all cases, ensure that the suitable test equipment is used. In the case of pressure gauges, always use a pressure resistance greater than the pressure of the tested function.
09K01.3
Auxiliary hydraulics tests Main functions tested Pressures (Fig. 1 and Fig. 2) Values (bar) min.
max.
Pressure gauge to use
5
10
30
160
270
-
225 to 245
270
Variable displacement pump discharge pressure
22
200
270
P5 (PpLS)
XLS control line pressure
4
210
30 or 270
P6
Trailer braking pressure
0
140
270
P7
Lift control shock valve opening pressure
225
270
P8 (PpT)
Tank return line pressure
5
270
Ref.
Description
P1 (PpAC)
Cooling circuit pressure
P2
Max. steering circuit pressure
P3
Orbitol shock valve opening pressure
P4 (PpPPV)
0
Flow rates (Fig. 3) Ref.
Description
Values (L/min)
Q1
Max. flow rate of the 19cc pump at 2,200 rpm (steering / cooling circuit)
48
Q2
Max. flow rate of the 60cc pump at 2,200 rpm (high flow rate circuit)
140
Q3
Max. flow rate of the trailer brake system at 2,200 rpm
50
Distribution block pressure connectors
Fig. 1
09K01.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary hydraulics tests
Pressure tests
P2 P3
P1 P8 P5
P6
P7
P4
Fig. 2 Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09K01.5
Auxiliary hydraulics tests
Flow rate tests
Q1
Q2
Q3 Fig. 3
09K01.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary hydraulics tests
B . Steering and cooling circuit Maximum 19cc pump flow rate - Connect a flow meter in series with the hydraulic cooler. NOTE: The flow meter should be connected using locally made unions. NOTE: Check that the flow meter load valve remains fully open. - Without turning the steering wheel, check the Q1 max. flow rate. Engine speed
Flow rate (no action on steering)
1000
19 L/min
2200
48 L/min
Fig. 4
Cooling circuit pressure The cooler is protected by means of a by-pass valve calibrated to 5 bar. It is fitted in parallel at the level of the distribution block. - Connect a pressure gauge (max. 30 bar) to the “PpAC” diagnostics connector (P1) (Fig. 4) located at the front of the distribution block. - Check that the maximum pressure of the circuit: P1 = max. 10 bar.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09K01.7
Auxiliary hydraulics tests Maximum steering circuit pressure - Connect a T union between the steering ram and one of the ram supply hoses. - Connect a pressure gauge with a maximum capacity of approximately 270 bar to the T union (Fig. 5). - Start the engine. - Turn the steering wheel to full lock. - Check that the max. pressure P2 = 160 bar+/-10
Orbitol shock valve pressure - Connect a T union between a steering ram supply hose and the ram. - On the T union, connect a hand calibrating pump fitted with a 300 bar pressure gauge. - With the engine stopped, pump until the Orbitol shock valve opens. - Check that the max. pressure P3 = 225 - 245 bar.
Fig. 5
Steering circuit leaks - Run the engine at 1000 rpm. - Turn the steering on full lock and apply a torque of 4 Nm to the axis of the steering wheel. The wheel must not turn more than 2 rpm. If the wheel turns more than 2 rpm, disconnect the pipes that supply the rams, block the two ports and then apply the same torque (4 Nm) to the steering wheel. If it turns at less than 2 rpm, there is a leak at the level of the ram.
09K01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary hydraulics tests
C . High flow rate auxiliary hydraulic circuit Checking the maximum pump pressure - Connect a pressure gauge with a capacity of approximately 270 bar to the PpPPV (P4) pressure connector located to the right of the distribution block. - Connect a flow meter to an auxiliary spool valve. CAUTION: Ensure that supply and return pipes are connected in the correct direction (Fig. 6) in order to avoid damaging the flow meter. - Start the engine. - Activate the concerned spool valve in fully open position. - Close the flow meter valve until the maximum pressure P4 = 200 +/-5 bar is reached.
Fig. 6
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09K01.9
Auxiliary hydraulics tests Checking the maximum pump flow rate - Connect a pressure gauge to the PpPPV pressure connector (P4) located to the right of the distribution block (Fig. 6). - As the flow rate per spool valve is limited to approximately 95+/-5 l/min, connect a flow meter to two auxiliary spool valves. NOTE: Make a local assembly to connect two spool valve supplies and two returns to the same flow meter. Ensure that suitable unions are used and that the supplies and returns are connected in the correct direction. - Activate the concerned auxiliary spool valves in fully open position. - Progressively close the flow meter valve, check the P4 pressure and corresponding Q2 flow rate.
at 1000 rpm Q2 flow rate
P4 pressure
66 l/min.
110 bar
65 l/min.
130 bar
65 l/min.
150 bar
64 l/min.
170 bar
61 l/min.
190 bar
0 l/min.
195 bar
at 2200 rpm
Fig. 7
Q2 flow rate
P4 pressure
140 l/min.
110 bar
140 l/min.
130 bar
135 l/min.
150 bar
110 l/min.
170 bar
90 l/min.
190 bar
0 l/min.
195 bar
09K01.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary hydraulics tests Checking the discharge pressure and XLS pressure Definition of pressures • The discharge pressure (P4) is measured at the variable displacement pump outlet. • The XLS pressure (P5) is the pressure necessary to activate the requested function. • The standby pressure or regulating pressure allows to maintain a constant differential pressure between the discharge pressure and the XLS pressure. • The standby pressure is measured on the pump discharge pressure connector, with the engine running and the high pressure functions at rest. IMPORTANT: In order to avoid damage to the low capacity pressure gauges used during these tests, do not activate any high pressure components (auxiliary spool valve, linkage, trailer brake). Check - Connect a pressure gauge with a capacity of approximately 30 bar to the PpLS pressure connector (P5) located to the left of the distribution block, then a second pressure gauge with a capacity of approximately 30 bar to the PpPPV pressure connector (P4) located to the right of the distribution block (Fig. 8). - These diagnostics connectors are located on the distribution block. NOTE: The PpLS pressure connector (P5) is difficult to access to. It may be necessary to make a union locally for connecting the pressure gauge. P4: Pump discharge pressure P5: XLS line pressure - Check P4 and P5. Engine speed (rpm)
P4 (bar)
P5 (bar)
1000
22
4
2200
22
4
Fig. 8
The P4 discharge pressure must be equal to the P5 XLS flow rate control pressure +18 +/-2 bar. P4 = P5 + 18+/-2 bar Note: The XLS pressure can be checked at the same time as another high pressure function test. Checking the XLS pressure on the P5 connector allows the Load Sensing control line to be checked during action on a high pressure function. In this case, pressure gauges with a capacity of approximately 270 bar must be used.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09K01.11
Auxiliary hydraulics tests Maximum trailer braking pressure - Connect a pressure gauge with a capacity of 270 bar onto the trailer brake coupler (Fig. 9). - Press down the dual brake pedals. - Check the pressure reading: P6 = 140 +/-5 bar at 1,000 rpm and at 2,000 rpm.
Maximum trailer brake flow rate - Connect a pressure gauge between the trailer braking coupler and the optional tank return union (Fig. 10). - Check that the flow meter load valve is fully open. - With the engine running, fully press down on the brake pedals. - Check that the maximum trailer brake flow rate Q3 = 50 l/min.
Fig. 9
Fig. 10
09K01.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary hydraulics tests Checking the SMS management system of electrohydraulic spool valves The electrohydraulic spool valves are used to regulate and store flow rates from the DOT MATRIX control screen or from the DATATRONIC 3 (according to option). This function, along with the Kick out and floating position functions, can be checked by connecting a flow meter to the auxiliary spool valve and a pressure gauge with a capacity of approximately 270 bar to the PpPPV pump discharge pressure connector (P4) located to the right of the distribution block. The connection is identical to that used for checking the pump Q2 flow rate (Fig. 11). The connection allows different functions to be tested: - Kick out - floating position - linkage / spool valve flow rate priority
Fig. 11
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09K01.13
Auxiliary hydraulics tests Checking lift control shock valve opening pressure - Stop the tractor engine. - Connect a manual discharge pump to the unions of the pipes supplying the lift rams (Fig. 12). - Check that the pressure P7 = 225 bar
Checking the tank return line pressure - Connect a pressure gauge to the PpT pressure connector (P8) located on the front of the distribution block (Fig. 13). - Run the engine at 2200 rpm. - Actuate one or more high pressure circuit components (spool valve, linkage, brakes, etc.).
Fig. 12
Fig. 13
09K01.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary hydraulics tests
D . Service tools - AG01A: Hydraulic measurement and testing instrument kit (Fig. 14).
Fig. 14
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09K01.15
Auxiliary hydraulics tests
Page left blank intentionally
09K01.16
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Auxiliary hydraulics tests
PRESSURE TESTS X aux P aux T aux
B A
B A
P 3/4
B A
T 3/4 X SUS
P SUS
T SUS LS 3/8
FS
135 bar A1
B A
P SUS P AUX P OPT
T 22 bar
P P DIR A2
F2
X OPT
B A
X AUX X SUS
230 bar Tx Px
T OPT T SUS T AUX T DIR AC Pp 5 bar
LS PV
FR Pp
TC
P1 B A
Pp
P6
PPp
Pp T
P8
P5
P7
P4 P2
OSPFD 80/240
160 bar
7 bar
P3 60 cc
19 cc 1
1
90 2
2
B
90 3
A
3
B
180
A
1
2 1 180
2
MA-09-03930A
Fig. 15
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
09K01.17
Auxiliary hydraulics tests
FLOW RATE TESTS X aux P aux T aux
B A
Q2
B A
P 3/4
B A
T 3/4 X SUS
P SUS
T SUS LS 3/8
FS
135 bar A1
B A
P SUS P AUX P OPT
T 22 bar
P P DIR A2
F2
X OPT
B A
X AUX X SUS
230 bar Tx Px
T OPT T SUS T AUX T DIR AC Pp 5 bar
LS PV
FR Pp
TC
Q1 B A
Pp
Q3
PPp
Pp T
OSPFD 80/240
T 160 bar LS
P DIR
7 bar
60 cc
19 cc 1
1
90 2
2
B
90 3
A
3
B
180
A
1
2 1 180
2
MA-09-03931A
Fig. 16
09K01.18
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Electrical equipment
10 - Electrical equipment CONTENTS 10A01 - Fuse box 10A02 - Electrical diagrams
Massey Ferguson 8400
¤ H
Contents - i
Electrical equipment
Contents - ii
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400
Fuse box
10A01 - Fuse box
CONTENTS A . General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Fuse box for Europe. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 C . Fuse box - North America . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
10A01.1
Fuse box
10A01.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Fuse box
A . General The fuse box elements are named depending on their function: F Fuse SH Shunt (shunts are fuses) R Relays The fuses used are of different powers and sizes: Amperage
Size
3
normal
5
min.
7,5
min.
10
min.
10
normal
15
min.
15
normal
20
normal
25
normal
30
normal
40
max.
50
max.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Colour
10A01.3
Fuse box
B . Fuse box for Europe Ref. F1
Amp Size 10
min.
min.
Direction indicator
15
min.
Direction indicator
SH14
15
min.
min.
10
min.
Direction indicator
R1
Handrail road lights (A)
Brake lights
R2
Fuel booster pump (ECU)
DynaVT electrical control unit, Headland/SV1/SV2 switches
R3
Electronic injection control unit (ECU)
R4
Reversing light (optional)
Electronic injection control unit (ECU) control relay, reversing lights relay
R5
Brake lights
R6
1st additional ON/OFF spool valve (optional)
Air conditioning compressor
R7
2nd additional ON/OFF spool valve (optional) Handrail dipped lights (A) Power socket
normal Front work headlights on grille min.
normal Direction indicator
SH13
15
10
normal Direction indicator
Front right- and rear left-hand side lights, backlighting of switches / console / cigarette lighter
F6
F11
15 15
F5
25
Dipped lights (B)
SH7
15
Instrument panel, gearbox / differential / 4WD / PTO / creeper unit switches
F10
Road lights (B)
min.
SH9
min.
min.
min.
10
SH11
10
5
15
SH5
Protected function
F4
F7
SH4
F12
15
min.
Autotronic 4 calculator
R8
F13
7,5
min.
Work headlights module
R10
F14
7,5
min.
Electric rear-view mirrors (optional)
R11
DynaVT actuator
F16
30
normal Injection pump stop solenoid valve, braking pressure sensor
R12
Wiper timer
R14
Air conditioning
F17
3
normal Brake switches
R15
+ ignition on
F18
7,5
R16
Cab suspension (optional)
R17
Front work headlights
F19
25
F21
7,5
F22
10
min.
Linkage, diagnostics, braking circuit pressure sensor
normal Pneumatic seat, fuel heater min. min.
Linkage TOC/BOC switch, ParkLock switch, buzzer, starter switch, reverse shuttle lever, throttle pedal position sensor, armrest, parameter display selector switch
R18
Rear work headlights
R19
Rear fender work headlights
R20
Footstep work headlights
R21
Left-hand direction indicator Right-hand direction indicator
F23
30
normal Cigarette lighter, radio, roof light
R24
F25
25
normal Hazard warning lights switch
R27
Flashing beacon Central direction indicator unit
F26
30
normal Power socket
R28
F28
20
normal Electronic injection control unit (ECU)
R29
Air conditioning compressor
F30
15
min.
R31
Front work headlights on grille
F31
15
min.
ECU
F32
10
min.
Electronic injection control unit (ECU)
F34
15
min.
Dipped lights
F35
7,5
min.
Horn
F36
15
min.
Road lights
F37
5
min.
Clutch safety switch
F38
7,5
min.
Front left- and rear right-hand side lights, instrument panel back lighting
Thermostart electronic injection control unit (ECU)
F39
20
F40
15
min.
F41
15
min.
5th auxiliary hydraulic spool valve (optional)
F42
5
min.
ECU
normal Side / road lights switch on handrails Left-hand direction indicator
F44
15
min.
Right-hand direction indicator
F46
15
min.
Rear windscreen wiper.
F47
10
min.
Radio
F49
50
max.
Cab suspension (optional)
F50
50
max.
Air conditioning
F51
15
min.
Instrument panel
F52
10
min.
Power socket
F53
25
F54
30
normal Front work headlights
F55
25
normal Rear work headlights
normal Front windscreen wiper
F56
25
normal Work headlights on rear fenders and/or handrails
F57
30
normal Footstep work headlights
F58
7,5
min.
Work headlights module
F59
10
min.
Flashing beacon
F60
10
min.
+ ignition on relay control
F61
25
F62
40
SH2
30
10A01.4
¤ H
(A): Tractors with Germany specifications only. (B) : All models except tractors with Germany specifications.
normal Hazard warning lights max.
Autotronic 4 calculator supply
normal Handrail work headlights on fenders
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Fuse box
R31
X14 X15 R29
RESERVE 2
BLINK
1
1
2
PLAFOND
R30
2
1 R27
BAF2
PILIER
R28 2
BAF1
1 SH3 SH2
BAF3
X5
SH1
BAF4 R19
R20
X3
SH14
SH13
R18
X13
X8
F61 F60 F59 F58 F62 40A
R17
F57 25A
X7 F56
10A 10A 7,5A
F55 R26
SH11
F54
30A SH12
F53
25A
X12
R16
25A
SH10
X9
R24 30A
R25
SH6 SH8
R15
25A
F47 10A F46 15A F45 7,5A F44 15A F43 7,5A
R22
R21 SH7 SH9 F40 15A
R6
R7
F42
F41 15A F39
5A
R8
R13 F49 50A F50 F51 50A F48 7,5A
R11
15A F52
R12
R10
R9 F26
R5
30A
10A F25 25A
F27 25A 20A SH5
F28 20A
F33 5A F32 10A F31 15A
F34 15A SH4 R1
X6
F23
F29 15A
F21 7,5A F19 25A
F30 15A R3
R2
30A
F18 7,5A
R4
F38 7,5A F37 5A F36 15A F35 7,5A
X10
R14
R23
F24 10A F22 10A
F17 3A F16 30A
TB1-B BAF8
1
2
F15 40A F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F11 F12 F13 F14
F7 F8 F9 F10 10A 15A 10A 10A 15A 10A 5A 15A 15A Res 10A 15A 7,5A 7,5A
X11
MA-10-06072A
Fig. 1 Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
10A01.5
Fuse box
C . Fuse box - North America Ref. F1
Amp Size 10
min.
F59
10
min.
Flashing beacon
F60
10
min.
+ ignition on relay control
F61
25
F62
40
normal Hazard warning lights
Protected function
SH3
30
Front right- and rear left-hand side lights, backlighting of switches / console / cigarette lighter
SH4
15
min.
Road lights
SH5
10
min.
Dipped lights
SH6
10
normal Direction indicator normal Direction indicator
max.
Autotronic 4 calculator supply
normal Work headlights on footsteps and handrails
F2
15
min.
Roof direction indicators
F3
10
min.
Left-hand fender extension direction indicator
F4
10
min.
Instrument panel, gearbox / differential / 4WD / PTO / creeper unit switches
SH8
10
SH10
15
min.
F5
15
min.
Brake lights
SH12
15
min.
F6
10
min.
DynaVT electrical control unit, Headland/SV1/SV2 switches
R2
Fuel booster pump (ECU)
R3
Electronic injection control unit (ECU)
F7
5
min.
Electronic injection control unit (ECU) control relay, reversing lights relay
R4
Reversing light (optional)
R5
Brake lights
F10
25
F11
10
normal Front work headlights on grille min.
Direction indicator
R6
1st additional ON/OFF spool valve (optional)
Autotronic 4 calculator
R7
2nd additional ON/OFF spool valve (optional) Power socket
Air conditioning compressor
F12
15
F13
7,5
min.
Work headlights module
R10
F14
7,5
min.
Electric rear-view mirrors (optional)
R11
DynaVT actuator
F16
30
normal Injection pump stop solenoid valve, braking pressure sensor
R12
Wiper timer
R14
Air conditioning
F17
3
normal Brake switches
R15
+ ignition on
F18
7,5
R16
Cab suspension (optional)
F19
25
R17
Front work headlights
F21 F22
7,5 10
F23
30
F24
10
F25
25
min.
Direction indicator
min.
Linkage, diagnostics, braking circuit pressure sensor
normal Pneumatic seat, fuel heater min. min.
Linkage TOC/BOC switch, ParkLock switch, buzzer, starter switch, reverse shuttle lever, throttle pedal position sensor, armrest, parameter display selector switch
normal Cigarette lighter, radio, roof light min.
Right-hand fender extension direction indicator
R18
Rear work headlights
R19
Rear fender work headlights
R20
Footstep work headlights
R21
Left-hand direction indicator
R22
Direction indicator and brake light on left-hand fender extension
R23
Direction indicator and brake light on right-hand fender extension
normal Hazard warning lights switch
F26
30
normal Power socket
R24
Right-hand direction indicator
F28
20
normal Electronic injection control unit (ECU)
R25
Right-hand direction indicator on rear fender
F30
15
R26
Left-hand direction indicator on rear fender
min.
Thermostart electronic injection control unit (ECU)
F31
15
min.
ECU
F32
10
min.
Electronic injection control unit (ECU)
F34
15
min.
Dipped lights
F35
7,5
min.
Horn
F36
15
min.
Road lights
F37
5
min.
Clutch safety switch
F38
7,5
min.
Front left- and rear right-hand side light, instrument panel back lighting
F39
20
F40
15
min.
Left-hand direction indicator
F41
15
min.
5th auxiliary hydraulic spool valve (optional)
5
min.
ECU
F43
7,5
min.
Left-hand direction indicator on brake light
F44
15
min.
Right-hand direction indicator
F45
7,5
min.
Right-hand direction indicator on brake light
F46
15
min.
Rear windscreen wiper
F47
10
min.
Radio
F49
50
max.
Cab suspension (optional)
F50
50
max.
Air conditioning
F51
15
min.
Instrument panel
F52
10
min.
Power socket
F53
25
F54
30
normal Front work headlights
F55
25
normal Rear work headlights
Central direction indicator unit
R29
Air conditioning compressor
R31
Front work headlights on grille
normal Front windscreen wiper
F56
25
normal Work headlights on rear fenders and/or handrails
F57
30
normal Footstep work headlights
F58
7,5
¤ H
Flashing beacon
R28
normal Side / road lights switch on handrails
F42
10A01.6
R27
min.
Work headlights module
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Fuse box
R31
X14 X15 R29
RESERVE 2
BLINK
1
1
2
PLAFOND
R30
2
1 R27
BAF2
PILIER
R28 2
BAF1
1 SH3 SH2
BAF3
X5
SH1
BAF4 R19
R20
X3
SH14
SH13
R18
X13
X8
F61 F60 F59 F58 F62 40A
R17
F57 25A
X7 F56
10A 10A 7,5A
F55 R26
SH11
F54
30A SH12
F53
25A
X12
R16
25A
SH10
X9
R24 30A
R25
SH6 SH8
R15
25A
F47 10A F46 15A F45 7,5A F44 15A F43 7,5A
R22
R21 SH7 SH9 F40 15A
R6
R7
F42
F41 15A F39
5A
R8
R13 F49 50A F50 F51 50A F48 7,5A
R11
15A F52
R12
R10
R9 F26
R5
30A
10A F25 25A
F27 25A 20A SH5
F28 20A
F33 5A F32 10A F31 15A
F34 15A SH4 R1
X6
F23
F29 15A
F21 7,5A F19 25A
F30 15A R3
R2
30A
F18 7,5A
R4
F38 7,5A F37 5A F36 15A F35 7,5A
X10
R14
R23
F24 10A F22 10A
F17 3A F16 30A
TB1-B BAF8
1
2
F15 40A F1
F2
F3
F4
F5
F6
F11 F12 F13 F14
F7 F8 F9 F10 10A 15A 10A 10A 15A 10A 5A 15A 15A Res 10A 15A 7,5A 7,5A
X11
MA-10-06073A
Fig. 2 Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
10A01.7
Fuse box
10A01.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Electrical diagrams
10A02 - Electrical diagrams
CONTENTS A . Cab equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Engine equipment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 C . Bulb types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 D . Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 E . Electronic units supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.1
Electrical diagrams
10A02.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams
A . Cab equipment General power supply of fuse box with cut-out switch ....... 5 General power supply of fuse box without cut-out switch......................................................................... 6 Right-hand side cigarette lighter ................................ 7 Left-hand side cigarette lighter .................................. 8 Power socket ............................................................. 9 Horn ......................................................................... 10 Front windscreen wiper ........................................... 11 Rear windscreen wiper ............................................ 12 Cab suspension........................................................ 13 Pneumatic seat ........................................................ 14 Radio - Europe (except Germany) ............................ 15 Radio - North America .............................................. 16 Radio - Germany....................................................... 17 Manual air conditioning for standard roof................. 18 Manual air conditioning for high visibility roof .......... 19 Automatic air conditioning........................................ 20 Standard ventilation for standard roof ...................... 21 Standard ventilation for high visibility roof ............... 22 Extreme cold weather air conditioning..................... 23 Electrical rear view mirrors....................................... 24 Door switch.............................................................. 25 Instrument panel controls ........................................ 26 Radar ........................................................................ 27 Fieldstar.................................................................... 28 Auxiliary hydraulics oil gauge ................................... 29 Emergency handbrake ............................................. 30
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.3
Electrical diagrams
Page left blank intentionally
10A02.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams General power supply of fuse box with cut-out switch 2 3 5 20 25 46 FAI 13 FAI 35 FAI 137 FAI 138 FAI 139
Fuse box Start switch Supply terminal Cut-out switch Starter motor Alternator Fuse box supply harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness Battery +12V fuse box supply harness Ignition on +12V fuse box supply harness Instrument panel +ignition on harness
20
-
+
2 X1 +12V X1.1/MASSE_BAF.1
1
-
+
3A
MASSE BAF N
1
FAI138
X2
X2.1/CAB120.1
1
R
+12V
CAB120
1
CAB120
1 X
1
Y
CAB120.1/S1.1
R
1
+12V
1
X4
1
X3
FAI139
25
S1
1 X3.1/CAB22.1
R
CAB32
R
R CAB34
1
X2.1/CAB21.1
FAI35
X2.1/CAB33.1
X2.1/CAB32.1
X2.1/CAB34.1
R
R
+12V ACC
CAB33
1
1
CAB21
225A 150A
1
XX
1
CAB22
S1.1/CAB24.1
M
46
3
1 CAB24
3
CAB121 1
1
CAB121.1/S1.1
CAB121
M
S1 S1.1/CAB23.1
M
2
1
5
CAB23
FAI137 S1.1/CAB25.1
M
1
4
1 CAB25
PLUS_CAB.1/CAB121.1 M X4.1/PLUS_CAB.1 M
FAI13
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
5 1
XXX
MA-10-06057A
1
PLUS CAB
10A02.5
Electrical diagrams General power supply of fuse box without cut-out switch 2 3 5 25 46 FAI 13 FAI 35 FAI 137 FAI 138 FAI 139
Fuse box Start switch Supply terminal Starter motor Alternator Fuse box supply harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness Battery +12V fuse box supply harness Ignition on +12V fuse box supply harness Instrument panel +ignition on harness
2
-
+
+12V
X1
-
+
BAF X1.1/MASSE_BAF.1
1
N
1
FAI138
X2
X2.1/CAB120.1
1
R CAB120
1
CAB120
1
+12V AP. CONTACT
X
1
Y
CAB120.1/S1.1
R
1
+12V
1
X4
1
X3
25 FAI139
S1
1 X3.1/CAB22.1
R
CAB32
R
R
1
CAB34
X2.1/CAB21.1
FAI35
X2.1/CAB33.1
X2.1/CAB32.1
X2.1/CAB34.1
R
R
+12V ACC
1
CAB33
1
CAB21
1
225A 150A XX
1
CAB22
46 S1.1/CAB24.1
M
3
1 CAB24
3
CAB121 1
1
CAB121.1/S1.1
CAB121
M
S1 S1.1/CAB23.1
M
2
1
5
CAB23
FAI137 S1.1/CAB25.1
M
1
4
1 CAB25
MA-10-06058A
PLUS_CAB.1/CAB121.1 M X4.1/PLUS_CAB.1 M
FAI13
XXX 1
1 PLUS CAB
5
10A02.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Right-hand side cigarette lighter 2 18 FAI 31 FAI 35 CAB03
Fuse box Cigarette lighter Cab Dyna VT transmission harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness Road lights switch
N
CAB28 1
CAB3.7/CAB28.1
N
CAB03
2 8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
BAF9 TB2
BAF9.5/S2.1
S2
R
CAB3.3/S2.1
R
+3
BAF9.15/S3.1
M
S3.1/BAF9.17
M
+6
1
-7
N
F23
F39
FAI35
M
1 3
4 6
7
8
9 11
16
13 15 17
18
14
12
10
5
2
2
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
S3.1/CAB3.5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
2
2
5
CAB3
S3
CAB73 1 CAB94.1/CAB73.1.1
1
N
F1 CAB94
BAF12
1
2
3
6
5 7
8
9
10 12
11
1
15
16
17
18
13
F23 - 30A
14
F39 - 20A
4
F1- 10A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
BAF12.4/S6.1
S6
B
CAB95.1/S6.1
1
B
18
FAI31
CAB95
S11 BAF12.15/S11.1
M
BAF12.17/S11.1
M
S11.1/CAB96.1
1
M
CAB96
1
X4
MA-10-06044A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.7
Electrical diagrams Left-hand side cigarette lighter 2 19 FAI 15 FAI 31 FAI 124 FAI 126
Fuse box Cigarette lighter socket Roof harness Cab Dyna VT transmission harness LST pillar harness Lighting harness - Europe
2
2 F23 BAF12 17
18 16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
F23 - 30A 1 X4
BAF12.15/S7.1
S11
M
S11.1/CAB97.1
M
FAI 31 CAB97
1 2 3 4
CAB97
1 2 3 4
4
3
2
1
X1
S3.1/R43.1
S3
M
S3.1/R2.6
M
6
5
4
3
2
1
6 5 4 3 2 1 R2
R3.6/R10.1 R3.5/R10.1
N N
6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI15
R43
1
3
1
6
4
R3
6 5 4 3 2 1
ROOF2.6/CAB_97.1
3
1
6
4
6 5 4 3 2 1 ROOF3
6
5
4
3
2
1
4
1
2
M
FAI126
FAI124
ROOF2
CAB103.3/ROOF3.6 ROOF3.5/CAB103.3
3
CAB103.3/X1.1
N
1
CAB103 CAB103
N N 3
1
6
4
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
6
5
4
3
2
1
MA-10-06041A
1 R10 R44
19
1
R44.1/R49.1
N
N
1 R49
10A02.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Power socket 2 63 FAI 31 FAI 70
Fuse box Cab interior electrical socket Cab Dyna VT transmission harness Cab interior electrical socket harness
2
FAI31 X4
F26 - 30A
FAI70
6
5
4
3
2
1
3
2
1
6
5
4
S14.1/BAF12.18 BAF12.16/S14.1
CAB88 6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF12.13/CAB88.6 R CAB88.5/CAB73.2.1 N CAB88.4/CAB73.2.1 N S14.1/CAB88.3 M CAB88.1/S14.1
S14
M
CAB88
16
15
14
13
2
1
4
3
17
5
18 2
1
1
3
1
4
2
6
1
5
3
7
1
8
4
9
1
10
5
M
1
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F52 - 10A
X1X5 1
2 4
5
3
R10
1
BAF12
X2
11
12
1
M
1
63
F26 CAB73 2
F52
1
R10
2
MA-10-06048A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.9
Electrical diagrams Horn Fuse box Start switch Wiper control unit Horn Fuse box supply harness Fuse box Ground harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness
2
F53
ENG1
1
26
25
X4
1
X3
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 BAF8.6/S13.1 7 8 9 10
X1X5
(4) 56
X4.1/PLUS_CAB.1
13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 M 3 2 1
M S13 S13.1/CAB17.3
CAB17
(3) (8) 30 Sx
(9) Dx
(12) (1) (11) 31b 53b 53
FAI13
+ CAB
1
2
12 24
8
3
27
23
4 13 14
7
4
11
1 5 15
26
22
13
6
5
R
7
CAB17.7/BAF9.12
8
B
9
BAF10.4/ENG1.28
10
B
11
ENG1.28/ENG12.1
12
N
13
ENG11.1/ENG9.1
14
1
15
2
16
3
17
4 10 3
1
1
18
6
14
5
16 27
F53 - 25A
9
6
16 15
25
7
24
17 28
28
6 5
13
8
4 12
21
8 2 7
29
F60 - 10A
20
31 19
17
1
11 23
86
FAI35
BAF8
18
ENG1
29
2 F35
87
30
18
R15
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
30
30
7
F35 - 7.5A
85
19 2
9
8 9 3
R15
BAF9
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 BAF10
31
20 21 10 22
10
1
11
ENG9
FAI129
FAI35
12
ENG12
1
13
ENG11
14
1
15
1
16
1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
17
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
55
18
2 3 22 55 FAI 13 FAI 17 FAI 35 FAI 129
I
R
(13) J
O
(7) 53C
klaxon
J
II lave vitre
56b (5)
3
1
L (10)
H (2)
FAI35
CAB22
2
56a (6)
X3.1/CAB22.1
B
5
1
22
4
X1X5.1/MASSE_BAF.1 N
3
N 1
10A02.10
¤ H
FAI17
MA-10-06040A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Front windscreen wiper Fuse box Wiper control unit Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness Fender lighting harness (US) US lighting harness Front windscreen wiper motor Windscreen washer pump
22 CAB17
1
2
3
4
F53- 25A
6 4
R
9
2
B
3
10
R
CAB17.12/S9.1
R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
(4) 56
(3) (8) 30 Sx
(12) (1) (11) 31b 53b 53
(9) Dx
I
(13) J
O
(7) 53C
klaxon
J
II lave vitre
56b (5)
L (10)
56a (6)
H (2)
CAB17
X4
3
2
1
6
5
4
31
20
CAB41
21
22
CAB41.2/CAB17.11
87a
1 2 3 4 5 6
B
BAF8 86
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
87
1 X1X5
BAF8.2/CAB41.3
R
CAB41.3/BAF8.4
R
12
28 16
15
13 24
29 17
6 5
27
14 25
26
CAB41
CAB41 S9.1/BAF8.8 BAF8.10/S9.1
R R
S9 1
CAB20
1
2 6 8
4
5 7 9
10
3
2
1 2
1 2
FAI127
CAB20 LIG1.20/CAB20.2 CAB28 CAB41.6/CAB28.1
N
1
F60-10A
20
31 30
17
R15
1 LIG3
LIG23.1/LIG3.1
LIG23 R12
1 2
1 2 LIG23
LIG23
1 2
FAI36
N
12 13 24
14 26
23
4
15 27
22 11
1 5
16
GROUND
10 3
6
28
F53-25A
9 2
7
29
21
8 19
18
2
4
23
18 7
1
11
1 2 3 4 5 6
30 19
2 3
25
B
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
B
30
85
8 9
10
R12
LIG1.20/LIG23.2
1
6
87
8
X3
5
1 CAB41.1/BAF7.2 2 3 BAF7.4/CAB41.1 4 5 CAB17.13/BAF7.6 6 7 8 9 10
86
7
85
9
1
5
30
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
7
11 12 13
FAI35
BAF7
B B
1
F60 - 10A
2
CAB17.1/CAB41.4 CAB20.2/CAB17.2
8
R15
10
2 22 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 127 CAB41 LIG23
LIG1 LIG1
MA-10-06042A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.11
Electrical diagrams
BAF3.11/ROOF4.6
R
B
ROOF2 R2 1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
S7.1/R7.8
B
R7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
+8 1
+3
4
6
1
2
2
-7
5
M
R4
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
R21.3/R7.2 R7.6/R21.2 R2.3/R21.1
4
3
4
5
6
2
3
7
4 3 2 1 R21
R
6
5
4 3 2 1
B B R
R21
1
2
CAB3.3/S2.1
7
BAF9.5/S2.1 R S3.1/CAB3.5
8
S2
R4
R4.6/S7.1
S3.1/BAF9.17
M
M
B
3
1
8
2
5
5
6
2 3
6
N N
1
4
1
1
4
R49 R7.7/R49.1 R21.4/R49.1
FAI35
CAB3
R15 CAB3.7/CAB28.1
N
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
F39-20A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
+3
+6
R21 1
-7
2
2
MA-10-06055A
5
4 7
5
6 3
6 5
1 8
2
2
3 2
CAB3
1
CAB03
CAB28
10A02.12
¤ H
R
R7
4
S3
F46-15A
F1-10A
R2.3/R7.5
2
9
F60-10A
10
BAF9 BAF9
11
16
12
17
18
13
15
14
14
13
12
15
11
10
16
9
8
17
7
6
B
1
X4
R7.1/R7.6
3
1
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF9.15/S3.1
F39 - 20A
5
6
FAI15
18
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
X3
3
5
S7
1
4
4
R7
1 2
4 5 6
3
5
4
2
ROOF2.3/BAF3.14
BAF3
1
7
7
F1-10A
2
3
4
86
F60-10A
2
2
8
30
87
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
X1X5
85
1
BAF3
F46-15A
R15
8
1
1
3
14
6
12
2
10
1
8
4
6
3
4
6
2
FAI124
5
13
8
11
7
9
9
7
10
5
11
3
12
1
14
Fuse box Roof harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness LST pillar harness Road lights switch Rear windscreen wiper switch Rear windscreen wiper motor
13
2 FAI 15 FAI 35 FAI 124 CAB03 R7 R21
1
Rear windscreen wiper
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Cab suspension 2 29 FAI 37 FAI 126 CAB108
Fuse box Control unit Fender lighting harness Lighting harness - Europe Suspended cab switch 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI126 LIG_1.23/X9.1 LIG_1.22/X9.1 X9.1/CAB108.2
R R
R
X1.1/CAB108.7
CAB108
+8
N
X1
CAB108 1 2 3 LIG_1.24/CAB108.3 4 5 6 7 8 LIG_1.25/CAB108.8
3
1
-7
N
2
B
B
1 8
1
2
20
31
3
30
CAB
7
4
5
17
22
15 26
24
X9
4
6
5
N
LIG3
28
6 16 15 27
14 25
3
7
29 17
1 5 13
25
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
18 7
4 12
1
8
1
30 19
3
23
N
31
2
11
12 24
B B
8 9
22
13 14
21 10
23
4 5
16 27
LIG1.22/LIG2.1 R LIG1.23/LIG2.2 R LIG3.1/LIG2.3 N LIG3.1/LIG2.4 N
LIG3.1/LIG2.7
LIG1 LIG1
11
1 6
28
10 3
LIG2
LIG1.25/LIG2.6 LIG1.24/LIG2.5
20
9
7
29
6
2
29
FAI37
21
8 19
18
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
26
1
F49 - 50A
2
X4
R16
1 30
85
86
X1X5
F49-50A
1
87
R16
X3 1
2
MA-10-06014A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.13
Electrical diagrams Pneumatic seat 2 Fuse box FAI 31 Cab Dyna VT transmission harness CAB103 Pneumatic seat adjustment control
2
CAB103
BAF12.12/S2.1 BAF12.11/S2.1
R R
CAB103
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
FAI31
6
5
4
3
2
1
2
15
1
16
S2
R
17
S2.1/CAB103.1
18
1 2
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
X2
F19 - 25A
1
+APC
BAF12
CAB73 2 CAB103.2/CAB73.2.1
N
1
2
F19
MA-10-06049A
10A02.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Radio - Europe (except Germany) Fuse box Laser radio Loudspeaker Cab Dyna VT transmission harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness Roof harness (all countries except US) LST pillar harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness Lights module and radio ground harness Road lights switch
F60-10A
F47-10A
F39-20A
36
37
37 R15
F1-10A
F23-30A
2
6
8
1
3
5
7
6
5
4
3
8
4
2
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
R8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
R9
R9
R41
1
R22
1
R45
1
R20
1
R41
1
R22
1
R45
1
R20
1
R22.1/R9.6 N R41.1/R9.5 B R9.4/R20.1 N R9.3/R45.1 B
S2
BAF9.5/S2.1
S3
2
R
S3.1/BAF9.15
M
S3.1/BAF9.17
M
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF9
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF9
FAI 35
B M
R8
7
FAI 60
1
2 36 37 FAI 31 FAI 35 FAI 60 FAI 124 FAI 129 FAI 135 CAB03
R8.6/S7.1 S3.1/R8.7
CAB03
CAB3
+3
+6
1
2
-7
5
2
F39 - 20A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CAB3.3/S2.1
R
S3.1/CAB3.5
M BAF12
CAB3.7/CAB28.1
N
1
CAB28
BAF12.15/S11.1
FAI 124 FAI 31
CAB97 S3
S3.1/R2.6
M
6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI 60 6
5
4
3
2
1
R2
ROOF2.6/CAB97.1
6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4
M
3
2
1
6
5
4
3
4
1
2
S11.1/CAB97.1
1 2 3 4 CAB97
4
3
2
1
20
31
5
4
R1.3/R8.4
R
R8.8/R1.6
N
3
1 2 3 4 5 6
22 11 23
4 12
5
16
13 24
14
27 26
ROOF1.3/BAF3.13
10 3
1 6
28
1
2
9 2
7
29
21
8
18
4
15
1 2 3 4 5 6
25
R
R1.6/CAB38.1
N 3 2 1
FAI 124
3 2 1
CAB38 CAB38
1 S7
R4.6/S7.1
6
5
4
3
2
1
B
6 5 4 3 2 1 R4
6 5 4 3 2 1 ROOF4
BAF3.11/ROOF4.6
3
2
1
6
5
4
B
2
3
F23 - 30A
1 X4
1 F60 - 10A
BAF3
17
ROOF1
F1- 10A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
X1-X5
BAF12
19
6
M M
M
30
5
6
R1
BAF12.17/S11.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
ROOF2
1
2
3
S11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
3
2
1
FAI 35
CAB38.1/ENG1.2
N
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31
20 21
8 9
10 22
18
4 12
17 16
5 15
27
14 25
28
6
13 24
29
7 1
11 23
30 19
2 3
26
R15 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1
30
X3 85
86
87a
87
BAF3
FAI129 ENG22 ENG1.2/ENG22.1
N
1 ENG22
1
F47 - 10A
FAI135 ENG22.1/BAT1.1
N
1 BAT1
MA-10-06054A
ENG1 ENG1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.15
Electrical diagrams Radio - North America 2 36 37 FAI 15 FAI 31 FAI 35 FAI 60 FAI 124 FAI 129 FAI 135 CAB03
Fuse box Laser radio Loudspeaker Roof harness Cab Dyna VT transmission harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness Roof harness (all countries except US) LST pillar harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness Lights module and radio ground harness Road lights switch
F60-10A
37
F47-10A
F39-20A
37
36
R15
F1-10A
F23-30A
FAI 15 2
2
1
3
R22.1/R9.6 R41.1/R9.5 R9.4/R20.1 R9.3/R45.1
4 3 2 1
4
R41
1
R22
1
R45
1
R20
1
R41
1
R22
1
R45
1
R20
1
N B N B
S2
BAF9.5/S2.1
R9 S3
M
S3.1/BAF9.17
M
1 2 3 4 B M
R8
R
S3.1/BAF9.15
2
FAI 35
4
3
R8.6/S7.1 S3.1/R8.7
1
CAB03
2
+6
5
2
F39 - 20A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
2
-7
CAB3.3/S2.1
R
S3.1/CAB3.5
M BAF12
CAB3.7/CAB28.1
N
1
CAB28
BAF12.15/S11.1
FAI 124 FAI 31
CAB97 S3
S3.1/R2.6
M
6 5 4 3 2 1
6
5
4
3
2
1
R2
ROOF2.6/CAB97.1
6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4
M
3
2
1
6
5
4
3
4
1
2
S11.1/CAB97.1
1 2 3 4 CAB97
4
3
2
1
6
5
4
20
R8.8/R1.6
4
3
R
N
26
ROOF1.3/BAF3.13
23
4 12 13 24
14
27
22 11
5
16 15
1 2 3 4 5 6
10 3
1 6
28
1
2
9 2
7
29
21
8
18
5
17
R1
R1.3/R8.4
25
R
R1.6/CAB38.1
CAB38
N 3 2 1
ROOF1
FAI 124
3 2 1
CAB38
1 S7
R4.6/S7.1
6
5
4
3
2
1
B
6 5 4 3 2 1 R4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
ROOF2
6
1 2 3 4 5 6
M M
6 5 4 3 2 1 ROOF4
BAF3.11/ROOF4.6
2
3
3
2
1
B
FAI 35 3
2
1
6
5
4
F1- 10A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
F23 - 30A
1 X4
1 F60 - 10A
BAF3
31
1
BAF12.17/S11.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
X1-X5
BAF12
19
2
S11
M
30
3
BAF9 BAF9
CAB3
+3
1
FAI 60
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB38.1/ENG1.2
N
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31
20 21
8 9
10 22
18
12
17 16 15 27
14 25
28
6 5
13 24
29
7 1
4
23
30 19
2 3
11
26
R15 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1
30
X3 85
86
87a
87
BAF3
F47 - 10A
FAI129 ENG22 ENG1.2/ENG22.1
N
1
ENG22.1/BAT1.1
1
N
1
ENG22
FAI135
BAT1
MA-10-06039A
ENG1 ENG1
10A02.16
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Radio - Germany Fuse box Laser radio Loudspeaker Radio harness Cab Dyna VT transmission harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness Roof harness (all countries except US) LST pillar harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness Lights module and radio ground harness Road lights switch
F60-10A
F47-10A
F39-20A 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
HP
HP
37
F1-10A
1
3
6
5 3
8
4
6
1
4
2
8
FAI 22
2
2 F23-30A
R41
1
R22
1
R45
1
R20
1
R41
1
R22
1
R45
1
R20
1
4 3 2 1
R22.1/R9.1 R41.1/R9.3 R9.2/R20.1 R9.1/R45.1
N B N B
S2
FAI 60 1
ALIM
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
2
S3
FAI 35 CAB03
FAI 22
2
1
2
2
5
2
CAB3.3/S2.1
R
S3.1/CAB3.5
M N
CAB28
BAF12.15/S11.1
S3.1/R8.2
FAI 31
CAB97 S3.1/R2.6
M
6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI 60 6
5
4
3
2
1
1 2 3 4
M
3
2
1
6
5
4
3
4
1
2
S11.1/CAB97.1
1 2 3 4
S11
BAF12.17/S11.1
M M
M
CAB97
4
3
2
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
ROOF2
R8.1/S7.1
20
31
1
6
5
4
18
5
6
4
17
R1
ROOF1
3
R8.3/R1.3
R
R8.4/R1.6
N
1 2 3 4 5 6
26
ROOF1.3/BAF3.13
23
4 12 13 24
14
27
22 11
5
16 15
1 2 3 4 5 6
10 3
1 6
28
1
2
9 2
7
29
21
8 19
2
25
R
R1.6/CAB38.1
N 3 2 1
FAI 124
3 2 1
CAB38 CAB38
1 S7
R4.6/S7.1
6
5
4
3
2
1
B
6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
R4 ROOF4
BAF3.11/ROOF4.6
3
2
1
6
5
4
2
3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
F1- 10A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
1
F23 - 30A
X4
1 X1-X5 F60 - 10A
BAF3
30
3
BAF9
BAF12
B
R2
ROOF2.6/CAB97.1
6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF9
BAF12 CAB3.7/CAB28.1
FAI 124
S3
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F39 - 20A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
4
3
M
+6
1
1
M
S3.1/BAF9.17
CAB3
+3
-7
1 2 3 4
R
S3.1/BAF9.15
4
3
M
R8
F002_RETRO_ECLAIRAGE_RADIO 0_6MM_BLANC F003_PLUS_PERMANENT_RADIO 1MM_MARRON F004_MASSE 1MM_NOIR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
F001_PLUS_ACC_RADIO 1MM_ROUGE
ALIM
BAF9.5/S2.1
R9
7
5
37 R15
F005_HP_DROIT 0_6MM_BLANC F006_HP_DROIT 0_6MM_NOIR F007_HP_GAUCHE 0_6MM_BLANC F008_HP_GAUCHE 0_6MM_NOIR
36
7
2 36 37 FAI 22 FAI 31 FAI 35 FAI 60 FAI 124 FAI 129 FAI 135 CAB03
3
2
1
FAI 35
B
CAB38.1/ENG1.2
N
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31
20 21
8 9
10 22
18
12
17 16 15 27
14 25
28
6 5
13 24
29
7 1
4
23
30 19
2 3
11
26
R15 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
30
X3 85
86
87a
87
BAF3
FAI129 ENG1.2/ENG22.1
F47 - 10A
FAI135 N
1
1
ENG22 ENG22
ENG22.1/BAT1.1
N
1 BAT1
MA-10-06037A
ENG1 ENG1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.17
Electrical diagrams Manual air conditioning for standard roof
FAI124
BAF3.11/ROOF4.6
2
R15 30
1
ROOF4 R4
CAB3.7/CAB28.1
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
3
2
1
6
5
4
1 2 3 4 5 6
R6 R4.6/S7.1
S7
B
B
CAB28
8
1
2
7
4
5
3
6
FAI15
S3.1/CAB3.5
BAF9.5/S2.1 86
S2
R
CAB3.3/S2.1
M
R
R6
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
+3
1
CAB3
2
-7
2
R6.1/S7.1 R1.1/R6.2 S2.1/R6.3 R1.4/R6.4
+6
B R R B
1 2 3 4
3
4
1
2
5
CAB3
R14
FAI35
M
M S3.1/BAF9.17
S3
BAF9.15/S3.1
1 3
4 6
7
8
9 11
16
14
15 17
18
13
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
12
10
5
2
BAF9
87
85
4
2
B
2
1 3
8
5 7 9
14
10
11
12
13
F1- 10A
30
5
1 2 3 4 5 6
BAF3
F60 - 10A
85
6 3
1
X3
4
Fuse box Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness LST pillar harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness Compressor electromagnetic clutch Air conditioning condenser pressure switch Air conditioning control
6
2 FAI 35 FAI 124 FAI 129 ENG13 ENG14 R6
ROOF1.2/X10.1 ROOF1.1/X10.1
86
87
3
2
1
6
5
4
6 5 4 3 2 1
R R
ROOF1
X1X5
6
5
4
3
2
1
6 5 4 3 2 1
R1.2/S2.1
S2
R
R1
F39-20A 1
X10 1 F50-50A X4 1
F11 - 10A
+12V
X2 1
+APC
87
1
2 6
4
5
8 14
7 9
10
11
12
13
R29
86
3
26
22
23 12 24
25
BAF1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
BAF1.5/BAF1.6
BAF1.8/ROOF1.4
CAB38.3/BAF1.12
FAI124
B
B
FAI35 B
3 2 1
ENG1.21/CAB38.3
3 2 1
CAB38 CAB38
1
2
3
3
2
1
R29
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
31 8
9 10
22 11
4 13 14
27
30
10 3
1 5 15
21
ENG1
9 2
7 6 16
85
21
8 19
18 17
20
20
31 30
29 28
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
30 19 18
2 1 4
12
17 16 15 27
14 25
28
6 5
13 24
29
7
3 11
23
26
FAI129 ENG1.21/ENG14.1
B
ENG14.2/ENG13.1
B
1
ENG14
1 2
1
ENG13
1
1 2
ENG1
F50 ENG14
ENG13
R14
F39
2
MA-10-06050A
F1
F11
10A02.18
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Manual air conditioning for high visibility roof 2 FAI 35 FAI 59 FAI 124 FAI 126 FAI 129 ENG13 ENG14 R6
Fuse box Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness High visibility roof harness LST pillar harness Lighting harness - Europe SisuDiesel EEM engine harness Compressor electromagnetic clutch Air conditioning condenser pressure switch Air conditioning control
R6 1 R11
1 R10
2
R15 30
R6 85
86
6
5
4
3
2
1
CAB103
87
CAB103.3/X1.1
N
3
2
1
6
5
4
1
2
3
6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
5
6
N N
CAB103
1 30
85
+12V ACC
3
2
1
6
5
4
R14 ROOF1.2/X10.1 ROOF1.1/X10.1
86
87
6 5 4 3 2 1 ROOF3
X3
5
4
2
1
R1.4/R6.1 R1.1/R6.2
B R
4
CAB103.3/ROOF3.6 ROOF3.5/CAB103.3
FAI126 F60 - 10A
6 3
R R
6 5 4 3 2 1 ROOF1
X1X5
6 5 4 3 2 1
R3.6/R10.1 R3.5/R10.1
N N
R6.5/R11.1
N
R1.2/R6.7
R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
7
R3
4 6
5
4
3
2
1
5
6 3
2
1
FAI59
6 5 4 3 2 1 R1
1
X10 F50-50A
1
X4 1
F11 - 10A
+12V
X2 1
+APC
15
BAF1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
BAF1.5/BAF1.6
BAF1.8/ROOF1.4
B
B
FAI35 CAB38 CAB38.3/BAF1.12
B
3 2 1
ENG1.21/CAB38.3
3 2 1
CAB38 3
1
2
24
2
1
87
13 25
FAI124
4 6 8
3 5 7 9
10
11
12
13
86
14
30
85
22
23 12
14 26
22 11
4
2
R29
3
2
1
31 8
9 10
10 3
1 5
27
21
ENG1
9 2
7 6 16
R29
21
8 19
18 17
20
20
31 30
29 28
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
30 19 18
2 1 4
17 16 15
13 24
27
14 25
28
6 5
12
29
7
3 11
23
26
FAI129
ENG1.21/ENG14.1
B
ENG14.2/ENG13.1
1
ENG14
1 2
B
1
ENG13
1
1 2
ENG1
ENG14
ENG13
R15 R14
F39
F50
MA-10-06047A
F1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
F11
10A02.19
Electrical diagrams Automatic air conditioning
5
1
5
CAB27.2/ENG2.28 ENG2.29/CAB27.1
CA4
B B
CA2
1
FAI
R33 2
3
3
2
1
2
CA9
1
4
5 4 3 2 1
CA9.3/CAB38.1 B S1.1/CA9.2 R
R
B R
S1.1/CA10.5
CA10.3/R34.1 S1.1/CA10.2
R S1.1/CA9.5
1
R49
1 2
R33.1/R49.1
B
CA1.23/CA10.1 B CA1.24/CA3.B B CA1.25/CA3.A B CA9.1/CA1.26 B
CA1.15/CA6.1 CA6.2/CA1.16 CA1.22/CA3.E
CA6.3/S1.1
R
CA3
CA3
A B C D E F G H
A B C D E F G H
R
3 2 1
M B B
CA6
6
CAB3
F1-10A
F23-30A +12V ACC
2
46 24 1
M
M
2
BAF12.15/S11.1
BAF12.17/S11.1
68 45 23
3
4 6
5 7
8
9
10
11
12 14
13
1
1 2 3 4 5 6
B
3
2
1
6
5
4
4
3
2
1
CAB97
M
1 2 3 4 5 6
F
C
E
D
3
2
1
6
5
4
R4.6/S7.1
S7
B
S7.1/R50.2
B
ROOF3
R3
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
6
5
4
3
2
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
3
4
1
2
ROOF2.6/CAB97.1
CAB103.3/ROOF3.5 CAB103.3/ROOF3.6
CAB103
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55
10A02.20
4 3 2 1
R10 R3.5/R10.1 R3.6/R10.1
N N
1
FAI15
R6
6
5
4
3
2
1
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
3
2
1
6
5
4
S3.1/R2.6
M
S3
S3.1/R50.1
M
M
CAB97
6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
N
4 3 2 1
4 3 2 1
3
2
1
6
5
4
N N
BAF1.8/ROOF1.4 R
CAB1
+12V
16
4
2
5
ROOF1.2/X10.1
CAB01
15
3
5
ROOF2 R2
CAB103.3/X1.1
17
2
6 3
CAB3
2
-7
FAI126
S3
18
CA2
1 2
B
1
CAB103
1
X3
2 1
ROOF4 R4
B
+6
S11.1/CAB97.1
F39-20A
1
+3
FAI31
R S2
S11
R14
1
B BAF9.5/S2.1
X4
F23 - 30A
R50
R6.1/S7.1
3
5
R
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
CAB27
3
2
1
6
5
4
B
6 5 4 3 2 1 ROOF1
6 5 4 3 2 1
R1.4/R6.4
B
R1.2/S2.1
R
R1
6
5
4
3
2
1
S2
S2.1/R50.3
ENG1
FAI35 CAB38.3/ENG1.21
CAB1.33/ENG1.27
21
8 19
18
9
15
1 2 1
ENG14
ENG2.29/S2.1 B ENG2.28/ENG27.1 B
1
1
ENG13
1 2
ENG27 ENG27
1 2
1
T° 31
20 21
8 9
29
7
ENG13
27
14
31 8
26
25
ENG2
18
16 27
26
10 11 23
4 12
5 15
13 24
14 26
22
3 1
6
28
21 9
2 7
29 17
28 16 27
15 14
8 19
29 17
6 5
13
20
31 30
18 7
1 4
12 24
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
30
2 3
11 23
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
19
9
15
13 25
20
22
16
5
12
10
28
6
24
21
17
1 4
24
analog
18
2 3
11
25
30 19
10
23
13 14
26
B
2
ENG1
23 12
S2
B
FAI129 ENG14.2/ENG13.1
22
11 4
5
27
S2.1/ENG1.27
22
3 1
6 16
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
10
2 7
17
B
20
31 30
29 28
B
R
ENG2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
S2.1/ENG27.2
6 8
11
12 14
FAI35
BAF12
CAB27
2 1
S2.1/R6.3
2
4
CAB3.3/S2.1
X10
F50-50A
1
M M
16
1
7
M
BAF9.15/S3.1 S3.1/BAF9.17
15 17
8
B
87
1
CAB38-.1/S1.1
3 2 1
1
2
FAI124
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB3.7/CAB28.1
1
F50 - 50A
CAB38
1 CAB28
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
2 1
3 2 1
B
86
CAB38 CAB38
BAF3.11/ROOF4.6
X1X5 85
1
CAB38
S3.1/CAB3.5
BAF9
CA4
S1
B
3
F39 - 20A
30
ENG1.21/CAB38.1
3 2 1
2
1
R14
4
5 7
3
F60 - 10A
18
87
13
9
1
2
3
4 6
7
8
9
10
11
86
13
85
12
30
14
R15
5
F1- 10A
10
86
4 3 2 1
3
1
BAF3
87
4
FAI56
+12V
1 2 3 4 BAF1.5/BAF1.6 R 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 BAF1.12/CAB38.3 B 12 13 14
87a
3
A
H
CA1.21/CA3.G
BAF1
85
2
B
G
FAI57
1
30
1
1 2
CA1.9/CA3.C B CA1.10/CA3.H B
X2
R29
R34
N
S1
F11 - 10A
R34
2 1
2
R33
3
2 1 CA10
B B
5 4 3 2 1
N B B
S1.1/CA1.17
2
2
B
CA1
1
1 2
1
CA3.F/CAB27.2 CA3.E/CAB27.1
1
4 3
CA1.5/CA7.1 CA1.6/CA3.F CA1.7/CA3.D
2
1
CA1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
3
CA3.D/CA4.4 B CA3.C/CA4.3 B CA3.B/CA4.2 B CA3.A/CA4.1 B
2 CA7
2
5
5
5
CA3.H/CA2.2 B CA3.G/CA2.1 B
3
5
1
¤ H
B
CA10
ENG1.21/ENG14.1
FAI 129 CAB01 ENG13 ENG14 ENG27
R34.2/R33.2
CA9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
FAI 57 FAI 60 FAI 124 FAI 125 FAI 126
Fuse box Automatic air conditioning control unit Roof harness Cab Dyna VT transmission harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness Automatic air conditioning - Instrument panel harness Automatic air conditioning - Roof harness Roof harness (all countries except US) Pillar harness Automatic air conditioning adapter harness Cab interior lighting harness (all countries except US) SisuDiesel EEM engine harness DCC2 Instrument panel Compressor electromagnetic clutch Air conditioning condenser pressure switch Outside temperature sensor
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
2 34 FAI 15 FAI 31 FAI 35 FAI 56
25
ENG14 CAB-38 1 2 3
1 2 3
S1.1/CAB38_.1
3
1
2
B
FAI125 MA-10-06046A
CAB-38 2
1
3
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Standard ventilation for standard roof 2 FAI 15 FAI 35 FAI 124 CAB03 R6
Fuse box Roof harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness LST pillar harness Road lights switch Ventilation control
6
5
4
3
2
1
FAI124
2
BAF3.11/ROOF4.6
3
2
1
6
5
4
R4.6/S7.1
B
ROOF4 R4 1 2 3 4 5 6
B
1 2 3 4 5 6
R6 S7
2 4
3 7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
5
F1- 10A
6
1
BAF3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1
8
1
2
3
CAB28
7
4
5
6
FAI 15 CAB3.7/CAB28.1
BAF9.5/S2.1
S3.1/CAB3.5
M
CAB3.3/S2.1
R
S__2
R
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
B
R6 +3
1
-7
2
2
R6.1/S7.1 R1.1/R6.2 S2.1/R6.3
+6
CAB03
B R R
1 2 3 4
3
4
1
2
5
CAB3
FAI 35
M
M
S3
BAF9.15/S3.1
16
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
S3.1/BAF9.17
6
1 3
4
5 7
8
9
10 12
15 17
14
11 85
18
13
R14
30
2
BAF9
ROOF1.2/X10.1 ROOF1.1/X10.1
86
87
R R
3
2
1
6
5
4
6 5 4 3 2 1 ROOF1
X1X5
6 5 4 3 2 1
6
5
4
3
2
1
R1.2/S2.1
R
S2
R1
F39-20A 1
FAI 124
X10 1 F50-50A X4 1
+12V
2 X3 1
30
85
+ACC
R60
R15
86
87
R15
F60-10A
R14 F39
F50
MA-10-06052A
F1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.21
Electrical diagrams Standard ventilation for high visibility roof 2 FAI 59 FAI 124 R6
Fuse box High visibility roof harness LST pillar harness Ventilation control
1 R11
R6 R6 R1.1/R6.2
R
R6.5/R11.1
N
R1.2/R6.7
R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2 7 4
3
2
1
6
5
4
6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
ROOF1
R1
R14
85
ROOF1.2/X10.1 ROOF1.1/X10.1
86
87
X1X5
2
1
FAI 59
FAI 124
30
5
6 3
R R
6
5
4
3
2
1
1
X10 1 F50-50A X4 1
+12V
X3 1
30
85
R60
+ACC
R15
86
87
R15
2
F60-10A
R14
F50
MA-10-06053A
10A02.22
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Extreme cold weather air conditioning 2 43 FAI 15 FAI 124 R6 R33
Fuse box Manual air conditioning control unit Roof harness Pillar harness Ventilation control Water pump motor
R49 1
R33.1/R49.1
N
F60-10A
R33 F46-15A R15
R33/R47 1 2
2
1 2
FAI 15
43
ROOF2 R2
ROOF2.3/BAF3.14
FAI124
R
3
2
1
6
5
4
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
R34 R2.3/R21.1 6
5
4
3
2
1
R
R21.1/R34.1 R34.2/R33.2
R B
1 2
R6
1
BAF3
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
F46 - 15A
2 X4 1
+12V
R21 1 2 3 4
R15
F60
30
- 10A
4
1
2
X3 1
85
3
86
+12V ACC
87
X1X5 1 MA-10-06051A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.23
Electrical diagrams Electrical rear view mirrors
R2
2
FAI 49
2
+3
-7
F39-20A 1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
R2
R2
R4
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
R4
5
F1-10A
2
R4 R1.5/R4.1 B R4.2/S1.1 N R2.3/R4.3 R R1.2/R4.4 B S2.1/R4.5 B
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
N
Fuse box Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness Electric rear view harness Roof harness (all countries except US) Pillar harness Road lights switch Rear view mirror adjustment switch Rear view mirror defroster switch Right-hand rear viw mirror Left-hand rear view mirror
+8
2 FAI 35 FAI 49 FAI 60 FAI 124 CAB03 R1 R2 R4 R5
1
3
2
R2.7/S1.1
F14-7.5A
4
ROOF3
N
R5 FAI 49
S1.1/R5.2
R R
1
R2.2/R1.8 R2.3/R5.3
N N
N B N
R10 R3.5/R10.1 R3.6/R10.1
R N N
6 5 4 3 2 1
R40.2/S1.1 R40.3/R2.8 R1.4/S1.1
ROOF3.5/X1.1 X1.1/ROOF3.6
6 5 4 3 2 1
R40.1/R2.2
S1
R5
R5
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 5
R3
X1
B
R4.6/S7.1
ROOF4
S7 R40.3/S7.1 B R49.1/R40.2 N R40.1/ROOF4.1 R B
3 2 1
B
3 2 1
5
S2
4
1
3
2
R40
1
1
2
B
1 2
R
R1.7/S2.1
4
2
1
5 4
6
5
2
BAF3.3/ROOF4.1
FAI 49 R40
S2.1/R5.5
FAI 60
3
F14 - 7.5A
BAF3.11/ROOF4.6
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
3
F1- 10A
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
6
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
B B
ROOF4
FAI124 BAF3
R1.1/R5.4 R1.6/R5.1
1
2
3
BAF3
3 1
M
FAI 35 CAB03 CAB3
BAF9.5/S2.1
R
S_2 CAB3.3/S2.1 S_3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
+3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
-7
2
2
R1
R1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
MIRRORS L
R
+6
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
5
CAB3
MA-10-06038A
4 7
5
1
2
X4
+12V 1
6
BAF9
1
X2
R
S3.1/CAB3.5 M
8
F39 - 20A
R1 FAI 49
R49/R12
M
S3.1/BAF9.17
3
BAF9
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF9.15/S3.1
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB28
+12V
CAB3.7/CAB28.1
N
10A02.24
¤ H
1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Door switch Fuse box Roof light Roof harness Cab Dyna VT transmission harness LST pillar harness Door switch
1
2
1
R24
6
3
7
8
9
10
5
X4
12
11
1
15
16
17
18
13
F23 - 30A
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 BAF12.15/S11.1 15 16 BAF12.17/S11.1 17 18
F23
2
2
BAF12
14
2 48 FAI 15 FAI 31 FAI 124 R24
FAI 31
M
S11
S11.1/CAB97.1
M
M
4
3
2
1
3
4
1
2
CAB97
1 2 3 4
CAB97
1 2 3 4
2
R24 1 2
S3.1/R46.1
M
S3
S3.1/R2.6
B
FAI 15
M
6
5
4
3
2
1
6 5 4 3 2 1
R24.2/R11.1
R2
R24.1/R49.1
R47.1/R49.1
1
R11
1
R46
1
6 5 4 3 2 1
ROOF2.6/CAB97.1
M
FAI124 3
1
6
4
ROOF2
N
N
R47 1
R49
48 MA-10-06056A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.25
Electrical diagrams Instrument panel controls Fuse box Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness DCC2 Instrument panel DOT MATRIX control keyboard Display selector switch
CAB1
68
24
1 23
45
46
CAB01
2
FAI35
F22
CAB31
2 1 1
CAB31
2
R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
CAB1.52/CAB31.2
B
S5.1/CAB31.1
2 FAI 35 CAB01 CAB16 CAB31
S5
9
7
5
3
1
10
8
6
4
2
BAF8.5/S5.1
R
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F22 - 10A
X2 1
+APC
BAF8
MA-10-06045A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2
5 6 7
CAB15
1 2 3
4
CAB16 CAB15.1/CAB16.1 CAB15.4/CAB16.2 CAB15.5/CAB16.3 CAB15.7/CAB16.4 CAB15.6/CAB16.5 CAB15.2/CAB16.6 CAB15.3/CAB16.7
B B B B B B B
6
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
CAB16
10A02.26
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Radar 2 FAI 35 FAI 129 FAI 130 CAB01 TR27
Fuse box Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness Cab Dyna VT transmission harness DCC2 Instrument panel Radar
CAB01
S24 CAB1.18/S24.1
TR31
1 8
4 12
28
6 16
5 15
13 24
FAI130
17
1
11 23
29
7
27
14 25
26
ENG10
TR27.1/TR31.1
1 2 3 4
TR27
S1.1/TR27.3
4
3
2
N R
ENG10.5/S1.1 TR27.2/ENG10.6 S1
1
2
4
5
6
12
11 10 9
8
7
3
R B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
ENG1.23/ENG10.6
S7.1/ENG10.5
R
B
S7
FAI129 6
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
1
1
ENG10 ENG1.8/S7.1
R
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
9 10
2 7
29 17
11
6
28
15
12 13 24
14
27 26
23
4 5
16
22
3 1
25
S24.1/ENG1.23
B
FAI35
BAF7.7/ENG1.8
B
CAB01
46 24 1
ENG1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
68 45 23
TR27
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
21
8 19
18
18
2
30
ENG1
30 19
9 3
20
31
31
20 21 10 22
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
CAB01
BAF7 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F16 - 30A
X2 1
2
+12V
9
7
5
3
1
10
8
6
4
2
BAF7
MA-10-06043A
F16-30A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.27
Electrical diagrams Fieldstar
1
FS5
9
FS5.7/S7.1
B FS4
FS5.2/S6.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37
FS4
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FS3
S7.1/FS3.6 S6.1/FS3.5
B B
S4.1/FS5.1
B B B B
R
FAI 68
FS3
F52
S4.1/FS3.1 FS3.2/S3.1 FS5.8/S3.1
BAF12
2 4 1
5
3
R10
M
R10
F26
CAB88
FAI 31
S14 S14.1/CAB88.1
M
S14.1/CAB88.3 M CAB73.2.1/CAB88.4 N CAB73.2.1/CAB88.5 N BAF12.13/CAB88.6 R
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 CAB88
BAF12 1 CAB73 2
CAB88A.1/CAB88.1 CAB88A.2/CAB88.2 CAB88A.3/CAB88.3 CAB88A.4/CAB88.4 CAB88A.5/CAB88.5 CAB88A.6/CAB88.6
K J
M B M N N R
H
N
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
R N N M M
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
FS1
3 2 9
4 1
5
FS1 N
BAF12.16/S14.1
M
S2
S3.1/CAB88.4
BAF12.18/S14.1
N
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F G
FS1 FS1.1/S3.1
FS1.6/S4.1 S3.1/FS1.7 S3 FS1.2/S3.1 FS1.3/S2.1 S2.1/FS1.4 M
F52 - 10A
X4
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB88.5/S3.1
1
A B
S4
CAB88.3/S2.1
F26 - 30A
R N N
E D C
FS2
+12V
2
FS2
P
N M L
R N N
1 4 7 2 5 8 3 6 9
FS4.26/FS3.9 FS4.25/FS3.8 FS4.24/FS3.7 S7 S7.1/FS4.5 S6 S6.1/FS4.6 B
M
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
A B C D E F G H J K L M N P
R
FS3
S4.1/FS4.31 R
FS5
FS2 A B C D E F G H J K L M N P
S4.1/FS4.37 FS2.E/S3.1 FS4.36/S3.1
1 4 7 2 5 8 3 6 9
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FS2.P/S2.1
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
15 22 28 33 37
B
FS5
33
4
5 10 16 23 29 34
FS2.H/S4.1 R CAB88.6/FS2.F
Fuse box Fieldstar terminal Cab Dyna VT transmission harness Fieldstar harness Cab interior electrical socket harness LBS+ Fieldstar connector Fieldstar Com Unit RS232 Fieldstar connector GPS Fieldstar connector
FS4.7/FS3.4
2 33 FAI 31 FAI 68 FAI 70 FS1 FS2 FS3 FS4
CAB88.1/S2.1
M
CAB88 1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
FAI 70
CAB88A MA-10-06059A
1
X2 +12V
X1X5 1
10A02.28
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Auxiliary hydraulics oil gauge FAI 23 FAI 31 FAI 35 FAI 128 FAI 130 CAB01 TR35
Cab linkage harness Cab Dyna VT transmission harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness Linkage with DUAL CONTROL harness Cab Dyna VT transmission harness DCC2 Instrument panel Auxiliary hydraulics oil gauge FAI23
L14.23/L20.8
B
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L14
L14
TR35 1
FAI128
TR31
FAI130 TR36 TR35 TR36.2/L14.23
B
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
TR36.2/TR35.1 TR35.2/TR31.1
B N
1 2
TR36
L20 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
CAB18
FAI31
L20.8/CAB18.7
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
FAI35 CAB18.7/CAB10.61
B
CAB18
L20
68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB01
CAB01
MA-10-06013A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.29
Electrical diagrams Emergency handbrake FAI 31 FAI 130 CAB54 TR20
Cab Dyna VT transmission harness Cab Dyna VT transmission harness Autotronic 4 Emergency handbrake switch
CAB54
68 45 23
46 24 1
CAB54
68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB50 30 19 18
9
17
11
15
12 13 24
14 26
23
4 5
16 27
22
3 1
6
28
10
2 7
29
21
21
8
25
CAB54.21/CAB50.20
B
FAI 31
CAB50.10/CAB54.1
N
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31
20
20
31
68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 CAB50
8
30
9 10 22
19 18
2
17
1
11 4
23
16 15
13
27
14
24 25
28
6 5
12
29
7
3
26
TR20.3/CAB50.20
B
FAI130
CAB50.10/S2.1
N
S2
4
TR20.4/S2.1
3
2
N
4 3 2 1
TR20
4 3 2 1
TR20
1
TR20
MA-10-06066A
CAB54
10A02.30
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams
B . Engine equipment Air filter vacuum sensor ........................................... 33 Fuel gauge ............................................................... 34 Sisu engine power relay........................................... 35 Vistronic ................................................................... 36 Fuel preheater .......................................................... 37 Battery charge and engine start ............................... 38
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.31
Electrical diagrams
Page left blank intentionally
10A02.32
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Air filter vacuum sensor
1
24
Air filter vacuum sensor Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness DCC2 Instrument panel 46
24 FAI 35 FAI 129 CAB01
24
1
ENG15
1
ENG16
ENG39 1
ENG15.1/ENG39.1
ENG1.20/ENG16.1
N
B
FAI129
N
17
11
1 6
28
15
12 13 24
14 26
23
4 5
16 27
22
3
25
68 8 9 10
10
22
18 17
1 4
16 15
13
27
14 25
28
6 5
12 24
29
7
3
23
30 19
2
11
B
31
20 21
9 2
7
29
CAB1.36/ENG1.20
21
8 19
18
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
20
31 30
ENG1
26
23
1
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
45
ENG1
CAB1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
CAB1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
CAB01
MA-10-06060A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.33
Electrical diagrams Fuel gauge DynaVT dipstick Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness Cab Dyna VT transmission harness DCC2 Instrument panel
FAI 35 31
20 21
8 9
10 22
30 19 18
2
17
1 4
28
6
12
16
5 15
13 24
29
7
3 11
23
CAB1.12/ENG1.25
27
14 25
26
ENG1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
ENG1
B
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
9
17
11
15
12 13 24
14
ENG9
25
ENG10.2/ENG9.1
N
1
FAI129
ENG10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
ENG10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1
2
4
5
6
12
11 10 9
8
7
3
6
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
1
B
S3.1/ENG10.2
N
26
23
4 5
16 27
22
3 1
6
28
10
2 7
29
21
8 19
18
ENG1.25/ENG10.1
20
31 30
1
TR22.1/S3.1
N
TR21.1/ENG10.1
FAI130
S3
TR21
1
TR22
39
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
46 24 1
CAB1 CAB1
CAB01
68 45 23
39 FAI 35 FAI 129 FAI 130 CAB01
MA-10-06062A
10A02.34
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Sisu engine power relay
20
31 30
22
ENG4
B ENG2.15/ENG4.15
ENG2.12/ENG4.7 B
1
26
24 25
2
27
14
3
13 25
28 16
15
4
17 6
5
24
29
7 1
4 12
6
18
2 3
11 23
5
10 22
30 19
7
8 9
8
31
20 21
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
9
FAI129
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
10
26
23
13 14
26
27
14 25
15 27
11
24
ENG2
12
15
12
13
16
5 13
22 11
4 5
16
14
12
28
6
10
1 6
28
17
1 4
21 9 3
17 29
7
3 11
23
18
2
2 7
29
15
10
18
30 19
16
8 9
8 19
31
20 21
17
Fuse box Grid Heater relay Fuse box supply harness Fuse box Ground harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness Electronic injection harness junction
18
2 61 FAI 13 FAI 17 FAI 35 FAI 129 ENG4
FAI35
S14 BAF10.5/ENG2.12
S14.1/ENG2.15
BAF10.7/S14.1
B
B
2 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 B 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2
5
3
R3
4 1
F30 - 15A
BAF10
FAI13
F42 - 5A
+CAB PLUS_CAB.1/X4.1
1
R
1 X4 1
X1X5
ENG2
F42
MASSE_BAF.1/X1.1
N
FAI17
F30
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 R3
2 1
ENG4
61 FAI129
ENG29_B/ENG25.1 R 1 1
ENG25
1
ENG25
FAI129
ENG29B
F- 225A
ENG29
ENG29.1/S11.1
M
S11
S11.1/ENG32.1
M
1 ENG32
1 MA-10-06061A
+BATT
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.35
Electrical diagrams Vistronic
8
18
4 12
17 16 15
13
27
14 25
28
6 5
24
29
7 1
11 23
30
30 19
2
26
FAI35
CAB1
68
1
24
CAB1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
ENG1.5/CAB1.3
B
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
ENG1
ENG1
9
11
15
12 13 24
14
27 26
23
4 5
16
22
3 1
6
500-2/3W-+/-5%
10
2 7
17 28
21
8 19
18 29
25
2 1
6 6
5
4
3
2
5
2
3
4
1
1
ENG19 ENG1.6/ENG19.1 B ENG9.1/ENG19.2 N ENG9.1/ENG19.3 N ENG1.5/ENG19.4 B ENG1.14/ENG19.5 B
FAI129
1
ENG9
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
ENG19.1/S1.1
S1
B
ENG19.5/S2.1
B
S2
ENG19
FAI20
FAI35
1
ENG1.6/CAB1.62
R1
2
3
4
5
5 4 3 2 1
ENG33
B
CAB1.66/ENG1.14
R
23
45
46
CAB01
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
B B
9 3
20
31
31
20 21 10 22
R1.2/S1.1 R1.1/S2.1
Vistronic harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness DCC2 Instrument panel
ENG33.5/S2.1 B ENG19.4/ENG33.4 B ENG19.3/ENG33.3 N ENG19.2/ENG33.2 N ENG33.1/S1.1 B
FAI 20 FAI 35 FAI 129 CAB01
MA-10-06063A
10A02.36
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Fuel preheater 2 FAI 35 FAI 129 ENG20
Fuse box Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness Fuel preheater
ENG9 ENG20.2/ENG9.1 N
1
2
ENG20
FAI129
1 2
ENG20
F19 1 20
31 30
17
4
15 26
23
23
4
24
28
6 16 15 27
14 25
25
29 17
5 13
24
2
18 7
1
12
12
30 19
2 3
11
13 14
27
22
22
11
1 5
16
10
10 3
6
28
8 9
9 2
7
29
21
21
8 19
18
31
20
26
ENG1
FAI35
BAF8
1
2
B
4 6
3 5
2
8
X2
BAF8.3/ENG1.4
7
1
9
+APC
10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
F19 - 25A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
ENG1.4/ENG20.1
B
MA-10-06064A
ENG1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.37
Electrical diagrams Battery charge and engine start 2 3 25 32 46 47 FAI 11 FAI 35 FAI 129 FAI 130 CAB01 ENG5 L8
Fuse box Start switch Starter motor Safety switch Alternator Battery BOC - safety switch harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness Cab Dyna VT transmission harness DCC2 Instrument panel Start relay LS signal breaker solenoid valve
+ F51
CAB01
47
2
F16
ENG29B.1/ENG25.1 M
F37
68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB01
68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB01
Y
25
225A
1
2 4
3
BAF7.7/ENG1.8
1 F16 - 30A
5
6
7
8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
+12V APC
10
BAF7 BAF7
31
20 21
8 9
10 22
18
12
17 16
5 15
27
14 25
28
6
13 24
29
7 1
4
23
30 19
2 3
11
26
+12V
1
BAF10 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F37 - 5A
1
2
3
6
4
5 7
8
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
FAI 129
ENG1.8/S7.1
17
22 11 23
4 12
5 15
13 24
14
27
1
10 3
1 6
16
ENG26
1
9 2
7
28
1
ENG29
21
8 19
18
ENG29
20
31 30
29
S7
B
26
25
1 2 3 5
30
1 2 3 5
2
ENG24 ENG9
M
3 1
85
FAI129
ENG5
4
ENG5
ENG24.1/S11.1 ENG1
86
ENG5
ENG1.29/ENG5.1 B ENG5.2/ENG9.1 N ENG5.1/S11.1 M S11 ENG5.5/S3.1 B S3
87
46
1
9
10
11 13
ENG18 ENG18.1/ENG30.1 B
14
12
1
16
32
BAF10.2/ENG1.29
15
2
17
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
18
F51 - 15A
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
B
N
CAB28
X4
1
ENG29.1/S11.1 M
FAI 35 CAB28.1/CAB1.23
X2
1
ENG29B
1
M ENG1
1
ENG29B
S3.1/ENG26.1
BAF7.8/CAB1.68
ENG25
1
46 24 1
68 45 23
-
+
1
BAF10 BAF9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
BAF9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
1
ENG30.2/S7.1
2 1
SECU1
1
SECU2
3
1 CAB14.2/SECU2.1
CAB14
B SECU1.1/CAB14.1
FAI 11
6 3
ENG31.2/ENG9.1 N S3.1/ENG31.1 B
5
4
2
1
B
6 5 4 3 2 1 CAB14
6 5 4 3 2 1
17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
CAB14.1/BAF9.14 3
2
1
6
5
4
B
FAI 35
B
2 1
ENG30
2 1
1
2
FAI130
1
2 1
ENG31.2/L8.2 L8.1/ENG31.1
N B
MA-10-06065A
L8
CAB35
1
10A02.38
¤ H
B
ENG31 ENG31
L8 CAB35.1/CAB14.2
2 1
2
2
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams
C . Bulb types
Road lights Europe Lighting
Bulb(s)
Type
Front road lights and dipped lights on grille H4 12V / 60W/55W
Road lights and dipped lights on handrails H4 12V / 60W/55W
Front side lights and direction indicators
Direction indicator 12V / 21W
Position 12V / 5W
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.39
Electrical diagrams
Side lights / stop lights and rear direction indicators
Direction indicator 12V / 21W
Side light / Stop light 12V / 21W/5W
Flashing beacon(s)
Flashing beacon H1 12V / 55W
Reversing light
Reversing light 12V / 21W
10A02.40
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams
Work headlights Europe models Lighting Four front work headlights on grille
Description
Bulb(s)
Single bulb
Work headlight
Type
H9 12V/65W
Four front roof headlights
Two rear roof headlights
Single bulb
Work headlight
Double bulbs
H3 12V / 55W
Xenon bulb
Xenon bulb GDL D2S / 35W
Double bulbs
Work headlight
Xenon bulb
Handrail headlights
Single bulb
Single bulb
H3 12V / 55W Xenon bulb GDL D2S / 35W
Work headlight
Double bulbs
Fender headlights
H3 12V / 55W
H3 12V / 55W H3 12V / 55W
Work headlight
H3 12V / 55W
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.41
Electrical diagrams
Footstep headlights
Single bulb
Work headlight H3 12V / 55W
10A02.42
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams
Road lights - North America Lighting Road lights and dipped lights
Bulb(s)
Description
Headlight H4 12V / 60W/55W
Front side lights and direction indicators
Direction indicator 12V / 21W
Position 12V / 5W
Rear side lights / stop lights and direction indicators with fender extension (North America)
Direction indicator 12V / 21W
Guard extension 12V / 21W
Side light / Stop light 12V / 21W/5W
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.43
Electrical diagrams
Roof front direction indicators
Direction indicator 12V / 21W
Roof rear direction indicators
Direction indicator 12V / 21W
Flashing beacon(s)
Flashing beacon H1 12V / 55W
10A02.44
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams
Work headlights - North America Lighting Four front work headlights on grille
Description
Bulb(s)
Single bulb
Work headlight
Type
H9 12V/65W
Two front roof headlights
Two rear roof headlights
Single bulb
Work headlight
Double bulbs
H3 12V / 55W
Xenon bulb
Xenon bulb GDL D2S / 35W
Double bulbs
Work headlight
Xenon bulb
Handrail headlights
Single bulb
Single bulb
H3 12V / 55W Xenon bulb GDL D2S / 35W
Work headlight
Double bulbs
Fender headlights
H3 12V / 55W
H3 12V / 55W H3 12V / 55W
Work headlight H3 12V / 55W
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.45
Electrical diagrams
Footstep headlights
Single bulb
Work headlight H3 12V / 55W
Work headlights - High Visibility model Lighting Two front roof headlights
Description
Bulb(s)
Type
Single bulb
Work headlight
H3 12V / 55W
Double bulbs
Two rear roof headlights
Single bulb Double bulbs
10A02.46
¤ H
H3 12V / 55W
Work headlight
H3 12V / 55W H3 12V / 55W
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams
D . Lighting Instrument panel lighting ......................................... 49 Road lights and dipped lights - Europe..................... 50 Road lights and dipped lights - Germany.................. 51 Side lights - Europe .................................................. 52 High visibility and standard roof side lights .............. 53 Number plate lighting............................................... 54 Number plate lighting for high visibility roof............. 55 Standard roof direction indicator and warning lights Europe...................................................................... 56 High visibility roof direction indicator and warning lights - Europe.................................................................... 57 Standard roof and fender extensions direction indicator and warning lights - North America.......................... 58 High visibility roof and fender extensions direction indicator and warning lights - North America................. 59 Standard roof direction indicator and warning lights without fender extensions - North America ............. 60 High visibility roof direction indicator and warning lights without fender extensions - North America ............. 61 Work headlights module .......................................... 62 Footstep lighting - Europe ........................................ 63 Footstep lighting - North America ............................ 64 Flashing beacons...................................................... 65 Standard roof work headlights ................................. 66 Xenon work headlights for standard roof ................. 67 Work headlights on grille.......................................... 68 Fender and handrail work headlights ....................... 69 Roof work headlights - North America ..................... 70 Xenon roof work headlights - North America ........... 71 Reversing light ......................................................... 72
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.47
Electrical diagrams
Page left blank intentionally
10A02.48
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Instrument panel lighting 2 FAI 35 CAB01 CAB03
Fuse box Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness DCC2 Instrument panel Road lights switch
CAB28 CAB3.7/CAB28.1
1
CAB03
N
FAI35
S3.1/CAB3.5
S3 S2
2
CAB3.3/S2.1
M R
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
+3
+6
1
-7
2
2
5
R S2.1/BAF9.18
S3.1/BAF9.17
N
R
Ole Object
CAB1.24/BAF9.16
16
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
CAB28.1/CAB1.23
2
3
4 6
7
8
9
10
5
1
F38 - 7.5A
12
13
14
15
11
F39
18
17
F38
BAF9
M
CAB3
F39 - 20A 1 X4
FAI35
68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
68
46
45
24
23
1
CAB01
CAB1
MA-10-06031A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.49
Electrical diagrams Road lights and dipped lights - Europe 2 22 FAI 35 FAI 129 FAI 132 CAB01 CAB03 ENG6 ENG7
Fuse box Wiper control unit Instrument panel Dyna VT with EEM harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness LST front headlights harness DCC2 Instrument panel Road lights switch Right-hand road lights and direction indicators Left-hand road lights and direction indicators 13
8
7
1
22 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI35
(4) 56
(3) (8) 30 Sx
(12) (1) (11) 31b 53b 53
(9) Dx
I
1
B BAF9.9/CAB1.25
F53
4
1
M
2
BAF8.6/S13.1
3
F39 - 20A
F60
6
BAF7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
5
4
BAF8
8
1
2
3
8
6
7 9
10
5
ENG1 ENG1
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
7
23 12 24
25
9
26
22 11
4 13 14
27
10
10 3
1 5 15
R15
F60 - 10A
30
85
86
F53 - 25A 87
R15
FAI35
F39
CAB1
CAB17.4/CAB3.6 B S3.1/CAB3.5 M
SH5 F34 SH4
1 +12V
2
X4
1
X3
1
H (2)
CAB01
1
2
9 2
7 6 16
46
3
21
8 19
18 17
24
4
20
31 30
29 28
68
6
5
S13
23
7
S3
68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
45
8
B
F34 - 10A
SH5
L (10)
56a (6)
M
9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 CAB17.6/BAF9.10 10 11 12 CAB17.5/BAF9.13 B 13 14 BAF9.15/S3.1 M 15 16 S3.1/BAF9.17 M 17 18
S13.1/CAB17.3
10
ENG8.3/ENG9.1 N ENG8.4/ENG9.1 N
11
MASSE
12
MASSE
13
BAF10
14
F36 - 15A
SH4
16
26
BAF9
15
28 16 27
lave vitre
56b (5) 17
29 17
6 15 14
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
18
18 7
1 5 13
1
1
30 19
2
4 12 24
2
8 9 3
11 23
25
ENG9
31
20 21 10 22
3
B B
4
ENG7
S4.1/ENG7.3 S3.1/ENG7.2
6
ROUTE
3 2 1
ENG7
B
5
CROISEMENT
BAF10.9/ENG1.17
7
B
B
8
ENG1.17/ENG8.7
ENG1.19/BAF7.10
9
B
10
ENG1.19/ENG8.8 ENG8 ENG8
FAI35
11
FAI132
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
12
ENG7.1/ENG8.4 N ENG8.3/ENG6.1 N
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
13
B B
14
S4
ENG6
ENG8.8/S3.1 ENG8.7/S4.1
15
S_3
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
16
ENG6
S4.1/ENG6.3 B S3.1/ENG6.2 B
klaxon
J
17
18
ROUTE
FAI129 3 2 1
O
(7) 53C
II
CAB17
CROISEMENT
(13) J
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
+3
+6
1
2
X1X5
CAB3
ACC
2
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
-7
2
5
CAB03
MA-10-06020A
F36
10A02.50
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Road lights and dipped lights - Germany
1 2
4
2
1
6 5 4 3 2 1
B B
FAI124
R19 1
3
2
1
6
5
4
R10 R3
R37.1/S1.1
N
R37.1/R10.1
1
1 R37
R3.5/R10.1 R3.6/R10.1
N N
5
4
3
2
1
ROOF3 1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
N
R37
6
ROOF3.5/CAB103.3 CAB103.3/ROOF3.6
1
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
22
(4) 56
(3) (8) 30 Sx
(12) (1) (11) 31b 53b 53
(9) Dx
I
6
4
3
2
1
5
5
BAF10
7
F36 - 15A
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 CAB17.6/BAF9.10 10 11 12 CAB17.5/BAF9.13 B 13 14 BAF9.15/S3.1 M 15 16 S3.1/BAF9.17 M 17 18 8
R1
9
3
10
5
4
11
2
12
BAF9
2
B
S13
R8
F34 - 10A
1
20
31 30
21
8 19
18
9 10
2 7
29 17
11 12 13 24
14 26
23
4 5
15 27
22
3 1
6 16
25
1
2
3
4 8
6
7 9
10
5
ENG1 ENG1
S3
3
4
28
(13) J
O
(7) 53C
klaxon
J
II lave vitre
56b (5)
13
ENG8.3/ENG9.1 N ENG8.4/ENG9.1 N
4
14
MASSE
1
5
15
MASSE
2
16
26
3 6
8
7
13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
17
28 16 27
1 2 3 4 5 6
18
29 17
6 15 14
1
1
18 7
1 5 13 25
ENG9
30 19
2
4 12 24
2
8 9 3
11 23
3
ENG7
31
20 21 10 22
4
B B
6
S4.1/ENG7.3 S3.1/ENG7.2
B
5
ROUTE
3 2 1
ENG7
B
BAF10.9/ENG1.17
7
CROISEMENT
ENG1.19/BAF7.10
8
B
9
B
ENG1.17/ENG8.7
10
ENG1.19/ENG8.8 ENG8 ENG8
FAI132
FAI35
11
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
12
ENG7.1/ENG8.4 N ENG8.3/ENG6.1 N
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
13
B B
14
S4
ENG6
ENG8.8/S3.1 ENG8.7/S4.1
15
ENG6
S3
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
16
ROUTE
3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB103
13
17
R38
FAI129
1 2 3 4 5 6
CAB17
CROISEMENT
S4.1/ENG6.3 B S3.1/ENG6.2 B
1
CAB103
N 18
R38
4
2
B
R10.1/R38.1
1
5
BAF9.9/CAB1.25
N
6 3
FAI35
N N
BAF3 R38.1/S1.1
FAI127
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
BAF7 F39 - 20A
F60
2
F53
BAF8.6/S13.1
M
R15 30
F60 - 10A 85
86
F53 - 25A 87
R15
FAI35
68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L (10)
56a (6)
H (2)
CAB01
1
R19
R2.5/R19.5 R2.4/R19.4
ROOF2
46
6 5 4 3 2 1
1
24
3
X1
ROOF2.5/BAF3.10 B ROOF2.4/BAF3.12 B
68
1 2
R2
6 5 4 3 2 1
H4
6 5 4
4
2
23
3
1
5
-7
45
2
2
2
M
1
5
+3
1
S13.1/CAB17.3
3 2 1
H4
6
4
S1
N B B
3 6
6 5 4 3 2 1
M
5
B
6 3
1 2
H4.3/S1.1 R19.5/H4.2 R19.4/H4.1
CAB05 +8 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
FAI15
3
6
S3.1/CAB5.2
R12
3
5
B B
CAB5.3/BAF9.11
R12
R2.5/R12.5 R2.4/R12.4
1
FAI34
6 5 4 3 2 1
2
4
2
H4
6 5 4 3 2 1
1
7
4
3
3
2
4
3
6
5
2
5
1
1
5
8
6 6
4
S1
7
3 2 1
N B B
9
H4
H4.3/S1.1 R12.5/H4.2 R12.4/H4.1
8
CAB5
10
3
N
Fuse box Wiper control unit Roof harness Handrail lighting harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness LST pillar harness US lighting harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness ML200 front headlights harness DCC2 Instrument panel Road lights switch Handrail road lights switch Right-hand road lights and direction indicators Left-hand road lights and direction indicators Handrail road lights
CAB103.3/X1.1
2 22 FAI 15 FAI 34 FAI 35 FAI 124 FAI 127 FAI 129 FAI 132 CAB01 CAB03 CAB05 ENG6 ENG7 H4
CAB1
F39 R8 CAB17.4/CAB3.6 B S3.1/CAB3.5 M
F34 R1
1
X4
1
X3
1
X1X5
+12V
2
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 CAB3
+3
+6
1
-7
2
2
5
CAB03
MA-10-06022A
F36
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.51
Electrical diagrams Side lights - Europe 2 38 FAI 35 FAI 37
Fuse box Trailer connector - Europe Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 60 Roof harness (all countries except US) FAI 61 Handrail lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 124 LST pillar harness FAI 126 Lighting harness - Europe CAB03 Road lights switch LIG4 Rear right-hand side lights LIG5 Rear left-hand side lights H1 Front right- and left-hand side lights
LIG4 LIG4
LIG4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
LIG16
H1 R12
R12
1 2 3
1 2 3
1
1
2
1 2
LIG13.1/S7.1
S7 S7.1/LIG4.2
B
B
LIG4.4/LIG3.1
N
3
H1 1 2 3
B N
S1
3
R2.2/R12.3
B
3
1
38
R37.1/S1.1
1 2
3
4
1
2
LIG17
N
R12.3/H1.2 S1.1/H1.3
R37
LIG17.1/S8.1
B
FAI 37
R37
1
R37.1/R10.1
1
N
LIG5 R10
FAI 61
1
1
H1 1 2 3
B N
1 2 3
S1
R38.1/S1.1
1 2 3
R38
4
2
1
27
14 26
R2
1 2 3 4 5 6
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
LIG1
ROOF2
1 2 3 4 5 6
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
LIG1
3
4
1
2
R38
1
R10.1/R38.1
1
N
FAI124
1
2 6
3 5 7 9 11
12 16
13 17
18
15
14
10
8
4
BAF5 BAF5 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
2
1
5
4
13
1
5
4
6
5
4
3
2
1
FAI126
S3.1/LIG1.1 S2.1/LIG1.2
24
14 26
2
23 12
5 15
3
22 11
4
16
6
10 3
1 6
27
CAB103
S2
9 2
7
28
21
8 19
18 17
CAB103
B B
20
31 30
29
6 5 4 3 2 1
S3
B B
3 6
6 5 4 3 2 1
S3.1/CAB103.1 S2.1/CAB103.2 BAF5.1/S3.1 BAF5.2/S2.1
ROOF2.1/CAB103.2 ROOF2.2/CAB103.1
B B
2
16 15
25
5
28
6
24
6 3
1 2 3 4 LIG5
17
1
13
B
29
5
12
R2.1/R19.3
18 7
4
23
3
N
30
2 3
11
1 2 3
1 2 3 4
B
19
10 22
N
R19.3/H1.2 S1.1/H1.3
8 9
R19
S8.1/LIG5.2 LIG5.4/LIG3.1
31
20 21
R19
3
S8
B B
2
1 2
LIG3
LIG1.2/S8.1 LIG1.1/S7.1
H1
LIG5
1
FAI 60
25
2
B B F39-20A
F38-7.5A
BAF9
F1- 10A
F39 - 20A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
8 7 BAF9.5/S2.1
1 4
2 5
3 6
R S2 S3
CAB3.3/S2.1
R
S3.1/CAB3.5
M
CAB3.7/CAB28.1
FAI 35
F1-10A
CAB03 CAB3
N
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
+3
+6
1
-7
2
2
5
CAB3 BAF9.15/S3.1
M
S3.1/BAF9.17 S2.1/BAF9.18
M R
BAF9 F38 - 7.5A
1
CAB28 17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
1
X4
10A02.52
¤ H
MA-10-06016A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams High visibility and standard roof side lights Fuse box Trailer connector - Europe Trailer connector - North America Roof harness Handrail lighting harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) LST pillar harness US lighting harness Road lights switch Rear right-hand side lights Rear left-hand side lights Front right- and left-hand side lights
LIG4
42 LIG4 LIG16 1
6
H1 1 2 3
2
4
3
B N
R12
R12
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
S1 N
R12.3/H1.2 S1.1/H1.3
5
3
1 2
4
3
1
LIG16.1/S7.1
S7 S7.1/LIG4.2
B
R2.2/R12.3
B
1 2 3 4
B
LIG4.4/LIG3.1
N
3
4
1
2
1 2 3 4
LIG17 1
LIG17.1/S8.1
B B
1 2
6 5
LIG4
R37
R37
1
1
R37.1/R10.1
38
N
FAI 36
LIG1.1/S7.1
H1
R37.1/S1.1
FAI 15
LIG5
R10 LIG5
FAI 34
1
1
1 2 3
2 3
R19
B N
1 2 3 4 5 6
S1
R38.1/S1.1
1 2 3
R19
5
2
4
3
21
24
R10.1/R38.1
1
N
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14 16
15 17
5
4
27
14
3
2
1
26
R2
1 2 3 4 5 6
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
LIG1
R2
1 2 3 4 5 6
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
LIG1
FAI 124
BAF5 BAF5
18
16 15
25
6
28
6 5
13
B
29 17
4
3
4
1
2
R38
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
18 7
1
12
R2.1/R19.3
1 2 3 4
19 2
3
23
N
30
9 10 11
1 2 3 4 5 6
R38
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
8
1 2 3 4
B
LIG5.4/LIG3.1
31
20
22
N
R19.3/H1.2 S1.1/H1.3
5 4
1
S8.1/LIG5.2
B
H1
6
S8
LIG1.2/S8.1
1
6
S3.1/CAB103.1 S2.1/CAB103.2
B B
H1
LIG5
LIG3
3
2
1
ROOF2.1/CAB103.2 ROOF2.2/CAB103.1
2 38 42 FAI 15 FAI 34 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 124 FAI 127 CAB03 LIG4 LIG5 H1
6
5
4
9
1
6
5
4
CAB103
6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB103
6
5
4
3
2
1
11 23
4 12
5 15
2
22
3 1
6 16
3
10
2 7
28
21
8 19
18 17
6 5 4 3 2 1
B B
20
31 30
29
13 24
14
27 26
25
FAI127 F39-20A
BAF5.1/S3.1 BAF5.2/S2.1
S3
B B
S3.1/LIG1.1 S2.1/LIG1.2
S2
B B F38-7.5A
F1-10A BAF9 BAF9
F1- 10A
F39 - 20A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
BAF9.5/S2.1
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
CAB03 CAB3 CAB3
R S2
BAF9.15/S3.1
S3
M
CAB3.3/S2.1
R
S3.1/CAB3.5
M
CAB3.7/CAB28.1
FAI 35
S3.1/BAF9.17 S2.1/BAF9.18
N
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
+3
+6
1
-7
2
2
5
M R
2 MA-10-06015A
F38 - 7.5A CAB28
1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
1
X4
10A02.53
Electrical diagrams Number plate lighting 2 58 FAI 15 FAI 18 FAI 35 FAI 124 FAI 126 CAB03
Fuse box Number plate lighting Roof harness Number plate lighting harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness LST pillar harness Lighting harness - Europe Road lights switch
FAI18
2 R34B.1/R29.1
F39 - 20A
3
1
6
4
6
5
4
3
2
1
ROOF2
FAI15
R2
R34A.1/R29.1 ROOF2.1/CAB103.2 3
1
6
4
6 5 4 3 2 1
B
CAB103
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
58
1 R34B
FAI124
F38 - 7.5A
N
R29 R42.1/R29.1 R2.2/R29.2
B
1
R29 R34A
N B
1 2
1 2 R33B.1/R29.1
N
58
1
1
6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB103
R33B 2
6
5
4
3
2
1
S3.1/CAB103.1
B
R29.1/R33A.1
B
S3 1
FAI126
2
17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
BAF5.1/S3.1
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 R33A
R42
B
BAF5
F38 - 7.5A
CAB28
1
FAI35 F39 - 20A
1
X4
BAF9
CAB3.7/CAB28.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
S2.1/BAF9.18
S3.1/BAF9.17 BAF9.15/S3.1
M M
R
S2
S3.1/CAB3.5
CAB3.3/S2.1
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
N
R
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB03 +3
+6
1
-7
2
2
5
M CAB3
S3 MA-10-06017A
10A02.54
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Number plate lighting for high visibility roof 2 FAI 35 FAI 59 FAI 124 FAI 126 CAB03 R41 R42
Fuse box Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness High visibility roof harness LST pillar harness Lighting harness - Europe Road lights switch Number plate light for high visibility roof Number plate light for high visibility roof
2
2
5
4
2
1
6
4
R41
R41 1 2
1
3
F39 - 20A
6 3
1
FAI124
F38 - 7.5A
ROOF2 ROOF2.1/CAB103.2 3
1
6
4
6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB103
6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB103
R2 1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
B
R2.2/R41.2
R42.2/R41.2
5
3
2
4
B
FAI59 R42 R42 R42.1/R11.1
6
B
S3.1/CAB103.1
B
N R41.4/R11.1
1 2
N
1 2
1
S3
FAI126 R11 17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
BAF5.1/S3.1
1
1
R12
B Ole Object
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF5
2
F38 - 7.5A
CAB28
1
F39 - 20A
1
X4
TB2
FAI35 CAB3.7/CAB28.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
S2.1/BAF9.18
R
S2
CAB3.3/S2.1
N
R 8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB03 +3
1
-7
S3.1/BAF9.17 BAF9.15/S3.1
M
S3.1/CAB3.5
M
+6
2
2
5
CAB3
M S3 MA-10-06018A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.55
Electrical diagrams Standard roof direction indicator and warning lights - Europe 2
BAF9
2 4
1 5 7
8
9 15
16
17
13
11
10
6
3
LIG1.5/S10.1 LIG1.4/S9.1
LIG1
X1.1/ROOF3.6
6
5
4
3
2
1
N
X1
22
BAF3 BAF3
9
7
5
3
1
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
CAB103 6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
3
2
1
6
5
4
6
1
5
2
4
3
N
B
R10.1/R18.1
3
2
1
6
5
4
ROOF4
FAI124
BAF3.7/ROOF4.4
B
ROOF3.6/CAB103.3 ROOF3.5/CAB103.3
B
R4
6
5
4
3
2
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
N N
6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
ROOF3
R3
R3.6/R10.1 R3.5/R10.1
BAF2.1/CAB17.9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
2
1
5
4
B
CAB38.2/S12.1
1 2 3
B
CAB17.8/BAF2.3 B BAF2.4/CAB4.5 B S12.1/BAF2.5 B BAF2.7/S12.1
B
1 2 3
CAB105.4/CAB38.2
B
FAI124
S12
3
FLASH PROGRAMING
(9) Dx
(12) (1) (11) 31b 53b 53
(13) J
(7) 53C
J1_6 J1_12
L (10)
56a (6)
22
10
3
9
2
8
1
M CAB4
CAB4.6/CAB4.8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
6
8
10
5
7
9
4 3
2 1
CAB28 CAB4.7/CAB28.1
N
1 2 3
H1
1 2 3
1
S1.1/R37.1
S1
N
R37
FAI61 6
1
5
2
3 2 1
3 2 1
4
3
R19
R19
R19.2/H_1.1
B
H1.3/S1.1
N
1 2 3
H1
1 2 3
N
1
1
R38
R38
S1.1/R38.1
S1
N
5
J1-14
6
2 3
LUMIERE/LUZ (J1-18) H-ACTIVE
J1-16 J1-3
CONTACTO CONTACT (J1-5) H-ACTIVE
J1-17
WARNING (J1-4) L-ACTIVE
DL4 DL5 DL6
REF.NTC AGCO 3714264M1
DL1 DL2
(ROJO) (ROUGE)
DL7
DL3
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
3
4
5
6
7
3
8
2
2
1
-7
CAB105
5
13
18
7
12
1
6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
1
2
CAB01
MA-10-06028A
1
10A02.56
¤ H
J1-8
TOUCHE 9
6
3
CAB04 8
4
TOUCHE 8
CAB105 +8
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
B
J1-13
H (2)
7
11 12 13
56b (5)
4
X4
S13.1/CAB17.10
BAF8.7/CAB4.2 M CAB4.2/BAF8.9 M S12.1/CAB4.3 B
TOUCHE 7
J1-10
VERDE/VERTE
BAF8
S13
J1-7
TEMPERATURE (J1-2)
II
F53 - 25A
M
J1-1
TOUCHE 6
J
87
BAF8.6/S13.1
1
TOUCHE 5
J1-15
O
86
F25 - 25A
+ J1-9
TOUCHE 4
J1-11
I
30
1
MICRO-PROCESSOR
(3) (8) 30 Sx
6
7
(4) 56
5
1
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
4
3 5
CAB17
SH14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
N
R12
CAB1
CAB38
R15 85
H1.3/S1.1
B
1
R10 3 6
FAI35
F60 - 10A 1
R12.2/H1.1
N N
CAB38
FAI35
X3
1
3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6
BAF2.6CAB1.29 B BAF2.8/CAB1.28 B
8
SH13
3 2 1
FAI60 BAF3.5/ROOF_4.2
6
3 6
B
25
LCD
2 5
3
H1 R19.2/R4.2
J3
1 4
N
23
1 2 3 4 5 6
BAF2 BAF2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
2
46 24 1
F40-15A
F61-25A
F44-15A
11
1
5
11
3
13
B
R12
12
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
6
4
H1 R12.2/R4.4
24
R24
SH9- Eur
3
FAI37
10 3 4
CAB103
5
1 2
1
LIG3
13 14
26
6 5 4
FAI126
1
1
1 2 3 4
R37
9
1 5 15
BAF5
2
LIG4
R10.1/R20.1
21
2
6 16
1 2 3 4
20
7 17
27
LIG5
S9
8
18 29 28
1
S10
B
19
LIG1
B B
LIG18
B
31 30
BAF5.6/LIG1.5 BAF5.5/LIG1.4
1
1
68 45 23
SH1- EUR
12
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
14
BAF5 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
LIG19
2
S9.1/LIG4.1
1 SH7- Eur
1
1
LIG4.4/LIG3.1
4 1 X-X5
LIG21
3
2
B
3
4
N
27 26
3
S10.1/LIG5.1
16 15
14
B
28
6 5
13 25
LIG18.1/S9.1
4 12 24
B
17
1
11 23
29
LIG19.1/S10.1
18 7
N
30 19
2
LIG21.1/LIG3.1
16
8 9 3
LIG4
4
LIG5.4/LIG3.1
6
1 3
4
5 7
8
15
21 10 22
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31
20
BAF9
2
LIG5
10
11
12
13
14
9
38
R21 5
B B
2
BAF9.1/CAB1.26 CAB1.27/BAF9.2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
17
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
18
Fuse box Wiper control unit Trailer connector - Europe Handrail lighting harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 60 Roof harness (all countries except US) FAI 61 Handrail lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 124 LST pillar harness FAI 126 Lighting harness - Europe CAB01 DCC2 Instrument panel CAB04 Warning switch CAB105 Headlights module - NAO and Europe LIG4 Rear right-hand side lights LIG5 Rear left-hand side lights H1 Front right- and left-hand side lights
18
2 22 38 FAI 34 FAI 35 FAI 37
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams High visibility roof direction indicator and warning lights - Europe 2
BAF9
B B
X1.1/ROOF3.6
3
2
1
N
X1
6 5 4 3 2 1
26
6 5 4 3 2 1
5
4
F40-15A
F61-25A
F44-15A
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
BAF3.5/ROOF_4.2
B
BAF3.7/ROOF4.4
B
N LIG4.4/LIG3.1
23 12
6
1
5
2
4
3
24
3
2
1
6
5
4
ROOF4 ROOF4
3
2
1
6
5
4
ROOF3.6/CAB103.3 ROOF3.5/CAB103.3
6
5
4
3
2
1
N N
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
ROOF3
R3
ROOF4.2/R19.2
B
ROOF4.4/R21.2
B
R10.1/R18.1
6
5
4
3
2
1
R3.6/R10.1 R3.5/R10.1
N N
N
2
1
5
4
B
B
CAB38.2/S12.1
1 2 3
B
1 2 3
CAB105.4/CAB38.2
FAI124
B
CAB38 S12
3
FLASH PROGRAMING
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
(12) (1) (11) 31b 53b 53
(13) J
(7) 53C
O
L (10)
56a (6)
4 3
10 9
2
8
1
F53 - 25A
22
BAF8
S13.1/CAB17.10
M CAB4
CAB4.6/CAB4.8
B
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
6
8
10
5
7
9
4 3
2 1
CAB28 CAB4.7/CAB28.1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
J1_6 J1_12
N
4 5
LUMIERE/LUZ (J1-18) H-ACTIVE
J1-14
6
J1-16 J1-3
TOUCHE 9
CONTACTO CONTACT (J1-5) H-ACTIVE WARNING (J1-4) L-ACTIVE
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J1-17
DL4 DL5 DL6
REF.NTC AGCO 3714264M1
DL1 DL2
(ROJO) (ROUGE)
DL7
DL3
3
-7
2
4
5
6
6
3
1
CAB105
5
CAB04 8
2 3
J1-8
CAB105 +8
3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
2
BAF8.7/CAB4.2 M CAB4.2/BAF8.9 M S12.1/CAB4.3 B
1
S13
7
M
8
BAF8.6/S13.1
1
J1-13
TOUCHE 8
H (2)
7
56b (5)
87
X4
J1-7
TOUCHE 7
J1-10
lave vitre
R15
F25 - 25A
TOUCHE 6
TEMPERATURE (J1-2) VERDE/VERTE
86
1
J1-1
klaxon
J
30
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
J1-9
TOUCHE 5
J1-15
X3 85
+ TOUCHE 4
J1-11
I
F60 - 10A 1
(9) Dx
II
11 12 13
FAI35
(3) (8) 30 Sx
6
6
SH14
(4) 56
MICRO-PROCESSOR
CAB17
5
5 7
SH13
8
3
3 6
4
1
LCD
2 5
3
H1
R37.1/S1.1
R12.2/H1.1
B
S1.1/H1.3
N
1 2 3
1 2
H1
3
S1
N
6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
R19
R19
1
6
1
5
2
4
3
H1 R19.2/H1.1 S1.1/H1.3
R38.1/S1.1
N
B N
1 2 3
H1
1 2 3
S1
R38
CAB1
J3
1 4
2
1
CAB38
CAB17.8/BAF2.3 B BAF2.4/CAB4.5 B S12.1/BAF2.5 B BAF2.7/S12.1
1 R37
R18
R10 3 6
FAI35 BAF2.1/CAB17.9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 R20
1
FAI59
BAF2.6CAB1.29 B BAF2.8/CAB1.28 B
BAF2 BAF2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N
25
FAI124
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
R12
1
5
FAI37
BAF3 BAF3
1
R21
6
4
FAI34
3
SH9- Eur
6 5 4 3 2 1
S9
CAB103 2
R10.1/R20.1
13 14
27
CAB103
6 5 4 3 2 1
1
22
4
15
4
LIG3
11
5
16
5
1 2 3 4
10 3
1 6
28
6
3
9 2
7 17
BAF5
LIG4
1 2
21
8
18 29
1 2 3 4
6 5 4
S10
B B
20
31 30
LIG1 LIG1
1
B
LIG1.5/S10.1 LIG1.4/S9.1
19
FAI126
2
13
18
7
12
1
6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
1
2
46 24 1
BAF5.6/LIG1.5 BAF5.5/LIG1.4
LIG5
1
S9.1/LIG4.1
J
1
3
2
N
H
LIG18
4
B
16
15
X
1
3
S10.1/LIG5.1
L K
LIG19
LIG4
4
LIG5.4/LIG3.1
M C B
1
B
D A
G W
LIG21
LIG18.1/S9.1
14
13
P N
E
V
38
B
1
6
2
3
4
5 7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14 16
1 3
4
7
8
9
10
11
12
R
S T U F
1
B B
31
68 45 23
SH1- EUR
5
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
6
BAF5
2
BAF9
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
LIG19.1/S10.1
SH7- Eur
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
N
1
LIG5
LIG21.1/LIG3.1
4 1 X-X5
15
3
17
5
18
2
BAF9.1/CAB1.26 CAB1.27/BAF9.2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
17
FAI 59 FAI 124 FAI 126 CAB01 CAB04 CAB105 LIG4 LIG5 H1
Fuse box Wiper control unit Trailer connector - Europe Handrail lighting harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) High visibility roof harness LST pillar harness Lighting harness - Europe DCC2 Instrument panel Warning switch Headlights module - NAO and Europe Rear right-hand side lights Rear left-hand side lights Front right- and left-hand side lights
18
2 22 38 FAI 34 FAI 35 FAI 37
CAB01
MA-10-06029A
1
10A02.57
Electrical diagrams Standard roof and fender extensions direction indicator and warning lights - North America
BAF9.1/CAB1.26
2
B
+12 V X1-X5
1
R13
42
X2
LIG4
LIG5
R13.1/R48.1 R13.2/S6.1
N B
R18.1/R48.1 R18.2/S5.1
N B
2
1
R13
2
1
R18
1
2
BAF5.3/LIG1.3 B
LIG1-11/LIG30.1 LIG1.10/LIG31.1
1
1 2 3 4
3
2
1
6
5
4
1
B B N
X1
5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
3
4 1
R23 5
2
3
4 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
F44 droit
F40
F61
gauche
warning
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
6
1
5
2
4
3
R19.2/S5.1
B
N
LIG5.1/LIG1.3
LIG4.4/LIG3.1
LIG31.2/LIG3.1 LIG30.2/LIG3.1
6 5 4 3 2 1
5
4
2
1 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
6
5
4
3
2
1
ROOF4 R4
CAB104.2/ROOF4.3
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
ROOF3
R3
B
CAB104.1/ROOF4.5
B
FAI124 N N
FAI124
6
5
4
3
2
1
LIG31
2
1 2
LIG30
1 2
1
B
R4.4/S6.1
B
R3.6/R10.1 R3.5/R10.1
3
2
1
6
5
4
BAF2.1/CAB17.9
3
2
1
5
4
B CAB38.2/S12.1
B
R26.1/R42.1 R26.2/R4.5
N B
R32.1/R42.1 R32.2/R4.3
N B
R42
1
1
1 2 3
B
1 2 3
CAB105.4/CAB38.2
B
FAI124
3
FLASH PROGRAMING
(12) (1) (11) 31b 53b 53
(13) J
(7) 53C
klaxon
J
7
22
6
10 9
2
8
1
3
5
8
M
CAB04
CAB4
X4
1 +12 V
X3
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
CAB28 CAB4.7/CAB28.1
N
LUZ CUADRO (J1-18) H-ACTIVE
(VERDE/VERTE)
J1_6 J1_12
J1-8
5
J1-14
6
1
J1-16 J1-3 J1-17 J1-15
DL4 DL5 DL6
REF.NTC AGCO 3714264M1
CONTACT (J1-5) H-ACTIVE
DL1 DL2 (ROJO) DL7
WARNING (J1-4) L-ACTIVE
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
DL3
3
CAB105
1
-7
2
5
8
1 +12 V
4
TOUCHE 8 TOUCHE 9
6
3
7
B
3
J1-13
CAB105 +8
6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
4
9
CAB4.6/CAB4.8
M M B
5
BAF8.7/CAB4.2 CAB4.2/BAF8.9 S12.1/CAB4.3
3
S13.1/CAB17.10
J1-7
TOUCHE 7
H (2)
4
4
L (10)
56a (6)
6
11 12 13
56b (5)
10
S13
2
TOUCHE 4/6
J1-10
lave vitre
2
F25 - 25A
M
J1-1
TEMPERATURE (J1-2)
II
1
87
+ J1-9
TOUCHE 5
J1-11
O
R15 1 2 3 4 5 BAF8.6/S13.1 6 7 8 9 10
MICRO-PROCESSOR
(9) Dx
TOUCHE 4/6
-
7
3
(3) (8) 30 Sx
I
2
1
(4) 56
5
1
2 4
3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
6
5 7
CAB17
F60 - 10A
BAF8
B
S1.1/H1.3
N
1 2 3
1 2
H1
3
R37.1/S1.1
N
S1
6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
6
1
5
2
4
3
H1 R19.2/H_1.1 S__1.1/H_1.3
B N
1 2 3
1 2
H1
3
R19
1
1
R38
R38
R38.1/S1.1
N
S1
1 2
2
R26
1
1 2
2
1
R32
CAB1
CAB38
v9
F53 - 25A
H1 R12.2/H1.1
1
R48
B B
S12
FAI35
86
1 R37
3
R32
CAB38
CAB17.8/BAF2.3 B BAF2.4/CAB4.5 B S12.1/BAF2.5 B BAF2.7/S12.1
N
2
N N
6
FAI35
v8
30
1 R37
2
R26 c0
R4.2/S5.1
R10
v7
85
B
FAI15 ROOF3.6/CAB103.3 ROOF3.5/CAB103.3
BAF3.5/ROOF_4.2 B ROOF4.3/BAF3.6 B BAF3.7/ROOF4.4 B ROOF4.5/BAF3.8 B
8
3 6
2 5
R12
1
5
B B R10.1/R18.1
6 3
LCD
1 4
R12
6
4
S10
J3
R28
6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI34
1
BAF2.6/CAB1.29 BAF2.8/CAB1.28
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N
6 5 4 3 2 1
R19
BAF3 BAF3
2
R10.1/R20.1
S9
B B
CAB103
R26
B
1 2 3 4
S5
CAB103
LIG1.10/CAB103.5 LIG1.11/CAB103.4 CAB103.3/X1.1
3
1
3
FAI127
R24 4
1 2
LIG3 LIG1.9/S9.1 LIG1.8/S10.1
LIG1 LIG1
2
6 5 4
R12.2/S6.1
B B
BAF5 BAF5 F24
5
LIG5
N
LIG4
B
LIG19
LIG5.4/LIG3.1
1
LIG20
B
FAI36
1
LIG21
1 2
LIG25
LIG4.1/LIG1.6
1 2
LIG26
S9.1/LIG19.1
16
S6
B
15 17
1
S10.1/LIG20.1
6
B
2
1
N
3
4
5 7
8
9
10
11
12
13
BAF5.15/LIG1.6
2
LIG21.1/LIG3.1
6
14
B B
1 2
24
13
18
7
12
1
6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
1
2
46 24 1
F3
LIG1.9/BAF5.14 LIG1.8/BAF5.12
R18
68 45 23
F2
SH6
1
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1
25
B N
3
4
BAF9
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2
13 14
26
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1
23 12
5 15
27
J
H
2 22 11 4
16 K
X
3
10 3
1 6
B
G W
4
9 2
7 17
14
11 5
2
18
13
SH10
R21
28
12
1
29
L
3
21
8 19
18 M C
LIG25.1/S9.1 LIG25.2/LIG3.1
5 7
8
9
10
4
30 N
D A
B N
3
3
5
2
4
R22
P
E F
4 20
31
R
S T U V
LIG26.1/S10.1 LIG3.1/LIG26.2
1
2
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
16
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
15
3
17
5
2
18
R25
BAF2 BAF2
CAB01
MA-10-06026A
1
10A02.58
¤ H
1 2
BAF9
SH12
1
SH8
2 Fuse box 22 Wiper control unit 42 Trailer connector - NAO FAI 15 Roof harness FAI 34 Handrail lighting harness FAI 35 Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness FAI 36 Fender lighting harness (US) FAI 124 LST pillar harness FAI 127 US lighting harness CAB01 DCC2 Instrument panel CAB04 Warning switch CAB105 Headlights module - NAO and Europe LIG4 Rear right-hand side lights LIG5 Rear left-hand side lights LIG25 Right-hand fender extension direction indicator LIG26 Left-hand fender extension direction indicator LIG30 Additional left-hand direction indicator - NAO LIG31 Additional right-hand direction indicator - NAO H1 Front right- and left-hand side lights R13 Front left-hand roof direction indicator R18 Front right-hand roof direction indicator R26 Rear right-hand roof direction indicator R32 Rear left-hand roof direction indicator
B
CAB1.27/BAF9.2
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams High visibility roof and fender extensions direction indicator and warning lights North America
BAF9.1/CAB1.26
B
CAB1.27/BAF9.2 + 12V 1
X1-X5
1
42
X2
B
LIG4
LIG5
BAF9
1
2
3
4 6
5 7
8
12 24 25
9
10
11
LIG1.9/BAF5.14 LIG1.8/BAF5.12
B B
BAF5.15/LIG1.6
B
BAF5.3/LIG1.3
B
2
2
1
3
2
1
1 2
LIG26
3
6
5
4
1
B B N
X1
5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
3
1
R23 5
2
3
4 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1
LIG20
1
LIG19
F44
F40
F61
gauche
warning
6 5 4 3 2 1
5
4
3
2
1
6 5 4 3 2 1
5
4
2
1
CAB104.2/ROOF4.3
FAI124
ROOF4
1 2 3 4 5 6
6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
ROOF3
R3
FAI124 N N
3
2
1
6
5
4
R4
1 2 3 4 5 6
B B
ROOF3.6/CAB103.3 ROOF3.5/CAB103.3
3
2
1
6
5
4
1
5
2
4
3
N LIG5.4/LIG3.1
LIG31
LIG30
1 2
2
1 2
1
R19.2/R4.2
B
R4.4/R21.2
B
R10.1/R20.1 R10.1/R18.1
N N
R10
6
5
4
3
2
1
B CAB38.2/S12.1
1 2 3
B
1 2 3
CAB105.4/CAB38.2
B
FAI124
J3
FLASH PROGRAMING
O
7 6 4 3
9
2
M
CAB04
CAB4
+12 V PERMANENT PERMANENT + 12V
1
X3
+12 V ACCESSOIRES + 12V ACCESORIES
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
CAB28 CAB4.7/CAB28.1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
N
2
TOUCHE 4/6
J1-7
1
3
TOUCHE 7
J1-13
4
TOUCHE 8
J1-8
5
TOUCHE 9
J1-14
J1-16 J1-3
6
J1-17 J1-15
J1-10
LUZ CUADRO (J1-18) H-ACTIVE
(VERDE/VERTE)
J1_6 J1_12
DL5 DL6
REF.NTC AGCO 3714264M1
CONTACT (J1-5) H-ACTIVE
DL1 DL2 (ROJO) DL7
WARNING (J1-4) L-ACTIVE
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
DL3
3
CAB105
1
-7
DL4
TEMPERATURE (J1-2)
CAB105
6
3
2
5 7
B
+8
6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
4
M M B
5
BAF8.7/CAB4.2 CAB4.2/BAF8.9 S12.1/CAB4.3
3
S13.1/CAB17.10
22
2
S13
+
J1-1
H (2)
5
11 12 13
L (10)
56a (6)
8
X4
klaxon
J
lave vitre
10
M
CAB4.6/CAB4.8
1
(7) 53C
1
F25 - 25A
1 2 3 4 5 BAF8.6/S13.1 6 7 8 9 10
(13) J
II
1
6 8
BAF8 F53 - 25A
87
(12) (1) (11) 31b 53b 53
J1-9
TOUCHE 5
J1-11
8
4
5 7 9
10
R15 86
(9) Dx
TOUCHE 4/6
-
F60 - 10A
30
(3) (8) 30 Sx
I
v9
85
MICRO-PROCESSOR
2
1 3
4 6
5 7 1
2
3
(4) 56
56b (5)
1
5
2
4
3
S1
S__1.1/H_1.3
B N
1 2 3
1 2
H1 3
R19
R_37.1/S__1.1
1
N
R38
1
3
FAI35
6 5 4 3 2 1
6
CAB1
B B
CAB17
v8
FAI34
1
S12
v7
S1
N
N N
CAB38
8
3 6
2 5
H1
3
2
LCD
1 4
6 5 4 3 2 1 R19
B B
CAB38
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
1 2
FAI59
CAB17.8/BAF2.3 B BAF2.4/CAB4.5 B S12.1/BAF2.5 B B
R37.1/S1.1
1
R18
R3.6/R10.1 R3.5/R10.1
FAI35
BAF2.7/S12.1
1 2 3
R37
1 6 3
N
LIG4.4/LIG3.1
B S9.1/LIG19.1
LIG31.2/LIG3.1 LIG30.2/LIG3.1
1
BAF3.5/ROOF_4.2 B ROOF4.3/BAF3.6 B BAF3.7/ROOF4.4 B ROOF4.5/BAF3.8 B
BAF2.1/CAB17.9
6
S10 LIG4.1/LIG1.6 B LIG5.1/LIG1.3 B LIG1-11/LIG30.1 B LIG1.10/LIG31.1 B
6
B
S1.1/H1.3
H1
BAF2
R28
H1 R12.2/H1.1
1
LIG3
S9
B B
CAB104.1/ROOF4.5
BAF2
droit
3
1 2 3 4
LIG5
N
LIG1.9/S9.1 LIG1.8/S10.1
BAF2.6/CAB1.29 BAF2.8/CAB1.28
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
2
R19.2/H_1.1
BAF3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4
LIG4
1
CAB103
4
1
5
R12
R20
BAF3
2
1
LIG21
1 2
LIG25
FAI36
CAB103
LIG1.10/CAB103.5 LIG1.11/CAB103.4 CAB103.3/X1.1
R24
R26
6
4
1
BAF5
1
6 5 4 3 2 1
R21
FAI127
F24
5
6 5 4 3 2 1
12
13
14 16
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF5
4
3
13 14
LIG1 LIG1
2
1 2
23
4 5
15 26
BAF9
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4
11
1 6
16 27
J
H
N
7
8
9 11
12
13
16
14
15 17
18
28
K X
1
22
3
13
18
7
12
1
6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
2
46 24 1
F3
L B
G W
3
2
10
2 7
17
V
4
1
68 45 23
F2
SH6
1
29
C
A
F
M
3
9
18
D
B
4
E
S10.1/LIG20.1
3
19
N
T U
4
21
8
LIG21.1/LIG3.1
5
2
30
B N
SH10
R21
10
1
P
2 20
31
R
S
LIG25.1/S9.1 LIG25.2/LIG3.1
6
5
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
B N
3
3
5
2
4
R22
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
LIG26.1/S10.1 LIG3.1/LIG26.2
1
2
1
15
3
4
17
5
2
18
R25
SH12
LIG26 LIG30 LIG31 H1
Fuse box Wiper control unit Trailer connector - NAO Handrail lighting harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness Fender lighting harness (US) High visibility roof harness LST pillar harness US lighting harness DCC2 Instrument panel Warning switch Headlights module - NAO and Europe Rear right-hand side lights Rear left-hand side lights Right-hand fender extension direction indicator Left-hand fender extension direction indicator Additional left-hand direction indicator - NAO Additional right-hand direction indicator - NAO Front right- and left-hand side lights
SH8
2 22 42 FAI 34 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 59 FAI 124 FAI 127 CAB01 CAB04 CAB105 LIG4 LIG5 LIG25
2
CAB01
MA-10-06025A
1
10A02.59
Electrical diagrams Standard roof direction indicator and warning lights without fender extensions North America
BAF9.1/CAB1.26
B
CAB1.27/BAF9.2 +12 V X1-X5
1
B
R13
X2
LIG4
42
LIG5
R13.1/R48.1 R13.2/S6.1
N B
R18.1/R48.1 R18.2/S5.1
N B
2
1
R13
2
1
R18
F3
B
BAF5.3/LIG1.3
B
FAI127
5
3
4
1
1
1
6
5
4
LIG1.10/CAB103.5 LIG1.11/CAB103.4 CAB103.3/X1.1
R24 2
2
B B N
X1
6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF3
5
4
2
1 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
R26 5
2
3
4 1
5
2
3
4 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
6
5
4
3
2
1
CAB104.2/ROOF4.3
BAF3
FAI124
ROOF4
R4
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
ROOF3
R3
B
CAB104.1/ROOF4.5
B
FAI124
6
5
4
3
2
1
LIG31
2
1 2
LIG30
F44 droit
F40
F61
gauche
warning
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2
1
B
R4.4/S6.1
B
N N
R3.6/R10.1 R3.5/R10.1
3
2
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
6
5
4
FAI35 B CAB38.2/S12.1
B
N
N B
R32.1/R42.1 R32.2/R4.3
N B
1
R42
1
1 2 3
B
1 2 3
CAB105.4/CAB38.2
R48
B
FAI124
FLASH PROGRAMING
O
L (10)
56a (6)
10 9
2
8
1
M
CAB04
CAB4
+12 V
X3
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
CAB28 CAB4.7/CAB28.1
N
J1-9
TOUCHE 5
J1-1
2
TOUCHE 4/6
J1-7
3
1
TOUCHE 7
J1-13
4
TOUCHE 8
J1-8
5
TOUCHE 9
J1-14
J1-16 J1-3
6
J1-17 J1-15
J1-10
1
10A02.60
LUZ CUADRO (J1-18) H-ACTIVE
(VERDE/VERTE)
J1_6 J1_12
DL5 DL6
REF.NTC AGCO 3714264M1
CONTACT (J1-5) H-ACTIVE
DL1 DL2 (ROJO) DL7
WARNING (J1-4) L-ACTIVE
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
DL3
3
CAB105
1
-7
DL4
TEMPERATURE (J1-2)
CAB105
6
3
2
5 6
B
+8
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
5
M M B
3
BAF8.7/CAB4.2 CAB4.2/BAF8.9 S12.1/CAB4.3
7
X4
MICRO-PROCESSOR
4
6
S13.1/CAB17.10
22
3
5
8
S13
+ TOUCHE 4/6
H (2)
8
+12 V
1
klaxon
J
7
56b (5)
7
M
CAB4.6/CAB4.8
1
(7) 53C
2
4
(13) J
lave vitre
11 12 13
1
2
3
(12) (1) (11) 31b 53b 53
1
F25 - 25A
1 2 3 4 5 BAF8.6/S13.1 6 7 8 9 10
R19
B
S1.1/H1.3
N
1 2 3
H1
1 2 3
R37.1/S1.1
N
S1
FAI34 6
1
5
2
4
3
H1 R19.2/H1.1 S1.1/H1.3
B
1 2 3
N
H1
1 2 3
R38.1/S1.1
1
N
S1
R38
1 2
2
R26
1
1 2
2
1
R32
1
II
9
BAF8 F53 - 25A
87
R19
H1 R12.2/H1.1
CAB1
B B
J1-11
10
R15 86
6 5 4 3 2 1
3
1
-
F60 - 10A
30
(9) Dx
I
v9
85
(3) (8) 30 Sx
6
FAI35
v8
(4) 56
5
2
1 3
4 6
5 7 v7
6 5 4 3 2 1
2
MASSE
3
8
3 6
2 5
1 R37
1
R26.1/R42.1 R26.2/R4.5
LCD
1 4
1 R37
R38
J3
R28
R12
1
5
R32
S12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
R12
6
4
B B
CAB38
CAB17
B
2
CAB38
CAB17.8/BAF2.3 B BAF2.4/CAB4.5 B S12.1/BAF2.5 B BAF2.7/S12.1
R19.2/S5.1
N N
R10
BAF2.1/CAB17.9
S5
6 5 4 3 2 1
R26 c0
R4.2/S5.1
BAF2.6/CAB1.29 BAF2.8/CAB1.28
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
3
FAI15
ROOF3.6/CAB103.3 ROOF3.5/CAB103.3
BAF3.5/ROOF_4.2 B ROOF4.3/BAF3.6 B BAF3.7/ROOF4.4 B ROOF4.5/BAF3.8 B
BAF2 BAF2
1 2
R10.1/R18.1
6 3
CAB103
6 5 4
N
6 5 4 3 2 1
S10
LIG31.2/LIG3.1 LIG30.2/LIG3.1 CAB103
B
1
LIG1 LIG1 3
3
R10.1/R20.1
S9
B B
1 2
1 2 3 4
LIG3 LIG1.9/S9.1 LIG1.8/S10.1
6 5 4
R12.2/S6.1
B B
BAF5 BAF5 F24
LIG5
N
1 2 3 4
B
LIG4
LIG4.4/LIG3.1
1
LIG5.1/LIG1.3
LIG19
N
16
1
B
15 17
FAI36
LIG1-11/LIG30.1 LIG1.10/LIG31.1
LIG20
1
LIG5.4/LIG3.1
6
BAF5.15/LIG1.6
LIG21
LIG4.1/LIG1.6
1
2
3
4
5 7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
B B
S6
B
6
16
LIG1.9/BAF5.14 LIG1.8/BAF5.12
1 2
24
13
18
7
12
1
6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
2
46 24 1
F2
SH6
1
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
R18
68 45 23
4
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1
25
S9.1/LIG19.1
3
BAF9
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2
13 14
26
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1
23 12
5 15
27
J
H
2 22 11 4
16 K
X
3
10 3
1 6
B
G W
4
9 2
7 17
B
5
2
18
13
SH10
R21
28
14
1
29
L
3
21
8 19
18 M C
S10.1/LIG20.1
5 7
8
9
10
11
12
4
30 N
D A
N
3
3
5
2
4
R22
P
E F
4 20
31
R
S T U V
LIG21.1/LIG3.1
1
2
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
15
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
17
3
18
5
2
R23
¤ H
1 2
BAF9 R25
SH12
1
SH8
2 Fuse box 22 Wiper control unit 42 Trailer connector - NAO FAI 15 Roof harness FAI 34 Handrail lighting harness FAI 35 Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness FAI 36 Fender lighting harness (US) FAI 124 LST pillar harness FAI 127 US lighting harness CAB01 DCC2 Instrument panel CAB04 Warning switch CAB105 Headlights module - NAO and Europe LIG4 Rear right-hand side lights LIG5 Rear left-hand side lights LIG30 Additional left-hand direction indicator - NAO LIG31 Additional right-hand direction indicator - NAO H1 Front right- and left-hand side lights R13 Front left-hand roof direction indicator R18 Front right-hand roof direction indicator R26 Rear right-hand roof direction indicator R32 Rear left-hand roof direction indicator
2
CAB01
MA-10-06024A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams High visibility roof direction indicator and warning lights without fender extensions North America
BAF9.1/CAB1.26
2
B
+12 V X1-X5
1
42
X2
LIG4
LIG5
4
B
FAI127
LIG21
FAI36
SH12
3
1
1
1
LIG1.9/S9.1 LIG1.8/S10.1
6
5
4
B B N
X1
6 5 4 3 2 1
6
5
4
SH8
5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
3
4 1
R23 5
2
3
4 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
3
2
1
F44 droit
F40
F61
gauche
warning
6
5
4
3
2
1
CAB104.2/ROOF4.3
FAI124
ROOF4 1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
ROOF3
R3
B B
FAI124 ROOF3.6/CAB103.3 ROOF3.5/CAB103.3
N N
3
2
1
6
5
4
R4
3
2
1
6
5
4
5
2
4
3
N LIG30
1 2
1 2
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
CAB38.2/S12.1
R19.2/R4.2
B
R4.4/R21.2
B
R10.1/R20.1 R10.1/R18.1
1 2 3
B
1 2 3
CAB105.4/CAB38.2
B
FAI124
J3
FLASH PROGRAMING
(12) (1) (11) 31b 53b 53
(13) J
(7) 53C
O
klaxon
J
7 6 4 1
3
9
2
8
10
22
S13.1/CAB17.10
M
CAB04
CAB4 BAF8.7/CAB4.2 CAB4.2/BAF8.9 S12.1/CAB4.3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
+12 V
X4
1 +12 V
X3
B
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
CAB28 CAB4.7/CAB28.1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
N
3 4 5
TOUCHE 9
J1-14
J1-16 J1-3
6
J1-17 J1-15
1
LUZ CUADRO (J1-18) H-ACTIVE
(VERDE/VERTE)
J1_6 J1_12
DL4 DL5 DL6
REF.NTC AGCO 3714264M1
CONTACT (J1-5) H-ACTIVE
DL1 DL2 (ROJO) DL7
WARNING (J1-4) L-ACTIVE
DL3
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
3
6
3
CAB105
1
-7
2
5
8
1
1
J1-13 J1-8
CAB105 +8
7
CAB4.6/CAB4.8
M M B
6
S13
4
M
5
F25 - 25A
1 2 3 4 5 BAF8.6/S13.1 6 7 8 9 10
3
F53 - 25A
J1-7
TOUCHE 7 TOUCHE 8
H (2)
5
11 12 13
L (10)
56a (6)
2
86
87
2
TOUCHE 4/6
J1-10
lave vitre
1
85
J1-1
TEMPERATURE (J1-2)
II
R15 BAF8
+ J1-9
TOUCHE 5
J1-11
F60 - 10A
30
MICRO-PROCESSOR
2
1 3
4 6
5 7
(9) Dx
TOUCHE 4/6
-
4 6 8
3 5 7 9
10
(3) (8) 30 Sx
I
2
1
(4) 56
v9
FAI34
6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
6
1
5
2
4
3
S1
S__1.1/H_1.3
B N
1 2 3
1 2
H1 3
R19
R_37.1/S__1.1
1
N
R38
1
3
56b (5)
S1
N
CAB1
B B
S12
FAI35
R37.1/S1.1
1
1
CAB17
v8
H1
3
N N
CAB38
v7
1 2
2
N N
R10
B
8
3 6
2 5
1 2 3
R12
R37
R19
LCD
1 4
N
LIG4.4/LIG3.1
1
B B
BAF2
R28
B
S1.1/H1.3
H1
6
CAB38
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
R12.2/H1.1
FAI59
CAB17.8/BAF2.3 B BAF2.4/CAB4.5 B S12.1/BAF2.5 B B
H1
1
LIG3
R18
R3.6/R10.1 R3.5/R10.1
FAI35
BAF2.7/S12.1
3
1 2 3 4
1
BAF3.5/ROOF_4.2 B ROOF4.3/BAF3.6 B BAF3.7/ROOF4.4 B ROOF4.5/BAF3.8 B
BAF2.1/CAB17.9
2
ETAMAGE LIG31 2
BAF2.6/CAB1.29 BAF2.8/CAB1.28
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
LIG5
LIG31.2/LIG3.1 LIG30.2/LIG3.1
1
CAB104.1/ROOF4.5
BAF2
1
5
R19.2/H_1.1
BAF3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4
S10
6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB103
2
LIG4
1
S9
B B
BAF3
R26
LIG19
LIG4.1/LIG1.6 B LIG5.1/LIG1.3 B LIG1-11/LIG30.1 B LIG1.10/LIG31.1 B CAB103
LIG1.10/CAB103.5 LIG1.11/CAB103.4 CAB103.3/X1.1
R24 5
2
1
1
BAF5 BAF5 3
LIG20
1
R20
LIG1
LIG1
ETAMAGE
ETAMAGE
1 3 5
6 8
7 9 11
BAF5.3/LIG1.3
6
4
13
18
7
12
1
6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
2
46 24 1
B
R21
N
16
12 24 25
10
B B
BAF5.15/LIG1.6
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
12
LIG1.9/BAF5.14 LIG1.8/BAF5.12
4
3
13 14
LIG5.4/LIG3.1
13
14
15 17
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F24
2
1 2
23
4 5
15 26
BAF9
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4
11
1 6
16 27
J
H
14
13
28
K X
1
22
3
B
7
8
9
L B
G W
3
2
10
2 7
17
V
4
1
68 45 23
F3
29
C
A
F
M
3
9
18
D
S9.1/LIG19.1
1
E
B
3
4
19
N
T U
4
21
8
S10.1/LIG20.1
5
2
18
11
R21
30
12
10
1
P
2 20
31
R
S
N
6
5
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
LIG21.1/LIG3.1
3
3
5
2
4
R22
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
16
1
2
1
15
3
4
17
5
2
18
R25
2
BAF9
SH10
1
SH6
Fuse box Wiper control unit Trailer connector - NAO Handrail lighting harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness Fender lighting harness (US) High visibility roof harness LST pillar harness US lighting harness DCC2 Instrument panel Warning switch Headlights module - NAO and Europe Rear right-hand side lights Rear left-hand side lights Front right- and left-hand side lights
F2
2 22 42 FAI 34 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 59 FAI 124 FAI 127 CAB01 CAB04 CAB105 LIG4 LIG5 H1
B
CAB1.27/BAF9.2
CAB01
MA-10-06023A
10A02.61
Electrical diagrams Work headlights module 2 Fuse box FAI 35 Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness FAI 124 LST pillar harness FAI 129 SisuDiesel EEM engine harness FAI 135 Lights module and radio ground harness CAB105 Headlights module - NAO and Europe
2
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
+12V F58 - 7.5A 1 X4
F13 - 7.5A 1 X2
+12V
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB105
CAB105.6/BAF4.10
M
FAI 124 S1_ CAB105.5/BAF4.3
BAF4 BAF4
R
CAB105.12/S1.1
N
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
CAB105 3
13
18
7
12
1
6
CAB105 3
1
2
1
2
3
CAB38
20
31 30 18
9 10
2 7
17
11
1
15
12 13 24
14
27 26
23
4 5
16
22
3
6
28
21
8 19
29
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
25
FAI129
ENG22.1/ENG1.2
N
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB38.1/ENG1.2
N
1 2 3
FAI35
1 2 3
CAB38.1/S1.1
N
F58-7.5A
CAB38
F13-7.5A 31
20 21
8 9
10 22
18 29
7
3
17
1
11 4
23
30 19
2
12
28
6 16
5 15
13
27
14
24 25
26
2
ENG1 ENG1
1
BAT1
ENG22 1 ENG22
1
ENG22.1/BAT1.1
N
FAI 135
10A02.62
¤ H
MA-10-06033A
1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Footstep lighting - Europe 2 FAI 35 FAI 124 FAI 129 FAI 130 CAB105 TR28 TR29
Fuse box Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness LST pillar harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness DynaVT transmission harness Headlights module - NAO and Europe Left-hand footstep lighting Right-hand footstep lighting
TR28
TR29
X4
F57 - 30A
1
TR29
FAI130
10
11 12
1
R
S
D
U
H
17
10 11 23
4
1
BAF10
BAF4
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
2
12
5 15
13 24
14 26
22
3 1
6 16 27
J
X1-X5
87
9 2
7
29 28
L K X
TR31
ENG1 ENG1
M
B
G W
86
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
18
C
A
F V
R20 30
85
21
8 19
N E
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
+12V
20
31 30
P
T
1
9
2
8
3
2
7
4
3
7
6
4
8
5
5
11 10 9
7
6
12
8
6
9
5
10
4
3
11
2
12
ENG10 ENG10
1
13
B B
14
ENG1.31/ENG10.4 ENG1.30/ENG10.3
FAI35
15
R R
FAI129
B
16
ENG10.4/TR29.1 ENG10.3/TR28.1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF10.16/ENG1.30
17
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
B
18
N
2 1
TR29.2/TR31.1
TR28
N
2 1
TR28.2/TR31.1
2
2
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1
1
BAF10.18/ENG1.31
25
1
3
J3
FLASH PROGRAMING
2
MICRO-PROCESSOR
LCD
+ J1-9
TOUCHE 4 TOUCHE 5
J1-1
TOUCHE 6
J1-7
1 2 3
TOUCHE 7
J1-13
4
TOUCHE 8
J1-8
5
TOUCHE 9
J1-14
6
J1-16 J1-3 J1-17 J1-15 J1-11
J1-10
J1_6 J1_12
LUMIERE/LUZ (J1-18) H-ACTIVE
CONTACTO CONTACT (J1-5) H-ACTIVE WARNING (J1-4) L-ACTIVE
FAI124
DL4
TEMPERATURE (J1-2) VERDE/VERTE
DL5
R20
DL6
REF.NTC AGCO 3714264M1
DL1 DL2
(ROJO) (ROUGE)
DL7
DL3
CAB105
CAB105
3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
F57
CAB105.8/BAF4.12
B
CAB105.11/BAF4.9
B
13
18
7
12
1
6
MA-10-06032A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.63
Electrical diagrams Footstep lighting - North America
2
TR29
TR28
R
S
P
30 N
T E
W H
11
1 6
23
4 12
5
16 15
J
22
3
17 28
K X
21 10
2 7
29
L B
G
9
18
M C
A
V
8 19
D
U F
20
31
13
F57 - 30A
24
14
27 26
X4
25
1
TR29
2 1
TR28
2 1
1
1
2
FAI130
2
FAI129
N
N
TR28.2/TR18.1
TR29.2/TR18.1
11 12
1
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
+12V
R20 30
85
86
SH3
X1-X5
87
1
BAF10
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
ENG1
ENG1
TR18
1
10
2
9
3
8
4
2
7
6
3
7
5
4
8
7
5
11 10 9
8
6
12
9
6
10
5
11
4
3
12
2
13
ENG10 ENG10
1
FAI35
14
B B
B
15
ENG1.31/ENG10.4 ENG1.30/ENG10.3
BAF10.16/ENG1.30
16
R R
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
B
17
ENG10.4/TR29.1 ENG10.3/TR28.1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF10.18/ENG1.31
18
2 Fuse box FAI 15 Roof harness FAI 35 Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness FAI 124 LST pillar harness FAI 127 US lighting harness FAI 129 SisuDiesel EEM engine harness FAI 130 Cab Dyna VT transmission harness CAB105 Headlights module - NAO and Europe H2 Left-hand handrail lighting H3 Right-hand handrail lighting TR28 Left-hand footstep lighting TR29 Right-hand footstep lighting
BAF3
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF4
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
1
FAI15
3
2
1
6
5
4
R3.3/R19.1 R12.1/R3.3 R3.5/R10.1 R3.6/R10.1
ROOF3
R3
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
B B N N
6
5
4
3
2
1
FAI124
BAF3.2/ROOF3.3 B BAF3.1/ROOF3.3 B ROOF3.5/X1.1 N X1.1/ROOF3.6 N
CAB103 R37.1/R10.1 R10.1/R38.1
N N
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 R10
FAI127 1 2 3 4 5 6
X1 CAB103.3/X1.1
N
1
CAB103 6
1
6
1
5
2
5
2
4
3
4
3
FAI124 3
R19
1 2 3 4 5 6
R38
1
R12
1 2 3 4 5 6
R37
1
R19
1 2 3 4 5 6
R38
1
R12
1 2 3 4 5 6
R37
1
5
2
4
3
S1 R38.1/S1.1
H2.1/S1.1 N H2.2/H3.2 B
H2.1/S1.1
N
1
5
2
4
3
FLASH PROGRAMING LCD
S_1 R37.1/S1.1
N
+ TOUCHE 4/6
J1-9
SH3
1
TOUCHE 5
J1-1
2
TOUCHE 4/6
J1-7
3
TOUCHE 7
J1-13
4
TOUCHE 8
J1-8
TOUCHE 9
J1-14
J1-16
5 J1-3 6
N
R20
J1-17 J1-15
J1-11
N
J1-10
H2.2/H3.2
H2.1/S1.1
DL4
TEMPERATURE (J1-2)
B N
B
(VERDE/VERTE)
J1_6 J1_12
H2.1/S1.1
R19.1/H2.2
6
MICRO-PROCESSOR
1
R12.1/H2.2
B
J3
6
LUZ CUADRO (J1-18) H-ACTIVE
CONTACT (J1-5) H-ACTIVE
F57
DL5 DL6
REF.NTC AGCO 3714264M1
DL1 DL2 (ROJO) DL7
WARNING (J1-4) L-ACTIVE
DL3
2 CAB105
2 1
H2
2 1
H3
2 1
H2
2 1
H3
3
H2
H3
H2
H3
CAB105
10A02.64
¤ H
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
CAB105.8/BAF4.12
B
CAB105.11/BAF4.9
B
13
18
7
12
1
6
MA-10-06019A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Flashing beacons 2 FAI 60 FAI 124 CAB105 R23 R39
Fuse box Roof harness (all countries except US) LST pillar harness Headlights module - NAO and Europe Left-hand flashing beacon Right-hand flashing beacon
R27
F59-10A
3
CAB105 3 J3
FLASH PROGRAMING
2
MICRO-PROCESSOR
LCD
+ TOUCHE 4
J1-9
TOUCHE 5
J1-1
2
TOUCHE 6
J1-7
3
TOUCHE 7
J1-13
4
TOUCHE 8
J1-8
5
TOUCHE 9
J1-14
6
1
J1-16 J1-3 J1-17 J1-15 J1-11
J1-10
DL4
TEMPERATURE (J1-2) VERDE/VERTE
LUMIERE/LUZ (J1-18) H-ACTIVE
J1_6 J1_12
CONTACTO CONTACT (J1-5) H-ACTIVE WARNING (J1-4) L-ACTIVE
DL5 DL6
REF.NTC AGCO 3714264M1
DL1 DL2
(ROJO) (ROUGE)
DL7
DL3
2
14 13
B
FAI 124
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
R39 1
R39.1/R3.4
B
11
CAB105.3/BAF4.4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
12
B
9
CAB105.1/BAF4.2
10
BAF4
8
6
R39
7
12
1
6
18
5
13 7
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
3
CAB105
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
1
CAB105
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
2
5
3
R27
4 1
X1-X5
BAF4
1 BAF3
+12V 14 13
2
11
1
4
12
3
6
9
5
8
10
7
10
8
9
12
7
11
14
1
6
13
X4
F59 - 10A
5
B
4
ROOF3.4/BAF3.9
3
ROOF3
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
2
1
B
4
1
4
R23.1/R3.4
5
ROOF3 1 2 3 4 5 6
R23 1
2
5
2
FAI 60
R23
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1
6
3
3
6
FAI 124
BAF3 MA-10-06036A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.65
Electrical diagrams Standard roof work headlights 2 Fuse box FAI 15 Roof harness FAI 124 LST pillar harness CAB105 Headlights module - NAO and Europe R14 Front work headlight R15 Front work headlight R16 Front work headlight R17 Front work headlight R27 Rear work headlight R28 Rear work headlight R30 Rear work headlight R31 Rear work headlight
F55 F54 3
CAB105
R18
X8
3 J3
FLASH PROGRAMING
X7
MICRO-PROCESSOR
LCD
+ TOUCHE 4
J1-9
TOUCHE 5
J1-1
2
TOUCHE 6
J1-7
3
TOUCHE 7
J1-13
4
TOUCHE 8
J1-8
5
TOUCHE 9
J1-14
6
1
R17
J1-16 J1-3 J1-17 J1-15 J1-11
J1-10
DL4
TEMPERATURE (J1-2) VERDE/VERTE
CONTACTO CONTACT (J1-5) H-ACTIVE
LUMIERE/LUZ (J1-18) H-ACTIVE
J1_6 J1_12
DL5 DL6
REF.NTC AGCO 3714264M1
DL1 DL2
(ROJO) (ROUGE)
WARNING (J1-4) L-ACTIVE
DL7
DL3
2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
CAB105
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
13
18
7
12
1
6
B B
CAB105
2
1
1
2 6 8
4
5 7 9
10
11 13
13
2
14
1
R17_ 30
85
86
87
F55 - 25A
2
11
B
12
B
CAB105.7/BAF4.13
9
CAB105.9/BAF4.11
10
1 2
R16
N B
8
R48.1/R16.1 R16.2/S4.1
7
1
R16
6
S4
5
R48
AV
4
N B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
3
R48.1/R15.1 R15.2/S4.1
1 2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
2
R15
BAF4 BAF4
1
R15
3
F54 - 30A
12
1
2
N B
14
R48.1/R14.1 R14.2/S4.1
1 2
R14
CAB105.16/ROOF3.1 ROOF3.2/CAB105.17
R14
R18
FAI 124
30
R17 R48.1/R17.1 S4.1/R17.2
1 2
N B R3.1/S4.1 R3.2/S1.1
2
1
R17
85
B B
FAI 15 3
2
1
6
5
4
R3
R3
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
6
5
4
3
2
1
ROOF3.1/X7.1
B
X8.1/ROOF3.2
B
X7
X7
1
1
X8
X8
1
1
86
87
R27 R27.1/R42.1 S1.1/R27.2
N B
2
1 2
1
R27
1
R28 1 2
MASSE
N B
2
R28
1
AR
R28.1/R42.1 S1.1/R28.2
S1
X1
1
X4
+12V
R42 1
MA-10-06035A
R30 R30.1/R42.1 S1.1/R30.2
N B
2
1 2
1
R30
R31 R42.1/R31.1 S1.1/R31.2
N B
2
1 2
1
R31
10A02.66
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Xenon work headlights for standard roof Fuse box Roof harness Xenon flashing beacon adapter harness LST pillar harness Headlights module - NAO and Europe Xenon work headlight
F55 F54 3
CAB105
R18
X8
3 J3
FLASH PROGRAMING
X7 LCD
MICRO-PROCESSOR
2 FAI 15 FAI 58 FAI 124 CAB105 PX2
+ TOUCHE 4
J1-9
TOUCHE 5
J1-1
2
TOUCHE 6
J1-7
3
TOUCHE 7
J1-13
4
TOUCHE 8
J1-8
5
TOUCHE 9
J1-14
6
1
R17
J1-16 J1-3 J1-17 J1-15 J1-11
J1-10
VERDE/VERTE
LUMIERE/LUZ (J1-18) H-ACTIVE
J1_6 J1_12
DL3
CAB105
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
CAB105
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
N B
1
2 4 6 8
3 5 7 13
11
9
1
2
1
1
2
2
N B
B
13
R48.1/R16.1 R16.2/S4.1
14
1 2
11
B
CAB105.7/BAF4.13
12
R17_ 30
85
86
87
F55 - 25A
BAF4 1
2
2
1
1
PX2 3
1 2
CAB105.9/BAF4.11 R16
9
2 1
PX2
N B
10
PX1 3 PX2.2/PX1.1 PX2.1/PX1.2
1
8
S4
7
R48
FAI 58
6
N B
2
AV
R48.1/R15.1 R15.2/S4.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
5
1 2
BAF4 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
4
R15
F54 - 30A
10
R48.1/R14.1 R14.2/S4.1
3
1 2
1
PX2 2
N B
6
2
PX2
PX2.2/PX1.1 PX2.1/PX1.2
12
1
2 1
18
1
12
1 2
2
PX1 2
13 7
14
1 2
DL7
R14
2
1
PX2 1
N B
WARNING (J1-4) L-ACTIVE
B B
PX2.2/PX1.1 PX2.1/PX1.2
DL1 DL2
(ROJO) (ROUGE)
1
2 1
PX2
DL5 DL6
REF.NTC AGCO 3714264M1
CAB105.16/ROOF3.1 ROOF3.2/CAB105.17
PX1 1
2
DL4
TEMPERATURE (J1-2) CONTACTO CONTACT (J1-5) H-ACTIVE
1
4
4
1
2
R18 30
1
R3 R3.1/S4.1 R3.2/S1.1
2
FAI 15
B B
1 2 3 4 5 6
R3
5
2
6
R48.1/R17.1 N S4.1/R17.2 B
3
1 2
3
1 2
2
1
PX2 4
N B
6
PX2.2/PX1.1 PX2.1/PX1.2
1
2 1
PX2
R17
2
PX1 4
5
2
FAI 124 85
ROOF3.1/X7.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 X8.1/ROOF3.2
B
B
X7
X7
1
1
X8
X8
1
1
86
87
PX1 5 R27 1 2
1 2
R27.1/R42.1 S1.1/R27.2
N B
1
1 2
1
PX2 5
N B
1
PX2.2/PX1.1 PX2.1/PX1.2
2 1
2
PX2
X1
1
X4
2
+12V
PX1 6 R28 2 1
1 2
R28.1/R42.1 S1.1/R28.2
N B
1
2
MA-10-06027A 1
PX2 6
1 2
1
PX2
N B
2
AR
PX2.2/PX1.1 PX2.1/PX1.2
2
S1
FAI 58
R42 1
PX1 7 R30
N B
1 2
R30.1/R42.1 S1.1/R30.2 1
PX2.2/PX1.1 PX2.1/PX1.2
1 2
N B
2
N B
1
PX2 7
PX2.2/PX1.1 PX2.1/PX1.2
1
2 1
2
PX2
2
PX1 8 R31 R42.1/R31.1 S1.1/R31.2 1
1 2
N B
2
1
PX2 8
1 2
1
2 1
2
PX2
2
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.67
Electrical diagrams Work headlights on grille 2 Fuse box FAI 23 Cab linkage harness FAI 31 cab Dyna VT transmission harness FAI 124 LST pillar harness FAI 128 Linkage with DUAL CONTROL harness FAI 129 SisuDiesel EEM engine harness FAI 130 Cab Dyna VT transmission harness FAI 132 LST front headlights harness CAB105 Headlights module - NAO and Europe PH1 Work headlights on grille PH2 Work headlights on grille PH3 Work headlights on grille PH4 Work headlights on grille
CAB105 3
3 J3
FLASH PROGRAMING
18
4
23
29
7 17
1
28
6 16
5
12
15
13 24
27
14 25
26
FAI128 3
1
4
1
4
2
3
2
ENG10.10/TR36.4 ENG10.11/TR36.3
R R
4 3 2 1
L14.21/TR36.4 L14.22/TR36.3
4 3 2 1
R R
TR36 TR36
19 18
9 10
2 7
29
15
5
TOUCHE 9
J1-14
6
2 3
J1-16 J1-3 J1-17 J1-15 J1-11
12
DL4
TEMPERATURE (J1-2)
24
LUMIERE/LUZ (J1-18) H-ACTIVE
VERDE/VERTE
25 J1_6 J1_12
FAI23
L20.10/L14.21 L20.11/L14.22
J1-8
J1-10
13 14
26
4
TOUCHE 8
1
23
4 5
16 27
J1-13
11
1 6
J1-7
TOUCHE 7
22
3
17 28
TOUCHE 6
L20
L20
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
R R
FAI31 4
3
3
4
2
1
1
2
CAB97.3/L20.10 CAB97.2/L20.11
DL5 DL6
REF.NTC AGCO 3714264M1
DL1 DL2
(ROJO) (ROUGE)
DL7
DL3
CAB105
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
CAB105
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
4 3 2 1
R R
4 3 2 1
CAB97.3/X15.1 CAB97.2/X15.1
B B
CAB97 CAB97 1
2
4
5
6
6
5
4
3
2
12
11 10 9
8
7
7
8
9
10
11 12
3
CONTACTO CONTACT (J1-5) H-ACTIVE WARNING (J1-4) L-ACTIVE
1
13
18
7
12
1
6
B
19 2
3 11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
J1-1
FAI124
BAF1.2X14.1 R BAF1.1/X14.1 R
30
21
J1-9
TOUCHE 5
BAF1.4/CAB105.13
9 10 22
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
20 8
+ TOUCHE 4
B
8
30
X15.1/CAB105.15
21
L14 31
31
20
L14
MICRO-PROCESSOR
LCD
X15
1
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF1
X14
1
X15
1
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF1
X14
1
1
X2
PH1
FAI130
PH1.1/S5.1 PH1.2/S1.1 1
6
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
1
1
2
4
5
6
12
11 10 9
8
7
3
ENG9
1
B N
1 2
PH1
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
2
F10 - 25A
FAI132
R31
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
ENG8 ENG8 ENG8.1/ENG9.1 N ENG8.2/ENG9.1 N
ENG10.11/ENG8.5 ENG10.10/ENG8.6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
B B
ENG8.1/S1.1 ENG8.2/S2.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
PH2
N N
S5 S1
PH2.1/S5.1 PH2.2/S1.1
B N
1 2
PH2 R31
ENG8.5/S5.1 B ENG8.6/S6.1 B
1
2 30
FAI129
85
ENG10 ENG10
5
8
4
1
1
2
3
4
8
7
6
5
87
PH3 S6 S2
PH3.1/S6.1 PH3.2/S2.1
1
B N
1 2
86
PH3
2
PH4 PH4.1/S6.1 PH4.2/S2.1
2
1
B N
1 2
PH4
2 1
X1X5
2
F10
MA-10-06034A
10A02.68
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Fender and handrail work headlights 2 FAI 37
Fuse box Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 60 Roof harness (all countries except US) FAI 61 Handrail lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 124 LST pillar harness FAI 126 Lighting harness - Europe CAB105 Headlights module - NAO and Europe H2 Left-hand handrail lighting H3 Right-hand handrail lighting LIG13 Right-hand fender work headlight LIG14 Left-hand fender work headlight
SH2-30A
CAB105
R19 3
F56-25A 3 J3
H3
H2
FLASH PROGRAMING LCD
H3 MICRO-PROCESSOR
H2
+ J1-9
TOUCHE 4 TOUCHE 5
J1-1
TOUCHE 6
J1-7
1 2 3
TOUCHE 7
J1-13
4
TOUCHE 8
J1-8
5
TOUCHE 9
J1-14
6
J1-16 J1-3
2
J1-17 J1-15 J1-11
J1-10
DL4
TEMPERATURE (J1-2)
J1_6 J1_12
1
1 2
H2
1 2
H2
1 2
2
2
CAB105
N
1
2 4 6
3 5 9
B
8
H2.1/S1.1
R19.1/H2.2
1
3
2
5
2
3 1
3
1
4
1 6
13
N
14
R38.1/S1.1
11
B
12
R12.1/H2_.2
9
N
10
B
8
CAB105.14/BAF4.14
7
1 2 3
B
6
R19
CAB105.10/BAF4.7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
5
1
BAF4 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
4
R37.1/S1_.1
6
3
R38
2
1 2 3
5
1 2 3
R19
6
R12
1
3
1
3
R37
R38 2
1 2 3
12
1 2
3
R12
1 2
1
18
1
2
S1
R37
13 7
2
H3.1/S1.1
N
N
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
1
S1
CAB105
7
1
1
FAI61
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
B
10
2
H2.2/H3.2
H3_.1/S1_.1
2
1
N
H3
1 2
2
B
H2_.1/S1_.1
1 2
1
H2_.2/H3_.2
H3
11
H3
1 2
12
1 2
DL3
14
H3
DL7
13
H2
1 2
4
1 2
DL1 DL2
(ROJO) (ROUGE)
1
2
H2
DL5 DL6
REF.NTC AGCO 3714264M1
WARNING (J1-4) L-ACTIVE
1 2
CONTACTO CONTACT (J1-5) H-ACTIVE
LUMIERE/LUZ (J1-18) H-ACTIVE
VERDE/VERTE
X4 F56 - 25A
BAF4 R10.1/R38.1
N
1
FAI124 R3
FAI60
ROOF3 BAF3 BAF3
ROOF3.5/CAB103.3 CAB103.3/ROOF3.6
N N
1
3
4 6 8 14
5 7 9
10
11
12
13
R19_ X1-X5 30
1 85
87a
86
MASSE
X1.1/CAB103.3
SH2 - 30A
N
13
2
14
1
11
2
12
2
1 3
4 6
5 7
8
9
10 12
11 13
87
14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
16
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
15
17
1
9
16
2
10
15
FAI126
18
B B
13
1
14
X1
11
1
8
7
26
12
2
6
27
LIG1.12/BAF5.17 LIG1.13/BAF5.18
5
16 15
14 25
28
6 5
13
9
¤ H
17
BAF5
10
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
4 12 24
29
8
LIG14
18 7
1
11 23
30 19
2
7
LIG13
8 9 3
6
2 1
31
20 21 10 22
5
LIG14
LIG13
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
3
2 1
2 1
B
1
LIG1
4
LIG14
25
2
CAB103
1
2 1
24
LIG1.12/LIG13.1
N B
23 12
13 14
3
6 5 4 3 2 1
2
LIG13.2/LIG3.1 LIG1.13/LIG14.1
11 4
5 15 26
22
3 1
6 16 27
4
4
17
N
10
5
CAB103
3
9 2
7
29 28
FAI37
21
8 19
18
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
6
6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
2
20
31 30
1
4
R10
LIG1
LIG3
1
5
N 1
LIG14.2/LIG3.1
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1
R37.1/R10.1
3 6
B B
17
N N
BAF3.1/ROOF3.3 BAF3.2/ROOF3.3
1
R3.5/R10.1 R3.6/R10.1
1 2 3 4 5 6
18
1 2 3 4 5 6
B B
2
R3.3/R19.1 R12.1/R3.3
BAF5
MA-10-06021A
LIG13
10A02.69
Electrical diagrams Roof work headlights - North America 2 Fuse box FAI 15 Roof harness FAI 35 Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness FAI 124 Pillar Dyna VT harness CAB04 Warning switch CAB105 Headlights module - NAO and Europe R14 Front work headlight R15 Front work headlight R16 Front work headlight R17 Front work headlight R27 Rear work headlight R28 Rear work headlight R30 Rear work headlight R31 Rear work headlight
F55 F54
CAB105
R18
3
X8 J3
3
FLASH PROGRAMING
X7
MICRO-PROCESSOR
LCD
+ TOUCHE 4/6
J1-9
TOUCHE 5
J1-1
2
TOUCHE 4/6
J1-7
1
3
TOUCHE 7
J1-13
4
TOUCHE 8
J1-8
5
TOUCHE 9
J1-14
R17 J1-16 J1-3
6
J1-17 J1-15
J1-11 J1-10
DL4
TEMPERATURE (J1-2)
(ROJO)
13
18
7
12
1
6
2
1
1
2 6 8
4
5 7 9
10
11 13
13
2
14
B
11
B
CAB105.7/BAF4.13
12
1 2
R16
N B
9
R48.1/R16.1 R16.2/S4.1
10
CAB105.9/BAF4.11 R16
8
1
7
S4
6
R48
AV
5
N B
4
R48.1/R15.1 R15.2/S4.1
1 2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
3
R15
BAF4 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
2
R15
3
F54 - 30A
1
B B
N B
CAB105.16/ROOF3.1 ROOF3.2/CAB105.17
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 B
CAB105 CAB105
2
1
2
CAB105.4/CAB38.2
R48.1/R14.1 R14.2/S4.1
1 2
DL3
12
DL7
WARNING (J1-4) L-ACTIVE
R14
R14
DL1 DL2
14
(VERDE/VERTE)
J1_6 J1_12
DL5 DL6
REF.NTC AGCO 3714264M1
CONTACT (J1-5) H-ACTIVE
LUZ CUADRO (J1-18) H-ACTIVE
R17_ 30
85
86
87
F55 - 25A
2
1
BAF4 R18
FAI 124
30
R17 R48.1/R17.1 S4.1/R17.2
1 2
N B
X7 R3 R3.1/S4.1 R3.2/S1.1
2
1
R17
85
B B
FAI 15 3
2
1
6
5
4
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
6
5
4
3
2
1
ROOF3.1/X7.1
B
X8.1/ROOF3.2
B
1
X8
R3
1
X7 1
X8 1 F25 - 25A
R27 R27.1/R42.1 S1.1/R27.2
N B
CAB38
R28 R28.1/R42.1 S1.1/R28.2
2
R42
+8
6
3
N B
1
2
1
R30.1/R42.1 S1.1/R30.2
-7
R31
10A02.70
¤ H
1
X1
1
X4
2
5
CAB4.2/BAF8.9 CAB4.2/BAF8.7 CAB04.3/S12.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
M M B
MA-10-06085A
FAI35
CAB04
N B
2
R42.1/R31.1 S1.1/R31.2 1
1 2
BAF8
+12V
CAB04
1
R31
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1
S12 S1
1 2
2
CAB38
R30
R30
CAB38.2/S12.1 B 3
3
N B
2
R28
1
1
AR
1 2
3 2 1
3 2 1
2
1 2
1
R27
86
87
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Xenon roof work headlights - North America F55
Fuse box Roof harness Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness Xenon flashing beacon adapter harness Pillar Dyna VT harness Warning switch Headlights module - NAO and Europe Xenon work headlight
F54
CAB105
R18
3
X8 3 J3
FLASH PROGRAMING
X7 LCD
MICRO-PROCESSOR
2 FAI 15 FAI 35 FAI 58 FAI 124 CAB04 CAB105 PX2
+ TOUCHE 4/6
J1-9
TOUCHE 5
J1-1
2
TOUCHE 4/6
J1-7
1
3
TOUCHE 7
J1-13
4
TOUCHE 8
J1-8
5
TOUCHE 9
J1-14
6
R17 J1-16 J1-3 J1-17 J1-15
J1-11 J1-10
DL4
TEMPERATURE (J1-2) LUZ CUADRO (J1-18) H-ACTIVE
(VERDE/VERTE)
J1_6 J1_12
DL7
CAB105
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
CAB105
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 11
12
13
1
B
1
2
2
13
R17_ 30
85
86
87
F55 - 25A
1
2
2
1
N B
14
R48.1/R16.1 R16.2/S4.1
11
1 2
12
1
PX2-3
1 2
9
2 1
PX2
10
B
CAB105.7/BAF4.13
8
CAB105.9/BAF4.11 PX1-3 R16 N B
7
2
1
6
R48 S4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
5
N B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
4
BAF4 BAF4
3
R48.1/R15.1 R15.2/S4.1
FAI 58
PX2.2/PX1.1 PX2.1/PX1.2
2
F54 - 30A
14
1
2
2
2
2
1 2
6
1
1 2
1
PX2-2
AV
N B
12
10
N B
2
PX2
PX2.2/PX1.1 PX2.1/PX1.2
18
1
B B
R48.1/R14.1 R14.2/S4.1
PX1-2 R15 2 1
13 7
B
R14 1 2
DL3
CAB105.16/ROOF3.1 ROOF3.2/CAB105.17
1 2
1
PX2-1
N B
(ROJO)
WARNING (J1-4) L-ACTIVE
1
PX2.2/PX1.1 PX2.1/PX1.2
DL1 DL2
CAB105.4/CAB38.2
PX1-1 2 1
PX2
DL5 DL6
REF.NTC AGCO 3714264M1
CONTACT (J1-5) H-ACTIVE
86
4
1 2
N R3
1
3
6
R48.1/R17.1 S4.1/R17.2 B
3
1 2
85
6
1 2
2
1
PX2-4
N B
R3.1/S4.1 R3.2/S1.1
2
PX2.2/PX1.1 PX2.1/PX1.2
R17
1
2 1
PX2
30
5
2
5
4
1
2
PX1-4
R18
FAI 124
2
FAI 15
B B
1 2 3 4 5 6
R3
ROOF3.1/X7.1
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 X8.1/ROOF3.2
B
X7
X7
1
1
X8
X8
1
1
87
F25 - 25A 3 2 1
PX1-5 R27 1 2
1 2
R27.1/R42.1 S1.1/R27.2
CAB38.2/S12.1
B S12
N CAB38 CAB38
B
1
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 2
1
PX2-5
N B
1
PX2.2/PX1.1 PX2.1/PX1.2
2 1
2
PX2
3 2 1
2
PX1-6 R28 1 2
1 2
+8
1
1
R42
2
S1
FAI 58
1
-7
PX1-7 R30
N B
1 2
R30.1/R42.1 S1.1/R30.2 1
PX2.2/PX1.1 PX2.1/PX1.2
1 2
N B
CAB04
2
5
X1
1
X4
CAB4.2/BAF8.9 M CAB4.2/BAF8.7 M CAB04.3/S12.1 B
FAI35 8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
MA-10-06086A
2
N B
1
PX2-7
PX2.2/PX1.1 PX2.1/PX1.2
1
2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
2
PX2
6
3
R28.1/R42.1 N S1.1/R28.2 B
2
1
PX2-6
N B
1
PX2.2/PX1.1 PX2.1/PX1.2
2 1
2
AR
PX2
BAF8
+12V
CAB04
2
PX1-8 R31 R42.1/R31.1 S1.1/R31.2 1
1 2
N B
2
1
PX2-8
1 2
1
2 1
2
PX2
2
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.71
Electrical diagrams Reversing light 2 FAI 31 FAI 37
Fuse box Cab Dyna VT transmission harness Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 126 Cab interior lighting harness (all countries except US) CAB54 Autotronic 4 calculator LIG15 Reversing light junction
LIG1
9
17
15
13 24 25
1
R4 5
2
3
4 1
+12V
12
14
27
23
4
26
X1X5
11
1 5
16
22
3
6
28
10
2 7
F7- 5A 1 X2 17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI126
LIG1.7/BAF5.11 BAF5.9/CAB81.1
B B
1
2
CAB81
1 2 3
CAB81
1 2 3
3
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31
20 21
8
18
2
17
1 4
12
16
LIG15
15
13
27
14 25
28
6 5
24
29
7
3 11
23
30 19
9 10 22
26
LIG15
1 2 2
1
B N
18 29
2
21
8 19
LIG15.1/S12.1 LIG5.2/LIG3.1
20
31 30
FAI37
1 LIG3
S12.1/LIG1.7
B
S12
BAF5 LIG1
R4
1 2 3
F7
FAI31 CAB81.1/CAB54.25
CAB54
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
CAB54 46 24 1
68 45 23
MA-10-06030A
10A02.72
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams
E . Electronic units supply Autotronic 4 electronic unit supply........................... 75 Datatronic 3 electronic unit supply........................... 76 Autotronic 5 Linkage electronic unit supply ............. 77 Autotronic 5 ParkLock electronic unit supply ........... 78 EEM Sisu electronic unit supply............................... 79 DCC2 supply ............................................................ 80
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.73
Electrical diagrams
Page left blank intentionally
10A02.74
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Autotronic 4 electronic unit supply 2 FAI 31 FAI 124 CAB54
Fuse box Cab Dyna VT transmission harness Pillar harness Autotronic 4 calculator CAB54
46 24 1
68 45 23
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
CAB54
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
R
CAB97
3
2
1
CAB73-1
1
BAF1.3/CAB97.1
S8
2 14 13
12 11
10 9
8 7
6 5
4 3
2 1
BAF1
15
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
16
BAF1
17
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
18
FAI124
4
CAB73.1.1/CAB54.55
1 2 3 4
M M M M M
1 2 3 4
S8.1/CAB54.56 S8.1/CAB54.57 S8.1/CAB54.58 S8.1/CAB54.59 S8.1/CAB54.60
2
M
1
CAB97
FAI 31
CAB54.54/S8.1
4
CAB97.4/CAB54.28
3
N
R
CAB54
F12
1
3
5
7
9
11
13
15
17
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
18
16
F62
F12
- 15A
X2
1 X12
F62
2
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
- 50A
+12V
1
X4
1 X12
S8.1/X12.1
M
MA-10-06067A
+12V
1
10A02.75
Electrical diagrams Datatronic 3 electronic unit supply 2 FAI 23 FAI 31 FAI 131
Fuse box Cab linkage harness Cab Dyna VT transmission harness Datatronic 3 harness CAB112
6
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 R S2.1/CAB112.8
FAI131
2
M
12 11 10 9 8 7 12 11 10
9
8
7
1
4
5
6
2
3
1 2 3 4 5 6
FAI 31 L20.9/CAB73.1.1
N
BAF12 BAF12.7/L20.5
L20.2/CAB73.1.1
CAB73 1
R
N
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L20
L20
L20.9/S15.1
R N L22.5/S2.1 L22.6/S1.1
L22.3/CAB112.9
BAF12.9/L20.1
7
L22
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
L22
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 L22.5/S7.1 R S1.1/L22.6 N S15.1/L22.7 N
18
S2
S13.1/L22.3 M
17
16
15 13
14
11
1
12
2
9
3
10
4
8
6
5
7
7
6
8
5
9
3
10
4
11
1
12
2
13
+12V
14
X2
15
1
F18 - 7.5A
16
1
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
17
F21 - 7.5A
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
18
+12V
M
S1
BAF12
X4
N
CAB112
F18-7.5A
L22.7/CAB112.12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
N
CAB112
S1.1/CAB112.10
F21-7.5A
2
1
5
4
1 2 3
4
6
3
2
1
5 6 7
S15
N
FAI 23 S7.1/L20.5
S7
R
S1.1/L20.2 N S13.1/L20.1 M
S_1 S13
1
MA-10-06068A
10A02.76
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams Autotronic 5 Linkage electronic unit supply 2 FAI 23 FAI 31 L13
Fuse box Cab linkage harness Cab Dyna VT transmission harness Autotronic 5 electronic linkage calculator L13
29
42
15
28
1
14
R
N M S7
S7.1/L13.42
R N L13.14/S7.1 L13.15/S1.1
L13.28/S1.1 S13.1/L13.29
R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
L13.9/S7.1
L13
R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
L13.1/S7.1
L13
S1
17
16 18
15 13
14
11
12 8
9
+12V
1
10
7
FAI 31
X4
F21 - 7.5A
6
M
+12V
1
5
BAF12.9/L20.1
X2
F18 - 7.5A
3
R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
4
1
2 4
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
BAF12.7/L20.5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
1
1
BAF12
2
CAB73 1
5
3
N L20.2/CAB73_1.1
F18-7.5A
16
L20
15
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
17
L20
18
S1.1/L20.2 L20.1/S13.1
L20.5/S7.1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F21-7.5A
2
FAI 23
6
N M
R
S13
2
BAF12
MA-10-06069A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.77
Electrical diagrams Autotronic 5 ParkLock electronic unit supply
CAB141
29
42
15
28
1
14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
CAB141
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
S15
CAB141.42/S14.1 R
CAB141.28/S15.1 N CAB141.29/S13.1 M
CAB141.14/S14.1 CAB141.15/S15.1
CAB141.1/S7.1
R N
CAB141
R
2 Fuse box FAI 23 Cab linkage harness FAI 31 Cab Dyna VT transmission harness CAB141 ParkLock electronic calculator (Autotronic 5)
L20.9/CAB73_1.1
N
1 CAB73 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF6
6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF6
5
3
1
6
4
2
FAI 23 S14 S13 5
4
6
X2 +12V
F18 - 7.5A 1
X4 F21 - 7.5A
+12V
18
17 13
14
11
8 6
9 7 5
10
12
15
16
1
3
7
8
9
10
6
7 8
11
16
13 15 17
18
4
4 3 2
11 10 9
1
12
5
1 2
7
3
9
5
8
6
10
F22-10A
11 12
5
FAI 31
3
F21-7.5A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
4
R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
1
N
L20.5/BAF12.7
R
1
S15.1/L20.9
L20.3/BAF6.2
3
2
F22 - 10A
BAF12
M
2
R
L20.1/BAF12.9
2
S7.1/L20.5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
4
R
L20
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
6
S14.1/L20.3
L20
12
2
M
14
S7
S13.1/L20.1
1
2
BAF12
MA-10-06071A
F18-7.5A
10A02.78
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electrical diagrams EEM Sisu electronic unit supply 2 FAI 35 FAI 129 ENG4
Fuse box Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness Electronic injection harness junction
2
31
20 21
8 9
10 22
18
4
17 16 15
13 24
27
14 25
28
6 5
12
29
7 1
11 23
30 19
2 3
26
ENG4
FAI129 ENG4
FAI35 F28-20A
F32-10A
31
20 21
8 9
10 22
2
BAF10 F28
4 12
F32 - 10A
1
3
5
7
9
11
13
15
17
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
18
16
28 16
15 27
14 25
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
17
5
24
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
29
6
13
- 20A
18 7
1
11 23
30 19
2 3
26
BAF10.17/ENG2.14 BAF10.15/ENG2.13
M M
BAF10.10/ENG2.11
M
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
S12.1/ENG4.3
31
20 21
8 9
10 22
18
4 12
17 28
6 16
5 15
13 24
29
7 1
11 23
30 19
2 3
27
14 25
26
ENG2.14/S12.1 ENG2.13/S12.1
M M
ENG2.11/ENG4.1
M
S12
M
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 ENG4
BAF10 ENG2 ENG2 17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
MA-10-06070A ENG9 1 X4
ENG4.4/ENG9.1 N ENG4.2/ENG9.1 N
1
+12V
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
¤ H
10A02.79
Electrical diagrams DCC2 supply 2 Fuse box FAI 35 Dyna VT Instrument panel with EEM harness CAB01 DCC2 Instrument panel
CAB01
46 24 1
68 45 23
CAB1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
CAB1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
FAI 35
BAF9.3/CAB1.1
R
BAF7.8/CAB1.68
M
CAB28 CAB28.1/CAB1.23
N
1
F51-15A 17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
9 10
7
5
3
1
8
6
4
2
F4-10A
+12V
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF9
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF7
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF9
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF7
1
3
5
7
9
11
13
15
17
1
3
5
7
9
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
18
16
2
4
6
8
10
F4- 10A 1 X2
F51 - 15A 1
2
X4
10A02.80
¤ H
2
MA-10-06083A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.a
Electronics
11 - Electronics CONTENTS 11B10
- EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description
GUF101 - SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Programming GUF102 - SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Tests and diagnostics GUF103 - SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes GUF105 - SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams 11C10
- DCC2 - Description
GUF211 - DCC2 (DynaVT) – Programming and setting parameters GUF213 - DCC2 (DynaVT) - Error codes GUF214 - DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments GUF215 - DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams 11D10
- Autotronic 4 - Description
GUF401 - AUTOTRONIC 4 - Programming and setting parameters GUF402 - AUTOTRONIC 4 - Tests and diagnostics GUF403 - AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes GUF404 - AUTOTRONIC 4 - Calibration GUF405 - AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams 11E10
- Autotronic 5 - ParkLock - Description
GUF531 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Programming
Massey Ferguson 8400
¤ H
Contents - i
Electronics GUF532 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Tests and diagnostics GUF533 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Error codes GUF535 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Electrical diagrams 11F10
- Autotronic 5 - Linkage - Description
GUF521 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters GUF522 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Tests and diagnostics - MF6400/7400/8400 GUF523 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400 GUF524 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Calibration and adjustments GUF525 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams - MF6400/7400/8400 11G10
- Datatronic 3 - Description
GUF601 - DATATRONIC 3 - Programming GUF604 - DATATRONIC 3 - Calibration and adjustments GUF605 - DATATRONIC 3 - Electrical diagrams GUF71 - SMS - JOYSTICK - Setting parameters GUF72 - SMS - JOYSTICK - Tests and diagnostics GUF73 - SMS - JOYSTICK - Error codes GUF74 - SMS - JOYSTICK - Settings GUF75 - SMS - JOYSTICK - Electrical diagrams - Auto 5 linkage
Contents - ii
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400
EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description
11B10 - EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description
CONTENTS A . Presentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Components on the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 C . VP30 electronic injection pump (66ETA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 D . VP44 electronic injection pump (74ETA/84ETA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 E . Details of electronic components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 F . Tractor / Engine Communication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 G . Cab controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11B10.1
EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description
11B10.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description
A . Presentation
B . Components on the engine
The main function of the engine electronic control is to continuously adjust and measure the load, quantity of fuel and rotational speed. Other additional functions include the automatic cold start and automatic engine protection. The electronic control unit receives continuous signals from sensors that measure different functions in the engine, for example rotational speed, oil pressure, turbo booster pressure and coolant temperature. The control unit receives information via the CAN bus from the injection pump control unit and from the cab concerning engine load requirements. With the EEM2 unit it is also possible carry out diagnostics with a large number of codes.
Basic diagram (Fig. 1) Parts list (1) Electronic control unit (ECU) (2) Coolant temperature sensor (3) Oil pressure sensor (4) Speed sensor (5) Intake air manifold heater (Grid Heater) (6) Grid Heater relay (7) Intake air pressure and temperature sensor (8) Harness fitted to engine (9) Fuel pressure sensor (10) Electric lift pump (11) Pump control unit (PCU) (ENG4) SisuDiesel harness / Engine harness junction
Fig. 1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11B10.3
EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description Position on the engine
Fig. 2
ECU ECU (Electronic Control Unit) is the master calculator of the electronic injection system. ENGINE SIDE
Lift pump control
TRACTOR SIDE
SENSOR Engine speed and injection timing
Grid Heater control Error indicator
Air temperature Digital outputs
Coolant temperature Oil temperature
Throttle pedal potentiometer
Oil pressure
Digital inputs
Inlet pressure
Engine emergency stop Engine speed Voltage supply
Fig. 3
11B10.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description
C . VP30 electronic injection pump (66ETA) 4
3
12
13
9
1
8
10
4
7
3
12
15
2
1
5
13
6
7
8
9
10
11
Fig. 4
MA-11-1010A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11B10.5
EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description The Bosch VP30 pump is a rotating injection pump. It includes a small electronic control unit (PCU) which only communicates with the ECU via a 500Kb CAN network. NOTE: If the pump is sent to a Bosch dealer, it is IMPERATIVE to fit PLUGS into the inlet and outlet unions. Parts list (1) Fuel quantity solenoid valve (2) Tank (3) Pump control unit (PCU) (4) Pump secondary speed and position sensor (5) Pressure relief valve (6) Transfer pump (7) Timing device solenoid valve (8) Advance timing variator (9) Spur ring (10) Cam plate (11) Fuel injector (12) Fuel temperature sensor (13) Plunger (15) Transfer pump
Pump filling phase (Fig. 5) When the plunger (13) retracts, the fuel control solenoid valve (1) is not supplied. In this case the valve is open which allows the pump chamber to fill with fuel.
1
12v
n)
0v (off)
MA-11-01011A
11B10.6
¤ H
13
11 Fig. 5
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description Injection phase (Fig. 6) As the plunger (13) starts to move forwards, the fuel control solenoid valve (1) is supplied, which closes the valve. The fuel pressure increases in the chamber. This forces the fuel out to the injector (11). When the ECU has calculated that enough fuel has been delivered the solenoid (1) is no longer supplied. The pressure inside the pumping chamber drops and injection stops.
1
MA-11-01012A
Advance timing (Fig. 7) During the advance timing phase, the PWM signal is decreased, thus reducing the size of the channel in the valve (7) and therefore the flow of pressurised fuel through it. This increases the pressure in the advance timing variator (8) which pushes against the spring and moves the mechanism to an advanced position.
5
11
13
Fig. 6
6
4
8 12v
PWM
0v
7
MA-11-01013A
Timing delay (Fig. 8) During the timing delay phase, the PWM signal to the solenoid (7) is increased which widens the channel in the valve. This allows more fuel to flow through the solenoid and relieves the pressure in the advance timing variator (8). The spring pushes back the mechanism and delays injection.
5
6
Fig. 7
4
8 12v
MA-11-01042A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
7
PWM
0v
Fig. 8
11B10.7
EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description
D . VP44 electronic injection pump (74ETA/84ETA) 4
12
3
1
5
6
9
8
4
7
3
13
15
2
1
6
11B10.8
¤ H
10
9
8
5
MA-11-1392A
11
Fig. 9
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description The Bosch VP44 pump is a radial piston injection pump. It includes a small electronic control unit (PCU) which only communicates with the ECU via a 500Kb CAN network. NOTE: If the pump is sent to a Bosch dealer, it is IMPERATIVE to fit PLUGS into the inlet and outlet unions. Parts list (1) Fuel quantity solenoid valve (2) Tank (3) Pump control unit (PCU) (4) Pump secondary speed and position sensor (5) Spool valve rotor (6) Transfer pump (7) Timing device solenoid valve (8) Advance timing variator (9) Cam bush (10) Pistons (11) Fuel injector (12) Fuel temperature sensor (13) Hydraulic head (15)Transfer pump
Pump filling phase (Fig. 10) When the plungers (10) are set apart, the fuel control solenoid valve (1) is not supplied. In this case the valve is open, which allows the fuel from the transfer pump to fill the spool valve rotor.
5
13
10
1 12v (on)
0v (off)
MA-11-01393A
Fig. 10
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11B10.9
EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description Injection phase (Fig. 11) When the spool valve rotor (5) rotates, the fuel control solenoid valve (1) is supplied, which closes the valve. In this case, the fuel pressure rises in the rotor and the hydraulic head (13) because the pistons (10) are tightened by the cam bush. This forces the fuel out to the injector (11). When the ECU has calculated that enough fuel has been delivered the solenoid (1) is no longer supplied. The pressure inside the spool valve rotor drops and injection stops.
5
13
10
1
11 MA-11-01394A
Fig. 11 Advance timing (Fig. 12) During the advance timing phase, the PWM signal is decreased, thus reducing the size of the channel in the valve (7) and therefore the flow of pressurised fuel through it. This increases the pressure in the advance timing variator (8) which pushes against the spring and moves the mechanism to an advanced position.
10 9 6 8
12v
PWM
7 0v MA-11-01395A
Fig. 12
Timing delay (Fig. 13) During the timing delay phase, the PWM signal to the solenoid (7) is increased which widens the channel in the valve. This allows more fuel to flow through the solenoid and relieves the pressure in the advance timing variator (8). The spring pushes back the mechanism and delays injection.
10 9 6 8
12v
PWM
7 0v MA-11-01396A
Fig. 13
11B10.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description
E . Details of electronic components Inlet air pressure and temperature sensor
Resistance (Ohm) Out-of-tolerance range, HIGH
1. Ground 2. Temperature signal 3. +5V 4. Pressure signal Location: on the inlet manifold, screws M5 / 3.3 Nm. Characteristics: Power supply: 5V Output signal: 0.5V to 4.5V
Out-of-tolerance range, LOW Temp (°C) Fig. 15
Out-of-tolerance range, HIGH
Out-of-tolerance range, LOW Fig. 14 Fig. 16
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11B10.11
EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description Oil pressure sensor (Fig. 17 and Fig. 18)
Coolant temperature sensor (Fig. 19)
1. Ground 2. Pressure signal 3. +5V Location: On the cylinder block, right-hand side Thread M10 x 1 / 25 Nm O’ring V6158 71016 Characteristics: Power supply: 5V Output signal: 0.5V (0 bar) to 4.5V (10 bar)
Resistance (Ohm)
Fig. 17 Temp (°C) Out-of-tolerance range, HIGH Fig. 19
Out-of-tolerance range, LOW
Fig. 18
11B10.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description Grid Heater Only activated by ECU. There are 2 phases: - A : Post heating - B: Pre heating
Fig. 20
Speed sensor (Fig. 21) 1. Ground 2. Rpm signal 3. +12V Location: On the cylinder block, right-hand side Screws M8 / 25 Nm, O’ring V6146 01524 Characteristics: Hall effect Power supply: 12V Output signal: 4V to 8V
Fig. 21
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11B10.13
EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description
F . Tractor / Engine Communication
Fig. 22 Parts list: (CAB44) Throttle pedal potentiometer (CAB84) A and B memorised speeds activation switch (CAB85) Memorised speeds + and - adjusting switch During normal operation, the throttle pedal potentiometer value is read by the DCC2 which sends the information to the ECU via the CAN. The programming and parameter setting of the DCC2 determines the minimum engine speed sent via the CAN to the ECU. The hand throttle control is mechanically linked to the foot pedal. If a problem occurs on the CAN network, the direct line to the ECU is used to read the throttle pedal potentiometer value. NOTE: The throttle pedal potentiometer can be calibrated (see GUF 214). Characteristic: - Provides linear voltage output (0.5V to 4.5V)
11B10.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description
G . Cab controls Engine speed can be controlled in several ways from the cab: - Throttle pedal - Hand throttle control lever - Memorised speed A (Fig. 23) - Memorised speed B (Fig. 23)
A
+
B
-
MA-11-01000A
Fig. 23
Activating memorised speeds No speed is activated when the engine is started. However, the ECU will have memorised A and B speeds before the engine was last switched off. Memorised speed A is activated by pressing memory button A (Fig. 24) Memorised speed B is activated by pressing memory button B (Fig. 25) When the speed is activated: - It is always possible to shift from one speed to the other (A to B or B to A) - It can still be adjusted (see later) - The speed reduces to idle (no activation) when: • The activated memory button is pressed • The brake pedals are pressed down • The throttle pedal is pressed very quickly for a very short time.
A
R PM MA-11-01003A
Fig. 24
B
RPM MA-11-01004A
Fig. 25
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11B10.15
EEM2 SisuDiesel - Description Memorising engine speeds - Select the required speed using either: • The foot throttle control • The hand throttle control - Press and hold the desired memory button (A or B) for 1 or 2 seconds. - The speed is memorised and activated - Carry out this procedure for both memories - The speed is saved even if the ignition is switched off
A
+
B
-
MA-11-01000A
Fig. 26
Adjusting activated speeds When the speed is activated, it can be adjusted by pressing the + or – buttons. - By holding the + or - button pressed, the engine speed is increased (or decreased) rapidly. - To fine-tune engine speed, press the + or - button briefly to adjust the speed by 10 rpm.
A
NOTE: Depending on the different models and equipment, the stored and active speed values are displayed on the DOT MATRIX screen or on the Datatronic 3.
R PM MA-11-01003A
Fig. 27
B
RPM MA-11-01004A
Fig. 28
11B10.16
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Programming
GUF101 - SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION Programming
CONTENTS A . Matching serial numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 B . Location of softs for WinEEM2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 C . List of the various engine softs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
¤ H
GUF101.1
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Programming
GUF101.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Programming - Turn on the ignition key. - Start Wintest. - Click on the “Engine” icon
Wintest
DCC2 : 3.02 AUTO 3 : B20
CLIM : 20.05 JOY : 3.6
EHRC : 1.9
DATA : D040911
MA-11-01096A
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
¤ H
GUF101.3
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Programming The following screen is displayed: Electronic injection
+ 0,00
OFF
14%
70.0 C
22 C
376 kPa
0%
Set RATIO :
0
571.0 L
101 h
1500 rpm R57
7K4 X A M
2600
7K4 X A M
220 rpm
R57
1
R57
2%
1 2
2 1
1 ENG20
1
1 ENG22 1
ENG21
31 7 1 R51
81 21 6
CAB34 1
R001
654321 7 8 9 101112
W011_5MM_MARRON
CAB24 1 1 W0123MM MARRON
1
W108_ 3MM_ROUGE
CAB32 1
CAB35 W109_3MM_ROUGE
1X2
X4
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
CAB21 1
W110_3MM_ROUGE
ENG1
R051
CAB25 W113_3MM_MARRON 1 1004N1
W107_ 3MM_ROUGE
CAB33
CAB23 1
R051
R001
R065
1004N1
R57
51L
R57
0
NIM
1492 rpm
NIM
400 rpm
TROFFE
1
1MM_NOIR
2%
7K4 NOITISOP
0
R051
Requested values
xxxx h
R065
Active values
4.10 L/h
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9011121314151617181
Actual RATIO :
/h
TOTAL
MA-11-01128A
Click on the “SisuDiesel” icon
to start the
SisuDiesel diagnostics tool: WinEEM2 NOTE: The WinEEM2 start-up screen may not appear; in this case, exit Wintest. The WinEEM2 screen will then be displayed.
GUF101.4
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Programming
A . Matching serial numbers
Click on: "Couple Current Pump to ECU"
The ECU must bear the injection pump serial number. For this reason, after replacing the control unit or injection pump, the serial numbers must be matched. On accessing this window:
MA-11-01412A
The operation is complete. Click on: "ECU status" then on: "Monitoring" On accessing this second window:
MA-11-01411A
Click on: "Configurations"
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
¤ H
GUF101.5
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Programming
B . Location of softs for WinEEM2 On accessing this window:
Click on “Download new software” and select the required file via the following access path: (C = your hard drive address containing the Wintest program).
At the end of programming, the transfer pump can be heard as it starts running. NOTE: If the ECU programming procedure stops unexpectedly, exit the software. This enables you to resume programming.
GUF101.6
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Programming
C . List of the various engine softs File name
Model
6485 up to serial n° N258068
6485-7485_1.hex 6485 7485 6485-7485_2.hex
7485 up to serial n° N254049 6485 from serial n° N258069 7485 from serial n° N254050 6490 up to serial n° N342061
6490-7490_1.hex 6490 7490 6490-7490_2.hex
7490 up to serial n° N344066 6490 from serial n° N342062 7490 from serial n° N344067 6495 up to serial n° N344031
6495-7495_1.hex 6497_1.hex
Detail
7495 up to serial n° N348008 6495 6497 7495
6495-6497-7495_2.hex
6497 up to serial n° N345039 6495 from serial n° N344032 7495 from serial n° N348009 6497 from serial n° N345040
6499_1.hex 6499_2.hex
up to serial n° N307025 from serial n° N307026
8450_1.hex
8450
-
8460_1.hex
8460
-
8470_1.hex
8470
-
8480_1.hex
8480
-
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
¤ H
6499
GUF101.7
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Programming
GUF101.8
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Tests and diagnostics
GUF102 - SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Tests and diagnostics
CONTENTS A . Tests and diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF102.1
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Tests and diagnostics
GUF102.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Tests and diagnostics
A . Tests and diagnostics - Start the engine. - Click on the “Engine” icon
Wintest
DCC2 : 3.02 AUTO 3 : B20
CLIM : 20.05 JOY : 3.6
EHRC : 1.9
DATA : D040911
MA-11-01096A
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF102.3
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Tests and diagnostics The following screen is displayed: Electronic injection
+ 0,00
OFF
14%
70.0 C
22 C
376 kPa
0%
Set RATIO :
0
571.0 L
101 h
1500 rpm R57
7K4 X A M
2600
7K4 X A M
220 rpm
R57
1
R57
2%
1 2
2 1
1 ENG20
1
1 ENG22 1
ENG21
31 7 1 R51
81 21 6
CAB34 1
R001
654321 7 8 9 101112
W011_5MM_MARRON
CAB24 1 1 W0123MM MARRON
1
W108_ 3MM_ROUGE
CAB32 1
CAB35 W109_3MM_ROUGE
1X2
X4
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
CAB21 1
W110_3MM_ROUGE
ENG1
R051
CAB25 W113_3MM_MARRON 1 1004N1
W107_ 3MM_ROUGE
CAB33
CAB23 1
R051
R001
R065
1004N1
R57
51L
R57
0
NIM
1492 rpm
NIM
400 rpm
TROFFE
1
1MM_NOIR
2%
7K4 NOITISOP
0
R051
Requested values
xxxx h
R065
Active values
4.10 L/h
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9011121314151617181
Actual RATIO :
/h
TOTAL
MA-11-01128A
Design ground speed indicated by ground speed sensor in kph
Switch for memorised speed A (CAB84)
0,00 Power take-off status
- Memorised speed not activated, white - Memorised speed activated, green Switch for memorised speed B (CAB85)
Left and right brake pedal switches
- Memorised speed not activated, white - Memorised speed activated, green
Throttle pedal potentiometer (CAB44)
"+" switch for memorised speed adjustment 0%
"-" switch for memorised speed adjustment
GUF102.4
¤ H
- Position in % - value between 0.5 V minimum and 4.5 V maximum, set at calibration. NOTA: for tractors with DynaVT transmission, the control unit ratio information (TR18) is displayed.
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Tests and diagnostics Minor warning light, turns red when an error occurs. Warning light making the engine operate in degraded mode, turns red when the engine is in degraded mode.
Active values: these are the real values activated by the ECU. Requested values: These are the values required by the DCC2 Regulation slope
Cold start indicator light 2% Engine oil pressure circuit indicator light
Set at 2%, regardless of the situation Torque curve selection (Power boost)
- if the pressure is correct, it is displayed in normal video. - The display is red if the pressure is incorrect. Engine load value in %
14% Coolant temperature sensor value in °C (2)
1 - Curve n°2 when the tractor is in Hare range for Dynashift - Curve n°2 when the tractor is in range 3 and 4 for Dyna-6 - Curve n°2 when the tractor speed exceeds 12kph for DynaVT - Curve n°2 if ground speed is zero and the PTO clutch is engaged - Curve n°1 is used in all other conditions
70.0°C Vistronic speed in rpm (if fitted) NOTA: The Vistronic is not controlled by the ECU, but by the DCC2.
Intake air manifold temperature sensor value in °C (7) 220
22°C Engine oil pressure sensor value in KPa (3)
- The system may seem slow in terms of reaction time, but this is intended to avoid excessive speed oscillations
376KPa
Engine speed sensor value in rpm Total fuel consumption stored by the ECU (since engine first putting into service)
571.0 L
1492 0
Instant fuel consumption measured by the EEM in litres per hour
2600 Progress bar displaying engine speed range Icon allowing to start SisuDiesel diagnostic tool: WinEEM2
4.10L/h Total engine time stored by the ECU (since first use of engine) 1 engine hour = 1 hour real time
Icon used to start the Vistronic control tool
101 h -
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF102.5
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Tests and diagnostics Vistronic control tool - Click on the icon: The following screen is displayed: Vistronic
0
820
360 RPM
MA-11-01455A
Current Vistronic speed in rpm
Vistronic speed required by the DCC2 RPM
To control the Vistronic speed in a different manner to the DCC2 instruction, move the cursor so as to display the desired speed:
Vistronic
1585
1360
1580 RPM
MA-11-01456A
Considering system operation, this function should be tested using an engine speed above 1,500 rpm. Vistronic speed control cursor. When the value is zero, or when this window is closed, it is the DCC2 that controls the 1585 Vistronic speed: this is the tractor normal operating mode. Significant speed changes can be heard from the sound made by the engine fan.
CAUTION: Ensure that changing the Vistronic speed cannot lead to engine heating.
GUF102.6
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes
GUF103 - SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes
CONTENTS A . Reading error codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . List of error codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 C . EEM2 troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 D . EEM2 sensor diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 E . EEM2 controller diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 F . Fuel injection pump diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 G . Electrical diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 H . Component characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
GUF103.1
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes
GUF103.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes
A . Reading error codes The reading of error codes can be carried out in 2 ways: - by direct reading of the error code on the DCC2, - with WinEEM2, which is accessed from Wintest in the engine diagnostics screen. Error codes are stored by the ECU.
Reading codes on the DCC2 The user is informed when there is a possible fault by an error code displayed on the DCC2. - Tractor without DOT MATRIX screen (Fig. 1) To erase the error code, press the display change control key; this cancels the display (unless there is a major fault) but does not delete the error from the ECU memory. - Tractor with DOT MATRIX screen (Fig. 2) To erase the error code, press the Escape (ESC) key on the DOT MATRIX control keyboard; this cancels the display (unless there is a major fault) but does not delete the error from the ECU memory. The “E” of “NumE” indicates an Engine error.
A
MA-11-01298A
Fig. 1
If several faults occur simultaneously, the corresponding error codes are displayed one after the other for approximately 4 seconds each.
ERROR NumE 100 MA-11-01299A
Fig. 2
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
GUF103.3
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes
B . List of error codes Display Code display before soft on DCC2 DCC2 01.06
EEM2 error description
Page
629
10, Power On self-test error ..................................................................................................... 22
9000
11, Hardware Watchdog ........................................................................................................... 22
620
15, 5 VDC supply error, LOW ( 5.2V).......................................................................................................23
168
17, Battery voltage LOW (< 7.8V)............................................................................................. 23
1136
20, ECU temperature too high > 120×C................................................................................... 24
9200
30, PCU EEPROM CheckSum error ......................................................................................... 24
9201
31, PCU EEPROM hardware error ............................................................................................ 24
9203
32, PCU ADC error.................................................................................................................... 25
9204
33, Pump MAP error ................................................................................................................. 25
9205
34, PCU Internal bus error..........................................................................................................................25
9206
35, PCU Powerstage error ........................................................................................................ 25
9207
37, Pump CAN interface configuration error ..............................................................................................26
9209
39, PCU BIP not recognised ..................................................................................................... 26
9210
40, Solenoid valve final error..................................................................................................... 27
9211
41, Solenoid valve error ............................................................................................................ 27
9212
42, IAT final error ...................................................................................................................... 27
9213
43, PCU Over temperature ....................................................................................................... 27
9214
44, PCU Temperature sensor error........................................................................................... 28
9215
45, PCU Battery voltage measurement .................................................................................... 28
9216
46, Injection timing device error ............................................................................................... 28
9717
47, Injection timing device vibrations ....................................................................................... 29
9218
48, PCU Speed sensor final error ............................................................................................. 29
9219
49, PCU CAN bus final error ..................................................................................................... 29
9220
50, PCU reset while the engine is running (< 6.0V).................................................................... 6
9221
51, PCU connection defective on the CAN................................................................................. 7
9222
52, Emergency shutdown signal (MAB) test error ..................................................................... 7
9223
53, PSG1 signal missing ............................................................................................................. 8
9224
54, Injection control pulse width error ........................................................................................ 8
9225
55, Pump speed deviation .......................................................................................................... 9
9226
56, Pump supply voltage too low (< 6.8V) .................................................................................. 9
9226
57, Pump supply voltage too high (>17.0V) ................................................................................ 9
190
66, Speed sensor error ............................................................................................................. 17
190
94, Overspeed (over 3000 rpm) ................................................................................................ 10
NOTE: Until DCC2 soft version 01.06, the error display was in the right-hand column
GUF103.4
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes
Display Code display before soft on DCC2 DCC2 01.06
EEM2 error description
Page
100
95, Oil pressure sensor error .................................................................................................... 18
100
96, Oil pressure sensor error, LOW.......................................................................................... 18
100
97, Oil pressure sensor error, HIGH ......................................................................................... 18
100
98, Oil pressure LOW, warning ................................................................................................ 10
100
99, Oil pressure too LOW, alarm .............................................................................................. 10
102
100, Boost pressure sensor error, LOW................................................................................... 19
102
101, Boost pressure sensor error, HIGH .................................................................................. 19
102
102, Boost pressure LOW ........................................................................................................ 10
110
110, Coolant temperature sensor error, LOW .......................................................................... 20
110
111, Coolant temperature sensor error, HIGH.......................................................................... 20
110
112, Coolant temperature HIGH, warning ................................................................................ 11
110
113, Coolant temperature HIGH, alarm .................................................................................... 11
105
114, Intake manifold temperature sensor error, LOW.............................................................. 21
105
115, Intake manifold temperature sensor error, HIGH ............................................................. 21
105
116, Intake manifold temperature HIGH................................................................................... 12
-
120, Individual cylinder error (not used).................................................................................... 12
97
121, Water in fuel (not used) .................................................................................................... 12
94
122, Fuel pressure LOW........................................................................................................... 13
9227
123, Air in the fuel system........................................................................................................ 13
9006
141, Vehicle CAN off ................................................................................................................ 14
9007
142, CAN pump off................................................................................................................... 15
898
146, Speed requested by the CAN out of range, LOW (< 500 rpm) ........................................ 15
898
147, Speed requested by the CAN out of range, HIGH (> 3000 rpm) ...................................... 15
-
172, Overspeed supervisor failure (not used)........................................................................... 15
9101
173, Power parameters too high .............................................................................................. 16
9102
174, Absolute maximum power not set ................................................................................... 16
9103
175, Injection pump serial number mismatch ........................................................................................... 16
237
176, Invalid ECU source address selected ................................................................................................ 16
9108
177, Test soft expired................................................................................................................................ 16
-
180, Maximum power mismatch.............................................................................................. 17
-
181, Maximum vehicle speed mismatch (not used).................................................................................. 17
-
182, Control system identification mismatch (not used) .......................................................... 17
-
183, Cruise control UI failure (not used) ................................................................................... 17
-
184, Ground speed missing (not used)..................................................................................... 17
NOTE: Until DCC2 soft version 01.06, the error display was in the right-hand column
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
GUF103.5
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes
C . EEM2 troubleshooting
50, PCU reset while the engine is running (< 6.0V)
Initial system check
Description
When the power is switched on, observe the correct operation of the engine oil pressure indicator light on the instrument panel. The engine oil pressure indicator light should be on when the engine is not running. If it does not turn on, the problem is probably caused by one of the following elements: oil pressure sensor, LED, CAN bus or EEM2 controller.
The supply voltage of the pump control unit drops below the allowed voltage limit (< 6.0 V) during operation. If the supply voltage returns to the allowed voltage range (< 200ms), the engine continues normal operation. Otherwise the engine will stop. In both cases the error code has been stored. Reaction in the EEM
If the indicator light does not turn on within 4 seconds after switching the ignition on or the light is dim, the problem is caused by the EEM2 controller supply or one of the following elements: EEM2 controller, oil pressure switch or CAN bus. Check the following: 1. Check the battery voltage. If the battery voltage is below 11.5V, the battery and generator have to be inspected and replaced if necessary. 2. • +12VDC supply - EEM2 (fuse 10A) Measure the voltage from EEM2 pin 70 (+12 VDC) to pin 69 (ground). If the voltage is more than 1 V below the battery voltage, check the +12VDC EEM2 fuse. • +12VDC supply, BOSCH VP (fuse 25A) Measure the voltage from EEM2 pin 48 (+12 VDC) to pin 46 (ground). If the voltage is more than 1 V below the battery voltage, check the +12VDC BOSCH VP fuse. • +12VDC ignition key (fuse 5A) Measure the voltage from EEM2 pin 21 (+12 VDC). If the voltage is more than 1 V below the battery voltage, check the +12VDC ignition fuse. If one or several fuse are blown, replace and switch the power on. If the fuse(s) blows again, check the wiring from the fuses to the EEM2 pins 70, 48 and 21 for a short circuit to the tractor ground. If no short circuit is found and voltages are correct, the controller is faulty. Replace the controller and couple current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
GUF103.6
¤ H
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. There is no fuel injection during the PCU reset time. Solution • Check battery condition for too low voltage (< 11.5V). • Check alternator operation. • Check the contacts of wiring between the battery and the rotary pump for bad contact at a connector (Fig. 8). • Measure the voltage from EEM2 pin 48 (+12 VDC) to pin 46 (ground). If the voltage is more than 1 V below the battery voltage, check the +12VDC BOSCH VP fuse. The EEM2 controller provides a power supply to the PCU. If the power supply to the EEM2 controller is correct, but the PCU power supply is not, a possible cause is a faulty EEM2 controller. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool. NOTE: Error code 50 may be activated if the power supply to the EEM2 has been switched off incorrectly. • Test PCU operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 50 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 51, PCU connection defective on the CAN Description The EEM2 controller is not able to communicate with the injection pump. Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The “Limp home” function will be activated in the injection pump. The engine will run at a constant speed of 1400 rpm with reduced power. If the power supply is too weak the engine will not start.
52, Emergency shutdown signal (MAB) test error Description Normally, the engine shutdown is managed by the CAN bus. If normal shutdown can not be managed by the CAN bus, the EEM2 controller activates the MAB emergency shutdown signal which will stop the engine and after a few seconds the EEM2 unit cuts the power supply to the PCU (if the MAB signal has been activated). To be sure that the MAB signal is working in emergency situations, the EEM2 tests the MAB line continuously. If the test fails, error code 52 is stored.
Solution • Check the CAN bus between the injection pump and EEM2 controller for a short circuit and ensure the injection pump is receiving the correct power supply (Fig. 8). • Measure the CAN loop from the EEM2 controller between pins 44 and 20 (resistance 120 Ohms ± 10%). Disconnect the Bosch VP pump connector first. • If the CAN bus between the injection pump and EEM2 controller and the power supply are OK, the possible causes are a faulty EEM2 controller or a faulty PCU (Pump control unit). • Test PCU operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 51 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool. If error code 51 does not disappear when using another EEM2 controller, the Bosch VP PCU is damaged. Contact the BOSCH service agency.
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Solution • Check the MAB line between the EEM2 controller and the PCU (Pump Control Unit) for broken contact/wiring (Fig. 8). • Test PCU operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 52 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool. If error code 52 does not disappear when using another EEM2 controller, the Bosch VP PCU is damaged. Contact the BOSCH service agency.
GUF103.7
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 53, PSG1 signal missing
54, Injection control pulse width error
Description
Description
The EEM2 controller cannot communicate correctly with the PCU via the CAN bus. This message contains important information for engine operation.
The EEM2 controller cannot manage normal shutdown if fuel quantity is zero because of an error in the CAN bus, power supply or PCU.
Reaction in the EEM
Reaction in the EEM
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The EEM2 controller will activate emergency shutdown.
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The EEM2 controller will activate emergency shutdown.
Solution
Solution
The probable cause of the problem is a faulty PCU. • Check the CAN bus between the injection pump and EEM2 controller for short circuit and ensure the injection pump is receiving the correct power supply (Fig. 8). • If the CAN bus between the injection pump and EEM2 controller are operating correctly and the power supply is correct, the possible causes are an EEM2 controller error or a PCU (Pump control unit) error. • Test PCU operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 53 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool. If error code 53 does not disappear when using another EEM2 controller, the Bosch VP PCU is damaged. Contact the BOSCH service agency. • Switch the ignition off (5 sec.) and back on and start the engine. If the error is still active, the problem is caused by a faulty PCU (Pump Control unit). Contact the BOSCH service agency.
The probable cause of the problem is a faulty PCU. • Check the CAN bus between the injection pump and EEM2 controller for a short circuit and the power supply to the injection pump (Fig. 8). • If the CAN bus between the injection pump and EEM2 controller operate correctly and the power supply is correct, the possible causes are an EEM2 controller error or a PCU (Pump control unit) error. • Test PCU operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 54 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool. If error code 54 does not disappear with another EEM2 controller, the Bosch VP PCU is damaged. Contact the BOSCH service agency. • Switch the ignition off (5sec.) and back on and start the engine. If the error is still active, the problem is caused by a faulty PCU (Pump Control unit). Contact the BOSCH service agency.
GUF103.8
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 55, Pump speed deviation
56, Pump supply voltage too low (< 6.8V)
Description
Description
The EEM2 controller has inconsistent speed information between crank speed (detected by Hall sensor from the crank shaft) and pump speed (detected inside the Injection pump). The probable causes for the problem is the PCU, because if there is an error with a Hall sensor, there would be a different error code.
The supply voltage is too low for the defined time. The engine cannot start.
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The EEM2 controller will activate emergency shutdown. Solution The probable cause of the problem is a faulty PCU. • Test PCU operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 55 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool. If error code 55 does not disappear when using another EEM2 controller, the Bosch VP PCU is damaged. Contact the BOSCH service agency. • Switch the ignition off (5sec.) and back on and start the engine. If the error is still active, the problem is caused by a faulty PCU (Pump Control unit). Contact the BOSCH service agency.
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Solution The probable cause of the problem is the voltage drop down during starting. • Check that battery voltage is not too low (> 11.5V). • Check alternator operation. If the error remains active after ignition is switched on: • check all contacts and fuses and wiring from the battery to the EEM2 controller and to the rotary pump for bad contact at a connector or for a short circuit. • Check the supply voltage of the BOSCH VP injection pump (Fig. 8).
57, Pump supply voltage too high (>17.0V) Description Supply voltage is too high for defined time. Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The EEM2 controller will switch off the supply voltage from the PCU and will stop the engine if the error remains active after 20 seconds. Solution • The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Check the correct operation of the alternator and charge voltage. • Check the supply voltage of the BOSCH VP injection pump (Fig. 8).
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
GUF103.9
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 94, Overspeed (over 3000 rpm)
99, Oil pressure too LOW, alarm
Description
Description
The error is activated if the engine exceeds 3000 rpm during operation. A possible cause is engine braking at downhill with the gear ratio too low.
Oil pressure drops below the alarm level.
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. No fuel injection. The engine will recover after returning to normal condition (< 3000 rpm).
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The engine will stop automatically, after 30 seconds. Activation of the stopping procedure can be detected with “ shutdown pending status ” by CAN message. The oil pressure light has been switched on.
98, Oil pressure LOW, warning Description Oil pressure decreases below the allowed limit. Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The warning can be detected by the CAN message or the oil pressure light. Solution Find the cause for the low oil pressure indication. Possible causes: • Check the oil level and condition. • Check the mechanical condition of the engine. • The idling speed is too low. • The oil filter is clogged. • Check the contact surfaces of the pins (oxidation). • Check the sensor wiring (Fig. 6). • Check the oil pressure sensor (Fig. 11).
Solution Find the cause for the low oil pressure indication. Possible causes: • Check the oil level and condition. • The oil filter is clogged. • Check the mechanical condition of the engine. • Check the contact surfaces of the pins (oxidation). • Check the sensor wiring (Fig. 6). • Check the oil pressure sensor (Fig. 11).
102, Boost pressure LOW Description Boost pressure drops below the alarm level. Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Solution Find the cause for the low boost pressure indication. Possible causes: • Check the tightness of the boost pressure pipelines of the engine. • Check the condition of the engine turbo charger • Check the mechanical condition of the engine. • Check the boost pressure sensor (Fig. 12). • Check the contact surfaces of the pins (oxidation). • Check the wiring from the EEM2 controller to the boost pressure (Fig. 5).
GUF103.10
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 112, Coolant temperature HIGH, warning
113, Coolant temperature HIGH, alarm
Description
Description
Coolant temperature exceeds the overheating limit value. The warning can be detected by the CAN message or indicator light.
Coolant temperature rises above the alarm level.
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The Engine power will be reduced above this limit for prevent overheating of the engine.
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The engine will stop automatically, after 30 seconds. When the coolant temperature rises above alarm level, activation of the stopping procedure can be detected with “ shutdown pending status ” by CAN message. The alarm is activated.
Solution Find the cause for the overheating. Possible causes: • Check the coolant level. • Check the radiator condition. • Check the mechanical condition of the engine. • Check the contact surfaces of the pins (oxidation). • Check the sensor wiring (Fig. 7). • Check the temperature sensor (Fig. 10). If the error remains active and the engine temperature is low: • Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 112 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
Solution Find the cause for the overheating. Possible causes: • Check the coolant level. • Check the radiator condition. • Check the mechanical condition of the engine. • Check the contact surfaces of the pins (oxidation). • Check the sensor wiring (Fig. 7). • Check the temperature sensor (Fig. 10). If the error remains active and the engine temperature is low: • Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 113 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
GUF103.11
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 116, Intake manifold temperature HIGH
121, Water in fuel (not used)
Description
Description
Intake manifold temperature rises above the warning limit value. This temperature sensor is integrated in the boost sensor.
Water level in the water separator rises to warning level. Example: condensation water. Reaction in the EEM
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Engine power will be reduced.
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Solution
Solution Find the cause for the excessive intake manifold temperature. Possible causes: • Check the condition of the air-cooling system. (Cleanliness, pressure tightness, etc.) • Check the contact surfaces of the pins (oxidation). • Check the sensor wiring (Fig. 5). • Check the temperature sensor (integrated in boost pressure sensor) (§ H, (7) Intake air temperature sensor). • Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 116 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
Check the water separator at the bottom of the prefilter. Drain water from the fuelling system. If there is no water in the fuelling system: • Check the wiring from EEM2 connector to sensor connector. • Check the supply voltage at the water detector sensor connector from pin A (+12V) to pin B (GND). • If the power supply to the sensor is correct and there are no breaks or short circuits in wirings -> replace the sensor.
120, Individual cylinder error (not used)
GUF103.12
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 122, Fuel pressure LOW
123, Air in the fuel system
Description
Description
Fuel feed pressure after filters is too low (less than 0.2 bar) for > 20 seconds.
The EEM2 controller has identified a permanent injection pump piston oscillation. The probable cause for oscillating is an air leak into the fuel. The EEM2 controller activates the default mode to avoid damaging the internal injection pump. NOTE: Immediately seek the source of the air in the fuel circuit.
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Solution Check that the lift pump above the filter is running; it should run for one minute after switching the ignition on. Possible causes • The filter is blocked (impurities, freezing, etc.). • Leak / air in the fuel system. • Check the fuel level. • Check the sensor wiring (Fig. 9). • Check the sensor. If the lift pump is operating, check: • that the filter is not choked (impurities, freezing, etc.). • that there is no leak / air in the fuel system. • the fuel level from the tank (maybe gauge is showing wrong level). If the lift pump is not operating, check: • Feed pump fuse. • Feed pump relay. • Feed pump wiring. If the power supply is operating correctly, then the lift pump is damaged and has to be replaced.
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Engine speed is limited to 1,500 rpm and engine power decreases. Solution • The probable cause of the problem is an air leak into the fuel at the low pressure side or in the fuel system. Check the tightness of all of the engine fuel supply lines. • Check the tractor supply lines. • Measure fuel pressure to ensure that the fuel filter elements or supply lines from the tank are not clogged. Run the engine slowly for a few seconds. When idling, the pressure must be between 1.0 and 1.2 bar. • Check the tightness of the main filter and prefilter. • Replace the original metal feed pipe located between the injection pump and the feed pump with a transparent hose (rubber / plastic tube) and ensure that there is no air in the fuel. If this is not the case, check all feed lines again, along with filter tightness in one run. • If there is no air in the system and error code 42 is still active, the problem may be due to a failure of the Bosch VP injection pump sensor.
GUF103.13
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 141, Vehicle CAN off Description EEM2 controller is not able to communicate with other devices on the CAN bus. NOTE: the EEM2 cannot detect an open circuit (wiring). Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Control requests by the CAN are not active. Solution • Check the CAN bus between the EEM2 controller and the tractor for a short circuit between the CAN lines (Fig. 8). • At worst the cause of the problem is an error in the EEM2 controller or the vehicle controller. • Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 141 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
GUF103.14
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 142, CAN pump off Description
146, Speed requested by the CAN out of range, LOW (< 500 rpm)
The EEM2 controller is not able to communicate with the injection pump.
Description
Reaction in the EEM
Reaction in the EEM
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The EEM2 controller is not able to govern engine speed. The “Limp home” function will be activated in the injection pump. The engine will run at a constant speed of 1400 rpm with reduced power. The engine will not start if there is no power supply.
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The EEM2 controller will start to use the hardwired throttle for speed control. If there is no hardwired throttle the engine runs at idle speed.
Solution
Find the cause for the too low speed request from the vehicle controller.
• Check the CAN bus between the EEM2 controller and the injection pump for a short circuit between the CAN lines. The probable cause of the problem is a short circuit between the CAN lines. At worst, the problem is an error in the EEM2 controller or the PCU (pump control unit). • Measure the CAN loop from the EEM2 controller between pins 44 and 20 (resistance 120 Ohms ± 10%). Disconnect the Bosch VP pump connector first. • Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 142 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool. Delete the error code. Switch the ignition off (5sec.) and back on and start the engine. If the error is still active, the problem is caused by a faulty PCU (Pump Control unit). Contact the BOSCH service agency.
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
Speed requested by the CAN is below 500 rpm.
Solution
147, Speed requested by the CAN out of range, HIGH (> 3000 rpm) Description Speed requested by the CAN is above 3000 rpm. Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The EEM2 controller will start to use the hardwired throttle for speed control. If there is no hardwired throttle the engine runs at idle speed. Solution Find the cause for the too high speed request from the vehicle controller.
172, Overspeed supervisor failure (not used)
GUF103.15
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 173, Power parameters too high Description Allowed power parameters for application have been exceeded. The power parameters do not match with the current EEM2 controller. The error code will be activated, for example if the wrong application software has been downloaded to the EEM2 controller. If for example, 143 kW software has been downloaded into an EEM2 controller, which had 120 kW software inside originally, this error is shown too.
175, Injection pump serial number mismatch Description Injection pump serial number does not match with the current EEM2 controller. Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The engine will start, but the fuel quantity has been reduced.
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The volume of fuel injected is reduced. Solution • Switch the ignition off (5 sec.) and back on to see if the error is still active. If the error is still active, download the correct software (for correct horse-power setting) to the EEM2 controller with the Service Tool. If this does not help, replace the EEM2 controller for the engine.
Solution • Replace the engine EEM2 controller. • Couple the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the service tool. • If this does not help, replace the EEM2 controller for the engine. If a new (spare part) EEM2 controller is fitted, couple the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
176, Invalid ECU source address selected If a new (spare part) EEM2 controller is fitted, couple the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
177, Test soft expired
174, Absolute maximum power not set Description Absolute maximum power value has not been activated. Example: wrong software in the EEM2 controller. Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The volume of fuel is reduced. Solution This problem cannot be solved on the field. Replace the EEM2 controller and couple the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with controller with the Service Tool.
GUF103.16
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 180, Maximum power mismatch
D . EEM2 sensor diagnostics
Description Maximum power configuration is not correct for the vehicle. Power information between the EEM2 controller and the vehicle controller do not match, for example the wrong vehicle controller or software for application may have been installed.
66, Speed sensor error
Reaction in the EEM
Reaction in the EEM
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The engine will start, but the fuel quantity has been reduced.
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. EEM2 will start to use redundant speed information from the injection pump and engine speed is limited to 1800 rpm. Engine power will be reduced and the injection timing delayed.
Solution • Replace the engine EEM2 controller. • Replace the tractor controller. • Download the correct software in the vehicle/EEM2 controller.
181, Maximum vehicle speed mismatch (not used) 182, Control system identification mismatch (not used) 183, Cruise control UI failure (not used) 184, Ground speed missing (not used)
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
Description EEM2 cannot recognize correct speed signal from the speed sensor.
Solution • Check the contact surfaces of the pins (oxidation). • Check the sensor wiring (Fig. 4). • Check the +12V supply voltage for the speed sensor (Fig. 4). • Check the sensor. Run the engine with the starter motor and measure the speed pulses between the tractor ground and the sensor connector pin 2. The pulses should be from 0 V to the battery voltage (12 V). • Battery voltage may drop down during starting. • If no pulses are detected replace the damaged sensor. • Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 66 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
GUF103.17
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 95, Oil pressure sensor error
97, Oil pressure sensor error, HIGH
Description
Description
Too high voltage from the oil pressure sensor has been detected (>200 kPa), while the engine is not running.
The voltage measured by the oil pressure sensor lies above the normal operating range.
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Engine power will be reduced. Solution • • • • •
Check the contact surfaces of the pins (oxidation). Check the sensor wiring (Fig. 6). Check the +5V supply voltage for the sensor. Check the sensor (Fig. 11). Replace the damaged sensor.
96, Oil pressure sensor error, LOW Description The measured voltages from the oil pressure sensor lie below the normal operating range. Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Engine power will be reduced. Engine protection in case of low oil pressure is not active. NOTE: may cause engine damage, if oil pressure is too low.
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated, the fuel quantity is reduced. Engine protection in case the high oil pressure is not activated. NOTE: may cause engine damage, if oil pressure is too high. Solution • • • • • •
Check the contact surfaces of the pins (oxidation). Check the sensor wiring (Fig. 6). Check the +5V supply voltage for the sensor. Check the sensor (Fig. 11). Replace the damaged sensor. Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 97 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
Solution • • • • • •
Check the contact surfaces of the pins (oxidation). Check the sensor wiring (Fig. 6). Check the +5V supply voltage for the sensor. Check the sensor (Fig. 11). Replace the damaged sensor. Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 96 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
GUF103.18
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 100, Boost pressure sensor error, LOW
101, Boost pressure sensor error, HIGH
Description
Description
The voltage measured by the boost pressure sensor lies above the normal operating range.
The voltage measured by the boost pressure sensor lies above the normal operating range.
Reaction in the EEM
Reaction in the EEM
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The boost pressure functions are not active.
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The boost pressure functions are not active.
Solution
Solution
• • • • • •
• • • • • •
Check the contact surfaces of the pins (oxidation). Check the sensor wiring (Fig. 5). Check the +5V supply voltage for the sensor. Check the sensor (Fig. 12). Replace the damaged sensor. Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 100 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
Check the contact surfaces of the pins (oxidation). Check the sensor wiring (Fig. 5). Check the +5V supply voltage for the sensor. Check the sensor (Fig. 12). Replace the damaged sensor. Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 101 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
GUF103.19
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 110, Coolant temperature sensor error, LOW
111, Coolant temperature sensor error, HIGH
Description
Description
The signal measured by the coolant temperature sensor lies below the normal operating range.
The signal measured by the coolant temperature sensor lies above the normal operating range.
Reaction in the EEM
Reaction in the EEM
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Engine power will be reduced. Engine protection and others functions linked to coolant temperature are not active. For instance overheating protection is not active. NOTA: may cause engine damage if the engine overheats. [check that the engine really is overheating, see error no.111]
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The volume of fuel is reduced. Engine protection and others functions linked to coolant temperature are not active. For instance overheating protection is not active. NOTE: may cause engine damage if the engine overheats. Solution
Solution • • • • •
Check the contact surfaces of the pins (oxidation). Check the sensor wiring (Fig. 7). Check the sensor (Fig. 10). Replace the damaged sensor. Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 110 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
GUF103.20
¤ H
• • • • •
Check the contact surfaces of the pins (oxidation). Check the sensor wiring (Fig. 7). Check the sensor (Fig. 10). Replace the damaged sensor. Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 111 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 114, Intake manifold temperature sensor error, LOW
115, Intake manifold temperature sensor error, HIGH
Description
Description
The signal measured by the temperature sensor (integrated in the boost pressure sensor) lies below the normal operating range.
The signal measured by the temperature sensor (integrated in the boost pressure sensor) lies above the normal operating range.
Reaction in the EEM
Reaction in the EEM
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Functions linked to intake manifold temperature are not active.
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Functions linked to intake manifold temperature are not active.
Solution
Solution
• Check the contact surfaces of the pins (oxidation). • Check the sensor wiring (Fig. 5). • Check the sensor (§ H, (7) Intake air temperature sensor). • Replace the damaged sensor. • Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 114 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
• Check the contact surfaces of the pins (oxidation). • Check the sensor wiring (Fig. 5). • Check the sensor (§ H, (7) Intake air temperature sensor). • Replace the damaged sensor. • Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 115 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
GUF103.21
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes
E . EEM2 controller diagnostics
11, Hardware Watchdog Description
10, Power On self-test error Description When ignition is switched ON, the EEM2 controller performs internal system checks. If any of these test fail, the system reports the Power On self-test error. The engine will not start.
There is a failure in the EEM2 program execution caused by a unit failure. Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The engine will stop immediately and may not start.
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The engine will not start. Solution • Turn the ignition key off and back on. If the error code is displayed again, the EEM2 controller has to be replaced. • Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 10 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
GUF103.22
¤ H
Solution • Turn the ignition key off and back on. If the error code is displayed again, the EEM2 controller has to be replaced. • Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 11 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 15, 5 VDC supply error, LOW ( 5.2V)
Description
Description
Reference supply voltage for sensors and throttle control is too low.
Reference supply voltage for sensors and throttle control is too high.
Reaction in the EEM
Reaction in the EEM
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The EEM2 controller detects wrong values from the sensors and throttle control which explains incorrect engine operation.
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The EEM2 controller detects wrong values by the sensors and throttle control which explains incorrect engine operation.
Solution
Solution
The probable cause of the problem is the voltage drop down, during starting, if the error code remains active when the ignition is switched on and the engine is not running. In this case: • Check boost pressure sensor for a short circuit via supply pin 2 to ground. • Check foot throttle for a short circuit via supply pin 13 to ground. • Check reference supply lines for a short circuit to ground. • Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 15 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
• Check the reference supply lines from EEM2 controller pin 13 for short circuit to battery voltage. • If no short circuit is found, the voltage regulator of the EEM2 controller is faulty. • Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 16 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
17, Battery voltage LOW (< 7.8V) Description Supply voltage for EEM2 controller is too low. Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Solution The probable cause of the problem is the voltage drop down, during starting. If error code 17 remains active, check the following path: • Check the battery condition for too low voltage. • Check contacts through the wiring from the battery to the EEM2 for bad contact at a connector (Fig. 3). • Check alternator operation.
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
GUF103.23
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 20, ECU temperature too high > 120°C
F . Fuel injection pump diagnostics
Description Temperature inside EEM2 controller is too high. This can be caused when overheating has stopped the engine and the cooling system does not work; the temperature may rise inside the EEM2 controller, because there is no cooling airflow. Thermocouple operation: from -40°C to 150°C Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored. Solution • If the error IS STILL ACTIVE: Test the body temperature of the EEM2 controller by touch. If the controller is not hot, but the error is still active, the EEM2 controller has to be replaced. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool. • If the error is NOT ACTIVE anymore, check error codes 112 and 113. If these error codes are active at the same time, the problem is probably caused by engine overheating. You can now ignore this error code. If error code 112 or 113 has not been stored, the temperature element inside the EEM2 controller may be defective. Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool.
GUF103.24
¤ H
30, PCU EEPROM CheckSum error Description The cause of the problem is incorrect check sum. At least one eeprom value cannot be read in the pump control unit. Engine power is reduced due to this error. Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Solution The cause of the problem is a faulty PCU. • Switch the ignition off (5 sec.) and back on and start the engine. If the error is still active, the problem is a faulty PCU (Pump Control Unit). Contact the BOSCH service agency.
31, PCU EEPROM hardware error Description The cause of the problem is a hardware error. All eeprom values cannot be read in the pump control unit. Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Engine power will be reduced. Solution The cause of the problem is a faulty PCU. • Switch the ignition off (5 sec.) and back on and start the engine. If the error is still active, the problem is a faulty PCU (Pump Control Unit). Contact the BOSCH service agency.
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 32, PCU ADC error
34, PCU Internal bus error
Description
Description
Incorrect analog values, for instance battery voltage for fuel quantity correction.
The cause of the problem is unit error. The pump control unit detects and incorrect injection quantity.
Reaction in the EEM
Reaction in the EEM
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Engine power will be reduced.
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The EEM2 controller will activate emergency shutdown.
Solution
Solution
The cause of the problem is a faulty PCU. • Switch the ignition off (5 sec.) and back on and start the engine. If the error is still active, the problem is a faulty PCU (Pump Control Unit). Contact the BOSCH service agency.
The cause of the problem is a faulty PCU. • Switch the ignition off (5 sec.) and back on and start the engine. If the error is still active, the problem is a faulty PCU (Pump Control Unit). Contact the BOSCH service agency.
33, Pump MAP error
35, PCU Powerstage error
Description
Description
After power on, the pump control unit checks during a self-test whether a pump MAP has been programmed and operates faultlessly.
The cause of the problem is a unit error or solenoid valve voltage measurement error.
Reaction in the EEM
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Engine power will be reduced.
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The EEM2 controller will activate emergency shutdown. Solution The cause of the problem is a faulty PCU. • Switch the ignition off (5 sec.) and back on and start the engine. If the error is still active, the problem is a faulty PCU (Pump Control Unit). Contact the BOSCH service agency.
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
Reaction in the EEM
Solution The cause of the problem is a faulty PCU. • Switch the ignition off (5 sec.) and back on and start the engine. If the error is still active, the problem is a faulty PCU (Pump Control Unit). Contact the BOSCH service agency.
GUF103.25
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 37, Pump CAN interface configuration error
39, PCU BIP not recognised
Description
The pump control unit cannot recognize the beginning of injection pulse. Injection timing and fuel amount are not correct.
The EEM2 controller and pump control unit are not able to communicate because of wrong configuration, error code 33 is also activated. The error code may also be activated if an unsuitable spare part injection pump has been installed.
Description
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated.
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The EEM2 controller will activate emergency shutdown. Solution The cause of the problem is a faulty PCU. • Contact the BOSCH service agency, if the injection pump is not suitable for the SisuDiesel engine. • If the injection pump is correct, delete the error code. Switch the ignition off (5 sec.) and back on and start the engine. If the error remains active, the problem is a faulty PCU (Pump Control Unit). Contact the BOSCH service agency.
GUF103.26
¤ H
Solution Possible cause of the problem is a too long/thin power supply line for the injection pump. Impedance of the power supply line is too high. • Check the contacts through the wiring (Fig. 3). The EEM2 controller provides a power supply to the PCU. Measure the voltage from EEM2 pin 48 (+12 VDC) to pin 46 (ground) of EEM2 connector. NOTE: battery voltage will drop during pre or post heating period. If the power supply to the EEM2 controller is correct, but PCU power supply is not correct, replace the controller and couple the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the Service Tool. • If wirings and the EEM2 controller are OK, the problem is a faulty PCU (Pump Control Unit). Contact the BOSCH service agency.
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 40, Solenoid valve final error
42, IAT final error
Description
Description
The Pump control unit monitors the solenoid valve current and activates the error code when the solenoid valve is continuously energized.
IAT is an angular reference for the cam-based control of the fuel quantity solenoid valve. If the IAT pulse is missing then the error code is activated, and fuel injection will be stopped.
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The EEM2 controller will activate emergency shutdown.
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Solution 1
Solution The probable cause of the problem is a faulty solenoid valve or PCU. • Contact the BOSCH service agency.
The probable cause of the problem is too low engine operating speed during starting. Check the tractor battery and starter motor condition. Solution 2
41, Solenoid valve error Description The Pump control unit monitors the solenoid valve current and the solenoid valve quick decay voltage. If both of these variables leave the permitted range then a solenoid valve error is recognized.
The probable cause of the problem is an air leak into the fuel at the low-pressure side or air in the fuel system. At worst, the cause of the problem is an injection pump error.
43, PCU Over temperature Description
Reaction in the EEM
The pump control unit recognises over temperature.
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Engine power will be reduced (also by the pump).
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Engine power will be reduced.
Solution The probable cause of the problem is a faulty solenoid valve pump or PCU. • Contact the BOSCH service agency.
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
Solution • If other error codes are active (for example 112 or 113), check those errors first. • Find the cause for the over temperature. • Switch the ignition off (5 sec.) and back on: If the error is still active, the problem is caused by a faulty PCU (Pump Control unit). Contact the BOSCH service agency.
GUF103.27
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 44, PCU Temperature sensor error
45, PCU Battery voltage measurement
Description
Description
The temperature measurement does not work correctly inside the injection pump and the pump control unit uses a default value for pump temperature.
Battery voltage measurement does not work correctly inside the injection pump and the pump control unit uses a default value for battery voltage.
Reaction in the EEM
Reaction in the EEM
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Engine power will be reduced.
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated.
Solution
Solution
The cause of the problem is a faulty PCU. • Switch the ignition off (5 sec.) and back on: If the error is still active, the problem is caused by a faulty PCU (Pump Control unit). Contact the BOSCH service agency.
The cause of the problem is a faulty PCU. • Switch the ignition off (5sec.) and back on and start the engine. If the error is still active, the problem is caused by a faulty PCU (Pump Control unit). Contact the BOSCH service agency.
46, Injection timing device error Description There is persistent governor deviation in injection timing or the oscillating timing device piston. Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Engine power will be reduced. Solution • The probable cause for oscillating is an air leak into the fuel at the low-pressure side. • The probable cause for persistent governor deviation is a wrong pump mounting angle or defective injection pump.
GUF103.28
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes 47, Injection timing device vibrations
48, PCU Speed sensor final error
Description
Description
The PCU (pump control unit) has identified a continuous oscillation of the pump injection timing device piston. This error code is valid only for the Bosch VP44 injection pump.
The pump control unit does not recognize reference pulses sent to the engine top dead center by the engine control unit. Reaction in the EEM
Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Engine power will be reduced.
The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. Engine power is reduced and injection timing delayed.
Solution
Solution
The probable cause for oscillating is an air leak into the fuel at the low-pressure side. • Check the tightness of all of the engine fuel supply lines. • Check the tractor supply lines. • Measure fuel pressure to ensure that the fuel filter elements or supply lines from the fuel system are not clogged. Run the engine slowly for a few seconds. When idling, the pressure must be between 1.0 and 1.2 bar. • Check the tightness of the main filter and prefilter. • Replace the original metal feed pipe located between the injection pump and the feed pump with a transparent hose (rubber / plastic tube) and ensure that there is no air in the fuel. If there is some air left in the fuel, re-check all supply lines and filter tightness.
If error 66 is also active at the same time then check its cause first. Next: • Check “DZG” wiring between the pump and EEM2 controller (Fig. 8).
49, PCU CAN bus final error Description There is problem at the CAN bus between the pump control unit and EEM2 controller. The pump control unit continuously indicates no message or an incorrect value range in the control message. Reaction in the EEM The error code is stored and the indicator light is activated. The EEM2 controller will activate emergency shutdown. Solution • Check CAN bus wiring between the injection pump and EEM2 controller (Fig. 8). At worst, the cause of the problem is the faulty EEM2 controller or Injection pump. • Test the current EEM2 controller operation with another EEM2 controller. NOTE: If the EEM2 controller from another tractor is used, error code 175 will be activated, because of pump serial number mismatch. If error code 49 disappears, the EEM2 controller has been damaged. Replace the controller and connect the current injection pump (serial number) to the new EEM2 controller with the EEM2 Service Tool. • In case of a faulty PCU (Pump Control Unit), contact the BOSCH service agency.
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
GUF103.29
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes
G . Electrical diagrams Electrical supplies
Fig. 3 Speed sensor
Fig. 4 Turbo Boost pressure sensor
Fig. 5 NOTE: To view these electrical diagrams in greater detail, see GUF105
GUF103.30
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes
Oil pressure sensor
Fig. 6
Coolant temperature sensor
Fig. 7 NOTE: To view these electrical diagrams in greater detail, see GUF105
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
GUF103.31
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes
Bosch VP
NOTE: It is not allowed to make any resistance measurements from the Bosch VP PCU connector pins! This may destroy the Bosch injection pump!!! Ensure that the Bosch VP PCU connector is disconnected when measuring wiring!!
Fig. 8 NOTE: To view these electrical diagrams in greater detail, see GUF105
GUF103.32
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes
Fuel pressure sensor
Fig. 9 NOTE: To view these electrical diagrams in greater detail, see GUF105
Legend Figure 1: main connector, +12VDC Bosch VP, Power ground Bosch VP, ignition key input, +12VDC Bosch VP, Power ground Bosch VP Figure 2: speed sensor, main connector Figure 3: turbo pressure, main connector Figure 4: oil pressure, main connector Figure 5: coolant temperature, main connector Figure 6: PCU (pump control unit), main connector, +12VDC Bosch VP, Power ground Bosch VP Figure 7: water detector, main connector Figure 8: fuel pressure, main connector
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
GUF103.33
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes
H . Component characteristics (2) Coolant temperature sensor (Fig. 10) Temperature (°C)
Resistance (ohm)
-50 0 25 50 75 100 125 150
1000 1600 2000 2400 2900 3400 4000 4600
Resistance (Ohm)
Possible error codes 110: low coolant temperature < -40°C (1100 Ohm) 111: high coolant temperature > 125°C (4000 Ohm) 112: high coolant temperature > 105°C (3500 Ohm) 113: high coolant temperature > 115°C (3600 Ohm)
Temperature (°C) Fig. 10
GUF103.34
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes (3) Oil pressure sensor (Fig. 11) Pressure (kPa) bar (kPa) 0 0 1 100 2 200 3 300 4 400 5 500 6 600 7 700 8 800 9 900 10 1000
(7) Intake air pressure sensor (Fig. 12) Pressure
Voltage (V) bar 0,5 0,8 1,1 1,4 1,7 2 2,3 2,6 2,9 3,2 3,5
0,5 0,9 1,3 1,7 2,1 2,5 2,9 3,3 3,7 4,1 4,5
(kPa) 50 80 110 140 170 200 230 260 290 320 350
Voltage (V) 0,5 0,9 1,3 1,7 2,1 2,5 2,9 3,3 3,7 4,1 4,5
Possible error codes
Possible error codes
96 : Oil pressure sensor error, too low (signal < 0.2V)
100: Pressure sensor error, too low (signal < 0.2V)
97 : Oil pressure sensor error, too high (signal > 4.8V)
101: Pressure sensor error, too high (signal > 4.8V)
98 : Oil pressure low, warning
102: low pressure, warning
99 : Oil pressure low, alarm
Signal out-of-tolerances, HIGH
Signal out-of-tolerances, HIGH
Signal out-of-tolerances, LOW Signal out-of-tolerances, LOW
Fig. 12 Fig. 11
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
¤ H
GUF103.35
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Error codes (7) Intake air temperature sensor Temperature (°C)
Resistance (ohm)
-40 -20 0 20 40 60 80 100 120 130
39260 13850 5500 2420 1166 609 340 202 127 102
Possible error codes 100: Temperature sensor error, too low (signal < 0.2V) 101: Temperature sensor error, too high (signal > 4.8V) 102: high temperature, warning
GUF103.36
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.b
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams
GUF105 - SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . SisuDiesel engine harness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 C . Electrical diagrams on the tractor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF105.1
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams
GUF105.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
CAB83 OFF
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CAB83
R S2
MA-10-01000A
CAB37.6/CAB83.1 B CAB37.7/CAB83.3 B
6
7
5 3
4 2
11 10 9
1
FAI 03 FAI 48
8
CAB37
12
- Components with only one connector are identified by the connector name: CAB83 - Suspended front axle switch (Fig. 1). - Harnesses performing the same funtions have the same colour on the diagram (Fig. 1): • FAI03 - Dynashift console harness (green) • FAI48 - DynaVT console harness (green) - All wires can be identified by the pins of the outgoing and incoming connectors of the harness: CAB37.6/CAB83.1: The wire connects pin 6 of the CAB37 connector to pin 1 of the CAB83 connector - The detail of pins allocation for each connector is shown on the harness side - The wire colour is indicated: CAB37.6/CAB83.1 B, the wire is white List of colours: - N: Black - M: Brown - R: Red - B: White - J: Yellow - V: Green - The splices inside the harnesses are indicated by a dot and the letter S (S2).
S2.1/CAB83.2
The harnesses fitted on the tractor allow data to be exchanged and power to be supplied to the electrical and electronic systems. The tractor is fitted with 3 different types of power supply: • +12V Battery (Permanent) • +12V APC (Ignition key ON) • +12V ACC (Accessories) Most harnesses have a maximum of six different wire colours: - Black: Ground - Brown: +12V Permanent - Red: +12V APC (Ignition key ON) and Accessories - White: Information - Yellow: CAN High - Green: CAN Low The CAN network wires (yellow and green) are twisted together.
R
Description
In general, the components or connectors are named in order to indicate the corresponding elements of the tractor: AC## Armrest BAF## Fuse box CA## Automatic air conditioning CAB## Cab ENG## Engine FA## Suspended front axle L## Linkage - ParkLock (HA) LIG## Lighting R## Linkage and roof ROOF##Roof TR## Transmission V# Electrohydraulic spool valve X# Round battery cable terminal on fuse box
BAF12.2/S2.1
A . General
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
CAB37 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
Fig. 1
GUF105.3
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams Layout 5 Deutsch connectors (31-way) are connected to the cab: - 2 on the front panel Fig. 2) - 3 at the bottom rear right-hand side of the cab (Fig. 3).
ENG1
Fig. 2: All these connectors belong to the engine harness. ENG2 is dedicated to information concerning the electronic injection.
ENG2
Fig. 3: Always in the following order (regardless of tractor configuration and options), from left to right: L14 Linkage harness junction CAB50 Transmission harness junction LIG1 Lighting harness junction
MA-10-01003A
Fig. 2
L14
LIG1
+12V
MA-10-01002A
14
16
13
15
17
12 11
10 9
8 7
6 5
4 3
2 1
BAF10
F9- 15A +APC
1 X2 F48 - 7.5A
+12V
1 X4 18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
F48
MA-10-01001A
2
GUF105.4
¤ H
Fig. 3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
18
BAF12
The fuses and relays of the electrical or electronic board (Fig. 4) are indicated by a black mark on their locations on the fuse box (2).
CAB50
F9
Fig. 4
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams
B . SisuDiesel engine harness SisuDiesel engine harness ......................................... 6
C . Electrical diagrams on the tractor Electrical power supply .............................................. 9 Controls.................................................................... 11 Grid Heater circuit .................................................... 13 CAN network - all options with Autotronic 3 transmission calculator .......................................................... 15 CAN network - all options with Autotronic 3 transmission calculator and Autotronic 5 Park Lock .............. 17 CAN network - all options with Autotronic 4 transmission calculator and EHRC linkage calculator............. 19 CAN network with Autotronic 4 transmission calculator and Autotronic 5 linkage calculator .................. 21
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF105.5
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams SisuDiesel engine harness
Parts list (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (9) (10) (11) (ENG4) (R2) (R3)
Electronic control unit (ECU) Coolant temperature sensor Oil pressure sensor Speed sensor Intake manifold air heater (Grid Heater) Grid Heater relay Intake air pressure and temperature sensor Fuel pressure sensor Electric lift pump Pump control unit (PCU) SisuDiesel harness / Engine harness junction Lift pump relay in cab Grid Heater relay control in cab
GUF105.6
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams
120R
M
3
2
2
1
1
LP1 LP2
10
10 mm LP2 GH2
DT-06-3S 1 2 3
1
P
WD1 WD2 WD3
1JO 973 701 A 1
FP1
9
7 BOSCH 1928403112100 P U
Ground Temp. +5V
1
1
2
2
3
3
Pressure
4
4
BP1 AT BP2 BP3
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
5
5
6
6
7
7
8
8
9
9
10
10
11
11
12
12
13
13
14
14
15
15
16
16
17
17
18
18
19
19
20
20
21
21
22
22
23
23
24
24
25
25
26
26
27
27
28
28
29
29
30
30
31
31
3
P U
+5V Signal Ground
3
3
2
2
1
1
67
66
18
67
Foot throttle input
A B + -
CAN High CAN Low
W
OP3 OP4 OP5
66
+12V Lift pump +12V Grid Heater relay
D+
AMP 282087-1
R3
+
AMP 282087-1 3
Shunt when CAN terminator is used
R2 +12V permanent, EEM (fuse F32) Ground, EEM +12V permanent, Bosch VP (fuse F28) Ground, Bosch VP +12V APC (Ignition key ON) +12V Lift pump control +12V Grid Heater control
1
+
1 2 3 4 IGN DO1 DO2 DO3 DO4 DO5 DO6 DO7 DO8 LP1 GH1 REF GND FT1 HT1 DI1 DI2 DI3 DI4 DI5 DI6 DI7 DI11 S4 S5 CN1 CN2
42
18
CN1 CN2
70
1
47
69
22
WD3 2
21
IGN
25
48
46
4 3 WD1
52
5
28
4
51
27
3
50
DO1 DO2 DO3 DO4 DO5 DO6 DO7 DO8
32
8
7
54
30
6
DI1 DI2 DI3 DI4 DI5 DI6 DI7 DI11
53
29
37
36
60
13
REF GND FT1 HT1
55
31
WD2 FP1
33
CT1 CT2
9
61
38
14
OP3 OP4 OP5
12
ENG4
+12V Ground
42
70
47
69
22
21
25
48
46
52
28
5
4
51
27
50
3
32
8
7
54
30
53
6
29
37
60
36
13
31
55
33
9
61
14
38
12
35
59
63
16
62
39
45
19
1
23
43
11
35
11
59
BP1 BP2 BP3 AT
9
63
9
16
8
62
8
VP3 VP4 VP5 VP6
39
7
45
6
7
19
5
6
1
4
5
23
4
AMP 70 Saab 1-968879-1 43
3
20
3
ECU
VP1 VP2 44
2
S4 S5
11
1
2
S1 S2 S3
MAB Battery Battery + DZG
1
VP1 VP2 VP3 VP4 VP5 VP6
CAN High CAN Low
44
AMP 967563-1
PCU BOSCH
20
1
+12V Lift pump (fuse F31) +12V Grid Heater relay (fuse F30)
Starter relay +12V Grid Heater - battery
AMP 282087-1
4
+12V Signal Ground
3 2 1
S1 S2 S3
10 MM
8 MM
6.3 MM
8 MM
6 MM
B+
B-
B+
+
D+
5 B-
6
2
5 MM
CT1 CT2
W
2
4 MM
1
2
6 MM
T
6 MM
AMP 963040-3 1
GH2
GH1
+ battery
G
M Fig. 5 MA-11-01050B
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF105.7
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams Harness parts list
Colour reminder
FAI 01 FAI 02 FAI 03 FAI 04 FAI 12 FAI 13 FAI 17 FAI 23 FAI 24 FAI 25 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 33 FAI 35 FAI 38 FAI 41 FAI 46 FAI 47 FAI 57 FAI 68 FAI 131
N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
Engine harness Instrument panel harness Console harness Cab Autotronic 3 harness Dynashift armrest harness Fuse box supply harness Fuse box Ground harness Cab linkage harness Single linkage harness Linkage with Dual Control harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness Datatronic 2 harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness (GPA40) DynaVT armrest harness 4 electrohydraulic spool valves harness ParkLock - Autotronic 5 harness Automatic air conditioning - Roof harness Fieldstar harness Datatronic 3 harness
Component parts list AC12 CA1 CAB1 CAB44 CAB54 CAB74 CAB84 CAB85 ENG4 L13 TR18 FS1 FS2 V2 V3 V4 V5
Joystick Air conditioning control unit Instrument panel (DCC2) Throttle pedal potentiometer Autotronic 4 Autotronic 5 - ParkLock Memorised ratios activation switch Memorised ratios adjustment switch Electronic injection harness junction Electronic linkage calculator (ELC) Transmission control unit Fieldstar LBS+ connector Fieldstar terminal Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve
1 2 61
Autotronic 3 Fuse box Grid Heater relay
GUF105.8
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams
Electrical power supply
2
31
20 21
8 9
10 22
18
4
17 16 15
13 24
27
14 25
28
6 5
12
29
7 1
11 23
30 19
2 3
26
ENG4
FAI01 ENG4
FAI02 F28-20A
F32-10A
31
20 21
8 9
10 22
2 F28
12 24
F32 - 10A
1
3
5
7
9
11
13
15
17
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
18
16
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
28
6 16 15 27
14 25
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
29 17
5 13
- 20A
18 7
1 4
23
BAF10
30 19
2 3
11
26
BAF10.17/ENG2.14 BAF10.15/ENG2.13
M M
BAF10.10/ENG2.11
M
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
S12.1/ENG4.3
31
20 21
8 9
10 22
18
12
17 28
6 16
5 15
13
27
14
24
29
7 1
4
23
30 19
2 3
11
25
26
ENG2.14/S12.1 ENG2.13/S12.1
M M
ENG2.11/ENG4.1
M
S12
M
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 ENG4
BAF10 ENG2 ENG2 17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
MA-10-06070A ENG9 1 X4
ENG4.4/ENG9.1 N ENG4.2/ENG9.1 N
1
+12V
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF105.9
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams Harness parts list
Colour reminder
FAI 01 FAI 02 FAI 03 FAI 04 FAI 12 FAI 13 FAI 17 FAI 23 FAI 24 FAI 25 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 33 FAI 35 FAI 38 FAI 41 FAI 46 FAI 47 FAI 57 FAI 68 FAI 131
N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
Engine harness Instrument panel harness Console harness Cab Autotronic 3 harness Dynashift armrest harness Fuse box supply harness Fuse box Ground harness Cab linkage harness Single linkage harness Linkage with Dual Control harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness Datatronic 2 harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness (GPA40) DynaVT armrest harness 4 electrohydraulic spool valves harness ParkLock - Autotronic 5 harness Automatic air conditioning - Roof harness Fieldstar harness Datatronic 3 harness
Component parts list AC12 CA1 CAB1 CAB44 CAB54 CAB74 CAB84 CAB85 ENG4 L13 TR18 FS1 FS2 V2 V3 V4 V5
Joystick Air conditioning control unit Instrument panel (DCC2) Throttle pedal potentiometer Autotronic 4 Autotronic 5 - ParkLock Memorised ratios activation switch Memorised ratios adjustment switch Electronic injection harness junction Electronic linkage calculator (ELC) Transmission control unit Fieldstar LBS+ connector Fieldstar terminal Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve
1 2 61
Autotronic 3 Fuse box Grid Heater relay
GUF105.10
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams
Controls
17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 B 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F42 F31
S14
BAF10.7/S14.1
F30 R3
F31 - 15A
1 2
5
+12V
3
R2
4 1
F30 - 15A
X1X5 1 2 4
BAF10
F22
X4
5
3
F42 - 5A
R3
1
2 ENG2 ENG2
ENG4
9 10
2 7
11
15
12 13 24
14 26
23
4 5
27
22
3 1
6 16
25
ENG2.21/ENG4.18
B
ENG2.5/ENG4.21 ENG2.6/ENG4.22 ENG2.7/ENG4.23 ENG2.8/ENG4.24
29 28
14 25
2
9
7
5
3
1
10
8
6
4
2
27
27
10 22
3 11
23
4 12
5 15
13 24
14 26
26
21 9
1 6
16
25
CAB44
B B B B
6
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
1 2 3
1
CAB37
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
CAB37
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3
2
alim
3
Us
1 0V
CAB44
1
2
4
5
6
12
11 10 9
8
7
3
CAB37.1/CAB84.3
B
CAB37.2/CAB84.1 S6.1/CAB84.2
3
2
1
FAI03
CAB44
CAB37.4/CAB85.1
B
CAB37.3/CAB85.3 S6
B
S2.1/CAB83.2
B B B
CAB44.1/CAB1.11 8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB84
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
EEM
EEM A
B
+APC
S18
B
20
2 7
17
16 15
13 24
29 28
17 6
5
8 19
18
18 7
1
12
30
30 19
2
4
23
31
8 9 3
11
B B
X2 1
FAI02
31
20 21 10 22
ENG2.17/ENG4.14 ENG2.15/ENG4.15
F22 - 10A
B
21
8 19
18 17
S1.1/ENG4.5 R ENG2.16/ENG4.6 B ENG2.12/ENG4.7 B
ENG2.21/S18.1
CAB37.5/S6.1
20
31 30
29 28
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
S14.1/ENG2.15 B BAF10.8/ENG2.16 B BAF10.6/ENG2.17 B
B
FAI01
R
B
R
ENG 4
BAF10.5/ENG2.12
CAB44.2/S5.1
R2
BAF8.5/S5.1
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 BAF8
CAB44.3/S18.1
R
S5
B B B B B
B
S1.1/ENG2.9
CAB37.1/ENG2.5 CAB37.2/ENG2.6 CAB37.3/ENG2.7 ENG2.8/CAB37.4 CAB37.5/ENG2.10
S18.1/CAB1.10
S1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
-
+
B
CAB85 68
46
45
24
23
1
68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB1
CAB84
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
B
A
CAB1
CAB85
MA-11-01207A
GUF105.11
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams Harness parts list
Colour reminder
FAI 01 FAI 02 FAI 03 FAI 04 FAI 12 FAI 13 FAI 17 FAI 23 FAI 24 FAI 25 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 33 FAI 35 FAI 38 FAI 41 FAI 46 FAI 47 FAI 57 FAI 68 FAI 131
N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
Engine harness Instrument panel harness Console harness Cab Autotronic 3 harness Dynashift armrest harness Fuse box supply harness Fuse box Ground harness Cab linkage harness Single linkage harness Linkage with Dual Control harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness Datatronic 2 harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness (GPA40) DynaVT armrest harness 4 electrohydraulic spool valves harness ParkLock - Autotronic 5 harness Automatic air conditioning - Roof harness Fieldstar harness Datatronic 3 harness
Component parts list AC12 CA1 CAB1 CAB44 CAB54 CAB74 CAB84 CAB85 ENG4 L13 TR18 FS1 FS2 V2 V3 V4 V5
Joystick Air conditioning control unit Instrument panel (DCC2) Throttle pedal potentiometer Autotronic 4 Autotronic 5 - ParkLock Memorised ratios activation switch Memorised ratios adjustment switch Electronic injection harness junction Electronic linkage calculator (ELC) Transmission control unit Fieldstar LBS+ connector Fieldstar terminal Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve
1 2 61
Autotronic 3 Fuse box Grid Heater relay
GUF105.12
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams
Grid Heater circuit
20
31 30
1
B
24 25
2
ENG2.15/ENG4.15
3
ENG2.12/ENG4.7 B
4
ENG4
6
26
5
27
14 25
28 16
15
13
7
17 6
5
24
29
7 1
4 12
8
18
2 3
11 23
9
10 22
30 19
10
8 9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
11
31
20
13 14
26
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
23 12
12
26
FAI01
21
15 27
27
14 25
ENG2
11 4
5
16
13
16 15
22
3
14
24
28
6 5
13
10
15
12
21 9
1 6
28
17
1 4
23
29
7
3 11
17
16
22
18
2
2 7
29
17
10
18
30 19
18
8 9
8 19
31
20 21
FAI02 S14 BAF10.5/ENG2.12
S14.1/ENG2.15
BAF10.7/S14.1
B
B
2 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 B 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2
5
3
R3
4 1
F30 - 15A
BAF10
FAI13
F42 - 5A
+CAB PLUS_CAB.1/X4.1
1
R
1 X4 1
X1X5
ENG2
F42
MASSE_BAF.1/X1.1
N F30
FAI17
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
R3
2 1
ENG4
61 ENG29_B/ENG25.1 R 1 1
ENG25
FAI01
ENG29B
F- 225A
ENG29
ENG29.1/S11.1
M
FAI01
S11
S11.1/ENG32.1
M
1 ENG32
1 1
ENG25 MA-10-06061A
+BATT
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF105.13
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams Harness parts list
Colour reminder
FAI 01 FAI 02 FAI 03 FAI 04 FAI 12 FAI 13 FAI 17 FAI 23 FAI 24 FAI 25 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 33 FAI 35 FAI 38 FAI 41 FAI 46 FAI 47 FAI 57 FAI 68 FAI 131
N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
Engine harness Instrument panel harness Console harness Cab Autotronic 3 harness Dynashift armrest harness Fuse box supply harness Fuse box Ground harness Cab linkage harness Single linkage harness Linkage with Dual Control harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness Datatronic 2 harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness (GPA40) DynaVT armrest harness 4 electrohydraulic spool valves harness ParkLock - Autotronic 5 harness Automatic air conditioning - Roof harness Fieldstar harness Datatronic 3 harness
Component parts list AC12 CA1 CAB1 CAB44 CAB54 CAB74 CAB84 CAB85 ENG4 L13 TR18 FS1 FS2 V2 V3 V4 V5
Joystick Air conditioning control unit Instrument panel (DCC2) Throttle pedal potentiometer Autotronic 4 Autotronic 5 - ParkLock Memorised ratios activation switch Memorised ratios adjustment switch Electronic injection harness junction Electronic linkage calculator (ELC) Transmission control unit Fieldstar LBS+ connector Fieldstar terminal Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve
1 2 61
Autotronic 3 Fuse box Grid Heater relay
GUF105.14
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams CAN network - all options with Autotronic 3 transmission calculator
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF105.15
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams Harness parts list
Colour reminder
FAI 01 FAI 02 FAI 03 FAI 04 FAI 12 FAI 13 FAI 17 FAI 23 FAI 24 FAI 25 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 33 FAI 35 FAI 38 FAI 41 FAI 46 FAI 47 FAI 57 FAI 68 FAI 131
N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
Engine harness Instrument panel harness Console harness Cab Autotronic 3 harness Dynashift armrest harness Fuse box supply harness Fuse box Ground harness Cab linkage harness Single linkage harness Linkage with Dual Control harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness Datatronic 2 harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness (GPA40) DynaVT armrest harness 4 electrohydraulic spool valves harness ParkLock - Autotronic 5 harness Automatic air conditioning - Roof harness Fieldstar harness Datatronic 3 harness
Component parts list AC12 CA1 CAB1 CAB44 CAB54 CAB74 CAB84 CAB85 ENG4 L13 TR18 FS1 FS2 V2 V3 V4 V5
Joystick Air conditioning control unit Instrument panel (DCC2) Throttle pedal potentiometer Autotronic 4 Autotronic 5 - ParkLock Memorised ratios activation switch Memorised ratios adjustment switch Electronic injection harness junction Electronic linkage calculator (ELC) Transmission control unit Fieldstar LBS+ connector Fieldstar terminal Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve
1 2 61
Autotronic 3 Fuse box Grid Heater relay
GUF105.16
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams
CAN network - all options with Autotronic 3 transmission calculator and Autotronic 5 Park Lock
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF105.17
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams Harness parts list
Colour reminder
FAI 01 FAI 02 FAI 03 FAI 04 FAI 12 FAI 13 FAI 17 FAI 23 FAI 24 FAI 25 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 33 FAI 35 FAI 38 FAI 41 FAI 46 FAI 47 FAI 57 FAI 68 FAI 131
N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
Engine harness Instrument panel harness Console harness Cab Autotronic 3 harness Dynashift armrest harness Fuse box supply harness Fuse box Ground harness Cab linkage harness Single linkage harness Linkage with Dual Control harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness Datatronic 2 harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness (GPA40) DynaVT armrest harness 4 electrohydraulic spool valves harness ParkLock - Autotronic 5 harness Automatic air conditioning - Roof harness Fieldstar harness Datatronic 3 harness
Component parts list AC12 CA1 CAB1 CAB44 CAB54 CAB74 CAB84 CAB85 ENG4 L13 TR18 FS1 FS2 V2 V3 V4 V5
Joystick Air conditioning control unit Instrument panel (DCC2) Throttle pedal potentiometer Autotronic 4 Autotronic 5 - ParkLock Memorised ratios activation switch Memorised ratios adjustment switch Electronic injection harness junction Electronic linkage calculator (ELC) Transmission control unit Fieldstar LBS+ connector Fieldstar terminal Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve
1 2 61
Autotronic 3 Fuse box Grid Heater relay
GUF105.18
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams
CAN network - all options with Autotronic 4 transmission calculator and EHRC linkage calculator
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF105.19
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams Harness parts list
Colour reminder
FAI 01 FAI 02 FAI 03 FAI 04 FAI 12 FAI 13 FAI 17 FAI 23 FAI 24 FAI 25 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 33 FAI 35 FAI 38 FAI 41 FAI 46 FAI 47 FAI 57 FAI 68 FAI 131
N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
Engine harness Instrument panel harness Console harness Cab Autotronic 3 harness Dynashift armrest harness Fuse box supply harness Fuse box Ground harness Cab linkage harness Single linkage harness Linkage with Dual Control harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness Datatronic 2 harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness (GPA40) DynaVT armrest harness 4 electrohydraulic spool valves harness ParkLock - Autotronic 5 harness Automatic air conditioning - Roof harness Fieldstar harness Datatronic 3 harness
Component parts list AC12 CA1 CAB1 CAB44 CAB54 CAB74 CAB84 CAB85 ENG4 L13 TR18 FS1 FS2 V2 V3 V4 V5
Joystick Air conditioning control unit Instrument panel (DCC2) Throttle pedal potentiometer Autotronic 4 Autotronic 5 - ParkLock Memorised ratios activation switch Memorised ratios adjustment switch Electronic injection harness junction Electronic linkage calculator (ELC) Transmission control unit Fieldstar LBS+ connector Fieldstar terminal Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve Electrohydraulic spool valve
1 2 61
Autotronic 3 Fuse box Grid Heater relay
GUF105.20
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams
CAN network with Autotronic 4 transmission calculator and Autotronic 5 linkage calculator
23
24
14
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V J
CAB83 1 120
S12.1/CAB54.26 CAB54.27/S13.1
J
V
CAB83.2/CAB50.4
CAB83.1/CAB50.7
FAI 31
V J
8
30 19
9
18
2
17
1
11 4 12
28
6 16
5 15
13 24
29
7
3
23
27
14 25
26
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI 28
CA1
ENG4
34
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
FAI 31 4
3
2
1
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
8
7
6
5
TR18.5/CAB50.7
V
TR18.2/CAB50.4
J
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
V
CA1.14/CA8.2
J
FAI 57
TR18 TR18
CAB18 S21 S20
1
8
FAI 32
FAI 35
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CA1.1/CA8.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
4
J V
S21.1/CAB18.2 S20.1/CAB18.1
V J
ENG2
11
1 6
28
23
4 12
5
16 15
13 24
14
27 26
25
10 22
3 11
1 6
23
4 12
5
16 15
13 24
14 26
25
FAI 41 S5.1/AC2.8 S6.1/AC2.7
V J
6
5
4
3
2
1
7
8
9
10
11 12
S5 S6
L14
1 2 3 4 1 2
3
4
3
V J S2.1/V5.2 S3.1/V5.3
V J
V J
V J S2.1/V3.2 S3.1/V3.3
S2.1/V4.2 S3.1/V4.3
V J S2.1/V2.2 S3.1/V2.3 1
2
S5
J V
V1.2/S4.1 V1.3/S5.1
V J
L 22
L14
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
1
S10 S9
FAI 23
S8.1/L22A.1 S9.1/L22A.2
V J
V1.2/S2.1 V1.3/S3.1
V J CAB112
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
L22.1/S4.1 L22.2/S3.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V J
S4_ S4.1/CAB112.4 S_3 S3.1/CAB112.3
V J
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L13
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
6
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
S3.1/L111.14 S4.1/L111.16 L111.13/CAB112.6 L111.12/CAB112.5
FAI 68
S8.1/FS4.29
V
S1.1/FS4.30
V
S_1
FS2.N/S1.1 FS2.M/S1.1
V V
S5.1/FS2.K FS2.J/S5.1
J J
J
S5.1/FS4.28
J S__5
FS4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37
FS1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
FS1
33 1 5 10 16 23 29 34
CAB1 29
42
29
42
15
28
15
28
1
14
1
14
13
7 8 9 10
3 4 5
1 2
6
1
CAB112
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
J V V J
FAI 68 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
CAB141 CAB141
11 12 14
S9
CAB141
L13
16
CAB112
FS1 L13
15
FAI 131
FAI 68
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
L 22
J V
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CA8.1/S4.1 CA8.2/S3.1
1
2
S8
S9.1/FS4.27
J V CAB141.40/S10.1 CAB141.39/S9.1
1 2 3 4
7
L22A 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V1
1 2 3 4
FAI 128
L22.1/S8.1 L22.2/S9.1 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V1
1
L22
J V
3
4
J V
L14.13/S5.1 S4.1/L14.12
2
S10.1/AC1.12 AC1.11/S9.1
FAI 46
28
4
AC1 S10.1/L13.40 S9.1/L13.39
1 2 3 4
V5
3
7
V5
4
16
S4
4
6
3
26
S5.1/L14.16 S4.1/L14.15
5
5 8
1 2
27
14 25
6
4
3
1 2 3 4
7
2
11 10 9
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4
V4
15
J V
5 6 7
1 12
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V4
4
S2
17 6
5 13
24
29
7 1
4 12
4
V
3
18
2 3
11 23
AC1 CAB1.39/S21.1
1 2
19
9 10 22
7
AC2
S6.1/AC1.12 AC1.11/S5.1
1 2
CA8
4
7
CA8
S3
5
6
1 2
30
6
5 8
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8
5 6
4
3
1 2 3 4
31
20 21
4
2
11 10 9
1 2 3 4
V3
1
9 2
7 17
27
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
3
1 12
V3
4
3
2
19 18 29 28
21
8
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2
V J
1 2 3 4
3
20
31 30
J V J V
AC2.8/S12.1 S13.1/AC2.7
1 2 3 4
V2
V J
FAI 41
L13.15/L14.16 L13.34/L14.15 L14.13/L22.2 L14.12/L22.1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI 31
V2
1 2
AC2
J
X
X
X
5 6 7
AC12
ENG2
CAB1.16/S20.1
V5
V4
4
17
22
1 2 3
27 26
10 3
1
16 15
14
9 2
7
2
28
6 5
13
21
8 19
18
X
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
3
17
1 4
12 24
30
29
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
20
31
V3
4
29
V2
5
18 7
11 23
30 19
2 3
AC12 AC12
6
8 9
10
ENG2.1/ENG4.30 J ENG2.2/ENG4.31 V
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
7
21
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
31
20
22
J V
J V
S20.1/ENG2.1 S21.1/ENG2.2
1 2 3
46 24 1
31
20 21 10
5
S13.1/CAB18.1 S12.1/CAB18.2
CAB1
68 45 23
26
22
CAB18 S13 S12
FAI 35
CAB1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
ENG4
28 16 27
14 25
TR18
CAB54
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
29 17
15
CAB50
25
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
18
6 5
13 24
25
2
30
7 1
4 12
CAB50
19 2
3 11
13
26
CAB83.1/CAB54.4 CAB83.2/CAB54.5
22
23 12
5
27
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
22 11
4
15
10
10 3
1
AC12.3/S6.1 S5.1/AC12.4
68 45 23
46 24 1
CAB54
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
8 9
9 2
7 6 16
CAB54
21
21
8 19
18 17
31
20
20
31 30
29 28
4
J V B
FS2
P
N
E M
D A C
L
F
B G K J
H
FS2
3
9 15 22 28 33 37
FS2.C/FS1.8 FS1.9/FS2.B FS1.5/FS2.A
P N M L K J H G F E D C B A
2 9
4 1
5
MA-11-01384A
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF105.21
SisuDiesel ELECTRONIC INJECTION - Electrical Diagrams
GUF105.22
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 - Description
11C10 - DCC2 - Description
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 C . Allocation of DCC2 pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11C10.1
DCC2 - Description
11C10.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DCC2 - Description
A . General
TECHstar Dyna VT CAN network
The electronic control circuit of the DynaVTPOWERMAXX transmission on 8400DT A series tractors comprises three main components: the DCC2 (second generation digital instrument panel), the Autotronic 4 (transmission controller) and the CAN network. These components are connected via harnesses, switches, potentiometers, sensors and solenoid valves.
1
10
7
8
9
1 2
The DCC2 and Autotronic 4 also contain a self-diagnostic function intended to warn the operator when the circuit of one of the components is defective or disconnected. The error code diagnostics help qualified personnel when troubleshooting the various control components. These codes are displayed on the DOT MATRIX screen of the DCC2 and may, depending on the severity of the breakdown, place the transmission in neutral or allow it to continue functioning. Codes are stored in memory and can be later displayed by qualified personnel to troubleshoot intermittent problems (see Error codes section).
3 4 5 6
ESC
CAN network
4
The DCC2 receives the following information from the Autotronic 4 via the CAN network: engine speed, transmission input and output speeds, Hare / Tortoise range position, PTO speed, transmission oil temperature, transmission oil pressure and filter clogging level.
2
6
5
3
15 16
11 12 13 14
7 8 9 10
3 4 5
1 2
6
The DCC2 is also connected to all the tractor electronic calculators as well as to the diagnostics connector (for programming and setting parameters with Wintest) via the CAN network (Fig. 1).
The transmission electronic control circuit (Fig. 1) (1) (2)
7
DCC2 Autotronic 4 CAN network Location
Other CAN network connections (Fig. 1) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10)
16-way diagnostics connector Electronic injection control unit (EEM) Autotronic 5 electronic linkage calculator Autotronic 5 ParkLock calculator Datatronic 3 Joystick Electrohydraulic spool valves Automatic air conditioning controller
2
5
8
6
10 1
3 9
4
MA-11-06068A
Fig. 1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11C10.3
DCC2 - Description The DCC2 and Autotronic 4 both control the tractor functions. The DCC2 provides the operator with information via two digital display screens, analog instruments and warning indicator lights. It also communicates with the Autotronic 4 via the CAN network to inform it of electrical signals from the functions activated by the operator, for example the clutch pedal and both gear shift levers: the left-hand FNR lever and the armrest lever, throttle pedal, lever / pedal mode switch, SV1 and SV2 ground speed selector encoders and switches, engine underspeed supervisor, PTO automation switch, the Headland switch and the DOT MATRIX control keys for information, for example the clutch-coupler function status (Fig. 2).
3 2
1
4
16
Parts list (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) (12) (13) (14) (15) (16)
Vistronic Buzzer Clutch pedal Right-hand console Reverse shuttle lever Armrest Throttle pedal Air filter vacuum sensor Main lighting switch Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging switch Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor Auxiliary hydraulics oil gauge Speed parameter display selector switch DOT MATRIX keyboard Radar Fuel gauge
DCC 2 15
5 1
14
2
10
15
5
0
20
RPM x 100
25
A
6
.
Sv 1
.
Sv 2
.
A
B
AUTO
540 750 1000
.
KPH MPH RPM
13 23
1
45
24
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
68
46
7 12
8
9
11
CAN
10
MA-11-06044A
Fig. 2
11C10.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DCC2 - Description Vistronic (1) The DCC2 controls the rotational speed of the Vistronic depending on the engine temperature it receives from the Autotronic 4 via the CAN network. The Vistronic therefore turns faster or slower in order to maintain a constant optimum engine temperature (Fig. 3). Note: The °C values in Fig. 3 are indicative values. They are not displayed on the instrument panel. The DCC2 measures the rotational speed of the Vistronic using an embedded sensor.
95°C
100°C
85°C
110°C
60°C
Buzzer (2) It warns the driver when a fault occurs. Clutch pedal (3) The clutch pedal is fitted with three different elements: - a pedal high position (TOC) sensor (A) (Fig. 4), - a potentiometer that measures clutch pedal travel (B) (Fig. 4), - a pedal low position (BOC) sensor (C) (Fig. 4),
Fig. 3
MA-11-06069A
C
A B
Right-hand console (4) The DCC2 controls several elements in the right-hand console: - the underspeed supervisor (A) (Fig. 5): it allows the drop in engine speed to be limited when under load. Its control is directly linked to a potentiometer that sends a different signal to the DCC2 depending on user requirements, - the lever / pedal mode (and self-propelled mode) selector switch (B) (Fig. 5), - the SV1 and SV2 encoders (C) (Fig. 5): they allow pre-setting of SV1 and SV2 grounds speeds, - the rear PTO automation switch (D) (Fig. 5).
MA-11-06070A
Fig. 4
C
B A MA-11-06072A-MF-CH
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
D Fig. 5
11C10.5
DCC2 - Description Reverse shuttle lever (5) It is located on the left-hand steering column. The lever allows: - the gearbox to be put into neutral position, - forward or reverse travel to be selected, - ground speed to be increased or decreased in forward and reverse positions. Armrest (6)
C
It consists of several elements: - the Headland switch (A) (Fig. 6), - the SV1 and SV2 switches (B) (Fig. 6), - the right-hand lever potentiometer (C) (Fig. 6). The potentiometer allows ground speed acceleration and deceleration.
A B MA-11-06071A-AG-MF
Fig. 6
Throttle pedal (7) The throttle pedal is directly linked to the potentiometer. This potentiometer sends the DCC2 a signal proportional to the throttle pedal position. The DCC2 can therefore manage the operation of the underspeed supervisor and lever / pedal (and self-propelled) modes. Air filter vacuum sensor (8) The air filter vacuum sensor is fitted with a switch that is activated when the air filter is clogged (excessive vacuum). When activated, the switch sends a signal to the DCC2, which turns on an indicator light to warn the user. Main lighting switch (9) When activated, it allows the DCC2 to switch to night mode (dimmer screen lighting). Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging switch (10) When the auxiliary hydraulics oil filter is clogged, the switch is activated and sends a signal to the DCC2, which turns on an indicator light to warn the user. Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor (11) It measures the auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature and sends a signal to the DCC2 which turns on an indicator light to warn the user when the temperature is too high.
11C10.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DCC2 - Description Auxiliary hydraulics oil gauge (12) It measures the auxiliary hydraulics oil level and informs the DCC2, which displays the value on the DOT MATRIX screen. The gauge consists of a float fitted with a magnet (A) (Fig. 7) that activates the switches (B) (Fig. 7) connected in parallel with resistors. The DCC2 therefore receives a signal proportional to the tank filling level. Speed parameter display selector switch (13) The display selector switch allows the user to display in the DCC2 screen the rear PTO speed, engine speed, ground speed, daily engine hours and total engine hours.
12 x 20 ohm
A
DOT MATRIX keyboard (14) It is located to the right of the steering column. The keyboard allows access to the various DCC2 menus displayed on the DOT MATRIX screen (left-hand screen). 4 x 60 ohm
B
Radar (15) (optional) The radar allows actual tractor ground speed to be displayed when below 25 kph. Above 25 kph, design speed is displayed. Fuel gauge (16) It transmits a signal to the DCC2 depending on the level of fuel in the tank. The DCC2 then activates a pointer on the instrument panel (Fig. 8) to allow the user to view the contents of the tank.
20 ohm
MA-11-06073A
Fig. 7
MA-11-06074A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Fig. 8
11C10.7
DCC2 - Description
Page left blank intentionally
11C10.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DCC2 - Description
B . Description The DCC2 is attached by four screws to the steering column assembly. It receives and displays the tractor functions and supplies information required by the operator to use the tractor, via indicator lights and display tables (Fig. 9).
9 11
10
1
Parts list (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11)
13
12
DOT MATRIX screen Right-hand control display Tachometer DOT MATRIX control keypad Coolant temperature gauge Fuel gauge Control indicator lights for functions in use Failure control and ParkLock indicator lights Failure control indicator lights Right-hand direction indicator light Left-hand direction indicator light
10
15
5
0
7
20
RPM x 100
25
8
3 A
A
B
AUTO
st
AUTO
(12) Direction indicator light for the 1 trailer (13) Direction indicator light for the 2nd trailer (14) Headlights indicator light (15) Speed parameters display selector switch on right-hand control screen.
2
540 750 1000
1
5
KPH MPH RPM
6
2
14
15
4
MA-11-06045A-MF
Fig. 9 Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11C10.9
DCC2 - Description
Page left blank intentionally
11C10.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DCC2 - Description Indicator light units Control indicator lights for functions in use ((A) Fig. 10)
1
2
10
15
5
0
A
20
RPM x 100
25
A
.
Sv 1
.
Sv 2
.
A
B
AUTO
.
540 750 1000
KPH MPH RPM
MA-11-06046A
Fig. 10
Green and orange control indicator lights display and monitor the functioning of the equipment. Front PTO (not used)
Front axle suspension (not used) Transmission oil filter clogging (15 microns) 4WD front axle
Differential lock
Rear PTO
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11C10.11
DCC2 - Description Failure control and ParkLock indicator lights ((B) Fig. 11)
1
2
10
15
5
0
20
RPM x 100
25
B A
.
Sv 1
.
Sv 2
.
A
B
AUTO
.
540 750 1000
KPH MPH RPM
MA-11-06047A
Fig. 11
Red indicator lights signal problems of varying importance; they come on when the ignition is switched on and usually turn off when the engine has started.
Grid Heater (not used)
Intake air temperature indicator light CAUTION: If they light up when the engine is running normally, stop the engine at once and investigate the cause of the problem.
Air filter clogging
Transmission oil and auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging
ParkLock and emergency handbrake
11C10.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DCC2 - Description Failure control indicator lights ((C) Fig. 12)
C 1
2
10
15
5
0
20
RPM x 100
25
A
.
Sv 1
.
Sv 2
.
A
B
AUTO
.
MA-11-06048A
540 750 1000
KPH MPH RPM
Fig. 12
Trailer brake pressure (if fitted)
Engine oil pressure
Coolant temperature Brake master cylinder supply circuit - 18 bar pressure Transmission high pressure (480 bar)
Alternator charge
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11C10.13
DCC2 - Description Left-hand control screen (Fig. 13) This control screen allows the different parameter displays to be monitored: (1) Forward / neutral / reverse and ParkLock liquid crystal display. (2) Reverse shuttle sensitivity (1, 2, 3 or 4). (3) Selected symbol display: rear PTO, engine speed, ground speed and engine hours (these parameters can all be selected by pressing the switch (9) located on the instrument panel). (4) Digital display: rear PTO speed, engine speed, ground speed, daily engine hours and total engine hours (only the daily engine hours can be reset by pressing the switch (9) for 5 seconds). (5) Power take-off automation. (6) 4WD front axle automation control. (7) A/B stored engine speed status. (8) Hare / Tortoise range engagement indicator lights. (9) Parameter display selector switch.
A
7
6
A
1
B
2
5 8
540 750 1000
3
4
KPH MPH RPM
9
MA-11-06067A-MF-CH
Fig. 13
11C10.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DCC2 - Description DOT MATRIX screen The DOT MATRIX screen is initialised at tractor start-up. The DOT MATRIX keyboard to the right of the steering column must be used to access the different menus, and the instructions given in the following table must be followed.
Screens
Access
Function Auxiliary oil level screen
HYDR OIL Ignition before engine start (ignition key on +ACC position)
95 % MA-05-04291A
1055
Displays the filling level of the auxiliary oil tank (0-100%): - 100%: tank full. - 50%: warning threshold. When the auxiliary oil tank level drops to < 50%, it is automatically displayed every 4 minutes (press ESC to return to the main screen). If sensor problem, ERROR is displayed instead of the filling level.
800
3.2
Sv 1 Sv 2
AUTO
Start-up screen
35.0 3.2
Starting the tractor
Displays the restart speeds, the SV1 and SV2 speeds, engine supervisor, PTO, pedal mode, eco or lever mode.
0.2 MA-05-04014A
1430 1160
Work screen
0 RPM 0% 2,6
Sv 1
To display from the start-up screen
Displays memorised engine speeds, PTO speed, actual wheel slip rate, lever mode, pedal mode (power or eco), self-propelled mode and SV1 and SV2 speeds.
To display from the previous screen
Reverse shuttle sensitivity
MA-05-04292A
Delay
-
4 No +
OK
MA-05-04032A
MODE + -
4 2
Allows to adjust the response time when shifting direction of travel To increase or decrease the value The delay begins when the reverse shuttle lever is activated. If the delay is authorised, declutching takes place 5 seconds after the lever is Allows a delay (5 seconds) to be authorised or not when reversing direction of pulled. If not authorised, declutching takes place as soon as the lever is activated. travel
To display from the previous screen
Pedal mode sensitivity screen To increase or decrease the value
Used to adjust acceleration (+) and deceleration (-) sensitivity in pedal mode operation.
+
MA-05-04293A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11C10.15
D C C 2 - D e s c r ip t io n
Screens
Access
(l) 0 10 T 500 ok 5s 0 0 T
To display from the previous screen Press 5 seconds to reset
OK
Function
Fuel used screen Indicates fuel consumed: 0: Quantity of fuel consumed since last reset. T: total fuel consumed. This value cannot be modified or reset
MA-05-04024A
To display from the previous screen
SLIP
OK
Off
Press to enter the settings menu. The symbol appears To set the required wheel slip percentage value
0% Max 22%
Wheel slip screen (optional) Enables the max. allowable slip to be defined and displays the current slip setting.
Allows to exit the settings screen
ESC
MA-05-04029A
To display from the previous screen
100 100
%
Press to enter the menus
100
100
OK
OFF
Joystick setting menu (1/2) (if Datatronic 3 not installed)
This menu allows to adjust the flow rate values of To select one of the displayed flow rate values each spool valve controlled by the Joystick. If the Joystick is locked (padlock displayed on screen) or timing press the blue armrest ON/OFF button near the To modify displayed flow rate values PTO control.
MA-05-04268A
When timing is selected, it is possible to display the type of timing (value or infinite)
100 84
%
To adjust the timing value
100
100
ON 60
ESC
Joystick setting menu (2/2) (if Datatronic 3 not installed)
This menu allows to activate or deactivate timing, and can be adjusted from 0 to 60 seconds or to Allows to exit the settings screen and infinite mode. validate settings
MA-05-04269A
To display from the previous screen
EEM-EHR
OK
OF + 9s + 0s
A B
MA-05-04270A
EEM-SV SV1 SV2 A
ON ON
A B
Headland 2 screen (if Datatronic 3 not installed)
This menu allows to adjust the engine speed when changing linkage status (work or transport). Allows to activate the mode or validate the val- The operating conditions are: - ON mode ues - power shuttle lever out of neutral Used to shift from one line to another - tractor moving. - When the linkage transport mode is selected, engine speed B is activated after the preset Allows to set the seconds value of the time. displayed time - When the linkage working mode is selected, engine speed A is activated after the preset time.
To display from the previous screen
Headland 1 screen To activate or deactivate one of the two functions
This menu is used to vary the engine speed during activation of SV1 and SV2 memorised ground speeds.
B
MA-05-04294A
11C10.16
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DCC2 - Description
Screens
Access
CLUTCH ON
0 k 5 s off
Function
To display from the previous screen
Clutch coupler screen
OK
Press 5 seconds to switch from ON to OFF while pressing down the clutch pedal
Displays whether the clutch coupler fonction is on or off.
MA-05-04030A
Auxiliary oil level screen
HYDR OIL To display from the previous screen
95 % MA-05-04291A
SPEED
To display from the previous screen
+
100 / 0 -
% +
Displays the filling level of the auxiliary oil tank (0-100%): - 100%: tank full. - 50%: warning threshold. When the auxiliary oil tank level drops to < 50%, it is automatically displayed every 4 minutes (press ESC to return to the main screen). If sensor problem, ERROR is displayed instead of the filling level.
Linkage and spool valves menu
This menu allows to give priority to the auxiliary spool valves over the linkage, and vice versa. To modify displayed linkage and spool Maximum linkage value: 100 Minimum spool valve value 0 valve flow rate values Minimum linkage value: 20 Maximum spool valve value: 80
MA-05-04267A
ERROR To display from the previous screen
Error code screen Displays all tractor error codes. Each error code is displayed for 4 seconds in a loop
Num MA-05-04222A
To display from the previous screen
Brightness screen To increase or decrease the value
-
Setting screen brightness
+
MA-05-04021A
To display from the previous screen To increase or decrease the value
-
Contrast screen Setting screen contrast
+
MA-05-04020A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11C10.17
DCC2 - Description
C . Allocation of DCC2 pins 1
The DCC2 is fitted with two connectors (Fig. 14): - a 68-pin connector to which the instrument panel harness is connected, - a 7-pin connector to which the DOT MATRIX control panel harness is connected. The pin allocation is set out in the following tables.
2
10
15
5
20
RPM x 100
0
A
EEM-EHR 85°C
A 60°C
540 750 1000
110°C
B
23
1
1
Calculator power supply +12 V AC (Ignition key On)
2
Not used
3
Vistronic power supply
5
CAB12 Clutch pedal potentiometer
CAB78 Engine underspeed supervisor
8
3
2
1
Fig. 14
Signal
12 V output 0-5V input
0-5V input Ground output
Not used
10
0-5V input CAB44 Throttle pedal potentiometer
11
Ground output
12
39
Fuel gauge
0-12V input
13
15
Top-of-clutch (TOC) pedal switch normally open
TOC NO 12V input
14
Not used
15
Not used
16
CAN High
17
CAB86 Front power take off switch (if fitted)
18
TR27
19
12V input
Radar
0-12 V square signal input
Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch normally open
BOC NO 12V input
Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch normally closed
BOC NC 12V input
BOC1
20
Wired but not used
22
11C10.18
¤ H
4
5 V output
7
21
5
Not used
6
9
6
MA-11-06043A
Description
4
7
45
KPH MPH RPM
68
46
Pin
B
100°C
24
Description of 68-pin connector
A
95°C
OF + 9s + 0s
25
65
Buzzer
12V output to buzzer
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DCC2 - Description
Pin 23 24
Description Battery ground (-) CAB3
Main light switch
12V input (backlighting)
25
Headlights
12V input
26
Left-hand direction indicator
12V input
27
Right-hand direction indicator
12V input
28
1st trailer direction indicator
12V input
29
2nd trailer direction indicator
12V input
30
CAB59 PTO automation switch
Ground / open circuit input
31
CAB20 Trailed implement status switch (if fitted)
12V input
32
AC10
Headland switch
33
Wired but not used
34
Not used
35
Not used
36
24
37
Not used
38
Not used
39
CAN Low
Air filter clogging switch
40 41
CAB19 Left-hand FNR lever potentiometer Not used
44
AC11
45
Not used
47 48 49
CAB79 CAB80
50
Not used
51
Not used
52
Ground / open circuit input
0-5V input Ground output
43
46
12V input
5 V output
42 Armrest lever potentiometer
0-5V input
SV1 encoder - Pin 3
12V input
SV1 encoder - Pin 2
12V input
SV2 encoder - Pin 3
12V input
SV2 encoder - Pin 2
12V input
CAB31 Speed parameter display selector switch
12V input
53
AC7
SV1 switch
12V input
54
AC8
SV2 switch
12V input
55
TR26
Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging switch
12V input
56
Not used Left-hand FNR lever neutral switch normally closed
Neutral NC 12V input
Left-hand FNR lever neutral switch normally open
Neutral NO 12V input
57 58 59 60
CAB19
CAB77 Lever / pedal mode switch
Ground / open circuit input
Wired but not used
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Signal
11C10.19
DCC2 - Description
Pin
Description
61
TR35
62
Auxiliary hydraulics oil gauge
Vistronic rotational frequency sensor (signal)
63
ENG21 Pneumatic trailer brake pressure indicator light (if fitted)
64
Not used
65
Not used
66
Vistronic rotational frequency sensor supply
67
TR25
68
Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor
Signal 0-5V input Frequency input 12V input
5 V output 0-12V input
+12V battery supply
Description of 7-pin connector Pin
Description
1
DCC2 5V supply
2
“ESC” key
3
"OK" key
4
Right scroll key
5
Left scroll key
6
Down scroll key
7
Up scroll key
11C10.20
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
DCC2 (DynaVT) – Programming and setting parameters
GUF211 - DCC2 (DynaVT) – Programming and setting parameters
CONTENTS A . Setting parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Programming. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF211.1
DCC2 (DynaVT) – Programming and setting parameters
GUF211.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) – Programming and setting parameters
A . Setting parameters Important: If the DCC2 is new, its parameters must be set before it can be programmed. Switch on the ignition key to carry out this operation. The engine must be stopped. Parameter setting is necessary: - when the former DCC2 unit has been replaced by a new one, - when improvements to one or more functions have been made through parameter setting, Click on the “Tools” icon and then on “DCC2 label”.
Wintest
AUTO4 label Programming AUTO4 List of AUTO4 - DCC2 error codes DCC2 label Table of DCC2 constants Programming DCC2 Programming DATA3 AUTO5 - linkage label Programming AUTO5 Table of AUTO5 constants
DCC2 : 4.01 AUTO 4 : 1.06
CLIM : 20.05 JOY : 3.6
EHRC : 1.9
DATA : D040911
MA-11-01104A
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF211.3
DCC2 (DynaVT) – Programming and setting parameters The following screen is displayed:
DCC2 Label Code parameters Code AA
Code B
Code C
Code D
Code E
Code F
Code G
Code H
Code I
Code J
Code K
C0
0
0
2
3
0
2
0
5
0
0
AA = BA - > 6460 6465 LS AA = BB - > 6470 6475 6480 LS AA = BC - > 6485 NORMAL DUTY TFLS PARKLOCK AA = BD - > 6485 6490 HEAVY DUTY TFLS PARKLOCK AA = BE - > 6490 6495 HEAVY DUTY E TFLS PARKLOCK AA = BF - > 6485 NORMAL DUTY LS PARKLOCK AA = C0 - > 6485 6490 HEAVY DUTY LS PARKLOCK AA = C1 - > 6490 6495 HEAVY DUTY E LS PARKLOCK OK
MA-11-01129A
The tractor label code can be modified either by: - moving the mouse cursor directly into the relevant box and entering the appropriate code (it is also possible to navigate between codes by pressing the “tabulation” key on the keyboard), - clicking on the arrow under the code concerned; you can then scroll down the scroll bar and double-click on the desired parameter. Confirm the code by clicking on “OK”.
GUF211.4
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) – Programming and setting parameters The DCC2 parameter code is displayed on a label stuck on the rear of the fuse box cover. This code has 7 digits and corresponds to the 6 parameters whose meaning is shown below.
M142028 2601 100121 1022215
M142028 = Tractor serial number 2601 = linkage parameter code 100121= Autotronic 4 parameter code 1022215 = DCC2 parameter code
M142028 2601 100121 1022215
MA-11-01126A
Parameter code
AA
D
E
G
H
I
Example of parameter setting
10
2
2
2
1
5
Code Code Code Code Code Code Code Code Code Code Code
AA B C D E F G H I J K
= = = = = = = = = = =
10 = = = 2 = 2 = = 2 = 1 = 5 = = =
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
7480 Inactive Inactive Avec electronic injection Ground speed limited to 40 kph Inactive Metric unit With radar MF 6400 / 7400 / 8400 Inactive Inactive
GUF211.5
DCC2 (DynaVT) – Programming and setting parameters
Models with Autotronic 4 7465 7475
Details
Status of 2 CAN loop switches (*)
Code AA
Rear axle: HA 110
ON
06
Rear axle: HA 130
ON
08
Rear axle: HA 110
ON
07
Rear axle: HA 130
ON
09
up to serial n° M183044
ON
03
from serial n° M183045
ON
10
7480 7485
-
ON
11
7490
-
ON
12
7495
-
ON
13
8450
-
ON
20
8460
-
ON
21
8470
-
ON
22
8480
-
ON
23
Identifying the rear axle, 2 possible methods: • Lift rams diameter Fig. 2 - HA 110: 2 rams with Ø 40 mm rod - HA 130: 1 ram with a Ø 40 mm rod and a second ram with a Ø 36 mm rod • Width of final drive unit spacer Fig. 1
MA-11-01122A
Fig. 2
HA110
HA130
37 mm MA-11-01320A
GUF211.6
¤ H
65 mm
Fig. 1
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) – Programming and setting parameters
CODE B Inactive
CODE C Inactive
CODE D Electronic injection (a) 0 = Without (mechanical injection) 1 = With + without Boost 2 = With Boost 18=With Boost and Vistronic MF7480 34=With Boost and Vistronic MF7485/90/95 66=With Boost and Vistronic MF8450/8460 82=With Boost and Vistronic MF8450/8480
CODE E Maximum speed (b)
CODE F Inactive
CODE G Unit type 0 = US 2 = Metric
1 = 30 kph 2 = 40 kph 3 = 33 kph 5 = 50 kph (c)
CODE H Radar 0 = Without 1 = With
CODE I Factory code
CODE J Inactive
5 = MF 6400 / 7400 / 8400
CODE K Inactive
(a)
Vistronic introduced: MF7480 from N285074 MF7485/90/95 from N295045 All MF8400 tractors are fitted with Vistronic
(b)
Limit set according to regulations in force in the country Not valid on MF8400 series tractors
(c)
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
(*) Positioning of the 2 CAN loop configuration switches at the back of DCC2: ON: Looping is carried out in the DCC2
GUF211.7
DCC2 (DynaVT) – Programming and setting parameters - Another screen allows you to display the constants entered during parameter setting and stored after calibration. - Click on the “Tools” icon and on “Table of DCC2 constants”.
Wintest
AUTO4 label Programming AUTO4 List of AUTO4 - DCC2 error codes DCC2 label Table of DCC2 constants Programming DCC2 Programming DATA3 AUTO5 - linkage label Programming AUTO5 Table of AUTO5 constants
DCC2 : 4.01 AUTO 4 : 1.06
CLIM : 20.05 JOY : 3.6
EHRC : 1.9
DATA : D040911
MA-11-01104A
GUF211.8
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) – Programming and setting parameters The following screen is displayed:
DCC parameters Front PTO = not installed tempo1 ratio = 600 tempo2 ratio = 900 Max. speed = 42 Trans. response = no choice tempo3 ratio = 1600 tempo4 ratio = 3200 Reverse shuttle type = no choice Electronic injection (EEM) = with + Boost
Minimum Maximum
The left-hand column defines the parameter. The right-hand column gives the constant of the parameter or the value stored during calibration.
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF211.9
DCC2 (DynaVT) – Programming and setting parameters
B . Programming Important: If the DCC2 is new, its parameters must be set before it can be programmed. - Switch on the ignition key to carry out this operation. The engine must be stopped. - Programming of the DCC2 is necessary: - when the former DCC2 unit has been replaced by a new one, - when a new program becomes available to improve the product, - Click on the “Tools” icon and then on “Programming DCC2” icon.
Wintest
AUTO4 label Programming AUTO4 List of AUTO4 - DCC2 error codes DCC2 label Table ofDCC2 constants Programming DCC2 Programming DATA3 AUTO5 - linkage label Programming AUTO5 Table of AUTO5 constants
DCC2 : 4.01 AUTO 4 : 1.06
CLIM : 20.05 JOY : 3.6
EHRC : 1.9
DATA : D040911
MA-11-01104A
GUF211.10
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) – Programming and setting parameters The following screen is displayed:
Programming DCC2
Existing version: 03.02 New version: 03.03 Do you want to reprogram?
- Click: “OK” to carry out programming to cancel programming - A gauge indicates the progression of the programming.
Programming in progress...
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF211.11
DCC2 (DynaVT) – Programming and setting parameters During programming, several error messages may be displayed.
Error Engine speed > 500 rpm, Stop the engine
Message: - Impossible to open hex file!! - Impossible to enter in Programming mode!! - Erase error!! - Downloading problem!! - Impossible to exit Programming mode!! - Impossible to determine the DCC2 type!! Correction method: - Depending on the type of message, try to follow the requested indications. - Cut the ignition and turn it back on. - Check the CAN BOX interface connections with the 16-pin diagnostics connector. - The DCC2 is faulty. - If necessary, reinstall the Wintest software on your PC. NOTA: If the DCC2 programming procedure stops unexpectedly, disconnect then connect the calculator battery power supply (either using the battery circuit breaker, or by disconnecting the F51 fuse). This enables you to resume programming.
GUF211.12
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Error codes
GUF213 - DCC2 (DynaVT) - Error codes
CONTENTS A . Reading error codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . List of error codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 C . Analysing error codes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF213.1
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Error codes
GUF213.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Error codes
A . Reading error codes The DCC2 and Autotronic 4 have a self-diagnostic mode; they continuously monitor their functions and generate an error code if a fault occurs: - the reading of error codes can be carried out in 2 ways: - by direct reading of the error code on the DCC2, - by direct reading of the error code using Wintest. DCC2 and Autotronic 4 error codes can be stored: - the DCC2 can store up to 16 error codes - the Autotronic 4 can store up to 20 codes. Depending on the severity of the error code, the tractor can switch to Neutral Calculator (C.N.), which restricts the tractor to limp home mode until the fault is repaired.
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF213.3
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Error codes Reading codes on the DCC2 The user is informed when there is a possible fault by an error code displayed on the DOT MATRIX screen of the DCC2.
ERROR
If several faults occur simultaneously, the corresponding error codes are displayed one after the other for approximately 4 seconds each.
CODE D121
To delete the error code, press the Escape (ESC) key on the DOT MATRIX control keyboard; this cancels the display (unless there is a major fault) but does not delete it from the DCC2 or Autotronic 4 memory.
MA-11-01160A
Fig. 1
Reading error codes with Wintest Wintest allows all error codes stored by the DCC2 and Autotronic 4 to be displayed and cleared. Click on the “Tools” icon and on "List of AUTO4 - DCC2 error codes".
Wintest
AUTO4 label Programming AUTO4 List of AUTO4 - DCC2 error codes DCC2 label Table of DCC2 constants Programming DCC2
DCC2 : 4.01 AUTO 4 : 1.06
CLIM : 20.05 JOY : 3.6
EHRC : 1.9
DATA : D040911
MA-11-01104A
GUF213.4
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Error codes The following screen is displayed: List of AUTO4 - DCC2 error codes
AUTO4 Error: 41.07 x 00126 DCC2 Error: 154 x 00002
CLEAR
MA-11-01134A
- It allows all stored error codes and their number of occurrences to be displayed. For example: DCC2 error 154 has appeared 2 times. - By clicking on “CLEAR”, all error codes are deleted (DCC2 and AUTOTRONIC 4). NOTE: when reading error codes in Wintest, they appear at the same time on the DOT MATRIX even if they are no longer active.
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF213.5
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Error codes
B . List of error codes Num.
Components concerned
Description
D121
Alternator
Alternator regulator voltage too high (filtered battery signal)
D122
Alternator
Alternator regulator voltage too low (filtered battery signal)
D127
Fuel gauge
Electrical signal too high
D128
Fuel gauge
Electrical signal too low
D129
Alternator
Alternator regulator voltage too high (non filtered battery signal)
D130
Alternator
Alternator regulator voltage too low (non filtered battery signal)
D131
CAB78 Engine underspeed supervisor potentiometer
Electrical signal too high
D132
CAB78 Engine underspeed supervisor potentiometer
Electrical signal too low
D133
CAB44 Throttle pedal potentiometer
Electrical signal too high
D134
CAB44 Throttle pedal potentiometer
Electrical signal too low
D135
CAB19
Left-hand lever potentiometer - PowerShuttle Electrical signal too high - C.N. control
D136
CAB19
Left-hand lever potentiometer - PowerShuttle Electrical signal too low - C.N. control
D137
AC11 Armrest lever potentiometer
Electrical signal too high
D138
AC11 Armrest lever potentiometer
Electrical signal too low
D139
CAB12 Clutch pedal progressivity sensor
Electrical signal too high
D140
CAB12 Clutch pedal progressivity sensor
Electrical signal too low
D141
TR23
Engine speed signal not at maximum speed
Engine speed sensor
Note: displayed alternately with Autotronic 4 error code 4144 D142
15
D143
BOC1 Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch
Short circuit to + 12V AC - C.N.
D148
CAB1 DCC2 instrument panel
Attempt to reprogram with engine running
D149
CAN network (CAN Bus)
CAN network deactivated (CAN Bus off)
D150
CAN network (CAN Bus)
CAN message lost
D151
Tractor ground speed monitoring
Tractor speed too high
D152
CAB1 DCC2 instrument panel
Engine service hourmeter error
D153
CAB1 DCC2 instrument panel
Parameter table error
D154
CAN network (CAN Bus)
CAN communications from Autotronic 4 to DCC2 - C.N. Special failed
D155
CAB1 DCC2 instrument panel
Incorrect tractor code selected
GUF213.6
¤ H
Top-of-Clutch (TOC) pedal switch
Short circuit to + 12V AC
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Error codes
Num.
Components concerned
Description
D156
15
Top-of-Clutch (TOC) pedal switch
TOC stuck open
D157
TR23
Engine speed sensor
No electrical signal
NOTE:
displayed alternately with Autotronic 4 error code 4144
D158
AC11 Armrest lever potentiometer
D159
CAB19
Left-hand lever neutral switch - PowerShuttle control
Error at neutral switch in Neutral - C.N. position
D160
CAB19
Left-hand lever neutral switch - PowerShuttle control
Error at Neutral switch outside Neutral C.N. position
D197
TR25
Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor
Electrical signal too high
D198
TR25
Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor
Electrical signal too low
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
Armrest lever calibration error
GUF213.7
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Error codes
C . Analysing error codes D121 error code Alternator regulator voltage too high (filtered battery signal) - Possible causes: The filtered battery supply voltage at terminal 68 of the DCC2 is above 15.5 V. The alternator is over charging. - Tests: Check the voltage at terminal 68 and the power output of the alternator.
D130 error code Battery voltage too low (non filtered battery signal) - Possible cause: The filtered battery supply voltage at terminal 68 of the DCC2 is below 11V. - Tests: Measure the voltage at terminal 68 of the DCC2. If it is low, check whether the alternator output is low or whether there is an open circuit or short circuit in the wiring harness. D131 error code
Alternator regulator voltage too low (filtered battery signal) - Possible cause: The filtered battery supply voltage at terminal 68 of the DCC2 is below 11V. - Tests: Measure the voltage at terminal 68 of the DCC2. If it is low, check whether the alternator output is low or whether there is an open circuit or short circuit in the wiring harness.
Electrical signal from engine underspeed supervisor potentiometer too high - Possible causes: The potentiometer signal line between terminal 2 of the potentiometer and terminal 7 of the DCC2 is at >5 V or the reference ground line between terminal 8 of the DCC2 and terminal 3 of the potentiometer is in open circuit. - Tests: Test the signal line between terminal 2 of the potentiometer and terminal 7 of the DCC2 to detect any short circuit to 12 V. Test the ground line between terminal 8 of the DCC2 and terminal 3 of the potentiometer to detect any short circuit.
D127 error code
D132 error code
Fuel gauge electrical signal too high - Possible causes: The circuit between terminal 12 of the DCC2 and the fuel gauge is open or the return circuit to ground is open. - Tests: Check the circuit between terminal 12 of the DCC2 and the fuel gauge to detect any open circuit and check the wiring between the fuel gauge and the ground to detect any open circuit. Check if the gauge is faulty.
Electrical signal from engine underspeed supervisor potentiometer too low - Possible causes: The reference voltage line between terminal 6 of the DCC2 and terminal 1 of the potentiometer is in open circuit, and the potentiometer signal line between terminal 2 of the potentiometer and terminal 7 of the DCC2 is in open circuit or short circuit to ground. - Tests: Test the line between terminal 6 of the DCC2 and terminal 1 of the potentiometer to detect any short circuit. Test the line between terminal 2 of the potentiometer and terminal 7 of the DCC2 to detect any open circuit or short circuit to ground.
D122 error code
D128 error code Fuel gauge electrical signal too low - Possible cause: The circuit from terminal 12 of the DCC2 is short circuit to ground. - Tests: Check the wire from terminal 12 of the DCC2 to detect any short circuit to ground. Check if the gauge is faulty. D129 error code Battery voltage too high (non filtered battery signal) - Possible causes: The filtered battery supply voltage at terminal 68 of the DCC2 is above 15.5 V. The alternator is over charging. - Tests: Check the voltage at terminal 68 and the power output of the alternator.
GUF213.8
¤ H
D133 error code Electrical signal from throttle pedal potentiometer too high - Possible causes: The potentiometer signal line between terminal 3 of the potentiometer and terminal 10 of the DCC2 is at >5 V or the reference ground line between terminal 11 of the DCC2 and terminal 1 of the potentiometer is in open circuit. - Tests: Test the signal line between terminal 3 of the potentiometer and terminal 10 of the DCC2 to detect any short circuit to 12 V. Test the ground line between terminal 11 of the DCC2 and terminal 1 of the potentiometer to detect any short circuit.
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Error codes D134 error code
D137 error code
Electrical signal from throttle pedal potentiometer too low - Possible causes: The 12 V supply line at terminal 2 of the potentiometer is in open circuit, the potentiometer signal line between terminal 3 of the potentiometer and terminal 10 of the DCC2 is in open circuit or short circuit at ground. - Tests: Test the supply line at terminal 2 of the potentiometer to detect any open circuit. Test the line between terminal 3 of the potentiometer and terminal 10 of the DCC2 to detect any open circuit or short circuit to ground.
Electrical signal from armrest lever potentiometer too high - Possible causes: The potentiometer signal line between terminal 3 of the potentiometer and terminal 44 of the DCC2 is at >5 V or the ground line at terminal 1 of the potentiometer is in open circuit. - Tests: Test the signal line between terminal 3 of the potentiometer and terminal 44 of the DCC2 to detect any short circuit to 12 V. Test the ground line at terminal 1 of the potentiometer to detect any short circuit. D138 error code
D135 error code - C.N. Electrical signal from left-hand lever potentiometer PowerShuttle control too high - Possible causes: The potentiometer signal line between terminal 2 of the potentiometer and terminal 41 of the DCC2 is at >5 V or the reference ground line between terminal 42 of the DCC2, and terminal 3 of the potentiometer is in open circuit or one of the internal “reed” switches is faulty. - Tests: Test the signal line between terminal 2 of the potentiometer and terminal 41 of the DCC2 to detect any short circuit to 12 V. Test the ground line between terminal 42 of the DCC2 and terminal 3 of the potentiometer to detect any short circuit. Check the voltage of the signal line in all lever positions, and change the lever if there is a problem. D136 error code - C.N. Electrical signal from left-hand lever potentiometer PowerShuttle control too low - Possible causes : The reference voltage line between terminal 40 of the DCC2 and terminal 1 of the potentiometer is in open circuit, and the potentiometer signal line between terminal 2 of the potentiometer, and terminal 41 of the DCC2 is in open circuit or short circuit to ground, or one of the internal "reed" switches is faulty. - Tests: Test the line between terminal 40 of the DCC2 and terminal 1 of the potentiometer to detect any short circuit. Test the line between terminal 2 of the potentiometer and terminal 41 of the DCC2 to detect any open circuit or short circuit to ground. Check the voltage of the signal line in all lever positions, and change the lever if there is a problem.
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
Electrical signal from armrest lever potentiometer too low - Possible causes: The 12 V supply line at terminal 2 of the potentiometer is in open circuit, the potentiometer signal line between terminal 3 of the potentiometer and terminal 44 of the DCC2 is in open circuit or short circuit at ground. - Tests: Test the supply line at terminal 2 of the potentiometer to detect any open circuit. Test the line between terminal 3 of the potentiometer and terminal 44 of the DCC2 to detect any open circuit or short circuit to ground. D139 error code Electrical signal from clutch pedal progressivity sensor too high - Possible causes: The potentiometer signal line between terminal 3 of the potentiometer and terminal 4 of the DCC2 is at >5 V or the ground line at terminal 1 of the potentiometer is in open circuit. - Tests: Test the signal line between terminal 3 of the potentiometer and terminal 4 of the DCC2 to detect any short circuit to 12 V. Test the ground line at terminal 1 of the potentiometer to detect any short circuit.
GUF213.9
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Error codes D140 error code
D148 error code
Electrical signal from clutch pedal progressivity sensor too low - Possible causes: The 12 V supply line at terminal 2 of the potentiometer is in open circuit, the potentiometer signal line between terminal 3 of the potentiometer and terminal 4 of the DCC2 is in open circuit or short circuit at ground. - Tests: Test the supply line at terminal 2 of the potentiometer to detect any open circuit. Test the line between terminal 3 of the potentiometer and terminal 4 of the DCC2 to detect any open circuit or short circuit to ground.
Attempt to reprogram with engine running - Possible cause: An attempt has been made to load a new software programme in the DCC2 while the engine was running. - Tests: To carry out reprogramming, the ignition key switch must be on but the engine must be stopped. NOTE: This is an additional safety as Wintest system normally does not allow reprogramming with engine running.
D141 error code Engine speed signal not at maximum speed - Possible cause: The DCC2 detects that the Autotronic 4 is transmitting via CAN an unrealistic engine speed value. - Tests: Check if the engine speed sensor is disconnected. NOTE 1: when this error occurs, the DCC2 positions the tachometer pointer at the maximum speed of 2500 rpm. NOTA 2: The D141 error code is displayed alternately with Autotronic 4 error code 4144. D142 error code Top-of-Clutch pedal switch (TOC) short circuit to + 12 V AC - Possible causes: Input line at terminal 13 of the DCC2 is short circuit to 12 V or TOC switch is defective or wrongly adjusted. - Tests: Check the input line at terminal 13 to detect any short circuit to 12 V. Check whether the TOC switch is incorrectly adjusted or defective.
D149 error code CAN network deactivated - Possible causes: Error at the two CAN network wires which link the systems or error in the hardware program of the DCC2 or the Autotronic 4. - Tests: Check the continuity of the two CAN wires; CAN High connecting terminal 16 of the DCC2 to terminal 27 of the Autotronic 4, and CAN Low connecting terminal 39 of the DCC2 to terminal 26 of the Autotronic 4. If the CAN network functions correctly, replace the DCC2 and/or Autotronic 4. D150 error code CAN message lost - Possible causes: Error at the two CAN network wires which link the systems or error in the hardware program of the DCC2 or the Autotronic 4. - Tests: Check the continuity of the two CAN wires; CAN High connecting terminal 16 of the DCC2 to terminal 27 of the Autotronic 4, and CAN Low connecting terminal 39 of the DCC2 to terminal 26 of the Autotronic 4. If the CAN network functions correctly, replace the DCC2 and/or Autotronic 4. D151 error code
D143 error code - C.N. Bottom-of-Clutch pedal switch (BOC) short circuit to +12 V AC - Possible causes: Input line at terminal 19 of the DCC2 is short circuit to 12 V or BOC switch is defective or wrongly adjusted. - Tests: Check the input line to terminal 19 of the DCC2 to detect any short circuit to 12 V. Check whether the BOC switch is incorrectly adjusted or defective.
GUF213.10
¤ H
Tractor speed too high - Possible cause: The DCC2 detects that the Autotronic 4 is transmitting via CAN a ground speed value higher than 55 kph after operating the tractor in free-wheel mode. - Tests: Do not operate the tractor in free-wheel mode, because this can damage the transmission.
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Error codes D152 error code
D156 error code
Engine service hourmeter error - Possible causes: The engine service hours are stored in 3 different places. If one of the values differs from the other two, these two values will be copied to replace the wrong value. If ever all 3 locations have different values then there is no majority and the true engine hours are lost. To clear this error, turn the key to OFF position, then to ON again.
Top-of-clutch pedal switch (TOC) stuck open - Possible causes: Open circuit on the 12 V line at the switch, or incorrect mechanical adjustment of the switch/pedal, or faulty switch, or clutch pedal pressed down for too long without touching BOC. - Tests: Check for 12V at red wire to TOC switch. If there is no voltage, check for open circuit in the supply line to TOC switch. Check mechanical adjustment. Check the switch. Press down fully to touch the BOC.
D153 error code Parameter table error - Possible causes: An error occurred in saving a parameter to the DCC2. The system will clear the error after one or two ignition cycles, but the parameter may not have been saved and the default parameters will be used. - Tests: Check the "DCct" parameters (see Level 2 Calibration). D154 error code - C.N. Special CAN communications from Autotronic 4 to DCC2 C.N. Special failed - Possible causes: Open circuit or short circuit in the two CAN network wires connecting the DCC2 and Autotronic 4. The Autotronic 4 no longer receives permanent 12 V supply. - Tests: Check the connection of the two CAN wires; CAN high connecting terminal 16 of the DCC2 to terminal 27 of the Autotronic 4, and CAN low connecting terminal 39 of the DCC2 to terminal 26 of the Autotronic 4. Check the supply line at terminal 28 of the Autotronic 4. NOTE: Computer Neutral Special: If the D154 error code is displayed on the DCC2 but the transmission does not transfer directly to neutral, the tractor can continue to run as long as the clutch pedal is not fully pressed down (BOC switch activated) or the PowerShuttle lever is not in neutral position (neutral switch activated).
D157 error code No electrical signal from engine speed sensor - Possible causes: The electronic injection control unit (ECM or ECU) transmits an engine oil pressure signal via the CAN to the DCC2, which does not detect the engine speed signal transmitted by the Autotronic 4. The absence of this signal is caused by a fault in the sensor or in the Autotronic 4 sensor signal circuit. - Tests: Check the sensor resistance and the continuity of the circuit between terminal 2 of the sensor and terminal 12 of the Autotronic 4. NOTE: The D157 error code is displayed alternately with Autotronic 4 error code 4144. D158 error code Armrest lever potentiometer calibration error - Possible causes: The lever has been calibrated incorrectly. The initial calibration values have changed following a problem on the potentiometer. - Tests: Re-calibrate the lever (see Level 2 Calibration). If the fault remains, check the potentiometer and its harness.
D155 error code Incorrect tractor code selected - Tests: Enter the correct parameter AA code
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF213.11
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Error codes D159 error code - C.N.
D198 error code
Error at the neutral switch of the PowerShuttle lever in Neutral position - Possible causes: Neutral switch error in PowerShuttle lever. The error comes from the two contacts of the Neutral switch which are both open or closed when in fact one should be open and the other closed when the lever is in the Neutral position. - Tests with Wintest: Compare the status of the shuttle lever switches in Wintest when changing the lever position. If Wintest does not correspond with the lever positions, check that the switches are not stuck, and check the Neutral switch harness from terminals 4 and 6 of the lever connector to terminals 57 and 58 of the DCC2 for an open circuit or short circuit. Replace the switch.
Electrical signal from auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor too low - Possible cause: The circuit from terminal 67 of the DCC2 is short circuit to ground. - Tests: Check the wire from terminal 67 of the DCC2 to detect any short circuit to ground. Check if the sensor is faulty.
D160 error code - C.N. Error at the Neutral switch of the PowerShuttle lever outside Neutral position - Possible causes: Neutral switch error in left-hand lever. The error comes from the two contacts of the Neutral switch which are both open or closed when in fact one should be open and the other closed when the lever is in the Forward or Reverse position. - Tests with Wintest: Compare the status of the shuttle lever switches in Wintest when changing the lever position. If Wintest does not correspond with the lever positions, check that the switches are not stuck, and check the Neutral switch harness from terminals 4 and 6 of the lever connector to terminals 57 and 58 of the DCC2 for an open circuit or short circuit. Replace the switch. D197 error code Electrical signal from auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor too high - Possible causes: The circuit between terminal 67 of the DCC2 and the sensor is open or the return circuit to ground is open. - Tests: Check the circuit between terminal 67 of the DCC2 and the terminal 1 of the sensor to detect any open circuit and check the wiring between terminal 2 of the sensor and the ground to detect any open circuit. Check if the sensor is faulty.
GUF213.12
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments
GUF214 - DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments
CONTENTS A . Calibrating the ground speed (level 0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Calibrating the throttle pedal potentiometer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 C . Input at level 2 - CAL 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 D . Input at level 3 - CAL 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 E . Diagnostic mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 F . Adjusting the manoeuvring pedal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF214.1
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments
GUF214.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments
A . Calibrating the ground speed (level 0) This calibration allows improved precision of ground speed depending on: - different tyre sizes available, - radar (if fitted). 1. Mark out a 100 meter (400 ft) course according to the unit selected, on a firm surface. 2. Press and hold down the display selector switch for 15 seconds. Remark: the daily hourmeter resets after 5 seconds. 3. "CAL" will appear on the display Fig. 1. 4. Drive the tractor forwards at normal work speed. 5. Press the display selector switch when crossing the start point of the 100 metre (400 ft) course. 6. "run" will appear on the display Fig. 2. 7. Press the display selector switch when crossing the end point of the course. 8. Press the display selector switch; the constant ground speed (design) measured during calibration is displayed. 9. Press the display selector switch again; the actual constant ground speed (radar) measured during calibration is displayed on tractors fitted with radar. 10. Press the display selector switch a final time to return the instrument panel to normal operating mode. NOTE: The tractor must always be moving before starting the measured course; otherwise calibration is incorrect.
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
KPH
MA-11-01340A
Fig. 1
KPH
MA-11-01341A
Fig. 2
GUF214.3
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments
B . Calibrating the throttle pedal potentiometer The calibration of the throttle pedal potentiometer must be carried out each time that one of the following elements is replaced or modified: - Throttle potentiometer - DCC2
A
1
Preliminary operations 1. Start the engine. Apply the handbrake. 2. Set the PowerShuttle lever to neutral 3. The power take-off must be disengaged.
RPM MA-11-01131A
Fig. 3
Calibration The calibration is carried out in two successive steps so as to determine the minimum and maximum engine speeds in relation to the pedal. 4. Pedal fully released, minimum engine speed. 5. Press and hold down the differential lock switch for 5 seconds. 6. The symbol (1, Fig. 3) is displayed for approximately 2 seconds indicating the end of the first calibration phase. Release the differential lock switch. 7. Pedal fully depressed, maximum engine speed. 8. Press and hold down the differential lock switch for 5 seconds. 9. The symbol (1, Fig. 3) is displayed for approximately 2 seconds indicating the end of the second calibration phase. Release the differential lock switch.
GUF214.4
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments
C . Input at level 2 - CAL 2 To select CAL 2: 1. Switch on the ignition key (do not start the engine). 2. Engage and release the clutch pedal in order to delete the “TC” “DC” display from the screen on the right-hand side of the instrument panel. 3. Within the next five seconds, simultaneously press keys ⇑ and ⇒ on the DOT MATRIX control keyboard. The screen Fig. 1 appears, with 5 available functions displayed in icon or written form: -
Calibrating the armrest lever
2 DCct 0DC TC TCct MA-11-01161A
- “DCct”: Display DCC2 constants - “0DC”: Clear error codes stored in DCC2 - “0TC”: Clear error codes stored in (Autotronic 4) - “TCct”: Display TC constants (Autotronic 4)
Fig. 1 TC
The selected function is displayed in reverse video. 4. Select the required function using the buttons ⇐ and ⇒ of the DOT MATRIX control keyboard, then press “OK”.
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF214.5
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments Calibrating the armrest lever The calibration of the armrest lever must be carried out each time that one of the following elements is replaced or modified: - Armrest lever potentiometer - DCC2 Select the icon Fig. 1; press on “OK” and the screen Fig. 2 is displayed: 1. “0” is displayed. 2. Do not touch the lever: leave in neutral. Press “OK” within 5 seconds of the buzzer sounding. 3. “+” is displayed. 4. Move the lever forward until it stops (1st stop, and above all not end of travel) and hold in this position. Press “OK” within 5 seconds of the buzzer sounding. 5. “-” is displayed. 6. Move the lever backwards to 1st stop and hold in this position. Press “OK” within 5 seconds of the buzzer sounding. 7. The calibration is completed, the normal screen is displayed. 8. Switch off the ignition key for at least 5 seconds to validate calibration.
2 0 526 480 MA-11-01162A
Fig. 2
NOTE: If “ERROR” is displayed, repeat the procedure, making sure to respect the time of action and the lever position.
GUF214.6
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments Display DCC constants Select “DCct” Fig. 3 and the screen Fig. 4 appears. Select the following and preceding pages (Fig. 4, Fig. 5 and Fig. 6) with the keys ⇐ and ⇒. Press “ESC” to return to the previous mode.
Screen Code
Parameter
Tract code
Tractor Code AA
Tester code
Wintest user code
Interfac
Interface
Features
Specifications
Radar const
Radar constant
Eng spd pro
Maximum engine speed for maximum speed regulation
Units
Units: 0= US 2= Metric
Max eng rpm
Maximum engine speed
Min eng rpm
Minimum engine speed
Clutch max
Maximum clutch value
Clutch mini
Minimum clutch value
R lever CAL0
Stored value at neutral of right-hand lever
R lever CAL+
Stored value at + of right-hand lever
R lever CAL-
Stored value at - of right-hand lever
Acceler Max
Maximum accelerator stored value
Acceler Min
Minimum accelerator stored value
Front PTO
Front PTO control
Max speed
Maximum allowed speed
Elec engine
Electronic injection: equivalent to label code D
Trans regul
-
Joystickcvt
-
REMINDER: Values are usually calculated from a precise parameter, calibration or characteristic; for this reason they cannot be considered as default values or used to draw comparisons.
2 DCct 0DC TC TCct MA-11-01163A
Fig. 3
Tract Code Tester Code Interfac Features Radar Const Eng Spd Pro Units Max Eng RPM
3 927 4419 4371 0 240 2 235
MA-11-01164A
Fig. 4
Min Eng RPM Clutch Max Clutch Min RLever Cal0 RLever Cal+ RLever CalAcceler Max Acceler Min
80 680 334 556 794 280 894 90
MA-11-01165A
Fig. 5
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF214.7
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments
Front PTO Max Speed Elec Engine Trans Regul JoystickCVT
0 40 2 1 0 0 0 0
MA-11-01166A
Fig. 6
GUF214.8
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments
Clear error codes stored in DCC2 Select “DC” Fig. 7 and the screen Fig. 8 appears.
2 DCct 0DC TC TCct MA-11-01169A
Fig. 7
When the screen is displayed, click on " OK ": the error codes are cleared.
2 PRESS OK MA-11-01170A
Fig. 8
Clear error codes stored in TC (Autotronic 4) Select “TC” Fig. 9 and the screen Fig. 10 appears.
2 DCct 0DC TC TCct MA-11-01167A
Fig. 9
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF214.9
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments
When the screen is displayed, click on " OK ": the error codes are cleared.
2 PRESS OK MA-11-01170A
Fig. 10
Display TC constants (Autotronic 4) Select “TCct” Fig. 11. Function unavailable: it is not possible to read the Autotronic 4 constants.
2 DCct 0DC TC TCct MA-11-01171A
Fig. 11
GUF214.10
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments
D . Input at level 3 - CAL 3 In level 3, the parameters can be modified. To select CAL 3: 1. Switch on the ignition key (do not start the engine). 2. Engage and release the clutch pedal in order to delete the “TC” “DC” display from the screen on the right-hand side of the instrument panel. 3. Within the next five seconds, simultaneously press keys ⇐ and ⇒ on the DOT MATRIX control keyboard. The screen Fig. 1 is displayed: 4. Press “OK” to display Fig. 2 Select the following and preceding pages (Fig. 2, Fig. 3 et Fig. 4) with the keys ⇐ and ⇒.
3 DC
Const
MA-11-01172A
Fig. 1 NOTE: Some parameters cannot be modified
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF214.11
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments Modify the required parameters using the buttons ⇐, ⇑, ⇒, ⇓ and “OK” on the DOT MATRIX control keyboard. Screen Code
Parameter
Tract code
Tractor Code AA
Tester code
Wintest user code
Interfac
Interface
Features
Specifications
Radar const
Radar constant
Eng spd pro
Maximum engine speed for maximum speed regulation
Units
Tract Code Tester Code Interfac Features Radar Const Eng Spd Pro Units Max Eng RPM MA-11-01173A
Units: 0= US 2= Metric
Max eng rpm
Maximum engine speed
Min eng rpm
Minimum engine speed
Clutch max
Maximum clutch value
Clutch mini
Minimum clutch value
R lever CAL0
Stored value at neutral of right-hand lever
R lever CAL+
Stored value at + of right-hand lever
R lever CAL-
Stored value at - of right-hand lever
Acceler Max
Maximum accelerator stored value
Acceler Min
Minimum accelerator stored value
Front PTO
Front PTO control
Max speed
Maximum allowed speed
Elec engine
Electronic injection: equivalent to label code D
Trans regul
-
Joystickcvt
-
REMINDER: Values are usually calculated from a precise parameter, calibration or characteristic; for this reason they cannot be considered as default values or used to draw comparisons.
3 927 419 371 0 240 2 235 Fig. 2
Min Eng RPM Clutch Max Clutch Min RLever Cal0 RLever Cal+ RLever CalAcceler Max Acceler Min
80 680 334 556 794 280 894 90
MA-11-01174A
Fig. 3
Front PTO Max Speed Elec Engine Trans Regul JoystickCVT
0 42 2 1 0 0 0 0
MA-11-01175A
Fig. 4
GUF214.12
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments
E . Diagnostic mode The diagnostic mode is used to test and monitor the electronic functions of the tractor. The diagnostic menu may be entered at any time using the following procedure: Press the key ⇑ until the menu displaying the various diagnostics functions appears Fig. 1: - DATA: DCC2 system data - DC BIN: DCC2 digital input data (switches) - DC ANA: DCC2 analog input data - DC ERR: Stored DCC2 error codes - DC LED: DCC2 indicator lights check - DC GAUGE: DCC2 gauges check - TC BIN: TC digital input data (Autotronic 4) - TC ANA: TC analog input and frequency data (Autotronic 4) - TC EV: TC solenoid valves supply (Autotronic 4) - TC ERR: Error codes stored in TC (Autotronic 4) - EC BIN: DCC2 digital input data for electronic injection - EC ANA: DCC2 analog input data for electronic injection The selected function is displayed in reverse video. Select the required function using the buttons ⇐, ⇑, ⇒ and ⇓ of the DOT MATRIX control keyboard, then press “OK”.
DIAGNOSTIC DATA DC BIN DC ANA DC ERR DC LED DC GAUGE TC BIN TC ANA TC EV TC ERR EC BIN EC ANA MA-11-01176A
Fig. 1
Engine Temp Trans Temp Clutch Pos Engine OilP Fuel Level Radar Speed Tempo Nerv Max Speed
74 42 100 458 8 0 1 33
MA-11-01177A
Fig. 2
DATA: DCC2 system data Screen Code
Diagnostic function
Engine temp
Engine temperature
Trans temp
Transmission temperature
Clutch pos
Clutch pedal travel
Engine oilP
Engine oil pressure
Fuel level
Remaining fuel value
Radar speed
Radar speed
Tempo new
-
Max speed
Maximum allowed speed
Battery Fil Alarm Pulse Alarm Bits Engine Sup Theo EngSpd Engine Load Right Lever Left lever
103 0 0 10 800 100 2 4
MA-11-01178A
Fig. 3
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF214.13
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments
Screen Code
Diagnostic function
Battery fil
Filtered battery voltage
Alarm pulse
-
Alarm bits
-
Engine sup
Underspeed supervisor
Theo eng spd
Engine design speed
Engine load
Engine load
Right-hand lever
Armrest lever
Left-hand lever
Steering wheel lever
Accelerator
Throttle pedal value
Set Ratio
Required transmission ratio
Act ratio
Current transmission ratio
Shu dec inc
100= Reverse shuttle 10= deceleration 1= acceleration
Speed incr
Acceleration value
Status lever
-
SV 1/2
0= no preselected speed 1= SV1 2= SV2
Hyd temp
Hydraulics temperature
Radar freq
Radar frequency between 0 and 273
Radar speed
Radar speed
Radar filt
Filtered radar speed
Trans speed
Design speed
Trans sprec
Recalculated design speed
ComputerNeu
-
Engine temp
Engine temperature
Accelerator Set Ratio Act Ratio Shu Dec Inc Speed Incr Status Levr SV l/2 Hyd Temp
0 0 0 1000 192 1 0 189
MA-11-01179A
Air In Temp Speed Dem Visco Speed Visco State Duty Cycle Pid Out REMINDER: Values are usually calculated from a precise parameter, calibration or characteristic; for this reason they cannot be considered as default values or used to draw comparisons.
Fig. 4
Radar Freq Radar Speed Radar Filt Trans Speed Trans SpRec ComputerNeu
0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0
MA-11-01180A
Fig. 5
Engine Temp Air In Temp Speed Dem Visco Speed Visco State Duty Cycle Pid Out
74 17 399 0 0 98 0 0
MA-11-01319A
Fig. 6
GUF214.14
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments DC BIN: DCC2 digital input data (switches) Screen Code
Diagnostic function
SV1E1 / E2 SV1 encoder SV2E1 / E2 SV2 encoder BocNc
Bottom-of-Clutch pedal switch (BOC) normally closed (NC)
BocNo
Bottom-of-Clutch pedal switch (BOC) normally open (NO)
Dig6
-
Park
Parking brake and ParkLock
P ESC
ESC (Escape) key
P OK
OK key
P↓
Move down arrow key
P↑
Move up arrow key
P→
Move right arrow key
P←
Move left arrow key
HBeam
Road lights
Light
Dipped lights
LINNc
Steering wheel lever Neutral switch normally closed (NC)
LINNo
Steering wheel lever Neutral switch normally open (NO)
FrSOn
Suspended front axle ON
FrSOf
Suspended front axle OFF
Toc
Top-of-Clutch switch (TOC)
TMain
-
SV1
SV1 switch
SV2
SV2 switch
Hyd F
Hydraulic filter
Hyd P
Hydraulic pressure
Air F
Air filter
Brk P
Brake pressure
PtoAu
Automatic PTO
Set In Implm
High position for trailed implement if switch input
Headl
-
DIAGNOSTIC DATA DC BIN DC ANA DC ERR DC LED DC GAUGE TC BIN TC ANA TC EV TC ERR EC BIN EC ANA MA-11-01181A
Fig. 7
Sv1E1 Sv2E1 BocNc Dig6 P Esc P P HBeam
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Sv1E2 Sv2E2 BocNo Park P Ok P P Light
0 0 1 1 0 0 0 1
MA-11-01182A
Fig. 8
LINNc FrSOn Toc Sv1 Hyd F Air F PtoAu Implm
0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0
LINNo FrSOf TMain Sv2 Hyd P Brk P Set In Headl
1 1 0 0 0 0 1 0
MA-11-01183A
Fig. 9
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF214.15
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments DC ANA: DCC2 analog input data Screen Code
Diagnostic function
Clutch Sens
Clutch
Right lever
Armrest lever
Engine supv
Underspeed supervisor
Accelerator
Accelerator
Left lever
Steering wheel lever
Battery Dir
Battery voltage
9.5 Volts
Supply to sensors provided by DCC2
battery fil
Filtered battery voltage
Analog1 Spa
-
Analog2 Spa
-
Fuel Sensor
Fuel level
Engine Temp
Engine temperature
Oil Pressur
Engine oil pressure
NTC Input
-
Hy Oil Temp
Hydraulic oil temperature
Air Temp
Air temperature
REMINDER: Values are usually calculated from a precise parameter, calibration or characteristic; for this reason they cannot be considered as default values or used to draw comparisons.
DIAGNOSTIC DATA DC BIN DC ANA DC ERR DC LED DC GAUGE TC BIN TC ANA TC EV TC ERR EC BIN EC ANA MA-11-01186A
Fig. 10
Clutch Sens Right Lever Engine Supv Accelerator Left Lever Battery Dir 9.5 Volts Battery Fil
699 539 163 80 38 369 995 347
MA-11-01187A
Fig. 11
Analog1 Spa Analog2 Spa Fuel Sensor Engine Temp Oil Pressur NTC Input Hy Oil Temp Air Temp
930 943 283 939 899 874 773 29
MA-11-01188A
Fig. 12
GUF214.16
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments DC ERR: Stored DCC2 error codes The error codes are displayed with their occurrences Fig. 14.
DIAGNOSTIC DATA DC BIN DC ANA DC ERR DC LED DC GAUGE TC BIN TC ANA TC EV TC ERR EC BIN EC ANA MA-11-01184A
Fig. 13
E 156 13 E 155 1 E 136 5 E 0 0 E 0 0 E 0 0 E 0 0 E 0 0
E E E E E E E E
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
MA-11-01185A
Fig. 14
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF214.17
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments DC LED: DCC2 indicator lights check In ON position, all LEDs are lit (excluding headlight and direction indicator lights) Fig. 17
DIAGNOSTIC DATA DC BIN DC ANA DC ERR DC LED DC GAUGE TC BIN TC ANA TC EV TC ERR EC BIN EC ANA MA-11-01189A
Fig. 15
LED / On/Off MA-11-01190A
Fig. 16
2
1
10
15
5
0
20
RPM x 100
25
MA-11-01210A
Fig. 17
GUF214.18
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments DC GAUGE: DCC2 gauges check The three DCC2 gauges (tachometer, coolant temperature and fuel tank) can be forced to low, intermediate and high position.
DIAGNOSTIC DATA DC BIN DC ANA DC ERR DC LED DC GAUGE TC BIN TC ANA TC EV TC ERR EC BIN EC ANA MA-11-01191A
Fig. 18
Gauges / MA-11-01192A
Fig. 19
2
1
10
15
5
0
Gauges /
20
RPM x 100
25
A
540 750 1000
A
B
KPH MPH RPM
MA-11-01209A
Fig. 20
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF214.19
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments TC BIN: TC digital input data (Autotronic 4) Screen Code
Diagnostic function
HTemp
Auxiliary hydraulic oil temperature
RShaf
Summing shaft speed
VrRef
Transmission control unit
Crown
Bevel gear design speed
Pfa
4WD switch
Diff
Differential lock switch
RPtoC
Front PTO rotation
F Pto
-
RPtoF
PTO ON/OFF switch on fender
Range
Hare / Tortoise range selector switch
L Brk
Left-hand brake switch
R brk
Right-hand brake switch
Pto n
PTO neutral switch
Pto54
540 rpm PTO speed selector switch
Pto75
750 rpm PTO speed selector switch
Pto10
1000 rpm PTO speed selector switch
Ignit
+12V APC (Ignition key ON)
SusOn
Suspended front axle switch ON
Park
Parking brake switch
SusOf
Suspended front axle switch OFF
REMINDER: Values are usually calculated from a precise parameter, calibration or characteristic; for this reason they cannot be considered as default values or used to draw comparisons.
DIAGNOSTIC DATA DC BIN DC ANA DC ERR DC LED DC GAUGE TC BIN TC ANA TC EV TC ERR EC BIN EC ANA MA-11-01198A
Fig. 21
HTemp VrRef Pfa RPtoC RPtoF L Brk Pto N Pto75
0 0 2 2 2 2 2 2
RShaf Crown Diff F Pto Range R Brk Pto54 Pto10
0 0 2 3 2 2 2 2
MA-11-01199A
Fig. 22
Ignit SusOn
0 2
Park SusOf
0 2
MA-11-01200A
Fig. 23
GUF214.20
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments TC ANA: TC analog input and frequency data (Autotronic 4) Screen Code
Diagnostic function
Engine Spd1
Engine speed sensor
Engine Spd 1
Engine speed sensor
FrontPto Spd
Front PTO speed
RPtoShaf spd
PTO shaft speed
RPtoClu Spd
PTO clutch speed
HydShaf Spd
Summing shaft speed
Crown spd
Bevel gear design speed
HiPressure
High pressure (transmission circuit)
Range Pos
Range position
FrAxle Sens
-
Trans Temp
Transmission temperature
REMINDER: Values are usually calculated from a precise parameter, calibration or characteristic; for this reason they cannot be considered as default values or used to draw comparisons.
DIAGNOSTIC DATA DC BIN DC ANA DC ERR DC LED DC GAUGE TC BIN TC ANA TC EV TC ERR EC BIN EC ANA MA-11-01193A
Fig. 24
Engine Spd1 Engine Spd1 FrontPto Spd RPtoShaf Spd RPtoClu Spd HydShaf Spd Crown spd HiPressure
840 840 0 0 0 0 0 10
MA-11-01194A
Fig. 25
Range Pos FrAxle Sens Trans Temp
49 0 170 245
MA-11-01195A
Fig. 26
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF214.21
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments TC EV: TC solenoid valves supply (Autotronic 4) Screen Code
Diagnostic function
RPto
PTO solenoid valve
FPto
Front PTO solenoid valve
V540
540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve
V750
750 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve
V1000
1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve
Neutr
Coupler function solenoid valve
30kph
Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph
Prior
-
Rang1
Tortoise range solenoid valve
Rang2
Hare range solenoid valve
Diffl
Differential lock solenoid valve
Pfa
4 WD solenoid valve
AcOunt
Transmission control unit
REMINDER: Values are usually calculated from a precise parameter, calibration or characteristic; for this reason they cannot be considered as default values or used to draw comparisons.
DIAGNOSTIC DATA DC BIN DC ANA DC ERR DC LED DC GAUGE TC BIN TC ANA TC EV TC ERR EC BIN EC ANA MA-11-01196A
Fig. 27
RPto V540 V1000 30kph Rang1 Diffl AcOut
0 0 0 0 0 0 1
FPto V750 Neutr Prior Rang2 Pfa
0 0 0 0 0 0
MA-11-01197A
Fig. 28
GUF214.22
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments TC ERR: Error codes stored in TC (Autotronic 4)
DIAGNOSTIC DATA DC BIN DC ANA DC ERR DC LED DC GAUGE TC BIN TC ANA TC EV TC ERR EC BIN EC ANA MA-11-01201A
Fig. 29
E5153 E4108 E6101 E6143 E6110 E0000 E0000 E0000
E0000 E0000 E0000 E0000 E0000 E0000 E0000 E0000
MA-11-01202A
Fig. 30
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF214.23
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments EC BIN: DCC2 digital input data for electronic injection
DIAGNOSTIC DATA DC BIN DC ANA DC ERR DC LED DC GAUGE TC BIN TC ANA TC EV TC ERR EC BIN EC ANA MA-11-01205A
EC ANA: DCC2 analog input data for electronic injection
DIAGNOSTIC DATA DC BIN DC ANA DC ERR DC LED DC GAUGE TC BIN TC ANA TC EV TC ERR EC BIN EC ANA MA-11-01203A
Fig. 31
Switch A Switch B Switch + Switch Hours
0 0 0 0 128
MA-11-01206A
Fig. 33
Droop Curv Torque Curv Engine Temp Fuel Cons Air Inlet Oil Pressur Engine Load Torque Ref
5 1 120 20 79 78 73 590
MA-11-01204A
Fig. 32 Screen Code
Diagnostic function
Switch A
A memorised speed activation switch
Switch B
B memorised speed activation switch
+ Switch
+ switch for memorised speeds adjustment
- Switch
- switch for memorised speeds adjustment
Hours
Total engine hours stored by engine electronic calculator
GUF214.24
¤ H
Fig. 34 Screen Code
Diagnostic function
Droop Curv
Regulation slope: always 5%
Torque Curv
Torque curve
Engine Temp Engine temperature Fuel Cons
Fuel consumption
Air Inlet
Vacuum gauge
Oil Pressur
Engine oil pressure
Engine Load
Engine load
Torque Ref
Reference torque
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments
F . Adjusting the manoeuvring pedal Manoeuvring pedal assembly (Fig. 37) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7)
Bottom of clutch switch (BOC) Starter safety switch Pedal pressed adjustment screw Pedal released stop adjustment screw Top of pedal switch Progressivity potentiometer
- The manoeuvring pedal can be used when manoeuvring in very tight spaces or when hitching an implement. - It is not necessary to use this pedal to reverse direction. - The position of the manoeuvring pedal is transmitted to the DCC2 by the sensors.
Fig. 35
Adjusting BOC - Tighten to provide a clearance of 0.3 to 1mm between the switch body and the holder (Section C-C. - Tighten the lock nut to a torque of 6 - 9 Nm. Adjusting the potentiometer and switch - Fit the potentiometer into its housing. - Tighten the screws in order to reach the centre of the ports (Fig. 35). - Fit the plastic fork and tighten the screws with Loctite 241 or equivalent (Fig. 36). - Adjust the released pedal stop adjustment screw (5) to provide a clearance of 6mm (view B). - Fit and tighten the top of pedal switch (6) to a torque of 18 to 30 Nm. - With the pedal released (top), allow 0.5 to 0.7 mm clearance between the switch body and screw head (4) (view A).
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
Fig. 36
GUF214.25
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Calibrations, constants and adjustments
A
6
4
B
5
J = 0,5 / 0,7 mm 18 - 30 Nm
2
7
6
J = 6 mm
4
C
A
E
D 3 5
C
B E
D
Loctite 241
8 Nm
2
J = 0,3/1,00 mm
C-C 6 - 9 Nm
3
E-E
J = 0,5 mm
MA-11-01132A
GUF214.26
¤ H
Fig. 37
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams
GUF215 - DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Electrical diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF215.1
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams
GUF215.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
CAB83 OFF
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CAB83
R S2
MA-10-01000A
CAB37.6/CAB83.1 B CAB37.7/CAB83.3 B
6
7
5 3
4 2
11 10 9
1
FAI 03 FAI 48
8
CAB37
12
- Components with only one connector are identified by the connector name: CAB83 - Suspended front axle switch (Fig. 1). - Harnesses performing the same funtions have the same colour on the diagram (Fig. 1): • FAI03 - Dynashift console harness (green) • FAI48 - DynaVT console harness (green) - All wires can be identified by the pins of the outgoing and incoming connectors of the harness: CAB37.6/CAB83.1: The wire connects pin 6 of the CAB37 connector to pin 1 of the CAB83 connector - The detail of pins allocation for each connector is shown on the harness side - The wire colour is indicated: CAB37.6/CAB83.1 B, the wire is white List of colours: - N: Black - M: Brown - R: Red - B: White - J: Yellow - V: Green - The splices inside the harnesses are indicated by a dot and the letter S (S2).
S2.1/CAB83.2
The harnesses fitted on the tractor allow data to be exchanged and power to be supplied to the electrical and electronic systems. The tractor is fitted with 3 different types of power supply: • +12V Battery (Permanent) • +12V APC (Ignition key ON) • +12V ACC (Accessories) Most harnesses have a maximum of six different wire colours: - Black: Ground - Brown: +12V Permanent - Red: +12V APC (Ignition key ON) and Accessories - White: Information - Yellow: CAN High - Green: CAN Low The CAN network wires (yellow and green) are twisted together.
R
Description
In general, the components or connectors are named in order to indicate the corresponding elements of the tractor: AC## Armrest BAF## Fuse box CA## Automatic air conditioning CAB## Cab ENG## Engine FA## Suspended front axle L## Linkage - ParkLock (HA) LIG## Lighting R## Linkage and roof ROOF##Roof TR## Transmission V# Electrohydraulic spool valve X# Round battery cable terminal on fuse box
BAF12.2/S2.1
A . General
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
CAB37 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
Fig. 1
GUF215.3
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams Layout 5 Deutsch connectors (31-way) are connected to the cab: - 2 on the front panel Fig. 2) - 3 at the bottom rear right-hand side of the cab (Fig. 3).
ENG1
Fig. 2: All these connectors belong to the engine harness. ENG2 is dedicated to information concerning the electronic injection.
ENG2
Fig. 3: Always in the following order (regardless of tractor configuration and options), from left to right: L14 Linkage harness junction CAB50 Transmission harness junction LIG1 Lighting harness junction
MA-10-01003A
Fig. 2
L14
LIG1
+12V
MA-10-01002A
14
16
13
15
17
12 11
10 9
8 7
6 5
4 3
2 1
BAF10
F9- 15A +APC
1 X2 F48 - 7.5A
+12V
1 X4 18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
F48
MA-10-01001A
2
GUF215.4
¤ H
Fig. 3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
18
BAF12
The fuses and relays of the electrical or electronic board (Fig. 4) are indicated by a black mark on their locations on the fuse box (2).
CAB50
F9
Fig. 4
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams
B . Electrical diagrams Electrical power supply .............................................. 7 Radar and DOT MATRIX keyboard - tractor with EHRC linkage calculator........................................................ 9 DOT MATRIX keyboard - tractor with Autotronic 5 linkage calculator...................................................... 11 Radar - tractor with Autotronic 5 linkage calculator.. 13 Vistronic ................................................................... 15 Auxiliary hydraulics dipstick...................................... 17 CAN network - Perkins engine ................................. 19 CAN network - SisuDiesel engine with EHRC linkage calculator .................................................................. 21 CAN network - SisuDiesel engine with Autotronic 5 linkage calculator...................................................... 23
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF215.5
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 01 FAI 02 FAI 03 FAI 06 FAI 20 FAI 23 FAI 31 FAI 48 FAI 128 FAI 130
Engine harness Instrument panel harness Console harness Transmission harness Vistronic harness Cab linkage harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT console harness Linkage with Dual Control harness DynaVT transmission harness
Component parts list CAB1 CAB16 CAB31 ENG33 TR27 TR35
Instrument panel (DCC2) DOT MATRIX control keyboard Display change control knob Vistronic Radar Auxiliary hydraulics oil gauge
2
Fuse box
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
GUF215.6
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams
Electrical power supply
31
46 24 1
68 45 23
CAB1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
CAB1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
FAI 02
BAF9.3/CAB1.1
R
BAF7.8/CAB1.68
M
CAB28 CAB28.1/CAB1.23
17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
9
7
5
3
1
10
8
6
4
2
N
1
F51-15A 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF9
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF7
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF9
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF7 F4-10A
+12V AP. CONTACT
1
3
5
7
9
11
13
15
17
1
3
5
7
9
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
18
16
2
4
6
8
10
F4- 10A 1 X2 F51 - 15A +12V BATTERIE
1 X4 MA-11-01326A
2
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
2
GUF215.7
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 01 Engine harness FAI 02 Instrument panel harness FAI 03 Console harness FAI 06 Transmission harness FAI 20 Vistronic harness FAI 23 Cab linkage harness FAI 31 Cab DynaVT transmission harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 128Linkage with Dual Control harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness
Component parts list CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB16 DOT MATRIX control keyboard CAB31 Display change control knob ENG33 Vistronic TR27 Radar TR35 Auxiliary hydraulics oil gauge 2
Fuse box
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
GUF215.8
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams
Radar and DOT MATRIX keyboard - tractor with EHRC linkage calculator TR1 1
2
ENG1
CAB1
CAB1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1
9 10
0 1 2 3
12 13 14 15 16 17
CAB1.18/S20.1
B
FAI 01
5 6 7 8
S20
19 20 21 22 23 24
TR27 TR27
3 4 5 6
TR27.1/TR1.1 ENG10.6/TR27.2
8 9 10 11 12
12
B
FAI 06
2 3 4 5
B
31
39 40 41
ENG1.23/ENG10.6
B TR
S20.1/ENG1.23
FAI 02
7 8 9 0 31
CAB50
1
5 6
1
CAB50
43 44 45 46 47 48
FAI 04 FAI 31
50 51 2
10
CAB51.1/S2.1
20
RPM x 100
S2
R
CAB50.15/S2.1
R
53 54 55 56 57 58
15
5
0
1
0
26 27 28 29 30
1
N
25
60 61 62 63 64 65
1 2 3
5
67 68
CAB15
1 2
CAB31
FAI 03 FAI 48 CAB15.5/CAB16.3 CAB15.6/CAB16.5 CAB15.7/CAB16.4
CAB15.3/CAB16.7
B
1
2
S5.1/CAB31.1
S5
R
CAB1.52/CAB31.2
BAF12.1/CAB51.1
B
R
2
FAI 02 BAF12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
F4- 10A
12 11
9 8 7 6
10 9 8 7
4 3 2 1 BAF8.5/S
X2 F22 - 10A +APC
F22 F4
BAF8
CAB16 2
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
MA-11-01228A
GUF215.9
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 01 Engine harness FAI 02 Instrument panel harness FAI 03 Console harness FAI 06 Transmission harness FAI 20 Vistronic harness FAI 23 Cab linkage harness FAI 31 Cab DynaVT transmission harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 128Linkage with Dual Control harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness
Component parts list CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB16 DOT MATRIX control keyboard CAB31 Display change control knob ENG33 Vistronic TR27 Radar TR35 Auxiliary hydraulics oil gauge 2
Fuse box
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
GUF215.10
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams
DOT MATRIX keyboard - tractor with Autotronic 5 linkage calculator
CAB1
68
F22
CAB31
2 1 1
CAB31
2
R
24
1 23
45
46
CAB01
2
CAB1.52/CAB31.2
B
S5.1/CAB31.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
S5
9
7
5
3
1
10
8
6
4
2
BAF8.5/S5.1
FAI02
R
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F22 - 10A
X2 1
+APC
BAF8
MA-10-06045A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2
5 6 7
CAB15
1 2 3
4
CAB16
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
CAB15.1/CAB16.1 CAB15.4/CAB16.2 CAB15.5/CAB16.3 CAB15.7/CAB16.4 CAB15.6/CAB16.5 CAB15.2/CAB16.6 CAB15.3/CAB16.7
B B B B B B B
6
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
CAB16
GUF215.11
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 01 Engine harness FAI 02 Instrument panel harness FAI 03 Console harness FAI 06 Transmission harness FAI 20 Vistronic harness FAI 23 Cab linkage harness FAI 31 Cab DynaVT transmission harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 128Linkage with Dual Control harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness
Component parts list CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB16 DOT MATRIX control keyboard CAB31 Display change control knob ENG33 Vistronic TR27 Radar TR35 Auxiliary hydraulics oil gauge 2
Fuse box
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
GUF215.12
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams
Radar - tractor with Autotronic 5 linkage calculator
CAB01
S24 CAB1.18/S24.1
TR31
1 8 9 22
4
23 12
FAI06
16 15
13
27
14 25
28
6 5
24
29 17
1
26
ENG10
TR27.1/TR31.1
1 2 3 4
TR27
S1.1/TR27.3
N R
ENG10.5/S1.1 TR27.2/ENG10.6 S1
1 12
4
3
2
2
3
4
11 10 9
5 8
6 7
R B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
ENG1.23/ENG10.6
S7.1/ENG10.5
R
B
S7
FAI01 6
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
1
1
ENG10 ENG1.8/S7.1
R
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
9 10
2 7
29 17
11
6
28
15
12 13 24
14
27 26
23
4 5
16
22
3 1
25
S24.1/ENG1.23
B
FAI02
BAF7.7/ENG1.8
B
46 24 1
ENG1
CAB01
68 45 23
TR27
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
21
8 19
18
18 7
3 11
30
ENG1
30 19
2
20
31
31
20 21 10
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
CAB01
BAF7 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F16 - 30A
X2 1
2
+12V
9
7
5
3
1
10
8
6
4
2
BAF7
MA-10-06043A
F16-30A
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF215.13
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 01 Engine harness FAI 02 Instrument panel harness FAI 03 Console harness FAI 06 Transmission harness FAI 20 Vistronic harness FAI 23 Cab linkage harness FAI 31 Cab DynaVT transmission harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 128Linkage with Dual Control harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness
Component parts list CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB16 DOT MATRIX control keyboard CAB31 Display change control knob ENG33 Vistronic TR27 Radar TR35 Auxiliary hydraulics oil gauge 2
Fuse box
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
GUF215.14
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams
Vistronic
68
1
24
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
ENG1.5/CAB1.3
B
FAI02
27
14 26
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
ENG1
ENG1
9
17
11
15
12 13 24
14
27 26
23
4 5
16
22
3 1
6
500-2/3W-+/-5%
10
2 7
28
21
8 19
18 29
25
2 1
6 6
5
4
3
2
5
2
3
4
1
1
ENG19 ENG1.6/ENG19.1 B ENG9.1/ENG19.2 N ENG9.1/ENG19.3 N ENG1.5/ENG19.4 B ENG1.14/ENG19.5 B
FAI01
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
ENG19.1/S1.1
S1
B
ENG19.5/S2.1
B
S2
ENG19
FAI20
1
ENG9
1
ENG1.6/CAB1.62
R1
B B
16
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2
3
4
5
5 4 3 2 1
ENG33
B
CAB1.66/ENG1.14
R
23
45
46
CAB01
CAB1
28
15
13 25
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
17 6
5
24
29
R1.2/S1.1 R1.1/S2.1
4 12
CAB1
18 7
1
11 23
30
30 19
2
ENG33.5/S2.1 B ENG19.4/ENG33.4 B ENG19.3/ENG33.3 N ENG19.2/ENG33.2 N ENG33.1/S1.1 B
8 9 3
20
31
31
20 21 10 22
MA-10-06063A
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF215.15
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 01 Engine harness FAI 02 Instrument panel harness FAI 03 Console harness FAI 06 Transmission harness FAI 20 Vistronic harness FAI 23 Cab linkage harness FAI 31 Cab DynaVT transmission harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 128Linkage with Dual Control harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness
Component parts list CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB16 DOT MATRIX control keyboard CAB31 Display change control knob ENG33 Vistronic TR27 Radar TR35 Auxiliary hydraulics oil gauge 2
Fuse box
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
GUF215.16
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams
Auxiliary hydraulics dipstick
FAI23
L14.23/L20.8
B
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L14
L14
TR35 1
FAI128
TR31
FAI130 TR36 TR35 TR36.2/L14.23
B
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
TR36.2/TR35.1 TR35.2/TR31.1
B N
1 2
TR36
L20 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
CAB18
FAI31
L20.8/CAB18.7
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
FAI35 CAB18.7/CAB10.61
B
CAB18
L20
68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB01
CAB01
MA-10-06013A
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF215.17
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 01 Engine harness FAI 02 Instrument panel harness FAI 03 Console harness FAI 06 Transmission harness FAI 20 Vistronic harness FAI 23 Cab linkage harness FAI 31 Cab DynaVT transmission harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 128Linkage with Dual Control harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness
Component parts list CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB16 DOT MATRIX control keyboard CAB31 Display change control knob ENG33 Vistronic TR27 Radar TR35 Auxiliary hydraulics oil gauge 2
Fuse box
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
GUF215.18
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams
CAN network - Perkins engine
68 45 23
J
V
CAB83.2/CAB50.4
CAB83.1/CAB50.7 4
3
2
1
5
6
7
8
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1
2
3
4
8
7
6
5
TR18.5/CAB50.7
V
TR18.2/CAB50.4
J
TR18 S21 S20
S21.1/CAB18.2 S20.1/CAB18.1
1 8
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2 7
FAI 32
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
6
FAI 31
CAB18
3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
5
J V
4
S9.1/CAB18.1 S8.1/CAB18.2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
TR18
V
CA1.14/CA8.2
J
FAI 57
V J
ENG2 ENG2
23
4 12
5
16 15
13 24
14
27 26
25
1
2 3 11 10
4 9
5 8
6 7
AC1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V5
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
V5
1 2 3 4
1 2
26
24 25
FAI 41 S5.1/AC2.8 S6.1/AC2.7
V J
6
5
4
3
1
7
8
9
10
S5 S6
2
11 12
L14
21
8 9
10 22
1 2
3
4
1
2
3
4
6
5
4
3
7
8
9
10
2
J V
L22 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1
11 12
FAI 23
4
3
1
2
4
V1
J V S5
L14.13/S6.1 S5.1/L14.12
S6
J V
FAI 24
V1.2/S5.1 V1.3/S6.1
1 2 3 4
V J
3
2
1
V1 1 2 3 4
V1.2/S2.1 V1.3/S3.1
V J
FAI 25
L22 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
L22 L22.1/S4.1 L22.2/S3.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V S4 J
S4.1/CAB110.11 S3 S3.1/CAB110.20
V J
FAI 33
L22 V J
S8
29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
15 16
CAB110
55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI 68
S1
S8.1/FS4.29
V
S1.1/FS4.30
V
S9.1/FS4.27
J
S5.1/FS4.28
J S5
FS1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37
FS2.N/S1.1 FS2.M/S1.1
V V
S5.1/FS2.K FS2.J/S5.1
J J
FS1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
FS1
33
L13 38
55
20
37
7
3
8
4
9
5
10
1 2
6
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
CAB110 S3.1/L111.14 S4.1/L111.16 V
L13 L13 FS4
11 12 13 14
J
FAI 33
FAI 68
1
V J
CAB110
S9
AC1
55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CA8.1/S4.1 CA8.2/S3.1
26
S6.1/L14.16 S5.1/L14.15
S8.1/L22A.1 S9.1/L22A.2
S2.1/V5.2 S3.1/V5.3
27
14 25
L14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
S2.1/V4.2 S3.1/V4.3
S2
28 16
15
13 24
29 17
6 5
J V
L13.14/AC1.12 AC1.11/L13.33
V J
V J
V J S2.1/V3.2 S3.1/V3.3
18 7
1 4
12
S3
30 19
2 3
11 23
1
23 12
13 14
27
22 11
4 5
11
10 3
1 6
6 1 12
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4
V4
FAI 46
7
V
1 2
CA8
20
9 2
7
31
20
1
CAB1.37/S21.1
V4
4
19
21
8 19
17 28
15
AC2
S6.1/AC1.12 AC1.11/S5.1
3
2
10
AC2
CA8
29
30 18 29
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1
20
31
16
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V J 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2
7
1
3
6
8
1 2 3 4
4
5
9
1 2 3 4
V3
5
4
2
V3
4
3
2
S2.1/V2.2 S3.1/V2.3
FAI 41
5 6 7
3
11 10
1 2 3 4
4
12
1 2 3 4
V2
2 3
1
FAI 35
V J
V2
V J
AC2.8/S8.1 S9.1/AC2.7
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
5 6 7
AC12 AC12
J
FAI 31
X
X
4
6
28
L22.1/S8.1 L22.2/S9.1
CAB1.16/S20.1
22 11
1 2 3
27 26
10 3
1
1
16 15
14
9 2
7
2
28
6 5
13 25
21
8 19
18 17
V5
V4
X
3
12 24
20
31 30
29
V3
X
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V2
4
29 17
AC12
5
18 7
1 4
23
30 19
2
ENG2.1/ENG4.52 J ENG2.2/ENG4.61 V
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
6
8 9 3
11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
7
31
20 21 10 22
J V
J V
S20.1/ENG2.1 S21.1/ENG2.2
1
KPH MPH RPM
CAB18 S8
2
540 750 1000
46 24 1
.
B
TR18
S9
CA1.1/CA8.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
3
.
A
CA1
4
.
2
70
34
5
1
64
FAI 28
6
A
. AUTO
56
63
7
25
42
57
5 6 7
20
RPM x 100
28
CAB50 CAB50
CAB1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
14
43
4
5
0
V J
8
7
29
1 2 3
15
FAI 31
1
15
J V J V
10
120
26
L13.15/L14.16 L13.34/L14.15 L14.13/L22.2 L14.12/L22.1
2
1
1
27
25
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
AC12.3/S6.1 S5.1/AC12.4
68 45 23
CAB1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
V J
CAB83
S8.1/CAB54.26 CAB54.27/S9.1
15 14
24
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
28 16
5 13
25
29 17
6
ENG4
CAB1
12
ENG4
18 7
1 4
24
14
2
30 19
2 3
11
13
27
CAB83.1/CAB54.4 CAB83.2/CAB54.5
23
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70
46 24 1
CAB54
22
23 12
5
26
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
22 11
4
15
10
10 3
1
16
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
8 9
9 2
7 6
CAB54 CAB54
21
21
8 19
18 17
31
20
20
31 30
29 28
1
19
J V B
N
P E
M
D A C
L
B K J
F
G
H
FS2
4
5
9
29
33
10
3
15
2
22
16 23
37
9
FS2
4
28
34
FS2.C/FS1.8 FS1.9/FS2.B FS1.5/FS2.A
P N M L K J H G F E D C B A
1
5
MA-11-01150A
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF215.19
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 01 Engine harness FAI 02 Instrument panel harness FAI 03 Console harness FAI 06 Transmission harness FAI 20 Vistronic harness FAI 23 Cab linkage harness FAI 31 Cab DynaVT transmission harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 128Linkage with Dual Control harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness
Component parts list CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB16 DOT MATRIX control keyboard CAB31 Display change control knob ENG33 Vistronic TR27 Radar TR35 Auxiliary hydraulics oil gauge 2
Fuse box
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
GUF215.20
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams
CAN network - SisuDiesel engine with EHRC linkage calculator
CAB83 1
120
S8.1/CAB54.26 CAB54.27/S9.1
J
V
CAB83.2/CAB50.4
CAB83.1/CAB50.7
FAI 31
V J
FAI 38
CAB18
S8
S9.1/CAB18.1 S8.1/CAB18.2
FAI 31 4
3
2
1
5
6
7
8
S21 S20
S21.1/CAB18.2 S20.1/CAB18.1
68 45 23
3
4
7
6
5
FAI 35
V J
1
8 7
2
6
3
5 17
1 4
28
6
12
16
5 15
13
27
14
24
29
7
3 11
23
25
26
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
V
CA1.14/CA8.2
J
FAI 57
ENG4
ENG4 ENG4
15
12 13 24
14 26
25
V
1
2
4
5
6
12
11 10 9
8
7
3
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
AC1
AC1
5 6 7
CA8
1 2
CA8
1 2
4
1 2 3 4 3
2
V4
1 2 3 4
V5
1 2 3 4
V4
1 2 3 4
V5
1 2 3 4
4
1
3
2
1
4
2
3
4
24 25
FAI 41 S5.1/AC2.8 S6.1/AC2.7
V J
6
5
4
3
2
1
7
8
9
10
11 12
S5 S6
L14
8 9
V J
V J
V J S2.1/V3.2 S3.1/V3.3
V J
V J S2.1/V2.2 S3.1/V2.3 29
L22
J V
6
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
15
13
27
14 25
26
4 S6.1/L14.16 S5.1/L14.15
1
FAI 23
3
1
2
S5 L14.13/S6.1 S5.1/L14.12
S6
J V
V1.2/S5.1 V1.3/S6.1
FAI 24
2
1
V1
1 2 3 4
V J
1 2 3 4
V1.2/S2.1 V1.3/S3.1
V J
FAI 25
L22
L22A
3
4
V1
J V
L14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
S8.1/L22A.1 S9.1/L22A.2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
L22 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
L22.1/S4.1 L22.2/S3.1
V S4 J
S4.1/CAB110.11 S3 S3.1/CAB110.20
V J
FAI 33
V J
S8
29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB110
L111
15 16
11 12 13 14
S9
7
3
8
4
9
5
10
1 2
6
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
CAB110 CAB110 S3.1/L111.14 S4.1/L111.16 V
FAI 68
J
FAI 33
S1
S8.1/FS4.29
V
S1.1/FS4.30
V
S9.1/FS4.27
J
S5.1/FS4.28
J S5
FS2.N/S1.1 FS2.M/S1.1
V V
S5.1/FS2.K FS2.J/S5.1
J J
FAI 68 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FS1
L13 L13 FS4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37
FS1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
FS1
33
L13 38
55
20
37
1
CA8.1/S4.1 CA8.2/S3.1
28 16
J V
L13.14/AC1.12 AC1.11/L13.33
S2.1/V5.2 S3.1/V5.3
S2
17 6
5
24
S2.1/V4.2 S3.1/V4.3
18 7
1 4
12
S3
30 19
2 3
11 23
1
26
21 10 22
11
23 12
14
27
22 11
4 13
20
10 3
1 5 15
19
9 2
7 6 16
FAI 46
10
21
8 19
18 17
31
20
29
30
29
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1
20
31
28
AC2 AC2
CAB1.37/S21.1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI 41
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
S6.1/AC1.12 AC1.11/S5.1
1 2 3 4
V3
2
7
X
X 1
3
6
8
V3
4
3
4
5
2
5
4
3
1
6
2
11 10 9
1 2 3 4
7
1 12
1 2 3 4
V2
5 6 7
V J
V2
4
AC2.8/S8.1 S9.1/AC2.7
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V5
V4
X
AC12 AC12
J
FAI 31
V3
1 2 3
CAB1.16/S20.1
23
4 5
16 27
V J
FAI 35
6
28
1 2 3
27 26
22 11
1
28 16
15 14
10 3
1
2
17 6
5 13
9 2
7
3
4 12 24
21
8 19
18 17
V2
X
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
20
31 30
29
AC12
4
29
ENG2.1/ENG4.30 J ENG2.2/ENG4.31 V
5
18 7
1
11 23
30 19
2
ENG2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
6
8 9 3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
7
31
20 21 10 22
J V
J V
ENG2 S20.1/ENG2.1 S21.1/ENG2.2
L22.1/S8.1 L22.2/S9.1
KPH MPH RPM
2
18
1
540 750 1000
46 24 1
.
1 8
22
2
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
30 19
2
3
.
A
CAB18
8 9
4
.
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
21 10
CA1.1/CA8.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
31
20
5
1
J V
CA1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
6
A
. AUTO
CA1 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB50 CAB50
S9
TR18
7
25
TR18
FAI 32
5 6 7
20
RPM x 100
J
4
5
0
TR18.2/CAB50.4
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2 3
15
V
1
10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
TR18.5/CAB50.7
J V J V
2
1
CAB1
26
L13.15/L14.16 L13.34/L14.15 L14.13/L22.2 L14.12/L22.1
CAB1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
27
25
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
4
V J
28 16
15 14
24
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
29 17
6 5
13
25
2
18 7
1 4
12
24
14
TR18
30 19
2 3
11
13
25
CAB1
23
12
5
27
CAB83.1/CAB54.4 CAB83.2/CAB54.5
22
23
AC12.3/S6.1 S5.1/AC12.4
68 45 23
46 24 1
CAB54
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
22 11
4
15
10
10 3
1
26
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
8 9
9 2
7 6 16
CAB54 CAB54
21
21
8 19
18 17
31
20
20
31 30
29 28
19
1 5 10 16 23 29 34
4
J V B
P
N
E M
D A C
L
F
B G K J
H
FS2
3
9 15 22 28 33 37
FS2.C/FS1.8 FS1.9/FS2.B FS1.5/FS2.A
P N M L K J H G F E D C B A
2 9
4 1
FS2 5
MA-11-01159A
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF215.21
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 01 Engine harness FAI 02 Instrument panel harness FAI 03 Console harness FAI 06 Transmission harness FAI 20 Vistronic harness FAI 23 Cab linkage harness FAI 31 Cab DynaVT transmission harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 128Linkage with Dual Control harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness
Component parts list CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB16 DOT MATRIX control keyboard CAB31 Display change control knob ENG33 Vistronic TR27 Radar TR35 Auxiliary hydraulics oil gauge 2
Fuse box
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
GUF215.22
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams
CAN network - SisuDiesel engine with Autotronic 5 linkage calculator
23
24
14
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V J
CAB83 1 120
S12.1/CAB54.26 CAB54.27/S13.1
J
V
CAB83.2/CAB50.4
CAB83.1/CAB50.7
FAI 31
V J
8
30 19
9
18
2
17
1
11 4 12
28
6 16
5 15
13 24
29
7
3
23
27
14 25
26
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI 28
CA1
ENG4
34
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
FAI 31 4
3
2
1
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
8
7
6
5
TR18.5/CAB50.7
V
TR18.2/CAB50.4
J
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
V
CA1.14/CA8.2
J
FAI 57
TR18 TR18
CAB18 S21 S20
1
8
FAI 32
FAI 35
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CA1.1/CA8.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
4
J V
S21.1/CAB18.2 S20.1/CAB18.1
V J
ENG2
11
1 6
28
23
4 12
5
16 15
13 24
14
27 26
25
10 22
3 11
1 6
23
4 12
5
16 15
13 24
14 26
25
FAI 41 S5.1/AC2.8 S6.1/AC2.7
V J
6
5
4
3
2
1
7
8
9
10
11 12
S5 S6
L14
1 2 3 4 1 2
3
4
3
V J S2.1/V5.2 S3.1/V5.3
V J
V J
V J S2.1/V3.2 S3.1/V3.3
S2.1/V4.2 S3.1/V4.3
V J S2.1/V2.2 S3.1/V2.3 1
2
S5
J V
V1.2/S4.1 V1.3/S5.1
V J
L 22
L14
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
1
S10 S9
FAI 23
S8.1/L22A.1 S9.1/L22A.2
V J
V1.2/S2.1 V1.3/S3.1
V J CAB112
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
L22.1/S4.1 L22.2/S3.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V J
S4_ S4.1/CAB112.4 S_3 S3.1/CAB112.3
V J
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L13
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
6
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
S3.1/L111.14 S4.1/L111.16 L111.13/CAB112.6 L111.12/CAB112.5
FAI 68
S8.1/FS4.29
V
S1.1/FS4.30
V
S_1
FS2.N/S1.1 FS2.M/S1.1
V V
S5.1/FS2.K FS2.J/S5.1
J J
J
S5.1/FS4.28
J S__5
FS4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37
FS1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
FS1
33 1 5 10 16 23 29 34
CAB1 29
42
29
42
15
28
15
28
1
14
1
14
13
7 8 9 10
3 4 5
1 2
6
1
CAB112
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
J V V J
FAI 68 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
CAB141 CAB141
11 12 14
S9
CAB141
L13
16
CAB112
FS1 L13
15
FAI 131
FAI 68
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
L 22
J V
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CA8.1/S4.1 CA8.2/S3.1
1
2
S8
S9.1/FS4.27
J V CAB141.40/S10.1 CAB141.39/S9.1
1 2 3 4
7
L22A 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V1
1 2 3 4
FAI 128
L22.1/S8.1 L22.2/S9.1 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V1
1
L22
J V
3
4
J V
L14.13/S5.1 S4.1/L14.12
2
S10.1/AC1.12 AC1.11/S9.1
FAI 46
28
4
AC1 S10.1/L13.40 S9.1/L13.39
1 2 3 4
V5
3
7
V5
4
16
S4
4
6
3
26
S5.1/L14.16 S4.1/L14.15
5
5 8
1 2
27
14 25
6
4
3
1 2 3 4
7
2
11 10 9
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4
V4
15
J V
5 6 7
1 12
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V4
4
S2
17 6
5 13
24
29
7 1
4 12
4
V
3
18
2 3
11 23
AC1 CAB1.39/S21.1
1 2
19
9 10 22
7
AC2
S6.1/AC1.12 AC1.11/S5.1
1 2
CA8
4
7
CA8
S3
5
6
1 2
30
6
5 8
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8
5 6
4
3
1 2 3 4
31
20 21
4
2
11 10 9
1 2 3 4
V3
1
9 2
7 17
27
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
3
1 12
V3
4
3
2
19 18 29 28
21
8
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2
V J
1 2 3 4
3
20
31 30
J V J V
AC2.8/S12.1 S13.1/AC2.7
1 2 3 4
V2
V J
FAI 41
L13.15/L14.16 L13.34/L14.15 L14.13/L22.2 L14.12/L22.1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI 31
V2
1 2
AC2
J
X
X
X
5 6 7
AC12
ENG2
CAB1.16/S20.1
V5
V4
4
17
22
1 2 3
27 26
10 3
1
16 15
14
9 2
7
2
28
6 5
13
21
8 19
18
X
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
3
17
1 4
12 24
30
29
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
20
31
V3
4
29
V2
5
18 7
11 23
30 19
2 3
AC12 AC12
6
8 9
10
ENG2.1/ENG4.30 J ENG2.2/ENG4.31 V
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
7
21
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
31
20
22
J V
J V
S20.1/ENG2.1 S21.1/ENG2.2
1 2 3
46 24 1
31
20 21 10
5
S13.1/CAB18.1 S12.1/CAB18.2
CAB1
68 45 23
26
22
CAB18 S13 S12
FAI 35
CAB1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
ENG4
28 16 27
14 25
TR18
CAB54
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
29 17
15
CAB50
25
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
18
6 5
13 24
25
2
30
7 1
4 12
CAB50
19 2
3 11
13
26
CAB83.1/CAB54.4 CAB83.2/CAB54.5
22
23 12
5
27
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
22 11
4
15
10
10 3
1
AC12.3/S6.1 S5.1/AC12.4
68 45 23
46 24 1
CAB54
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
8 9
9 2
7 6 16
CAB54
21
21
8 19
18 17
31
20
20
31 30
29 28
4
J V B
FS2
P
N
E M
D A C
L
F
B G K J
H
FS2
3
9 15 22 28 33 37
FS2.C/FS1.8 FS1.9/FS2.B FS1.5/FS2.A
P N M L K J H G F E D C B A
2 9
4 1
5
MA-11-01384A
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF215.23
DCC2 (DynaVT) - Electrical diagrams
GUF215.24
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
Autotronic 4 - Description
11D10 - Autotronic 4 - Description
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Allocation of Autotronic 4 pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11D10.1
Autotronic 4 - Description
11D10.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Autotronic 4 - Description
A . General
TECHstar Dyna VT CAN network
The electronic control circuit of the Dyna VT transmission on 8400 series tractors comprises three main components: the Autotronic 4 (transmission controller), the DCC2 (second generation digital instrument panel), and the CAN network. These components are connected via harnesses, switches, potentiometers, sensors and solenoid valves. The Autotronic 4 is fitted in the cab floor to the right of the driver’s seat.
1
10
7
8
9
1 2 3 4 5 6
ESC
The Autotronic 4 and DCC2 also contain a self-diagnostics function intended to warn the operator when the circuit or one of the components is defective or disconnected. The error code diagnostics help qualified personnel when troubleshooting the various control components. These codes are displayed on the DOT MATRIX screen of the DCC2 and may, depending on the severity of the breakdown, place the transmission in neutral or allow it to continue functioning. Codes are stored in memory and can be later displayed by qualified personnel to troubleshoot intermittent problems (see Error codes section). The Autotronic 4 receives the following information from the DCC2 via the CAN network: position of the clutch pedal, reverse shuttle lever, armrest lever, lever / pedal mode switch, SV1 and SV2 switch encoders, underspeed supervisor, PTO automation switch, Headland switch and keys of the DOT MATRIX keypad. The Autotronic 4 is also connected to all the tractor electronic calculators as well as to the diagnostics connector (for programming and setting parameters with Wintest) via the CAN network (Fig. 1).
CAN network
4
2
6
16
7 8 9 10
3 4 5
1 2
6
7 2
5
8
6
10
DCC2 Autotronic 4 CAN network
16-way diagnostics connector Electronic injection control unit (EEM) Autotronic 5 electronic linkage calculator Autotronic 5 ParkLock calculator Datatronic 3 Joystick Electrohydraulic spool valves Automatic air conditioning controller
11 12 13 14
Location
1
3 9
4
Other CAN network connections (Fig. 1) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10)
3
15
The transmission electronic control circuit (Fig. 1) (1) (2)
5
MA-11-06075A
Fig. 1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11D10.3
Autotronic 4 - Description The Autotronic 4 and DCC2 both control the tractor functions. The Autotronic 4 directly receives input signals generated by the operator, for example from the brake pedals and parking brake switches, 4WD switches and differential lock, Hare / Tortoise range switch, PTO speed control and selector switches. It also receives input signals directly from the sensors, for example engine speed, transmission input and output speeds, Hare / Tortoise range position, PTO speed, transmission oil temperature as well as from the transmission oil pressure switches and filter clogging switches. The status of these sensors and switches is transmitted to the DCC2 by the CAN network and is used by the Autotronic 4 to activate the transmission control unit and the various solenoid valves: Hare / Tortoise, clutch coupler, speed regulator, 4WD, differential lock and PTO (Fig. 2).
30
29
28
27
26
25
1
24 CAN 23
2
Autotronic 4 Parts list (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) (12) (13) (14) (15) (16) (17) (18) (19) (20) (21) (22) (23) (24) (25) (26) (27) (28) (29) (30)
Transmission control unit (TR18) Hare / Tortoise range position sensor (TR8) 4WD switch (CAB67) Engine speed sensor (TR23) Clutch speed sensor (TR10) Transmission oil temperature sensor (TR12) Brake switches (CAB10-CAB11) Bevel gear design speed sensor (TR11) PTO control module (CAB61) Emergency control switch (CAB53) Emergency handbrake switch (TR20) PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders (LIG11) Transmission oil high pressure sensor (TR17) Steering pressure switch (TR33) Differential lock switch (CAB66) PTO shaft speed sensor (TR9) PTO ON/OFF switch (CAB70) Hare / Tortoise range selector switch (CAB76) Summing shaft speed sensor (TR19) Transmission oil filter clogging switch (TR13) Rear PTO solenoid valve (TR2) 540 or 540E rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (TR6) (depending on option) 1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (TR3) Tortoise range solenoid valve (TR14) Hare range solenoid valve (TR15) Coupler function solenoid valve (TR16) Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph (TR24) Reversing light junction (LIG15) (optional) Differential lock solenoid valve (TR7) 4WD solenoid valve (TR5)
3
22
4
21
5
20
6
19
18 7 17 8
68
46 45
24
16
23
1
9
15
10
11
12
13
14
CAN MA-11-06076A
Fig. 2
11D10.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Autotronic 4 - Description Transmission control unit (TR18)
TR18
It is fitted to the right-hand part of the transmission (Fig. 3). The control unit drives the cam channel drive shaft, which changes the transmission ratio. The Autotronic 4 activates the control unit via the CAN network and receives an electrical signal of the angular position of the actuator via an incremental sensor in the control unit.
TR12
Hare / Tortoise range position sensor (TR8) It is located on the left-hand side of the transmission (Fig. 4). The sensor measures the speed selector travel and informs the Autotronic 4. 4WD switch (CAB67) The switch is located on the cab right-hand console. It allows the 4 WD front axle to be engaged or not.
Fig. 3
MA-11-06078A
Engine speed sensor (TR23) The sensor is fitted to the left-hand part of the engine spacer (Fig. 5). It sends a signal proportional to engine speed to the Autotronic 4.
TR8
MA-11-06081A
Fig. 4
TR23
MA-11-06093A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Fig. 5
11D10.5
Autotronic 4 - Description PTO clutch speed sensor (TR10) The sensor is fitted to the rear of the tractor above the PTO output (Fig. 6). It measures the PTO clutch rotational speed and informs the Autotronic 4.
TR10
Transmission oil temperature sensor (TR12) It is fitted to the right of the transmission (Fig. 3). It monitors the transmission oil temperature and informs the Autotronic 4. Left and right brake switches (CAB10-CAB11) The switches are located on top of the brake pedals (Fig. 7). They inform the Autotronic 4 of the brake pedal position (released or not). Bevel gear design speed sensor (TR11) The sensor is fitted to the right of the transmission (Fig. 8). It sends a signal proportional to tractor ground speed to the Autotronic 4 and informs it of the direction of travel.
MA-11-06082A
Fig. 6
CAB10 CAB11
MA-11-06077A
Fig. 7
TR11
MA-11-06079A
Fig. 8
11D10.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Autotronic 4 - Description PTO control module (CAB61) The module is located on the cab right-hand console. It comprises 3 PTO speed selector switches (Fig. 9): (1) 1000 rpm PTO speed (2) 540 or 540E rpm PTO speed (depending on option) (3) PTO neutral
1000
1
Emergency control switch (CAB53) It is fitted in the cab floor, to the right of the driver’s seat. The switch allows the tractor to be started when there is a transmission failure.
540
2
1000
3
540E
Emergency handbrake switch (TR20) The switch is fitted to the left on the rear axle (Fig. 10). It informs the Autotronic 4 when the emergency handbrake is used, and this transmits the signal to the Autotronic 5 ParkLock via the CAN network.
Fig. 9
MA-11-06080A
PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders (LIG11) It is fitted on the left-hand fender. The switch allows the PTO to be engaged or disengaged (in this case, it must be held down for at least 6 seconds).
TR20
Transmission oil high pressure sensor (TR17) It is located on the right-hand side of the transmission (Fig. 11). It transmits instantaneous pressure in the high pressure circuit to the Autotronic 4.
MA-11-6086A
Fig 10
TR17
MA-11-06083A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Fig. 11
11D10.7
Autotronic 4 - Description Steering pressure switch (TR33) It is fitted on the engine spacer (Fig. 12) The sensor measures the steering pressure and informs the Autotronic 4.
TR33
Differential lock switch (CAB66) It is located on the cab right-hand console. The switch allows the differential lock to be engaged and disengaged. PTO shaft speed sensor (TR9) The sensor is located on the rear axle (Fig. 13). It measures the PTO output shaft rotational speed and informs the Autotronic 4. PTO ON/OFF switch (CAB70)
Fig. 12
MA-11-06087A
It is located on the cab right-hand console. The switch allows the PTO to be engaged and disengaged. Hare / Tortoise range selector switch (CAB76)
TR9
The switch is located on the cab front right-hand console. It ensures the Hare / Tortoise range change. Summing shaft speed sensor (TR19) It is fitted to the right of the transmission (Fig. 14). The sensor measures the summing shaft rotational speed and direction and informs the Autotronic 4.
MA-11-06084A
Fig. 13
MA-11-06085A
Fig. 14
TR19
11D10.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Autotronic 4 - Description Transmission oil filter clogging switch (TR13) It is fitted to the right of the transmission (Fig. 15). The sensor monitors the transmission oil filter clogging status and informs the Autotronic 4.
TR13
Rear PTO solenoid valve (TR2) It is fitted on top of the rear axle (Fig. 16). It allows the PTO to be engaged and disengaged. 540 or 540E rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (TR6) (depending on option) It is fitted on top of the rear axle (Fig. 16). It allows 540 or 540E PTO speeds to be selected. 1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (TR3)
MA-11-06088A
Fig. 15
It is fitted on top of the rear axle (Fig. 16). It allows the 1000 rpm PTO speed to be selected. Tortoise range solenoid valve (TR14) It is located on the right-hand side of the transmission (Fig. 17). It allows the Tortoise range to be selected. Hare range solenoid valve (TR15) It is located on the right-hand side of the transmission (Fig. 17). It allows the Hare range to be selected.
TR2 TR6 TR3
MA-11-06089A
Fig. 16
TR15
TR14
MA-11-06090A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Fig. 17
11D10.9
Autotronic 4 - Description Coupler function solenoid valve (TR16) It is located on the right-hand side of the transmission (Fig. 18). It allows the coupler function to be activated or not.
TR24
Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph (TR24) It is located on the right-hand side of the transmission (Fig. 18). It limits ground speed to 30 kph when using limp home mode.
TR16 Reversing light junction (LIG15) (optional) It is located at the rear of the tractor. The reversing light is controlled by the Autotronic 4 when reverse position is engaged.
MA-11-06091A
Fig. 18
Differential lock solenoid valve (TR7) It is fitted on top of the rear axle (Fig. 19). It allows the differential lock to be activated and deactivated. 4WD solenoid valve (TR5) It is fitted on top of the rear axle (Fig. 19). It allows the 4WD front axle to be engaged and disengaged.
TR5 TR7
MA-11-06092A
Fig 19
11D10.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Autotronic 4 - Description
B . Allocation of Autotronic 4 pins
MA-11-01137A
The Autotronic 4 electronic calculator is fitted with a 68-pin connector (Fig. 20) whose pin allocation is given in the table below.
68
46 45
24
23
1
Fig. 20
Description of 68-pin connector
Pin
Description
1
Sensor ground
2
Sensor supply
3
Not used
4 TR18
Transmission control unit
6
TR8
Hare / Tortoise range position sensor
7
Not used
8
Wired but not used
5
12V output
CAN Low CAN High Current input (4-20mA)
9
CAB67 4WD switch
Current input (4-20mA)
10
CAB53 Emergency control switch
Current output (4-20mA)
11
Not used
12
TR23
Engine speed sensor
Frequency input
13
TR19
Summing shaft speed sensor
Frequency input
14
TR10
PTO clutch speed sensor
Frequency input
15
TR12
Oil transmission temperature sensor
Digital input
16
CAB10 Right-hand brake switch
Digital input
17
Not used
18
TR11
Bevel gear design speed sensor (rotational direction)
Digital input
19
TR18
Transmission control unit
Digital input
20
CAB61 750 rpm speed switch on PTO control module
21
TR20
22
LIG11 PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders
Emergency handbrake switch
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Signal
Digital input Digital input Digital input
11D10.11
Autotronic 4 - Description
Pin
Description
23
Sensor supply
24
Not used
25
LIG15 Reversing light junction
26
CAN Low
27
CAN High
28
Calculator power supply +12 V AC (Ignition key On)
Signal 8.5V output
Current output (0.5A)
29
TR17
Transmission oil high pressure sensor
Current input (0-20mA)
30
TR33
Steering pressure sensor
Current input (0-20mA)
31
CAB66 Differential lock switch
Current input (0-20mA)
32
Wired but not used
33
Not used
34
TR11
Bevel gear design speed sensor
Frequency input
35
TR9
PTO shaft speed sensor
Frequency input
36
Not used
37
Not used
38
CAB70 PTO ON/OFF switch
Digital input
39
CAB11 Left-hand brake switch
Digital input
40
CAB76 Hare / Tortoise range selector switch
Digital input
41
CAB61 1000 rpm speed switch on PTO control module
Digital input
42
TR19
Summing shaft speed sensor (rotational direction)
Digital input
43
CAB61 540 rpm speed switch on PTO control module
Digital input
44
CAB61 Neutral switch on PTO control module
Digital input
45
TR13
46
Not used
47
Transmission oil filter clogging sensor
Digital input
TR2
Rear PTO solenoid valve
PWM output (4A)
48
TR6
750 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve
Current output (4A)
49
Not used
50
TR16
Coupler function solenoid valve
PWM output (4A)
51
TR24
Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph
PWM output (4A)
52
Not used
53
TR3
1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve
Current output (4A)
54
+12V battery supply
55
Calculator ground
56
+12V battery supply
57
+12V battery supply
58
+12V battery supply
59
+12V battery supply
11D10.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Autotronic 4 - Description
Pin 60
Description +12V battery supply
61
TR14
Tortoise range solenoid valve
Current output (5A)
62
TR15
Hare range solenoid valve
Current output (5A)
63
TR7
Differential lock solenoid valve
Current output (5A)
64
TR5
4WD solenoid valve
Current output (5A)
65
Wired but not used
66
Wired but not used
67
Not used
68
Wired but not used
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Signal
11D10.13
Autotronic 4 - Description
11D10.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Programming and setting parameters
GUF401 - AUTOTRONIC 4 - Programming and setting parameters
CONTENTS A . Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Setting parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF401.1
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Programming and setting parameters
GUF401.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Programming and setting parameters
A . Programming IMPORTANT: For any new Autotronic 4, it is necessary to proceed to parameter setting first. Programming can then be carried out, only to update the soft delivered with the new unit, if required. - Switch on the ignition key to carry out this operation. The engine must be stopped. - The programming of the Autotronic 4 is necessary: - if the calculator has been replaced by a new one and if the soft installed in the new unit is an older version than that present in Wintest - when a new program becomes available to improve the product. - Click on the “Tools” icon and then on “Programming AUTO4” icon.
Wintest
AUTO4 label Programming AUTO4 List of AUTO4 - DCC2 error codes DCC2 label Table of DCC2 constants Programming DCC2 Programming DATA3 AUTO5 label - Linkage Programming AUTO5 Table of AUTO5 constants
DCC2 : 4.01 AUTO 4 : 1.06
CLIM : 20.05 JOY : 3.6
EHRC : 1.9
DATA : D040911
MA-11-01104A
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF401.3
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Programming and setting parameters The following screen is displayed: Programming Autotronic 4 Existing version: 01.05 New version: 01.06
Do you want to reprogram? OK
Boot Soft MA-11-01123A
There are 2 available choices: - Updating the Boot (only for calculators currently programmed with 01.04 or 01.05 version), - Programming the soft.
Updating the Boot REMINDER : Updating the Boot is only for calculators currently programmed with 01.04 or 01.05 version. If the program version is later, only the soft needs to be programmed. - Select the Boot line if the calculator is programmed with 01.04 or 01.05 version. - Click: “OK” to carry out programming to cancel programming - The following screen appears, displaying a progress gauge in the lower part of the screen to indicate the Boot programming status:
Programming Autotronic 4 Existing version: 01.05 New version: 01.06
Programming in progress... OK
Boot Soft MA-11-01124A
Programming lasts approximately 30 seconds. - When programming is complete, the window closes. NOTE: To validate the Boot update, switch off the ignition key! It is now possible to program the calculator with soft version 01.06.
GUF401.4
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Programming and setting parameters Programming the Soft - Select the Soft line if the Boot has just been updated or if the program version is 01.06 or later. - Click: “OK” to carry out programming to cancel programming - The following screen appears, displaying a progress gauge in the lower part of the screen to indicate the programming status:
Programming Autotronic 4 Existing version: 01.05 New version: 01.06
Programming in progress... OK
Boot Soft MA-11-01421A
Programming lasts approximately 6 minutes. - When programming is complete, the window closes. NOTE: to validate programming, switch off the ignition key!
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF401.5
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Programming and setting parameters
B . Setting parameters IMPORTANT: For any new Autotronic 4, it is necessary to proceed to parameter setting first. Programming can then be carried out, only to update the soft delivered with the new unit, if required. - Switch on the ignition key to carry out this operation. The engine must be stopped. - Parameter setting is necessary: - if the former Autotronic 4 has been replaced by a new one, - when improvements to one or more functions have been made through parameter setting. - Click on the “Tools” icon and then on “AUTO4 label”.
Wintest
AUTO4 label Programming AUTO4 List of AUTO4 - DCC2 error codes DCC2 label Table of DCC2 constants Programming DCC2 Programming DATA3 AUTO5 label - Linkage Programming AUTO5 Table of AUTO5 constants
DCC2 : 4.01 AUTO 4 : 1.06
CLIM : 20.05 JOY : 3.6
EHRC : 1.9
DATA : D040911
MA-11-01104A
GUF401.6
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Programming and setting parameters The following screen is displayed:
Autotronic 4 Label Code parameters
A
B
D
E
K
10
0
1
2
1
03 = 7480 ->I M183044 04 = 05 = 06 = 7465 HA110 07 = 7475 HA110 08 = 7465 HA130 09 = 7475 HA130 10 = 7480 I-> M183045 11 = 7485
OK
?
MA-11-01127A
To read the label code present in Autotronic 4, click on
It is not IMPERATIVE to read the label code before setting the parameters; the parameters can be set directly. The tractor label code can be modified either by: - moving the mouse cursor directly into the relevant box and entering the appropriate code (it is also possible to navigate between codes by pressing the “tabulation” key on the keyboard), - clicking on the rectangle under the code concerned; you can then scroll down the scroll bar and double-click on the desired parameter. Confirm the code by clicking on “OK”. It requires approximately 1 minute to set parameters, and during this period a progress gauge indicates the parameter setting status. NOTE: to validate parameters, switch off the ignition key!
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF401.7
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Programming and setting parameters The Autotronic 4 parameter code is displayed on a label stuck on the rear of the fusebox cover. This code has 6 digits and corresponds to the 5 parameters whose meaning is shown below.
M142028 2601 100121 1022215
M142028 = Tractor serial number 2601 = linkage parameter code 100121= Autotronic 4 parameter code 1022215 = DCC2 parameter code
M142028 2601 100121 1022215
MA-11-01126A
Parameter code
AA
B
D
E
K
Example of parameter setting
10
0
1
2
1
Code Code Code Code Code Code Code Code Code Code Code
AA B C D E F G H I J K
GUF401.8
¤ H
= = = = = = = = = = =
10 = 7480 0 = All models = Inactive 1 = Manual or automatic front axle, and PTO in all countries (except US) 2 = Ground speed limited to 40 kph = Inactive = Inactive = Inactive = Inactive = Inactive 1 = With 540E PTO
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Programming and setting parameters
Models with Autotronic 4 7465 7475
Details
Status of 2 CAN loop switches (*)
Code AA
Rear axle: HA 110
ON
06
Rear axle: HA 130
ON
08
Rear axle: HA 110
ON
07
Rear axle: HA 130
ON
09
up to serial n° M183044
ON
03
from serial n° M183045
ON
10
7480 7485
-
ON
11
7490
-
ON
12
7495
-
ON
13
8450
-
ON
20
8460
-
ON
21
8470
-
ON
22
8480
-
ON
23
Identifying the rear axle, 2 possible methods: • Lift rams diameter Fig. 2 - HA 110: 2 rams with Ø 40 mm rod - HA 130: 1 ram with a Ø 40 mm rod and a second ram with a Ø 36 mm rod • Width of final drive unit spacer Fig. 1
MA-11-01122A
Fig. 2
HA110
HA130
37 mm MA-11-01320A
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
65 mm
Fig. 1
GUF401.9
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Programming and setting parameters
CODE B Not used
CODE C Inactive
0 = All models
CODE E Maximum speed (c)
CODE D Operation 1 = Manual or automatic front axle, and PTO in all countries (except US) 2 = US front axle (a) and US PTO (b)
CODE F Inactive
CODE G Inactive
CODE I Inactive
CODE J Inactive
1 = 30 kph 2 = 40 kph 3 = 33 kph 5 = 50 kph
CODE H Inactive
CODE K Power take-off 1 = With 540E PTO (750 rpm) 2 = Without 540E PTO (750 rpm)
(a)
When the 4WD switch is pressed for 5 seconds, the front axle changes to the US mode. In this case, it disengages only when the brake pedal is pressed. It engages again when the brake pedal is released.
(b)
Using the PTO in US mode: - Select the speed - Press the ON/OFF switch twice within 5 seconds to start the PTO - Press once on the ON/OFF switch to stop the PTO - Again press the ON/OFF switch twice within 5 seconds to start the PTO
(c)
Limit set according to regulations in force in the country
GUF401.10
¤ H
(*) Positioning of the 2 CAN loop configuration switches at the back of DCC2: ON: Looping is carried out in the DCC2
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Tests and diagnostics
GUF402 - AUTOTRONIC 4 - Tests and diagnostics
CONTENTS A . Safety Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Gearbox function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 C . Front Axle function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 D . Differential function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 E . Power Take-Off function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF402.1
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Tests and diagnostics
GUF402.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Tests and diagnostics
A . Safety Function - Start the engine. - Click on the “Safety” icon
Wintest
DCC2 : 4.01 AUTO 4 : 1.06
CLIM : 20.05 JOY : 3.6
EHRC : 1.9
DATA : D040911
MA-11-01104A
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF402.3
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Tests and diagnostics The following screen is displayed: Safety devices test - AUTO4 DCC 2
AUTO4
802
OK ESC
10 bars
MA-11-01105A
DCC2
AUTO4
Bottom-of-clutch pedal switch
Engine speed sensor value (TR23) in rpm
802 - pedal up: switch open, white - pedal down: switch closed, blue
Transmission in “Neutral” position
Top-of-clutch pedal switch - neutral position: switch closed, blue - non-neutral position: switch open, white Left-hand lever Neutral switch
Left and right brake pedal switches
Neutral position Park brake switch (TR20) Left-hand lever in front or rear position
Switch error or pedal pressed down
GUF402.4
¤ H
- switch open: white - switch closed: blue
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Tests and diagnostics DCC2
AUTO4
DOT MATRIX control keyboard (CAB16) -Changes to red when pressed
Oil transmission temperature sensor (TR12)
- Turns red when temperature exceeds 105°C
- "Up, left, down and right" scroll arrows - "OK" key - ESC (Escape) key
Transmission oil pressure indicator light (TR17) in bars 10 bars
Speed selector switch (CAB31) - Changes to red when pressed
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF402.5
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Tests and diagnostics
B . Gearbox function - Start the engine. - Click on the "Gearbox" icon
Wintest
DCC2 : 4.01 AUTO 4 : 1.06
CLIM : 20.05 JOY : 3.6
EHRC : 1.9
DATA : D040911
MA-11-01104A
GUF402.6
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Tests and diagnostics The following screen is displayed: Gearbox - AUTO4 DCC 2
AUTO4 3.5
0%
1 8.1 1481
2.4
29
21
36˚C
52
153
45% 2 0.4 3.2
20.4%
1
5.0
Actual Ratio
83
Set Ratio
91
2
1.6
36 0.38 2.5 Mode Speed increment
Lever
SV :
0 m/h
2.8 2
30 Kph
2 No error
No error MA-11-01106A
DCC2
AUTO4
Bottom-of-clutch pedal switch
Engine speed sensor value (TR23) in rpm
1481 3.5 Clutch pedal travel potentiometer value in percent and in volts. 0% - Value between 0% = clutch disengagement and 100% = clutch engagement - Voltage between 3.5V and 1.4V
Summing shaft speed sensor value (TR19) in rpm 29 Ring gear design speed sensor value (TR11) in rpm
0.9 45% Throttle pedal potentiometer value in percent and in volts. - Value between 0% = pedal released and 100% = pedal pressed down - Voltage between 0.5V and 4.5V
21 Transmission oil temperature sensor value (TR12) in °C and value measured in ohms. 36°C 153
Top-of-clutch pedal switch Transmission oil high pressure sensor value (TR17) in mA 52
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF402.7
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Tests and diagnostics DCC2
AUTO4
Forward switch, reverse shuttle lever
Left and right brake pedal switches
- changes to blue when Forward speed is selected Neutral switch, reverse shuttle lever
- changes to blue when lever is in neutral Reverse switch, reverse shuttle lever
- changes to blue when Reverse speed is selected Reverse shuttle shifting request pulse
Display of active Autotronic 4 information - transmission in “Neutral” position - underspeed supervisor - SV1 - SV2 - reverse shuttle shifting pulse Current transmission control position calcuActual lated by Autotronic 4 using engine speed Ratio sensor (TR23) and summing shaft (TR19). Current transmission control module position Set Ratio requested by Autotronic 4. Value between
-10000 and 10000, 0 being "neutral" - changes to blue for the duration of a pulse when there is a reverse shuttle shifting request Value of output analog signal of reverse shuttle lever in volts (+/-0.2V): 3.4 -
lever in raised position (de-clutched) ............... 2.5 V FWD+.................................................................. 4 V FWD ................................................................. 3.5 V FWD- ................................................................... 3 V N....................................................................... 0.5 V REV- .................................................................... 2 V REV .................................................................. 1.5 V REV+ .................................................................... 1V
Current valus of "Set Ratio"
Range in rpm 2 kph (reverse)
2 kph 5 kph 10 kph 15 kph 5 kph 15 kph
GUF402.8
¤ H
1000
-1935
1800
-1029
1000
1470
1800
814
1000
3608
1800
2014
1000
7444
1800
4051
1000
/
1800
5995
1000
1563
1800
865
1000
4770
1800
2577
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Tests and diagnostics DCC2
AUTO4
Value of engine underspeed supervisor control potentiometer in % and in volts
Design ground speed indicated by ground speed sensor (TR11) in kph
20.4%
0.38
1.6
Solenoid valve, coupler function
- is activated at the values selected when engine speed exceeds 1440 rpm - is set at 7% when the engine speed drops below 1400 rpm (with DCC2 soft from before 02.04, the set value is 10%). Armrest lever potentiometer value in volts
- ON: transmission neutral: no current is sent to solenoid valve - OFF: coupler function: a current is sent to solenoid valve: transmission activated Speed limitation solenoid valve set at 30kph 30 kph (TR24) when running in limp home mode
2.5
ON: solenoid valve supplied: limitation Autotronic 4 status flowcharts
0
MA-11-01107-A
........................................................... 3.32 to 4 V ...................................................... 2.34 to 3.02 V ...................................................... 1.37 to 2.05 V NOTE: the values are determined by the armrest lever calibration (diplayed in CAL2, see section GUF404)
-
forward speed activated reverse speed activated neutral dynamic stop (“0” displayed) Hare range solenoid valve (TR15) Range switch in cab (CAB76)
Mode
Lever
Transmission operating mode - Lever - Power pedal - Eco pedal - Self propel mode SV:
2
Speed governor - 0: speed governor not activated - 1: SV1 activated - 2: SV2 activated
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
Tortoise range solenoid valve (TR14) Range position sensor value (TR8) in mA 36 Displays the error code if a fault appears in Autotronic 4. Click on the icon to display the type of fault. No error
GUF402.9
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Tests and diagnostics DCC2 Speed increment
AUTO4
0 kph
Speed increment selected by armrest lever or by left-hand steering wheel lever (Values: see table below) NOTE: the values , and of the potentiometerare determined by armrest lever calibration, see section GUF404. Values of armrest lever potentiometer ≥
+ 0.1V
N160061
29
TR17
Transmission oil high pressure sensor
Current input (0-20mA)
30
TR33
Direction pressure switch
Digital input
31
CAB66
Differential lock switch
Current input (4-20mA)
32
Not used
33
Not used
34
TR11
Bevel gear design speed sensor
Frequency input
35
TR9
PTO shaft speed sensor
Frequency input
36
Not used
37
Not used
38
CAB70
PTO ON/OFF switch
Digital input
39
CAB11
Left-hand brake switch
Digital input
40
CAB76
Hare / Tortoise range selector switch
Digital input
41
CAB61
1000 rpm speed switch on PTO control module
Digital input
42
TR19
Summing shaft speed sensor (rotational direction)
Digital input
43
CAB61
540 rpm speed switch on PTO control module
Digital input
44
CAB61
Neutral switch on PTO control module
Digital input
45
TR13
Transmission filter clogging switch
Digital input
46
Not used
47
TR2
PTO solenoid valve
Pulse outputs
48
TR4
540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve
Digital output
49
Not used
50
TR16
Coupler function solenoid valve
Pulse outputs
51
TR24
Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph
Pulse outputs
52
Not used
53
TR6
540E rpm PTO speed solenoid valve
Digital output
54
+12 V AC (Ignition key On) calculator power supply ->I N160061 +12V permanent calculator power supply I-> N160061
55
Calculator ground
GUF403.14
¤ H
Reversing light junction
Digital output Digital output
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes
Pin
Description
Type of signal
56 57 58
+12 V AC (Ignition key On) calculator power supply ->I N160061 +12V permanent calculator power supply I-> N160061
59 60 61
TR14
Tortoise range solenoid valve
Digital output
62
TR15
Hare range solenoid valve
Digital output
63
TR7
Differential lock solenoid valve
Digital output
64
TR5
4 WD solenoid valve
Digital output
65
Not used
66
Not used
67
Not used
68
TR3
1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve
Digital output
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF403.15
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes CAB61: PTO control module Description Location: on cab right-hand console This module contains a network of resistors Fig. 8 allowing the Autotronic 4 to differentiate between signals, for example: switch not pressed down, switch pressed down, open circuit or short circuit. This module also transfers signals from the PTO ON / OFF, Hare / Tortoise, differential lock and 4WD.
1000 540E
540
Allocation of pins: MA-11-01212A
Pin
Description
14
Differential lock switch input (CAB66)
15
Differential lock output to Autotronic 4
16
4WD switch input (CAB67)
17
4WD output to Autotronic 4
18
Available
19
Available
20
Available
21
Not used
22
Not used
CAB61
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
MA-11-01211A
NEUTRE
8.5V supply
R160
13
R510
12V lighting
540
12
R160
11
PTO ON/OFF output on fender to Autotronic 4
R510
PTO ON/OFF switch input (CAB70)
750
10
1000
9
Hare / Tortoise range selection output to Autotronic 4
R160
Hare / Tortoise range selector switch input (CAB76)
R510
8
R160
PTO ON/OFF output to Autotronic 4
R510
7
R160
PTO ON/OFF switch input (CAB70)
R510
6
2 x 1W 12 Volts
R160
1000 rpm PTO speed output to Autotronic 4
R510
5
K1.1
R160
540E rpm PTO speed output to Autotronic 4
R510
4
R510
540 rpm PTO speed output to Autotronic 4
K1.3
3
Fig. 7
R510
PTO neutral output to Autotronic 4
K1.3
2
R953
Ground
R383
1
1
3
5
7
9
11
13
15
17
19
21
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
18
20
22
Fig. 8
Possible error codes (see next page)
GUF403.16
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes Possible error codes 6115: Signal error Result: PTO speed can no longer be modified or preselected 6116: Signal error Result: PTO speed can no longer be modified or preselected 6117: Signal error Result: PTO speed can no longer be modified or preselected 6118: Signal error Result: PTO speed can no longer be modified or preselected 6155: Pressed down for over 30 seconds, mechanical or electrical error on switch Result: Other speeds can be selected and engaged. NEUTRAL cannot be selected. 6156: Pressed down for over 30 seconds, mechanical or electrical error on switch Result: As long as “540” is selected, engagement is not possible. "1000" and "540E" can be selected. Press down PTO ON/OFF switch for over 5 seconds. "540" cannot be selected 6157: Pressed down for over 30 seconds, mechanical or electrical error on switch Result: As long as “540E” is selected, engagement is not possible. "1000" and "540" can be selected. Press down PTO ON/OFF switch for over 5 seconds. "540E" cannot be selected 6158: Pressed down for over 30 seconds, mechanical or electrical error on switch Result: As long as “1000” is selected, engagement is not possible. "540" and "540E" can be selected. Press down PTO ON/OFF switch for over 5 seconds. "1000" cannot be selected 61B5: Communication error 61B6: Communication error 61B7: Communication error 61B8: Communication error
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF403.17
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes CAB66: Differential lock switch Description Location: on cab right-hand console The switch is closed between 2 and 3 when pressed down. - Pin 2: Signal - Pin 3: Power supply - Pin 7: Ground - Pin 8: 12V lighting NOTE: the signal passes via the PTO control module before reaching Autotronic 4.
8
7
1
4
2
5
3
6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
3
+8
Possible error codes
MA-11-01213A
CAB66
2 -7
Fig. 9
5151: Signal error Result: Other functions still active
GUF403.18
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes CAB67: 4WD switch Description Location: on cab right-hand console The switch is closed between 2 and 3 when pressed down. - Pin 2: Signal - Pin 3: Power supply - Pin 7: Ground - Pin 8: 12V lighting NOTE: the signal passes via the PTO control module before reaching Autotronic 4.
8
7
1
4
2
5
3
6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
3
+8 MA-11-01214A
CAB67
2 -7
Fig. 10
Possible error codes 5131: Manual engagement signal faulty Result: Other functions still active 5132: Automatic engagement signal faulty Result: Other functions still active
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF403.19
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes CAB70: PTO ON/OFF switch Description Location: on cab right-hand console (Fig. 11) The switch is closed between 1 and 2 when pressed down. - Pin 1: Signal - Pin 2: Ground NOTE: the signal passes via the PTO control module before reaching Autotronic 4.
MA-11-01215A
Fig. 11
1 2 3
3
2
1
CAB70
MA-11-01216A
Fig. 12
Possible error codes 6101: Signal error Result: PTO stops 6141: Pressed down for over 30 seconds, mechanical or electrical error on switch Result: The selected speed changes to neutral, and it is impossible to select a speed 61A1: Communication error
GUF403.20
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes CAB76: Hare / Tortoise range selector switch Description Location: on cab right-hand console The switch is closed between 1 and 2 when pressed down. - Pin 1: Signal - Pin 2: Ground NOTE: the signal passes via the PTO control module before reaching Autotronic 4.
2
1
MA-11-01217A
Fig. 13 Possible error codes 412B: Signal error Result: The selected range stays in position; shifting not possible
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF403.21
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes LIG11: PTO ON/OFF switch on fender Description
2
1
LIG11 1 2 3
3
Location: on rear left-hand wing The switch is open between 1 and 2 when pressed down. - Pin 1: Signal - Pin 2: Ground NOTE: the signal passes via the PTO control module before reaching Autotronic 4.
MA-11-12018A
Possible error codes
Fig. 14
6102: Signal error Result: Operation possible only in emergency control mode by holding down the PTO ON/OFF switch in the cab for at least 5 seconds 6143: Pressed down for over 30 seconds, mechanical or electrical error on switch Result: Impossible to select a speed and engage PTO
GUF403.22
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR2: PTO solenoid valve Description
TR9
MA-11-01219A
TR2
TR10
Location: • to the right of the rear axle (ML130/160 Fig. 15) • on the rear axle (ML200 Fig. 16) Proportional solenoid valve.
TR3 TR4
- Pin 1: Supply signal - Pin 2: Ground
TR5
Signals: Resistance: 7.4 Ohms Current when PTO is engaged: 1.7A
TR6 TR7 Fig. 15
TR2 TR5 TR6
TR20
TR7
TR3 MA-11-01452A
Fig. 16
Possible error codes
2
1
6104: Control error Result: PTO stops
1 2
MA-11-01230A
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
Fig. 17
GUF403.23
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR3: 1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve Description
TR9
MA-11-01219A
TR2
TR10
Location: • to the right of the rear axle (ML130/160 Fig. 18) • on the rear axle (ML200 Fig. 19) ON/OFF solenoid valve
TR3 TR4
- Pin 1: Supply signal - Pin 2: Ground
TR5
Signals: Resistance: 8.1 Ohms Preselected 1000 rpm PTO speed current: 1.5A
TR6 TR7 Fig. 18
TR2 TR5 TR6
TR20
TR7
TR3 MA-11-01452A
Fig. 19
Possible error codes
2
1
611C: Control error Result: Impossible to engage PTO
1 2 MA-11-01221A
GUF403.24
¤ H
Fig. 20
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR4: 540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve Description
MA-11-01219A
TR9
TR10
Location: to the right of the rear axle (ML130/160 Fig. 21) ON/OFF solenoid valve
TR2 TR3 TR4
- Pin 1: Supply signal - Pin 2: Ground
TR5 Signals: Resistance: 8.1 Ohms Preselected 540 rpm PTO speed current: 1.5A
TR6 TR7
2
1
Fig. 21
1 2 MA-11-01221A
Fig. 22
Possible error codes 611A: Control error Result: Impossible to engage PTO
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF403.25
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR5: 4 WD solenoid valve Description
TR9
MA-11-01219A
TR2
TR10
Location: • to the right of the rear axle (ML130/160 Fig. 23) • on the rear axle (ML200 Fig. 24) ON/OFF solenoid valve
TR3 TR4
- Pin 1: Supply signal - Pin 2: Ground
TR5
Signals: Resistance: 8.1 Ohms Front axle not engaged: 1.5A
TR6 TR7 Fig. 23
TR2 TR5 TR6
TR20
TR7
TR3 MA-11-01452A
Fig. 24
Possible error codes
2
1
5133: Control error Result: The front axle engages
1 2 MA-11-01221A
GUF403.26
¤ H
Fig. 25
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR6: 540 rpm (or 540E) PTO speed solenoid valve
TR9
MA-11-01219A
TR2
TR10
Description Location: • 540E solenoid valve to the right of the rear axle (ML130/160 Fig. 26) • 540 or 540E solenoid valve on the rear axle (ML200 Fig. 27) ON/OFF solenoid valve
TR3
- Pin 1: Supply signal - Pin 2: Ground
TR6
Signals: Resistance: 8.1 Ohms Preselected 750 rpm PTO speed current: 1.5A
TR7
TR4 TR5
Fig. 26
TR2 TR5 TR6
TR20
TR7
TR3 MA-11-01452A
Fig. 27
Possible error codes
2
1
611B: Control error Result: Impossible to engage PTO
1 2 MA-11-01221A
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
Fig. 28
GUF403.27
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR7: Differential lock solenoid valve Description
TR9
MA-11-01219A
TR2
TR10
Location: • to the right of the rear axle (ML130/160 Fig. 29) • on the rear axle (ML200 Fig. 30) ON/OFF solenoid valve
TR3 TR4
- Pin 1: Supply signal - Pin 2: Ground
TR5
Signals: Resistance: 8.1 Ohms Differential lock engaged: 1.5A
TR6 TR7 Fig. 29
TR2 TR5 TR6
TR20
TR7
TR3 MA-11-01452A
Fig. 30
Possible error codes
2
1
5153: Control error Result: Differential lock cuts off
1 2 MA-11-01221A
GUF403.28
¤ H
Fig. 31
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR8: Hare / Tortoise range position sensor Description
TR8
Location: to the left of the transmission (Fig. 32) - Pin 1: Ground - Pin 2: 8.5V supply - Pin 3: Signal Signals: Tortoise range: 4V or 20mA Hare range: 1V or 4mA
MA-11-01222A
Fig. 32
3 2 1
MA-11-01223A
Fig. 33 Possible error codes 4108: Signal error, 8.5 Volt supply error Result: Shifting from Tortoise to Hare range impossible 41EB: Calibration error or sensor value out-of-tolerances Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF403.29
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR9: PTO shaft speed sensor Description
TR9
Location: on the rear axle (Fig. 34) Hall effect sensor. - Pin 1: Ground - Pin 2: Signal - Pin 3: 8.5V supply NOTE: Prior to serial number N160061, power supply is +12V APC (Ignition key On).
TR10
Signals: PTO when running: 1.5V PTO when stopped: 1.1V or 5.4V (depending on presence or absence of a gear tooth)
Fig. 34
MA-11-01453A
If a value of 7.3V is measured: the component is faulty
3 2
Possible error codes
1
6110: Signal error Result: Operation possible only in emergency control mode by holding down the PTO ON/OFF switch in the cab for at least 5 seconds
2 510 R
510 R
6150: - PTO output shaft speed exceeds 1300 rpm, signal error (TR9 or TR10) - Selected speed is lower than PTO output shaft speed, error in TR9 sensor supply voltage, speed solenoid valve (TR3, TR4, TR6) locked in “deactivated” position. Result: Electric speed change possible, operation possible only in emergency control mode by holding down the PTO ON/OFF switch in the cab for at least 5 seconds. If there is a solenoid valve fault, the corresponding speed cannot be selected.
3
1 MA-11-12020A
Fig. 35
6160: Discrepancy of at least 12% between actual output shaft speed and PTO clutch speed value Speed solenoid valve (TR3, TR4, TR6) poorly connected or seized up. Mechanical fault at speed selection. Signal error to sensors (TR9, TR10) result: Electric speed change possible, operation possible only in emergency control mode by holding down the PTO ON/OFF switch in the cab for at least 5 seconds. If there is a solenoid valve fault, the corresponding speed cannot be selected.
GUF403.30
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR10: PTO clutch speed sensor Description
TR9
Location: on the rear axle (Fig. 36) Hall effect sensor. - Pin 1: Ground - Pin 2: Signal - Pin 3: 8.5V supply NOTE: Prior to serial number N160061, power supply is +12V APC (Ignition key On).
TR10
Signals: PTO when running: 1.5V PTO when stopped: 1.1V or 5.4V (depending on presence or absence of a gear tooth)
Fig. 36
MA-11-01453A
If a value of 7.3V is measured: the component is faulty
3 2 1
3 2 510 R
510 R
1 MA-11-12020A
Fig. 37
Possible error codes (see next page)
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF403.31
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes Possible error codes 6105: Signal error Result: Operation possible only in emergency control mode by holding down the PTO ON/OFF switch in the cab for at least 5 seconds 6145: - NEUTRAL speed selection, PTO not activated, TR10 displays a speed, the clutch disc assembly does not separate, PTO brake does not operate - Selected speed, PTO clutch 100% engaged, over 20% discrepancy between PTO clutch speed and engine speed. The PTO clutch disc assembly slips: clutch slippage - PTO clutch speed is lower than output shaft speed, error in TR10 sensor supply voltage Result: Electric speed change possible, operation possible only in emergency control mode by holding down the PTO ON/OFF switch in the cab for at least 5 seconds. If there is a solenoid valve fault, the corresponding speed cannot be selected. 6160: Discrepancy of at least 12% between actual output shaft speed and PTO clutch speed value Speed solenoid valve (TR3, TR4, TR6) poorly connected or seized up. Mechanical fault at speed selection. Signal error to sensors (TR9, TR10) result: Electric speed change possible, operation possible only in emergency control mode by holding down the PTO ON/OFF switch in the cab for at least 5 seconds. If there is a solenoid valve fault, the corresponding speed cannot be selected.
GUF403.32
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR11: Bevel gear design speed sensor Description Location: to the right of the transmission (Fig. 38) Hall effect sensor. -
Pin 1: Ground Pin 2: Speed signal Pin 3: 8.5V supply Pin 4: Rotational direction signal
Signals: Speed signal (2): Speed greater than 5 kph: 3V Tractor when stopped: 1V or 5V (depending on presence or absence of a gear tooth)
Fig. 38
If a value of 7.3V is measured: the component is faulty
4
Rotational direction signal (4) Forward speed greater than 5 kph: 2.4V Reverse speed greater than 5 kph: 5V
3 2 1
If a value of 8V is measured: the component is faulty
4 3 2 1 MA-11-1225A
Fig. 39
Possible error codes 412A: Signal error Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode 4145: Signal error Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode 4182: Incoherent speeds result: Driving possible only in limp home mode 4183: Incoherent rotational directions result: Driving possible only in limp home mode
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF403.33
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR12: Oil transmission temperature sensor Description Location: to the right of the transmission (Fig. 40) Resistant sensor. - Pin 1: Signal - Pin 2: Ground Signals: Temperature in °C
Resistance in ohms
50
150
60
105
95
40
105
35
110
30
Fig. 40
Remarks: - The indicator light comes on at 95°C in Hare range, requesting a return to Tortoise range - The indicator light comes on at 105°C in Tortoise range - The buzzer rings at 110°C: it is necessary to stop!
2
2 1
T˚
analog.
1 MA-11-01226A
Fig. 41 Possible error codes 4153: Transmission oil temperature higher than 100°C Result: A problem may occur in the transmission if the tractor is not stopped 4173: Signal error Result: No longer possible to monitor, breakdown possible
GUF403.34
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR13: Transmission filter clogging switch Description Location: to the right of the transmission (Fig. 42) Switch with resistive circuit. - Pin 1: Signal - Pin 2: Ground Signals: Signal Ohms Voltage (sensor connected to harness)
Pressure
Values
> 5 bar
122 ohms
< 5 bar
512 ohms
> 5 bar
2.4V
< 5 bar
5.1V
Fig. 42
If a value of 8V is measured: the component is faulty
2
1
Remarks: An alarm message is displayed when the following elements occur at the same time - Engine running - Transmission oil temperature higher than 50°C - Pressure difference either side of the upper filter exceeds 5 bar - The above 3 points have lasted for over 2 minutes
160 R
510 R
1 2 MA-11-01227A
Possible error codes
Fig. 43
4150: Filter clogged Result: A problem may occur in the transmission if the tractor is not stopped 4156: Signal error Result: No longer possible to monitor 4172: Signal error Result: No longer possible to monitor, breakdown possible
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF403.35
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR14: Tortoise range solenoid valve Description Location: to the right of the transmission (Fig. 44) ON/OFF solenoid valve - Pin 1: Supply signal - Pin 2: Ground Signals: Resistance: 8.8 Ohms Range shifting, for a short time: 1.5A
2
1
Fig. 44
1 2 MA-11-01221A
Fig. 45
Possible error codes 4161: Control error when shifting from Hare to Tortoise mode Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode 41B1: Illogical range engagement Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode
GUF403.36
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR15: Hare range solenoid valve Description Location: to the right of the transmission (Fig. 46) ON/OFF solenoid valve - Pin 1: Supply signal - Pin 2: Ground Signals: Resistance: 8.8 Ohms Range shifting, for a short time: 1.5A
2
1
Fig. 46
1 2 MA-11-01221A
Fig. 47
Possible error codes 4162: Control error when shifting from Tortoise to Hare mode Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode 41B1: Illogical range engagement Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF403.37
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR16: Coupler function solenoid valve Description Location: to the right of the transmission (Fig. 48) Proportional solenoid valve. - Pin 1: Supply signal - Pin 2: Ground Signals: Resistance: 6.4 ohms for a coil temperature of 20°C 9.7 ohms for a coil temperature of 150°C Current: Fig. 48 Coupler function status
Engine speed
Values
stopped
0A
800 rpm
0.46A
1000 rpm
0.74A
1200 rpm
1.23A
1400 rpm
1.71A
over 1400 rpm
1.71A
indifferent
1.71A
ON
2
1
OFF
1 2
MA-11-01229A
Fig. 49
Possible error codes 4164: Error in PWM control 41E0: Coupler function reference curve wrongly interpreted Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode
GUF403.38
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR17: Transmission oil high pressure sensor Description Location: to the right of the transmission (Fig. 50) - Pin 1: Ground - Pin 2: Signal - Pin 3: 8.5V supply NOTE: Prior to serial number N160061, power supply is +12V APC (Ignition key On). Signals: Current: Engine speed
Pressure
Values
stopped
0 bar
4mA
800 rpm
90 bar
6.4mA
150 bar
8mA
200 bar
9.4mA
250 bar
10.8mA
300 bar
12.2mA
350 bar
13.5mA
400 bar
14.9mA
450 bar
16.2mA
480 bar
17mA 3
2
1
over 1400 rpm
Fig. 50
1 2 3
P bar
MA-11-01231A
Fig. 51
Possible error codes 4107: Signal error, 8.5 Volt supply error Result: Shifting from Tortoise to Hare range impossible
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF403.39
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR18: Transmission control unit Description Location: to the right of the transmission (Fig. 52) -
Pin 1: Not used Pin 2: Transmission CAN High Pin 3: FWD/REV Reference Pin 4: +12V APC (Ignition key ON) Pin 5: Transmission CAN Low Pin 6: 12V supply from Autotronic 4 Pin 7: Analog ground (sensor ground) Pin 8: Ground
Signals: Fig. 52 Pins 2
3
Values 1.5V / 2.5V
If 2.4V: slowly turn limp home mode control to the 2.4V or 5V left. If 5V: slowly turn limp home mode control to the right. 12V: battery voltage
4
5
Comments
Voltage must remain constant. The maximum drop in voltage allowed is 1V.
2.5V / 3.5V
Possible error codes (see next page)
GUF403.40
¤ H
1
2
3
4
8
7
6
5
MA-11-01232A
Fig. 53
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes Possible error codes 4128: Signal error Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode 41A0: Control of control module interrupted Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode 41A1: The rotational angle is mechanically limited, but not by the TR24 speed limitation solenoid valve. Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode 41A2: The CAN network control is interrupted Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode 41A3: Increment sensor signal (internal actual position sensor) interrupted or illogical Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode 41A4: Autotronic 4 signal interrupted or illogical Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode 41A5: Reference output (Position “0”) not found when ignition switched on Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode 41A6: Reference point signal interrupted during operation Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF403.41
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR19: Summing shaft speed sensor Description Location: to the right of the transmission (Fig. 54) Hall effect sensor. -
Pin 1: Ground Pin 2: Speed signal Pin 3: 8.5V supply Pin 4: Rotational direction signal
Signals: Speed signal (2): Speed greater than 5 kph: 3V Tractor when stopped: 1V or 5V (depending on presence or absence of a gear tooth)
Fig. 54
If a value of 7.3V is measured: the component is faulty
4
Rotational direction signal (4) Forward speed greater than 5 kph: 5.1V Reverse speed greater than 5 kph: 2.4V
3 2 1
If a value of 8V is measured: the component is faulty
4 3 2 1 Possible error codes
MA-11-1225A
Fig. 55
4131: Signal error Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode 4142: Signal error Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode 4182: Incoherent speeds result: Driving possible only in limp home mode 4183: Incoherent rotational directions result: Driving possible only in limp home mode
GUF403.42
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR20: Parking brake switch Description Location: • to the right on the rear axle (MI130/160 Fig. 56) • to the left on the rear axle (MI200 Fig. 57) The switches are closed when the brake is engaged. - Pins 1 and 2: Not used - Pin 3: Signal - Pin 4: Ground Signals: Signal Ohms Voltage (sensor connected to harness)
Handbrake
Values
engaged
510 ohms
released
121 ohms
engaged
5.1V
TR2
released
2.4V
TR5
Fig. 56
TR6
When starting, the transmission moves to neutral position after 2O seconds if the parking brake is not deactivated.
TR20
TR7
TR3 MA-11-01452A
Fig. 57
Possible error codes 4124: Signal error Result: Handbrake error
2
3
4
510 R
160 R
2
3
3,9 R
1
1
4174: Signal error
4 MA-11-01135A
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
Fig. 58
GUF403.43
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR23: Engine speed sensor Description Location: • to the right on the engine spacer (ML130/160 Fig. 59) • to the left on the engine spacer (ML200 Fig. 60) Hall effect sensor. - Pin 1: Ground - Pin 2: Signal - Pin 3: 8.5V supply NOTE: Prior to serial number N160061, power supply is +12V APC (Ignition key On). Signals: Engine running: 1.5V Engine when stopped: 1.1V or 5.4V (depending on presence or absence of a gear tooth)
Fig. 59
If a value of 7.3V is measured: the component is faulty
MA-11-01454A
Fig. 60
Possible error codes
3
4144: Signal error Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode
2 1
3 2
GUF403.44
¤ H
510 R
510 R MA-11-01233A
1 Fig. 61
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes TR24: Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph Description Location: to the right of the transmission (Fig. 62) Proportional solenoid valve. - Pin 1: Supply signal - Pin 2: Ground Signals: Resistance: 6.5 Ohms Current: 800mA +/- 50mA value When the value of the current differs from this value, transmission is limited to 30 kph
2
1
Fig. 62
1 2
MA-11-01234A
Fig. 63
Possible error codes 4163: Control error Result: Maximum speed limited to 30 khp
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF403.45
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes
D . Analysing other error codes 4158: The transmission output speed states over 30% slippage compared to the value given Result: this can happen when used in extremely cold temperatures; continued use of the transmission can heat the oil, causing serious failures 4159: Manual engagement of limp home mode without reason, fault in limp home mode 41B0: Initialisation error Result: Limited transfer of data to the CAN network 41EE: Calibration error or sensor value out-of-tolerances Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode 41EF: Calibration error or sensor value out-of-tolerances Result: Driving possible only in limp home mode
Calibration error Errors
Description
Solutions
41D1
Incorrect preliminary operations for transmission calibration
41D2
After switching the ignition off, the Autotronic 4 - Check the connection with the transmission control internal relay does not break down module (TR18) - Change the Autotronic 4
41D3
The control module does not control with the exact specified value
Check the mobility of the transmission control by engaging limp home mode for example.
41D4
Transmission ratio adjustment not performed within 8 seconds time.
Check the mobility of the transmission control by engaging limp home mode for example.
41D5
Step 1: Neutral position "0" cannot be found in the forward direction Step 2: Neutral position "0" cannot be found in the reverse direction
Check the connection with the transmission control module (TR18)
41D6
Transmission ratio adjustment not performed within 8 seconds time.
Check the mobility of the transmission control by engaging limp home mode for example
41D7
Step 2: The forward and reverse "0" neutral positions are more than 8° apart
Check the connection with the transmission control module (TR18)
GUF403.46
¤ H
Ensure that all steps are followed (see GUF404)
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes
Errors
Description
Solutions Check the connection with the transmission control module (TR18)
41D8
Step 3: Maximum forward transmission point (which should be between 155° and 187°) not found Step 4: Maximum reverse transmission point (which should be between 136° and 165°) not found
41D9
Step 3: Transmission adjustment reacts at less Check the connection with the transmission control module (TR18) than 155° in the forward position Step 4: Transmission adjustment reacts at less than 135° in the reverse position
The transmission characteristic is not logical. 41DA Reverse position is identified when forward position is selected
Check the summing shaft speed sensor signal (TR19)
Step 7 : Examination of values measured during - First correct the 41D2 error if it appeared 41DB steps 1 to 6: incorrect transmission ratio - Repeat calibration - Check the mobility of the transmission control by engaging limp home mode for example 41DC - Measure the transmission hydraulic pressures The programmed and parameterised values are Reprogram and set parameters correctly. 41DD incorrect Incorrect transmission ratio 41DE
41DF
Maximum transmission ratio in forward and/or - Check the state and operation of the speed limiting reverse position not reached solenoid valve at 30kph (TR24 ) - Repeat calibration
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
- First correct the 41D2 error if it appeared - Repeat calibration - Check the mobility of the transmission control by engaging limp home mode for example - Measure the transmission hydraulic pressures
GUF403.47
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Error codes
GUF403.48
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Calibration
GUF404 - AUTOTRONIC 4 - Calibration
CONTENTS A . Input at level 1 - CAL 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Hare / Tortoise range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 C . Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 D . Coupler function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 E . Power take-off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF404.1
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Calibration
GUF404.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Calibration Calibration of the following Autotronic 4 functions is necessary for optimal performance: - Hare / Tortoise range - transmission - coupler function Calibration of the power take-off is also possible with special tools if there is a problem when starting.
A . Input at level 1 - CAL 1
IMPORTANT: In order to carry out a calibration, possible error codes must be corrected. If an error code is active: calibration automatically enters error mode.
MA-11-01116A
Fig. 1
To select CAL 1 1. Start the engine. 2. Engage and release the clutch pedal in order to delete the “TC” “DC” display from the screen on the right-hand side of the instrument panel. 3. Within the next five seconds, simultaneously press keys ⇐ and ⇑ on the DOT MATRIX control keyboard. 4. The screen Fig. 1 appears, displaying the 4 symbols of the functions to be calibrated: Hare / Tortoise range
Transmission
Coupler function
Power take-off The selected function is displayed in reverse video. 5. Before starting calibration, ensure the tractor is in a suitable condition (see relevant §: B, C, D and E) 6. Select the function to be calibrated using buttons ⇐ and ⇒ of the DOT MATRIX control keyboard, then press “OK”. NOTE: this procedure is to be repeated for each calibration.
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF404.3
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Calibration
B . Hare / Tortoise range Calibration procedure This calibration must be carried out systematically after replacing either of the following: - Hare range solenoid valve - Tortoise range solenoid valve - Range position sensor - Autotronic 4
Preliminary operations 1. 2. 3. 4.
Handbrake (or ParkLock) disengaged Left-hand lever in neutral position Clutch pedal pressed down Engine speed less than 1000 rpm
MA-11-01117A
Fig. 2
Calibration 5. Having selected
in the CAL 1 screen
(Fig. 1), press “OK” to start calibration. 6. Calibration takes place for approximately 6 seconds in 3 steps, which are displayed consecutively on the screen Fig. 2: - Step 0: Tortoise range - Step 1: Hare range - Step 2: Neutral (intermediate position) 7. The calibration result is displayed: - “OK”: successful calibration (Because calibration ends by moving the transmission to neutral, the Hare / Tortoise symbols flash alternately on the right-hand screen) - “ERROR”: calibration failed (repair the fault before resuming the procedure). 8. Switch off the ignition key for at least 8 seconds to validate calibration.
GUF404.4
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Calibration
C . Transmission Calibration procedure This calibration must be carried out systematically after replacing either of the following: - Transmission control unit - Transmission - Transmission high pressure sensor - Autotronic 4
Preliminary operations Calibration must be carried out just after the range has been calibrated. 1. Handbrake applied or ParkLock engaged 2. Left-hand lever in neutral position 3. Hare / Tortoise range in neutral (Hare / Tortoise symbols flash alternately on the right-hand screen) because calibration of the range has been carried out at the previous step.
2
RATIO +10000 MA-11-01118A
Fig. 3
Calibration 4. Having selected
in the CAL 1 screen
(Fig. 1), press “OK” to start calibration. 5. Engine speed automatically adjusts to 1600 rpm. 6. Hare / Tortoise symbols continue to flash alternately. 7. Calibration takes place for approximately 6 minutes in 7 steps, which are displayed consecutively on the screen Fig. 3. These 7 steps allow calibration of the hydraulic motors and pumps. 8. The calibration result is displayed: - “OK”: successful calibration (Fig. 4). - “ERROR”: calibration failed (repair the fault before resuming the procedure). 9. Switch off the ignition key for at least 8 seconds to validate calibration.
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
OK RATIOTLPH -00221 MA-11-01121A
Fig. 4
GUF404.5
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Calibration
D . Coupler function Calibration procedure This calibration must be carried out systematically after replacing either of the following: - Coupler function solenoid valve - Transmission oil high pressure sensor - Autotronic 4
Preliminary operations 1. Transmission temperature ≥ at 40°C (1) [Recommendation: do not cancel calibration if the value is too low]. 2. Handbrake applied or ParkLock engaged 3. Left-hand lever in neutral position 4. Hare range engaged.
032 MA-11-01119A
Fig. 5
Calibration 5. Having selected
6. 7.
8.
9.
in the CAL 1 screen
(Fig. 1), press “OK” to start calibration. Engine speed automatically adjusts to 1100 rpm. Calibration takes place for approximately 2 minutes in 9 steps, which are displayed consecutively on the screen Fig. 5. These 9 steps allow calibration of the solenoid valve current. The calibration result is displayed: - “OK”: successful calibration - “ERROR”: calibration failed (repair the fault before resuming the procedure). Switch off the ignition key for at least 8 seconds to validate calibration.
(1)
There are 2 ways to view the transmission temperature: - The value can be viewed in the Wintest gearbox screen - Using the DIAG mode of the DCC2 by means of DOT MATRIX: • Press for 3 seconds on ⇑. • Select DATA (in reverse video) then press “OK”. • The value is indicated by the “Trans Temp” line.
GUF404.6
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Calibration
E . Power take-off Calibration procedure This calibration must be performed only in case of a starting problem due to high inertia implement and therefore when replacing the PTO solenoid valve.
Preliminary operations 1. Handbrake applied or ParkLock engaged 2. Left-hand lever in neutral position 3. Select a PTO speed (540, 540ECO or 1000 rpm) depending on the implement. MA-11-01120A
Calibration
Fig. 6 4. Having selected
5. 6. 7.
8.
(Fig. 1), press “OK” to start calibration. Engage the PTO. Calibration takes place automatically, the time taken depending on the implement. The calibration result is displayed: - “OK”: successful calibration - “ERROR”: calibration failed Switch off the ignition key for at least 8 seconds to validate calibration.
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
in the CAL 1 screen
GUF404.7
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Calibration
GUF404.8
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams
GUF405 - AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Electrical diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 C . Layout of components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF405.1
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams
GUF405.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
CAB83 OFF
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CAB83
R S2
MA-10-01000A
CAB37.6/CAB83.1 B CAB37.7/CAB83.3 B
6
7
5 3
4 2
11 10 9
1
FAI 03 FAI 48
8
CAB37
12
- Components with only one connector are identified by the connector name: CAB83 - Suspended front axle switch (Fig. 1). - Harnesses performing the same funtions have the same colour on the diagram (Fig. 1): • FAI03 - Dynashift console harness (green) • FAI48 - DynaVT console harness (green) - All wires can be identified by the pins of the outgoing and incoming connectors of the harness: CAB37.6/CAB83.1: The wire connects pin 6 of the CAB37 connector to pin 1 of the CAB83 connector - The detail of pins allocation for each connector is shown on the harness side - The wire colour is indicated: CAB37.6/CAB83.1 B, the wire is white List of colours: - N: Black - M: Brown - R: Red - B: White - J: Yellow - V: Green - The splices inside the harnesses are indicated by a dot and the letter S (S2).
S2.1/CAB83.2
The harnesses fitted on the tractor allow data to be exchanged and power to be supplied to the electrical and electronic systems. The tractor is fitted with 3 different types of power supply: • +12V Battery (Permanent) • +12V APC (Ignition key ON) • +12V ACC (Accessories) Most harnesses have a maximum of six different wire colours: - Black: Ground - Brown: +12V Permanent - Red: +12V APC (Ignition key ON) and Accessories - White: Information - Yellow: CAN High - Green: CAN Low The CAN network wires (yellow and green) are twisted together.
R
Description
In general, the components or connectors are named in order to indicate the corresponding elements of the tractor: AC## Armrest BAF## Fuse box CA## Automatic air conditioning CAB## Cab ENG## Engine FA## Suspended front axle L## Linkage - ParkLock (HA) LIG## Lighting R## Linkage and roof ROOF##Roof TR## Transmission V# Electrohydraulic spool valve X# Round battery cable terminal on fuse box
BAF12.2/S2.1
A . General
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
CAB37 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
Fig. 1
GUF405.3
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams Layout 5 Deutsch connectors (31-way) are connected to the cab: - 2 on the front panel Fig. 2) - 3 at the bottom rear right-hand side of the cab (Fig. 3).
ENG1
Fig. 2: All these connectors belong to the engine harness. ENG2 is dedicated to information concerning the electronic injection.
ENG2
Fig. 3: Always in the following order (regardless of tractor configuration and options), from left to right: L14 Linkage harness junction CAB50 Transmission harness junction LIG1 Lighting harness junction
MA-10-01003A
Fig. 2
L14
LIG1
+12V
MA-10-01002A
14
16
13
15
17
12 11
10 9
8 7
6 5
4 3
2 1
BAF10
F9- 15A +APC
1 X2 F48 - 7.5A
+12V
1 X4 18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
F48
MA-10-01001A
2
GUF405.4
¤ H
Fig. 3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
18
BAF12
The fuses and relays of the electrical or electronic board (Fig. 4) are indicated by a black mark on their locations on the fuse box (2).
CAB50
F9
Fig. 4
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams
B . Electrical diagrams Autotronic 4 electrical power supply.......................... 7 MF7400 transmission ................................................ 9 MF8400 transmission .............................................. 11 CAB19 detailed view: PowerControl lever ............... 12 4WD front axle ......................................................... 13 Differential lock - tractor with EHRC linkage calculator ..... 15 Differential lock - tractor with Autotronic 5 linkage calculator .................................................................. 17 PTO control module electrical power supply (CAB61)....... 19 MF7400PTO............................................................. 21 MF8400PTO............................................................. 23 CAN network - Perkins engine - EHRC linkage calculator ....................................................................... 25 CAN network - SisuDiesel engine - EHRC linkage calculator .......................................................................... 27 CAN network - SisuDiesel engine - Autotronic 5 linkage calculator .................................................................. 29
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF405.5
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 09 FAI 23 FAI 28 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37 FAI 41 FAI 48 FAI 124 FAI 127 FAI 129 FAI 130 FAI 131 FAI 135
Cab interior lighting harness Cab linkage harness Perkins EEM engine harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness (7400) Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) DynaVT armrest harness DynaVT console harness Pillar harness Cab interior lighting harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness DynaVT transmission harness (8400) Datatronic 3 harness Lights module and radio ground harness
Component parts list AC7 AC8 AC11 AC13 BOC1 CAB1 CAB10 CAB11 CAB12 CAB19 CAB44 CAB53 CAB54 CAB59 CAB61 CAB66 CAB67 CAB70 CAB76 CAB77 CAB78 CAB79 CAB80 L3 LIG11 LIG15 TR2 TR3 TR4
SV1 speed selector switch SV2 speed selector switch Armrest lever potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch Instrument panel (DCC2) Right-hand brake switch Left-hand brake switch Top-of-Clutch (TOC) progressivity sensor PowerControl lever Throttle pedal potentiometer Emergency control switch Autotronic 4 PTO automation switch PTO control module Differential lock switch 4WD switch PTO ON/OFF switch Hare / Tortoise range selector switch (lever / pedal) mode selector switch Underspeed supervisor potentiometer SV1 encoder SV2 encoder Linkage position sensor PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders Reversing light junction PTO solenoid valve 1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve 540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (MF7400
GUF405.6
¤ H
TR5 TR6 TR7 TR8 TR9 TR10 TR11 TR12 TR13 TR14 TR15 TR16 TR17 TR18 TR19 TR20 TR23 TR24 TR25 TR26 TR33 TR34
2 3 5 6 15 32
only) 4 WD solenoid valve 540E rpm (or 540 rpm) PTO speed solenoid valve (MF8400) Differential lock solenoid valve Hare / Tortoise range position sensor PTO shaft speed sensor PTO clutch speed sensor Bevel gear design speed sensor Transmission oil temperature sensor Transmission filter clogging switch Tortoise range solenoid valve Hare range solenoid valve Coupler function solenoid valve Transmission oil high pressure sensor Transmission control unit Summing shaft speed sensor Park brake switch Engine speed sensor Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging sensor Direction pressure switch 18 bar pressure switch on brake assistance supply Fuse box Start switch Inside cab Left-hand fender Top-of-Clutch (TOC) pedal switch Safety switch
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams
Autotronic 4 electrical power supply
CAB54
46 24 1
68 45 23
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
CAB54
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
R
CAB97
3
2
1
CAB73-1
1
BAF1.3/CAB97.1
S8
2 14 13
12 11
10 9
8 7
6 5
4 3
2 1
BAF1
15
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
16
BAF1
17
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
18
FAI124
4
CAB73.1.1/CAB54.55
1 2 3 4
M M M M M
1 2 3 4
S8.1/CAB54.56 S8.1/CAB54.57 S8.1/CAB54.58 S8.1/CAB54.59 S8.1/CAB54.60
2
M
1
CAB97
FAI 31
CAB54.54/S8.1
4
CAB97.4/CAB54.28
3
N
R
CAB54
F12
1
3
5
7
9
11
13
15
17
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
18
16
F62
F12
- 15A
X2
1 X12
F62
2
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
- 50A
+12V
1
X4
1 X12
S8.1/X12.1
M
MA-10-06067A
+12V
1
GUF405.7
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 09 FAI 23 FAI 28 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37
Cab interior lighting harness Cab linkage harness Perkins EEM engine harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness (7400) Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 41 DynaVT armrest harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 124Pillar harness FAI 127Cab interior lighting harness FAI 129SisuDiesel EEM engine harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness (8400) FAI 131Datatronic 3 harness FAI 135Lights module and radio ground harness
Component parts list AC7 AC8 AC11 AC13
SV1 speed selector switch SV2 speed selector switch Armrest lever potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch BOC1 Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB10 Right-hand brake switch CAB11 Left-hand brake switch CAB12 Top-of-Clutch (TOC) progressivity sensor CAB19 PowerControl lever CAB44 Throttle pedal potentiometer CAB53 Emergency control switch CAB54 Autotronic 4 CAB59 PTO automation switch CAB61 PTO control module CAB66 Differential lock switch CAB67 4WD switch CAB70 PTO ON/OFF switch CAB76 Hare / Tortoise range selector switch CAB77 (lever / pedal) mode selector switch CAB78 Underspeed supervisor potentiometer CAB79 SV1 encoder CAB80 SV2 encoder L3 Linkage position sensor LIG11 PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders LIG15 Reversing light junction TR2 PTO solenoid valve TR3 1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve TR4 540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (MF7400
GUF405.8
¤ H
TR5 TR6 TR7 TR8 TR9 TR10 TR11 TR12 TR13 TR14 TR15 TR16 TR17 TR18 TR19 TR20 TR23 TR24 TR25 TR26 TR33 TR34
2 3 5 6 15 32
only) 4 WD solenoid valve 540E rpm (or 540 rpm) PTO speed solenoid valve (MF8400) Differential lock solenoid valve Hare / Tortoise range position sensor PTO shaft speed sensor PTO clutch speed sensor Bevel gear design speed sensor Transmission oil temperature sensor Transmission filter clogging switch Tortoise range solenoid valve Hare range solenoid valve Coupler function solenoid valve Transmission oil high pressure sensor Transmission control unit Summing shaft speed sensor Park brake switch Engine speed sensor Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging sensor Direction pressure switch 18 bar pressure switch on brake assistance supply Fuse box Start switch Inside cab Left-hand fender Top-of-Clutch (TOC) pedal switch Safety switch
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams
MF7400 transmission 1000 540E
540
V4
V3 1
3
2
to starter relay
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
TR34 TR34
ENG2 ENG2
S1.1/TR33.1
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
R
TR34.2/ENG10.7
B
MA-11-01155C
GUF405.9
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 09 FAI 23 FAI 28 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37
Cab interior lighting harness Cab linkage harness Perkins EEM engine harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness (7400) Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 41 DynaVT armrest harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 124Pillar harness FAI 127Cab interior lighting harness FAI 129SisuDiesel EEM engine harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness (8400) FAI 131Datatronic 3 harness FAI 135Lights module and radio ground harness
Component parts list AC7 AC8 AC11 AC13
SV1 speed selector switch SV2 speed selector switch Armrest lever potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch BOC1 Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB10 Right-hand brake switch CAB11 Left-hand brake switch CAB12 Top-of-Clutch (TOC) progressivity sensor CAB19 PowerControl lever CAB44 Throttle pedal potentiometer CAB53 Emergency control switch CAB54 Autotronic 4 CAB59 PTO automation switch CAB61 PTO control module CAB66 Differential lock switch CAB67 4WD switch CAB70 PTO ON/OFF switch CAB76 Hare / Tortoise range selector switch CAB77 (lever / pedal) mode selector switch CAB78 Underspeed supervisor potentiometer CAB79 SV1 encoder CAB80 SV2 encoder L3 Linkage position sensor LIG11 PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders LIG15 Reversing light junction TR2 PTO solenoid valve TR3 1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve TR4 540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (MF7400
GUF405.10
¤ H
TR5 TR6 TR7 TR8 TR9 TR10 TR11 TR12 TR13 TR14 TR15 TR16 TR17 TR18 TR19 TR20 TR23 TR24 TR25 TR26 TR33 TR34
2 3 5 6 15 32
only) 4 WD solenoid valve 540E rpm (or 540 rpm) PTO speed solenoid valve (MF8400) Differential lock solenoid valve Hare / Tortoise range position sensor PTO shaft speed sensor PTO clutch speed sensor Bevel gear design speed sensor Transmission oil temperature sensor Transmission filter clogging switch Tortoise range solenoid valve Hare range solenoid valve Coupler function solenoid valve Transmission oil high pressure sensor Transmission control unit Summing shaft speed sensor Park brake switch Engine speed sensor Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging sensor Direction pressure switch 18 bar pressure switch on brake assistance supply Fuse box Start switch Inside cab Left-hand fender Top-of-Clutch (TOC) pedal switch Safety switch
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams
MF8400 transmission
S4.1/BAF12.5
B
CAB 61
BAF12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
BAF12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
X2
1
X1X5
1
CAB 54 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
K1.1 R510
R510
R510
R510
R510
R510
R510
R160
R160
R160
R160
R160
R160
R160
R510
K1.3
R510
K1.3
R953
R383
2 x 1W 12 Volts
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F16 - 30A
F17 - 3A
540
NEUTRE
540E
1000
BAF7 BAF7
F22 - 10A
FAI 31
CAB50.2/CAB54.61 B CAB50.3/CAB54.62 B
CAB54.50/S7.1 B CAB50.1/CAB54.51 B
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI 31
CAB35.1/CAB14.2
B
CAB76.1/CAB61.8
B
S5.1/CAB50.14
BAF12.3/S7.1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB50
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB18
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB50
B
CAB14
1 2
B B B
R
N
TR15.1/CAB50.3 TR14.1/CAB50.2 TR24.1/CAB50.1
CAB50.8/TR18.6
R
TR14 TR18
TR24 1 2
1 2 3 4
TR 8
TR14.2/TR31.1 TR24.2/TR31.1 TR18.8/TR31.1 TR15.2/TR31.1
TR11 S2.1/TR11.1 TR11.3/S4.1
N N N N
1
TR 16
S2.1/TR17.1 N TR17.2/CAB50.13 TR17.3/S4.1 R
TR25.1/CAB50.27
AC2
A B C D E F G H J K
A B C D E F G H J K
TR 19
1 2 3 4
K J H G F E D C B A
K J H G F E D C B A
TR12.1/CAB50.12 S2.1/TR12.2 N
B
TR13
TR 13
TR13.1/CAB50.11 S2.1/TR13.2 N
1 2
B
TR20
TR 20
TR23
1 2 3 4
TR20.3/CAB50.20 B TR20.4/S2.1 N
TR23.3/S4.1 R TR23.2/CAB50.29 TR23.1/S2.1 N
3 2 1 TR23
ENG1.18/CAB18.4
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
B
2 1
FAI 41
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
3 2 1
AC 8
CAB 12
CAB12
S_4 S4.1/AC8.1 R S4.1/AC7.2 R AC7.1/AC2.12 B
BAF7.1/CAB11.2 B BAF7.3/CAB10.2 B
AC 7
2 1
CAB80.2/CAB57.A CAB80.3/CAB57.B
CAB 77
CAB56.H/CAB28.1
CAB10
4 3 2 1
CAB28
FAI 35
1
CAB19.5/CAB14.4 CAB12.1/CAB28.1
N
CAB11
B B
CAB13.1/CAB1.13
CAB57.K/CAB1.53 CAB57.J/CAB1.54 CAB57.H/CAB1.59 CAB1.8/CAB57.G CAB1.7/CAB57.F CAB57.E/CAB1.6 CAB57.D/CAB1.46 CAB1.47/CAB57.C CAB57.B/CAB1.48 CAB57.A/CAB1.49
B B B N B R B B B B
CAB14.4/CAB1.20 CAB19.6/CAB1.58 S__1
B B
CAB19.4/S1.1 B CAB19.3/CAB1.42 N CAB19.2/CAB1.41 B CAB19.1/CAB1.40 R
CAB 80
1 2 3
6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB 79
1 2 3
S1.1/CAB1.57
6 5 4 3 2 1
B
CAB 19
CAB19
FAI 35
CAB44.1/CAB1.11 S18.1/CAB1.10
CAB78 R N B
B
CAB19
CAB79 S1.1/CAB79.1 R CAB79.2/CAB57.C B CAB57.D/CAB79.3 B
CAB 11
B N CAB1.44/CAB56.J B CAB56.K/S5.1 R
FAI 31
CAB57.E/CAB78.1 CAB57.G/CAB78.2 CAB78.3/CAB57.F
CAB 10
4 3 2 1
ENG1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
N B
CAB 78
1 2 3
TR25
TR 25
1 2
ENG10 ENG10 1
FAI129 ENG1.8/S7.1
B
ENG10.2/ENG9.1 N ENG9 S7
ENG1.22/ENG10.8 B ENG1.18/ENG10.9 B
S7.1/ENG10.5
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F6- 10A
2
BAF11
AC8
CAB57 CAB57
TR12
VERS BAF10 - 2
to starter relay
S5.1/CAB12.2 R CAB12.3/CAB1.4 B
S18
B
B ENG1
1 2
AC 11
AC11
CAB10.3/CAB28.1 N CAB28.1/CAB11.3 N CAB56.C/CAB10.4 B CAB11.4/CAB56.D B
CAB80
TR 12
B R B
F37 - 5A
1
FAI 31
TR19
TR17 1 2 3
1 2
1 S2.1/TR19.1 N TR19.2/CAB50.18 B TR19.3/S4.1 R TR19.4/CAB50.19 B
AC11.3/AC2.3 AC11.2/AC2.4 AC8.2/AC2.11
1 2 3
1 2
TR30
TR8.3/TR50.15 B TR8.2/S4.1 R S2.1/TR8.1 N
3 2 1
N
CAB56 CAB56
TR31
TR16 TR16.1/CAB50.28 B TR16.2/TR31.1 N
AC11.1/AC2.1
AC7
S4
R
15
1
R11
BAF11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB43
BOC 1
CAB77
S2
N
TR8
TR 17
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
S5
S5.1/CAB14.5 R S5.1/CAB43.1 R
BOC1
CAB14
B R
R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 AC2
TR 18
CAB56.J/AC2.3 CAB56.K/AC2.4
TR18.4/CAB50.6
TR 11
R
FAI130
1 2
TR 24
1
FAI 35 3 2 1
CAB13
S1.1/CAB80.1 R AC2.11/CAB57.J B AC2.12/CAB57.K B CAB77.1/CAB57.H B AC2.1/CAB56.H N
TR 14
CAB73 1
N
R
3
1
BAF9 BAF9
N B AC2.2/S1.1
CAB50.10/S2.1
1 2
S4.1/CAB50.14
B B TR11.4/CAB50.17 TR11.2/CAB50.16
TR15
CAB77.2/CAB73.1.1
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
CAB 76
S1
CAB 44
B
CAB1.19/CAB14.3 B CAB14.3/BOC1.1 B CAB14.5/BOC1.2 B CAB14.3/BOC1.3 B
CAB76
CAB76.2/CAB73.1.1 N
TR 15
FAI 35
CAB35
CAB50.9/CAB73.1.1 N S1.1/CAB50.6 R
32
5
2 4
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
3 2 1
SEC2
CAB44.2/S5.1
FAI 35
TR18.7/CAB50.9 TR18.3/CAB50.5
V2
CAB44
CAB37 CAB37
V1
BAF8 BAF8
FAI 35
FAI 11
1
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
R
CAB18
CAB 53
1
CAB14.1/BAF9.14 BAF11.2/S1.1 R
AC2.2/S4.1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3
SEC1
1
CAB44.3/S18.1
FAI 31
R
B
B
3
S7.1/CAB50.28
CAB18.3/CAB50.27
B
S7_
CAB53.1/S4.1 B CAB53.2/CAB37.10 B
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
B
CAB50.11/CAB54.45 B
CAB54.39/CAB56.D B CAB54.40/CAB61.9 B
CAB54.42/CAB50.19 B
CAB54.34/CAB50.16 B
CAB54.29/CAB50.13 B CAB54.30/CAB18.4 B
R CAB54.23/S5.1
CAB54.21/CAB50.20 B
CAB54.18/CAB50.17 B CAB50.5/CAB54.19 B
CAB54.15/CAB50.12 B CAB54.16/CAB56.C B
B S4.1/CAB54.10
CAB54.12/CAB50.29 B CAB54.13/CAB50.18 B
CAB54.6/CAB50.15 B
S5_
CAB53
O O
CAB61
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 CAB50.10/CAB54.1 N CAB50.8/CAB54.2 R
CAB54
BAF8.5/S5.1 R S4
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB14.1/SEC1.1 CAB14.2/SEC2.1
CAB61
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
CAB37.10/CAB14.3
CAB54
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
S3.1/ENG10.2
N
ENG10.5/S1.1
R
S3
S3.1/TR25.2
FAI 35
N
68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB1
TR26 S_1
TR26.2/S1.1
1 2
R
CAB1 CAB1
TR 26
FAI130 TR26.1/ENG10.8
B
TR33 S1.1/TR33.1
ENG10.9/TR33.2
B
R
1 2
TR 33
MA-11-01443A
CAB1.55/ENG1.22 B CAB1.67/CAB18.3 B BAF7.7/ENG1.8 B
GUF405.11
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list
CAB19 detailed view: PowerControl lever 1
1KOhm
1KOhm
S1 24KOhm
S2
36KOhm
2.55KOhm
10KOhm
2.4KOhm
2KOhm
S3 15,8KOhm
2 S7
100KOhm
2KOhm
S4 560Ohm 10KOhm
2.55KOhm
S5
2.4KOhm
1.5KOhm
24KOhm
3
34KOhm
S6
1KOhm
4 5
FAI 09 FAI 23 FAI 28 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37
Cab interior lighting harness Cab linkage harness Perkins EEM engine harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness (7400) Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 41 DynaVT armrest harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 124Pillar harness FAI 127Cab interior lighting harness FAI 129SisuDiesel EEM engine harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness (8400) FAI 131Datatronic 3 harness FAI 135Lights module and radio ground harness
6
Component parts list AC7 AC8 AC11 AC13
6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6
MA-11-01308A
Pin
Description
1
5V supply
2
Signal
3
Ground
4
Neutral (NC)
5
Neutral switch supply (12V)
6
Neutral (NO)
Lever position High (declutched) Forward + Front Forward Neutral Reverse Rear Reverse +
Switch None S1 + S2 + S3 S1 + S2 S1 + S2 + S4 S7 S5 + S6 +S4 S5 + S6 S5 + S6 + S3
Signal in volts 2.5 4 3.5 3 0.5 2 1.5 1
SV1 speed selector switch SV2 speed selector switch Armrest lever potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch BOC1 Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB10 Right-hand brake switch CAB11 Left-hand brake switch CAB12 Top-of-Clutch (TOC) progressivity sensor CAB19 PowerControl lever CAB44 Throttle pedal potentiometer CAB53 Emergency control switch CAB54 Autotronic 4 CAB59 PTO automation switch CAB61 PTO control module CAB66 Differential lock switch CAB67 4WD switch CAB70 PTO ON/OFF switch CAB76 Hare / Tortoise range selector switch CAB77 (lever / pedal) mode selector switch CAB78 Underspeed supervisor potentiometer CAB79 SV1 encoder CAB80 SV2 encoder L3 Linkage position sensor LIG11 PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders LIG15 Reversing light junction TR2 PTO solenoid valve TR3 1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve TR4 540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (MF7400
GUF405.12
¤ H
TR5 TR6 TR7 TR8 TR9 TR10 TR11 TR12 TR13 TR14 TR15 TR16 TR17 TR18 TR19 TR20 TR23 TR24 TR25 TR26 TR33 TR34
2 3 5 6 15 32
only) 4 WD solenoid valve 540E rpm (or 540 rpm) PTO speed solenoid valve (MF8400) Differential lock solenoid valve Hare / Tortoise range position sensor PTO shaft speed sensor PTO clutch speed sensor Bevel gear design speed sensor Transmission oil temperature sensor Transmission filter clogging switch Tortoise range solenoid valve Hare range solenoid valve Coupler function solenoid valve Transmission oil high pressure sensor Transmission control unit Summing shaft speed sensor Park brake switch Engine speed sensor Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging sensor Direction pressure switch 18 bar pressure switch on brake assistance supply Fuse box Start switch Inside cab Left-hand fender Top-of-Clutch (TOC) pedal switch Safety switch
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams 4WD front axle K1.1 R510
R510
R510
R510
R510
R510
R510
R160
R160
R160
R160
R160
R160
R160
R510
K1.3
R510
K1.3
R953
R383
2 x 1W 12 Volts
NEUTRE
540
750
1000
TR 11 4
21
19
17
15
13
22
20
18
16
14
CAB 61
CAB61
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 11 12
9
7
5
3
1
10
8
6
4
2
TR11.4/CAB50.17 TR11.3/S4.1 R TR11.2/CAB50.16 S2.1/TR11.1 N
3
B
13
21 10 11 12
CAB50 CAB50 22
46 24 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
24
25
B
R S4
S4.1/CAB50.14R
FAI 31 CAB54.31/CAB61.15
B
CAB54.34/CAB50.16
B
CAB54.39/CAB56.D
B
CAB54.64/CAB50.24
B
K
J
H
G
F
A
B
C
D
E
21 22 23
23
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
10 11 12 24
20 9 3 4 13 25
8 2 1 5 14
31 19 7 6 15 26
FAI 32
30 18 17 16
29 28
27
TR 5 S2
CAB50.10/S2.1 N
TR5 TR5.1/CAB50.24 TR5.2/TR30.1
S4
S4.1/CAB50.14 R
FAI 35 K J H G F E D C B A
K J H G F E D C B A
B
1 2
N
1
1
F
G
H
J
K
E
D
C
B
A
BAF7.3/CAB10.2 B BAF7.1/CAB11.2 B
CAB11.4/CAB56.D B CAB56.C/CAB10.4 B
2
TR30
1
3
2
5 14
9
4
4
26
1
3
15
20 8 2
B
CAB54.18/CAB50.17
CAB54.23/S4.1
7 6
6
68 45 23
CAB54.16/CAB56.C
31 19
5
16 27
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F17- 7.5A
BAF7
1
CAB 67
CAB56 CAB56
1
2
3
7 4
5
6
8
18 17
8
30 29 28
7
B
9
CAB54.9/CAB61.17
TR11
10
N
S4.1/CAB61.13R
CAB 54
CAB50.10/CAB54.1
1
4 3 2 1
B
CAB54 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
2
X2
+APC
CAB10.3/CAB28.1 N
2
CAB28.1/CAB11.3 N
CAB67 +8
-7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
3
2
CAB61.16/CAB67.2 B CAB67.3/S4.1 R 1 CAB28 CAB73.1/CAB67.7 N
CAB 11
4
4 3 2 1
3
2
4
1
CAB11
4 3 2 1
3
2
1
CAB 10
CAB10
F17
CAB73 1
FAI 31
CAB 66 1
2
3
7 4
5
6
8
CAB66 +8
-7
3
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CAB66.2/CAB61.14 B CAB66.3/S4.1 R
CAB66.7/CAB73.1 N
2
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
MA-11-01156A
GUF405.13
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 09 FAI 23 FAI 28 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37
Cab interior lighting harness Cab linkage harness Perkins EEM engine harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness (7400) Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 41 DynaVT armrest harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 124Pillar harness FAI 127Cab interior lighting harness FAI 129SisuDiesel EEM engine harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness (8400) FAI 131Datatronic 3 harness FAI 135Lights module and radio ground harness
Component parts list AC7 AC8 AC11 AC13
SV1 speed selector switch SV2 speed selector switch Armrest lever potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch BOC1 Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB10 Right-hand brake switch CAB11 Left-hand brake switch CAB12 Top-of-Clutch (TOC) progressivity sensor CAB19 PowerControl lever CAB44 Throttle pedal potentiometer CAB53 Emergency control switch CAB54 Autotronic 4 CAB59 PTO automation switch CAB61 PTO control module CAB66 Differential lock switch CAB67 4WD switch CAB70 PTO ON/OFF switch CAB76 Hare / Tortoise range selector switch CAB77 (lever / pedal) mode selector switch CAB78 Underspeed supervisor potentiometer CAB79 SV1 encoder CAB80 SV2 encoder L3 Linkage position sensor LIG11 PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders LIG15 Reversing light junction TR2 PTO solenoid valve TR3 1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve TR4 540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (MF7400
GUF405.14
¤ H
TR5 TR6 TR7 TR8 TR9 TR10 TR11 TR12 TR13 TR14 TR15 TR16 TR17 TR18 TR19 TR20 TR23 TR24 TR25 TR26 TR33 TR34
2 3 5 6 15 32
only) 4 WD solenoid valve 540E rpm (or 540 rpm) PTO speed solenoid valve (MF8400) Differential lock solenoid valve Hare / Tortoise range position sensor PTO shaft speed sensor PTO clutch speed sensor Bevel gear design speed sensor Transmission oil temperature sensor Transmission filter clogging switch Tortoise range solenoid valve Hare range solenoid valve Coupler function solenoid valve Transmission oil high pressure sensor Transmission control unit Summing shaft speed sensor Park brake switch Engine speed sensor Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging sensor Direction pressure switch 18 bar pressure switch on brake assistance supply Fuse box Start switch Inside cab Left-hand fender Top-of-Clutch (TOC) pedal switch Safety switch
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams
Differential lock - tractor with EHRC linkage calculator K1.1 R510
R160
R160
R160
540
NEUTRE
750
1000
17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
22
20
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
TR11.4/CAB50.17 B TR11.3/S4.1 R TR11.2/CAB50.16 B S2.1/TR11.1 N
332R
1.3K
R510
R160
19
2
1
4 3 2 1
221R
7
17
18
2
3
TR11 CAB54.18/CAB50.17 B
AC 13
S4.1/CAB61.13R
CAB54.23/S4.1
R
CAB50.10/CAB54.1 N
30 29 28
18 17 16 27
31 19 7 6 15 26
20 8
9
2
3
1
4
5 14
13
21
21
10
10
11 12
22
22
23
23
9 3 4 13 25
8 2 1 5 14
31 19 7 6 15 26
30 18 17 16
29 28
FAI 32
27
AC13 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
B S4
S4.1/CAB50.14R
FAI 31
CAB54.63/CAB50.25
20
CAB50 CAB50
CAB54.34/CAB50.16 B
CAB54.39/CAB56.D
11 12 24
24
25
CAB54.31/CAB61.15 B
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
1 2 3 4 5 7 8 10 1718
10
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
17 18
TR 7 TR7 TR7.1/CAB50.25B TR7.2/TR30.1 N
1 2
S2
CAB50.10/S2.1N
S4
S4.1/CAB50.14R
1 2
1
TR30
FAI 41 S3.1/AC13.7 R
S3
S2.1/AC13.17 N
S2 6 5 4 3 2 1 7 8 9 10 11 12 AC1.3/AC13.2B
FAI 23
1
2
3
4
5
6
AC1.1/S3.1 R
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
AC1 AC1
K
J
H
G
F
A
B
C
D
E
K J H G F E D C B A
K J H G F E D C B A
F
G
H
J
K
E
D
C
B
A
FAI 35 BAF7.3/CAB10.2 B BAF7.1/CAB11.2 B
CAB11.4/CAB56.D CAB56.C/CAB10.4
B B
7
8
9
AC1.2/S2.1 N
10
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F17- 7.5A
BAF7
1 CAB56 CAB56
X2
+APC
FAI 31 CAB10.3/CAB28.1 N
2
S6.1/L13.39 R
3
6 5 7
2 1
4
8
N CAB66.7/CAB73.1
S5
CAB66.2/CAB61.14 CAB66.3/S4.1 R
S5.1/L13.20 N
B
CAB28.1/CAB11.3 N
CAB73
1
1 CAB28
CAB 11
4
4 3 2 1
3
2
4
1
CAB11
4 3 2 1
3
2
1
CAB 10
CAB10
F17
CAB66
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
S6
L13.46/AC1.3 B
3
CAB 66
¤ H
21
3
750R
UP
CAB54.16/CAB56.C B
+8
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
TR 11
CAB 61
CAB61
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
S5.1/AC1.2 N AC1.1/S6.1 R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55
DOWN NEUTRAL
4
L13 L13
R510
19
R510
37
R160
46 24 1
55
1
R510
68 45 23
38 20
R160
CAB 54
R510
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
R160
CAB54
R510
R510
K1.3
R510
K1.3
R953
R383
2 x 1W 12 Volts
2 -7
2
MA-11-01157A
GUF405.15
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 09 FAI 23 FAI 28 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37
Cab interior lighting harness Cab linkage harness Perkins EEM engine harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness (7400) Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 41 DynaVT armrest harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 124Pillar harness FAI 127Cab interior lighting harness FAI 129SisuDiesel EEM engine harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness (8400) FAI 131Datatronic 3 harness FAI 135Lights module and radio ground harness
Component parts list AC7 AC8 AC11 AC13
SV1 speed selector switch SV2 speed selector switch Armrest lever potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch BOC1 Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB10 Right-hand brake switch CAB11 Left-hand brake switch CAB12 Top-of-Clutch (TOC) progressivity sensor CAB19 PowerControl lever CAB44 Throttle pedal potentiometer CAB53 Emergency control switch CAB54 Autotronic 4 CAB59 PTO automation switch CAB61 PTO control module CAB66 Differential lock switch CAB67 4WD switch CAB70 PTO ON/OFF switch CAB76 Hare / Tortoise range selector switch CAB77 (lever / pedal) mode selector switch CAB78 Underspeed supervisor potentiometer CAB79 SV1 encoder CAB80 SV2 encoder L3 Linkage position sensor LIG11 PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders LIG15 Reversing light junction TR2 PTO solenoid valve TR3 1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve TR4 540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (MF7400
GUF405.16
¤ H
TR5 TR6 TR7 TR8 TR9 TR10 TR11 TR12 TR13 TR14 TR15 TR16 TR17 TR18 TR19 TR20 TR23 TR24 TR25 TR26 TR33 TR34
2 3 5 6 15 32
only) 4 WD solenoid valve 540E rpm (or 540 rpm) PTO speed solenoid valve (MF8400) Differential lock solenoid valve Hare / Tortoise range position sensor PTO shaft speed sensor PTO clutch speed sensor Bevel gear design speed sensor Transmission oil temperature sensor Transmission filter clogging switch Tortoise range solenoid valve Hare range solenoid valve Coupler function solenoid valve Transmission oil high pressure sensor Transmission control unit Summing shaft speed sensor Park brake switch Engine speed sensor Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging sensor Direction pressure switch 18 bar pressure switch on brake assistance supply Fuse box Start switch Inside cab Left-hand fender Top-of-Clutch (TOC) pedal switch Safety switch
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams
Differential lock - tractor with Autotronic 5 linkage calculator
K1.1 R510
R510
R510
R510
R510
R510
R510
R160
R160
R160
R160
R160
R160
R160
DOWN
CAB54.16/CAB56.C
19
17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
22
20
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
221R
4 3 2 1
B
AC 13 7
17
18
2
3
B
S5.1/CAB61.13
R
B S5_
S5.1/CAB50.14
R
FAI 31
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
FAI130 CAB50.10/S2.1
N
7
5
4
8
9
3
2
10
11 12
S4.1/CAB50.14
R
S_4 1
1
2
TR31
FAI 41 S3.1/AC13.7
S3
N R
S3.1/L13.2
N
B
AC1.1/S3.1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
R
AC1.2/S2.1
S3
R
R
S2.1/AC13.17
1
AC1.3/AC13.2 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 7 8 10 17 18
1 2
K
J
H
G
F
A
B
C
D
E
K J H G F E D C B A
2
N
CAB56 K J H G F E D C B A
1
6
5 17 18
S2
S_2 B
2
4
TR7 TR7.1/CAB50.25 B TR7.2/TR31.1 N
CAB50 CAB54.63/CAB50.25
1
7
TR 7
2
CAB54.39/CAB56.D
AC13 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
4
B
CAB50
3
CAB54.34/CAB50.16
3 10
8
26
6
B
25
25
5
CAB54.31/CAB61.15
28 16 27
14
F
G
H
J
K
E
D
C
B
A
CAB11.4/CAB56.D CAB56.C/CAB10.4
BAF7.3/CAB10.2
B
BAF7.1/CAB11.2
B
8
N
29 17
15
13
7
CAB50.10/CAB54.1
18
6 5
24
24
14 26
7 1
4 12
13
30 19
3 11
23
23 12
5
31
2
22
22 11
4
15 27
10
10 3
1
8 9
9 2
7 6 16
21
21
8 19
18 17
20
20
31 30
29 28
9
CAB54.23/S5.1
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F17 - 3A
BAF7
B B
FAI 35
CAB56
1
X2
+APC
FAI 23 FAI 31
CAB10.3/CAB28.1 CAB28.1/CAB11.3
S2.1/L13.41
N
N
N
CAB66
N CAB66.7/CAB73.1
CAB73 2 Rétro-éclairage
B 6 5
CAB66.2/CAB61.14 CAB66.3/S5.1 R
3 2
B
1
L13.46/AC1.3
4
L13
332R
R
CAB54.18/CAB50.17
1
TR11
7
14
B
B
8
28
1
TR11.4/CAB50.17 TR11.3/S4.1 R TR11.2/CAB50.16 S2.1/TR11.1 N
2
3
750R
UP
10
46 24 1
15
CAB 61
CAB61
21
L13
42
NEUTRE
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
AC1 AC1
29
TR 11 4
S2.1/AC1.2 AC1.1/S3.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
540
68 45 23
CAB 54
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
750
1000
CAB54
NEUTRAL
1.3K
R510
K1.3
R510
K1.3
R953
R383
2 x 1W 12 Volts
1
1
CAB28
4
4 3 2 1
CAB 11
3
2
CAB11
4
1
4 3 2 1
3
2
1
2
CAB10
CAB 10
F17
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
S2_
3 2
+8
CAB 66
-7
MA-11-01444A
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF405.17
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 09 FAI 23 FAI 28 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37
Cab interior lighting harness Cab linkage harness Perkins EEM engine harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness (7400) Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 41 DynaVT armrest harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 124Pillar harness FAI 127Cab interior lighting harness FAI 129SisuDiesel EEM engine harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness (8400) FAI 131Datatronic 3 harness FAI 135Lights module and radio ground harness
Component parts list AC7 AC8 AC11 AC13
SV1 speed selector switch SV2 speed selector switch Armrest lever potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch BOC1 Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB10 Right-hand brake switch CAB11 Left-hand brake switch CAB12 Top-of-Clutch (TOC) progressivity sensor CAB19 PowerControl lever CAB44 Throttle pedal potentiometer CAB53 Emergency control switch CAB54 Autotronic 4 CAB59 PTO automation switch CAB61 PTO control module CAB66 Differential lock switch CAB67 4WD switch CAB70 PTO ON/OFF switch CAB76 Hare / Tortoise range selector switch CAB77 (lever / pedal) mode selector switch CAB78 Underspeed supervisor potentiometer CAB79 SV1 encoder CAB80 SV2 encoder L3 Linkage position sensor LIG11 PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders LIG15 Reversing light junction TR2 PTO solenoid valve TR3 1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve TR4 540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (MF7400
GUF405.18
¤ H
TR5 TR6 TR7 TR8 TR9 TR10 TR11 TR12 TR13 TR14 TR15 TR16 TR17 TR18 TR19 TR20 TR23 TR24 TR25 TR26 TR33 TR34
2 3 5 6 15 32
only) 4 WD solenoid valve 540E rpm (or 540 rpm) PTO speed solenoid valve (MF8400) Differential lock solenoid valve Hare / Tortoise range position sensor PTO shaft speed sensor PTO clutch speed sensor Bevel gear design speed sensor Transmission oil temperature sensor Transmission filter clogging switch Tortoise range solenoid valve Hare range solenoid valve Coupler function solenoid valve Transmission oil high pressure sensor Transmission control unit Summing shaft speed sensor Park brake switch Engine speed sensor Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging sensor Direction pressure switch 18 bar pressure switch on brake assistance supply Fuse box Start switch Inside cab Left-hand fender Top-of-Clutch (TOC) pedal switch Safety switch
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams
PTO control module electrical power supply (CAB61)
CAB61
K1.1 R510 R160
R160
R160
R510
R160
1000 540E
540
NEUTRE
540
540E
1000
***
21
19
17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
22
20
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
CAB73.1.1/CAB61.1
N
S5
CAB54.23/S5.1
R
FAI 31
S5.1/CAB61.13
R
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
R510
R510
R160
R160
R510
R160
R510
R510
R510
K1.3
R510
K1.3
R953
R383
2 x 1W 12 Volts
68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB54
68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB54
1
CAB54
68 45 23
CAB73 1
46 24 1
MA-11-01445A
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF405.19
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 09 FAI 23 FAI 28 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37
Cab interior lighting harness Cab linkage harness Perkins EEM engine harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness (7400) Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 41 DynaVT armrest harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 124Pillar harness FAI 127Cab interior lighting harness FAI 129SisuDiesel EEM engine harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness (8400) FAI 131Datatronic 3 harness FAI 135Lights module and radio ground harness
Component parts list AC7 AC8 AC11 AC13
SV1 speed selector switch SV2 speed selector switch Armrest lever potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch BOC1 Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB10 Right-hand brake switch CAB11 Left-hand brake switch CAB12 Top-of-Clutch (TOC) progressivity sensor CAB19 PowerControl lever CAB44 Throttle pedal potentiometer CAB53 Emergency control switch CAB54 Autotronic 4 CAB59 PTO automation switch CAB61 PTO control module CAB66 Differential lock switch CAB67 4WD switch CAB70 PTO ON/OFF switch CAB76 Hare / Tortoise range selector switch CAB77 (lever / pedal) mode selector switch CAB78 Underspeed supervisor potentiometer CAB79 SV1 encoder CAB80 SV2 encoder L3 Linkage position sensor LIG11 PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders LIG15 Reversing light junction TR2 PTO solenoid valve TR3 1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve TR4 540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (MF7400
GUF405.20
¤ H
TR5 TR6 TR7 TR8 TR9 TR10 TR11 TR12 TR13 TR14 TR15 TR16 TR17 TR18 TR19 TR20 TR23 TR24 TR25 TR26 TR33 TR34
2 3 5 6 15 32
only) 4 WD solenoid valve 540E rpm (or 540 rpm) PTO speed solenoid valve (MF8400) Differential lock solenoid valve Hare / Tortoise range position sensor PTO shaft speed sensor PTO clutch speed sensor Bevel gear design speed sensor Transmission oil temperature sensor Transmission filter clogging switch Tortoise range solenoid valve Hare range solenoid valve Coupler function solenoid valve Transmission oil high pressure sensor Transmission control unit Summing shaft speed sensor Park brake switch Engine speed sensor Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging sensor Direction pressure switch 18 bar pressure switch on brake assistance supply Fuse box Start switch Inside cab Left-hand fender Top-of-Clutch (TOC) pedal switch Safety switch
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams MF7400PTO
K1.1 R510
R510
R510
R160
R160
R160
R160 NEUTRE
540
540E
1000
2 alim
R510
R160
3 Us 1 0V
R510
R160
2 alim
R510
R160
TR 10
TR 9 3 Us 1 0V
R510
R510
K1.3
R510
K1.3
R953
R383
2 x 1W 12 Volts
TR 11 TR9
1 2 3
3 2 1
3 2 1
TR10
1 2 3 4
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
TR11.4/CAB50.17 TR11.3/S4.1 R TR11.2/CAB50.16 S2.1/TR11.1 N
CAB 61
30 29 28
68 45 23
CAB50.30/CAB54.14
B
CAB54.18/CAB50.17
B
CAB54.20/CAB61.4
18 17 16 27
31 19 7 6 15 26
20 8 2 1 5 14
9 3 4 13
21 21 10 11 12
CAB50 CAB50 22 23
24
25
B
CAB61.11/CAB54.22 CAB54.23/S4.1 R
B
S4
S4.1/CAB50.14 R
46 24 1
FAI 31 CAB54.34/CAB50.16 CAB50.31/CAB54.35
B B
CAB54.38/CAB61.7
B
CAB54.41/CAB61.5
B
CAB54.43/CAB61.3 CAB54.44/CAB61.2
B B
CAB54.47/CAB50.26 CAB54.50/S5.1 B
CAB54.53/CAB50.22
22 23
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
10 11 12 24
20 9 3 4 13 25
8 2 1 5 14
31 19 7 6 15 26
B
1
17 16
4 3 2 1
B
B
FAI 32
30 18
B
TR11
TR10.1/S2.1 N TR10.2/CAB50.30 TR10.3/S4.1 R
TR9.1/S2.1 N TR9.2/CAB50.31 TR9.3/S5.1 R
CAB50.10/CAB54.1N
29 28
27
TR 2 TR2 TR2.1/CAB50.26 TR2.1/CAB50.26
B N
1 2
S2
CAB50.10/S2.1 N
S4
S4.1/CAB50.14 R
1
2
TR 4 TR4 TR4.1/CAB50.21 B TR4.2/TR30.1 N
1 2
1 2
S1.1/CAB50.6 R
CAB 54
B
CAB54 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
2
3
CAB61
TR 6 TR6 TR6.1/CAB50.22 B TR6.2/TR30.1 N
1 2
B
1 2
TR3 CAB54.68/CAB50.23
TR3.1/CAB50.23 B TR3.2/TR30.1 N
B
1 2
LIG1 LIG1
CAB56.E/CAB1.30
FAI 35
B
K
J
H
G
F
A
B
C
D
E
K J H G F E D C B A
K J H G F E D C B A
CAB73 CAB73.1/CAB61.1
F
G
H
J
K
E
D
C
B
A
N
1
TR 3
1 2
1
TR30
46 24 1
68 45 23
CAB61.10/CAB60.1 CAB60.3/CAB73.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
FAI 09
3 2 1
CAB56 CAB56
B
1 2 3
N
CAB1
1 2 3
LIG_1.17/CAB60.1
B
LIG_1.19/CAB60.3
N
CAB60 CAB60
CAB 1
10
15
5
0
.
2
.
FAI 08 LIG1.17/S6.1 B
S6
LIG11
LIG11 S6.1/LIG11.1 B LIG1.19/LIG11.2 N
6
1 2 3
RPM x 100
CAB 59
FAI 31
20
25
A
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
2
1
.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
AUTO A
B
1
2
AUTO
.
540 750 1000
KPH MPH RPM
CAB59.2/CAB73.1 CAB59.1/CAB56.E
N B
2 1 CAB59
CAB 70
5
3 2 1 CAB70 CAB70.1/CAB61.6 CAB70.2/CAB73.1
B N
1 2 3
MA-11-01158B
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF405.21
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 09 FAI 23 FAI 28 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37
Cab interior lighting harness Cab linkage harness Perkins EEM engine harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness (7400) Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 41 DynaVT armrest harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 124Pillar harness FAI 127Cab interior lighting harness FAI 129SisuDiesel EEM engine harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness (8400) FAI 131Datatronic 3 harness FAI 135Lights module and radio ground harness
Component parts list AC7 AC8 AC11 AC13
SV1 speed selector switch SV2 speed selector switch Armrest lever potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch BOC1 Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB10 Right-hand brake switch CAB11 Left-hand brake switch CAB12 Top-of-Clutch (TOC) progressivity sensor CAB19 PowerControl lever CAB44 Throttle pedal potentiometer CAB53 Emergency control switch CAB54 Autotronic 4 CAB59 PTO automation switch CAB61 PTO control module CAB66 Differential lock switch CAB67 4WD switch CAB70 PTO ON/OFF switch CAB76 Hare / Tortoise range selector switch CAB77 (lever / pedal) mode selector switch CAB78 Underspeed supervisor potentiometer CAB79 SV1 encoder CAB80 SV2 encoder L3 Linkage position sensor LIG11 PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders LIG15 Reversing light junction TR2 PTO solenoid valve TR3 1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve TR4 540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (MF7400
GUF405.22
¤ H
TR5 TR6 TR7 TR8 TR9 TR10 TR11 TR12 TR13 TR14 TR15 TR16 TR17 TR18 TR19 TR20 TR23 TR24 TR25 TR26 TR33 TR34
2 3 5 6 15 32
only) 4 WD solenoid valve 540E rpm (or 540 rpm) PTO speed solenoid valve (MF8400) Differential lock solenoid valve Hare / Tortoise range position sensor PTO shaft speed sensor PTO clutch speed sensor Bevel gear design speed sensor Transmission oil temperature sensor Transmission filter clogging switch Tortoise range solenoid valve Hare range solenoid valve Coupler function solenoid valve Transmission oil high pressure sensor Transmission control unit Summing shaft speed sensor Park brake switch Engine speed sensor Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging sensor Direction pressure switch 18 bar pressure switch on brake assistance supply Fuse box Start switch Inside cab Left-hand fender Top-of-Clutch (TOC) pedal switch Safety switch
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams MF8400PTO K1.1
Us
alim
NEUTRE
540
1 0V
R160
540E
2
R510
R160
1000
3
R510
R160
Us
R510
R160
alim
R510
R160
1 0V
R510
R160
2
R510
R160
TR 10
TR 9
3
R510
R510
K1.3
R510
K1.3
R953
R383
2 x 1W 12 Volts
TR 11 3 3
TR9
1 2 3
2
1
TR10
2
1
1 2 3 4
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
TR11.4/CAB50.17 TR11.3/S4.1 R TR11.2/CAB50.16 S2.1/TR11.1 N
B
N
CAB50
68 45 23
CAB50.30/CAB54.14
B
CAB54.18/CAB50.17
B
CAB54.20/CAB61.4
S5.1/CAB50.14
B
CAB61.11/CAB54.22 CAB54.23/S5.1 R
B S5
46 24 1
FAI 31 CAB54.34/CAB50.16 CAB50.31/CAB54.35
B B
CAB54.38/CAB61.7
B
CAB54.41/CAB61.5
B
CAB54.43/CAB61.3 CAB54.44/CAB61.2
B B
A
B
24 25
R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
10 22
30 19 18
2
17
1 4
16 15
13 24
26
CAB50.10/S2.1
CAB54.47/CAB50.26 CAB54.48/CAB50.21
CAB1
1 2
N
1
2
S4 S4.1/CAB50.14
R S2
TR 6 TR6 TR6.1/CAB50.21 B TR6.2/TR31.1 N
1 2
1
2
TR 3 TR3
TR31
1
TR3.1/CAB50.22 B TR3.2/TR31.1 N
1 2
B B
CAB54.53/CAB50.22
2
B
LIG1
CAB73.1.1/CAB61.1
N
FAI127
H C
G D
B
F
K J H G F E D C B A
3
K J H G F E D C B A
2
1
CAB60 CAB61.10/CAB60.1 CAB73 1
B
CAB60.3/CAB73.2.1 N
1 2 3
1 2 3
LIG_1.17/CAB60.1
B
LIG_1.19/CAB60.3
N
1 CAB60
F
G
H
J
K
E
D
C
B
A
E
CAB73 2 1
FAI 35
46 24 1
TR 2 TR2
1
CAB56
68 45 23
TR11
TR2.1/CAB50.26 B TR2.2/TR31.1 N
27
14 25
28
6 5
12
29
7
3 11
23
FAI130
CAB50
CAB56.E/CAB1.30
J
12 13
14 26
23
4
15 27
22 11
5
16
CAB56
K
6
28
10 3
1
8 9
9 2
7
31
20
21
8 19
18 17
21
20
31 30
29
TR10.1/S2.1 N TR10.2/CAB50.30 B TR10.3/S4.1 R
CAB 54
TR9.1/S2.1 N TR9.2/CAB50.31 TR9.3/S4.1 R
CAB54 CAB50.10/CAB54.1
1
4 3 2 1
B
B
CAB 61
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
2
3
CAB61
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
LIG1.17/S6.1
B
S6
LIG11
FAI 36
LIG11 S6.1/LIG11.1 LIG1.19/LIG11.2
B N
ON/OFF
1 2 3
LIG1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
9
7
5
3
1
10
8
6
4
2
CAB 59
AUTO 1
2
CAB59.2/CAB73.2.1 CAB59.1/CAB56.E
N B
2 1 CAB59
CAB 70
6
FAI 31 3
2
1
CAB70 CAB70.1/CAB61.6 CAB70.2/CAB73.1.1
CAB1
B N
1 2 3
ON/OFF
MA-11-01446A
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF405.23
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 09 FAI 23 FAI 28 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37
Cab interior lighting harness Cab linkage harness Perkins EEM engine harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness (7400) Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 41 DynaVT armrest harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 124Pillar harness FAI 127Cab interior lighting harness FAI 129SisuDiesel EEM engine harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness (8400) FAI 131Datatronic 3 harness FAI 135Lights module and radio ground harness
Component parts list AC7 AC8 AC11 AC13
SV1 speed selector switch SV2 speed selector switch Armrest lever potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch BOC1 Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB10 Right-hand brake switch CAB11 Left-hand brake switch CAB12 Top-of-Clutch (TOC) progressivity sensor CAB19 PowerControl lever CAB44 Throttle pedal potentiometer CAB53 Emergency control switch CAB54 Autotronic 4 CAB59 PTO automation switch CAB61 PTO control module CAB66 Differential lock switch CAB67 4WD switch CAB70 PTO ON/OFF switch CAB76 Hare / Tortoise range selector switch CAB77 (lever / pedal) mode selector switch CAB78 Underspeed supervisor potentiometer CAB79 SV1 encoder CAB80 SV2 encoder L3 Linkage position sensor LIG11 PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders LIG15 Reversing light junction TR2 PTO solenoid valve TR3 1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve TR4 540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (MF7400
GUF405.24
¤ H
TR5 TR6 TR7 TR8 TR9 TR10 TR11 TR12 TR13 TR14 TR15 TR16 TR17 TR18 TR19 TR20 TR23 TR24 TR25 TR26 TR33 TR34
2 3 5 6 15 32
only) 4 WD solenoid valve 540E rpm (or 540 rpm) PTO speed solenoid valve (MF8400) Differential lock solenoid valve Hare / Tortoise range position sensor PTO shaft speed sensor PTO clutch speed sensor Bevel gear design speed sensor Transmission oil temperature sensor Transmission filter clogging switch Tortoise range solenoid valve Hare range solenoid valve Coupler function solenoid valve Transmission oil high pressure sensor Transmission control unit Summing shaft speed sensor Park brake switch Engine speed sensor Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging sensor Direction pressure switch 18 bar pressure switch on brake assistance supply Fuse box Start switch Inside cab Left-hand fender Top-of-Clutch (TOC) pedal switch Safety switch
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams CAN network - Perkins engine - EHRC linkage calculator
68 45 23
J
V
CAB83.2/CAB50.4
CAB83.1/CAB50.7 4
3
2
1
5
6
7
8
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1
2
3
4
8
7
6
5
TR18.5/CAB50.7
V
TR18.2/CAB50.4
J
TR18 S21 S20
S21.1/CAB18.2 S20.1/CAB18.1
1 8
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2 7
FAI 32
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
6
FAI 31
CAB18
3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
5
J V
4
S9.1/CAB18.1 S8.1/CAB18.2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
TR18
V
CA1.14/CA8.2
J
FAI 57
V J
ENG2 ENG2
23
4 12
5
16 15
13 24
14
27 26
25
1
2 3 11 10
4 9
5 8
6 7
AC1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V5
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
V5
1 2 3 4
1 2
26
24 25
FAI 41 S5.1/AC2.8 S6.1/AC2.7
V J
6
5
4
3
1
7
8
9
10
S5 S6
2
11 12
L14
21
8 9
10 22
1 2
3
4
1
2
3
4
6
5
4
3
7
8
9
10
2
J V
L22 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1
11 12
FAI 23
4
3
1
2
4
V1
J V S5
L14.13/S6.1 S5.1/L14.12
S6
J V
FAI 24
V1.2/S5.1 V1.3/S6.1
1 2 3 4
V J
3
2
1
V1 1 2 3 4
V1.2/S2.1 V1.3/S3.1
V J
FAI 25
L22 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
L22 L22.1/S4.1 L22.2/S3.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V S4 J
S4.1/CAB110.11 S3 S3.1/CAB110.20
V J
FAI 33
L22 V J
S8
29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
15 16
CAB110
55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI 68
S1
S8.1/FS4.29
V
S1.1/FS4.30
V
S9.1/FS4.27
J
S5.1/FS4.28
J S5
FS1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37
FS2.N/S1.1 FS2.M/S1.1
V V
S5.1/FS2.K FS2.J/S5.1
J J
FS1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
FS1
33
L13 38
55
20
37
7
3
8
4
9
5
10
1 2
6
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
CAB110 S3.1/L111.14 S4.1/L111.16 V
L13 L13 FS4
11 12 13 14
J
FAI 33
FAI 68
1
V J
CAB110
S9
AC1
55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CA8.1/S4.1 CA8.2/S3.1
26
S6.1/L14.16 S5.1/L14.15
S8.1/L22A.1 S9.1/L22A.2
S2.1/V5.2 S3.1/V5.3
27
14 25
L14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
S2.1/V4.2 S3.1/V4.3
S2
28 16
15
13 24
29 17
6 5
J V
L13.14/AC1.12 AC1.11/L13.33
V J
V J
V J S2.1/V3.2 S3.1/V3.3
18 7
1 4
12
S3
30 19
2 3
11 23
1
23 12
13 14
27
22 11
4 5
11
10 3
1 6
6 1 12
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4
V4
FAI 46
7
V
1 2
CA8
20
9 2
7
31
20
1
CAB1.37/S21.1
V4
4
19
21
8 19
17 28
15
AC2
S6.1/AC1.12 AC1.11/S5.1
3
2
10
AC2
CA8
29
30 18 29
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1
20
31
16
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V J 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2
7
1
3
6
8
1 2 3 4
4
5
9
1 2 3 4
V3
5
4
2
V3
4
3
2
S2.1/V2.2 S3.1/V2.3
FAI 41
5 6 7
3
11 10
1 2 3 4
4
12
1 2 3 4
V2
2 3
1
FAI 35
V J
V2
V J
AC2.8/S8.1 S9.1/AC2.7
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
5 6 7
AC12 AC12
J
FAI 31
X
X
4
6
28
L22.1/S8.1 L22.2/S9.1
CAB1.16/S20.1
22 11
1 2 3
27 26
10 3
1
1
16 15
14
9 2
7
2
28
6 5
13 25
21
8 19
18 17
V5
V4
X
3
12 24
20
31 30
29
V3
X
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V2
4
29 17
AC12
5
18 7
1 4
23
30 19
2
ENG2.1/ENG4.52 J ENG2.2/ENG4.61 V
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
6
8 9 3
11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
7
31
20 21 10 22
J V
J V
S20.1/ENG2.1 S21.1/ENG2.2
1
KPH MPH RPM
CAB18 S8
2
540 750 1000
46 24 1
.
B
TR18
S9
CA1.1/CA8.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
3
.
A
CA1
4
.
2
70
34
5
1
64
FAI 28
6
A
. AUTO
56
63
7
25
42
57
5 6 7
20
RPM x 100
28
CAB50 CAB50
CAB1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
14
43
4
5
0
V J
8
7
29
1 2 3
15
FAI 31
1
15
J V J V
10
120
26
L13.15/L14.16 L13.34/L14.15 L14.13/L22.2 L14.12/L22.1
2
1
1
27
25
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
AC12.3/S6.1 S5.1/AC12.4
68 45 23
CAB1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
V J
CAB83
S8.1/CAB54.26 CAB54.27/S9.1
15 14
24
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
28 16
5 13
25
29 17
6
ENG4
CAB1
12
ENG4
18 7
1 4
24
14
2
30 19
2 3
11
13
27
CAB83.1/CAB54.4 CAB83.2/CAB54.5
23
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70
46 24 1
CAB54
22
23 12
5
26
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
22 11
4
15
10
10 3
1
16
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
8 9
9 2
7 6
CAB54 CAB54
21
21
8 19
18 17
31
20
20
31 30
29 28
1
19
J V B
N
P E
M
D A C
L
B K J
F
G
H
FS2
4
5
9
29
33
10
3
15
2
22
16 23
37
9
FS2
4
28
34
FS2.C/FS1.8 FS1.9/FS2.B FS1.5/FS2.A
P N M L K J H G F E D C B A
1
5
MA-11-01150A
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF405.25
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 09 FAI 23 FAI 28 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37
Cab interior lighting harness Cab linkage harness Perkins EEM engine harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness (7400) Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 41 DynaVT armrest harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 124Pillar harness FAI 127Cab interior lighting harness FAI 129SisuDiesel EEM engine harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness (8400) FAI 131Datatronic 3 harness FAI 135Lights module and radio ground harness
Component parts list AC7 AC8 AC11 AC13
SV1 speed selector switch SV2 speed selector switch Armrest lever potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch BOC1 Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB10 Right-hand brake switch CAB11 Left-hand brake switch CAB12 Top-of-Clutch (TOC) progressivity sensor CAB19 PowerControl lever CAB44 Throttle pedal potentiometer CAB53 Emergency control switch CAB54 Autotronic 4 CAB59 PTO automation switch CAB61 PTO control module CAB66 Differential lock switch CAB67 4WD switch CAB70 PTO ON/OFF switch CAB76 Hare / Tortoise range selector switch CAB77 (lever / pedal) mode selector switch CAB78 Underspeed supervisor potentiometer CAB79 SV1 encoder CAB80 SV2 encoder L3 Linkage position sensor LIG11 PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders LIG15 Reversing light junction TR2 PTO solenoid valve TR3 1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve TR4 540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (MF7400
GUF405.26
¤ H
TR5 TR6 TR7 TR8 TR9 TR10 TR11 TR12 TR13 TR14 TR15 TR16 TR17 TR18 TR19 TR20 TR23 TR24 TR25 TR26 TR33 TR34
2 3 5 6 15 32
only) 4 WD solenoid valve 540E rpm (or 540 rpm) PTO speed solenoid valve (MF8400) Differential lock solenoid valve Hare / Tortoise range position sensor PTO shaft speed sensor PTO clutch speed sensor Bevel gear design speed sensor Transmission oil temperature sensor Transmission filter clogging switch Tortoise range solenoid valve Hare range solenoid valve Coupler function solenoid valve Transmission oil high pressure sensor Transmission control unit Summing shaft speed sensor Park brake switch Engine speed sensor Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging sensor Direction pressure switch 18 bar pressure switch on brake assistance supply Fuse box Start switch Inside cab Left-hand fender Top-of-Clutch (TOC) pedal switch Safety switch
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams CAN network - SisuDiesel engine - EHRC linkage calculator
CAB83 1
120
S8.1/CAB54.26 CAB54.27/S9.1
J
V
CAB83.2/CAB50.4
CAB83.1/CAB50.7
FAI 31
V J
FAI 38
CAB18
S8
S9.1/CAB18.1 S8.1/CAB18.2
FAI 31 4
3
2
1
5
6
7
8
S21 S20
S21.1/CAB18.2 S20.1/CAB18.1
68 45 23
3
4
7
6
5
FAI 35
V J
1
8 7
2
6
3
5 17
1 4
28
6
12
16
5 15
13
27
14
24
29
7
3 11
23
25
26
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13
14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
V
CA1.14/CA8.2
J
FAI 57
ENG4
ENG4 ENG4
15
12 13 24
14 26
25
V
1
2
4
5
6
12
11 10 9
8
7
3
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
AC1
AC1
5 6 7
CA8
1 2
CA8
1 2
4
1 2 3 4 3
2
V4
1 2 3 4
V5
1 2 3 4
V4
1 2 3 4
V5
1 2 3 4
4
1
3
2
1
4
2
3
4
24 25
FAI 41 S5.1/AC2.8 S6.1/AC2.7
V J
6
5
4
3
2
1
7
8
9
10
11 12
S5 S6
L14
8 9
V J
V J
V J S2.1/V3.2 S3.1/V3.3
V J
V J S2.1/V2.2 S3.1/V2.3 29
L22
J V
6
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
15
13
27
14 25
26
4 S6.1/L14.16 S5.1/L14.15
1
FAI 23
3
1
2
S5 L14.13/S6.1 S5.1/L14.12
S6
J V
V1.2/S5.1 V1.3/S6.1
FAI 24
2
1
V1
1 2 3 4
V J
1 2 3 4
V1.2/S2.1 V1.3/S3.1
V J
FAI 25
L22
L22A
3
4
V1
J V
L14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
S8.1/L22A.1 S9.1/L22A.2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
L22 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
L22.1/S4.1 L22.2/S3.1
V S4 J
S4.1/CAB110.11 S3 S3.1/CAB110.20
V J
FAI 33
V J
S8
29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB110
L111
15 16
11 12 13 14
S9
7
3
8
4
9
5
10
1 2
6
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
CAB110 CAB110 S3.1/L111.14 S4.1/L111.16 V
FAI 68
J
FAI 33
S1
S8.1/FS4.29
V
S1.1/FS4.30
V
S9.1/FS4.27
J
S5.1/FS4.28
J S5
FS2.N/S1.1 FS2.M/S1.1
V V
S5.1/FS2.K FS2.J/S5.1
J J
FAI 68 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FS1
L13 L13 FS4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37
FS1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
FS1
33
L13 38
55
20
37
1
CA8.1/S4.1 CA8.2/S3.1
28 16
J V
L13.14/AC1.12 AC1.11/L13.33
S2.1/V5.2 S3.1/V5.3
S2
17 6
5
24
S2.1/V4.2 S3.1/V4.3
18 7
1 4
12
S3
30 19
2 3
11 23
1
26
21 10 22
11
23 12
14
27
22 11
4 13
20
10 3
1 5 15
19
9 2
7 6 16
FAI 46
10
21
8 19
18 17
31
20
29
30
29
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1
20
31
28
AC2 AC2
CAB1.37/S21.1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI 41
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
S6.1/AC1.12 AC1.11/S5.1
1 2 3 4
V3
2
7
X
X 1
3
6
8
V3
4
3
4
5
2
5
4
3
1
6
2
11 10 9
1 2 3 4
7
1 12
1 2 3 4
V2
5 6 7
V J
V2
4
AC2.8/S8.1 S9.1/AC2.7
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V5
V4
X
AC12 AC12
J
FAI 31
V3
1 2 3
CAB1.16/S20.1
23
4 5
16 27
V J
FAI 35
6
28
1 2 3
27 26
22 11
1
28 16
15 14
10 3
1
2
17 6
5 13
9 2
7
3
4 12 24
21
8 19
18 17
V2
X
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
20
31 30
29
AC12
4
29
ENG2.1/ENG4.30 J ENG2.2/ENG4.31 V
5
18 7
1
11 23
30 19
2
ENG2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
6
8 9 3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
7
31
20 21 10 22
J V
J V
ENG2 S20.1/ENG2.1 S21.1/ENG2.2
L22.1/S8.1 L22.2/S9.1
KPH MPH RPM
2
18
1
540 750 1000
46 24 1
.
1 8
22
2
B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
30 19
2
3
.
A
CAB18
8 9
4
.
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
21 10
CA1.1/CA8.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
31
20
5
1
J V
CA1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
6
A
. AUTO
CA1 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB50 CAB50
S9
TR18
7
25
TR18
FAI 32
5 6 7
20
RPM x 100
J
4
5
0
TR18.2/CAB50.4
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2 3
15
V
1
10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
TR18.5/CAB50.7
J V J V
2
1
CAB1
26
L13.15/L14.16 L13.34/L14.15 L14.13/L22.2 L14.12/L22.1
CAB1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
27
25
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
4
V J
28 16
15 14
24
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
29 17
6 5
13
25
2
18 7
1 4
12
24
14
TR18
30 19
2 3
11
13
25
CAB1
23
12
5
27
CAB83.1/CAB54.4 CAB83.2/CAB54.5
22
23
AC12.3/S6.1 S5.1/AC12.4
68 45 23
46 24 1
CAB54
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
22 11
4
15
10
10 3
1
26
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
8 9
9 2
7 6 16
CAB54 CAB54
21
21
8 19
18 17
31
20
20
31 30
29 28
19
1 5 10 16 23 29 34
4
J V B
P
N
E M
D A C
L
F
B G K J
H
FS2
3
9 15 22 28 33 37
FS2.C/FS1.8 FS1.9/FS2.B FS1.5/FS2.A
P N M L K J H G F E D C B A
2 9
4 1
FS2 5
MA-11-01159A
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF405.27
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 09 FAI 23 FAI 28 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37
Cab interior lighting harness Cab linkage harness Perkins EEM engine harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness (7400) Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 41 DynaVT armrest harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 124Pillar harness FAI 127Cab interior lighting harness FAI 129SisuDiesel EEM engine harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness (8400) FAI 131Datatronic 3 harness FAI 135Lights module and radio ground harness
Component parts list AC7 AC8 AC11 AC13
SV1 speed selector switch SV2 speed selector switch Armrest lever potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch BOC1 Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB10 Right-hand brake switch CAB11 Left-hand brake switch CAB12 Top-of-Clutch (TOC) progressivity sensor CAB19 PowerControl lever CAB44 Throttle pedal potentiometer CAB53 Emergency control switch CAB54 Autotronic 4 CAB59 PTO automation switch CAB61 PTO control module CAB66 Differential lock switch CAB67 4WD switch CAB70 PTO ON/OFF switch CAB76 Hare / Tortoise range selector switch CAB77 (lever / pedal) mode selector switch CAB78 Underspeed supervisor potentiometer CAB79 SV1 encoder CAB80 SV2 encoder L3 Linkage position sensor LIG11 PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders LIG15 Reversing light junction TR2 PTO solenoid valve TR3 1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve TR4 540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (MF7400
GUF405.28
¤ H
TR5 TR6 TR7 TR8 TR9 TR10 TR11 TR12 TR13 TR14 TR15 TR16 TR17 TR18 TR19 TR20 TR23 TR24 TR25 TR26 TR33 TR34
2 3 5 6 15 32
only) 4 WD solenoid valve 540E rpm (or 540 rpm) PTO speed solenoid valve (MF8400) Differential lock solenoid valve Hare / Tortoise range position sensor PTO shaft speed sensor PTO clutch speed sensor Bevel gear design speed sensor Transmission oil temperature sensor Transmission filter clogging switch Tortoise range solenoid valve Hare range solenoid valve Coupler function solenoid valve Transmission oil high pressure sensor Transmission control unit Summing shaft speed sensor Park brake switch Engine speed sensor Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging sensor Direction pressure switch 18 bar pressure switch on brake assistance supply Fuse box Start switch Inside cab Left-hand fender Top-of-Clutch (TOC) pedal switch Safety switch
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams CAN network - SisuDiesel engine - Autotronic 5 linkage calculator
23
24
14
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V J
CAB83 1 120
S12.1/CAB54.26 CAB54.27/S13.1
J
V
CAB83.2/CAB50.4
CAB83.1/CAB50.7
FAI 31
V J
8
30 19
9
18
2
17
1
11 4 12
28
6 16
5 15
13 24
29
7
3
23
27
14 25
26
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI 28
CA1
ENG4
34
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
FAI 31 4
3
2
1
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
8
7
6
5
TR18.5/CAB50.7
V
TR18.2/CAB50.4
J
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
V
CA1.14/CA8.2
J
FAI 57
TR18 TR18
CAB18 S21 S20
1
8
FAI 32
FAI 35
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CA1.1/CA8.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
4
J V
S21.1/CAB18.2 S20.1/CAB18.1
V J
ENG2
11
1 6
28
23
4 12
5
16 15
13 24
14
27 26
25
10 22
3 11
1 6
23
4 12
5
16 15
13 24
14 26
25
FAI 41 S5.1/AC2.8 S6.1/AC2.7
V J
6
5
4
3
2
1
7
8
9
10
11 12
S5 S6
L14
1 2 3 4 1 2
3
4
3
V J S2.1/V5.2 S3.1/V5.3
V J
V J
V J S2.1/V3.2 S3.1/V3.3
S2.1/V4.2 S3.1/V4.3
V J S2.1/V2.2 S3.1/V2.3 1
2
S5
J V
V1.2/S4.1 V1.3/S5.1
V J
L 22
L14
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
1
S10 S9
FAI 23
S8.1/L22A.1 S9.1/L22A.2
V J
V1.2/S2.1 V1.3/S3.1
V J CAB112
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
L22.1/S4.1 L22.2/S3.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V J
S4_ S4.1/CAB112.4 S_3 S3.1/CAB112.3
V J
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L13
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
6
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
S3.1/L111.14 S4.1/L111.16 L111.13/CAB112.6 L111.12/CAB112.5
FAI 68
S8.1/FS4.29
V
S1.1/FS4.30
V
S_1
FS2.N/S1.1 FS2.M/S1.1
V V
S5.1/FS2.K FS2.J/S5.1
J J
J
S5.1/FS4.28
J S__5
FS4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37
FS1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
FS1
33 1 5 10 16 23 29 34
CAB1 29
42
29
42
15
28
15
28
1
14
1
14
13
7 8 9 10
3 4 5
1 2
6
1
CAB112
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
J V V J
FAI 68 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
CAB141 CAB141
11 12 14
S9
CAB141
L13
16
CAB112
FS1 L13
15
FAI 131
FAI 68
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
L 22
J V
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CA8.1/S4.1 CA8.2/S3.1
1
2
S8
S9.1/FS4.27
J V CAB141.40/S10.1 CAB141.39/S9.1
1 2 3 4
7
L22A 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V1
1 2 3 4
FAI 128
L22.1/S8.1 L22.2/S9.1 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V1
1
L22
J V
3
4
J V
L14.13/S5.1 S4.1/L14.12
2
S10.1/AC1.12 AC1.11/S9.1
FAI 46
28
4
AC1 S10.1/L13.40 S9.1/L13.39
1 2 3 4
V5
3
7
V5
4
16
S4
4
6
3
26
S5.1/L14.16 S4.1/L14.15
5
5 8
1 2
27
14 25
6
4
3
1 2 3 4
7
2
11 10 9
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4
V4
15
J V
5 6 7
1 12
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V4
4
S2
17 6
5 13
24
29
7 1
4 12
4
V
3
18
2 3
11 23
AC1 CAB1.39/S21.1
1 2
19
9 10 22
7
AC2
S6.1/AC1.12 AC1.11/S5.1
1 2
CA8
4
7
CA8
S3
5
6
1 2
30
6
5 8
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8
5 6
4
3
1 2 3 4
31
20 21
4
2
11 10 9
1 2 3 4
V3
1
9 2
7 17
27
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
3
1 12
V3
4
3
2
19 18 29 28
21
8
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2
V J
1 2 3 4
3
20
31 30
J V J V
AC2.8/S12.1 S13.1/AC2.7
1 2 3 4
V2
V J
FAI 41
L13.15/L14.16 L13.34/L14.15 L14.13/L22.2 L14.12/L22.1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI 31
V2
1 2
AC2
J
X
X
X
5 6 7
AC12
ENG2
CAB1.16/S20.1
V5
V4
4
17
22
1 2 3
27 26
10 3
1
16 15
14
9 2
7
2
28
6 5
13
21
8 19
18
X
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
3
17
1 4
12 24
30
29
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
20
31
V3
4
29
V2
5
18 7
11 23
30 19
2 3
AC12 AC12
6
8 9
10
ENG2.1/ENG4.30 J ENG2.2/ENG4.31 V
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
7
21
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
31
20
22
J V
J V
S20.1/ENG2.1 S21.1/ENG2.2
1 2 3
46 24 1
31
20 21 10
5
S13.1/CAB18.1 S12.1/CAB18.2
CAB1
68 45 23
26
22
CAB18 S13 S12
FAI 35
CAB1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
ENG4
28 16 27
14 25
TR18
CAB54
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
29 17
15
CAB50
25
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
18
6 5
13 24
25
2
30
7 1
4 12
CAB50
19 2
3 11
13
26
CAB83.1/CAB54.4 CAB83.2/CAB54.5
22
23 12
5
27
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
22 11
4
15
10
10 3
1
AC12.3/S6.1 S5.1/AC12.4
68 45 23
46 24 1
CAB54
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
8 9
9 2
7 6 16
CAB54
21
21
8 19
18 17
31
20
20
31 30
29 28
4
J V B
FS2
P
N
E M
D A C
L
F
B G K J
H
FS2
3
9 15 22 28 33 37
FS2.C/FS1.8 FS1.9/FS2.B FS1.5/FS2.A
P N M L K J H G F E D C B A
2 9
4 1
5
MA-11-01384A
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF405.29
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams
C . Layout of components Harness parts list FAI 09 FAI 23 FAI 28 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37
Cab interior lighting harness Cab linkage harness Perkins EEM engine harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness (7400) Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 41 DynaVT armrest harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 124Pillar harness FAI 127Cab interior lighting harness FAI 129SisuDiesel EEM engine harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness (8400) FAI 131Datatronic 3 harness FAI 135Lights module and radio ground harness
Component parts list AC7 AC8 AC11 AC13
SV1 speed selector switch SV2 speed selector switch Armrest lever potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch BOC1 Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB10 Right-hand brake switch CAB11 Left-hand brake switch CAB12 Top-of-Clutch (TOC) progressivity sensor CAB19 PowerControl lever CAB44 Throttle pedal potentiometer CAB53 Emergency control switch CAB54 Autotronic 4 CAB59 PTO automation switch CAB61 PTO control module CAB66 Differential lock switch CAB67 4WD switch CAB70 PTO ON/OFF switch CAB76 Hare / Tortoise range selector switch CAB77 (lever / pedal) mode selector switch CAB78 Underspeed supervisor potentiometer CAB79 SV1 encoder CAB80 SV2 encoder L3 Linkage position sensor LIG11 PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders LIG15 Reversing light junction TR2 PTO solenoid valve
GUF405.30
¤ H
TR3 TR4 TR5 TR6 TR7 TR8 TR9 TR10 TR11 TR12 TR13 TR14 TR15 TR16 TR17 TR18 TR19 TR20 TR23 TR24 TR25 TR26 TR33 TR34
2 3 5 6 15 32
1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve 540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (MF7400 only) 4 WD solenoid valve 540E rpm (or 540 rpm) PTO speed solenoid valve (MF8400) Differential lock solenoid valve Hare / Tortoise range position sensor PTO shaft speed sensor PTO clutch speed sensor Bevel gear design speed sensor Transmission oil temperature sensor Transmission filter clogging switch Tortoise range solenoid valve Hare range solenoid valve Coupler function solenoid valve Transmission oil high pressure sensor Transmission control unit Summing shaft speed sensor Park brake switch Engine speed sensor Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging sensor Direction pressure switch 18 bar pressure switch on brake assistance supply Fuse box Start switch Inside cab Left-hand fender Top-of-Clutch (TOC) pedal switch Safety switch
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams
MF7400 series tractor CAB50
TR2 TR3 TR4 TR5 TR6 TR7 TR9
TR10
L3 TR20 CAB50
TR8 TR2 TR3 TR4 TR5 TR6 TR7
TR30 TR31
TR33 TR34 TR23 TR27
TR24
ENG10
TR14 TR15 TR16
TR13 TR11
TR12 TR19
TR17
TR18
TR25
TR26
TR29 MA-11-0113B
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF405.31
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 09 FAI 23 FAI 28 FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37
Cab interior lighting harness Cab linkage harness Perkins EEM engine harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness (7400) Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) FAI 41 DynaVT armrest harness FAI 48 DynaVT console harness FAI 124Pillar harness FAI 127Cab interior lighting harness FAI 129SisuDiesel EEM engine harness FAI 130DynaVT transmission harness (8400) FAI 131Datatronic 3 harness FAI 135Lights module and radio ground harness
Component parts list AC7 AC8 AC11 AC13
SV1 speed selector switch SV2 speed selector switch Armrest lever potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch BOC1 Bottom-of-Clutch (BOC) pedal switch CAB1 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB10 Right-hand brake switch CAB11 Left-hand brake switch CAB12 Top-of-Clutch (TOC) progressivity sensor CAB19 PowerControl lever CAB44 Throttle pedal potentiometer CAB53 Emergency control switch CAB54 Autotronic 4 CAB59 PTO automation switch CAB61 PTO control module CAB66 Differential lock switch CAB67 4WD switch CAB70 PTO ON/OFF switch CAB76 Hare / Tortoise range selector switch CAB77 (lever / pedal) mode selector switch CAB78 Underspeed supervisor potentiometer CAB79 SV1 encoder CAB80 SV2 encoder L3 Linkage position sensor LIG11 PTO ON/OFF switch on fenders LIG15 Reversing light junction TR2 PTO solenoid valve TR3 1000 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve TR4 540 rpm PTO speed solenoid valve (MF7400
GUF405.32
¤ H
TR5 TR6 TR7 TR8 TR9 TR10 TR11 TR12 TR13 TR14 TR15 TR16 TR17 TR18 TR19 TR20 TR23 TR24 TR25 TR26 TR33 TR34
2 3 5 6 15 32
only) 4 WD solenoid valve 540E rpm (or 540 rpm) PTO speed solenoid valve (MF8400) Differential lock solenoid valve Hare / Tortoise range position sensor PTO shaft speed sensor PTO clutch speed sensor Bevel gear design speed sensor Transmission oil temperature sensor Transmission filter clogging switch Tortoise range solenoid valve Hare range solenoid valve Coupler function solenoid valve Transmission oil high pressure sensor Transmission control unit Summing shaft speed sensor Park brake switch Engine speed sensor Solenoid valve limiting speed to 30 kph Auxiliary hydraulics oil temperature sensor Auxiliary hydraulics oil filter clogging sensor Direction pressure switch 18 bar pressure switch on brake assistance supply Fuse box Start switch Inside cab Left-hand fender Top-of-Clutch (TOC) pedal switch Safety switch
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams
MF8400 series tractor
TR20
TR24
TR18
TR13
TR33
TR35
TR26
TR11
TR14
TR19
TR15
TR16
TR17
TR12
TR23
TR25
TR26
TR10
TR20
TR7
TR3
TR6
TR5
TR2
TR8
TR20
TR9 MA-11-01419A
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
¤ H
GUF405.33
AUTOTRONIC 4 - Electrical diagrams
GUF405.34
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 8.a
Autotronic 5 - ParkLock - Description
11E10 - Autotronic 5 - ParkLock - Description
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . List of controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 C . ParkLock function activating conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 D . Logical diagram of ParkLock operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 E . Allocation of Autotronic 5 ParkLock pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11E10.1
Autotronic 5 - ParkLock - Description
11E10.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Autotronic 5 - ParkLock - Description
A . General Tractors with DYNA VT ML200 transmission are fitted with a ParkLock type parking brake system. This system acts directly on the tractor brakes and is composed of the following elements (Fig. 1): An electromechanical switch on the reverse shuttle lever (1) This switch, located to the left of the steering wheel, allows the ParkLock function to be activated and locked only when the reverse shuttle lever is in neutral position. An Autotronic 5 electronic calculator (2) The calculator is fitted in a housing located in the cab floor to the right of the driver’s seat. The calculator controls the ParkLock depending on the different readings it receives from the electromechanical switch (1) on the reverse shuttle lever (user information), the pressure switches M1 and M2 (4) and ground speed (activating conditions of the ParkLock function). The calculator thus also controls the control solenoid valve of the Parklock (8) ram pressure reversing valve. The calculator also controls trailer braking by activating: - either the control proportional solenoid valve (5) of the trailer braking valve depending on the signal it receives from the front axle braking pressure sensor (3), - or the control safety solenoid valve (6) of the trailer braking valve in case of electrical faults or when using the emergency handbrake. The calculator also controls the 5th optional electrohydraulic spool valve (9) and transmits information via the CAN network to the Autotronic 5 linkage calculator (10) which controls this spool valve. NOTE: The Autotronic 5 calculator is connected to the CAN network, so it is possible to reprogram it, set its parameters and test it using Wintest via the 16-pin connector (11). Safety: The ParkLock function is active when the engine is off. A safety system has been installed to deactivate it when the engine is started. The Autotronic 5 calculator must be informed by the Autotronic 4 calculator (7) via the CAN network that the engine speed exceeds 800 rpm, and the electromechanical switch on the left-hand lever must be moved from ON to OFF position.
A braking pressure sensor (3) This sensor is located on the front axle braking circuit at the brake master cylinders. It measures the front axle braking pressure and transmits a signal to the Autotronic 5 calculator. The latter amplifies the signal by a factor of 8 or 9 and sends a signal to the control proportional solenoid valve of the trailer braking valve (5) (for front axle braking pressure of 10 bar, trailer braking pressure is 80 or 90 bar).
9 11
Two pressure switches M1 and M2 (4) Located in the braking valve block, they measure accumulator charge pressure and transmit the information to the Autotronic 5 calculator (pressure must be > 105 bar). They allow pressure faults to be detected in the tractor braking hydraulic circuit (service brakes and ParkLock). Two pressure switches are used to show when one of them is defective.
CAN 10
CAN
Autotronic 5 Trailer braking valve control proportional solenoid valve (4)
1
The Autotronic 5 calculator transmits it a signal proportional to front axle braking pressure so that it can control the trailer braking valve. Trailer braking pressure is therefore proportional to tractor braking pressure.
8
M1 2
4
Trailer braking valve control safety solenoid valve (6)
7
M2
CAN
It is activated by the Autotronic 5 calculator when the latter receives the signal from the Autotronic 4 (7) via the CAN network, or when there is an electrical fault. 3
Parklock ram pressure reversing valve control solenoid valve (8)
42
29
- Ground speed - Engine speed - Emergency brake and ParkLock switch signal
15 28 14
1
It is controlled by the Autotronic 5 calculator, and allows the ParkLock ram chamber to be pressurised to release the tractor brakes. NOTE: Tractors not fitted with trailer brakes are also fitted with the braking valve block; only the tractor / trailer connection is not included.
5
6
MA-11-06021A
Fig. 1 Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11E10.3
Autotronic 5 - ParkLock - Description
Page left blank intentionally
11E10.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Autotronic 5 - ParkLock - Description B . List of controls The ParkLock function can be activated via two controls in the cab. An electromechanical switch A on the reverse shuttle lever (Fig. 2)
The emergency brake lever is fitted to the cab floor, to the left of the driver’s seat. It is directly connected to the ParkLock ram pressure reversing valve (Fig. 4). This lever only allows activation of the ParkLock function as it is not fitted with a locking detent, and when it is released it therefore deactivates the ParkLock function.
L 2 4
A
1
3
5
MA-11-06024A
Fig. 4
MA-11-06022A
Fig. 2
This switch allows the ParkLock funtion to be activated and locked when the engine is running in order to immobilise the tractor. To engage the switch, the reverse shuttle lever L must be in neutral position N.
Parts list (Fig. 4) (1) Emergency handbrake lever (2) Pressure reversing valve (3) ParkLock ram (4) Brake control guide rod link (5) Pressure reversing valve control solenoid valve
An emergency brake lever B (Fig. 3)
B
MA-11-06023A
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Fig. 3
11E10.5
Autotronic 5 - ParkLock - Description
C . ParkLock function activating conditions In order for the ParkLock function to be active when the engine is running, either the electromechanical switch on the reverse shuttle lever must be activated, or the emergency brake lever must be engaged. However, in addition to this information, the Autotronic 5 calculator must receive a ground speed reading lower than 1 kph from the Autotronic 4 calculator via the CAN network. To deactivate the ParkLock function, the calculator must receive an accumulator charge pressure reading (pressure switches M1 and M2) over 105 bar and an engine speed reading over 800 rpm from the Autotronic 4 calculator via the CAN network. The electromechanical switch must also be deactivated and the emergency brake lever must be released.
To unlock the brakes, tighten screw A. Two conditions must be met when towing the tractor: - Maximum towing speed: 10 kph. - Maximum towing distance: 10 km. IMPORTANT: Before any towing operation, the Hare / Tortoise range must be set to neutral position using the emergency control lever to prevent any risk of damage to the Dyna VT transmission.
When the engine is stopped, the ParkLock function is activated automatically (tractor immobilised).
CAUTION: When the ignition is off, the ParkLock engages gradually, regardless of tractor ground speed. The brakes are fitted with a mechanical unlocking system (Fig. 5) to allow tractor towing or use of the limp home mode in case of a breakdown.
A
Fig. 5
11E10.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Autotronic 5 - ParkLock - Description D . Logical diagram of ParkLock operation
Engine stopped ParkLock engaged
Engine start
Engine speed < 800 rpm or pressure < 105 bar
Autotronic 5 ParkLock OFF
Engine speed > 800 rpm and pressure > 105 bar
Switch ON to OFF
Switch in ON position
Autotronic 5 ParkLock ON (standby mode)
Switch in OFF position
Switch OFF to ON then to OFF
Autotronic 5 ParkLock activated ParkLock disengaged
ParkLock engaged
Ground speed < 1 kph
Switch OFF to ON or Emergency brake lever activated (kept in high position)
Switch ON to OFF or Emergency brake lever released (low position)
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Ground speed > 1 kph
No reaction ParkLock disengaged
ParkLock disengaged
11E10.7
Autotronic 5 - ParkLock - Description
Pin
E . Allocation of Autotronic 5 ParkLock pins The Autotronic 5 calculator is fitted with a 42-pin connector (Fig. 6) whose pin allocation is given in the table below.
29
42
Description
Type of signal
23
Not used
24
Not used
25
Not used
26
Not used
27
Not used
28
Calculator ground
29
+12V permanent calculator supply
30
M1
Pressure switch M1 (105 bar)
Analog input (0-12V)
31
TR34
Front axle braking pressure sensor
Analog input (0-12V)
32
5th electrohydraulic spool valve sensor signal
Analog input (0-9.5V)
33
Not used
34
Not used
35
Not used
36
Not used
15 28
MA-11-01268A
1
14
Fig. 6
Pin
Description
Type of signal
1
Calculator power supply +12 V AC (Ignition key On)
Initialisation
37
Not used
2
5th electrohydraulic spool valve sensor supply
9.5V regulated output
38
Not used
3
Not used
39
CAN Low
4
L10
Trailer braking valve control proportional solenoid valve
Output return (4A)
40
CAN High
41
Analog reference (5th electrohydraulic spool valve sensor ground)
5
L10
Trailer braking valve control proportional solenoid valve
Output (4A)
42
Calculator power supply +12 V AC (Ignition key On)
6
Not used
7
L11
Trailer braking valve control safety solenoid valve
Digital output (2A)
8
Not used
9
Not used
10
Not used
11
Not used
12
Not used
13
Not used
14
Calculator power supply +12 V AC (Ignition key On)
15
Calculator ground
16
M2
Pressure switch M2 (105 bar)
Analog input (0-12V)
17
CAB42
ParkLock electromechanical switch on the reverse shuttle lever
Analog input (0-12V)
18
Not used
19
Not used
20
Not used
21
Not used
22
L9
Parklock ram pressure reversing valve control Digital output (2A) solenoid valve
11E10.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Programming
GUF531 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Programming
CONTENTS A . Programming. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Saving to a file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF531.1
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Programming
GUF531.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Programming
A . Programming - Switch on the ignition key to carry out this operation. The engine must be stopped. - The programming of the Autotronic 5 is necessary: - when the former Autotronic 5 has been replaced by a new one, - when a new program becomes available to improve the product, - if the Autotronic 5 was programmed in a different configuration (ParkLock, linkage, etc.). NOTA: Parameter setting must be carried out on some softs after the first programming (Powershuttle, Dynashift, Dyna-6 and linkage soft). - Click on the “Tools” icon and then on “Programming AUTO5” icon.
Wintest
AUTO5 label Table of AUTO5 constants Programming AUTO5 List of AUTO5 error codes
MA-11-01281A
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF531.3
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Programming Autotronic 5 programming is a 5-step process: 1. Searching for calculators present on CAN network 2. Selecting a calculator to be programmed 3. Starting the programming process 4. Selecting a soft to integrate into the calculator 5. Validating the programming The following screen is displayed:
Programming Auto 5 Auto 5 present on the CAN network serial n° Auto 5 ParkLock GPA40-n° 002696
Application H01/B03 -> V02.01
Update -> V02.04
1. Searching for calculators present on CAN network 2. Selecting a programmed
calculator
to
be
Auto 5 selected: Auto 5 ParkLock-n° 002696
Programming
Scanning CAN network
Auto5->File
3. Starting the programming process
Select soft ->
ParkLock GPA40 ParkLock HA...
PowerShuttle Dyna-6 Trans1
Linkage
4WD suspension
4. Selecting a soft to integrate into the calculator
Dyna-6 Trans2 Dynashift Trans1 Dynashift Trans2 Soft selected: Auto 5 PowerShuttle - V01.05-B6
Validate
5. Validating the programming
MA-11-01498A
Fig. 1
NOTA: Each step must be validated to progress to the following step. If a step is dimmed, the previous step has not been validated.
GUF531.4
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Programming Searching for calculators present on CAN network When the window is opened, Wintest automatically starts an Autotronic 5 search on the CAN network. However, this search can be refreshed at any time by clicking on “Scanning CAN network”. The list of calculators appears as follows:
serial n°
Application
Auto 5 ParkLock-n°002696
H01/B03 -> V02.01
Update -> V02.04
Soft integrated into calculators (a) with • H01: Calculator hardware version (calcu- Program update possible with new soft version unique calculator serial number Fig. 2 lator version) • B03: Calculator Boot version (central hub included in Wintest of programs) (b) • V02.01: Soft version integrated into Autotronic 5 NOTA: (a) A blank Autotronic 5 is provided as standard with ParkLock GPA40 soft in the spare parts (b) A new Boot version can be included in the new soft version; however, 2 different soft items will often carry the same Boot version.
Fig. 2
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF531.5
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Programming Selecting a calculator to be programmed Double click in the left-hand column of the line of the calculator you wish to program. The line turns blue and at the base of the left-hand column, Wintest specifies which Autotronic 5 has been selected.
Starting the programming process Click on the “Programming” button to indicate your choice of programming.
Selecting a soft to integrate into the calculator Click on the “text” button of the required soft. The soft buttons are the same colour as the dots stuck on the calculators during assembly at the factory: Orange: ParkLock GPA40 Blue ParkLock HA... Yellow: PowerShuttle Violet: Dyna-6 - Transmission 1 Brown: Dyna-6 - Transmission 2 Green: Linkage Pink: Suspended front axle The line under the buttons specifies which soft has been selected.
Validating the programming Click on the “Validate” button. A gauge indicates the progression of the programming. At the end of the programming, Wintest automatically starts a scan of the CAN network.
GUF531.6
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Programming During programming, several error messages may be displayed.
Error File cannot be opened
IMPORTANT: When programming with a Boot update, unexpected interruption of programming can be fatal for Autotronic 5. To avoid Autotronic 5 breakdown: Do not disconnect the calculator. Restart programming (Wintest will offer to reprogram only the faulty calculator to make it operational). NOTE: If the Autotronic 5 programming is interrupted unexpectedly, switch off the ignition key and then switch it on again. This enables you to resume programming.
Message: - File cannot be opened - Select a soft - Select a calculator - Calculator cannot be unlocked - Bank 1 cannot be erased - Bank 2 cannot be erased - Bank 3 cannot be erased - Bank 4 cannot be erased (Boot) - Programming error - End-of-programming error - Reboot error - Table change reset error - File name length error - File run error Correction method: - Depending on the type of message, try to follow the requested indications. - Cut the ignition and turn it back on. - Check the CAN BOX interface connections with the 16-pin diagnostics connector. - The AUTOTRONIC 5 unit is defective. - If necessary, reinstall the Wintest software on your PC.
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF531.7
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Programming
B . Saving to a file Calculator data (program, parameters and calibration) can be saved in a single file that can be forwarded to technical support as requested. This file can be opened only by the factory engineers.
- Double click in the left-hand column of the line of the calculator whose content you wish to save. The line turns blue and at the bottom of the left-hand column, Wintest specifies which Autotronic 5 has been selected. - Next, click on the “Auto5 -> File” icon:
Programming Auto 5 Auto 5 present on the CAN network serial n° Auto 5 ParkLock GPA40-n° 002696
Application H01/B03 -> V02.01
Update -> V02.04
Auto 5 selected: Auto 5 ParkLock-n° 002696
Programming
Auto5->File
Scanning CAN network
The content will be saved in a file
Validate MA-11-01522A
Fig. 3 - Next, click on “Validate”.
GUF531.8
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Programming - The following screen is displayed: Programming Auto 5 Auto 5 present on the CAN network serial n° Auto 5 ParkLock GPA40-n° 002696
Application H01/B03 -> V02.01
Update -> V02.04
Auto 5 selected: Auto 5 ParkLock-n° 002696
Programming
Scanning CAN network
Auto5->File Reading flash: 16%
The content will be saved in a file: 02696_031.cln
Validate MA-11-01531A
- A gauge indicates the progression of the saving process. - It can take between 3 and 15 minutes to create the backup file (depending on the file type and the power of your computer). NOTA: Given the time required for the saving process, ensure that your computer cannot enter standby mode during the procedure.
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF531.9
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Programming - When the saving process is complete, the following screen is displayed: Save as
?
Save to:
My documents
My images 8961_062.cln
Name:
02696_031
Save
Type :
02696_031
Cancel
MA-11-01448A
- By default, the backup file is named with a “*.cln” extension, and cannot be renamed. Its name comprises the “unique” serial number of the calculator Fig. 2. - If you wish, you can change the location to which the backup file is saved. - Click on “Save”. - When the save process is complete, Wintest returns to the programming window.
GUF531.10
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Tests and diagnostics
GUF532 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Tests and diagnostics
CONTENTS A . Diagnostics screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF532.1
AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Tests and diagnostics
GUF532.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Tests and diagnostics
A . Diagnostics screen - Start the engine. - Click on the “ParkLock” icon
Wintest
DCC2 : 4.01 AUTO 4 : 1.06
JOY : 3.6
PK: A5 PK02.01 : 1.03
CLIM : 20.05
A5 RL : 1.50
DATA3 : 1.4
MA-11-01381A
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF532.3
AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Tests and diagnostics The following screen is displayed:
DynaVT ParkLock
9
1
2
35
7K4XAM
7K4XAM
R57
R57
R57
NIM
NIM
1 1
1 ENG21
ENG22 1
R57
R0 01
654 321 7 8 9 101112
R051
R0 01
R065
10 04N1
CAB34 1 W107_3MM_ROUGE
51L
R57
R065
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9011121314151617181
R051
81 21 6
R51
31 7 1
TROFFE
1 2 2 1 ENG20
1MM_NOIR
0 Km/h
7K4NOITISOP
No error
CAB33 CAB23 1 W011_5MM_MARRON 1 W108_3MM_ROUGE CAB32 CAB24 3MM_ROUGE 1 1 W109_ 1 W0123MM MARRON 1 X4
X2
CAB35 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 ENG1
R051
10 04N1
CAB21 CAB25 W110_ 3MM_ROUGE W113_ 3MM_MARRON 1 1
MA-11-01380A
Pressure reverse solenoid valve supplying the ParkLock ram (L9) OFF = ram not supplied = ParkLock activated ON = ram supplied = ParkLock deactivated Trailer brake valve safety solenoid valve (L11)
ON = Safety solenoid valve not supplied OFF = Safety mode activated (serious error or emergency control activated) = Safety solenoid valve supplied
Trailer brake valve proportional solenoid valve (L10) with a progress bar showing the pressure range and percentage of current. 35
Emergency control
Action on pedals
Trailer brake valve proportional solenoid valve (L10)
0
0
0%
0 or 1
1
35% to 80% depending on pressure on pedals
1
0
100%
No error
ParkLock information locked - if ParkLock is activated, it is displayed in red and the padlock is closed - if ParkLock is deactivated, it is displayed in white and the padlock is open
Error code display
- if error is active, it is displayed in red - For information on the errors, click on the icon Design ground speed indicated by ground speed sensor in kph (information from CAN) 0 Km/h
GUF532.4
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Tests and diagnostics Brake pedal switches (information on the 2 pedals together from CAN)
Parking brake switch (TR20) (information from CAN)
- switch open: White - switch closed: blue ParkLock electromechanical switch on the left-hand lever (CAB42)
- switch open: White - switch closed: blue Value of braking pressure switch (TR34) 9
1
105 bar pressure switch (M1) for braking circuit load pressure
- switch open: white = pressure < 105 bar - switch closed: blue = pressure > 105 bar
2
105 bar pressure switch (M2) for braking circuit load pressure
- switch open: white = pressure < 105 bar - switch closed: blue = pressure > 105 bar
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF532.5
AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Tests and diagnostics
GUF532.6
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Error codes
GUF533 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Error codes
CONTENTS A . List of error codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Analysing components and their error codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF533.1
AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Error codes
GUF533.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Error codes
A . List of error codes Autotronic 5 is able to detect certain faults in the ParkLock harness or components. When a fault is detected in Wintest, the error code is visibly displayed.
Code 31 32 33
Component
Open circuit Trailer brake valve proportional solenoid valve Short circuit to (-) earth (L10) Short circuit to + 12V
41 42
Open circuit Trailer brake valve safety solenoid valve (L11) Short circuit to (-) earth
43
Short circuit to + 12V
51
Open circuit
52
Pressure reverse solenoid valve (L9)
53 71
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
Fault
Short circuit to (-) earth Short circuit to + 12V
Braking pressure sensor (TR34)
Signal error
GUF533.3
AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Error codes
B . Analysing components and their error codes L9 : Pressure reverse solenoid valve Description Location: on the hydraulic unit under the emergency control lever - left-hand side of cab (Fig. 1) ON/OFF solenoid valve
L9
- Connectors 1: Signal - Connectors 2: Ground Signals: Solenoid valve OFF: 0V Solenoid valve ON: 12V - 2A max.
MA-11-01385A
Fig. 1
2
2 1
1 MA-11-01388A
Fig. 2 Possible error codes Errors
Description
51
Open circuit
52
Short circuit to (-) earth
53
Short circuit to + 12V
GUF533.4
¤ H
Solutions Check: - Contacts - Harness connections - Wiring - Solenoid valve condition
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Error codes L10 : Trailer brake valve proportional solenoid valve
L10
Description
L11
Location: on the braking valve (Fig. 3) - above the transmission Proportional solenoid valve supplied with current - Connectors 1: Signal - Connectors 2: Signal return Signals: Solenoid valve OFF: 0A Solenoid valve ON: 12V - up to 2A MA-11-01387A
Fig. 3
2 1
2 1
Possible error codes
Errors
Description
31
Open circuit
32
Short circuit to (-) earth
33
Short circuit to + 12V
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
MA-11-01389A
Fig. 4
Solutions Check: - Contacts - Harness connections - Wiring - Solenoid valve condition
GUF533.5
AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Error codes L11 : Trailer brake valve safety solenoid valve
L10
Description
L11
Location: on the braking valve (Fig. 5) - above the transmission ON/OFF solenoid valve - Connectors 1: Signal - Connectors 2: Ground Signals: Solenoid valve OFF: 0V Solenoid valve ON: 12V - 2A max. MA-11-01387A
Fig. 5
2
2 1
1
Possible error codes
Errors
MA-11-01390A
Description
41
Open circuit
42
Short circuit to (-) earth
43
Short circuit to + 12V
GUF533.6
¤ H
Fig. 6
Solutions Check: - Contacts - Harness connections - Wiring - Solenoid valve condition
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Error codes TR34: Braking pressure sensor Description Location: under the brake master cylinders (Fig. 7)
TR34
- Connectors A: 12V supply - Connectors B: Signal - Connectors C: Ground Signal: from 1 to 5V
Fig. 7 MA-11-01386A
A
Possible error codes
B
A B C
C
P bar
MA-11-01391A
Fig. 8
Errors 71
Description Signal error
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
Solutions Check: - Contacts - Harness connections - Wiring - F16 fuse
GUF533.7
AUTOTRONIC 5 - DynaVT ParkLock - Error codes
GUF533.8
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Electrical diagrams
GUF535 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Electrical diagrams
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Electrical diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 C . Layout of components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
¤ H
GUF535.1
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Electrical diagrams
GUF535.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Electrical diagrams
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
¤ H
CAB83 OFF
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CAB83
R S2
MA-10-01000A
CAB37.6/CAB83.1 B CAB37.7/CAB83.3 B
6
7
5 3
4 2
11 10 9
1
FAI 03 FAI 48
8
CAB37
12
- Components with only one connector are identified by the connector name: CAB83 - Suspended front axle switch (Fig. 1). - Harnesses performing the same funtions have the same colour on the diagram (Fig. 1): • FAI03 - Dynashift console harness (green) • FAI48 - DynaVT console harness (green) - All wires can be identified by the pins of the outgoing and incoming connectors of the harness: CAB37.6/CAB83.1: The wire connects pin 6 of the CAB37 connector to pin 1 of the CAB83 connector - The detail of pins allocation for each connector is shown on the harness side - The wire colour is indicated: CAB37.6/CAB83.1 B, the wire is white List of colours: - N: Black - M: Brown - R: Red - B: White - J: Yellow - V: Green - The splices inside the harnesses are indicated by a dot and the letter S (S2).
S2.1/CAB83.2
The harnesses fitted on the tractor allow data to be exchanged and power to be supplied to the electrical and electronic systems. The tractor is fitted with 3 different types of power supply: • +12V Battery (Permanent) • +12V APC (Ignition key ON) • +12V ACC (Accessories) Most harnesses have a maximum of six different wire colours: - Black: Ground - Brown: +12V Permanent - Red: +12V APC (Ignition key ON) and Accessories - White: Information - Yellow: CAN High - Green: CAN Low The CAN network wires (yellow and green) are twisted together.
R
Description
BAF12.2/S2.1
A . General
In general, the components or connectors are named in order to indicate the corresponding elements of the tractor: AC## Armrest BAF## Fuse box CA## Automatic air conditioning CAB## Cab ENG## Engine FA## Suspended front axle L## Linkage - ParkLock (HA) LIG## Lighting R## Linkage and roof ROOF##Roof TR## Transmission V# Electrohydraulic spool valve X# Round battery cable terminal on fuse box
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
CAB37 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
Fig. 1
GUF535.3
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Electrical diagrams Layout 5 Deutsch connectors (31-way) are connected to the cab: - 2 on the front panel Fig. 2) - 3 at the bottom rear right-hand side of the cab (Fig. 3).
ENG1
Fig. 2: All these connectors belong to the engine harness. ENG2 is dedicated to information concerning the electronic injection.
ENG2
Fig. 3: Always in the following order (regardless of tractor configuration and options), from left to right: L14 Linkage harness junction CAB50 Transmission harness junction LIG1 Lighting harness junction
MA-10-01003A
Fig. 2
L14
LIG1
+12V
MA-10-01002A
14
16
13
15
17
12 11
10 9
8 7
6 5
4 3
2 1
BAF10
F9- 15A +APC
1 X2 F48 - 7.5A
+12V
1 X4 18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
F48
MA-10-01001A
2
GUF535.4
¤ H
Fig. 3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
18
BAF12
The fuses and relays of the electrical or electronic board (Fig. 4) are indicated by a black mark on their locations on the fuse box (2).
CAB50
F9
Fig. 4
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Electrical diagrams
B . Electrical diagrams ParkLock..................................................................... 7 Electrical supply ......................................................... 8 CAN network.............................................................. 9
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
¤ H
GUF535.5
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Electrical diagrams Harness parts list FAI 23 FAI 31 FAI 35 FAI 128 FAI 129 FAI 130
Cab linkage harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Linkage with Dual Control - TIC harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness DynaVT transmission harness
Component parts list CAB01 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB42 ParkLock electromagnetic switch on the left-hand lever CAB141 Autotronic 5 - DynaVT ParkLock L8 LS signal breaker solenoid valve L9 Pressure reverse solenoid valve L10 Trailer brake valve proportional solenoid valve L11 Trailer brake valve safety solenoid valve TR20 Emergency handbrake switch TR34 Braking pressure sensor 2 M1 M2
Fuse box 105 bar pressure switch for braking circuit load pressure 105 bar pressure switch for braking circuit load pressure
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
GUF535.6
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Electrical diagrams
ParkLock
20
26
CAB141 CAB141
29
42
15
28
1
14
22
23
23
25
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
FAI 23 cab141.31/L14.24
B
CAB141.30/L14.25
B
CAB141.7/L14.27
B
CAB141.5/L14.28
B
CAB141.4/L14.29
B
CAB141.22/L14.30
B
L14.26/S15.1
N
L14.17/S7.1
R
B
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L14
L14
N
2
L10 L14.30/L9.1
B
L14.29/L10.2 L14.28/L10.1
L10
B
1 2
B
L14.27/L11.1
B
L14.26/S7.1
1 2
N
L14.25/L15.1
B
L11 S7.1/L11.2
S7
L14.17/S6.1
N
1 2
1
2
L11
R L15 1
1
M1 L16 S6.1/L16.1
R
1
1
L13 S6 S6.1/L13.1
R
1
1
L12 L14.3/L12.1
1
M2 1
4
7
FAI 35
CAB42
8
BAF8.5/CAB42.1 R S23.1/CAB42.2 B
4
5
B
5
3
6
2
B
1
L20.12/CAB18.6
S7.1/L9.2
FAI 128
27 26
8
CAB141.16/L14.3
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1
28 16
15 14
24
1 2
17 6
5 13
24
29
7 1
4 12
25
L9
18
2 3
11
12
L9
30 19
10 22
11 4 13
14
27
8 9
10 3
1 5 15
31
21
9 2
7 6 16
20 21
8 19
18 17 28
1
31 30
29
CAB141
1 2
CAB18 1
17
1
2
3
4
16 18
15 13
14
11
12
9
8 6
10
7 5 3
4
1
2
2
1 3
4 6
7
8
9 11
12
13
14 16
B
BAF7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
BAF7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
L14.24/TR36.1
ENG1
C
ENG10
30 19 18
2
17 16 27
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
TA34 TR34 ENG10.5/TR34.A
R TR36.1/TR34.B
B
TR34.C/TR31.1
N
26
ENG10
9
14
A B C
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
CAB1
46 24 1
68 45 23
CAB1 TR31
15
13 25
28
6 5
24
29
7 1
4 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
11 12
8 9 3
11 23
R
10
31
20 21 10 22
S7 S7.1/ENG10.5
R
1
ENG1.8/S7.1
8
25
B
A
FAI 129
2
24
FAI 130
3
13 14
26
23 12
1 2 3 4
4
1
15 27
22 11
4
1 2 3 4
TR36
1 2
5
10 3
1 5
TR36
3 4
7
9 2
7 6 16
1 2
6
21
8 19
18 17
4 3
7
20
31 30
29 28
B
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8
2
BAF7.7/ENG1.8
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
11 10 9
FAI 35
F18-7.5A
F16-30A
B
ENG1
12
10
6
9
8
5
7
6
4
5
3
3 4
2
1 2
1
1
12
7 8
3 2
11 10 9
7
6 5 4
9
5
8
6
1 2
S23.1/CAB1.21
BAF12
4
11 12
CAB18
+12V
3
3
CAB1
1
6
4
S23
X2
2
¤ H
B
F16 - 30A
F22-10A
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
CAB18.6/S23.1
BAF8
5
10
17
15
10
5
N
18
L20.9/CAB73_1.1
8
B
R
7
CAB141.17/L20.12
L20.5/BAF12.7
9
N
10
S15.1/L20.9
F18 - 7.5A
6
9
R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
5
10
S7.1/L20.5
L20
8
7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
F22 - 10A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
7
8
6 5
L20 S7
S15
BAF12 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
9
3
1
FAI 31
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
10
4
2
BAF8
1
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CAB73 1
2
1
MA-11-01383A
GUF535.7
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Electrical diagrams Electrical supply
Harness parts list
CAB141
Component parts list
42
15
28
1
14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
CAB141
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 CAB141.42/S14.1 R
CAB141.28/S15.1 N CAB141.29/S13.1 M
R
CAB141
CAB141.1/S7.1
S15
Fuse box 105 bar pressure switch for braking circuit load pressure 105 bar pressure switch for braking circuit load pressure
S14
6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF6
6 5 4 3 2 1
BAF6
5
3
1
6
4
2
S13 3
5
2
4
6
X2 +12V
F18 - 7.5A 1
X4 F21 - 7.5A
+12V
18
17 13
14
11 9
8
10
12
15
16
1
7
7
8
9
10
11
12 16
13 15 17
18
14
7 8
6 5 4 3 2
11 10 9
1
12
1 2
11 12
3
9
4 5
F22-10A
10
5
FAI 31
3
F21-7.5A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
6
R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
5
N
L20.5/BAF12.7
R
1
S15.1/L20.9
L20.3/BAF6.2
1
F22 - 10A
BAF12
M
3
R
L20.1/BAF12.9
4
S7.1/L20.5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1
R
L20
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
2
S14.1/L20.3
L20
2
2
M
4
S7
S13.1/L20.1
6
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
1
FAI 23
8
M2
N
CAB73 1
7
2 M1
L20.9/CAB73_1.1
6
CAB01 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB42 ParkLock electromagnetic switch on the left-hand lever CAB141 Autotronic 5 - DynaVT ParkLock L8 LS signal breaker solenoid valve L9 Pressure reverse solenoid valve L10 Trailer brake valve proportional solenoid valve L11 Trailer brake valve safety solenoid valve TR20 Emergency handbrake switch TR34 Braking pressure sensor
29
R N
Cab linkage harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Linkage with Dual Control - TIC harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness DynaVT transmission harness
CAB141.14/S14.1 CAB141.15/S15.1
FAI 23 FAI 31 FAI 35 FAI 128 FAI 129 FAI 130
2
BAF12
F18-7.5A MA-11-01382A
GUF535.8
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Electrical diagrams CAN network
Harness parts list 30
120
S12.1/CAB54.26 CAB54.27/S13.1
V
FAI 31
V J
68 45 23
12
29 17 28
6 16
5 15
13 24
27
14 25
26
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI 28
CA1
ENG4
34
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
FAI 31 4
3
2
1
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
8
7
6
5
TR18.5/CAB50.7
V
TR18.2/CAB50.4
J
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
V
CA1.14/CA8.2
J
FAI 57
TR18 TR18
CAB18 S21 S20
1
8
FAI 32
FAI 35
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CA1.1/CA8.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
4
J V
S21.1/CAB18.2 S20.1/CAB18.1
V J
ENG2
11
1 6
28
23
4 12
5
16 15
13 24
14
27 26
25
7
10 22
3 11
1 6
23
4 12
5
16 15
13 24
14 26
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
25
FAI 41 S5.1/AC2.8 S6.1/AC2.7
V J
6
5
4
3
2
1
7
8
9
10
11 12
S5 S6
L14
1 2
3
4
3
V J S2.1/V5.2 S3.1/V5.3
V J
V J
V J S2.1/V3.2 S3.1/V3.3
S2.1/V4.2 S3.1/V4.3
V J 1
2
S5
J V
V1.2/S4.1 V1.3/S5.1
V J
L 22
L14
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
1
S10 S9
FAI 23
S8.1/L22A.1 S9.1/L22A.2
V J
V1.2/S2.1 V1.3/S3.1
V J CAB112
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
L22.1/S4.1 L22.2/S3.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V J
S4_ S4.1/CAB112.4 S_3 S3.1/CAB112.3
V J
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L13
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
6
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
S3.1/L111.14 S4.1/L111.16 L111.13/CAB112.6 L111.12/CAB112.5
FAI 68
S8.1/FS4.29
V
S1.1/FS4.30
V
S_1
FS2.N/S1.1 FS2.M/S1.1
V V
S5.1/FS2.K FS2.J/S5.1
J J
J
S5.1/FS4.28
J S__5
FS4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37
FS1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
FS1
33 1 5 10 16 23 29 34
CAB1 29
42
29
42
15
28
15
28
1
14
1
14
13
7 8 9 10
3 4 5
1 2
6
1
CAB112
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
J V V J
FAI 68 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
CAB141 CAB141
11 12 14
S9
CAB141
L13
16
CAB112
FS1 L13
15
FAI 131
FAI 68
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
L 22
J V
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CA8.1/S4.1 CA8.2/S3.1
1
2
S8
S9.1/FS4.27
J V CAB141.40/S10.1 CAB141.39/S9.1
1 2 3 4
7
L22A 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V1
1 2 3 4
FAI 128
L22.1/S8.1 L22.2/S9.1 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V1
1
L22
J V
3
4
J V
L14.13/S5.1 S4.1/L14.12
2
S10.1/AC1.12 AC1.11/S9.1
FAI 46
28
4
AC1 S10.1/L13.40 S9.1/L13.39
1 2 3 4
3
7
1 2 3 4
V5
16
S4
4
6
V5
4
26
S5.1/L14.16 S4.1/L14.15
5
5 8
3
27
14 25
6
4
3
1 2
7
2
11 10 9
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4
15
J V
5 6 7
1 12
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V4 V4 4
S2
17 6
5 13
24
29
7 1
4 12
4
V
3
18
2 3
11 23
AC1 CAB1.39/S21.1
1 2
19
9 10 22
7
AC2
S6.1/AC1.12 AC1.11/S5.1
1 2
CA8
4
6
CA8
S3
30
5
5 8
1 2
1
9 2
7 17
27
8
6
4
3
1 2 3 4
31
20 21
5 6
2
11 10 9
1 2 3 4
V3
2
19 18 29 28
21
8
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
4
1 12
V3
4
3
3
20
31 30
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
3
V J
1 2 3 4
1 2
AC2.8/S12.1 S13.1/AC2.7
1 2 3 4
V2
S2.1/V2.2 S3.1/V2.3
FAI 41
J V J V
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FAI 31
V2
1 2
AC2
J
X
X
X
5 6 7
AC12
ENG2
CAB1.16/S20.1
V5
V4
4
17
22
V J
27 26
10 3
1 2 3
16 15
14
9 2
7
1
28
6 5
13
21
8 19
18
X
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2
17
1 4
12 24
30
29
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
20
31
V3
3
29
V2
4
18 7
11 23
30 19
2 3
AC12 AC12
5
8 9
10
ENG2.1/ENG4.30 J ENG2.2/ENG4.31 V
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
6
21
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
31
20
22
J V
7
S20.1/ENG2.1 S21.1/ENG2.2
1 2 3
46 24 1
N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
18 7
1 4
5
S13.1/CAB18.1 S12.1/CAB18.2
CAB1
Colour reminder
30 19
2
11 23
CAB18 S13 S12
FAI 35
CAB1
8 9 3
TR18
CAB54
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
31
20 21 10 22
CAB50
25
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
26
L13.15/L14.16 L13.34/L14.15 L14.13/L22.2 L14.12/L22.1
M2
Fuse box 105 bar pressure switch for braking circuit load pressure 105 bar pressure switch for braking circuit load pressure
1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
ENG4
28 16 27
14 25
J V
2 M1
CAB83
29 17
15
AC12.3/S6.1 S5.1/AC12.4
68 45 23
46 24 1
CAB01 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB42 ParkLock electromagnetic switch on the left-hand lever CAB141 Autotronic 5 - DynaVT ParkLock L8 LS signal breaker solenoid valve L9 Pressure reverse solenoid valve L10 Trailer brake valve proportional solenoid valve L11 Trailer brake valve safety solenoid valve TR20 Emergency handbrake switch TR34 Braking pressure sensor
V J
CAB83.1/CAB50.7
Component parts list
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
18
6 5
13 24
25
2
30
7 1
4 12
CAB50
19 2
3 11
24
14 26
CAB83.1/CAB54.4 CAB83.2/CAB54.5
23
13
J
CAB54
22
23 12
5
27
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
22 11
4
15
10
10 3
1 6
16
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
8 9
9 2
7 17
CAB54
21
21
8 19
18 29 28
31
20
20
31
Cab linkage harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Linkage with Dual Control - TIC harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness DynaVT transmission harness
CAB83.2/CAB50.4
FAI 23 FAI 31 FAI 35 FAI 128 FAI 129 FAI 130
4
J V B
FS2
P
N
E M
D A C
L
F
B G K J
H
FS2
3
9 15 22 28 33 37
FS2.C/FS1.8 FS1.9/FS2.B FS1.5/FS2.A
P N M L K J H G F E D C B A
2 9
4 1
5
MA-11-01384A
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
¤ H
GUF535.9
AUTOTRONIC 5 - ParkLock DynaVT - Electrical diagrams
C . Layout of components Harness parts list FAI 23 FAI 31 FAI 35 FAI 128 FAI 129 FAI 130
Cab linkage harness Cab DynaVT transmission harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Linkage with Dual Control - TIC harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness DynaVT transmission harness
TR34
Component parts list CAB01 Instrument panel (DCC2) CAB42 ParkLock electromagnetic switch on the left-hand lever CAB141 Autotronic 5 - DynaVT ParkLock L8 LS signal breaker solenoid valve L9 Pressure reverse solenoid valve L10 Trailer brake valve proportional solenoid valve L11 Trailer brake valve safety solenoid valve TR20 Emergency handbrake switch TR34 Braking pressure sensor 2 M1 M2
Fuse box 105 bar pressure switch for braking circuit load pressure 105 bar pressure switch for braking circuit load pressure
L9
L11
L10
TR20
L8
M1 M2
Colour reminder N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
MA-11-01418A
GUF535.10
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.b
Autotronic 5 - Linkage - Description
11F10 - Autotronic 5 - Linkage - Description
CONTENTS A . General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 C . Console and armrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 D . Allocation of Autotronic 5 linkage calculator pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11F10.1
Autotronic 5 - Linkage - Description
11F10.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Autotronic 5 - Linkage - Description
A . General
Dyna VT CAN network
8400 series tractors are fitted with an electronic linkage system controlled by an Autotronic 5 calculator. This calculator is attached under the cab floor, on the right-hand of the driver's seat. The Autotronic 5 Linkage electronic calculator ensures operation of the linkage in communication with the other electronic calculators of the tractors via the CAN network (Fig. 1).
1
10
7
8
9
1 2 3 4 5
The CAN network allows programming and parameter setting of the Autotronic 5 Linkage electronic calculator using the Wintest software.
Parts list 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
6
ESC
CAN network
DCC2 instrument panel Autotronic 4 transmission calculator 16-pin diagnostics connector Electronic injection control unit (EEM) Autotronic 5 electronic linkage calculator ParkLock Autotronic 5 calculator Datatronic 3 Joystick Electrohydraulic spool valves Automatic air conditioning controller
4
2
6
5
3
15 16
11 12 13 14
7 8 9 10
3 4 5
1 2
6
7 2
5
8
6
10 Location
1
3 9
4
MA-11-06101A
Fig. 1
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11F10.3
Autotronic 5 - Linkage - Description
B . Description The Autotronic 5 electronic linkage calculator is also electrically connected to various elements of the tractor (Fig. 2):
CAN 12
Parts list Linkage spool valve (L6-L7) Pressure relief solenoid valve on auxiliary hydraulics circuit (L2) (3) Linkage console (L15) (4) Armrest (quick soil engagement button AC6, height / depth setting potentiometer AC9 and linkage lifting / neutral / lowering selector switch AC13) (5) Electrohydraulic spool valve control panel (ON/OFF switch AC3 and flow rate memory switch AC5) (6) Front linkage external controls (L1) (7) Rear linkage external controls (LIG6, LIG7, LIG8, LIG9) (8) DUAL CONTROL and TIC sensor (L17) (9) Auxiliary hydraulics levers 1 and 2 sensor (L18-L19) (10) Linkage position sensor (L3) (11) Right- and left-hand draft sensors (L4-L5) (12) Start switch
10
11
(1) (2)
1
9 2
Autotronic 5
8 3
4 42
29 15
28 14
5
1
7
6
MA-11-06094A
Fig. 2
11F10.4
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Autotronic 5 - Linkage - Description Safety start switch (12) To avoid the system remaining active when the engine is stopped, a safety system is installed. When the ignition switch is turned on, the Autotronic 5 calculator receives 12 volts from the start switch (12). This lights the two indicator lights E and F (Fig. 12). F remains lit for 0.5 seconds. E remains lit until an "engine running" signal is received via the CAN network and the 3-position switch (AC13 Fig. 5) is toggled to Lifting then Neutral position.
CAUTION: Ensure that button B (Fig. 12) is in position control mode 1 to prevent unexpected movement of the lift arms in draft control mode.
L2 L6-L7
Fig. 3
MA-11-06096A
Linkage spool valve (Lifting solenoid valve: L6, Lowering solenoid valve: L7) It is fitted to the auxiliary hydraulics unit on the rear axle (Fig. 3). It is a proportional control solenoid valve that allows the linkage to be activated depending on the signals sent by the Autotronic 5 linkage calculator. Pressure relief solenoid valve on auxiliary hydraulics circuit (L2) It is fitted to the auxiliary hydraulics unit on the rear axle (Fig. 3). It allows the auxiliary hydraulic spool valves supply to be cut when a fault occurs on either of them.
A Linkage console (L15) MA-11-06115A-MF
It is located on the right-hand console (Ref. A Fig. 4). The linkage console comprises several elements, including the linkage high position setting potentiometer, function selector potentiometer (draft / Intermix / position), manual or automatic linkage lowering speed setting potentiometer, lowering speed automatic control indicator light, console locking and malfunction self-diagnostic indicator light, active transport control system indicator light, active transport control system selector switch, linkage lifting indicator light, linkage lowering indicator light and wheel slip control switch.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Fig. 4
11F10.5
Autotronic 5 - Linkage - Description Armrest The armrest comprises several elements (Fig. 5): AC6 Quick soil engagement button AC9 Linkage height / depth setting potentiometer AC13 Lifting / neutral / lowering linkage control selector switch
AC9
AC13
Electrohydraulic spool valve control panel It is located on the cab inside console, to the right of the driver’s seat. It is fitted with two switches (Fig. 6): AC3 ON / OFF switch AC5 Flow rate Memory switch NOTE: On tractors with Datatronic 3, only available for program versions later than version 10.4.
MA-11-06097A-AG-MF
AC6 Fig. 5
Front linkage external controls (L1) The two switches are located at the front of the tractor (Fig. 7): L1-A Switch on tractor 8470 / 8480 L1-A Switch on tractor 8450 / 8460
AC5
AC3
MA-11-06098A
Fig. 6
L1-A L1-B
MA-11-06099A
Fig. 7
11F10.6
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Autotronic 5 - Linkage - Description Rear linkage external controls The external switches are located on the ends of the rear fenders (Fig. 8): LIG6 Right-hand linkage lifting switch LIG7 Right-hand linkage lowering switch LIG8 Left-hand linkage lifting switch LIG9 Left-hand linkage lowering switch FRONT and REAR DUAL CONTROL and TIC sensor (L17) The same sensor is used for the three applications. (See characteristics in section 11G10: DUAL CONTROL application). This sensor informs the linkage calculator of the angular position of either the front linkage or the rear implement depth wheel.
LIG7
LIG8
LIG6
LIG9
MA-11-06100A-MF
Fig. 8 Auxiliary hydraulics levers 1 and 2 sensors (L18 - L19) The sensor is the same potentiometer for both levers. It is fitted to the side of the unit (Fig. 9). This angle sensor informs the linkage calculator of the lever position. Set the face (1) of the potentiometer parallel to that of the spacer (2) in order to position the potentiometer in the middle of the ports (see GUF 522). Linkage position sensor (L3) It is located on the left-hand side of the lift arms upper pivot pin (Fig. 10). The sensor reads the angle of the linkage shaft and sends the data to the Autotronic 5 linkage calculator.
2
1
MA-11-01115A
Fig. 9
L3
MA-11-06110A
Fig. 10
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11F10.7
Autotronic 5 - Linkage - Description Right- and left-hand draft sensors (L4 - L5) These two sensors serve as a clevis pin to the lower lift arms (Fig. 11), and have a maximum capacity of 90 kN. They transmit to the Autotronic 5 linkage calculator a signal proportional to the draft applied to the lift arms. (L4) Right-hand draft sensor (L5) Left-hand draft sensor
L5
MA-11-06111A
Fig. 11
11F10.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Autotronic 5 - Linkage - Description
C . Console and armrest List of controls Fig. 12 (A) (B) (C)
Linkage high position setting potentiometer Function selector potentiometer (Draft / Intermix / Position) Manual or automatic linkage lowering speed setting potentiometer
(D) Lowering speed automatic control indicator light (E) Console locking and malfunction self-diagnostic indicator light. (F) Active transport control system selection indicator light (G) Active transport control system selector switch (H) Linkage lifting indicator light (I) Linkage lowering indicator light (J) Wheel slip control switch (optional) (K) Linkage height / depth setting potentiometer (L) Linkage Lifting / Neutral / Lowering selector switch (M) Quick soil engagement button
A
C
B
D
E J
I H
F
G
K
L
M MA-11-06095A-AG-MF
Fig. 12
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11F10.9
Autotronic 5 - Linkage - Description Description of controls A. Linkage high position setting potentiometer This potentiometer is used to adjust the maximum height of the lift arms. When the switch L is toggled to the Lifting position, the lift arms raise until they reach the adjustment value selected on this potentiometer. B. Function selector potentiometer (Draft / Intermix / Position) This potentiometer must be adjusted depending on the work to be carried out: - Position control: used with mounted implements - Draft control: used with soil penetrating implements (rarely 100% control). - Intermix: used with soil penetrating implements, in order to control the maximum draft while keeping a regular working depth (most commonly used position for ploughing, subsoiling, etc.). C. Manual or automatic linkage lowering speed setting potentiometer This potentiometer allows two modes to be selected: - Manual mode: the user adjusts the linkage lowering speed himself by activating the potentiometer. - Automatic mode (potentiometer turned fully clockwise): linkage lowering speed adjusts automatically depending on the weight of the hitched implement and ground speed (indicator light D comes on when this mode is used). D. Lowering speed automatic control indicator light
F. Active transport control system selection indicator light The indicator light comes on when the active transport control system is selected. G. Active transport control system selector switch The switch must be activated once when switch L is set to Lifting position in order to activate the active transport control system. In this case, each time switch L is placed in the Lifting position, the Autotronic 5 electronic linkage calculator supplies power to the lift control valve solenoid in order to keep the implement stable, whatever the speed of the tractor. The system is automatically disengaged when switch L is in the Neutral or Lowering position. To deactivate this function, set switch L to the Lifting position and press the switch G once. H-I. Linkage Lifting and Lowering indicator lights The indicator lights are lit while the solenoid valves are under voltage. They signal correct operation of the system. Their status changes continually when the linkage is used in Draft control mode. J. Wheel slip control switch (optional) When wheel slip control is activated, the linkage functions as during draft control mode: the working depth depends on the difference between the level of wheel slip measured and the level of wheel slip allowed (see section 11C10).
The indicator light comes on when the linkage lowering speed automatic mode is selected. E. Console locking and malfunction self-diagnostic indicator light Indicator light fixed on: linkage locked. Indicator light flashing: error code displayed.
11F10.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Autotronic 5 - Linkage - Description K. Linkage height / depth setting potentiometer This potentiometer is used to adjust the depth (or height) of the implement after a selection has been made on function selector B. In position control, the potentiometer travel is maximum. The maximum high position is slightly higher when using the external controls instead of this potentiometer. A floating position can be obtained by setting this potentiometer to position 9. In this case, the Lowering indicator light remains lit. L. Linkage Lifting / Neutral / Lowering selector This switch allows work to be carried out in the following modes: - Lifting position: the implement raises to the maximum position selected by potentiometer A. - Neutral position: the implement is locked in its position. This position must not be used during the transport phase. - Lowering Position: the implement lowers until to the position selected by the depth potentiometer K and the function selector potentiometer B. NOTE: On starting or after using the external controls, the switch L must be toggled to the Lifting position in order to activate the system. M. Quick soil engagement button When switch L is in Lowering position, the settings are cancelled by holding the quick soil engagement button pressed down. The implement can then penetrate the soil more quickly.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
11F10.11
Autotronic 5 - Linkage - Description
D . Allocation of Autotronic 5 linkage calculator pins The Autotronic 5 linkage calculator is fitted with a 42-pin connector (5) whose pin allocation is given in the table below.
29
42
15 28
MA-11-01268A
1
14
Fig. 13 Pin
Description
Type of signal
1
Calculator power supply +12 V AC (Ignition key On)
Initialisation
2
10 V supply (sensors and potentiometers)
10V regulated output
3
L6
Linkage lifting solenoid valve
Output return (4A max.)
4
L7
Linkage lowering solenoid valve
Output return (4A max.)
5
L7
Linkage lowering solenoid valve
Output (4A max.)
6
L6
Linkage lifting solenoid valve
Output (4A max.)
7
L1
Front linkage lifting external control
Digital input (2A max.)
8
L1
Front linkage lowering external control
Digital input (2A max.)
9
Calculator power supply +12 V AC (Ignition key On)
10
L15
Linkage console - self-diagnostic indicator light (LED) Digital output (2A max.)
11
L15
Linkage console - lowering speed indicator light (LED)
12
L2
13
Not used
14
Calculator power supply +12 V AC (Ignition key On)
15
Calculator ground
16
L5
17
Digital output (2A max.)
Pressure relief solenoid valve on auxiliary hydraulics Digital output (2A max.) circuit
Left-hand draft sensor
Analog input
AC9
Linkage height / depth setting potentiometer
Analog input
18
L15
Linkage console - high position potentiometer
Analog input
19
AC13
Linkage lifting / lowering / neutral selector switch and quick soil engagement button
Analog input
20
L18
1st auxiliary hydraulics lever sensor signal
Analog input
11F10.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
Autotronic 5 - Linkage - Description
Pin
Description
21
LIG6 LIG7 LIG8 LIG9
Rear linkage external controls
Analog input
22
L15
Linkage console - active transport control system selector switch
Digital input (2A max.)
23
Not used
24
L15
Linkage console - active transport control system indicator light (LED)
Digital output (2A max.)
25
AC3
Electrohydraulic spool valves ON/OFF switch indicator light (LED)
Digital output (2A max.)
26
Wired but not used
27
Not used
28
Calculator ground
29
+12V permanent calculator supply
30
L3
Position sensor
Analog input
31
L4
Right-hand draft sensor
Analog input
32
L15
Linkage console - Intermix potentiometer
Analog input
33
L15
Linkage console - lowering speed potentiometer
Analog input
34
L17
Trailed implement position sensor (TIC) or FRONT Analog input DUAL CONTROL or REAR DUAL CONTROL sensor
35
L19
2nd auxiliary hydraulics lever sensor signal
Analog input
36
L15
Linkage console - wheel slip control switch
Digital input
37
AC5
Flow rate Memory switch
Digital input
38
AC3
Electrohydraulic spool valves ON/OFF switch
Digital input
39
CAN Low
40
CAN High
41
Analog reference (sensor and potentiometer ground)
42
Calculator power supply +12 V AC (Ignition key On)
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
¤ H
Type of signal
11F10.13
Autotronic 5 - Linkage - Description
11F10.14
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 1.b
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters
GUF521 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters
CONTENTS A . Programming. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Saving to a file . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 C . Setting parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 D . Table of constants. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Wintest - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF521.1
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters
GUF521.2
¤ H
Wintest - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters
A . Programming - Switch on the ignition key to carry out this operation. The engine must be stopped. - The programming of the Autotronic 5 is necessary: - when the former Autotronic 5 has been replaced by a new one, - when a new program becomes available to improve the product, - if the Autotronic 5 was programmed in a different configuration (ParkLock, linkage, etc.). NOTA: Parameter setting must be carried out on some softs after the first programming (Powershuttle, Dynashift, Dyna-6 and linkage soft). - Click on the “Tools” icon and then on “Programming AUTO5” icon.
Wintest
AUTO5 label Table of AUTO5 constants Programming AUTO5 List of AUTO5 error codes
MA-11-01281A
Wintest - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF521.3
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters Autotronic 5 programming is a 5-step process: 1. Searching for calculators present on CAN network 2. Selecting a calculator to be programmed 3. Starting the programming process 4. Selecting a soft to integrate into the calculator 5. Validating the programming The following screen is displayed:
Programming Auto 5 Auto 5 present on the CAN network serial n° Auto 5 ParkLock GPA40-n° 002696
Application H01/B03 -> V02.01
Update -> V02.04
1. Searching for calculators present on CAN network 2. Selecting a programmed
calculator
to
be
Auto 5 selected: Auto 5 ParkLock-n° 002696
Programming
Scanning CAN network
Auto5->File
3. Starting the programming process
Select soft ->
ParkLock GPA40 ParkLock HA...
PowerShuttle Dyna-6 Trans1
Linkage
4WD suspension
4. Selecting a soft to integrate into the calculator
Dyna-6 Trans2 Dynashift Trans1 Dynashift Trans2 Soft selected: Auto 5 PowerShuttle - V01.05-B6
Validate
5. Validating the programming
MA-11-01498A
Fig. 1
NOTA: Each step must be validated to progress to the following step. If a step is dimmed, the previous step has not been validated.
GUF521.4
¤ H
Wintest - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters Searching for calculators present on CAN network When the window is opened, Wintest automatically starts an Autotronic 5 search on the CAN network. However, this search can be refreshed at any time by clicking on “Scanning CAN network”. The list of calculators appears as follows:
serial n°
Application
Auto 5 ParkLock-n°002696
H01/B03 -> V02.01
Update -> V02.04
Soft integrated into calculators (a) with • H01: Calculator hardware version (calcu- Program update possible with new soft version unique calculator serial number Fig. 2 lator version) • B03: Calculator Boot version (central hub included in Wintest of programs) (b) • V02.01: Soft version integrated into Autotronic 5 NOTA: (a) A blank Autotronic 5 is provided as standard with ParkLock GPA40 soft in the spare parts (b) A new Boot version can be included in the new soft version; however, 2 different soft items will often carry the same Boot version.
Fig. 2
Wintest - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF521.5
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters Selecting a calculator to be programmed Double click in the left-hand column of the line of the calculator you wish to program. The line turns blue and at the base of the left-hand column, Wintest specifies which Autotronic 5 has been selected.
Starting the programming process Click on the “Programming” button to indicate your choice of programming.
Selecting a soft to integrate into the calculator Click on the “text” button of the required soft. The soft buttons are the same colour as the dots stuck on the calculators during assembly at the factory: Orange: ParkLock GPA40 Blue ParkLock HA... Yellow: PowerShuttle Violet: Dyna-6 - Transmission 1 Brown: Dyna-6 - Transmission 2 Green: Linkage Pink: Suspended front axle The line under the buttons specifies which soft has been selected.
Validating the programming Click on the “Validate” button. A gauge indicates the progression of the programming. At the end of the programming, Wintest automatically starts a scan of the CAN network.
GUF521.6
¤ H
Wintest - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters During programming, several error messages may be displayed.
Error File cannot be opened
IMPORTANT: When programming with a Boot update, unexpected interruption of programming can be fatal for Autotronic 5. To avoid Autotronic 5 breakdown: Do not disconnect the calculator. Restart programming (Wintest will offer to reprogram only the faulty calculator to make it operational). NOTE: If the Autotronic 5 programming is interrupted unexpectedly, switch off the ignition key and then switch it on again. This enables you to resume programming.
Message: - File cannot be opened - Select a soft - Select a calculator - Calculator cannot be unlocked - Bank 1 cannot be erased - Bank 2 cannot be erased - Bank 3 cannot be erased - Bank 4 cannot be erased (Boot) - Programming error - End-of-programming error - Reboot error - Table change reset error - File name length error - File run error Correction method: - Depending on the type of message, try to follow the requested indications. - Cut the ignition and turn it back on. - Check the CAN BOX interface connections with the 16-pin diagnostics connector. - The AUTOTRONIC 5 unit is defective. - If necessary, reinstall the Wintest software on your PC.
Wintest - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF521.7
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters
B . Saving to a file Calculator data (program, parameters and calibration) can be saved in a single file that can be forwarded to technical support as requested. This file can be opened only by the factory engineers.
- Double click in the left-hand column of the line of the calculator whose content you wish to save. The line turns blue and at the bottom of the left-hand column, Wintest specifies which Autotronic 5 has been selected. - Next, click on the “Auto5 -> File” icon:
Programming Auto 5 Auto 5 present on the CAN network serial n° Auto 5 ParkLock GPA40-n° 002696
Application H01/B03 -> V02.01
Update -> V02.04
Auto 5 selected: Auto 5 ParkLock-n° 002696
Programming
Auto5->File
Scanning CAN network
The content will be saved in a file
Validate MA-11-01522A
Fig. 3 - Next, click on “Validate”.
GUF521.8
¤ H
Wintest - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters - The following screen is displayed: Programming Auto 5 Auto 5 present on the CAN network serial n° Auto 5 ParkLock GPA40-n° 002696
Application H01/B03 -> V02.01
Update -> V02.04
Auto 5 selected: Auto 5 ParkLock-n° 002696
Programming
Scanning CAN network
Auto5->File Reading flash: 16%
The content will be saved in a file: 02696_031.cln
Validate MA-11-01531A
- A gauge indicates the progression of the saving process. - It can take between 3 and 15 minutes to create the backup file (depending on the file type and the power of your computer). NOTA: Given the time required for the saving process, ensure that your computer cannot enter standby mode during the procedure.
Wintest - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF521.9
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters - When the saving process is complete, the following screen is displayed: Save as
?
Save to:
My documents
My images 8961_062.cln
Name:
02696_031
Save
Type :
02696_031
Cancel
MA-11-01448A
- By default, the backup file is named with a “*.cln” extension, and cannot be renamed. Its name comprises the “unique” serial number of the calculator Fig. 2. - If you wish, you can change the location to which the backup file is saved. - Click on “Save”. - When the save process is complete, Wintest returns to the programming window.
GUF521.10
¤ H
Wintest - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters
C . Setting parameters Switch on the ignition key to carry out this operation. The engine must be stopped. Parameter setting is necessary: - when the former Autotronic 5 has been replaced by a new one, - when improvements to one or more functions have been made through parameter setting. - when a programming has been carried out. Click on the “Tools” icon and then on “AUTO5 Linkage label”.
Wintest
AUTO5 - PowerShuttle label Table of AUTO5 constants Programming AUTO5 List of AUTO5 error codes Programming DATA3 AUTO5 - linkage label
MA-11-01281A
Wintest - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF521.11
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters The following screen is displayed:
Auto5 Linkage Label Code parameters
Code AA
Code BB
43
50
AA = 40 - > 5400 diam. 66 mm AA = 41 - > 5400 PowerShuttle diam. 66 mm AA = 42 - > 5445 -> 5465 diam. 75 mm AA = 43 - > 5445 -> 5465 PowerShuttle diam. 75 mm AA = 44 - > 6445 6455 6460 6470 OC - diam. 66mm AA = 45 - > 6455 -> 6480 OC - diam. 75mm AA = 46 - > 6445 6455 LS - diam. 66mm AA = 47 - > 6455 LS - diam. 75mm OK
MA-11-01422A
The tractor label code can be modified either by: - moving the mouse cursor directly into the relevant box and entering the appropriate code (it is also possible to navigate between codes by pressing the “tabulation” key on the keyboard), - clicking on the arrow under the code concerned; you can then scroll down the scroll bar and double-click on the desired parameter. Confirm the code by clicking on “OK”.
GUF521.12
¤ H
Wintest - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters List of codes AA
Models
Hydraulic Circuit
5400 mechanical reverse shuttle
Details Lift cylinder Ø
Code AA
Ø 66 mm
40
Ø 66 mm
41
Ø 75 mm
42
Ø 75 mm
43
Ø 66 mm
44
Ø 75 mm
45
Ø 66 mm
46
Ø 75 mm
47
Ø 66 mm
48
Ø 75 mm
49
6485 to 6495
Ø 95 mm
50
6460 / 6465 / 6470
Ø 66 mm
51
Ø 75 mm
52
Ø 95 mm
53
5400 PowerShuttle 5445 to 5465 mechanical reverse shuttle
Open Centre (57 l/min) and Twin Flow (100 l/min)
5445 to 5465 PowerShuttle 6445 / 6455 / 6460 / 6470 6455 to 6480 6445 / 6455 6455
Open centre LS 90 l/min
6445 / 6455 / 6460 / 6470 6465 to 6480
6460 to 6480
TFLS 100 l/min
LS 110 l/min
6485 to 6499
Rear axle 7465 / 7475 7465 / 7475 / 7480
LS 110 l/min
7485 / 7490 / 7495 8450 / 8460 8470 / 8480
Wintest - Issue 7.a
¤ H
LS 150 l/min
HA110
54
HA130
55
HA160
56
HA200
57
HA260
58
GUF521.13
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters Identifying the rear axle, 2 possible methods: • Lift rams diameter Fig. 6 - HA 110: 2 rams with Ø 40 mm rod - HA 130: 1 ram with a Ø 40 mm rod and a second ram with a Ø 36 mm rod • Width of final drive unit spacer Fig. 5
MA-11-01122A
Fig. 6
HA110
HA130
37 mm MA-11-01320A
GUF521.14
¤ H
65 mm
Fig. 5
Wintest - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters List of codes BB Number of electrohydraulic spool valves
DUAL & TIC option
Control
Wheel slip control
Datatronic 3
Code BB
0
0
0
0
0
50
0
0
0
1
0
51
0
0
0
1
1
52
2
0
Joystick
0
0
53
2
0
Joystick
1
0
54
2
0
Joystick
1
1
55
3
0
Joystick
0
0
56
3
0
Joystick
1
0
57
3
0
Joystick
1
1
58
4
0
Joystick
0
0
59
4
0
Joystick
1
0
60
4
0
Joystick
1
1
61
5
0
Joystick
0
0
62
5
0
Joystick
1
0
63
5
0
Joystick
1
1
64
2
1
Joystick
1
1
76
3
1
Joystick
1
1
79
4
1
Joystick
1
1
82
5
1
Joystick
1
1
85
NOTA: 0 = Without option; 1 = With option
Wintest - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF521.15
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters
D . Table of constants - Another screen allows you to display the constants entered during parameter setting and stored after calibration. - Click on the “Tools” icon and on “Table of AUTO5 constants”.
Wintest
AUTO5 - PowerShuttle label Table of AUTO5 constants Programming AUTO5 List of AUTO5 error codes Programming DATA3 AUTO5 - linkage label
MA-11-01281A
GUF521.16
¤ H
Wintest - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters The following screen is displayed:
Table of AUTO5 constants Select an Auto5 calculator Auto5 PowerShuttle - n°002696
Auto5 Linkage - n°1437
Scanning CAN network
List of parameters Description Forward PowerShuttle Current Reverse PowerShuttle Current TOC calib. BOC calib. IDNSW calib. Wintest
Status
5 6 7 8 9 10 11
Data
7407 5719 56008 44572 44348 0 0
Save
MA-11-01297A
As with Autotronic 5 programming, reading constants takes place in several steps: 1. Searching for calculators present on CAN network This search can be refreshed at any time by clicking on “Scanning CAN network”. 2. Selecting the required calculator. 3. Reading searched constants (table title: list of parameters).
Wintest - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF521.17
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters The calculator data can be saved in the form of a text file, which can then be opened with any standard text editor software. In this manner, the file can be saved, printed out, transferred to the technical inspector who asked for it, etc. - Click on the "Save" icon . - The following screen is displayed: Save as
?
Save to:
My documents
My images AUTO5_8942.txt
Name:
AUTO5.Txt
Type :
Txt file
Save
Cancel
MA-11-01448A
- By default, the backup file is named "AUTO5.Txt”. You can, however, name it as you see fit. - If you wish, you can change the location to which the backup file is saved. - Click on “Save”. - Wintest returns to the constants display window.
GUF521.18
¤ H
Wintest - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters - You can now browse your hard disc and open this file, which shall look as follows:
MA-11-01523A
You therefore have access to all of the data that were displayed in the Wintest window.
Wintest - Issue 7.a
¤ H
GUF521.19
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Programming and setting parameters
GUF521.20
¤ H
Wintest - Issue 7.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Tests and diagnostics MF6400/7400/8400
GUF522 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Tests and diagnostics MF6400/7400/8400
CONTENTS A . Autotronic 5 statuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Electronic Linkage functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF522.1
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Tests and diagnostics MF6400/7400/8400
GUF522.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Tests and diagnostics MF6400/7400/8400 A . Autotronic 5 statuses The Autotronic 5 operates via 7 main statuses. The status of the Autotronic 5 is displayed at the bottom of the diagnostics window. List of statuses: - Initialisation - Locked - Neutral - Transport - Transport (Shock Absorber) - Work - External controls
AUTO5 - Linkage
54 %
92 %
35 %
14 %
50 %
No error
950
0 Km/h
54 %
49 %
86 %
92 %
50 %
50 %
0%
AUTO5 : Transport (shock absorber)
R57
R57
7K4XAM R57
NIM
NIM
1 2 2 1 ENG20
1 1
1 ENG21
ENG22 1
R57
R0 01
654 321 7 8 9 101112
R051
R0 01
R065
10 04N1
CAB34 1 W107_3MM_ROUGE
51L
R57
R065
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9011121314151617181
R051
81 21 6
R51
31 7 1
TROFFE
7K4XAM
7K4NOITISOP
0% 1MM_NOIR
0%
CAB33 CAB23 1 W011_5MM_MARRON 1 W108_3MM_ROUGE CAB32 CAB24 3MM_ROUGE 1 1 W109_ 1 W0123MM MARRON 1 X4
X2
CAB35 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 ENG1
R051
10 04N1
CAB21 CAB25 W113_ 3MM_MARRON W110_ 3MM_ROUGE 1 1
MA-11-01450A
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF522.3
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Tests and diagnostics MF6400/7400/8400 - Start the engine. - Toggle the 3-position selector switch at least once to the Up position to activate the electronic linkage. - Click on the "Electronic Linkage" icon
Wintest
MA-11-01281A
GUF522.4
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Tests and diagnostics MF6400/7400/8400 B . Electronic Linkage functions When the "Electronic linkage" function has been selected, the following screen is displayed: AUTO5 - Linkage
54 %
92 %
35 %
14 %
50 %
No error
950
0 Km/h
54 %
49 %
86 %
92 %
50 %
50 %
0%
AUTO5 : Transport (shock absorber)
R57
R57
7K4XAM R57
NIM
NIM
1 1
1 ENG21
ENG22 1
CAB34 1 W107_3MM_ROUGE 654 321 7 8 9 101112
CAB33 CAB23 1 W011_5MM_MARRON 1 W108_3MM_ROUGE
R051
R0 01
R065
10 04N1
R0 01
R57
51L
R57
R065
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9011121314151617181
R051
81 21 6
R51
31 7 1
TROFFE
1 2 2 1 ENG20
1MM_NOIR
7K4XAM
7K4NOITISOP
0%
0%
CAB32 CAB24 3MM_ROUGE 1 1 W109_ 1 W0123MM MARRON 1 X4
CAB35 1
X2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 ENG1
R051
10 04N1
CAB21 CAB25 W113_ 3MM_MARRON W110_ 3MM_ROUGE 1 1
MA-11-01450A
The window is split into 5 identifiable sections AUTO5 - Linkage
54 %
92 %
35 %
14 %
50 %
54 %
Operating information 950
0 Km/h
49 %
86 %
Sensors
User interface
92 %
50 %
50 %
External information
0%
Solenoid valves R57
R57
7K4XAM R57
NIM
NIM
1 2 2 1 ENG20
1 1
1 ENG21
ENG22 1
R57
R0 01
654 321 7 8 9 101112
R051
R0 01
R065
10 04N1
CAB34 1 W107_3MM_ROUGE
51L
R57
R065
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9011121314151617181
R051
81 21 6
R51
31 7 1
TROFFE
7K4XAM
7K4NOITISOP
0% 1MM_NOIR
0%
CAB33 CAB23 1 W011_5MM_MARRON 1 W108_3MM_ROUGE CAB32 CAB24 3MM_ROUGE 1 1 W109_ 1 W0123MM MARRON 1 X4
X2
CAB35 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 ENG1
R051
10 04N1
CAB21 CAB25 W110_ 3MM_ROUGE W113_ 3MM_MARRON 1 1
MA-11-01451A
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF522.5
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Tests and diagnostics MF6400/7400/8400 User interface REMARK: The signal values in percentage are representative of the voltage in Volts, as the components are supplied with 10V (=100%). Hence, if the value is of 35%, then the signal is of approximately 3.5V.
Transport shock absorber indicator light on console - transport shock absorber activated = red - transport shock absorber deactivated = white Self-diagnostics indicator light
Lowering speed potentiometer value in percent of travel: 54 %
- padlock position = 0% - maximum speed = 100% Lift arm height limiting potentiometer value in percent of travel: 92 %
- maximum limit = 0% - no limit = 100%
- This icon flashes red according to the linkage error code Automatic lowering indicator light - This icon is red when the lowering speed setting potentiometer is in the automatic zone (yellow sector) Error: 0
Intermix potentiometer value in percent of travel:
Error code indication In this case, there is no error
35 %
- pure draft = 0% - pure position = 100% Depth potentiometer value in percent of travel:
Operating information Engine speed rpm 950
14 %
- position 10 (low) = 0% - position 5 = 50% - position 0 (high) = 100% NOTE: ensure that calibration (see GUF524) is correct before checking the component
Design ground speed indicated by ground speed sensor in kph 0 Km/h
Wheel slip percent calculated by the DCC2 0%
3-position switch: Wheel slip control activation switch "Up" Position "Neutral" Position "Down" Position Transport control system (Shock Absorber) switch - ON = violet - OFF = white
GUF522.6
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Tests and diagnostics MF6400/7400/8400 Sensors
External information
Left-hand draft percentage:
sensor
value
in
draft
External control switch - “Lifting”
50 %
- traction draft (work): from 0 to 50% - pushing draft (transport): from 50 to 100% Right-hand draft sensor percentage:
value
- on = violet background - off = white background in
draft
External control switch - “Lowering”
49 %
- traction draft (work): from 0 to 50% - pushing draft (transport): from 50 to 100% Position sensor value in percent of travel:
- on = violet background - off = white background These data are identical for the front linkage controls, if the tractor is fitted with one.
86 %
- high position = 100% (-5) - low position = 0% (+5) - signal between 2 and 8 volts NOTE: ensure that calibration (see GUF524) is correct before checking the component Position of implement in Front Dual: 54 %
- High position: 100% - Low position: 0% These values are determined by the Dual calibration. Position of the implement in Rear Dual: 92 %
- High position: 100% - Low position: 0% These values are determined by the Dual calibration. Value in percent of EHS valve control lever potentiometers. 47 %
-
0%
floating >6.74V (>100%) move down: from 4.9V to 6.74V (from 0 to -100%) neutral: from 4.48V to 4.9V (0%) move up: from 2.1V to 4.48V (from 0 to 100%)
NOTE: For potentiometer adjustment, see GUF74.
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF522.7
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Tests and diagnostics MF6400/7400/8400 Solenoid valves Linkage lifting solenoid valve - solenoid valve in rest position: white background - solenoid valve supplied: blue background 0%
Percent displacement of the lifting proportional solenoid valve spool. Linkage lowering solenoid valve
- solenoid valve in rest position: white background - solenoid valve supplied: blue background 0%
Percent displacement of the lowering proportional solenoid valve spool.
GUF522.8
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400
GUF523 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes MF6400/7400/8400
CONTENTS A . Reading error codes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . List of error codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 C . Analysing components and their error codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF523.1
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400
GUF523.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400
A . Reading error codes Reading errors on the linkage console The Autotronic 5 carries out a permanent control of the linkage function. The user is informed of a fault by: - the flashing self-diagnostic indicator light (1) on the console (Fig. 1). Only one error code can be displayed at a time. Reading principle: 1. The indicator light flashes in a rapid burst to signal the code is about to be displayed. 2. 1st series of flashes displays the error code decimal. 3. Approximately one second without flash precedes display of the error code unit. 4. 2nd series of flashes displays the error code unit. 5. The procedure restarts from the beginning.
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
1 MA-11-01429A
Fig. 1
GUF523.3
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400 Reading error codes with Wintest Wintest allows all error codes stored by Autotronic 5 to be displayed and cleared. Click on the “Tools” icon and on “List of AUTO5 error codes”.
Wintest
AUTO5 label Table of AUTO5 constants Programming AUTO5 List of AUTO5 error codes
MA-11-01281A
GUF523.4
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400 The following screen is displayed:
AUTO5 - Error(s) stored Auto5 PowerShuttle - n˚2697 Auto5 Linkage - n°1437
CLEAR
MA-11-01316A
- Click on the line of the calculator whose errors you wish to display. The following screen is displayed:
AUTO5 - Error(s) stored Auto5 PowerShuttle - n˚2697 Auto5 Linkage - n°1437
Error n°15: External controls failure
CLEAR
MA-11-01342A
Only errors stored when the ignition key is switched on appear. The most recent errors are displayed at the top of the list. Autotronic 5 Linkage stores a maximum of 10 errors.
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
- If you click on “CLEAR”, all error codes will be erased from the selected Autotronic 5 memory.
GUF523.5
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400
B . List of error codes The error codes are divided into 3 classes according to their importance: - Class I: Major error (linkage is blocked) - Class II: Error generating degraded operation (the linkage console is bypassed) - Class III: Information
Errors
I
II
III
Description
11
L6 L7
Linkage lifting solenoid valve Linkage lowering solenoid valve
Open circuit
12
L6
Linkage lifting solenoid valve
Short circuit
13
L7
Linkage lowering solenoid valve
Short circuit
14
Transmission control unit
No CAN unlocking signal
15
LIG6 LIG7 LIG8 LIG9
External controls
Wrong signal
16
L13
Autotronic 5 - Linkage
Battery voltage 16V
17
L13
Autotronic 5 - Linkage
CheckSum error
18
AC13 AC6
Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch Quick soil engagement button
Wrong signal
22
L3
Position sensor
Wrong signal
23
AC9
Linkage height / depth setting potentiometer
Wrong signal
24
L15
Linkage console - raised position potentiometer
Wrong signal
31
L5
Left-hand draft sensor
Wrong signal
32
L4
Right-hand draft sensor
Wrong signal
34
L15
Linkage console - lowering speed potentiometer
Wrong signal
35
L15
Linkage console - Shock Absorber switch
Wrong signal
36
L15
Linkage console - Intermix potentiometer
Wrong signal
GUF523.6
¤ H
Components concerned
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400
C . Analysing components and their error codes
AC13
N
AC6
AC6: Quick soil engagement button
750R
1.3K
Description Location: on the right-hand armrest Switch normally open with internal resistors
332R
221R 464R 7
7
2
17
18
1
18
Wrong signal from linkage lifting / lowering / neutral selector switch or quick soil engagement button
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
5
18
1
Reaction of the System
4
3
AC6
AC13
1 2 3 4 5 7 8 10 17 18
2
Fig. 2
MA-11-01435A
Description
1
17
2 1
Errors
3
2
Signals: See detail of AC13 for quick soil engagement signal information Possible error codes
2
Solutions
Linkage blocked Check: - Contacts - Resistors that can be measured - Harness connections - Wiring
Resetting the system after clearing error
Stop then re-start the engine and unlock the linkage
GUF523.7
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400 AC9 : Linkage height / depth setting potentiometer Description Location: on the right-hand armrest Rotating potentiometer. 4K7
- Pins 1: 10V supply - Pins 2: Signal - Pins 3: Ground
1
3
2
Signals: Voltage varying between 0.27 V and 9.73 V at the Autotronic 5 terminals. 3
2
1
3 2 1
Possible error codes
Errors 23
Description Wrong signal from linkage height / depth setting potentiometer
GUF523.8
¤ H
AC9
MA-11-01432A
Reaction of the System
Solutions
Operation only Check: possible via - With Wintest that the external signal remains between controls 0.27 V and 9.73 V - Contacts - Harness connections - Wiring
Fig. 3
Resetting the system after clearing error
Unlock the linkage
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400 AC13 : Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch
AC13
Description
N
AC6
Location: on the right-hand armrest 3-position switch
1.3K
750R
- Pins 2: Signal to calculator - Pins 7: 10V supply - Pins 17: Ground
332R
221R 464R 7
7
2
Signals: 7.5V < Error 3.49V < Lifting < 7.5 V 2.62V < Neutral < 3.49 V 1.92V < Lowering < 2.62 V 1.3V < Quick soil engagement < 1.92 V Error < 1.3V
17
18
1
2
3
1 2
4 5
17 3 18
2 1
1
AC6
AC13
1 2 3 4 5 7 8 10 17 18
2
Fig. 4
MA-11-01435A
Possible error codes
Errors
18
Description
Solutions
Linkage blocked Check: Wrong signal from from linkage lifting / lowering / - Contacts neutral selector switch or - Resistors that can be quick soil engagement button measured - Harness connections - Wiring
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
Reaction of the System
Resetting the system after clearing error
Stop then re-start the engine and unlock the linkage
GUF523.9
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400 L3 : Position sensor Description Location: on the linkage upper arm (Fig. 5) Inductive angular sensor. Data is converted into voltage by the sensor itself. - Pins 1: Ground - Pins 2: Signal - Pins 3: 10V supply Signal: from 2 to 8V Assembly: - Position the mark on the rotating shaft on the same side as the connector (arrow Fig. 5), - Tighten the sensor approximately in the centre of the ports, - Carry out calibration after assembly.
Fig. 5 MA-11-01428A
3 2 1 L3
Possible error codes
1
MA-11-01436A
Errors 22
Description Wrong signal
GUF523.10
¤ H
Reaction of the System
Solutions
Operation only Check: possible via - With Wintest that the external signal remains between controls 2 V and 8 V - Contacts - Harness connections - Wiring - Sensor status
2
3
Fig. 6
Resetting the system after clearing error
Unlock the linkage
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400 L4 : Draft sensor on right-hand lift arm Description Location: lower arms pivot pin - Pins 1: Ground - Pins 2: Signal - Pins 3: 10V supply 1
2
3
Signal: from 2 to 8V
Possible error codes MA-11-01434A
Errors 32
Description Wrong signal
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
Reaction of the System
Solutions
Check: - Contacts The linkage - Harness connections operates but the - Wiring draft control is - Draft sensor status deactivated Measure the sensor signal, which should be between 2 V and 8 V
Fig. 7
Resetting the system after clearing error
Unlock the linkage
GUF523.11
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400 L5 : Draft sensor on left-hand lift arm Description Location: lower arms pivot pin - Pins 1: Ground - Pins 2: Signal - Pins 3: 10V supply 1
2
3
Signal: from 2 to 8V
Possible error codes MA-11-01434A
Errors 31
Description Wrong signal
GUF523.12
¤ H
Reaction of the System
Solutions
Check: - Contacts The linkage - Harness connections operates but the - Wiring draft control is - Draft sensor status deactivated Measure the sensor signal, which should be between 2 V and 8 V
Fig. 8
Resetting the system after clearing error
Unlock the linkage
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400 L6 : Linkage lifting solenoid valve Description Location: in the hydraulic spool valve block Proportional solenoid valve - power supplied - Pins 1: Signal - Pins 2: Signal return Signals: Solenoid valve OFF: 0A Solenoid valve supplied: up to 3.2 A
L7
2
1
L6 MA-11-01430A
Fig. 9
R
L6 P
LS
L7 MA-11-01431A
Possible error codes
Fig. 10
Errors
Description
11
Open circuit
12
Short circuit
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
Reaction of the System
Solutions
Check: - Contacts Linkage blocked - Harness connections - Wiring
Resetting the system after clearing error Stop then re-start the engine and unlock the linkage
GUF523.13
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400 L7 : Linkage lowering solenoid valve Description Location: in the hydraulic spool valve block Proportional solenoid valve - power supplied - Pins 1: Signal - Pins 2: Signal return Signals: Solenoid valve OFF: 0A Solenoid valve supplied: up to 3.2 A
L7
2
1
L6 MA-11-01430A
Fig. 11
R
L6 P
LS
L7 MA-11-01431A
Possible error codes
Fig. 12
Errors
Description
11
Open circuit
13
Short circuit
GUF523.14
¤ H
Reaction of the System
Solutions
Check: - Contacts Linkage blocked - Harness connections - Wiring
Resetting the system after clearing error Stop then re-start the engine and unlock the linkage
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400 L13 : Autotronic 5 - Linkage Description Location: bottom right-hand side of driver seat in cab Allocation of Autotronic 5 pins, see table below. Some pins can be configured at their input and output, as determined by the calculator soft. Possible error codes 17: CheckSum error that occurred during programming or when setting parameters. Solution: Reprogram and set parameters correctly. To reset the system: A correct CheckSum is required. 42
29 15
28
MA-11-01268A
14
1
Fig. 13
Pin
Description
1
Calculator power supply +12 V AC (Ignition key On)
2
10 V supply (sensors and potentiometers)
3
L6
Linkage lifting solenoid valve
4
L7
Linkage lowering solenoid valve
5
L7
Linkage lowering solenoid valve
6
L6
Linkage lifting solenoid valve
7
L1
Front linkage lifting external control
8
L1
Front linkage lowering external control
9
Calculator power supply +12 V AC (Ignition key On)
10
L15
Linkage console - self-diagnostic indicator light (Led)
11
L15
Linkage console - lowering speed indicator light (Led)
12
L2
13
Not used
14
Calculator power supply +12 V AC (Ignition key On)
15
Calculator ground
16
L5
17
AC9 AC6
Linkage height / depth setting potentiometer Quick soil engagement button
18
L15
Linkage console - raised position potentiometer
19
AC13
20
L18
1st auxiliary hydraulics lever sensor signal
21
LIG6 LIG7 LIG8 LIG9
Rear linkage external controls
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
Safety solenoid valve
Left-hand draft sensor
Linkage lifting / lowering / neutral selector switch and quick soil engagement button
GUF523.15
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400
Pin 22
L15
23
Not used
24
L15
Linkage console - transport control system indicator light (Led)
25
AC3
Electrohydraulic spool valves ON/OFF switch indicator light (Led)
26
L21
Floating stop solenoid valve relay control - Available
27
Not used
28
Calculator ground
29
+12V permanent calculator supply
Linkage console - transport control system selector switch
30
L3
Position sensor
31
L4
Right-hand draft sensor
32
L15
Linkage console - Intermix potentiometer
33
L15
Linkage console - lowering speed potentiometer
34
L17
DUAL CONTROL or trailed implement (TIC) position sensor
35
L19
2nd auxiliary hydraulics lever sensor signal
36
L15
Linkage console - wheel slip control switch
37
AC5
Flow rate Memory switch
38
AC3
Electrohydraulic spool valves ON/OFF switch
39
CAN Low
40
CAN High
41
Analog reference (sensor and potentiometer ground)
42
Calculator power supply +12 V AC (Ignition key On)
GUF523.16
¤ H
Description
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400 L15 : Linkage control console LED LED
LED
Description Location: on the right-hand console All potentiometers connected to resistors in order to form different voltage dividers.
150R
75R
560R 75R
75R
4K7 15R
560R
75R
Possible error codes
Solutions
Wrong signal from raised position potentiometer
34
Wrong signal from lowering speed potentiometer
35
Wrong signal from Shock Absorber switch (transport shock absorber control system)
The linkage Check: operates but the - The signal remains switch is between 0.03 V and 9.97 V bypassed - Contacts - Harness connections - Wiring Replace the console
Wrong Intermix potentiometer signal
The linkage Check: operates in - with Wintest that the position control signal can vary between 0V (+1V) and 10V (-1V) - Contacts - Harness connections - Wiring Replace the console
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
13
12
7
6
1
Resetting the system after clearing error
Operation only Check: possible via - with Wintest that the external signal can vary between controls 0V (+1V) and 10V (-1V) The linkage - Contacts operates but - Harness connections automatic - Wiring lowering speed Replace the console is deactivated
24
36
¤ H
Reaction of the System
18
L15
Fig. 14
MA-11-01433A
Description
150R
4K7
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
Errors
100R
75R
150R
- Pins 2: 10V supply - Pins 3: Ground - Pins 12: Ground
100R
4K7
Unlock the linkage
GUF523.17
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Error codes - MF6400/7400/8400 LIG6, LIG7, LIG8 and LIG9: External controls Description
2
1
Location: on the rear fenders Switch normally open.
3
- Pins 1: Supply from linkage console - Pins 2: Signal
1 2 3
MA-11-01330A
Fig. 15
MA-11-01331A
Fig. 16
1 2 3
3
2
1
Signals: The right- and left-hand switches are connected together. The Autotronic 5 uses a network of resistors to analyse the signal coming from the switches via the L15 linkage console. 7.5V < Error 5.95V < Lifting < 7.5 V 4.39V < Neutral < 5.95 V 2.2V < Lowering < 4.39 V Error < 2.2V
Possible error codes
Errors
Description Wrong signal
15
GUF523.18
¤ H
Reaction of the System
Solutions
Linkage blocked Check: - Contacts - Harness connections - Wiring Replace the console
Resetting the system after clearing error Stop then re-start the engine and unlock the linkage
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Calibration and adjustments
GUF524 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Calibration and adjustments
CONTENTS A . Adjusting the position sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Calibrating the linkage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Wintest - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF524.1
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Calibration and adjustments
GUF524.2
¤ H
Wintest - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Calibration and adjustments
A . Adjusting the position sensor 20 mm 0.79 in
For correct linkage calibration, ensure that the position sensor is assembled properly. Calibration is the only way to obtain precise linkage positioning. GPA20 assembly: A gap of 20mm (approx.) must be left between the sensor body and the locknut (Fig. 1). HA assembly: Position the mark on the rotating shaft on the same side as the connector (arrow Fig. 2) Tighten the sensor approximately in the centre of the ports (Fig. 2).
MA-11-01348A
Fig. 1
After adjusting, the linkage must be calibrated (see § B).
MA-11-01428A
Wintest - Issue 6.a
¤ H
Fig. 2
GUF524.3
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Calibration and adjustments
B . Calibrating the linkage The linkage must be calibrated after changing: - a linkage solenoid valve - the position sensor - the linkage height / depth setting potentiometer - the Autotronic 5 or soft type (e.g.: PowerShuttle to Linkage). The purpose of this calibration is: - to define the high and low stops of the linkage for optimum use of the linkage travel - to measure sensor signals to obtain maximum linkage position precision according to the setting potentiometer - to measure the solenoid valve starter currents that start to move the linkage. NOTE: DUAL CONTROL calibration is explained in the Datatronic 3 description of the Workshop Service Manual.
Preliminary operations - Hitch a weight of 200 kg (440 lbs) approx. to the linkage. - Ensure that with the hitch, the linkage can move through its whole operating range, between its high and low stops. - Position the tractor where the linkage can operate freely, and ensure that no one can enter the area of linkage travel throughout the calibration process.
GUF524.4
¤ H
Wintest - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Calibration and adjustments Preocedure to follow: 1. Set the tractor engine to idle speed. 2. Position the height / depth setting potentiometer between positions 3 and 4 (Fig. 3) 3. Set the switch (Fig. 3) to linkage lowering position (work position) 4. Set the 3 linkage console potentiometers in position (Fig. 4, depending on the console type): - maximum high stop (A) - pure position sensor (B) - maximum automatic lowering speed (C) 5. Press the Shock Absorber switch (D) 4 times in quick succession. The indicator light (Led) (E) starts to flash (Fig. 4). Calibration takes 1 minute approximately. 6. When calibration is complete, the indicator light stops flashing and the linkage locks. NOTE: To exit the calibration process at any time, press the Shock Absorber switch or the Lifting / Lowering / Neutral switch. In this case, the system uses the previously memorised parameters, or the default parameters in the case of a new Autotronic 5 unit.
MA-11-01437A
Fig. 3
A B 2
DANGER: Ensure that no one can enter the area of linkage travel throughout the calibration process!
5 3
4
C A
Validation: - Check maximum linkage travel using the cab controls • high position • low position; the lowering indicator light should stay on throughout - Check the sensitivity of the linkage height / depth setting potentiometer. - Set the linkage to transport position, then engage the Shock Absorber and ensure that the linkage lowers slightly (the lowering indicator light should come on). - Check the external controls and ensure that the lifting switch raises the linkage to its mechanical stop (hydraulic pump throttling sound). NOTE: If the calibration appears to be incorrect (impossible to change position), reset the linkage by pressing the Shock Absorber switch 5 times in quick succession. In this case the calculator uses the default values. A new calibration procedure must then be started.
Wintest - Issue 6.a
¤ H
D
D E MA-11-01349A
Fig. 4
GUF524.5
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Calibration and adjustments
GUF524.6
¤ H
Wintest - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams MF6400/7400/8400
GUF525 - AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams MF6400/7400/8400
CONTENTS A . General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Electrical diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF525.1
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams MF6400/7400/8400
GUF525.2
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams MF6400/7400/8400
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
CAB83 OFF
8
1
2
3
7
4
5
6
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CAB83
R S2
MA-10-01000A
CAB37.6/CAB83.1 B CAB37.7/CAB83.3 B
6
7
5 3
4 2
11 10 9
1
FAI 03 FAI 48
8
CAB37
12
- Components with only one connector are identified by the connector name: CAB83 - Suspended front axle switch (Fig. 1). - Harnesses performing the same funtions have the same colour on the diagram (Fig. 1): • FAI03 - Dynashift console harness (green) • FAI48 - DynaVT console harness (green) - All wires can be identified by the pins of the outgoing and incoming connectors of the harness: CAB37.6/CAB83.1: The wire connects pin 6 of the CAB37 connector to pin 1 of the CAB83 connector - The detail of pins allocation for each connector is shown on the harness side - The wire colour is indicated: CAB37.6/CAB83.1 B, the wire is white List of colours: - N: Black - M: Brown - R: Red - B: White - J: Yellow - V: Green - The splices inside the harnesses are indicated by a dot and the letter S (S2).
S2.1/CAB83.2
The harnesses fitted on the tractor allow data to be exchanged and power to be supplied to the electrical and electronic systems. The tractor is fitted with 3 different types of power supply: • +12V Battery (Permanent) • +12V APC (Ignition key ON) • +12V ACC (Accessories) Most harnesses have a maximum of six different wire colours: - Black: Ground - Brown: +12V Permanent - Red: +12V APC (Ignition key ON) and Accessories - White: Information - Yellow: CAN High - Green: CAN Low The CAN network wires (yellow and green) are twisted together.
R
Description
In general, the components or connectors are named in order to indicate the corresponding elements of the tractor: AC## Armrest BAF## Fuse box CA## Automatic air conditioning CAB## Cab ENG## Engine FA## Suspended front axle L## Linkage - ParkLock (HA) LIG## Lighting R## Linkage and roof ROOF##Roof TR## Transmission V# Electrohydraulic spool valve X# Round battery cable terminal on fuse box
BAF12.2/S2.1
A . General
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
CAB37 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
Fig. 1
GUF525.3
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams MF6400/7400/8400 Layout 5 Deutsch connectors (31-way) are connected to the cab: - 2 on the front panel Fig. 2) - 3 at the bottom rear right-hand side of the cab (Fig. 3).
ENG1
Fig. 2: All these connectors belong to the engine harness. ENG2 is dedicated to information concerning the electronic injection.
ENG2
Fig. 3: Always in the following order (regardless of tractor configuration and options), from left to right: L14 Linkage harness junction CAB50 Transmission harness junction LIG1 Lighting harness junction
MA-10-01003A
Fig. 2
L14
LIG1
+12V
MA-10-01002A
14
16
13
15
17
12 11
10 9
8 7
6 5
4 3
2 1
BAF10
F9- 15A +APC
1 X2 F48 - 7.5A
+12V
1 X4 18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
F48
MA-10-01001A
2
GUF525.4
¤ H
Fig. 3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
18
BAF12
The fuses and relays of the electrical or electronic board (Fig. 4) are indicated by a black mark on their locations on the fuse box (2).
CAB50
F9
Fig. 4
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams MF6400/7400/8400 B . Electrical diagrams Electrical supply ......................................................... 7 Standard linkage ........................................................ 9 Linkage with Dual Control or TIC ............................. 11 Front linkage controls .............................................. 13 CAN network ........................................................... 15
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF525.5
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams MF6400/7400/8400 Harness parts list
Colour reminder
FAI 23 FAI 26 FAI 27
N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37 FAI 41 FAI 46 FAI 57 FAI 68 FAI 69 FAI 126 FAI 127 FAI 128 FAI 129 FAI 131
Cab linkage harness Linkage position sensor harness Linkage control harness inside cab (automatic hitch) Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) DynaVT armrest harness 4 electrohydraulic spool valves harness Automatic air conditioning - Roof harness Fieldstar harness Front dual control harness Cab interior lighting harness (all countries except US) Cab interior lighting harness - US Linkage with Dual Control - TIC harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness Datatronic 3 harness
Component parts list AC6 AC9 AC13
Quick soil engagement button Linkage height / depth setting potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch CAB112 Datatronic 3 CAB141 Autotronic 5 - ParkLock DynaVT L3 Linkage position sensor L4 Draft sensor on right-hand lift arm L5 Draft sensor on left-hand lift arm L6 Linkage lifting solenoid valve L7 Linkage lowering solenoid valve L13 Autotronic 5 electronic linkage calculator L15 Linkage console L17 Trailed implement position sensor (TIC) L30 Linkage control inside cab (automatic hitch) LIG6 External control switch - lifting linkage LIG7 External control switch - lowering linkage LIG8 External control switch - lifting linkage LIG9 External control switch - lowering linkage 2 35 44 45
Fuse box Front linkage position sensor External control switch - lifting front linkage External control switch - lowering front linkage
GUF525.6
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams - MF6400/7400/8400
Electrical supply
L13
29
42
15
28
1
14
R
N M S7
S7.1/L13.42
R N L13.14/S7.1 L13.15/S1.1
L13.28/S1.1 S13.1/L13.29
R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
L13.9/S7.1
L13
R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
L13.1/S7.1
L13
S1
17
16 18
15 13
14
11
12 8
9
+12V
1
10
7
FAI 31
X4
F21 - 7.5A
6
M
+12V
1
5
BAF12.9/L20.1
X2
F18 - 7.5A
3
R
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
4
1
2 4
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
BAF12.7/L20.5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
1
1
BAF12
2
CAB73 1
5
3
N L20.2/CAB73_1.1
F18-7.5A
16
L20
15
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
17
L20
18
S1.1/L20.2 L20.1/S13.1
L20.5/S7.1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
F21-7.5A
2
FAI 23
6
N M
R
S13
2
BAF12
MA-10-06069A
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF525.7
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams MF6400/7400/8400 Harness parts list
Colour reminder
FAI 23 FAI 26 FAI 27
N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37 FAI 41 FAI 46 FAI 57 FAI 68 FAI 69 FAI 126 FAI 127 FAI 128 FAI 129 FAI 131
Cab linkage harness Linkage position sensor harness Linkage control harness inside cab (automatic hitch) Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) DynaVT armrest harness 4 electrohydraulic spool valves harness Automatic air conditioning - Roof harness Fieldstar harness Front dual control harness Cab interior lighting harness (all countries except US) Cab interior lighting harness - US Linkage with Dual Control - TIC harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness Datatronic 3 harness
Component parts list AC6 AC9 AC13
Quick soil engagement button Linkage height / depth setting potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch CAB112 Datatronic 3 CAB141 Autotronic 5 - ParkLock DynaVT L3 Linkage position sensor L4 Draft sensor on right-hand lift arm L5 Draft sensor on left-hand lift arm L6 Linkage lifting solenoid valve L7 Linkage lowering solenoid valve L13 Autotronic 5 electronic linkage calculator L15 Linkage console L17 Trailed implement position sensor (TIC) L30 Linkage control inside cab (automatic hitch) LIG6 External control switch - lifting linkage LIG7 External control switch - lowering linkage LIG8 External control switch - lifting linkage LIG9 External control switch - lowering linkage 2 35 44 45
Fuse box Front linkage position sensor External control switch - lifting front linkage External control switch - lowering front linkage
GUF525.8
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams - MF6400/7400/8400
Standard linkage
SWITCH ATC
LED
LED
LED
LED
L15
LED
AC9
1N4001
DOWN
AC6
NEUTRAL
VITESSE DESCENTE DOWN SPEED
75R
1N4001
75R
560R
4K7 BAS
2
4
5 17 18
332R
221R
HAUT
AC13
464R
EFFORT
1
3
7
2 2
POSITION HAUTE HIGH POSITION 100R
100R 75R MAX 4K7
1
7
SWITCH SLIP CTRL
75R 4K7
1.3K
15R
3 10
8
MIN
INTERMIX POS/EFFORT INTERMIX POSITION
POSITION
750R
UP
560R
150R
75R MAX 4K7
17
18
2
3
1
150R
L30
150R
MIN
UP 3
B
N B B
B B
N R
L15.12/S1.1 S6.1/L15.11 S5.1/L15.10
S12.1/L15.8 S11.1/L15.7
L15.3/S2.1 L15.2/S3.1
18
13
L15.15/S8.1
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2
3 2 1
1
AC9
2 1
2
1
FAI 41 510R 0.66W
AC13.18/AC6.1 B AC13.3/AC6.2 B
510R 0.66W
AC1.4/AC9.2
B
2 1
R1
S3.1/AC9.1 S2.1/AC9.3 N
R2
R S2
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 S3
S2.1/AC13.17
R2.2/S12.1 R2.1/S2.1
B N S11.1/R1.2 R1.1/S2.1
6
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
1
AC1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
AC1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
L30.1/S1.1 L30.2/S2.1 L30.3/S3.1
S3.1/AC1.1 S2.1/AC1.2
3
29
42
15
28
1
14
S3.1/L13.2 R L14.11/L13.3 B L13.4/L14.2 B S6.1/L13.5 B L13.6/S5.1 B
1 2 3
L16.1/S1.1 L16.2/S2.1 L16.3/S3.1
1 2 3
B B
2
L13.28/S1.1
L15.1/L13.32 L15.4/L13.33
S2.1/L13.41
S1
31 8
10 22
30 19 18
2
17
1 4
23 12
28
6 16
5 15
13
27
14
24
29
7
3 11
25
B
26
S8 B B
S12_
FAI 23
N
B B
L15.17/L13.36
S3
S1.1/L16.1 S2.1/L16.2 S3.1/L16.3
B B B
1 2 3
B
L14.10/S2.1 L14.9/S5.1
B B
L13.31/L14.7 L14.6/S3.1 L13.30/L14.5 L14.4/S2.1
B R B N
N
nom
LIG6
1 2 3
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
3
2
B B
31
20 21
8 9
10
2
3
22
S1
nom
1 2 3
B B B
1
2
3
2 1
B
L14
L14
1 2
9
11
6
23
4
1 2
12
5 15
13 24
14
27
22
3 1
16
26
25
L7.1/L14.10
FAI128 L14.11/L6.2
nom
S1.1/L5.3
R
S2.1/L5.1
N
3 2 1
B
L14.8/L5.2 L14.7/L4.2 L14.6/S1.1 L14.5/L3.2 L14.4/S2.1
B B R B N
L14.2/L7.2
B
1
2
3
1
2
3
L5
L5
S1.1/L4.3
R
S2.1/L4.1
N
3 2 1
L4
L4
S5.1/LIG7.1 S2.1/LIG7.2
26
B B
B B B
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 LIG1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
S2
9 10
2 7
11
15
12 13 24
14 26
23
4 5
16
22
3 1
6
27
L3 L3
21
8 19
18 17
R N
3 2 1
20
31 30
29 28
S1.1/L3.3 S2.1/L3.1
25
Us
nom
L7
alim
FAI 37
3
LIG7 1 2 3
2 1 L7
1 0V
FAI 36
B B
S5_ 2
16 27
14
LIG_1.16/S5.1 LIG1.15/S2.1 LIG_1.14/S1.1
3
S5.1/LIG9.1 S2.1/LIG9.2
1
B
2
2
LIG9 1 2 3
A
10
2 7
28
B
21
8 19
18 17
3
1
28
15
13 25
29 17
6 5
12
B B
18 7
1 4
24
S1.1/LIG8.1 S2.1/LIG8.2
30 19
2 3
11 23
LIG8
LIG7
LIG1.14/L16_.1 LIG1.15/L16_.2 LIG1.16/L16_.3
1
2
3
20
31 30
29
S1
1
LIG9
1 2 3
3
2
S1.1/LIG6.1 S2.1/LIG6.2
S2
LIG8
L16
L6
9
S12.1/L13.24
S2
1
S11 20
L13.21/S8.1 L15.9/L13.22
6
L6
21
L13.15/S1.1 N L13.16/L14.8 B L13.17/AC1.4 B L13.18/L15.5 B L13.19/AC1.3 B
S1
B B B
S6
1
¤ H
L16
L16
L6.1/L14.9 L13.10/L15.6 S11.1/L13.11
3
5
B B B
S5
LIG6
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
B B B
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
2
4
R N
L13
L13
1
7
FAI 27 L16
S_2_
8 N
L16.1/L15.14 S8.1/L16.2 L15.16/L16.3 S3_
L30
S3.1/AC13.7 R AC1.3/AC13.2 B
AC1.1/S3.1 R AC1.2/S2.1 N
B N
2 1
6
1
DOWN
1 2 3 4 5 7 8 10 17 18
L15
12
7
AC13
AC6
FAI126 FAI127
MA-11-01423A
LIG1
GUF525.9
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams MF6400/7400/8400 Harness parts list
Colour reminder
FAI 23 FAI 26 FAI 27
N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37 FAI 41 FAI 46 FAI 57 FAI 68 FAI 69 FAI 126 FAI 127 FAI 128 FAI 129 FAI 131
Cab linkage harness Linkage position sensor harness Linkage control harness inside cab (automatic hitch) Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) DynaVT armrest harness 4 electrohydraulic spool valves harness Automatic air conditioning - Roof harness Fieldstar harness Front dual control harness Cab interior lighting harness (all countries except US) Cab interior lighting harness - US Linkage with Dual Control - TIC harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness Datatronic 3 harness
Component parts list AC6 AC9 AC13
Quick soil engagement button Linkage height / depth setting potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch CAB112 Datatronic 3 CAB141 Autotronic 5 - ParkLock DynaVT L3 Linkage position sensor L4 Draft sensor on right-hand lift arm L5 Draft sensor on left-hand lift arm L6 Linkage lifting solenoid valve L7 Linkage lowering solenoid valve L13 Autotronic 5 electronic linkage calculator L15 Linkage console L17 Trailed implement position sensor (TIC) L30 Linkage control inside cab (automatic hitch) LIG6 External control switch - lifting linkage LIG7 External control switch - lowering linkage LIG8 External control switch - lifting linkage LIG9 External control switch - lowering linkage 2 35 44 45
Fuse box Front linkage position sensor External control switch - lifting front linkage External control switch - lowering front linkage
GUF525.10
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams - MF6400/7400/8400
Linkage with Dual Control or TIC
L13
L13
29
42
15
28
1
14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
S3.1/L13.2
S3
R
20
31 30
9 10
2 7
17
11
1
15
12 13 24
14
27 26
23
4 5
16
22
3
6
28
21
8 19
18 29
25
FAI 23
L13.34/L14.20
L13.41/S2.1
L14.6/S3.1
R
L14.4/S2.1
N
B
N
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L14
L14
3
1 2
31
20 21
8 9
18
2
29
7
3
17
1
11 4
23
30 19
10 22
28
6
12
16
5 15
13 25
L17
27
14
24
26
R6.1/S2.1 L14.20/R6.2
N
B R6.3/S1.1
R
L17
L17
1 2 3
1 2 3
FAI128
L14.6/S1.1
R
L14.4/S2.1
N
S1 S2
S2
C30 1 2 3
01 BLEU 03 N 02 M
FAI 69
Front Dual option: C30 connected to L17
1
2
3
35 2 3
R 100 OHMS 5% 1W
alim Us
1 0V
103 N 3 2 1
3 2 1
101 BLEU R 100 OHMS 5% 1W
XX
XXX
MA-11-01424A
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
GUF525.11
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams MF6400/7400/8400 Harness parts list
Colour reminder
FAI 23 FAI 26 FAI 27
N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37 FAI 41 FAI 46 FAI 57 FAI 68 FAI 69 FAI 126 FAI 127 FAI 128 FAI 129 FAI 131
Cab linkage harness Linkage position sensor harness Linkage control harness inside cab (automatic hitch) Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) DynaVT armrest harness 4 electrohydraulic spool valves harness Automatic air conditioning - Roof harness Fieldstar harness Front dual control harness Cab interior lighting harness (all countries except US) Cab interior lighting harness - US Linkage with Dual Control - TIC harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness Datatronic 3 harness
Component parts list AC6 AC9 AC13
Quick soil engagement button Linkage height / depth setting potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch CAB112 Datatronic 3 CAB141 Autotronic 5 - ParkLock DynaVT L3 Linkage position sensor L4 Draft sensor on right-hand lift arm L5 Draft sensor on left-hand lift arm L6 Linkage lifting solenoid valve L7 Linkage lowering solenoid valve L13 Autotronic 5 electronic linkage calculator L15 Linkage console L17 Trailed implement position sensor (TIC) L30 Linkage control inside cab (automatic hitch) LIG6 External control switch - lifting linkage LIG7 External control switch - lowering linkage LIG8 External control switch - lifting linkage LIG9 External control switch - lowering linkage 2 35 44 45
Fuse box Front linkage position sensor External control switch - lifting front linkage External control switch - lowering front linkage
GUF525.12
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams - MF6400/7400/8400
Front linkage controls
3
2
1
2 L14.18/L1.1 S6.1/L1.2 L14.19/L1.3
S6
B R B
L1
L1
1 2 3
1 2 3
1
45 2
1
FAI128
31
20 21
8 9
30 19 18
2
17
1
11 4
23
28
6 16
5
12
15
13 24
27
14 25
26
L13
42
15
28
1
14
L14
20
31 30
21
8 19
18
9 10
2 7
29 17
11
1 6
28
15
12 13 24
14
27
23
4 5
16
22
3
R
L13
L14
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
26
L14.17/S7.1
L13
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
25
FAI 23 S7
R
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
S7.1/L20.5
29
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L14.19/L13.8 L13.7/L14.18
B B
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L20
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L20
FAI 31
BAF12.7/L20.5
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
¤ H
44
29
7
3
L14.17/S6.1
22
R
10
17
15
13
11
9
7
5
3
1
18
16
14
12
10
8
6
4
2
R
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2
F18 - 7.5A
X2 1
F18 +APC
MA-11-01425A
BAF12
GUF525.13
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams MF6400/7400/8400 Harness parts list
Colour reminder
FAI 23 FAI 26 FAI 27
N: Black M: Brown R: Red B: White J: Yellow V: Green
FAI 31 FAI 32 FAI 35 FAI 36 FAI 37 FAI 41 FAI 46 FAI 57 FAI 68 FAI 69 FAI 126 FAI 127 FAI 128 FAI 129 FAI 131
Cab linkage harness Linkage position sensor harness Linkage control harness inside cab (automatic hitch) Cab DynaVT transmission harness DynaVT transmission harness Dyna VT with EEM instrument panel harness Fender lighting harness (US) Fender lighting harness (all countries except US) DynaVT armrest harness 4 electrohydraulic spool valves harness Automatic air conditioning - Roof harness Fieldstar harness Front dual control harness Cab interior lighting harness (all countries except US) Cab interior lighting harness - US Linkage with Dual Control - TIC harness SisuDiesel EEM engine harness Datatronic 3 harness
Component parts list AC6 AC9 AC13
Quick soil engagement button Linkage height / depth setting potentiometer Lifting / lowering / neutral linkage selector switch CAB112 Datatronic 3 CAB141 Autotronic 5 - ParkLock DynaVT L3 Linkage position sensor L4 Draft sensor on right-hand lift arm L5 Draft sensor on left-hand lift arm L6 Linkage lifting solenoid valve L7 Linkage lowering solenoid valve L13 Autotronic 5 electronic linkage calculator L15 Linkage console L17 Trailed implement position sensor (TIC) L30 Linkage control inside cab (automatic hitch) LIG6 External control switch - lifting linkage LIG7 External control switch - lowering linkage LIG8 External control switch - lifting linkage LIG9 External control switch - lowering linkage 2 35 44 45
Fuse box Front linkage position sensor External control switch - lifting front linkage External control switch - lowering front linkage
GUF525.14
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams - MF6400/7400/8400
CAN network 20
31 30
15
24
14
27 26
CAB83.1/CAB54.4 CAB83.2/CAB54.5
25
V J
CAB83 1
2
S12.1/CAB54.26 CAB54.27/S13.1
V
FAI 31
CAB83.1/CAB50.7
120 J V J
15
13
27
14
24 25
26
¤ H
8
30
9
19 18
2 1
11
17
4
28
6 16
5
12
15
13
27
14
24
29
7
3
23
25
26
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
34
3
2
1
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
8
7
6
5
V
TR18.2/CAB50.4
J
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
V
FAI 57 CA1.14/CA8.2
J
TR18 TR18
CAB18 S21 S20
8
FAI 32 TR18.5/CAB50.7
1
TR18
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
CA1.1/CA8.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
4
4
J V
CA1
ENG4
FAI 28
S21.1/CAB18.2 S20.1/CAB18.1
V J
ENG2
15
9 10
2 7
17
11
1 6
23
4 12
5
16
22
3
15
13 24
14 26
25
FAI 41 S5.1/AC2.8 S6.1/AC2.7
V J
6
5
4
3
2
1
7
8
9
10
11 12
S5 S6
5 6 7
8 9
22
AC1 S10.1/L13.40 S9.1/L13.39
1 2 3 4
V5
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
V5
1 2 3 4
1 2
1 2
4
3
3
4
V J
V J
V J
V J S2.1/V3.2 S3.1/V3.3
4
L14.13/S5.1 S4.1/L14.12
J V
S4 S5
3
1
2
V1.2/S4.1 V1.3/S5.1
V J
L 22
L14
L22.1/S8.1 L22.2/S9.1 5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
1
S10 S9
FAI 23
S8.1/L22A.1 S9.1/L22A.2
J V CAB141.40/S10.1 CAB141.39/S9.1
V1
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
V1.2/S2.1 V1.3/S3.1
V J CAB112 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
L 22 L22.1/S4.1 L22.2/S3.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V J
S4_ S4.1/CAB112.4 S_3 S3.1/CAB112.3
V J
FAI131
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
L111
15 16
V J
CAB112
6
5
4
3
2
7
8
9
10
11 12
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L13
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L13
FS4
S3.1/L111.14 S4.1/L111.16 L111.13/CAB112.6 L111.12/CAB112.5
FAI 68 S8.1/FS4.29
V
S1.1/FS4.30
V
S9.1/FS4.27
J
S5.1/FS4.28
J S__5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37
S_1
FS2.N/S1.1 FS2.M/S1.1
V V
S5.1/FS2.K FS2.J/S5.1
J J
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
FS1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
FS1
33
CAB141 1 5 10 16 23 29 34
29
42
29
42
15
28
15
28
1
14
1
14
8 9 10
3 4 5
1 2
6
CAB112
S9
CAB141 CAB141
7
1
S8
FS1 L13
11 12 13 14
4
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
L111
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V J
FS2.C/FS1.8 FS1.9/FS2.B FS1.5/FS2.A
J V B
P N M L K J H G F E D C B A FS2
P
N
E M
D A C
L
F
B G K J
H
FS2
3
9 15 22 28 33 37
L111
J V
J V
42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CA8.1/S4.1 CA8.2/S3.1
1
2
7
L22A 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
3
4
V1
FAI128
1
6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
S2.1/V5.2 S3.1/V5.3
27 26
J V
2
L22
J V
S2.1/V4.2 S3.1/V4.3
S2
16 15
14
S5.1/L14.16 S4.1/L14.15
3
S10.1/AC1.12 AC1.11/S9.1
FAI 46
28
6 5
13 25
4
7
V J 29 17
1 4
12 24
5
6
8
V4 V4 4
18 7
3 11
23
6
5
3
7
4
3
1 2
S3
30
J V
5 6 7
2
11 10 9
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2
CA8
19 2
7
L14
31
20 21 10
4
1 12
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4
S2.1/V2.2 S3.1/V2.3
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
AC1 V
CA8
4
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1
21
8 19
18
AC2
CAB1.39/S21.1
1 2 3 4
V3
1 2
2
20
31 30
29
27
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
S6.1/AC1.12 AC1.11/S5.1
V3
4
3
3
7
X
X
4
6
8
1 2
5
5
1 2 3 4
6
4
3
1 2 3 4
V2
5 6
2
11 10 9
V2
4
1 12
AC12
3
V J
V5
V4
X
1 2
AC2.8/S12.1 S13.1/AC2.7
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
24 25
28
ENG2
FAI 31
12 13
14 26
AC2
J
23
4 5
16 27
J V J V
CAB1.16/S20.1
6
28
V J
FAI 35
22 11
1 2 3
27 26
10 3
1
1
16 15
14
9 2
7
2
28
6 5
13
21
8 19
18 17
X
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
3
12 24
20
31 30
29
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
V3
4
29 17
V2
5
18 7
1 4
23
30 19
2 3
11
AC12 AC12
6
8 9
10
ENG2.1/ENG4.30 J ENG2.2/ENG4.31 V
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
7
21
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
31
20
22
J V
L13.15/L14.16 L13.34/L14.15 L14.13/L22.2 L14.12/L22.1
S20.1/ENG2.1 S21.1/ENG2.2
CAB1
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
31
20 21 10 22
1 2 3
46 24 1 68 45 23
16
5
5
S13.1/CAB18.1 S12.1/CAB18.2
CAB1
CAB1
28
6
12
CAB18 S13 S12
25
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
17
4
23
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CAB50
CAB54
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
1
J V
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
CAB83.2/CAB50.4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
29
7
3 11
13
18
2
22
ENG4
30 19
10
CAB50
23 12
AC12.3/S6.1 S5.1/AC12.4
68 45 23
46 24 1
CAB54
22 11
4 5
16
8 9
10 3
1 6
31
21
9 2
7 17
28
20
21
8 19
18 29
CAB54
2 9
4 1
5
MA-11-01426A
GUF525.15
AUTOTRONIC 5 - Linkage - Electrical diagrams MF6400/7400/8400
GUF525.16
¤ H
WINTEST - Issue 6.a
Datatronic 3 - Description
11G10 - Datatronic 3 - Description
CONTENTS A . General. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 B . Architecture of the Datatronic 3 connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 C . Allocation of Datatronic 3 connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 D . Description of controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 E . Using the Datatronic 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.1
Datatronic 3 - Description
11G10.2
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description
A . General The Datatronic 3 (Fig. 1) is an electronic calculator that allows optimum tractor performance.
WORK
HEADLAND
SETTINGS
MEMORIES/ JOBS
1 2
EHS VALVES
DUAL CTRL
3 4 5 6
ESC
MA-11-06030A
Fig. 1
The Datatronic 3 is fitted to the console to the right of the driver’s seat (Fig. 2).
MA-11-06031A
Fig. 2 Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.3
Datatronic 3 - Description
B . Architecture of the Datatronic 3 connections The Datatronic 3 electronic calculator is connected to the CAN network and can therefore communicate with the other electronic calculators installed on the tractor.
1
7
10
8
9
1 2 3 4 5 6
ESC
CAN network
4
2
6
5
3
15 16
11 12 13 14
7 8 9 10
3 4 5
1 2
6
7 2
5
8
6
10
Location
1
3 3
4
MA-11-06032A-AG-MF
Fig. 3
Parts list : (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6)
DCC2 Autotronic 4 16-pin diagnostics connector Electronic injection control unit (EEM) Autotronic 5 electronic linkage calculator Autotronic 5 ParkLock calculator
11G10.4
¤ H
(7) (8) (9) (10)
Datatronic 3 Joystick Electrohydraulic spool valves Automatic air conditioning controller
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description
C . Allocation of Datatronic 3 connectors 1
The calculator is fitted with a 12-pin connector (Fig. 4) whose pin allocation is given in the table below.
2 3 4 5 6
ESC
1
2
4
5
6
12
11 10 9
8
7
3
MA-11-06029A
Fig. 4
Pin
Description
1
Not used
2
Not used
3
CAN High 1
4
CAN Low 1
5
CAN High 2
6
CAN Low 2
7
Not used
8
+ 12 V AC (ignition key On) supply
9
Permanent +12V supply
10
Calculator ground
11
Not used
12
Analog reference (Ground)
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
Type of signal
Tractor CAN network Provision for tractor / implements link - CAN network (not used)
Initialisation
11G10.5
Datatronic 3 - Description
D . Description of controls 6
The calculator front is fitted with switches to access the different menus displayed on a screen.
Parts list Fig. 5 (1)
(2)
(3)
Main data display: A WORK application B SETTINGS application C EHS VALVES application D HEADLAND application E MEMORIES/JOBS application F DUAL CONTROL application
A
D
B
E
1 2
1
C
3 4
F
5
2
3
5 4
6
G H
I
ESC
MA-11-06033A
Data display for other functions: G Locking of electrohydraulic valves (unlocking via switch (A) located on the console near the PTO control Fig. 6; the switch is fitted with a diode that comes on when the lock is activated). H Linkage status (unlocking via lifting / neutral action on 3-position switch). I Valve Kickout mode (electrohydraulic valve activation time); key «6 authorises this mode.
Fig. 5
A
Selection of functions «1 Accesses the WORK application
«2 «3 «4 «5
Accesses the SETTINGS application Accesses the EHS VALVES application Accesses the HEADLAND application
Accesses the MEMORIES/JOBS application «6 Used to authorise valve Kickout mode ESC returns to the previous menu. (4)
Memory card reader (MMC and SD-Card types).
(5)
Encoder: - used to alter values and navigate through menus, - used to validate actions selected by the encoder.
(6)
Multi-colour diode: - Green during operation - Blue when ignition is switched off (storing data)
11G10.6
¤ H
MA-11-06040A
Fig. 6
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description
E . Using the Datatronic 3 MEMORIES/JOBS application ................................... 8 WORK application .................................................... 31 SETTINGS application .............................................. 44 HEADLAND application............................................ 51 EHS VALVES application .......................................... 63 DUAL CONTROL application.................................... 68 HIDDEN MENU........................................................ 98
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.7
Datatronic 3 - Description MEMORIES/JOBS application General A
This application is used to store the parameters of 6 different implements. Furthermore, it is possible to: - assign a specific name to each of the 6 implements, - record a HEADLAND sequence for each implement, - control, measure and store parameters while an implement is in use, - to import or export data and settings using an SD card (7 additional memories).
HEADLAND
WORK
SETTINGS + SD
EHS VALVES
MEMORIES/ JOBS DUAL CTRL
1 2 3 4 5 6
To start the MEMORIES/JOBS application (Fig. 7): ESC
- Rotate the encoder (1) to the MEMORIES/JOBS application and press the encoder once the active function is highlighted by red text and a red rectangle around the icon, or press the key «5 (2). The window (Fig. 9) is displayed. - To exit an application, press the ESC key (3).
Z3A-1468-03-05
Fig. 8
4
5
PLOUGH DUAL CTRL AR
SELF LOADING TRAILER
1
OFF DISC TILLER
WORK
HEADLAND
SETTINGS
MEMORIES/ JOBS
DUAL CTRL AV
DUAL CTRL
JOBs SD
1 2
EHS VALVES
ON
3
2
SUBSOILER
SD
SPREADER
SD
ROTARY HARROW
SD
4 5 6
Z3A-894-03-05
Fig. 9
ESC
Z3A-893-03-05
3 Fig. 7
(4) (5)
Memory name FRONT DUAL CONTROL, CONTROL or TIC calibration.
REAR
DUAL
Note: If a card is present in the reader, an icon is displayed on the main screen (ref. A Fig. 8).
11G10.8
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description Symbols in the right-hand part of the window: Enters the selected memory
ON OFF
JOBs SD
Activates or deactivates the selected memory
JOBs menu
SD
Export settings menu
SD
Import settings menu
SD
Data export menu
To activate one of these functions, press the corresponding key «1 to «6.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.9
Datatronic 3 - Description Description of a memory
Instant fuel consumption per unit of worked area (litres / hectare)
- Select one of the six memories with the encoder (Fig. 10).
Instant area worked per hour (in hectares / hour)
PLOUGH DUAL CTRL AR
Instant fuel consumption (litres / hour)
SELF LOADING TRAILER
ON OFF
DISC TILLER
=
JOBs SD
DUAL CTRL AV
SUBSOILER
SD
SPREADER
SD
ROTARY HARROW
SD
Z3A-894-03-05
Average value
Values in the central part of the window: (6) Total distance covered by the tractor (kilometres) (7) Total fuel used (litres, US/Imperial gallon) (8) Total hours worked Note: These values are incremented when the tractor is started.
Fig. 10 - Validate by pressing the encoder or the key «1. The window Fig. 11 is displayed.
1
ROTARY HARROW
KM
3 759 M 53 L
5 487 53.8
5:25 H
9:51
8.82 HA 12.4 L/HA 8.7 HA/H 14.6 L/H
6
ABC...
7
Reset
8
Symbols in the right-hand part of the window: ABC... Provides access to the memory naming menu
Reset
0
13
Used to measure work accomplished, either manually or automatically by means of a sensor (e.g.: the number of trailers) Provides access to the implement width setting menu
4.5 M
= 11.2 = 19 = 9.4
Resets the values
Used to select the event based on which the different values should be measured. (e.g.: as soon as the linkage is lowered)
9
OFF
OFF
Activates or deactivates the memory
Z3A-895-08-04-B
Fig. 11 Symbols in the left-hand part of the window: KM
Note: If a plough width has been stored previously, the sprayer icon is replaced by a plough icon. Provides access to the plough width setting menu
Total distance covered during work (kilometres)
(9)
Implement width (metres)
Total fuel used during work (litres)
Hours worked
Saving an implement name to memory When the window (Fig. 12) is open, press the key «1 to display the first memory menu. The window (Fig. 13) is displayed.
Total area worked (hectares)
11G10.10
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description
1
----------------
ABCDEFGHIJ KLMNOPQRST UVWXYZ &01 23456789*/ +-
10
ABC... CHANGE
ABC...
P
ABCDEFGHIJ KLMNOPQRST UVWXYZ &01 23456789*/ +-
CHANGE
...
...
Z3A-904-08-04-B
Z3A-906-08-04-B
Fig. 12 Note: If no implement name has been saved, a sequence of hyphens is displayed (10 Fig. 12). To enter a new name: - Press the key «1. The previously displayed name is erased and the first letter of the alphabet is displayed in red (11 Fig. 13).
1 ---------------11
ABCDEFGHIJ KLMNOPQRST UVWXYZ &01 23456789*/ +-
ABC...
CHANGE
- Repeat this operation for the remaining letters. - To change a letter, press the key «2. The letter to change is replaced by a hyphen (13 Fig. 15).
1
13 ABC...
PLOU-
ABCDEFGHIJ KLMNOPQRST UVWXYZ &01 23456789*/ +-
CHANGE
Z3A-913-08-04-B
Fig. 15
Z3A-905-08-04-B
Fig. 13 - Select the first letter to enter by rotating the encoder (e.g.: the P of PLOUGH). - Validate the letter by pressing the encoder. The letter P is displayed in black (12 Fig. 14).
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Fig. 14
...
...
¤ H
1
12
- Select the letter to enter by rotating the encoder and validate by pressing the latter. The hyphen is replaced by the new letter. - To validate the implement name, press the ESC key. - The window (Fig. 16) is displayed.
11G10.11
Datatronic 3 - Description
1
ABC...
PLOUGH
KM
0 M 0.0 L 0:00 H
0 0.0 0:00
0 000 HA 0.0 L/HA 0.0 HA/H 0.0 L/H
Reset 14
1
SPREADER
KM
0 0.0
0M 0.0 L 0:00 H
0
4.5 M
= 0.0 = 0.0 = 0.0
ABC...
0:00
0 000 HA L/HA
Z3A-907-08-04-B
0
4.5 M
= 0.0 = 0.0 = 0.0
0.0 0.0 HA/H 0.0 L/H
OFF
Reset
OFF
Z3A-907-08-04-B
Fig. 16 Note: All values are set to 0, except the implement width (14) if the latter has been set previously.
To modify a name: - When the window (Fig. 17) is open, select the name of the memory to modify using the encoder and validate by pressing the key «1 or the encoder.
PLOUGH
ON OFF
DISC TILLER DUAL CTRL AV
SUBSOILER SPREADER ROTARY HARROW
- Press the key «1 to display the memory naming menu. The window (Fig. 19) is displayed.
5
ABC...
SPREADER
ABCDEFGHIJ KLMNOPQRST UVWXYZ &01 23456789*/ +-
CHANGE
...
DUAL CTRL AR
SELF LOADING TRAILER
Fig. 18
JOBs SD
Z3A-915-08-04-B
SD
Fig. 19 SD
SD
- Press the key «2 (CHANGE) to modify the name. The first letter of the word "SPREADER" is displayed in red (15 Fig. 20) in a new window.
Z3A-894-03-05
Fig. 17
11G10.12
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description
5
15
1
SPREADER
ABCDEFGHIJ KLMNOPQRST UVWXYZ &01 23456789*/ +-
PLOUGH
KM
ABC...
0M 0.0 L 0:00 H
0 0.0 0:00
0 000 HA
...
0
4.5 M
L/HA
= 0.0 = 0.0 = 0.0
0.0 0.0 HA/H 0.0 L/H
Z3A-921-08-04-B
Reset
OFF
Z3A-907-08-04-B
Fig. 20 - Select a letter to change from the word “SPREADER” by pressing the key «1. - Press the encoder. The first letter of the alphabet is displayed in red (16 Fig. 21).
5
16
Fig. 22
Setting an implement width When the window (Fig. 22) is open, press the key «4. A new window is displayed (Fig. 23).
1
SPREADER
ABCDEFGHIJ KLMNOPQRST UVWXYZ &01 23456789*/ +-
PLOUGH
KM
0 000 HA
...
Z3A-922-08-04-B
- Select a letter by rotating the encoder and validate by pressing the latter. The letter is replaced and displayed in black. - Repeat this operation for the remaining letters to modify. - Press the ESC key to validate the word. The window (Fig. 22) is displayed.
¤ H
0 0.0 0:00 4.5 M
Z3A-908-08-04-B
Fig. 21
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
0 M 0.0 L 0:00 H
Fig. 23 If a plough is used, press the key «5. If any implement is used, press the key «6.. Setting a plough width: - Press the key «5 when the window (Fig. 23) is open. The settings window (Fig. 24) is displayed.
11G10.13
Datatronic 3 - Description
1
1
PLOUGH
KM
0 M 0.0 L 0:00 H
KM
0 0.0
0 0.0
0M 0.0 L 0:00 H
0:00
0 000 HA
5
PLOUGH
0:00
0 000 HA
4.5 M
5.48 M
12
18 17
14''
4.5 M
18''
Z3A-909-08-04-B
Z3A-911-08-04-B
20
Fig. 24 (17) Number of plough bodies (18) Distance in inches between bodies As soon as the window opens, the number of bodies is displayed in red. This value can therefore be set. - Set the number of plough bodies (18) by rotating the encoder (1 to 22 bodies). As soon as the encoder is rotated, the working width is displayed according to the selected distance in inches between the bodies (19 Fig. 25).
1
21
- Set the width in inches by rotating the encoder (from 8 to 30 inches). The working width (21) varies according to the value displayed. - Validate by pressing the encoder. The window (Fig. 27) is displayed.
1
0M 0.0 L 0:00 H 0 000 HA
KM
0 M 0.0 L 0:00 H
12
0 000 HA 0 0.0
0.0 L/HA 0.0 HA/H 0.0 L/H
0:00 19
4.26M
4.5 M
ABC...
PLOUGH
PLOUGH
KM
Fig. 26
Reset 0 0.0 22 23 0 0:00 12/18 ' ' 5.48 M = 0.0 24
= 0.0 = 0.0
OFF
Z3A-912-08-04-B
Fig. 27 (22) Number of plough bodies (23) Distance between bodies (24) Working width
14'' Z3A-910-08-04-B
Fig. 25 - Validate this number by pressing the encoder. The number of bodies is now displayed in black and the width in inches is displayed in red (20 Fig. 26).
11G10.14
¤ H
Icon representing the plough
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description Setting an implement width: - Select an implement to configure in the window (Fig. 28). Example: DISC TILLER by pressing the encoder or the key «1. The window of this implement (Fig. 29) is displayed.
3
DISC TILLER
KM
PLOUGH
0M 0.0 L 0.0 H
0 0.0 0:00
0 000 HA
DUAL CTRL AR
SELF LOADING TRAILER
12/18 ' ' 5.48M
ON OFF
DISC TILLER
JOBs SD
DUAL CTRL AV
SUBSOILER
SD
Z3A-924-08-04-B
Fig. 30
SPREADER
SD
ROTARY HARROW
- Press the key «6 to display the settings window (Fig. 31). The width is displayed in red (25).
SD
Z3A-894-03-05
Fig. 28
3
KM
3
ABC...
DISC TILLER
KM
0 M 0.0 L 0:00 H
0 0.0 0:00
0 000 HA 0.0 L/HA 0.0 HA/H 0.0 L/H
Reset
0 M 0.0 L 0:00 H 0 000 HA
0 0.0 0:00 25
12/18 ' ' 5.48 M
0
12/18 ' ' 5.48 M
= 0.0 = 0.0 = 0.0
4.5 M Z3A-925-08-04-B
Fig. 31
OFF
Z3A-923-08-04-B
Fig. 29
- Set the implement width by rotating the encoder. - Validate the width by pressing the encoder. The window (Fig. 32) is displayed.
- Press the key «4, whatever the icon displayed facing this key (plough or sprayer). The settings window (Fig. 30) is displayed.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.15
Datatronic 3 - Description
3
ABC...
DISC TILLER
KM
0M 0.0 L 0:00H 0 000 HA 0.0 L/HA 0.0 HA/H 0.0 L/H
0 0.0
Reset 26
0:00
0
4.5 M
= 0.0 = 0.0 = 0.0
27
OFF
Z3A-926-08-04-B
Fig. 32
Z3A-928-08-04
Fig. 33
(26) Implement width Icon representing a sprayer width
Counting function Manual counting: The MEMORIES application can be used to perform a manual count of, for example, the number of trailers carried during a working day. For this, press the key «3 when the window (Fig. 32) is open. Each successive press increments the value by 1 point.
Resetting values One or several values can be reset. For this purpose: - Press the key «2 when the window (Fig. 32) is open. A mark facing the total distance is displayed (28 Fig. 34)
3
ABC...
DISC TILLER
KM
5 628 M
7 323
53 L 6:20 H
76 8:14
28 Automatic counting This count can be performed automatically by means of a sensor placed on the implement and connected to the diagnostics connector (27 Fig. 33).
Reset 0
4.5 M
2.5 HA 0.0 L/HA 0.0 HA/H 0.0 L/H
= 0.0 = 0.0 = 0.0
OFF
Z3A-929-08-04-B
Fig. 34 - Select the value to reset by rotating the encoder. - Validate by pressing the encoder or the key «2.
- To reset all the values, rotate the encoder in such a manner as to place a mark facing each value and validate by pressing the encoder (Fig. 35) or the key «2.
11G10.16
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description
3
DISC TILLER
KM
ABC...
5 628 M
7 323
53 6:20 H
76 8:14
L
2.5 0.0 0.0 0.0
HA L/HA HA/H L/H
3
0 0.0 0:00
Reset 9713
0 0.0 0:00
4.5 M
= 0.0 = 0.0 = 0.0
29
OFF
Z3A-930-08-04-B
Z3A-1332-12-04
Fig. 35 It is also possible to completely reset the memory (name, headland sequence, hydraulic spool valves flow rate 100%, Dual Control default settings). - Turn the encoder until RESET is displayed in red (Fig. 36). - Validate by pressing the encoder or the key «2.
3
Fig. 37 Eleven events are available: On activation of the linkage Lowering control
On activation of the PTO control
As soon as the tractor engine is started
DISC TILLER
KM
ABC...
5 628 M
7 323
53 L 6:20 H
76 8:14
2.5 0.0 0.0 0.0
HA L/HA HA/H L/H
RESET 9713
4.5 M
= 0.0 = 0.0 = 0.0
As soon as the sensor placed on the implement sends data to the DATATRONIC 3 or by holding key«3 pressed down Never
For the two spool valves (red and green) controlled by the Joystick:
OFF
As soon as the Joystick control is moved to the "+" (in Kickout mode)
Z3A-1493-04-05
Fig. 36
Selecting an event for measuring parameters An event can be selected from which the measurement should start. To select this event, press the key «5 when the window (Fig. 35) is open. The window (Fig. 37) is displayed.
As soon as the Joystick control is moved to the "-" (in Kickout mode)
IMPORTANT: To measure parameters with one of the two spool valves, a Kickout must be activated. As soon as the Joystick control is moved to the floating position
IMPORTANT: To measure parameters when the spool valve control is in floating position, floating position must be enabled.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.17
Datatronic 3 - Description Note: When parameter measuring is active, a red dot is displayed on the corresponding icon (e.g. 29 Fig. 35). Activating a memory When the window (Fig. 38) is displayed, select a memory using the encoder. Press the key «5. The window Fig. 39 is displayed with the ON icon alongside the selected memory.
3
KM
0M 0.0 L 0:00 H
ON OFF
Reset 0
0:00 4.5 M
0.0 L/HA 0.0 HA/H 0.0 L/H
DUAL CTRL AR
DISC TILLER
0 0.0
0 000 HA
PLOUGH SELF LOADING TRAILER
ABC...
DISC TILLER
= 0.0 = 0.0 = 0.0
OFF
Z3A-926-08-04-B
Fig. 40
JOBs SD
DUAL CTRL AV
Press the key «6 to activate or deactivate the memory:
SUBSOILER
SD
SPREADER
OFF
Inactive memory
ON
Active memory
SD
ROTARY HARROW
SD
Z3A-894-03-05
Fig. 38
PLOUGH DUAL CTRL AR
SELF LOADING TRAILER
ON OFF
DISC TILLER
JOBs SD
DUAL CTRL AV
SUBSOILER
ON
SD
SPREADER SD
ROTARY HARROW
SD
Z3A-1466-03-05
Fig. 39 The memory can also be activated when the window Fig. 40 is open:
11G10.18
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description When a memory is active, all parameters defined and measured shall be stored in this memory: - memory name - event used to perform counting, - total fuel consumption, - area worked, - hours worked, - distance, - implement width, - headland sequence (see page 51 HEADLAND application), - spool valve parameters (see page 63 EHS VALVES application), - DUAL parameters (see page 68 DUAL CONTROL application),
Note: If a memory is active, its name is displayed in the window (example 30 Fig. 41) when the MEMORIES application is selected and there is no active JOB.
WORK
HEADLAND
SETTINGS
MEMORIES/ JOBS
1 2
EHS VALVES
DUAL CTRL
3 4 5
DISC TILLER 6
30
ESC
Z3A-893-03-05
Fig. 41
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.19
Datatronic 3 - Description JOBS menu The JOBS menu allows all instant values relating to a memory to be stored on the memory card (one value stored every 2 seconds), for example consumption, distance, area worked and also engine and transmission temperatures.
OFF
Job status (activated: ON, deactivated: OFF)
JOB
Allows access to jobs stored in the Datatronic 3
To enter the JOBS menu, press the key «3 when the window (Fig. 42) is open. The window (Fig. 43) is displayed.
JOB
SD
PLOUGH
FAT 32
OFF
DUAL CTRL AR
SELF LOADING TRAILER
Allows coordinates of a job stored on the SDcard to be imported
Provides access to the card formatting menu
Transport Job status (activated: ON, deactivated: OFF)
ON OFF
DISC TILLER
JOBs SD
DUAL CTRL AV
SUBSOILER
Note: If there is no card in the Datatronic 3 reader, a message is displayed on the screen (32 Fig. 44)
SD
JOB STATUS: OFF
SPREADER SD
FAT-NO-CARD-PRESENT
JOB NAME
ROTARY HARROW
OFF JOB
SD
FIELD
32 JOB
Z3A-894-03-05
Fig. 42
DRIVER SD
FARM
FAT 32
APPLICATION
JOB STATUS: OFF JOB NAME
OFF 31
JOB
TRANSPORT JOB
OFF
Z3A-1475-04-05
Fig. 44
FIELD JOB
DRIVER SD
FARM
FAT 32
APPLICATION
TRANSPORT JOB
OFF
Activating / deactivating a Job The Job status is displayed on the screen (31 Fig. 43). - To activate the Job, press the key «1 when the window (Fig. 43) is open. The window (Fig. 45) is displayed.
Z3A-1467-03-05
Fig. 43
11G10.20
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description
ETAT DU JOB : ON
ON
JOB NAME
JOB
FIELD
JOB STATUS: SUSPENDED JOB NAME
OFF JOB
FIELD JOB
DRIVER
JOB
DRIVER SD
FARM
FAT 32
APPLICATION
SD
FARM
FAT 32
APPLICATION
TRANSPORT JOB
TRANSPORT JOB
OFF
Z3A-1471-04-05
OFF
Z3A-1467-03-05
Fig. 45 When a Job is active, a symbol on the main screen displays the percentage of card memory used (33 Fig. 46) (useful card memory: approximately 1500 hours).
WORK
HEADLAND
SETTINGS
MEMORIES/ JOBS DUAL CTRL
Naming a Job This menu allows Job coordinates (Job name, field, driver name, farm name, application type) to be entered. - To access the Job naming menu, press the key «2 when the window (Fig. 43) is open. The window (Fig. 48) is displayed.
1 2
EHS VALVES
Fig. 47
Note: The Job must be suspended (or OFF) to access this menu.
3 4 5
JOB
0%
33
6
JOB STATUS: SUSPENDED
OFF
ESC
Z3A-1478-04-05
Fig. 46 - To deactivate the Job, press the key «1. The window (Fig. 47) is displayed.
------
JOB NAME FIELD DRIVER FARM APPLICATION
JOB
JOB
SD
FARM
FAT 32
APPLICATION
TRANSPORT JOB
OFF
Z3A-1472-04-05
Fig. 48 - Using the encoder, select the line to change (e.g. JOB NAME). - Press the encoder, and the window is displayed (Fig. 49).
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.21
Datatronic 3 - Description
JOB STATUS: SUSPENDED JOB NAME
---
OFF
NEW DELETE
JOB STATUS: SUSPENDED JOB NAME
JOB
FIELD
FIELD
--
NEW
--
DELETE
OFF JOB
PLOUGH
JOB
DRIVER
JOB
DRIVER SD
FARM
FAT 32
APPLICATION
SD
FARM APPLICATION
TRANSPORT JOB
TRANSPORT JOB
OFF
Z3A-1473-04-05
It is then possible to enter a new name, delete an existing name or use a name that has already been entered. Entering a new name - When the window (Fig. 49) is open, press the encoder. The window (Fig. 50) is displayed.
Fig. 51 Deleting an existing name - Select the DELETE line using the encoder when the window (Fig. 49) is open. - Validate by pressing the encoder. The window (Fig. 52) is displayed.
JOB STATUS: SUSPENDED JOB STATUS: SUSPENDED
FIELD
OFF
Z3A-1473-04-05
Fig. 49
JOB NAME
FAT 32
--
NEW
--
DELETE
OFF
FIELD
--
NEW
--
DELETE
PLOUGH JOB
DRIVER JOB
DRIVER SD
FAT 32
SD
FARM
TRANSPORT JOB
OFF
FAT 32
APPLICATION
APPLICATION
TRANSPORT JOB
JOB
JOB
A
FARM
JOB NAME
OFF
OFF
Z3A-1473-04-05
Fig. 52
Z3A-1473-04-05
Fig. 50 -
Select the letter by rotating the encoder. Validate the letter by pressing the encoder. Repeat this operation for the remaining letters. Press ESC to validate the name. The window (Fig. 51) is displayed.
11G10.22
¤ H
- Select the name to delete with the encoder. - Validate by pressing the encoder, and the window is displayed (Fig. 49). Selecting an entered name - When the window (Fig. 51) is displayed, select a name using the encoder (Fig. 53).
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description
JOB STATUS: SUSPENDED --
JOB NAME
-FIELD
OFF
NEW DELETE
JOB
JOB STATUS: SUSPENDED PLOUGH SUBSOILER
OFF JOB
PLOUGH JOB
JOB
DRIVER SD
FARM
FAT 32
SD
FAT 32
APPLICATION
TRANSPORT JOB
TRANSPORT JOB
OFF
Z3A-1473-04-05
Z3A-1474-04-05
Fig. 53 - Press the encoder to validate, and the window (Fig. 54) is displayed with the name of the selected Job.
JOB STATUS: SUSPENDED JOB NAME
OFF
PLOUGH
OFF
Fig. 55 - Select the required Job name with the encoder. (e.g. SUBSOILER Job). - Validate by pressing the encoder, and the window is displayed (Fig. 56).
JOB STATUS: SUSPENDED
OFF
JOB
JOB NAME
FIELD JOB
DRIVER
SUBSOILER
JOB
FIELD JOB
SD
FARM
FAT 32
DRIVER SD
FARM
APPLICATION
FAT 32
APPLICATION
TRANSPORT JOB
OFF
TRANSPORT JOB
OFF
Z3A-1467-03-05
Fig. 54
Z3A-1467-03-05
Fig. 56 - Use the same procedure to enter field name, driver name, farm name and application type.
Note: If no Job is present on the card, a message is displayed on the screen (34 Fig. 57).
Importing coordinates of a Job stored on the card It is possible to enter coordinates of a Job stored the card into the Datatronic 3 using computer software. - Press the key «3 when the window (Fig. 54) is open. The window (Fig. 55) is displayed.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.23
Datatronic 3 - Description
JOB STATUS: OFF FAT-FILE-NOT-FOUND
OFF
JOB NAME FIELD
JOB
34
JOB STATUS: TRANSPORT JOB JOB NAME
TRANSPORT JOB
FIELD
NO FIELD
OFF JOB
JOB
DRIVER
JOB
DRIVER SD
FARM
FAT 32
APPLICATION
SD
FARM
FAT 32
APPLICATION
TRANSPORT JOB
TRANSPORT JOB
OFF
Z3A-1476-04-05
ON
Z3A-1477-04-05
Fig. 57
Formatting the card - Press the key «4 when the window (Fig. 57) is open (a card must have been inserted into the reader previously). The window (Fig. 58) is displayed.
Fig. 59
The driver name is the same as that used for the last Job. As soon as a Job is active, a symbol on the main screen displays the percentage of card memory used (35 Fig. 60) (useful card memory: approximately 1500 hours).
Do you want to format the card? WORK
HEADLAND
SETTINGS
MEMORIES/ JOBS
1 2
EHS VALVES
DUAL CTRL
3 4 5
JOB
0%
6
Z3A-1496-04-05
Fig. 58 - Press the key «1 to carry out the formatting. - Press the ESC key to cancel the formatting.
35
ESC
Z3A-1478-04-05
Fig. 60
Using the Transport Job The Transport Job is a Job whose coordinates are factory predefined and stored in the Datatronic 3. - Press the key «6 when the window (Fig. 57) is open. The window (Fig. 59) is displayed.
11G10.24
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description Export settings menu This menu allows memory settings (e.g. restart speed, valve hydraulic flow rates, Kickout times, a headland sequence, stored ground speeds SV1 and SV2, stored engine speed A and B) to be exported to the memory card. - Press the key «4 when the window (Fig. 61) is open. The window (Fig. 62) is displayed.
- When the window (Fig. 62) is displayed, press the key «2 to select, of the six Datatronic 3 memories, the one to be transferred to the card. - Next, press the key «3 to select, from the seven card memories present, the memory to which the Datatronic 3 memory is to be transferred. - The memory can be renamed nefore carrying out the transfer by pressing the key «4. The window (Fig. 63) is displayed.
PLOUGH TRACTOR DATA -> CARD
DUAL CTRL AR
SELF LOADING TRAILER
ON OFF
DISC TILLER
PLOUGH
1
M1-6
AAAAAAAAA
1
SD
JOBs SD
DUAL CTRL AV
SUBSOILER
M1-7
SD
A
SPREADER
ABC..
SD
ROTARY HARROW
SD SD
Z3A-894-03-05
Fig. 61
Z3A-1479-04-05
Fig. 63
TRACTOR DATA -> CARD PLOUGH
1
M1-6
AAAAAAAAA
1
SD
- Using the encoder, select the 1st letter, then validate by pressing the encoder. - Repeat this operation for the remaining letters. - When the new name is complete, press the ESC key to validate.
M1-7
ABC..
- The settings transfer must then be validated by pressing the key «6. An OK message is displayed on the screen (36 Fig. 64).
SD
Z3A-1479-04-05
Fig. 62 M1-6
SD
M1-7
ABC..
SD
Selects a Datatronic 3 memory
Selects a card memory Allows the memory to be renamed (name that will be recorded on a card) Validates the transfer
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.25
Datatronic 3 - Description
TRACTOR DATA -> CARD
PLOUGH DUAL CTRL AR
PLOUGH
1
AAAAAAAAA
1
PLOUGH
M1-6
SD
M1-7
ABC..
SELF LOADING TRAILER
ON OFF
DISC TILLER
JOBs SD
DUAL CTRL AV
SUBSOILER
SD
SPREADER SD
OK Z3A-1484-04-05
SD
ROTARY HARROW
SD
Z3A-894-03-05
36
Fig. 64
Several transfers can be made at the same time. For this purpose repeat the operation, validating each transfer by pressing the key «6. - Press the ESC key when the window (Fig. 64) is open. The transfer is made and a message is displayed on the screen (37 Fig. 65).
Fig. 66
Note: If there is no card in the Datatronic 3 reader, a message is displayed on the screen (38 Fig. 67).
TRACTOR DATA -> CARD FAT-NO-CARD-PRESENT
PLOUGH
TRACTOR DATA -> CARD WRITING... PLOUGH AAAAAAAAA
37
AAAAAAAAA
1
M1-6
1
SD
PLOUGH
PLOUGH
38
1
M1-6
1
SD
M1-7
ABC..
M1-7
ABC.. SD
Z3A-1488-04-05
OK
SD
Fig. 67
Z3A-1484-04-05
Fig. 65 The window (Fig. 66) is displayed again when the transfer is complete.
11G10.26
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description Import settings menu This menu allows memory settings (e.g. restart speed, valve hydraulic flow rates, Kickout times, a headland sequence, stored ground speeds SV1 and SV2, stored engine speeds A and B) to be imported to the Datatronic 3. - Press the key «5 when the window (Fig. 68) is open. The window (Fig. 69) is displayed.
- When the window (Fig. 69) is displayed, press the key «2 to select, of the six Datatronic 3 memories, the one to which the card memory is to be transferred. - Next, press the key «3 to select, from the seven card memories present, the memory to transfer to the Datatronic 3. - The memory can be renamed nefore carrying out the transfer by pressing the key «4. The window (Fig. 70) is displayed.
PLOUGH DUAL CTRL AR
SELF LOADING TRAILER
IMPORT TRACTOR DATA
ON OFF
DISC TILLER
JOBs SD
DUAL CTRL AV
SUBSOILER
SD
SPREADER SD
ROTARY HARROW
PLOUGH
1
M1-6
AAAAAAAAA
1
SD
A
M1-7
ABC..
SD
Z3A-894-03-05
Fig. 68 Z3A-1486-04-05
Fig. 70 IMPORT TRACTOR DATA PLOUGH
1
M1-6
AAAAAAAAA
1
SD
M1-7
- Using the encoder, select the 1st letter, then validate by pressing the encoder. - Repeat this operation for the remaining letters. - When the new name is complete, press the ESC key to validate.
ABC.. - The settings transfer must then be validated by pressing the key «6. An OK message is displayed on the screen (39 Fig. 71).
Z3A-1486-04-05
Fig. 69 M1-6
SD
M1-7
ABC..
Selects a Datatronic 3 memory
Selects a card memory Allows the memory to be renamed (name that will be recorded on the Datatronic 3) Validates the transfer
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.27
Datatronic 3 - Description
IMPORT TRACTOR DATA
PLOUGH DUAL CTRL AR
PLOUGH
1
AAAAAAAAA
1
PLOUGH
M1-6
SD
M1-7
ABC..
SELF LOADING TRAILER
ON OFF
DISC TILLER
JOBs SD
DUAL CTRL AV
SUBSOILER
SD
SPREADER SD
ROTARY HARROW
OK Z3A-1487-04-05
SD
Z3A-894-03-05
39
Fig. 71
Several transfers can be made at the same time. For this purpose repeat the operation, validating each transfer by pressing the key «6. - Press the ESC key when the window (Fig. 71) is open. The transfer is made and a message is displayed on the screen (40 Fig. 72).
Fig. 73
Note: If there is no card in the Datatronic 3 reader, a message is displayed on the screen (41 Fig. 74).
IMPORT TRACTOR DATA FAT-NO-CARD-PRESENT
PLOUGH
IMPORT TRACTOR DATA WRITING... PLOUGH AAAAAAAAA
40
AAAAAAAAA
1
M1-6
1
SD
PLOUGH
PLOUGH
41
1
M1-6
1
SD
M1-7
ABC..
M1-7
ABC..
Z3A-1489-04-05
Fig. 74
OK Z3A-1487-04-05
Fig. 72 The window (Fig. 73) is displayed again when the transfer is complete.
11G10.28
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description Data export menu This menu allows memory data (values displayed on the memory screen: hours worked, area worked, etc.) to be exported onto the card. - Press the key «6 when the window (Fig. 75) is open. The window (Fig. 76) is displayed.
- When the window (Fig. 76) is displayed, press the key «2 to select, of the six Datatronic 3 memories, the one to be transferred to the card. - The memory can be renamed nefore carrying out the transfer by pressing the key «3. The following window is displayed.
WORK DATA -> CARD
PLOUGH DUAL CTRL AR
SELF LOADING TRAILER
PLOUGH
ON
1
OFF DISC TILLER
JOBs SD
DUAL CTRL AV
SUBSOILER
M1-6
A
ABC..
SD
SPREADER SD
ROTARY HARROW
SD
SD Z3A-1490-04-05
Z3A-894-03-05
Fig. 77
Fig. 75
WORK DATA -> CARD PLOUGH
1
M1-6
ABC..
- Using the encoder, select the 1st letter, then validate by pressing the encoder. - Repeat this operation for the remaining letters. - When the new name is complete, press the ESC key to validate. - The settings transfer must then be validated by pressing the key «6. An OK message is displayed on the screen (42 Fig. 78).
WORK DATA -> CARD SD
PLOUGH
1
M1-6
Z3A-1490-04-05
Fig. 76
M1-6
ABC..
PLOUGH
ABC..
Selects a Datatronic 3 memory
Allows the memory to be renamed
OK
SD
Z3A-1491-04-05 SD
Validates the transfer
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
42
Fig. 78
11G10.29
Datatronic 3 - Description Several transfers can be made at the same time. For this purpose repeat the operation, validating each transfer by pressing the key «6. - Press the ESC key when the window (Fig. 78) is open. The transfer is made and the window (Fig. 79) is displayed again.
PLOUGH DUAL CTRL AR
SELF LOADING TRAILER
ON OFF
DISC TILLER
JOBs SD
DUAL CTRL AV
SUBSOILER
SD
SPREADER SD
ROTARY HARROW
SD
Z3A-894-03-05
Fig. 79
Note: If there is no card in the Datatronic 3 reader, a message is displayed on the screen (43 Fig. 80).
IMPORT TRACTOR DATA FAT-NO-CARD-PRESENT
PLOUGH
43
1
M1-6
ABC..
SD
Z3A-1492-04-05
Fig. 80
11G10.30
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description WORK application General This application is used to display various parameters stored for tractor use. A certain number of parameters are fixed (Fig. 82, upper part of the screen) while others can be selected by the user (right- and left-hand windows on screen). To start the WORK application (Fig. 81): - Rotate the encoder (1) to the WORK application and press the encoder once the active function is highlighted by red text and a red rectangle around the icon, or press the key «1 (2). The window (Fig. 82) is displayed. - To exit an application, press the ESC key (3).
Left-hand window: - EHS VALVES 1-4, - GEARBOX SETTINGS, - ACTIVE MEMORY, - HEADLAND, - REAR DUAL CTRL, - FRONT DUAL CTRL, - TIC (Trailed Implement Control). Right-hand window: - EHS VALVES 1-4, - GEARBOX SETTINGS, - ACTIVE MEMORY, - HEADLAND, - POINTS, - EHS VALVES 5-6.
1 4
2 WORK
HEADLAND
2
SETTINGS
MEMORIES/ JOBS
EHS VALVES
DUAL CTRL
1000
B
2000
790RPM 5.3 KPH
3
1
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND REAR DUAL CTRL FRONT DUAL CTRL TIC
4 5 6
ESC
Z3A-782-03-05
A 1
3
540 10% M 5%
5
2
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
Fig. 81 Z3A-787-08-04-B
Fig. 82 Description (Fig. 82) Fixed upper section:
A
Memorised engine speed A (icon is green when the function is active)
B
Memorised engine speed B (icon is green when the function is active)
Note: When using this application, you can open the menu of your choice from the right-hand or left-hand part of the screen when displayed in both screens (EHS VALVES, GEARBOX SETTINGS, ACTIVE MEMORY and HEADLAND).
PTO speed (icon is yellow when the function is active) Tractor wheel slip (maximum percentage (4) and actual percentage (5))
Note: See DCC2 section for setting wheel slip.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.31
Datatronic 3 - Description EHS Valves menu EHS VALVES 1-4 menu displayed in the left-hand window:
Description: Each spool valve is distinguished by a colour, and the following information is displayed (Fig. 84): Icon indicating that the spool valve controls are locked. To unlock, press the button near the PTO control (Ref. A Fig. 85). The icon disappears.
A
1000
B
2000
790RPM 5.3 KPH
7
1
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND REAR DUAL CTRL FRONT DUAL CTRL TIC
Icon indicating that the Kick out (spool valve activation time) is locked. To unlock, press the key «5
540
when the window is active, or the key «6 when the window Fig. 81 is open.
10% M 5%
6
Shortcut icon providing access to the EHS VALVE SETTINGS application by pressing the key «6 (see page 63 EHS VALVES application).
2
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
Spool valve is in floating position
5s
Spool valve activation time. The value is displayed in a black frame when this function is activated.
89
Flow rate values adjusted
Z3A-788-08-04-B
Fig. 83 - To start one of the applications, press the key «1, or the key «2 twice. The first key press selects the window and the second displays the list. The active application is represented by a green button at the top right of the window (6 Fig. 83). - To call up the various menus, select the application using the encoder. The selected application is displayed in a black frame (7 Fig. 83). - Validate by pressing the encoder or the key «1. The window (Fig. 84) is displayed.
(8)
Real-time display of Spool valve lever movement (in red inside the progress bar).
- To return to the previous menu, press the key «1 or «2 once, depending on the window currently open.
A
790 5.3 KPH
RPM
A
1000
B
2000
87
53
98
19
100 2s
28 8s
76 5s
89
8 EHS VALVES 1-4
540 10% M 5%
1
2
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
MA-11-06040A
Fig. 85
Z3A-786-08-04-B
Fig. 84
11G10.32
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description EHS VALVES 5-6 menu displayed in the right-hand window only: - To display this menu, press key «2 twice. The first press selects the window and the second press displays the list if no application was activated previously. The active window is indicated by a green icon (9 Fig. 86). - To call up the various menus, select the application using the encoder. The selected application is displayed in a black frame (10 Fig. 86). - Validate by pressing the encoder or the key «1. The window (Fig. 87) is displayed.
A
1000
B
2000
790 RPM 5.3 KPH
EHS VALVES 1-4 87
53
98
19
100 2s
28 8s
76 5s
89
1
540 10% M 5%
9 EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
2
10
Z3A-1346-12-04
Fig. 86
A
1000
B
2000
790RPM 5.3KPH
EHS VALVES 1-4
1
540 10% M 5%
EHS VALVES 5-6
87
53
98
19
22
44
100 2s
28 8s
76 5s
89
76 3s
56 4s
2
Z3A-1345-12-04
Fig. 87
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.33
Datatronic 3 - Description Description:
Gearbox settings menu Displays the GEARBOX SETTINGS menu in the right-hand window (Fig. 88): This display is used to view the DynaVT transmission settings.
A
1000
B
2000
SV2
SV2 regulator speed value
540
The different transmission control modes:
10% M 5%
12
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND REAR DUAL CTRL FRONT DUAL CTRL TIC
SV1 regulator speed value
(13) Forward restart speed (14) Reverse restart speed
790 RPM 5.3 KPH 1
SV1
11
Lever mode
2
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
Pedal mode (POWER or ECO)
Self-propelled mode
Z3A-787-08-04-B
Fig. 88 - To start one of the applications, press the key «1, or the key «2 twice. The first key press selects the window and the second displays the list. The active application is represented by a green button at the top right of the window (11 Fig. 88). - To call up the various menus, select the application using the encoder. The selected application is displayed in a black frame (12 Fig. 88). - Validate by pressing the encoder or the key «2. The window (Fig. 89) is displayed.
A
1000
B
2000
790 RPM 5.3 KPH 1
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND REAR DUAL CTRL FRONT DUAL CTRL TIC 13
10% M 5%
GEARBOX SETTINGS
7.8
SV2
5.2
6.4
2
3.5 14 Fig. 89
¤ H
A
1000
B
2000
15
790RPM 5.3KPH
540 10% M 5% 2
1
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
Z3A-788-08-04-B
Fig. 90
Z3A-973-08-04-B
11G10.34
Displays the ACTIVE MEMORY menu in the left-hand window (Fig. 90):
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND REAR DUAL CTRL FRONT DUAL CTRL16 TIC
540
SV1
Active memory menu
- To start one of the applications, press the key «1 or «2 twice. The first key press selects the window and the second displays the list. The active application is represented by a green button at the top right of the window (15 Fig. 90). - To call up the various menus, select the application using the encoder. The selected application is displayed in a black frame (16 Fig. 90).
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description - Validate by pressing the encoder or the key «1. The window (Fig. 91) is displayed.
worked to be taken into account for improved precision. 1 3/4 1/2 1/4
A
1000
B
2000
790RPM 5.3KPH
17
SPRAYER
1
10% M 5%
1
20.4 HA 0.0
HA/H
0.0
L/HA L/H
0.0
540
3/4 1/2 1/4
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
0
19
2
Z3A-791-08-04-B
18
Fig. 91 Note: The first window displayed shows field parameters.
Fig. 92 Z3A-1347-12-04 Note: The total implement width is always taken into account by default. The icon (19 Fig. 91) is active. Transport parameters:
Description (Fig. 91): (17) Name of the active memory (if no memory is active, "MEMORY OFF" is displayed) (18) Width divider
A
1000
B
2000
790 RPM 5.3 KPH
Total area worked
TRAILER KM Instant area worked per hour (in hectares / hour)
Instant fuel consumption per unit of worked area (litres / hectare)
540 10% M 5%
1
13.5
M
3.5
H
12.6
L
5.8
L/H
2
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
Instant fuel consumption (litres / hour) Z3A-1382-01-05
Fig. 93 Allows field or transport parameters to be selected. The window (Fig. 93) is displayed. Shortcut icon providing access to the MEMORIES application by pressing the key «5. Selects a width divider by pressing the key
«6
KM
Total distance covered during work (kilometres)
Hours worked
Total fuel used during work (litres)
Using the width divider: This function is used to modify the measurement of an area when the work implement must pass over an area that has already been worked (example). Thus by selecting the correct icon (1, 3/4, 1/2 or 0), the implement width is reduced, allowing the areas already
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
Instant fuel consumption (litres / hour)
11G10.35
Datatronic 3 - Description Headland application Displays the HEADLAND menu in the right-hand window (Fig. 94): This display is used to view the programmed sequences.
- Pressing the key «5 (facing symbol 22 Fig. 95) calls up the HEADLAND configuration menu. The window (Fig. 96) is displayed.
OFF A
1000
B
2000
790RPM 5.3KPH
PLOUGH
0.0 1
L/HA L/H
3/4 1/2 1/4
1920 42.0
10% M 5% 2
1.2
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
20.4 HA HA/H 0.0 0.0
GO
540
20
1
REC
EDIT
Z3A-794-08-04
0
21
Fig. 96
Z3A-790-08-04-B
Fig. 94 - To start one of the applications, press the key«1 or«2 twice. The first key press selects the window and the second displays the list. The active application is represented by a green button at the top right of the window (20 Fig. 94). - To call up the various menus, select the application using the encoder. The selected application is displayed in a black frame (21 Fig. 94). - Validate by pressing the encoder or the key «2. The window (Fig. 95) is displayed.
A B
790RPM 5.3 KPH
1000 2000
PLOUGH
1
20.4
L/H
5.2
HA/H
1
Note: To activate a sequence, see page 8 MEMORIES/JOBS application. In this case, the actions are displayed in the icons (e.g.: Fig. 97). Note: To record the different sequences, see page 51 HEADLAND application.
A
1000
B
2000
10% M 5%
PLOUGH 2
+1
+2
20.4
+3
22 0
790 RPM 5.3 KPH
540
HEADLAND
0
HA
3/4 1/2 1/4
- Pressing the key «6 (facing symbol 23 Fig. 97) allows a sequence to be lauched if one of them is activated (ON).
0.0
123.6 L/HA 53.8
- To return to the previous menu, press the key «3.
GO
1
1
540 10% M 5%
HEADLAND
2
L/H HA/H
0.0
L/HA
0.0
HA
3/4 1/2 1/4
A
0
+1 24
0
+2
+3
25 23
OFF
Z3A-793-08-04-B Z3A-792-08-04-B
Fig. 97 Fig. 95
11G10.36
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description Description: (24) Current action (25) Following actions A symbol indicates the control status of each spool valve: Spool valve in floating position
Spool valve in Kickout position
The red rectangle indicates the next action, that will be performed as soon as the headland button on the armrest (26 Fig. 98) is pressed. At start-up, only 3 actions are displayed as no action has yet been performed.
26
Z3A-749-07-08
Fig. 98
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.37
Datatronic 3 - Description Rear DUAL CONTROL menu Displays the REAR DUAL CTRL menu in the left-hand window (Fig. 99):
A
1000
B
2000
790RPM 5.3KPH
27
540 10% M 5% 2
1
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND REAR DUAL CTRL FRONT DUAL CTRL 28 TIC
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
This display is used to view the evolution of settings performed while using a rear implement (for example a semi-mounted plough).
Description: (29) Indicates the position of the linkage control (e.g.: soil engagement) (30) Indicates if the DUAL CONTROL is in the furrow start or end mode (31) Indicates the position of the depth wheel spool valve control (e.g.: Lowering) (32) Indicates the linkage position value (33) Indicates the depth wheel position value - Pressing the key «6 switches the DUAL CONTROL to ON or OFF.
Z3A-788-08-04-B
Fig. 99 - To start one of the applications, press the key «1 or «2 twice. The first key press selects the window and the second displays the list. The active application is represented by a green button at the top right of the window (27 Fig. 99).
Note: If, in the case of a field with points (Fig. 101), the point correction lengths are different from 0 (to be defined in the right-hand POINTS window) and if this POINTS window is not displayed on the right-hand screen, then a POINT WARNING icon (34 Fig. 102) is displayed to alert the driver to the fact that the lengths will be modified when the DUAL CTRL is set to ON (see page 68 DUAL CONTROL application).
A
- To call up the various menus, select the application using the encoder. The selected application is displayed in a black frame (28 Fig. 99). - Validate by pressing the encoder or the key «1. The window (Fig. 100) is displayed.
A
1000
B
2000 32
33
790 RPM 5.3 KPH
REAR DUAL CTRL
5%
29 30
73 %
31 OFF
540 10% M 5%
1
B 2
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
Z3A-807-08-04-A
Fig. 101
Z3A-796-08-04-B
Fig. 100
11G10.38
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description
A
1000
B
2000
790RPM 5.3 KPH
REAR DUAL CTRL
5%
73 %
OFF Z3A-797-08-04-B
540 10% M 5%
1
2
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
34 Fig. 102
- Pressing the key «5 returns the user to the REAR DUAL CONTROL configuration menu (Fig. 103).
100% 100%
100% 100% 1920 42.0
0%
0%
0%
0%
6.0 m
6.0 m
6.0 m
6.0 m
100%
100%
100%
100%
Z3A-798-08-04-B
Fig. 103 Note: For data description and settings (Fig. 103), see page 68 DUAL CONTROL application. - To return to the previous window, press the key «2.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.39
Datatronic 3 - Description FRONT DUAL CONTROL menu Displays the FRONT DUAL CTRL menu in the left-hand window (Fig. 104):
A
1000
B
2000
790RPM 5.3 KPH
35
540 10% M 5% 2
1
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND REAR DUAL CTRL FRONT DUAL CTRL TIC
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6 36
Z3A-788-08-04-B
Fig. 104 - To start one of the applications, press the key «1 or «2 twice. The first key press selects the window and the second displays the list. The active application is represented by a green button at the top right of the window (35 Fig. 104). - To call up the various menus, select the application using the encoder. The selected application is displayed in a black frame (36 Fig. 104). - Validate by pressing the encoder or the key «1. The window (Fig. 105) is displayed.
A
1000
B
2000 40
41
790RPM 5.3 KPH
FRONT DUAL CTRL
5%
39
73 %
38
37
Description (Fig. 105): (37) Indicates the position of the rear linkage control (e.g.: Lowering) (38) Indicates if the DUAL CONTROL is in the furrow start or end mode (39) Indicates the position of the front linkage control (e.g.: floating position) (40) Front linkage position value (41) Rear linkage position value - Pressing the key «6 switches the DUAL CONTROL to ON or OFF. - Pressing the key «5 returns the user to the FRONT DUAL CONTROL configuration menu (Fig. 108). - To return to the window (Fig. 107), press the key «2. Note: If, in the case of a field with points (Fig. 106), the point correction lengths are different from 0 (to be defined in the right-hand POINTS window) and if this POINTS window is not displayed on the right-hand screen, then a POINT WARNING icon (42 Fig. 107) is displayed to alert the driver to the fact that the lengths will be modified when the DUAL CTRL is set to ON.
Note: For data description and settings (Fig. 108), see page 68 DUAL CONTROL application.
A
540 10% M 5%
1
2
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
B Z3A-807-08-04-A
Fig. 106
OFF
Z3A-799-08-04-B
Fig. 105 This display is used to view the evolution of settings performed while using a front implement (e.g.: plough, cultivator, roller) and a rear implement.
11G10.40
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description
A
1000
B
2000
790RPM 5.3 KPH
FRONT DUAL CTRL
5%
73 %
OFF
540 10% M 5%
1
2
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
42
Z3A-800-08-04-B
Fig. 107
100% 100%
100%
100% 1920 42.0
0%
0%
0%
0%
6.0 m
6.0 m
6.0 m
6.0 m
100% 100% Z3A-801-08-04-B
Fig. 108
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.41
Datatronic 3 - Description Trailed Implement Control (TIC) menu Displays the TIC menu in the left-hand window (Fig. 109):
A
1000
B
2000
43
790RPM 5.3 KPH
- Pressing the key «5 returns the user to the TIC configuration menu (Fig. 111).
540 10% M 5%
100% 100% 2
1
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND REAR DUAL CTRL FRONT DUAL CTRL TIC
Description: (45) Position of the spool valve control for the disc tiller lift cylinder (46) Value of the disc tiller lift cylinder position - Pressing the key «6 switches the TIC to ON or OFF.
1920 42.0
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
0%
0%
44
Z3A-788-08-04-B
Fig. 109 - To start one of the applications, press the key «1 or «2 twice. The first key press selects the window and the second displays the list. The active application is represented by a green button at the top right of the window (43 Fig. 109). - To call up the various menus, select the application using the encoder. The selected application is displayed in a black frame (44 Fig. 109). - Validate by pressing the encoder or the key «1. The window (Fig. 110) is displayed.
A
1000
B
2000
46
45
790RPM 5.3 KPH
TIC
OFF
Fig. 111 Note: For data description and settings (Fig. 111), see page 68 DUAL CONTROL application. - To return to the previous window, press the key «2.
540 10% M 5%
1
23 %
Z3A-804-08-04-B
2
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
Z3A-802-08-04-B
Fig. 110 This display is used to view the evolution of settings made while using a trailed rear implement on the swinging drawbar (a disc tiller for example).
11G10.42
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description Points menu POINTS menu displayed only in the right-hand window (Fig. 112):
This menu can only be used with a single DUAL CONTROL at a time. Note: To define the DUAL CONTROL and POINTS menu settings, see page 68 DUAL CONTROL application.
A B
790RPM 5.3 KPH
1000 2000
REAR DUAL CTRL
5%
A
540 10% M 5%
47
1
2
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
73 %
OFF
48
B
Z3A-796-08-04-B
Fig. 112 Z3A-807-08-04-A
- To start one of the applications, press the key «1 or «2 twice. The first press selects the window and the second displays the list. The active application is represented by a green button at the top right of the window (47 Fig. 112). - To call up the various menus, select the application using the encoder. The selected application is displayed in a black frame (48 Fig. 112). Validate by pressing the encoder. The window (Fig. 113) is displayed.
A
1000
B
2000
790RPM 5.3 KPH
REAR DUAL CTRL
1
Fig. 114
540 10% M 5%
POINTS
2
Syncr 0.0 m 0.0 m OFF
Reset
Z3A-805-08-04-B
Fig. 113 The DUAL CONTROL menus are used to initiate a straight furrow start or end phase. When the field is pointed, however (see diagram Fig. 114), the POINTS menu must be used.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.43
Datatronic 3 - Description SETTINGS application General This application is used to set the following parameters: - hours, - date, - display and calculation units, - screen (brightness and night mode), - buzzer volume, - language, - servicing schedule. To start the SETTINGS application (Fig. 115): - Rotate the encoder (1) to the SETTINGS application and press the encoder once the active function is highlighted by red text and a red rectangle around the icon, or press the key «2 (2). The main menu (Fig. 116) is displayed. - To exit an application, press the ESC key (3).
10:53:28
08/02/2005
METRIC
L Ga Km Mi
BRIGHTNESS ON: 2 ENGLISH SERVICE: 50 Z3A-814-08-04-B
Fig. 116
• Setting the time and date - Press the key «1, (the window (Fig. 117) is displayed).
1 10:53:28 WORK
HEADLAND
SETTINGS
MEMORIES/ JOBS
1 2
EHS VALVES
DUAL CTRL
2 08/02/2005
3 4 5 6
ESC
Z3A-813-03-05
3 Fig. 115
Z3A-1452-03-05
Fig. 117 Setting parameters (Fig. 116) To set each parameter, press keys «1 to «6, then adjust the values using the encoder. To validate each value, press the encoder.
11G10.44
¤ H
Setting the time: - Press the key «1, (the window (Fig. 118) is displayed). The black arrow indicates which value is to be modified.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description - Validate by pressing the encoder (the arrow moves to the year). - Adjust the year in the same manner. - Validate by pressing the encoder. The main menu is now displayed with the date set (Fig. 116).
10:53:28
08/02/2005
• Setting the display and calculation units - Press the key «2 (the last selected unit is displayed in red (8 Fig. 120)).
Z3A-1453-03-05
Fig. 118
METRIC UK US
8
L Ga Km Mi
- Adjust the hours using the encoder. - Validate the hours by pressing the encoder (the arrow moves to the minutes). - Adjust the minutes in the same manner. - Validate by pressing the encoder. The main menu is now displayed with hours and minutes set (Fig. 116). Setting the date: - Press the key «2 when the window Fig. 116 is open (the window Fig. 119 is displayed). The black arrow indicates which value is to be modified.
Z3A-815-08-04-B
Fig. 120 - Select the correct unit for the country by rotating the encoder and validate to return to the main menu (Fig. 116). Note: The METRIC unit is intended for European countries. The UK and US units are identical, with the exception of the gallon volume unit.
10:53:28
• Adjusting the screen - Press the key «3 when the window (Fig. 116) is open. The window (Fig. 121) is displayed.
08/02/2005
Z3A-1454-03-05
Fig. 119 - Adjust the date using the encoder. - Validate by pressing the encoder (the arrow moves to the month). - Adjust the months in the same manner. Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.45
Datatronic 3 - Description
BRIGHTNESS NIGHT MODE
BRIGHTNESS NIGHT MODE L Ga Km Mi
L Ga Km Mi
AUTO ON OFF
Z3A-815-08-04-B
Z3A-815-08-04-B
Fig. 121 - Using the encoder, select BRIGHTNESS or NIGHT MODE. Adjusting the brightness: - Select the BRIGHTNESS menu using the encoder (the window Fig. 122 is displayed).
Fig. 123 Using the encoder, select one of the following modes: - AUTO (night mode is activated when the tractor headlights are switched on), - ON (night mode is always active and, in this case, the screen goes dark), - OFF (night mode is always deactivated). As soon as one of the modes is validated, the window (Fig. 124) is displayed.
BRIGHTNESS NIGHT MODE L Ga Km Mi
13:22:12 METRIC
08/02/2005 L Ga Km Mi
BRIGHTNESS
78%
ON: 2 ENGLISH SERVICE: 50
Z3A-816-08-04-B
Fig. 122 Z3A-814-08-04-B
- Adjust the brightness (from 0 to 100%) using the encoder. - Validate by pressing the encoder. The main menu is displayed.
Fig. 124
Setting night mode This mode reduces screen brightness during night time use. - Select the NIGHT MODE menu using the encoder (the window Fig. 123 is displayed).
11G10.46
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description • Setting the buzzer volume - Press the key «4 when the window (Fig. 125) is open. The window (Fig. 126) is displayed.
13:22:12
08/02/2005
METRIC
L Ga Km Mi
BRIGHTNESS ON: 2 ENGLISH
FRANÇAIS ENGLISH DEUTSCH ESPAÑOL ITALIANO NORSK SVENSKA ESTONIAN PORTUGUES POLISH NEDERLANDS SUOMI DANSK
L Ga Km Mi
Z3A-815-08-04-B
Fig. 127 SERVICE: 50 Z3A-814-08-04-B
Fig. 125
0
OFF
1
MIN
2
• Setting the servicing schedule This menu allows a warning message to be displayed to remind the driver that the tractor must be serviced. L Ga Km Mi
3 4 5 6
- Select the language by rotating the encoder. - Validate by pressing the encoder. The main menu is displayed. To exit the SETTINGS application, press ESC key.
IMPORTANT: The first servicing must take place after 50 hours and the second after 400 hours. Servicing should then take place every 400 hours. For the first two servicings: The DATATRONIC is factory set. Therefore, a warning message is displayed after 30 hours for the first servicing. For the second, a message is displayed after 350 hours.
MAX
Z3A-815-08-04-B
Fig. 126 - Adjust the volume (from 0 to 6) using the encoder. - Validate by pressing the encoder. The main menu is displayed.
Operation: When the number of hours exceeds 30 hours, a warning message will be displayed regardless of which window is active (Fig. 128).
• Selecting the language - Press the key «5 when the window (Fig. 125) is open. The window (Fig. 127) is displayed.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.47
Datatronic 3 - Description
SERVICE
SERVICE
9
: 30 H
OK
+ -
+ -
< -20 h >
: 50 H 10
OK
PRESS ESC ! ! !
11
NEXT SERVICE = 50
NEXT SERVICE = 50
Z3A-1375-12-04
Z3A-1354-12-04
Fig. 128
Fig. 130
Number of actual tractor hours (identical to instrument panel) (10) Total number of hours before the next servicing (11) Number of hours remaining before next servicing (30 - 50 = -20)
- Press the key «2 regardless of the number of tractor hours. The number of hours to the next servicing is 400 hours (12 Fig. 131).
(9)
Note: This message is also displayed at each start-up (Fig. 129).
SERVICE
OK + 1
: 200 H PRESS ESC ! ! !
12
2
: 180 H < -20 h >
3 4
NEXT SERVICE = 400
5
Z3A-1376-12-04
6
Fig. 131 ESC
Z3A-1372-12-04
Fig. 129
Therefore, as soon as the number of tractor hours exceeds 350, a warning message identical to the first message is displayed (Fig. 132).
- To cancel the message, press the key ESC. When the servicing has been carried out, it should be validated. For this purpose: - Press the key «6 when the window (Fig. 125) is open. The window (Fig. 130) is displayed.
11G10.48
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description
SERVICE
SERVICE
: 350 H
OK
OK
+ -
+ -
< -50 h >
: 400 H PRESS ESC ! ! ! NEXT SERVICE = 400
NEXT SERVICE = 390
Z3A-1377-12-04
Z3A-1378-12-04
Fig. 132
Fig. 134
For the following servicings: Each time the servicing has been carried out on the tractor, it should be validated. For this purpose: - Press the key «6 when the window (Fig. 133) is open. The window (Fig. 134) is displayed.
- Press the key «2 regardless of the number of tractor hours. The number of hours to the next servicing is incremented by 400 hours (13 Fig. 135): 390+400 = 790 390 : number of actual tractor hours (identical to instrument panel) 400 : service interval 790 : hours total at which next servicing should take place.
13:22:12
08/02/2005
METRIC
L Ga Km Mi
SERVICE
BRIGHTNESS ON: 2
OK
ENGLISH
+ -
SERVICE: 390 13
Z3A-814-08-04-B
Fig. 133
NEXT SERVICE = 790 Z3A-1379-12-04
Fig. 135 - However, the number of hours to the next servicing can be modified. For this, press the key «3 when the window (Fig. 135) is open. The number of hours to the next servicing is displayed beside the key «3 (14 Fig. 136).
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.49
Datatronic 3 - Description
13:22:12
SERVICE
14
790
OK
METRIC
+ -
BRIGHTNESS
08/02/2005
L Ga Km Mi
ON: 2 ENGLISH SERVICE: 800
NEXT SERVICE = 790
Z3A-814-08-04-B
Z3A-1353-12-04
Fig. 136 - Adjust the number of hours to the next servicing by turning the encoder. - Validate by pressing the encoder. The adjusted number of hours is displayed in the lower part of the screen. (e.g. Fig. 137: next servicing at 800 hours).
Fig. 138 Therefore, in this example, a warning message is displayed 50 hours before the set value, i.e. at 750 hours.
SERVICE
OK + -
NEXT SERVICE = 800 Z3A-1380-01-05
Fig. 137 - Press the ESC key to return to the previous menu. The window (Fig. 138) is displayed with the number of hours to the next servicing (15 Fig. 138).
11G10.50
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description HEADLAND application Deactivate power take-off
General This application is used to automatically manage manoeuvres at the end of the field. Using a single button, it is possible to automate all functions in order to avoid activating each control lever or button separately. When using an implement, a sequence of 35 actions can be recorded from 46 different actions available.
A
Activate memorised engine speed A
B
Activate memorised engine speed B
Deactivate memorised engine speed
Description (Fig. 139): Activate rear linkage Lifting
MANUAL RECORD
SV1
A
SV2
Activate rear linkage Lowering SV
Activate quick soil engagement
B STOP
STOP
STOP
Deactivate quick soil engagement
STOP
STOP STOP
1
Insert 1-second time delay
2
Insert 2-second time delay
3
Insert 3-second time delay
4
Insert 4-second time delay
5
Insert 5-second time delay
STOP
Z3A-820-08-04-B
Fig. 139
Activate front axle
Deactivate front axle
Differential lock Insert pause Deactivate differential lock
SV1
Activate SV1 speed regulator
SV2
Activate SV2 speed regulator
SV
Deactivate speed regulator
Activate power take-off
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.51
Datatronic 3 - Description For each spool valve: Activate spool valve control (e.g.: ram rod extension)
OFF
REC GO
Activate spool valve control (e.g.: ram rod retraction)
1920 42.0
STOP
......
Activate spool valve control in neutral position
1.2 EDIT
Activate spool valve control in floating position
Each sequence is stored in the DATATRONIC 3 active memory. Up to 7 sequences can be memorised: - 1 sequence can be permanently stored in the HEADLAND application, - 6 sequences in the MEMORIES application, by assigning them an implement name (see page 8 MEMORIES/JOBS application).
Z3A-794-08-04-B
Fig. 141
To start the HEADLAND application (Fig. 140): - Rotate the encoder (1) to the HEADLAND application and press the encoder once the active function is highlighted by red text and a red rectangle around the icon, or press the key «4 (2). The window (Fig. 141) is displayed. - To exit an application, press the ESC key (3).
1
WORK
HEADLAND
SETTINGS
MEMORIES/ JOBS
1 2
EHS VALVES
DUAL CTRL
3
2
4 5 6
ESC
3 Z3A-818-03-05
Fig. 140
11G10.52
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description Recording a sequence To record a sequence, press the key «1 (REC) when the window (Fig. 141) is open. The recording window (Fig. 142) is displayed.
4 AUTOMATIC / MANUAL??
AUTO MANUAL
MEMORY OFF!!!
RECORD
5 6 Z3A-824-08-04
Fig. 143 - Press the key «1 (AUTO) when the window (Fig. 144) is open. A new display appears (Fig. 145).
Z3A-819-08-04-B
Fig. 142 Two recording modes are available: - AUTOMATIC mode (4), - MANUAL mode (5), AUTOMATIC mode records a sequence based on the actions performed. Each action is displayed. In MANUAL mode, the user records a sequence by manually selecting the actions to perform. Note: If no memory is active, a warning message is displayed (6). In this case, the sequence is recorded in the HEADLAND application. If other recordings are performed and if no memory is active, the previously recorded sequence is overwritten. To record a sequence in the memories application, see page 8 MEMORIES/JOBS application.
AUTOMATIC / MANUAL?? MEMORY OFF!!!
AUTO MANUAL
Z3A-819-08-04-B
Fig. 144 • Recording a sequence in AUTOMATIC mode Procedure to follow: IMPORTANT : To record a sequence in automatic mode, it must be started at the end of the field when you are preparing to make a half turn (RECORD Fig. 143). Indeed, the recording time for a sequence must not exceed 2 minutes and 30 seconds. Note: Automatic recording does not take into account the time between the actions, but only the order.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.53
Datatronic 3 - Description
AUTO RECORD
? 7 8
..... STOP Z3A-829-08-04-B Z3A-749-07-04
Fig. 145 The question mark (7) indicates that recording can start. - Perform the usual end of field manoeuvres. The actions are automatically recorded and displayed (Example Fig. 146).
Fig. 147
This stops sequence recording, allowing the operator to perform the end of field manoeuvres. Thus, the furrow end actions are recorded and end with a pause (9 Fig. 148).
AUTO RECORD AUTO RECORD SV1
A
SV1
A
SV
SV
? ..... .....
9 STOP
STOP Z3A-826-08-04-B
Fig. 148
Z3A-825-08-04-B
Fig. 146 - Insert a pause by pressing the headland button on the armrest (8 Fig. 147).
11G10.54
¤ H
- Make your half turn. - Perform the furrow start actions in the same manner. The actions are recorded once more (Fig. 149).
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description • Recording a sequence in MANUAL mode - When the window (Fig. 151) is open, press the key «2 to select MANUAL mode (11). The window (Fig. 152) is displayed.
AUTO RECORD
SV1
A
SV
AUTOMATIC / MANUAL?? A B
SV1
MEMORY OFF!!!
SV2
AUTO MANUAL
11
..... STOP Z3A-827-08-04-B
Fig. 149 - Press the key «6 (Stop) as soon as the furrow start manoeuvres are complete. A new pause is automatically inserted following the recorded actions (10 Fig. 150).
Z3A-819-08-04-B
Fig. 151
MANUAL RECORD OFF
SV1
GO
A A
B
REC SV
?
1920 42.0
SV1
1.2
SV2
EDIT
.....
..... STOP
10 Z3A-829-08-04-B Z3A-828-08-04-B
Fig. 152 Fig. 150 A question mark is displayed in the first icon.
To read a sequence, see page 59 Reading a sequence. Note: When recording in automatic mode, a time delay cannot be inserted. This action is only possible under Inserting an action in the Modifying a recorded sequence menu.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
- Select an action by rotating the encoder and validate by pressing it (e.g.: Fig. 153).
11G10.55
Datatronic 3 - Description
OFF
MANUAL RECORD
SV1
?
SV1
B
.....
GO
A A
REC SV
1920 42.0
SV1
1.2
SV2
EDIT
..... STOP Z3A-828-08-04-B
Z3A-860-08-04-B
Fig. 153 The action is recorded and a new question mark is displayed. - Proceed in the same manner for the other actions. Note: As for automatic recording, a pause must be inserted (by pressing the Headland button Ref. 12 Fig. 154) to perform the end of field manoeuvres.
Fig. 155 To read a sequence, see page 59 Reading a sequence.
Modifying a recorded sequence When the window (Fig. 155) is open, the sequence is not active. An action can be deleted, modified or inserted. For this purpose: - Press the key «5, (the EDIT window Fig. 156 opens).
EDIT
SV1
12
A A
B
SV
GO
SV1
SV2
.....
Z3A-749-07-08
Z3A-861-08-04-B
Fig. 154
- Press the key «6 (Stop) to terminate the sequence. A pause is automatically inserted and a new window is displayed (Fig. 155).
11G10.56
¤ H
Fig. 156 • Deleting an action: - Press the key «1 in the window (Fig. 156). A message is displayed (13) and the first icon is outlined in red (Fig. 157).
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description
OK
EDIT - DELETE
TURN THE ENCODER AND PRESS OK
TURN THE ENCODER AND PRESS OK A
SV1
A
SV
13
A
SV1
SV1
A
SV2
B
OK
EDIT - CHANGE
.....
Z3A-862-08-04-B
SV1
SV2
B
.....
SV
14
Z3A-862-08-04-B
Fig. 159
Fig. 157 - Select the action you wish to delete by rotating the encoder. - Validate either by pressing the encoder, or by pressing key «1. The window (Fig. 158) is displayed with the icon deleted.
OFF
GO
A A
REC SV
SV1
SV2
.....
1920 42.0
EDIT
SV1
B
.....
?
A
SV
SV1
SV2
15
Z3A-864-08-04-B
Fig. 158
• Modifying an action: - Press the key «2 in the window (Fig. 156). A message is displayed and the first icon is outlined in red (14 Fig. 159).
¤ H
TURN THE ENCODER AND PRESS OK
A
1.2
OK
EDIT - CHANGE
B
Z3A-865-08-04-B
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
- Select the action you wish to change by rotating the encoder. - Validate either by pressing the encoder, or by pressing key «1. The icon to modify is replaced by a question mark (15 Fig. 160).
Fig. 160 - Select an action by rotating the encoder. The question mark is replaced by an action. (e.g.: 16 Fig. 161)
11G10.57
Datatronic 3 - Description
OK
EDIT - CHANGE
EDIT
TURN THE ENCODER AND PRESS OK SV1
A A
B
A
SV1
SV
SV1
A
SV2
SV1
.....
16
Z3A-866-08-04-B
Z3A-861-08-04-B
Fig. 161 - Validate either by pressing the encoder, or by pressing key «1. The window (Fig. 162) is displayed with the changed icon.
Fig. 163 A message (17) and a red hyphen (18) are displayed (Fig. 164).
OK
EDIT - INSERT OFF
REC GO
SV1
A A
B
.....
GO
SV2
B
.....
SV
SV2
SV
TURN THE ENCODER AND PRESS OK A
SV1
1920 42.0
A
SV1
1.2 EDIT
17
SV1
SV2
B
.....
SV
18
Z3A-868-08-04-B
Fig. 164
Z3A-867-08-04-B
Fig. 162
• Inserting an action: - Press the key«3 when the window (Fig. 163) is open.
11G10.58
¤ H
- Move the red hyphen by rotating the encoder (the hyphen corresponds to the position of the action to insert). - Validate either by pressing the encoder, or by pressing key «1. An icon with a question mark is inserted. (e.g.: 19 Fig. 165).
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description
EDIT - INSERT
OK
OFF
REC
TURN THE ENCODER AND PRESS OK
?
SV1 SV
B
A
SV1
A
SV
1920 42.0
SV1
A B
SV2
.....
19
.....
Z3A-869-08-04-B
SV2
21
- Select the action to insert by rotating the encoder. The question mark is replaced by an action (e.g.: 20 Fig. 166).
EDIT - INSERT
OK
TURN THE ENCODER AND PRESS OK SV1
A
SV
A
.....
SV1
1.2 EDIT
Z3A-871-08-04-B
Fig. 165
B
GO
A
SV1
Fig. 167
Reading a sequence The DATATRONIC 3 can read either one of the 6 sequences recorded in the MEMORIES application, or a sequence recorded in the HEADLAND application. Note: To read one of the 6 sequences recorded in the MEMORIES application, a memory must first be activated. For this, see page 17 IMPORTANT: To measure parameters with one of the two spool valves, a Kickout must be activated.. Two modes are available for reading a sequence: - Manual mode reading. This mode requires the user to press the headland button (22 Fig. 168) to start each action. - Automatic mode reading This mode starts a series of actions by pressing the headland button once, for 1.5 seconds.
SV2
20
Z3A-870-08-04-B
Fig. 166 - Validate either by pressing the encoder, or by pressing key «1. The window (21 Fig. 167) is displayed with the inserted icon.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.59
Datatronic 3 - Description
OFF
GO
A
SV1
A
22
REC SV
SV1
1.2
SV2
B
1920 42.0
EDIT
.....
Z3A-828-08-04-B Z3A-749-07-04
Fig. 168
• Reading a sequence in MANUAL mode - Start reading a sequence depending on the order actions are stored in. If the sequence was stored in automatic mode, start reading just before furrow end (GO Fig. 169).
Fig. 170
ON 23 STOP
SV1
A A
B
SV
1920 42.0
SV1
SV2
..... Z3A-873-08-04-B
Fig. 171 The first icon (first action) is outlined in red (23 Fig. 171).
GO Z3A-872-08-04
Fig. 169 Procedure to follow: - Press the key «2 (GO) when the window (Fig. 170) is open. A new window is displayed (Fig. 171).
11G10.60
¤ H
- Press the headland button on the armrest (22 Fig. 168) for each action to perform. The icon outlined in red indicates the next action to be performed. - To stop reading a sequence, press the key «2 (STOP). Note: When a PAUSE action is triggered, a buzzer sounds (except if the volume is set to 0).
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description • Reading a sequence in AUTOMATIC mode Procedure to follow: - Press the key «2 (GO) when the window (Fig. 172) is open. A new window is displayed (Fig. 173).
OFF
GO
A
SV1
A
REC SV
1.2 EDIT
.....
• Setting reading parameters: The time delay between each action can be increased or decreased by a period of 0.2 to 3 seconds. When the (Fig. 172) window is open, press the key «4. Pressing this key increases the time delay by 0.2 seconds.
1920 42.0
SV1
SV2
B
Note: When a PAUSE action is triggered, reading stops and a buzzer sounds (except if the volume is set to 0). To resume reading, proceed in the same manner.
Z3A-828-08-04-B
Fig. 172
Note: If this time is not enough, time delays can be inserted manually (from 1 to 5 seconds) Modifying reading In both reading modes, reading progress can be modified if an action needs to be activated manually (Fig. 173): - To manually move to the next action, press the key «4, - To manually move to the previous action, press the key «5, - To move back to the start of a sequence, press the key «6.
ON 24 STOP
SV1
A A
B
SV
1920 42.0
Displaying reading in the WORK application - When the window (Fig. 172) is open, press the key «3. The window (Fig. 174) is displayed.
SV1
SV2
.....
A
1000
B
2000
790 RPM 5.3 KPH 1
Z3A-873-08-04-B
Fig. 173 The first icon (first action) is outlined in red (24 Fig. 173). - Press the headland button on the armrest (22 Fig. 168) for 1.5 seconds to start reading the sequence. The actions are performed in sequence at defined time intervals (see page 61 Setting reading parameters:). The icon outlined in red indicates the next action to be performed. - To stop reading a sequence, press the key «2 (STOP).
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND REAR DUAL CTRL FRONT DUAL CTRL TIC
540 10% M 5%
HEADLAND
2
A
0
+1
+2
+3
OFF
Z3A-874-08-04-B
Fig. 174 For the description of this window, see page 36 Headland application.
11G10.61
Datatronic 3 - Description Note: If a sequence reading operation is active when the window (Fig. 175) is open, the word HEADLAND flashes red to alert the driver (25).
25
WORK
HEADLAND
SETTINGS
MEMORIES/ JOB
1 2
EHS VALVES
DUAL CTRL
3 4 5 6
ESC
Z3A-875-03-05
Fig. 175
11G10.62
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description EHS VALVES application
Description (Fig. 177)
General This application is used to set the hydraulic spool valve parameters (maximum 5). The DATATRONIC 3 allows the following to be performed for each spool valve: - setting the ram rod retraction or extension flow rate, - setting "Kick out" values (spool valve activation time), - authorisation, or not, of spool valve floating position. To start the EHS VALVES application (Fig. 176): - Rotate the encoder (1) to the EHS VALVES application and press the encoder once the active function is highlighted by red text and a red rectangle around the icon, or press the key «4 (2). The window (Fig. 177) is displayed. - To exit an application, press the ESC key (3).
100%
100%
0s
100%
100%
0s
100%
100%
0s
100%
100%
0s
100%
100%
0s
Z3A-876-08-04
Fig. 177
Green spool valve controlled by the Joystick
1 Red spool valve controlled by the Joystick WORK
HEADLAND
SETTINGS
MEMORIES/ JOBS
3
DUAL CTRL
4
1 2
EHS VALVES
Black spool valve controlled by lever 1
2 Yellow spool valve controlled by lever 2
5 6
Blue spool valve controlled by lever 3 ESC
Z3A-875-03-05
3 Fig. 176
For each spool valve: Floating position available
0s
Spool valve activation time
100%
Value of the spool valve flow rate (on ram rod extension for example)
100%
Value of the spool valve flow rate (on ram rod retraction for example)
Note: The values displayed, along with the floating position of the spool valves in the window (Fig. 177) are default values.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.63
Datatronic 3 - Description Setting hydraulic spool valve parameters • Setting flow rates (Fig. 178) - Select the spool valve to adjust using keys «1 to «5.
4
0 < . . < 100%
100%
0 < . . < 100%
100%
100%
100%
0s
0 < . . < 60s / >>
100%
100%
0s
FLOAT :
100%
100%
0s
100%-0s-FLOAT=OK
100%
100%
0s
100%
100%
0s
0s 0s
OK-KO Reset
Z3A-887-08-04
Fig. 180
Z3A-876-08-04
Fig. 178
- Adjust the flow rate value (from 0 to 100%) by rotating the encoder. - Validate the selected value by either pressing the encoder, or by pressing key «2. The value is displayed in black (5 Fig. 181).
Example: key «1 provides access to the first spool valve. A new window is displayed (Fig. 179). 5
0 < . . < 100%
100%
0 < . . < 100%
100%
0 < . . < 60s / >> FLOAT :
0 < . . < 100%
84%
0 < . . < 100%
100%
0 < . . < 60s / >> FLOAT :
0s 0s
OK-KO
100%-0s-FLOAT=OK
OK-KO
0s 0s
Reset
Z3A-886-08-04
100%-0s-FLOAT=OK
Reset
Z3A-885-08-04
Fig. 179 - Select the ram rod extension flow rate by pressing the key «2. The percent flow rate is displayed in red (4 Fig. 180).
11G10.64
¤ H
Fig. 181 Proceed in the same manner to adjust the ram rod retraction flow rate. To return to the previous window, press the ESC key. Note: The flow rate values are defined with respect to the spool valve maximum flow rate.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description Operation (Fig. 182): As long as the position of control lever for the concerned spool valve is inferior to 80% of its maximum position, the generated flow is proportional to its position. Beyond 80%, the flow generated is that which was stored. When the EHS VALVES menu in the WORK application is open and a spool valve control is moved, the red real-time display zone moves in proportion to the lever position (6). The values of the set flow rates are displayed on either side of the progress bars (7 and 8).
A
1000
B
2000
87
53
6 EHS VALVES 1-4 98
790RPM 5.3KPH
28 8s
Z3A-786-08-04-B
76 5s
100%
0s
100%
100%
0s
100%
100%
0s
100%
100%
0s
100%
100%
0s
Z3A-876-08-04
10% M 5%
1
19
7
100 2s
540
100%
Fig. 183 2
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
Example: key «1 provides access to the first spool valve. A new window is displayed (Fig. 184).
89
8
Fig. 182
Note: To display this window, see page 31 WORK application. • Setting spool valve activation times (Kickout) (Fig. 183) - Select the spool valve to adjust using keys «1 to «5.
0 < . . < 100%
100%
0 < . . < 100%
100%
0 < . . < 60s / >> FLOAT :
0s 0s
OK-KO
100%-0s-FLOAT=OK
Reset
Z3A-885-08-04
Fig. 184 - Press the key «4. The spool valve activation time is displayed in red (9 Fig. 185).
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.65
Datatronic 3 - Description was stored. - Two other different symbols can be displayed depending on the configuration:
0 < . . < 100%
100%
0 < . . < 100%
100% 9
0 < . . < 60s / >> FLOAT :
>>
Permanent spool valve flow (12)
Spool valve in floating position (13)
0s 0s
OK-KO Reset
100%-0s-FLOAT=OK Z3A-888-08-04
Fig. 185 - Adjust the activation time by rotating the encoder (from 0 to 60 seconds or >> for permanent flow (hydraulic motor supply for example)). - Validate the value by either pressing the encoder, or by pressing key «3. The value is displayed in black (10 Fig. 186).
A
1000
B
2000
790RPM 5.3KPH
EHS VALVES 1-4 87
53
98
19
100 2s
>>
28
76 5s
89
540 10% M 5%
1
2
EHS VALVES 1-4 GEARBOX SETTINGS ACTIVE MEMORY HEADLAND POINTS EHS VALVES 5-6
Z3A-890-08-04-B
12
11
13
Fig. 187
Note: To display this window, see page 31 WORK application.
100%
0 < . . < 100%
100%
0 < . . < 100%
• Activating the floating position (Fig. 188) - Select the spool valve to adjust using keys «1 to «5.
10
0 < . . < 60s / >> FLOAT :
0s 8s
OK-KO
100%-0s-FLOAT=OK
Reset
Z3A-889-08-04
Fig. 186 To return to the previous window, press the ESC key. Operation (Fig. 187): - To initiate a spool valve activation time, push its control lever beyond 80% of its maximum position, then release the lever. - During the activation phase, the time delay set appears in a black frame (11). As long as the position of control lever for the concerned spool valve is inferior to 80% of its maximum position, the generated flow is proportional to its position. Beyond 80%, the flow generated is that which
11G10.66
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description
100%
100%
0s
100%
100%
0s
100%
100%
0s
100%
100%
100%
100%
• Resetting the parameters (Fig. 190) - Select the spool valve to adjust using keys «1 to «5.
100%
100%
0s
0s
100%
100%
0s
0s
100%
100%
0s
100%
100%
0s
100%
100%
0s
Z3A-876-08-04
Fig. 188 Example: key «1 provides access to the first spool valve. A new window is displayed (Fig. 189).
Z3A-876-08-04
Fig. 190 Example: key «1 provides access to the first spool valve. A new window is displayed (Fig. 191).
0 < . . < 100%
100%
0 < . . < 100%
100%
0 < . . < 60s / >> FLOAT :
0s 0s
OK-KO
100%-0s-FLOAT=OK
Reset
0 < . . < 100%
100%
0 < . . < 100%
100%
0 < . . < 60s / >> FLOAT :
Z3A-885-08-04
Fig. 189 - Press the key «5 to display either:
0s 0s
OK-KO
100%-0s-FLOAT=OK
Reset
Z3A-885-08-04
Fig. 191 STOP
Floating position unavailable
- Press the key «6 (RESET) to reset the values. Floating position available
To return to the previous window, press the ESC key.
Default values after reset: - spool valve flow on rod retraction and extension at 100%, - spool valve activation time at 0 seconds, - floating position available. To return to the previous window, press the ESC key.
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.67
Datatronic 3 - Description DUAL CONTROL application
Y
General The DUAL CONTROL is a system which automatically controls implements in working position and at the end of the field. It also allows the rear linkage position to be carried over to the front linkage position or to the depth wheel position of a semi-mounted plough for example. The information necessary for the correct operation of the system is acquired by sensors, processed by the Autotronic 5 linkage calculator, which controls the operation of an electrohydraulic spool valve, and is displayed on the Datatronic 3 onboard computer. Using this application, the following can be controlled: - a front and rear implement, with the FRONT DUAL CONTROL (e.g.: a front roller and a combined rear seeder (Fig. 192), a front and rear plough, etc.), - a semi-mounted rear implement, with the REAR DUAL CONTROL (e.g.: a semi-mounted plough (Fig. 193), a semi-mounted disc tiller, etc., These implements being hitched to the rear linkage), - a trailed rear implement with the TRAILED IMPLEMENT CONTROL (TIC) (e.g.: a disc tiller (Fig. 194), a trailed Chisel, etc. These implements are hitched to the swinging drawbar or lift arms). This system allows the implement height to be set according to the wheel slip and the draft applied to the lift arms (the linkage is fixed).
FURROW START
Y
FURROW END Z3A-808-08-04
Fig. 193
Y Z3A-945-08-04
Fig. 194
Z3A-944-08-04-B
Fig. 192
11G10.68
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description To start the DUAL CONTROL application (Fig. 195): - rotate the encoder (1) to the DUAL CTRL application.
1
WORK
HEADLAND
SETTINGS
MEMORIES/ JOBS
EHS VALVES
DUAL CTRL
1 2 3 4 5 6
ESC
Z3A-938-03-05
2 Fig. 195
- press the encoder when the active function is highlighted by red text and a red rectangle around the icon (the window Fig. 196 is displayed). - to exit an application, press the ESC key (2).
1
? 3
?
5
? Z3A-817-08-04
Fig. 196
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.69
Datatronic 3 - Description Parts list Fig. 197:
FRONT DUAL CONTROL • Operating principle With the FRONT DUAL CONTROL, the rear implement enters the soil at the exact point where the front implement entered the soil. The Datatronic 3 is the interface between the operator and the Autotronic 5 linkage calculator: - It allows initial FRONT DUAL CONTROL adjustments to be made. - It monitors FRONT DUAL CONTROL operation.
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10)
Datatronic 3 DCC2 Radar Engine and ground speed sensors Front linkage position sensor Rear linkage position sensor Rear linkage draft sensors Autotronic 5 linkage calculator Rear linkage solenoid valve DUAL CONTROL solenoid valve
2
1
3
1 2 3 4 5 6
8
ESC
4
CAN CAN
5
9 6 CAN
10 7 MA-11-06107A
Fig. 197
11G10.70
¤ H
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
Datatronic 3 - Description Note: The explanations in the section shall be illustrated with the example of a front roller and a combined rear seeder. When the window (Fig. 198) is open, press the key «1. The window (Fig. 199) is displayed.
Authorises furrow start setting
Authorises furrow end setting
Activates or deactivates the rear implement depth transfer function
1
?
- Left-hand part of the window: In all greyed boxes, memorised values
3
?
5
? Z3A-817-08-04
Fig. 198
3 100% 100%
100%
100% 1920 42.0
0%
0%
0%
4
6.0 m 100% 100%
Linkage high position values Linkage low position values Furrow start length Furrow start front linkage extra-lowering value Furrow end length
• Calibration To ensure correct operation of the FRONT DUAL CONTROL, the front linkage position sensor must be calibrated.
When reassembling, the sensor must be fitted to the centre of the ports (Fig. 200) to a torque of approximately 8 Nm.
6.0 m
5
(3) (4) (5) (6) (7)
IMPORTANT: This operation must be performed on first use, or as soon as work is carried out on the front linkage position sensor.
0%
6.0 m
6.0 m
Note: The values that are not in boxes correspond to instant values.
7 6
Z3A-801-08-04-B
Fig. 199 Description: - Right-hand part of the window: Memorises high and low implement positions
1920 42.0
Displays the FRONT DUAL menu in the work application
Opens the linkage calibration menu
Massey Ferguson 8400 - Issue 2.b
¤ H
11G10.71
Datatronic 3 - Description
CALIBRATION MODE 1500 RPM
3